Form 20-F
Table of Contents

As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on March 11, 2016

 

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549

Form 20-F

  ¨

REGISTRATION STATEMENT PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(b) OR (g) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

or

  x

ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 FOR THE FISCAL YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2015

or

  ¨

            TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

or

  ¨

SHELL COMPANY REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

Date of event requiring this shell company report……………………………….

Commission file number 1-15242

Deutsche Bank Aktiengesellschaft

(Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter)

Deutsche Bank Corporation

(Translation of Registrant’s name into English)

Federal Republic of Germany

(Jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)

Taunusanlage 12, 60325 Frankfurt am Main, Germany

(Address of principal executive offices)

Peter Burrill, +49-69-910-31781, peter.burrill@db.com, Taunusanlage 12, 60325 Frankfurt am Main, Germany

(Name, Telephone, E-mail and/or Facsimile number and Address of Company Contact Person)

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act

See following page

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act.

NONE

(Title of Class)

Securities for which there is a reporting obligation pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Act.

NONE

(Title of Class)

Indicate the number of outstanding shares of each of the issuer’s classes of capital or common stock as of the close of the period covered by the annual report:

 

Ordinary Shares, no par value    1,378,898,267

(as of December 31, 2015)

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.

Yes ¨             No x

If this report is an annual or transition report, indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.

Yes ¨            No x

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.

Yes x            No ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate website, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).

Yes ¨            No ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, or non-accelerated filer. See definition of “accelerated filer and large accelerated filer” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act (Check one):

Large accelerated filer x    Accelerated filer ¨    Non-accelerated filer ¨

Indicate by check mark which basis of accounting the registrant has used to prepare the financial statements included in this filing:

U.S. GAAP     ¨    International Financial Reporting Standards    x    Other     ¨
   as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board   

If “Other” has been checked in response to the previous question, indicate by check mark which financial statement item the registrant has elected to follow

Item 17 ¨            Item 18 ¨

If this is an annual report, indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).

Yes ¨            No x


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       2
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act (as of February 29, 2016).

 

Title of each class

  Name of each exchange on which        
registered

Ordinary shares, no par value

  New York Stock Exchange

 

 

 

6.55 % Trust Preferred Securities of Deutsche Bank Contingent Capital Trust II

  New York Stock Exchange

6.55 % Company Preferred Securities of Deutsche Bank Contingent Capital LLC II*

 

Subordinated Guarantees of Deutsche Bank AG in connection with Capital Securities*

 

 

 

 

7.60 % Trust Preferred Securities of Deutsche Bank Contingent Capital Trust III

  New York Stock Exchange

7.60 % Company Preferred Securities of Deutsche Bank Contingent Capital LLC III*

 

Subordinated Guarantees of Deutsche Bank AG in connection with Capital Securities*

 

 

 

 

8.05 % Trust Preferred Securities of Deutsche Bank Contingent Capital Trust V

  New York Stock Exchange

8.05 % Company Preferred Securities of Deutsche Bank Contingent Capital LLC V*

 

Subordinated Guarantees of Deutsche Bank AG in connection with Capital Securities*

 

 

 

 

Fixed to Fixed Reset Rate Subordinated Tier 2 Notes Due 2028

  New York Stock Exchange

 

 

 

4.50 % Fixed Rate Subordinated Tier 2 Notes Due 2025

  New York Stock Exchange

 

 

 

DB Agriculture Short Exchange Traded Notes due April 1, 2038

  NYSE Arca

 

 

 

DB Agriculture Long Exchange Traded Notes due April 1, 2038

  NYSE Arca

 

 

 

DB Agriculture Double Short Exchange Traded Notes due April 1, 2038

  NYSE Arca

 

 

 

DB Agriculture Double Long Exchange Traded Notes due April 1, 2038

  NYSE Arca

 

 

 

DB Base Metals Short Exchange Traded Notes due June 1, 2038

  NYSE Arca

 

 

 

DB Base Metals Long Exchange Traded Notes due June 1, 2038

  NYSE Arca

 

 

 

DB Base Metals Double Short Exchange Traded Notes due June 1, 2038

  NYSE Arca

 

 

 

DB Base Metals Double Long Exchange Traded Notes due June 1, 2038

  NYSE Arca

 

 

 

DB Commodity Short Exchange Traded Notes due April 1, 2038

  NYSE Arca

 

 

 

DB Commodity Long Exchange Traded Notes due April 1, 2038

  NYSE Arca

 

 

 

DB Commodity Double Long Exchange Traded Notes due April 1, 2038

  NYSE Arca

 

 

 

DB Commodity Double Short Exchange Traded Notes due April 1, 2038

  NYSE Arca

 

 

 

DB Crude Oil Short Exchange Traded Notes due June 1, 2038

  NYSE Arca

 

 

 

DB Crude Oil Long Exchange Traded Notes due June 1, 2038

  NYSE Arca

 

 

 

DB Crude Oil Double Short Exchange Traded Notes due June 1, 2038

  NYSE Arca

 

 

 

DB German Bund Futures Exchange Traded Notes due March 31, 2021

  NYSE Arca

 

 

 

DB Gold Double Long Exchange Traded notes due February 15, 2038

  NYSE Arca

 

 

 

DB Gold Double Short Exchange Traded notes due February 15, 2038

  NYSE Arca

 

 

 

DB Gold Short Exchange Traded notes due February 15, 2038

  NYSE Arca

 

 

 

DB Japanese Govt Bond Futures Exchange Traded Notes due March 31, 2021

  NYSE Arca

 

 

 

DB Inverse Japanese Govt Bond Futures Exchange Traded Notes due November 30, 2021

  NYSE Arca

 

 

 

DB 3x German Bund Futures Exchange Traded Notes due March 31, 2021

  NYSE Arca

 

 

 

DB 3x Japanese Govt Bond Futures Exchange Traded Notes due March 31, 2021

  NYSE Arca

 

 

 

DB 3x Inverse Japanese Govt Bond Futures Exchange Traded Notes due November 30, 2021

  NYSE Arca

 

 

 

DB 3x Long 25+ Year Treasury Bond Exchange Traded Notes due May 31, 2040

  NYSE Arca

 

 

 

DB 3x Short 25+ Year Treasury Bond Exchange Traded Notes due May 31, 2040

  NYSE Arca

 

 

 

ELEMENTS “Dogs of the Dow” Linked to the Dow Jones High Yield Select 10 Total Return Index due November 14, 2022   NYSE Arca

 

 

 

ELEMENTS Linked to the Morningstar® Wide Moat Focus(SM) Total Return Index due October 24, 2022

  NYSE Arca

 

 

 

FI Enhanced Global High Yield Exchange Traded Notes Linked to the MSCI World High Dividend Yield USD Gross Total Return Index due October 12, 2023   NYSE Arca
* For listing purpose only, not for trading.


Table of Contents
3   Deutsche Bank   
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F   
                       
    

 

                    

Table of Contents

 

Table of Contents – 3

PART I – 8

Item 1: Identity of Directors, Senior Management and Advisers – 8

Item 2: Offer Statistics and Expected Timetable – 8

Item 3: Key Information – 8

Selected Financial Data – 8

Dividends – 10

Exchange Rate and Currency Information – 11

Capitalization and Indebtedness – 12

Reasons for the Offer and Use of Proceeds – 12

Risk Factors – 13

Item 4: Information on the Company – 41

History and Development of the Company – 41

Business Overview – 41

Our Corporate Divisions – 47

The Competitive Environment – 47

Regulation and Supervision – 52

Organizational Structure – 72

Property and Equipment – 72

Information Required by Industry Guide 3 – 73

Item 4A: Unresolved Staff Comments – 73

Item 5: Operating and Financial Review and Prospects – 73

Overview – 73

Significant Accounting Policies and Critical Accounting Estimates – 73

Recently Adopted Accounting Pronouncements and New Accounting Pronouncements – 74

Operating Results – 74

Results of Operations – 75

Financial Position – 75

Liquidity and Capital Resources – 75

Post-Employment Benefit Plans – 75

Exposure to Monoline Insurers – 75

Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements – 76

Tabular Disclosure of Contractual Obligations – 76

Research and Development, Patents and Licenses – 76

Item 6: Directors, Senior Management and Employees – 76

Directors and Senior Management – 76

Board Practices of the Management Board – 79

Group Executive Committee – 80

Compensation – 80

Employees – 80

Share Ownership – 80

Item 7: Major Shareholders and Related Party Transactions – 81

Major Shareholders – 81

Related Party Transactions – 81

Interests of Experts and Counsel – 83

Item 8: Financial Information – 83

Consolidated Statements and Other Financial Information – 83

Significant Changes – 89

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       4
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

Item 9: The Offer and Listing – 89

Offer and Listing Details and Markets – 89

Plan of Distribution – 90

Selling Shareholders – 90

Dilution – 90

Expenses of the Issue – 90

Item 10: Additional Information – 91

Share Capital – 91

Memorandum and Articles of Association – 91

Notification Requirements – 95

Material Contracts – 97

Exchange Controls – 97

Taxation – 98

Dividends and Paying Agents – 101

Statement by Experts – 101

Documents on Display – 101

Subsidiary Information – 101

Item 11: Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Credit, Market and Other Risk – 102

Item 12: Description of Securities other than Equity Securities – 102

PART II – 103

Item 13: Defaults, Dividend Arrearages and Delinquencies – 103

Item 14: Material Modifications to the Rights of Security Holders and Use of Proceeds – 103

Item 15: Controls and Procedures – 103

Disclosure Controls and Procedures – 103

Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 103

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm – 104

Change in Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 105

Item 16A: Audit Committee Financial Expert – 105

Item 16B: Code of Ethics – 105

Item 16C: Principal Accountant Fees and Services – 106

Item 16D: Exemptions from the Listing Standards for Audit Committees – 106

Item 16E: Purchases of Equity Securities by the Issuer and Affiliated Purchasers – 106

Item 16F: Change in Registrant’s Certifying Accountant – 107

Item 16G: Corporate Governance – 107

Item 16H: Mine Safety Disclosure – 110

Disclosures Under Iran Threat Reduction and Syria Human Rights Act of 2012 – 111

PART III – 114

Item 17: Financial Statements – 114

Item 18: Financial Statements – 114

Item 19: Exhibits – 114

Signatures – 115

Annual Report – 116

Supplemental Financial Information (Unaudited) – S-1

 

 


Table of Contents
5   Deutsche Bank   
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F   
                       
    

 

                    

Deutsche Bank Aktiengesellschaft, which we also call Deutsche Bank AG, is a stock corporation organized under the laws of the Federal Republic of Germany. Unless otherwise specified or required by the context, in this document, references to “we”, “us”, “our”, “the Group” and “Deutsche Bank Group” are to Deutsche Bank Aktiengesellschaft and its consolidated subsidiaries.

Due to rounding, numbers presented throughout this document may not add up precisely to the totals we provide and percentages may not precisely reflect the absolute figures.

Our registered address is Taunusanlage 12, 60325 Frankfurt am Main, Germany, and our telephone number is +49-69-910-00.

Inclusion of Our Annual Report 2015

We have included as an integral part of this Annual Report on Form 20-F our Annual Report 2015, to which we refer for the responses to certain items hereof. Certain portions of the Annual Report 2015 have been omitted, as indicated therein. The included Annual Report 2015 contains our consolidated financial statements, which we also incorporate by reference into this report, in response to Items 8.A and 18. Such consolidated financial statements differ from those contained in the Annual Report 2015 used for other purposes in that, for Notes 44 and 45 thereto, notes addressing non-U.S. requirements have been replaced with notes addressing U.S. requirements, and Note 46 thereto has been omitted. Such consolidated financial statements have been audited by KPMG AG Wirtschaftsprüfungsgesellschaft, as described in their “Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm” included on page 389 of the Annual Report 2015, which report is included only in the version of the Annual Report 2015 included in this Annual Report on Form 20-F.

Cautionary Statement Regarding Forward-Looking Statements

We make certain forward-looking statements in this document with respect to our financial condition and results of operations. In this document, forward-looking statements include, among others, statements relating to:

 

 

the potential development and impact on us of economic and business conditions and the legal and regulatory environment to which we are subject;

 

the implementation of our strategic initiatives and other responses thereto;

 

the development of aspects of our results of operations;

 

our expectations of the impact of risks that affect our business, including the risks of losses on our trading processes and credit exposures; and

 

other statements relating to our future business development and economic performance.

In addition, we may from time to time make forward-looking statements in our periodic reports to the United States Securities and Exchange Commission on Form 6-K, annual and interim reports, invitations to Annual General Meetings and other information sent to shareholders, offering circulars and prospectuses, press releases and other written materials. Our Management Board, Supervisory Board, officers and employees may also make oral forward-looking statements to third parties, including financial analysts.

Forward-looking statements are statements that are not historical facts, including statements about our beliefs and expectations. We use words such as “believe”, “anticipate”, “expect”, “intend”, “seek”, “estimate”, “project”, “should”, “potential”, “reasonably possible”, “plan”, “aim” and similar expressions to identify forward-looking statements.

By their very nature, forward-looking statements involve risks and uncertainties, both general and specific. We base these statements on our current plans, estimates, projections and expectations. You should therefore not place too much reliance on them. Our forward-looking statements speak only as of the date we make them, and we undertake no obligation to update any of them in light of new information or future events.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       6
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

We caution you that a number of important factors could cause our actual results to differ materially from those we describe in any forward-looking statement. These factors include, among others, the following:

 

 

the potential development and impact on us of economic and business conditions;

 

other changes in general economic and business conditions;

 

changes and volatility in currency exchange rates, interest rates and asset prices;

 

changes in governmental policy and regulation, including measures taken in response to economic, business, political and social conditions;

 

the potential development and impact on us of legal and regulatory proceedings to which we are or may become subject;

 

changes in our competitive environment;

 

the success of our acquisitions, divestitures, mergers and strategic alliances;

 

our success in implementing our strategic initiatives and other responses to economic and business conditions and the legal and regulatory environment and realizing the benefits anticipated therefrom; and

 

other factors, including those we refer to in “Item 3: Key Information – Risk Factors” and elsewhere in this document and others to which we do not refer.

Use of Non-GAAP Financial Measures

This document and other documents we have published or may publish contain non-GAAP financial measures. Non-GAAP financial measures are measures of our historical or future performance, financial position or cash flows that contain adjustments which exclude or include amounts that are included or excluded, as the case may be, from the most directly comparable measure calculated and presented in accordance with IFRS in our financial statements. Examples of our non-GAAP financial measures, and the most directly comparable IFRS financial measures, are as follows:

 

Non-GAAP Financial Measure

  

Most Directly Comparable IFRS Financial Measure

IBIT attributable to Deutsche Bank shareholders

   Income (loss) before income taxes

 

  

 

Adjusted costs

   Noninterest expenses

 

  

 

Average active equity

   Average shareholders’ equity

 

  

 

Pre-tax return on average active equity

   Pre-tax return on average shareholders’ equity

 

  

 

Post-tax return on average active equity

   Post-tax return on average shareholders’ equity

 

  

 

Tangible shareholders’ equity, Tangible book value

   Total shareholders’ equity (book value)

 

  

 

Post-tax return on average tangible shareholders’ equity

   Post-tax return on average shareholders’ equity

 

  

 

CRR/CRD 4 Solvency Measures

Our regulatory assets, exposures, risk-weighted assets, capital and ratios thereof are calculated for regulatory purposes as of December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014 and set forth throughout this document under the regulation on prudential requirements for credit institutions and investment firms (“CRR”) and the Capital Requirements Directive 4 (“CRD 4”) implementing Basel 3, which were published on June 27, 2013 and which apply on and after January 1, 2014. CRR/CRD 4 provides for “transitional” rules, under which capital instruments that are no longer eligible under the new rules are permitted to be phased-out as the new rules on regulatory adjustments are phased in, as well as regarding the risk weighting of certain categories of assets. Unless otherwise noted, our CRR/CRD 4 solvency measures as of December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014 set forth in this document reflect these transitional rules.

We also set forth in this document such CRR/CRD 4 measures on a “fully loaded” basis, reflecting full application of the rules without consideration of the transitional provisions under CRR/CRD 4. As the final implementation of CRR/CRD 4 may differ from our expectations, and our competitors’ assumptions and estimates regarding such implementation may vary, our fully loaded CRR/CRD 4 measures, which are non-GAAP financial measures, may not be comparable with similarly labeled measures used by our competitors.

 

 


Table of Contents
7   Deutsche Bank   
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F   
                       
    

 

                    

Because CRR/CRD 4 was not yet applicable prior to January 1, 2014, our regulatory assets, exposures, risk-weighted assets, capital and ratios thereof were calculated for regulatory purposes as of December 31, 2013 under the previously applicable the Basel 2.5 capital rules.

We believe that these “fully loaded” and pro forma CRR/CRD 4 calculations provide useful information to investors as they reflect our progress against the new regulatory capital standards and as many of our competitors have been describing CRR/CRD 4 calculations on a “fully loaded” basis.

Further Description and Reconciliation of Non-GAAP Financial Measures

For descriptions of these non-GAAP financial measures and the adjustments made to the most directly comparable financial measures under IFRS (or the CRR/CRD 4 rules, as applicable), please refer to “Supplementary Information: Non-GAAP Financial Measures” on pages 438 through 442 of the Annual Report 2015 and, for the CRR/CRD 4 regulatory capital, risk-weighted assets, capital ratios and leverage ratio, to “Management Report: Risk Report: Risk and Capital Performance: Capital and Leverage Ratio” on pages 125 through 137 of the Annual Report 2015, which are incorporated by reference herein.

When used with respect to future periods, our non-GAAP financial measures are also forward-looking statements. We cannot predict or quantify the levels of the most directly comparable financial measures under IFRS (or the CRR/CRD 4 rules) that would correspond to these non-GAAP financial measures for future periods. This is because neither the magnitude of such IFRS (or CRR/CRD 4) financial measures, nor the magnitude of the adjustments to be used to calculate the related non-GAAP financial measures from such IFRS (or CRR/CRD 4) financial measures, can be predicted. Such adjustments, if any, will relate to specific, currently unknown, events and in most cases can be positive or negative, so that it is not possible to predict whether, for a future period, the non-GAAP financial measure will be greater than or less than the related IFRS (or CRR/CRD 4) financial measure.

Use of Internet Addresses

This document contains inactive textual addresses of Internet websites operated by us and third parties. Reference to such websites is made for informational purposes only, and information found at such websites is not incorporated by reference into this document.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       8
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
PART I      
     

 

Item 1: Identity of Directors, Senior Management and Advisers

Not required because this document is filed as an annual report.

Item 2: Offer Statistics and Expected Timetable

Not required because this document is filed as an annual report.

Item  3: Key Information

Selected Financial Data

We have derived the data we present in the tables below from our audited consolidated financial statements for the years presented. You should read all of the data in the tables below together with the consolidated financial statements and notes included in “Item 18: Financial Statements” and the information we provide in “Item 5: Operating and Financial Review and Prospects.” Except where we have indicated otherwise, we have prepared all of the consolidated financial information in this document in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”) as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (“IASB”) and as endorsed by the European Union (“EU”). Our corporate division and segment data comes from our management reporting systems and is not in all cases prepared in accordance with IFRS. For a discussion of the major differences between our management reporting systems and our consolidated financial statements under IFRS, see Note 4 “Business Segments and Related Information” to the consolidated financial statements.

 

 


Table of Contents
9   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

Income Statement Data

 

 

      2015       2014       2013       2012       2011    
    in m.       in m.       in m.       in m.       in m.    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income

    15,881           14,272          14,834          15,975          17,445      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Provision for credit losses

    956           1,134          2,065          1,721          1,839      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income after provision for credit losses

    14,925           13,138          12,769          14,254          15,606      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Commissions and fee income     12,765           12,409          12,308          11,809          11,878      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss     3,842           4,299          3,817          5,608          2,724      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other noninterest income (loss)     1,037           969          956          344          1,181      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total net revenues

    33,525           31,949          31,915          33,736          33,228      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Compensation and benefits

    13,293           12,512          12,329          13,490          13,135      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

General and administrative expenses

    18,632           14,654          15,126          15,017          12,657      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Policyholder benefits and claims

    256           289          460          414          207      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets

    5,776           111          79          1,886          0      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Restructuring activities

    710           133          399          394          0      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total noninterest expenses

    38,667           27,699          28,394          31,201          25,999      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) before income taxes

    (6,097)          3,116          1,457          814          5,390      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income tax expense

    675           1,425          775          498          1,064      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

    (6,772)          1,691          681          316          4,326      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income attributable to noncontrolling interests

    21           28          15          53          194      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Net income (loss) attributable to Deutsche Bank shareholders and additional equity components     (6,794)          1,663          666          263          4,132      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
         
    in            in           in           in           in       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Basic earnings per share1,2

    (5.06)          1.34          0.64          0.27          4.25      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Diluted earnings per share1,3

    (5.06)          1.31          0.62          0.26          4.11      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Dividends paid per share4

    0.75           0.75          0.75          0.75          0.75      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
1 

The number of average basic and diluted shares outstanding has been adjusted for all periods before June 2014 in order to reflect the effect of the bonus component of subscription rights issued in June 2014 in connection with the capital increase.

2 

We calculate basic earnings per share for each period by dividing our net income attributable to Deutsche Bank shareholders by the average number of common shares outstanding. In 2015 earnings were adjusted by 228 million net of tax for the coupons paid on Additional Tier 1 Notes in April 2015.

3 

We calculate diluted earnings per share for each period by dividing our net income attributable to Deutsche Bank shareholders by the average number of common shares outstanding, both after assumed conversions. In 2015 earnings were adjusted by 228 million net of tax for the coupons paid on Additional Tier 1 Notes in April 2015. For 2015, there is no dilutive effect as the Group reported a net loss.

4 

Dividends we declared and paid in the year.

Balance Sheet Data

 

 

  2015       2014       2013       2012       2011    
    in m.       in m.       in m.       in m.       in m.    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

        1,629,130              1,708,703              1,611,400              2,022,275              2,164,103     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loans

    427,749          405,612          376,582          397,377          412,514     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Deposits

    566,974          532,931          527,750          577,210          601,730     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Long-term debt

    160,016          144,837          133,082          157,325          163,416     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Common shares

    3,531          3,531          2,610          2,380          2,380     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total shareholders’ equity

    62,678          68,351          54,719          54,001          53,390     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Common Equity Tier 1 capital (CRR/CRD 4)1

    52,429          60,103          38,534          37,957          36,313     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Common Equity Tier 1 capital (CRR/CRD 4 fully loaded)1

    44,101          46,076          38,534          37,957          36,313     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Tier 1 capital (CRR/CRD 4)1

    58,222          63,898          50,717          50,483          49,047     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Tier 1 capital (CRR/CRD 4 fully loaded)1

    48,651          50,695          50,717          50,483          49,047     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total regulatory capital (CRR/CRD 4)1

    64,522          68,293          55,464          57,015          55,226     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total regulatory capital (CRR/CRD 4 fully loaded)1

    60,976          63,072          55,464          57,015          55,226     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
1 

Figures presented for 2015 and 2014 are based on the transitional rules (“CRR/CRD 4”) and the full application (“CRR/CRD 4 fully loaded”) of the CRR/CRD 4 framework. Figures presented for 2013, 2012 and 2011 are based on "Basel 2.5". The capital ratios relate the respective capital to risk-weighted assets. Until 2013 transitional items pursuant to the former Section 64h (3) of the German Banking Act are excluded.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       10
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

Certain Key Ratios and Figures

 

 

   2015        2014        2013        2012        2011    
Share price at period-end1                22.53                     24.99                     33.07                     31.43                   28.08     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Share price high1                33.42                     38.15                     36.94                     37.68                   46.45     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Share price low1                20.69                     22.66                     28.05                     21.09                   19.82     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Book value per basic share outstanding2,4                45.16                     49.32                     50.80                     54.74                   55.44     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Tangible book value per basic share outstanding3,4                37.90                     38.53                     37.87                     40.32                   39.03     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Post-tax return on average shareholders’ equity5      (9.8) %           2.7 %           1.2 %           0.5 %           8.2 %     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Post-tax return on average active equity6      (9.9) %           2.7 %           1.2 %           0.5 %           8.2 %     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Post-tax return on average tangible shareholders’ equity7      (12.3) %           3.5 %           1.6 %           0.7 %           11.7 %     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Cost/income ratio8      115.3 %           86.7 %           89.0 %           92.5 %           78.2 %     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Compensation ratio9      39.7 %           39.2 %           38.6 %           40.0 %           39.5 %     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Noncompensation ratio10      75.7 %           47.5 %           50.3 %           52.5 %           38.7 %     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Common Equity Tier 1 capital ratio (CRR/CRD 4)11      13.2 %           15.2 %           12.8 %           11.4 %           9.5 %     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Common Equity Tier 1 capital ratio (CRR/CRD 4 fully loaded)11      11.1 %           11.7 %           12.8 %           11.4 %           9.5 %     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Tier 1 capital ratio (CRR/CRD 4)11      14.7 %           16.1 %           16.9 %           15.1 %           12.9 %     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Tier 1 capital ratio (CRR/CRD 4 fully loaded)11      12.3 %           12.9 %           16.9 %           15.1 %           12.9 %     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Employees at period-end (full-time equivalent):12

              

In Germany

     45,757           45,392           46,377           46,308           47,323     

Outside Germany

     55,347           52,746           51,877           51,911           53,673     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Branches at period-end:

              

In Germany

     1,827           1,845           1,924           1,944           2,039     

Outside Germany

     963           969           983           1,040           1,039     

 

 
1

Historical share prices have been adjusted on June 5, 2014 with retroactive effect to reflect the capital increase by multiplying a correcting factor of 0.9538.

2

Shareholders’ equity divided by the number of basic shares outstanding (both at period-end).

3

Shareholders’ equity less goodwill and other intangible assets, divided by the number of basic shares outstanding (both at period-end).

4 

The number of average basic shares outstanding has been adjusted for all periods before June 2014 in order to reflect the effect of the bonus element of the subscription rights issue in connection with the capital increase in June 2014.

5 

Net income attributable to our shareholders as a percentage of average shareholders’ equity.

6 

Net income attributable to our shareholders as a percentage of average active equity.

7 

Net income attributable to our shareholders as a percentage of average tangible shareholders’ equity.

8 

Total noninterest expenses as a percentage of net interest income before provision for credit losses, plus noninterest income.

9 

Compensation and benefits as a percentage of total net interest income before provision for credit losses, plus noninterest income.

10 

Noncompensation noninterest expenses, which is defined as total noninterest expenses less compensation and benefits, as a percentage of total net interest income before provision for credit losses, plus noninterest income.

11 

Figures presented for 2015 and 2014 are based on the transitional rules (“CRR/CRD 4”) and the full application (“CRR/CRD 4 fully loaded”) of the CRR/CRD 4 framework. Figures presented for 2013, 2012 and 2011 are based on "Basel 2.5". The capital ratios relate the respective capital to risk-weighted assets. Until 2013 transitional items pursuant to the former Section 64h (3) of the German Banking Act are excluded.

12 

Deutsche Postbank aligned its FTE definition to that of Deutsche Bank which reduced the Group number as of December 31, 2011 by 260.

Dividends

The following table shows the dividend per share in euro and in U.S. dollars for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014, 2013, 2012, and 2011. We declare our dividends at our Annual General Meeting following each year. For 2015, the board will propose to the Annual General Meeting to pay no dividend. Our dividends are based on the non-consolidated results of Deutsche Bank AG as prepared in accordance with German accounting principles. Because we declare our dividends in euro, the amount an investor actually receives in any other currency depends on the exchange rate between euro and that currency at the time the euros are converted into that currency.

Effective January 1, 2009, the German withholding tax applicable to dividends is 26.375 % (consisting of a 25 % withholding tax and an effective 1.375 % surcharge). For individual German tax residents, the withholding tax paid after January 1, 2009 represents for private dividends, generally, the full and final income tax applicable to the dividends. Dividend recipients who are tax residents of countries that have entered into a convention for avoiding double taxation may be eligible to receive a refund from the German tax authorities for a portion of the amount withheld and in addition may be entitled to receive a tax credit for the German withholding tax not refunded in accordance with their local tax law.

 

 


Table of Contents
11   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

U.S. residents will be entitled to receive a refund equal to 11.375 % of the dividends received after January 1, 2009. For U.S. federal income tax purposes, the dividends we pay are not eligible for the dividends received deduction generally allowed for dividends received by U.S. corporations from other U.S. corporations.

Dividends in the table below are presented before German withholding tax.

See “Item 10: Additional Information – Taxation” for more information on the tax treatment of our dividends.

 

                   Payout ratio 2,3  

 

       Dividends  
    per share1  
    

    Dividends  
    per share  

         Basic earnings  
    per share  
         Diluted earnings  
    per share  
 

2015 (proposed)

     $ 0.00            0.00           N/M           N/M     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

2014

     $ 0.91            0.75           56 %           57 %     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

2013

     $ 1.03            0.75           117 %           121 %     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

2012

     $ 0.99            0.75           N/M           N/M     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

2011

     $ 0.97            0.75           17 %           17 %     

 

 
N/M – Not meaningful
1 

For your convenience, we present dividends in U.S. dollars for each year by translating the euro amounts at the period end rate for the last business day at each year end as described below under “Exchange Rate and Currency Information”.

2 

We define our payout ratio as the dividends we paid per share in respect of each year as a percentage of our basic and diluted earnings per share for that year.

3 

The number of average basic and diluted shares outstanding has been adjusted in order to reflect the effect of the bonus element of the subscription rights issue in connection with the capital increase in June 2014. For 2015, there is no dilutive effect as the Group reported a net loss.

Exchange Rate and Currency Information

Germany’s currency is the euro. For your convenience, we have translated some amounts denominated in euro appearing in this document into U.S. dollars. Unless otherwise stated, we have made these translations at U.S.$ 1.0887 per euro, the euro foreign exchange reference rate for U.S. dollars published by the European Central Bank (ECB) for December 31, 2015. ECB euro foreign exchange reference rates are based on a regular daily concertation procedure between central banks across Europe and worldwide, which normally takes place at 2.15 p.m. CET. You should not construe any translations as a representation that the amounts could have been exchanged at the rate used on December 31, 2015 or any other date.

The ECB euro foreign exchange reference rate for U.S. dollars for December 31, 2015 may differ from the actual rates we used in the preparation of the financial information in this document. Accordingly, U.S. dollar amounts appearing in this document may differ from the actual U.S. dollar amounts that we originally translated into euros in the preparation of our financial statements.

Fluctuations in the exchange rate between the euro and the U.S. dollar will affect the U.S. dollar equivalent of the euro price of our shares quoted on the German stock exchanges and, as a result, are likely to affect the market price of our shares on the New York Stock Exchange. These fluctuations will also affect the U.S. dollar value of cash dividends we may pay on our shares in euros. Past fluctuations in foreign exchange rates may not be predictive of future fluctuations.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       12
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

Euro foreign exchange reference rates for U.S. dollars as published by the ECB

 

in U.S.$ per

      Period-end1           Average2           High           Low    

2016

       

February

    1.0888          0.0000          1.1347          1.0884     

January

    1.0920          0.0000          1.0920          1.0742     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

2015

       

December

    1.0887          0.0000          1.0990          1.0600     

November

    1.0579          0.0000          1.1032          1.0579     

October

    1.1017          0.0000          1.1439          1.0930     

September

    1.1203          0.0000          1.1419          1.1138     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

2014

    1.2141          1.3211          1.3953          1.2141     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

2013

    1.3791          1.3308          1.3814          1.2768     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

2012

    1.3194          1.2932          1.3454          1.2089     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

2011

    1.2939          1.4000          1.4882          1.2889     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
1 

Period-end rate is the rate announced for the last business day of the period.

2 

We calculated the average rates for each year using the average of exchange rates on the last business day of each month during the year. We did not calculate average exchange rates within months.

Capitalization and Indebtedness

Consolidated capitalization in accordance with IFRS as of December 31, 2015

 

 

   in m.    

Debt:1,2

  

 

  

 

 

 

Long-term debt

     160,016     

 

  

 

 

 

Trust preferred securities

     7,020     

 

  

 

 

 

Long-term debt at fair value through profit or loss

     8,710     

 

  

 

 

 

Total debt

     175,747     

 

  

 

 

 
  

 

  

 

 

 

Shareholders’ equity:

  

 

  

 

 

 

Common shares (no par value)

     3,531     

 

  

 

 

 

Additional paid-in capital

     33,572     

 

  

 

 

 

Retained earnings

     21,182     

 

  

 

 

 

Common shares in treasury, at cost

     (10)    

 

  

 

 

 

Accumulated other comprehensive income, net of tax

  

 

  

 

 

 

Unrealized net gains (losses) on financial assets available for sale, net of applicable tax and other

     1,384     

Unrealized net gains (losses) on derivatives hedging variability of cash flows, net of tax

     97     

Unrealized net gains (losses) on assets classified as held for sale, net of tax

     662     

Foreign currency translation, net of tax

     2,196     

Unrealized net gains (losses) from equity method investments

     66     

 

  

 

 

 

Total shareholders’ equity

     62,679     

 

  

 

 

 

Equity component of financial instruments

     4,675     

 

  

 

 

 

Noncontrolling interests

     270     

 

  

 

 

 

Total equity

     67,624     

 

  

 

 

 

Total capitalization

     243,370     

 

  

 

 

 
1 

 864 million (0.5 %) of our debt was guaranteed as of December 31, 2015. This consists of debt of a subsidiary of Deutsche Postbank AG which is guaranteed by the German government.

2 

 33,117 million (19 %) of our debt was secured as of December 31, 2015.

Reasons for the Offer and Use of Proceeds

Not required because this document is filed as an annual report.

 

 


Table of Contents
13   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

Risk Factors

An investment in our securities involves a number of risks. You should carefully consider the following information about the risks we face, together with other information in this document, when you make investment decisions involving our securities. If one or more of these risks were to materialize, it could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition, results of operations, cash flows or prices of our securities.

Recent tepid economic growth, and uncertainties about prospects for growth going forward, have affected and continue to negatively affect our results of operations and financial condition in some of our businesses, while a continuing low interest environment and competition in the financial services industry have compressed margins in many of our businesses. If these conditions persist or worsen, our business, results of operations or strategic plans could be adversely affected.

After a period earlier in 2015 when economic data appeared to be stabilizing or improving in many countries and the risk of a negative macro scenario and diminishing global growth appeared to be receding, developments late in the year 2015, as well as developments since the start of the new year, have caused these concerns to resurface, and markets, including equity markets in particular, have moved sharply downward. Eurozone data confirmed that the economy continued to grow at about its trend rate during much of 2015, propelled by real income gains provided by falling oil prices. Despite what appeared to be an improving growth background at the time, the European Central Bank (“ECB”) cut the deposit rate to -0.30 per cent in December 2015 and announced an extension of the asset purchase program until March 2017 or beyond if inflation and inflation expectations do not materially improve. The economic outlook has dimmed somewhat since the start of the year largely in the face of political concerns and concerns about the global outlook, however, and thus the ECB will probably make its monetary policy even more expansionary in the course of the year. Similarly, the Bank of England surprised by pivoting toward a more dovish policy stance. In the U.S., meanwhile, strong labour market data finally prompted the Federal Reserve to end seven years of zero interest rates by increasing the Fed Funds target rate by 0.25 percentage points in December. Since then, however, U.S. data have been mixed, pointing towards a somewhat weaker winter half and causing the Federal Reserve once again to question the wisdom of further monetary tightening in the near term. Moreover, we now expect a lower trend growth rate in the U.S. for the coming years. While in the past falling oil prices were overwhelmingly positive for the U.S. economy, U.S. production levels given the “fracking” boom, and the economics of this business, have largely broken this historical relationship. In Emerging Markets, growth remains weak; while it appears to be bottoming out in some economies, others, particularly those for which oil exports are critical to the economy, may not yet be reaching their nadir. Political uncertainty is also taking an increasing toll in Emerging Markets. In China, prospects remain uncertain and prognostication difficult. While some leading indicators are still compatible with a modest improvement in near-term growth, others are less optimistic, and perceived risks to the Chinese growth rate over the medium term is heavily pressuring commodities markets worldwide. While China is supporting its economy with more expansionary monetary and fiscal policies, looser policy is placing pressure on the currency and structural problems are likely to slow down the intended shift towards domestic demand driven growth and the health of the financial sector remains open to question. Monetary policy in China will probably become more expansive in order to bolster the economy. In Japan, fiscal measures and the ongoing extremely expansionary monetary policy (“Abenomics”) are supporting growth, while weak external demand has impacted negatively.

Numerous risks are currently increasing the uncertainty of our global forecast by a greater degree than usual. While on the one hand the global financial markets could react much more negatively to normalization of U.S. monetary policy than assumed, a delay in further tightening due to perceptions of faltering growth could also unsettle the markets. This could have a negative impact on household and corporate expenditure worldwide and result in much higher capital outflows from emerging markets as investors flee riskier asset classes in the light of continuing uncertainty and greater volatility. In any event, monetary policymakers in most industrialized countries have few tools left in their toolboxes to combat stagnation or contraction. The falling oil price is exacerbating the problems in the oil-producing countries and complicating the financing of energy-related investments. Moreover, geopolitical risks could escalate, especially those arising from conflicts in the Middle East. Also, a hard landing in China could trigger global upheaval. In Europe, a flare-up in the debate on monetary policy going forward and the future of the eurozone, insufficient deleveraging in the private and public sectors, a halt in implementing structural reforms or, also, an elevated level of political uncertainty could potentially have a substantial impact on our forecasts.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       14
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

Against this background and these uncertainties, we have observed continued subdued client activity in a number of our businesses. The simultaneous easing of monetary policy in the eurozone and the tightening of it in the United States may have disruptive effects on many of our businesses. Our credit flow businesses continue to be affected by the potential tightening of monetary policy in the United States, even as the ultra-low interest rate environment, especially in the eurozone, where it may be sustained, and geopolitical uncertainties have also put pressure on our margins in several traditional banking sectors. We may face further uncertainty if, as it currently appears, the net effect of monetary policies in the U.S. and the eurozone is to continue to weaken the euro against the U.S. dollar. A stronger U.S. dollar can have a beneficial effect on our revenues, as a significant portion of our revenues is generated in the United States while our results are reported in euro. A stronger U.S. dollar will, however, also increase the euro values of our U.S. dollar-denominated costs and liabilities, including those incurred in respect of U.S. litigation and enforcement matters, and will also tend to significantly increase our risk-weighted assets, including those in the Non-Core Operations Unit (NCOU), that are denominated in U.S. dollars. This can lead to material declines in our capital ratios, as our capital is preponderantly denominated in euro.

Like many in the investment banking industry, we continue to rely on our trading and markets businesses as a primary source of profit. However, these “flow” businesses, in particular our fixed income securities franchise, have continued to face an extremely challenging environment, caused by cyclical uncertainty about the low interest rate environment, central bank intervention in markets and the gradual cessation thereof and overall sluggish economic growth. We are substantially dependent on the performance of our flow businesses, and this dependency exceeds that of many of our competitors. While some of our businesses can profit from market volatility, many businesses dependent on client flow are increasingly challenged in uncertain times, and our Strategy 2020 intends us to retreat from a number of businesses that focused on riskier asset classes or strategies (but that in earlier periods also had the potential to be more highly profitable than those dependent on low-risk, low-margin flow in a very low interest rate environment). Our strategic decisions on these businesses led in part to impairments we recognized in our Corporate Banking & Securities (CB&S) business division in 2015 and reflect a new view on the medium-term profit potential of these activities. These negative effects have been exacerbated by the impacts on our profitability from continued de-risking across the group and long-term structural trends driven by regulation (especially increased regulatory capital and leverage requirements and increased compliance costs) and competition that have further compressed our margins in many of our businesses. Should a combination of these factors continue to lead to reduced margins and subdued activity levels in our trading and markets business over the longer term, this could reflect structural challenges that may lead us to consider even further reaching changes to aspects of our business model than those contained in Strategy 2020.

If uncertainty about the macroeconomic environment or the financial sector persists or worsens, these trends are likely to continue to be difficult for us to counter. More generally, if economic conditions in the eurozone remain at their current subdued levels, or worsen, if growth falters in the U.S. or if economic growth stagnates in China or elsewhere, our results of operations may be materially and adversely affected. Continued quantitative easing by the ECB in response to this may lead to a continuation of the current environment of low interest rates and margin compression, which may also already affect our business and financial position. By contrast, any decision by the Federal Reserve or by central banks more generally to tighten their monetary policy if economies continue to improve could have a material adverse effect on perceptions of liquidity in the financial system and on the global economy more generally, and may adversely affect our business and financial position. In particular, we may in the future be unable to offset the potential negative effects on our profitability of the current macroeconomic and market conditions through performance in our other businesses.

 

 


Table of Contents
15   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

The challenges described above have been exacerbated as we continue to face headwinds from the continuing intensification of the regulatory environment. A continued high level of litigation and enforcement matters has given rise to reputational challenges, has put further pressure on our profitability and returns, and has made our periodic results more volatile as we often have little control as to the period in which we will resolve active matters. These factors, along with similar concerns regarding other financial institutions, have placed pressure on the markets for our securities, along with concerns regarding our ability to overcome the numerous headwinds facing us.

An elevated level of political uncertainty and the increasing attractiveness to voters of populist parties in a number of countries in the European Union could lead to a partial unwinding of European integration. Furthermore, anti-austerity movements in some member countries of the eurozone could undermine confidence in the continued viability of those countries’ participation in the euro. An escalation of political risks could have unpredictable political consequences as well as consequences for the financial system and the greater economy, potentially leading to declines in business levels, write-downs of assets and losses across our businesses. Our ability to protect ourselves against these risks is limited.

Regulatory and political actions in response to the European sovereign debt crisis may not be sufficient to prevent the euro crisis from flaring up again. The severity of the European debt crisis appeared to have abated somewhat over recent years as the actions by the ECB, the rescue packages and the economic recovery starting by mid-2013 seemed to be stabilizing the situation in Europe. However, political uncertainty seems set to be on an elevated level in 2016 and could trigger the unwinding of some of the levels of European integration that have benefitted our businesses. An escalation of political risks could have unpredictable consequences both for the financial system and the greater economy as a whole, potentially leading to declines in business levels, write-downs of assets and losses across our businesses.

The European sovereign debt crisis, the UK referendum on EU membership (“Brexit”), which is looking more likely to take place in mid-2016, and the migration/refugee crisis have released centrifugal forces which will pose an ongoing huge challenge for European politics. Member states, particularly those on the external geographical border of the European Union, are increasingly looking for national solutions rather than a European solution. In some, populist or anti-austerity political parties or movements have garnered increased popular support and political stature. In Germany, Chancellor Merkel’s focus on Europe-wide rather than single-state solutions has begun to undermine her domestic support, and has placed German policy increasingly at odds with that of many of its European partners. Against this background the prospects for meaningful national structural reform and further euro area integration, both seen as critical components to sustainably reducing euro area crisis vulnerabilities, look poor.

Any political decision by any member country to leave the eurozone could lead to tremendous pressure on other member countries to do so as well and could potentially lead to a significant deterioration of the sovereign debt market, especially if the exit did not result in the catastrophic effects on the exiting country that many have predicted. If one or more members of the eurozone defaults on their debt obligations or decides to leave the common currency, this would result in the reintroduction of one or more national currencies. Should a eurozone country conclude it must exit the common currency, the resulting need to reintroduce a national currency and restate existing contractual obligations could have unpredictable financial, legal, political and social consequences, leading not only to significant losses on sovereign debt but also on private debt in that country. Given the highly interconnected nature of the financial system within the eurozone, and the high levels of exposure we have to public and private counterparties around Europe, our ability to plan for such a contingency in a manner that would reduce our exposure to non-material levels is likely to be limited. If the overall economic climate deteriorates as a result of one or more departures from the eurozone, our businesses could be adversely affected, and, if overall business levels decline or we are forced to write down significant exposures among our various businesses, we could incur substantial losses. We could suffer similar effects should the UK choose in favor of “Brexit”; although the UK is not in the eurozone, its economy and those of the eurozone countries are very tightly linked as a result of EU integration projects other than the euro, and the scale of our businesses in the UK – especially those dependent on activity levels in the City of London, to which we are heavily exposed and which are likely to deteriorate considerably in the event of a Brexit – means that even modest effects in percentage terms can have a very substantial adverse effect on our businesses.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       16
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

We may be required to take impairments on our exposures to the sovereign debt of European or other countries if the European sovereign debt crisis reignites. The credit default swaps into which we have entered to manage sovereign credit risk may not be available to offset these losses.

The effects of the continuing sovereign debt crisis have been especially evident in the financial sector, as a large portion of the sovereign debt of eurozone countries is held by European financial institutions, including us. As of December 31, 2015, we had a direct sovereign credit risk exposure of 4.0 billion to Italy, 725 million to Spain, 112 million to Portugal, 55 million to Ireland and 0 million to Greece. Despite the apparent abatement of the crisis in recent years, it remains uncertain whether, in light of the current political environment, Greece or other eurozone sovereigns, such as Spain, Italy, Portugal and Cyprus, will be able to manage their debt levels in the future and whether Greece will attempt to renegotiate its past international debt restructuring. The rise of anti-austerity parties and populist sentiment in many of these countries poses a threat to the medium- to long-term measures recommended for these countries to alleviate the tensions in the euro caused by drastically differing economic situations among the eurozone states. In the future, negotiations or exchanges similar to the Greek debt restructuring in 2012 could take place with respect to the sovereign debt of these or other affected countries. The outcome of any negotiations regarding changed terms (including reduced principal amounts or extended maturities) of sovereign debt may result in additional impairments of assets on our balance sheet. Any negotiations are highly likely to be subject to political and economic pressures that we cannot control, and we are unable to predict their effects on the financial markets, on the greater economy or on ourselves.

In addition, any restructuring of outstanding sovereign debt may result in potential losses for us and other market participants that are not covered by payouts on hedging instruments that we have entered into to protect against the risk of default. These instruments largely consist of credit default swaps, generally referred to as CDSs, pursuant to which one party agrees to make a payment to another party if a credit event (such as a default) occurs on the identified underlying debt obligation. A sovereign restructuring that avoids a credit event through voluntary write-downs of value may not trigger the provisions in CDSs we have entered into, meaning that our exposures in the event of a write-down could exceed the exposures we previously viewed as our net exposure after hedging. Additionally, even if the CDS provisions are triggered, the amounts ultimately paid under the CDSs may not correspond to the full amount of any loss we incur. We also face the risk that our hedging counterparties have not effectively hedged their own exposures and may be unable to provide the necessary liquidity if payments under the instruments they have written are triggered. This may result in systemic risk for the European banking sector as a whole and may negatively affect our business and financial position.

We have a continuous demand for liquidity to fund our business activities. We may suffer during periods of market-wide or firm-specific liquidity constraints, and liquidity may not be available to us even if our underlying business remains strong.

We are exposed to liquidity risk, which is the risk arising from our potential inability to meet all payment obligations when they become due or only being able to meet them at excessive cost. Our liquidity may become impaired due to reluctance of our counterparties or the market to finance our operations due to actual or perceived weaknesses in our businesses, our business model or our strategy, as well as in our resilience to counter negative economic and market conditions. Such impairments can also arise from circumstances unrelated to our businesses and outside our control, such as, but not limited to, disruptions in the financial markets. For example, we have in recent weeks, as well as in the past, experienced steep declines in the price of our shares and increases in the premium investors must pay when purchasing CDSs on our debt. In addition, negative developments concerning other financial institutions perceived to be comparable to us and negative views about the financial services industry in general have also affected us in recent years. These perceptions have affected the prices at which we have accessed the capital markets to obtain the necessary funding to support our business activities; should these perceptions worsen, our ability to obtain this financing on acceptable terms may be adversely affected. Among other things, an inability to refinance assets on our balance sheet or maintain appropriate levels of capital to protect against deteriorations in their value could force us to liquidate assets we hold at depressed prices or on unfavorable terms, and could also force us to curtail business, such as the extension of new credit. This could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

As a result of funding pressures arising from the European sovereign debt crisis and the global economic weakness more generally, there has been increased intervention by a number of central banks over the past several years, in particular by the ECB and the Federal Reserve (although after seven years of monetary easing, the Federal Reserve

 

 


Table of Contents
17   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

reversed course in December 2015 by increasing the Fed Funds target interest rate by 0.25 percentage points). In September 2012, the ECB announced an unlimited sovereign bond buying program (referred to as the OMT Program) aimed at keeping the borrowing costs of affected eurozone countries low through the purchase of their debt instruments. In a court order dated January 14, 2014, the German Constitutional Court (Bundesverfassungsgericht) sought guidance from the Court of Justice of the European Union as to whether the OMT Program is compatible with European law. In its preliminary ruling of June 16, 2015, the Court of Justice of the European Union held that the OMT Program, subject to certain restrictions, was in compliance with European law. The final decision of the German Constitutional Court is still outstanding but could, if the OMT Program is found incompatible with German constitutional law, negatively impact the stability of the eurozone. Over the course of 2015, the ECB maintained its main refinancing rate at 0.05 %, and made liquidity available to the banks via targeted longer-term refinancing operations. In addition, the ECB has implemented a program commonly referred to as “quantitative easing”, which is designed to keep long-term interest rates low through substantial purchases of long-term financial assets from private institutions. The Federal Reserve has also expanded its provision of U.S. dollar liquidity to the ECB, which the ECB has then made available to European banks.

To the extent these incremental measures, most of which have resulted in the availability of additional liquidity to financial institutions and the financial markets in the eurozone more generally, are curtailed or halted, this could adversely impact funding markets for financial institutions, including us. This could in turn lead to an increase in funding costs, or reduced funding supply, which could result in a reduction in business activity. In particular, any decision by the ECB to discontinue or reduce quantitative easing or further steps by the Federal Reserve to tighten its monetary policy or actions by central banks more generally to tighten their monetary policy will likely cause long-term interest rates to increase and accordingly impact the costs of our funding. In addition, negative perceptions concerning our business and prospects could develop as a result of large losses, changes of our credit ratings, a general decline in the level of business activity in the financial services sector, regulatory action, serious employee misconduct or illegal activity, as well as many other reasons outside our control and that we cannot foresee.

Since the start of the global financial crisis, the major credit rating agencies have lowered our credit ratings or placed them on review or watch on multiple occasions. On July 29, 2014, Moody’s Investors Service downgraded our long-term debt and deposit ratings from A2 to A3. On January 25, 2016, Moody’s further downgraded our long-term debt rating from A3 to Baa1 (while upgrading our deposit rating from A2 to A3), based on the German Resolution Mechanism Act, which provides that certain senior debt instruments will be paid after deposits and other liabilities in resolution or insolvency proceedings; Moody’s outlook on both our long-term debt and deposit ratings is negative. On June 9, 2015, Standard & Poor’s downgraded our long-term counterparty credit rating from A to BBB+. Fitch Ratings downgraded our long-term issuer default rating and senior debt ratings from A+ to A on May 19, 2015 and from A to A- on December 8, 2015. On September 29, 2015, DBRS Ratings downgraded our senior unsecured debt and deposit ratings from A+ to A. Recent credit rating downgrades have not materially affected our borrowing costs. However, any future downgrade could materially affect our funding costs, although we are unable to predict whether this would be the case or the extent of any such effect. The effect would depend on a number of factors including whether a downgrade affects financial institutions across the industry or on a regional basis, or is intended to reflect circumstances specific to us; any actions our senior management may take in advance of or in response to the downgrade; the willingness of counterparties to continue to do business with us; any impact of other market events and the state of the macroeconomic environment more generally.

Additionally, under many of the contracts governing derivative instruments to which we are a party, a downgrade could require us to post additional collateral, lead to terminations of contracts with accompanying payment obligations for us or give counterparties additional remedies. We take these effects into account in our liquidity stress testing analysis, as further described in “Management Report: Risk Report: Liquidity Risk: Stress Testing and Scenario Analysis” on page 181 of the Annual Report 2015.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       18
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

Regulatory reforms enacted and proposed in response to weaknesses in the financial sector, together with increased regulatory scrutiny more generally, have created significant uncertainty for us and may adversely affect our business and ability to execute our strategic plans, and competent regulators may prohibit us from making dividend payments or payments on our regulatory capital instruments if we fail to comply with regulatory requirements.

In response to the global financial crisis and the European sovereign debt crisis, governments, regulatory authorities and others have made and continue to make proposals to reform the regulatory framework for the financial services industry to enhance its resilience against future crises. Legislation has been enacted and regulations have been issued in response to many of these proposals. The regulatory framework for financial institutions is likely to undergo further significant change. This creates significant uncertainty for us and the financial industry in general. The wide range of new laws and regulations or current proposals includes, among other things:

 

 

provisions for more stringent regulatory capital, leverage and liquidity standards,

 

restrictions on compensation practices,

 

restrictions on proprietary trading and other investment activities,

 

special bank levies and financial transaction taxes,

 

recovery and resolution powers to intervene in a crisis including “bail-in” of creditors,

 

large exposure limits,

 

the creation of a single supervisory authority and a single resolution authority within the eurozone and any other participating member states,

 

separation of certain businesses from deposit taking,

 

stress testing and capital planning regimes,

 

heightened reporting requirements, and

 

reforms of derivatives, other financial instruments, investment products and market infrastructures.

In addition, regulatory scrutiny under existing laws and regulations has become more intense. The specific effects of a number of new laws and regulations remain uncertain because the drafting and implementation of these laws and regulations are still on-going. One example of these uncertain effects is the possibility of stricter rules for the measurement of risks based on several initiatives of the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision. Stricter rules could lead to a significant increase of our risk-weighted assets and, as a result, a higher capital demand, changes in our deductions from our regulatory capital and the imposition of additional capital charges to cover financial, market and operational risk. These requirements may be in addition to regulatory capital buffers that may also be increased or be in addition to those already imposed on us and could themselves materially increase our capital requirements.

Regulatory authorities have substantial discretion in how to regulate banks, and this discretion, and the means available to the regulators, have been steadily increasing during recent years. Regulation may be imposed on an ad hoc basis by governments and regulators in response to ongoing or future crises, and may especially affect financial institutions such as us that are deemed to be systemically important.

In particular, the regulators with jurisdiction over us, including the ECB under the Single Supervisory Mechanism (also referred to as the “SSM”), may conduct stress tests and have discretion to impose capital surcharges on financial institutions for risks that are not otherwise recognized in risk-weighted assets or other surcharges depending on the individual situation of the bank and take or require other measures, such as restrictions on or changes to our business. Competent regulators may also, if we fail to comply with regulatory requirements, in particular with minimum capital requirements (including buffer requirements) or with liquidity requirements, or if there are shortcomings in our governance and risk management processes, prohibit us from making dividend payments to shareholders or distributions to holders of our regulatory capital instruments. Generally, a failure to comply with the new quantitative and qualitative regulatory requirements could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations, including our ability to pay out dividends to shareholders or distributions on regulatory capital instruments.

 

 


Table of Contents
19   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

European and German legislation regarding the recovery and resolution of banks and investment firms could, if steps were taken to ensure our resolvability or resolution measures were imposed on us, significantly affect our business operations, and lead to losses for our shareholders and creditors.

On January 1, 2015, the German Recovery and Resolution Act (Sanierungs- und Abwicklungsgesetz) came into force and transposed the European Union directive establishing a framework for the recovery and resolution of credit institutions and investment firms (referred to as the Bank Recovery and Resolution Directive or “BRRD”) into German law. In addition, starting on January 1, 2016, the Single Resolution Mechanism (referred to as the “SRM”) under the European Union regulation establishing uniform rules and a uniform procedure for the resolution of credit institutions and certain investment firms (referred to as the “SRM Regulation”) entered into force, which centralizes at a European level key competences and resources for managing the failure of any bank, such as us, within the eurozone and any other participating member states. In Germany, the German Resolution Mechanism Act (Abwicklungsmechanismusgesetz) adapted German bank resolution laws to the SRM.

The SRM Regulation and the German Recovery and Resolution Act require the preparation of recovery and resolution plans for banks and grant broad powers to public authorities to intervene in a bank which is failing or likely to fail. For a bank directly supervised by the ECB, such as us, the Single Resolution Board (referred to as the “SRB”) assesses its resolvability and may require legal and operational changes to the bank’s structure to ensure its resolvability. Under the SRM, the SRB is responsible for adopting a resolution scheme for resolving banks pursuant to the SRM Regulation in close cooperation with the ECB, the European Commission, and the competent national resolution authorities, in the event that such bank is failing or likely to fail and certain other conditions are met. Competent national resolution authorities in the European Union member states that participate in the SRM must implement any such resolution decisions in accordance with the powers conferred on them by national laws implementing the BRRD. Resolution measures that could be imposed upon a failing bank under the SRM Regulation and the German Recovery and Resolution Act include a range of measures including the transfer of shares, assets or liabilities of the bank to another legal entity, the reduction, including to zero, of the nominal value of shares, the dilution of shareholders of a failing bank or the cancellation of shares outright, or the amendment, modification or variation of the terms of the bank’s outstanding debt instruments, for example resulting in a deferral of payments or a reduction of the applicable interest rate. Furthermore, certain eligible unsecured liabilities, in particular certain senior unsecured debt instruments specified by the Resolution Mechanism Act, may be written down, including to zero, or converted into equity (commonly referred to as “bail-in”).

In order to facilitate the authorities’ bail-in powers, which became effective in Germany on January 1, 2015, banks are required to include in their eligible liabilities issued under non-EU law conditions that recognize the regulatory powers to write down or convert such liabilities as well as other resolution powers. The SRM Regulation, the BRRD and the Recovery and Resolution Act are intended to eliminate the need for public support of troubled banks. Therefore, financial public support for such banks, if any, would be used only as a last resort after having assessed and exploited, to the maximum extent practicable, the resolution powers, including a bail-in. The taking of actions to ensure our resolvability or the exercise of resolution powers by the competent resolution authority could materially affect our business operations and lead to a significant dilution of our shareholders or even the total loss of our shareholders’ or creditors’ investment.

Regulatory and legislative changes require us to maintain increased capital, in some cases (including the United States) applying capital rules to our local operations. These requirements may significantly affect our business model, financial condition and results of operations as well as the competitive environment generally. Any perceptions in the market that we may be unable to meet our capital requirements with an adequate buffer, or that we should maintain capital in excess of these requirements, could intensify the effect of these factors on our business and results.

In December 2010, the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision published a set of comprehensive changes to the capital adequacy framework, known as Basel 3, which have been implemented into European Union law by a legislative package referred to as “CRR/CRD 4”. CRR/CRD 4 became effective on January 1, 2014, with some of the regulatory adjustments being gradually phased in through January 1, 2019. CRR/CRD 4 contains, among other things, detailed rules on regulatory banking capital, increased capital requirements and the introduction of additional capital buffers (which will increase from year to year) as well as new and tightened liquidity standards and the introduction of a

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       20
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

leverage ratio not based upon risk-weightings. We are subject to additional capital buffers, including as a result of being designated a globally systemically important financial institution, or “G-SIFI”. In July 2013, U.S. federal bank regulators issued final rules implementing many elements of the Basel 3 capital adequacy framework in the United States. The impact and implementation of the Basel 3 capital adequacy framework is being assessed and monitored by regulators on a regular basis. Further revisions, such as stricter rules on the measurement of risks proposed by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision, could further increase risk-weighted assets and the corresponding capital demand for banks.

Furthermore, under the SRM Regulation, the BRRD and the German Recovery and Resolution Act, banks in the European Union are required to meet at all times a robust minimum requirement for own funds and eligible liabilities (“MREL”) which is determined on a case-by-case basis by the competent resolution authority. In addition, on November 9, 2015, the Financial Stability Board (“FSB”) published a new standard that will require, when implemented as law, global systemically important banks (“G-SIBs”), such as us, to meet a new firm-specific minimum requirement for total loss-absorbing capacity (“TLAC”) starting on January 1, 2019. Also in order to facilitate the meeting of TLAC requirements by German banks, under the German Resolution Mechanism Act, certain specifically defined senior unsecured debt instruments issued by German banks such as us would from 2017 onwards rank junior to, without constituting subordinated debt, all other outstanding unsecured unsubordinated obligations of such bank. Both the TLAC and MREL requirements are specifically designed to require banks to maintain a sufficient amount of instruments which are eligible to absorb losses in resolution with the aim of ensuring that failing banks can be resolved without recourse to taxpayers’ money. On October 30, 2015, the Federal Reserve Board published proposed rules that would implement in the United States the FSB’s TLAC standard. The proposed rules would require, among other things, the U.S. intermediate holding companies (“IHCs”) of non-U.S. G-SIBs, including our U.S. IHC, to maintain a minimum amount of internal TLAC and would separately require them to maintain a minimum amount of long-term debt. While the final impact of the MREL and TLAC requirements will depend on their final implementation, the need to comply with such requirements, and the change in ranking of certain debt instruments issued by us, may affect our business, financial condition and results of operation and in particular may increase our financing costs.

We may not have sufficient capital or other loss-absorbing liabilities to meet these increasing regulatory requirements. This could occur due to regulatory changes and other factors, such as the gradual phase out of our hybrid capital instruments as qualifying Additional Tier 1 (or AT1) capital or our inability to issue new securities which are recognized as regulatory capital or loss-absorbing liabilities under the new standards, due to an increase of risk-weighted assets based on more stringent rules for the measurement of risks or as a result of a continued decline in the value of the euro as compared to other currencies, due to stricter requirements for the compliance with the non-risk based leverage ratio, due to any substantial losses we may incur, which would reduce our retained earnings, a component of Common Equity Tier 1 capital, or due to a combination of these or other factors.

If we are unable to maintain sufficient capital to meet the minimum capital and buffer requirements established by regulators and expected by the market, we may become subject to restrictions on the pay-out of dividends, share buybacks and discretionary compensation payments. In addition, any requirement to increase risk-based capital ratios or the leverage ratio could lead us to adopt a strategy focusing on capital preservation and creation over revenue generation and profit growth, including the reduction in higher margin risk-weighted assets. If we are unable to increase our capital ratios to the regulatory minimum in such a case or by raising new capital through the capital markets, through the reduction of risk-weighted assets or through other means, we may be required to activate our group recovery plan. If these actions or other private or supervisory actions do not restore capital ratios to the levels required under the CRR/CRD 4 legislative package, and we are failing or likely to fail, competent authorities may apply resolution powers under the SRM Regulation, the German Recovery and Resolution Act and other applicable rules and regulations, which could lead to a significant dilution of our shareholders or even the total loss of our shareholders’ or creditors’ investment.

Moreover, we are required to hold and calculate capital separately for our operations in different jurisdictions. In the United States, the Federal Reserve Board has adopted rules that impose enhanced prudential standards on our U.S. operations. In February 2014, the Federal Reserve Board adopted U.S. prudential reforms (the “FBO Rules”) applicable to foreign banking organizations (“FBOs”). FBOs with U.S.$ 50 billion or more in U.S. non-branch assets, such as

 

 


Table of Contents
21   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

us, will be required to establish or designate a separately capitalized top-tier U.S. IHC to hold substantially all of the FBO’s ownership interests in U.S. subsidiaries by July 1, 2016. Beginning on that date, our IHC will be subject, on a consolidated basis, to the risk-based capital requirements under the U.S. Basel 3 capital adequacy framework, capital planning and stress testing requirements (on a phased-in basis), U.S. liquidity buffer requirements and other enhanced prudential standards comparable to those applicable to top-tier U.S. bank holding companies of a similar size. The Federal Reserve Board will have the authority to examine the IHC and any of its subsidiaries. U.S. leverage requirements applicable to the IHC will take effect beginning in January 2018. The Federal Reserve Board’s proposal to require the IHC subsidiaries of non-U.S. G-SIBs to meet minimum internal TLAC and long-term debt requirements would also apply to our IHC, with a phase-in expected to begin in 2019. The Federal Reserve Board has also stated that it intends, through future rulemakings, to apply the Basel 3 liquidity coverage ratio and net stable funding ratio to the U.S. operations of some or all large foreign banking organizations. In September 2014, the Federal Reserve Board and other U.S. regulators approved a final rule implementing liquidity coverage ratio (“LCR”) requirements for certain U.S. banking holding companies and depositary institutions that are generally consistent with the Basel Committee’s revised Basel 3 liquidity standards. The Federal Reserve Board has reaffirmed its plans to issue an additional rulemaking to address the application of an LCR requirement to the U.S. operations of some or all foreign banking organizations with U.S.$ 50 billion or more in combined U.S. assets which could impact the LCR requirements applicable to our IHC. Our combined U.S. operations, including our New York branch, will also be subject to additional quantitative requirements related to liquidity and risk management.

As of January 1, 2015, our existing U.S. bank holding company subsidiary, Deutsche Bank Trust Corporation, became subject to risk-based and leverage capital requirements, liquidity requirements, and other enhanced prudential standards applicable to large U.S. bank holding companies. Deutsche Bank Trust Corporation also became subject to capital planning and stress testing requirements on June 30, 2014. Deutsche Bank Trust Corporation will remain subject to the capital planning and stress testing requirements and certain enhanced prudential standards until corresponding requirements applicable to the IHC become effective. On March 5, 2015, the Federal Reserve Board released the results of the 2015 supervisory stress tests, which confirmed that Deutsche Bank Trust Corporation’s capital ratios would significantly exceed the required minimum levels even in the severely adverse economic stress test scenario. The capital plan did not include any planned dividends or share repurchases. However, on March 11, 2015, the Federal Reserve Board announced that it objected on qualitative grounds to the capital plan submitted by Deutsche Bank Trust Corporation as part of the 2015 Comprehensive Capital Analysis and Review (“CCAR”) process, citing numerous and significant deficiencies across Deutsche Bank Trust Corporation’s risk-identification, measurement, and aggregation processes, approaches to loss and revenue projection, and internal controls. Deutsche Bank Trust Corporation will submit its 2016 capital plan incorporating enhancements to its processes by April 5, 2016.

Title I of the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act of 2010 (the “Dodd-Frank Act”) and the implementing regulations require each bank holding company with assets of U.S.$ 50 billion or more, including Deutsche Bank AG, to prepare and submit annually a plan for the orderly resolution of subsidiaries and operations in the event of future material financial distress or failure (the “Title I US Resolution Plan”). For foreign-based covered companies such as Deutsche Bank AG, the Title I US Resolution Plan only relates to subsidiaries, branches, agencies and businesses that are domiciled in or conducted in whole or in material part in the United States. In addition to the Title I US Resolution Plan, in 2014, Deutsche Bank Trust Company Americas (“DBTCA”), one of our insured depository institutions (“IDIs”) in the United States, became subject to the FDIC’s final rule requiring IDIs with total assets of U.S.$ 50 billion or more to submit periodically to the FDIC a plan for resolution in the event of failure (the “IDI Rule”). In 2014, we expanded our Title I US Resolution Plan to also be responsive to the IDI Rule requirements, and in 2015 DBTCA submitted a separate resolution plan under the IDI Rule.

These new U.S. rules and interpretations could require us to reduce assets held in the United States, inject capital into or otherwise change the structure of our U.S. operations. To the extent that we are required to reduce operations in the United States or deploy capital in the United States that could be deployed more profitably elsewhere, these requirements could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       22
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

Any increased capital or liquidity requirements, including those described above, could have adverse effects on our business, financial condition and results of operations, as well as on perceptions in the market of our stability, particularly if any such proposal becomes effective and results in our having to raise capital at a time when financial markets are distressed. If these regulatory requirements must be implemented more quickly than currently foreseen, we may decide that the quickest and most reliable path to compliance is to reduce the level of assets on our balance sheet, dispose of divisions or separate out certain activities or reduce or close down certain business lines. The effects on our capital raising efforts in such a case could be amplified due to the expectation that our competitors, at least those subject to the same or similar capital requirements, would likely also be required to raise capital at the same time. Moreover, some of our competitors, particularly those outside the European Union, may not face the same or similar regulations, which could put us at a competitive disadvantage.

In addition to these regulatory initiatives, market sentiment may encourage financial institutions such as us to maintain significantly more capital than regulatory-mandated minima, which could exacerbate the effects on us described above or, if we do not increase our capital to the encouraged levels, could lead to the perception in the market that we are undercapitalized relative to our peers generally.

It is unclear whether the increased U.S. capital and other requirements described above, as well as similar developments in other jurisdictions could lead to a fragmentation of supervision of global banks that could adversely affect our reliance on regulatory waivers allowing us to meet capital adequacy requirements, large exposure limits and certain organizational requirements on a consolidated basis only rather than on both a consolidated and non-consolidated basis. Should we no longer be entitled to rely on these waivers, we would have to adapt and take the steps necessary in order to meet regulatory capital requirements and other requirements on a consolidated as well as a non-consolidated basis, which could result also in significantly higher costs and potential effects on our profitability and dividend paying ability.

Against this backdrop, our results of operation and financial condition have been negatively affected in recent quarters by a large number of claims, disputes, legal proceedings and government investigations. The extent of our financial exposure to these and other matters could continue to be material and could substantially exceed the level of provisions that we established for such litigation, regulatory and similar matters. In this environment, our compliance costs have also substantially increased.

As a result of the substantial uncertainties with respect to our calculation of our capital requirements and the potential outflows in respect of litigation and enforcement matters, we have found it necessary and may find it necessary or desirable to raise additional capital in the future to maintain our capital at levels required by our regulators or viewed by market participants as necessary for our businesses in comparison with our international peers.

Our regulatory capital ratios and our funds available for distributions on our shares or regulatory capital instruments will be affected by our business decisions and, in making such decisions, our interests and those of the holders of such instruments may not be aligned, and we may take decisions in accordance with applicable law and the terms of the relevant instruments that result in no or lower payments being made on our shares or regulatory capital instruments.

Our regulatory capital ratios are affected by a number of factors, including decisions we make relating to our businesses and operations as well as the management of our capital position, of our risk-weighted assets and of our balance sheet in general, and external factors, such as regulations regarding the risk weightings we are permitted to allocate to our assets, commercial and market risks or the costs of our legal proceedings. While we and our management are required to take into account a broad range of considerations in our and their managerial decisions, including the interests of the Bank as a regulated institution and those of our shareholders and creditors, particularly in times of weak earnings and increasing capital requirements, the regulatory requirements to build capital may become paramount. Accordingly, in making decisions in respect of our capital management, we are not required to adhere to the interests of the holders of instruments we have issued that qualify for inclusion in our regulatory capital, such as our Additional Tier 1 capital instruments. We may decide not to take any measures, including increasing our capital at a time when it is feasible to do so (through securities issuances or otherwise), even if our failure to take such an action would result in a non-payment or a writedown or other recovery- or resolution-related measure in respect of any of our

 

 


Table of Contents
23   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

regulatory capital instruments. Our decisions could cause the holders of such regulatory capital instruments to lose all or part of the value of their investments in these instruments due to their effect on our regulatory capital ratios, and such holders will not have any claim against us relating to such decisions, even if they result in a non-payment or a writedown or other recovery- or resolution-related measure in respect of such instruments they hold.

In addition, our annual profit and distributable reserves form an important part of the funds available for us to pay dividends on our shares and make payments on our other regulatory capital instruments, as determined in the case of each such instrument by its terms or by operation of law, and any adverse change in our financial prospects, financial position or profitability, or our distributable reserves, each as calculated on an unconsolidated basis, may have a material adverse effect on our ability to make dividend or other payments on these instruments. For example, as part of the implementation of our Strategy 2020, we recorded large impairments that in some cases reduced the carrying value of subsidiaries on our unconsolidated balance sheet and reduced profits and distributable reserves in 2015. While we plan to make all scheduled payments calculated by reference to our 2015 results on our regulatory capital instruments other than our shares, future impairments or other events that reduce our profit or distributable reserves on an unconsolidated basis could lead us to be unable to make such payments in respect of future years in part or at all.

In addition, German law places limits on the distribution of annual profits and otherwise-distributable reserves, as calculated on an unconsolidated basis, to be distributed to our shareholders or the holders of our regulatory capital instruments, such as our Additional Tier 1 capital instruments. Our management has, subject to applicable law, broad discretion under the applicable accounting principles to influence all amounts relevant for calculating funds available for distribution. Such decisions may impact our ability to make dividend or other payments under the terms of our regulatory capital instruments.

As we have previously announced in connection with the implementation of our Strategy 2020, we do not expect to pay dividends on our shares in respect of either the 2015 or the 2016 fiscal years.

Legislation in the United States and in Germany as well as proposals in the European Union regarding the prohibition of proprietary trading or its separation from the deposit-taking business may materially affect our business model.

On December 10, 2013, U.S. regulators released the final version of the rules implementing the “Volcker Rule”, as required by the Dodd-Frank Act. The final rules prohibit U.S. insured depository institutions and companies affiliated with U.S. insured depository institutions (such as us) from engaging in short-term proprietary trading of certain securities, derivatives, commodity futures and options on these instruments, for their own account. The final rules also impose limits on investments in, and other relationships with, hedge funds, private equity funds and other private funds and limit the ability of banking entities and their affiliates to enter into certain transactions with such funds with which they or their affiliates have certain relationships. The Volcker Rule requires banking entities to establish comprehensive compliance programs designed to help ensure and monitor compliance with restrictions under the Volcker Rule. In December 2013, the Federal Reserve Board extended the end of the conformance period for the Volcker Rule generally until July 21, 2015. In December 2014, the Federal Reserve Board issued an order extending the Volcker Rule’s general conformance period until July 21, 2016 for investments in and relationships with covered funds and certain foreign funds that were in place on or prior to December 31, 2013 (“legacy covered funds”), and stated its intention to grant a final one-year extension of the general conformance period, to July 21, 2017, for banking entities to conform ownership interests in and relationships with legacy covered funds. The extension of the conformance period does not apply to the Volcker Rule’s prohibitions on proprietary trading or to any investments in and relationships with covered funds made or entered into after December 31, 2013.

In Germany, the German Act on the Separation of Risks and Recovery and Resolution Planning for Credit Institutions and Banking Groups (Trennbankengesetz), referred to as the “Separation Act”, regulates the activities of banks that take deposits or other repayable funds from the public and lend them for their own account (referred to as “CRR Banks”). CRR Banks are required to cease or transfer certain activities deemed to be high risk to a financial trading institution, which may be established within the same banking group, if certain independence requirements are met. Banks concerned, such as us, generally have until July 1, 2016 to cease or transfer the relevant business activities, unless the German Federal Financial Supervisory Authority (Bundesanstalt für Finanzdienstleistungsaufsicht, “BaFin”)

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       24
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

extends this period. For Deutsche Bank Group, the period to cease or transfer the activities concerned was extended by the BaFin until June 30, 2017.

On January 29, 2014, the European Commission published a draft Regulation on Structural Measures Improving the Resilience of EU Banks and Transparency of the Financial Sector, referred to as the “Proposed Regulation”, which, if enacted as proposed, would prohibit certain large banks from engaging in proprietary trading in financial instruments and commodities and investing in hedge funds or other entities that engage in proprietary trading, for the sole purpose of making a profit for its own account. The Proposed Regulation would also grant supervisors broad powers to require these banks to separate certain activities deemed to be high risk from other businesses, such as deposit-taking and lending. Once enacted, the Proposed Regulation might overrule certain requirements set out in the Separation Act at the national level. The ultimate impact on us will depend on the content of the final version of the Proposed Regulation.

The Volcker Rule, the Separation Act and the Proposed Regulation may have significant implications for the future structure and strategy of our Group, and may increase our Group’s funding costs. This could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Other regulatory reforms adopted or proposed in the wake of the financial crisis – for example, extensive new regulations governing our derivatives activities, compensation, bank levies, deposit protection or a possible financial transaction tax – may materially increase our operating costs and negatively impact our business model.

On August 16, 2012, the EU Regulation on over-the-counter (“OTC”) derivatives, central counterparties and trade repositories, referred to as EMIR, entered into force. While a number of the compliance requirements introduced by EMIR already apply, the European Securities and Markets Authority (“ESMA”) is still in the process of finalizing some of the implementing rules mandated by EMIR. EMIR introduced a number of requirements, including clearing obligations for certain classes of OTC derivatives and various reporting and disclosure obligations. Although some of the particular effects brought about by EMIR are not yet fully foreseeable, many of its elements have led and may lead to changes which may negatively impact our profit margins, require us to adjust our business practices or increase our costs (including compliance costs). The new Markets in Financial Instruments Directive (which comprises a regulation (“MiFIR”) and a directive (“MiFID II”)) introduces, among other changes, a trading obligation for those OTC derivatives which are subject to mandatory clearing and which are sufficiently standardized. Originally, most requirements introduced by MiFID II/MiFIR were foreseen to be applicable to us starting on January 3, 2017. On February 10, 2016, however, the European Commission published proposals to delay the application of MiFID II/MiFIR by one year to January 3, 2018. This needs now to be agreed by the bodies of the European Union through the co-decision process. MiFID II needs yet to be transposed into national law, and ESMA and the European Commission yet have to finalize several related implementing regulations. We will also be impacted by the BCBS-IOSCO final minimum standards for margin requirements for non-centrally cleared derivatives, for which enabling legislation exists in the EU (EMIR) but where much of the impact depends on how these requirements are implemented.

In the United States, the Dodd-Frank Act has numerous provisions that may affect our operations. Pursuant to regulations implementing provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act, we registered as a swap dealer with the U.S. Commodity Futures Trading Commission (“CFTC”) and became subject to the CFTC’s extensive oversight. Regulation of swap dealers by the CFTC imposes numerous corporate governance, business conduct, capital, margin, reporting, clearing, execution and other regulatory requirements on us. It also requires us to comply with certain U.S. rules in some circumstances with respect to transactions conducted outside of the United States or with non-U.S. persons. Although the coverage of EMIR and CFTC regulations implementing the Dodd-Frank Act is in many ways similar, certain swaps may be subject to both regulatory regimes to a significant extent. However, the CFTC’s guidance on cross-border swaps regulation, as well as the margin requirements recently adopted by the U.S. bank regulatory agencies and the CFTC, may allow us to comply with some, but not all, U.S. regulatory requirements on a substituted basis by complying with EMIR and MiFID. The new requirements under the Dodd-Frank Act may adversely affect our derivatives business and make us less competitive, especially as compared to competitors not subject to such regulation. Additionally, under the Dodd-Frank Act, security-based swaps will be subject to a standalone regulatory regime under the jurisdiction of the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”). The SEC is in the early stages of finalizing rules for its security-based swap regime but it is expected to be parallel to, but not identical to, the CFTC’s regulation of swaps. This may impose further regulation of our derivatives business.

 

 


Table of Contents
25   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

In addition, CRD 4 provides for executive compensation reforms including caps on bonuses that may be awarded to “material risk takers” and other employees as defined in CRD 4, the German Banking Act and other applicable rules and regulations such as the Remuneration Regulation for Institutions (Institutsvergütungsverordnung). The compensation reforms of CRD 4, including any guidelines issued by the EBA to further implement them, could put us at a disadvantage to our competitors in attracting and retaining talented employees, especially compared to those outside the European Union that are not subject to these caps.

Bank levies also have been introduced in some countries including Germany and the United Kingdom and other countries. We accrued  197 million for bank levies in 2013,  342 million in 2014 and  653 million in 2015. We will also be required to contribute substantially to the single resolution fund under the SRM (which is expected to reach a target size of approximately  55 billion by January 1, 2024, of which approximately  15 billion is expected to be contributed by German banks) and the statutory deposit guarantee schemes under the recast European Union Deposit Guarantee Schemes Directive. Generally, however, the total impact of these future levies cannot currently be quantified and they may have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations in future periods.

Separately, on January 22, 2013, the Council of the European Union adopted a decision authorizing eleven EU member states (Austria, Belgium, Estonia, France, Germany, Greece, Italy, Portugal, Slovakia, Slovenia and Spain) to proceed with the introduction of a financial transaction tax under the European Union’s “enhanced cooperation procedure”. The European Commission on February 14, 2013 adopted a draft directive for the implementation of the financial transaction tax. Since then, the introduction of the financial transaction tax is subject to ongoing controversial discussions at the European Union level with the result that the final scope, design and entry into force of the financial transaction tax are uncertain. Estonia is understood to be no longer participating. Depending on the final details, the proposed financial transaction tax could have a materially adverse effect on our profits and business. Different forms of national financial transaction taxes have already been implemented in a number of European jurisdictions, including France and Italy, and these taxes may result in compliance costs as well as market consequences which may affect our revenues.

Adverse market conditions, historically low prices, volatility and cautious investor sentiment have affected and may in the future materially and adversely affect our revenues and profits, particularly in our investment banking, brokerage and other commission- and fee-based businesses. As a result, we have in the past incurred and may in the future incur significant losses from our trading and investment activities.

As a global investment bank, we have significant exposure to the financial markets and are more at risk from adverse developments in the financial markets than are institutions engaged predominantly in traditional banking activities. Sustained market declines have in the past caused and can in the future cause our revenues to decline, and, if we are unable to reduce our expenses at the same pace, can cause our profitability to erode or cause us to show material losses. Volatility can also adversely affect us, by causing the value of financial assets we hold to decline or the expense of hedging our risks to rise. Reduced customer activity can also lead to lower revenues in our “flow” business.

Specifically, our investment banking revenues, in the form of financial advisory and underwriting fees, directly relate to the number and size of the transactions in which we participate and are susceptible to adverse effects from sustained market downturns. These fees and other income are generally linked to the value of the underlying transactions and therefore can decline with asset values. In addition, periods of market decline and uncertainty tend to dampen client appetite for market and credit risk, a critical driver of transaction volumes and investment banking revenues, especially transactions with higher margins. In recent and other times in the past, decreased client appetite for risk has led to lower levels of activity and lower levels of profitability in our Corporate Banking & Securities Corporate Division. Our revenues and profitability could sustain material adverse effects from a significant reduction in the number or size of debt and equity offerings and merger and acquisition transactions.

Market downturns also have led and may in the future lead to declines in the volume of transactions that we execute for our clients and, therefore, to declines in our noninterest income. In addition, because the fees that we charge for managing our clients’ portfolios are in many cases based on the value or performance of those portfolios, a market downturn that reduces the value of our clients’ portfolios or increases the amount of withdrawals reduces the revenues we receive from our asset management and private banking businesses. Even in the absence of a market downturn,

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       26
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

below-market or negative performance by our investment funds may result in increased withdrawals and reduced inflows, which would reduce the revenue we receive from our asset management business. While our clients would be responsible for losses we incur in taking positions for their accounts, we may be exposed to additional credit risk as a result of their need to cover the losses where we do not hold adequate collateral or cannot realize it. Our business may also suffer if our clients lose money and we lose the confidence of clients in our products and services.

In addition, the revenues and profits we derive from many of our trading and investment positions and our transactions in connection with them can be directly and negatively impacted by market prices, which have been volatile in recent years. In each of the product and business lines in which we enter into these trading and investment positions, part of our business entails making assessments about the financial markets and trends in them. When we own assets, market price declines can expose us to losses. Many of the more sophisticated transactions of our Corporate Banking & Securities Corporate Division and our Non-Core Operations Unit are designed to profit from price movements and differences among prices. If prices move in a way we have not anticipated, we may experience losses. Also, when markets are volatile, the assessments we have made may prove to lead to lower revenues or profits, or may lead to losses, on the related transactions and positions. In addition, we commit capital and take market risk to facilitate certain capital markets transactions; doing so can result in losses as well as income volatility. Such losses may especially occur on assets we hold for which there are not very liquid markets initially. Assets that are not traded on stock exchanges or other public trading markets, such as derivatives contracts between banks, may have values that we calculate using models other than publicly-quoted prices. Monitoring the deterioration of prices of assets like these is difficult and could lead to losses we did not anticipate. We can also be adversely affected if general perceptions of risk cause uncertain investors to remain on the sidelines of the market, curtailing their activity and in turn reducing the levels of activity in those of our businesses dependent on transaction flow.

We announced the next phase of our strategy, Strategy 2020, in April 2015 and gave further details on it in October 2015. If we are unable to implement our strategic plans successfully, we may be unable to achieve our financial objectives, or we may incur losses or low profitability or erosions of our capital base, and our financial condition, results of operations and share price may be materially and adversely affected.

In April 2015, we announced the next phase of our strategy, Strategy 2020, and gave further details on it in October 2015. Among our Strategy 2020 plans are to become simpler and more efficient by focusing on the markets, products and clients where we are better positioned to succeed, to become less risky by modernizing our technology and by withdrawing from higher-risk client relationships, to become better capitalized and to run the Bank in a more disciplined way. We also announced specific execution measures for each business division and updated our financial targets to highlight the financial objectives of Strategy 2020. The details of Strategy 2020 are set forth in Item 4: “Information on the Company – Business Overview – Our Business Strategy.”

Our Strategy 2020 goals are subject to various internal and external factors including market, regulatory, economic and political uncertainties, and to limitations relating to our operating model. These could negatively impact or prevent the implementation of our strategic goals or the realization of their anticipated benefits. Economic uncertainties such as the recurrence of extreme turbulence in the markets; weakness in global, regional and national economic conditions; the continuation of the low interest rate environment; increased competition for business; and political instability, especially in Europe, may impact our ability to achieve our strategic goals. Regulatory changes could also adversely impact our ability to achieve our strategic aims. In particular, regulators could demand changes to our business model or organization that could reduce our profitability, or we may be forced to make changes that reduce our profitability in an effort to remain compliant with law and regulation. We are also involved in numerous litigation, arbitration and regulatory proceedings and investigations in Germany and in a number of jurisdictions outside of Germany, especially in the U.S. Such matters are subject to many uncertainties. While we have resolved a number of important legal matters and made progress on others, we expect the litigation environment to continue to be challenging. If litigation and regulatory matters continue to occur at the same rate and magnitude as in recent years, we may not be able to achieve our Strategy 2020 aspirations.

 

 


Table of Contents
27   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

In particular, macroeconomic risks and the risks relating to regulatory changes and our legal proceedings may impact our ability to meet our financial and capital targets articulated as part of Strategy 2020. As financial targets, we are aiming to achieve a cost-income ratio of approximately 70 % by 2018 and approximately 65 % by 2020 and a post-tax return on tangible equity of greater than 10 % by 2018. Our capital targets comprise a Common Equity Tier 1 capital ratio of at least 12.5 % from the end of 2018 and a leverage ratio of at least 4.5 % at the end of 2018 and at least 5 % at the end of 2020. Strategy 2020 is based on an ambitious financial plan with, we believe, some buffer for downside scenarios and contingencies. However, the base case scenario for our financial and capital plan includes revenue growth estimates which are dependent on positive macroeconomic developments. Stagnation or a downturn in the macroeconomic environment could significantly impact our ability to generate the revenue growth necessary to achieve these Strategy 2020 financial and capital targets. Furthermore, even if we are able to grow our revenues in accordance with our strategic plans, the materialization of any of the regulatory changes or the costs for us – in terms of the outcomes or necessary changes to our businesses – of the litigation and regulatory matters mentioned above, or any other unforeseen risk, could adversely impact our net income and thereby cause us to fall short of our Strategy 2020 financial and capital targets.

Our capital targets are further dependent on our ability to reduce the size of our balance sheet in accordance with Strategy 2020. We aim to reduce risk-weighted assets (RWAs) by approximately 90 billion to approximately 320 billion by 2018 and 310 billion by 2020, excluding RWA inflation due to stricter regulatory requirements, which we expect will amount to at least 100 billion by 2019/2020. Key components of executing this plan are the disposal of Postbank, the sale of our noncontrolling 19.99 % stake in Hua Xia Bank and the substantial wind-down of the Non-Core Operations Unit (NCOU) as well as the exit of selected Global Markets businesses. Difficult market conditions or regulatory uncertainties may prevent us from being able to dispose of assets at all, or at prices we would consider to be reasonable, thereby causing us to either sell these assets for losses (or losses that are higher than expected) or hold these assets for a longer period of time than desired or planned. If we cannot reduce our RWAs according to plan, we may not be able to achieve the capital targets set out under Strategy 2020.

Strategy 2020’s financial plan also includes substantial cost reduction targets, which we plan to achieve through efficiency gains from implementation of various initiatives. By 2018, we aim to produce net savings in our adjusted costs (defined as total noninterest expenses excluding restructuring and severance, litigation, impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets and policyholder benefits and claims) of approximately 1.0 to 1.5 billion, against restructuring and severance costs of approximately 3.0 to 3.5 billion, such that we would reduce total adjusted costs to below 22 billion. Our planned exit from certain businesses and clients may entail higher costs or take more time than anticipated and thereby impede us from achieving the cost reductions we have targeted. Furthermore, additional costs could arise from any number of anticipated or unanticipated developments, such as costs relating to compliance with additional regulatory requirements and increased regulatory charges. Our estimated restructuring and severance charges could ultimately run higher than anticipated, preventing us from achieving our adjusted cost target. Any failure to meet our cost reduction targets may also affect our ability to achieve our target cost-income ratio of approximately 70 % by 2018 and approximately 65 % by 2020.

Our ability to implement Strategy 2020 and meet its stated targets is based on a number of additional key assumptions relating to our business and operating model:

 

 

We assume that we will be able to overcome significant challenges arising from our business model. We continue to rely on our trading and markets businesses as a primary source of profit. However, these “flow” businesses, in particular our fixed income securities franchise, have continued to face an extremely challenging environment, caused by cyclical uncertainty about the low interest rate environment, central bank intervention in markets and the gradual cessation thereof and overall sluggish economic growth. We are substantially dependent on the performance of our flow businesses, and this dependency exceeds that of many of our competitors. While some of our businesses can profit from market volatility, many businesses dependent on client flow are increasingly challenged in uncertain times. Under Strategy 2020, we intend to retreat from a number of businesses that focused on riskier asset classes or strategies. In addition, some of our businesses may be resistant to change, posing risks to the implementation of changes to our business model. Should we be unable to implement this new business model successfully, or should the new business model fail to be profitable, we may not be able to achieve some or all of Strategy 2020’s goals.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       28
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

 

We assume that we will be able significantly to upgrade and reduce the complexity of our infrastructure. We currently operate a highly complex infrastructure, which can compromise the quality of the overall control environment. Establishing a more efficient bank with a strong control environment depends on successfully streamlining and simplifying the IT landscape as well as cultural change. Furthermore, capital and execution plans require robust monitoring and tracking that is dependent on accurate, timely and relevant data. We have undertaken initiatives designed to address existing challenges in our IT and data architecture as well as in our data aggregation capabilities. Potential delays and challenges to implementing these initiatives would impact our ability to achieve efficiency improvements and enhance the control environment, thereby affecting our ability to implement Strategy 2020 successfully.

 

We assume that we will be able to improve our internal control environment. A robust internal control framework is necessary to achieve Strategy 2020’s ambitions. We are undertaking several initiatives to strengthen our controls, enhance the efficacy of our safeguards and manage non-financial risks, in particular as a response to the circumstances that have resulted in the numerous litigation and regulatory investigations to which the Bank has recently been subject. However, we can provide no assurance that an improved control environment will result in fewer litigations or investigations in the future. Furthermore, implementation of enhanced controls may result in higher than expected costs of regulatory compliance and offset efficiency gains, and thereby affect our ability to implement Strategy 2020 successfully.

 

We assume that the buffers we have included in our Strategy 2020 targets will be sufficient to reflect a plausible range of downside scenarios and that absent more substantial disclocations we will be able to achieve the targets. However, the buffers that we have provided in order to achieve these goals may prove to be insufficient in a downside scenario. Should this risk materialize as a result of the macroeconomic, regulatory, litigation or other factors discussed above, we may fail to meet our Strategy 2020 targets.

If we fail to implement our strategic initiatives in whole or in part or should the initiatives that are implemented fail to produce the anticipated benefits, or should the costs we incur to implement our initiatives exceed the amounts anticipated, or should we fail to achieve the publicly communicated targets we have set for implementation of these initiatives in 2016, we may fail to achieve our financial objectives, or incur losses or low profitability or erosions of our capital base, and our financial condition, results of operations and share price may be materially and adversely affected.

As part of Strategy 2020, we announced our intention to dispose of Deutsche Postbank AG (together with its subsidiaries, “Postbank”). We may have difficulties disposing of Postbank at a favorable price or on favorable terms, or at all, and may experience material losses from our holding or disposition of Postbank. We may remain subject to the risks of or other obligations associated with Postbank following a disposal.

As part of our Strategy 2020, we announced our intention to dispose of Postbank. Such disposal may occur by means of a sale of all or part of our holding in Postbank in a public offering of Postbank’s shares or to one or more purchasers in a private transaction. Deutsche Postbank AG became a consolidated, majority-owned subsidiary of ours in December 2010 following a public takeover offer by us. In 2012 Deutsche Postbank AG and a wholly-owned subsidiary of ours entered into a domination and profit and loss transfer agreement. As a preparatory step for the planned disposal, in December 2015, Deutsche Postbank AG, became a wholly owned subsidiary of ours, following a squeeze-out of minority shareholders.

We may have difficulties disposing of Postbank at a favorable price or on favorable terms or timing, or at all. Our ability to dispose of Postbank will, among other things, depend on economic and market conditions, particularly those relevant to the banking industry in Germany. Our ability to dispose of Postbank will also depend on the financial position, results of operations and business prospects of Postbank. If economic or market conditions, or the financial position, results of operations and business prospects of Postbank, are unfavorable, we may not be able to dispose of all or a portion of Postbank at a favorable price or on favorable terms or timing, or at all. A disposal of Postbank may require the approval of relevant regulators in the European Union and elsewhere, which may not be received on favorable terms or at all or which may be subject to disadvantageous conditions. During the period in which Postbank has been a subsidiary of ours, we have sought to integrate certain of its operations into ours and vice versa, and to develop intensified mutual service relationships. We have and will need to make investments in Postbank or incur other expenditures in preparation for its disposal, including the separation of contractual interlinkages, businesses, IT systems and other functions. We may need to make investments in Deutsche Bank to ensure the separation from Postbank and to re-

 

 


Table of Contents
29   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

establish certain systems and other functions. To prepare Postbank for disposal, we will need to enable businesses and functions at Postbank, particularly those that rely on support from Deutsche Bank, to operate on a stand-alone basis, while maintaining efficiency, service quality and compliance with relevant regulations. In addition, prior to the disposal of Postbank we may terminate certain financial transactions with Postbank, transfer certain legal entities to Postbank, and terminate certain contractual relationships. Execution of these preparatory measures is required before a disposal can take place, and a failure to do so properly could hinder the disposal or give rise to financial losses.

Prior to its disposal, we remain exposed to the risks of Postbank and could be adversely affected by losses or obligations incurred by it, which losses or obligations could also adversely affect our ability to effect the disposal. In the event of a disposal of only part of our interest in Postbank, we would remain exposed to the economic risks of the portion of our interest that we did not dispose. In addition, we may remain exposed to certain of the risks of Postbank even following disposal of all or part of our interest in Postbank, if the terms of the sale, our previous relationship with Postbank, or applicable law, subject us to temporary or continuing obligations.

Any failure to dispose of Postbank on favorable terms, or any write-down for Postbank, whether upon its sale or otherwise, could have a material adverse effect on our net assets, financial condition and results of operations.

We may have difficulties selling companies, businesses or assets at favorable prices or at all and may experience material losses from these assets and other investments irrespective of market developments.

As part of Strategy 2020, we are seeking to reduce our assets, including in particular those of our Non-Core Operations Unit, but also those in our Global Markets business division. Such sales are part of our strategy to simplify and focus our business and to meet or exceed the new capital requirements by reducing risk-weighted assets and thereby improving our capital ratios. This strategy may prove difficult in the current and future market environment as many of our competitors are also seeking to dispose of assets to improve their capital ratios. We have already sold a substantial portion of our non-core assets, and our remaining non-core assets may be particularly difficult for us to sell as quickly as we have expected at prices we deem acceptable. Unfavorable business or market conditions may make it difficult for us to sell such assets at favorable prices, or may preclude such a sale altogether.

In addition, we have made significant investments in individual companies and have other assets that are not part of our core business such as our stake in Maher Terminals. While our intention remains to sell or otherwise reduce the amount and the risk of these exposures, if present market conditions persist, such sales will be difficult and may be delayed. Also, we are often a passive investor in such investments and as such we are reliant on the actions of third parties. This may also have an impact on our ability to effect sales or other risk reducing transactions with respect to such investments.

We operate in a highly and increasingly regulated and litigious environment, potentially exposing us to liability and other costs, the amounts of which may be substantial and difficult to estimate, as well as to legal and regulatory sanctions and reputational harm.

The financial services industry is among the most highly regulated industries. Our operations throughout the world are regulated and supervised by the central banks and regulatory authorities in the jurisdictions in which we operate. In recent years, regulation and supervision in a number of areas has increased, and regulators, law enforcement authorities, governmental bodies and others have sought to subject financial services providers to increasing oversight and scrutiny, which in turn has led to additional regulatory investigations or enforcement actions. This trend has accelerated markedly as a result of the global financial crisis and the European sovereign debt crisis. There has been a steep escalation in the severity of the terms which regulators and law enforcement authorities have required to settle legal and regulatory proceedings against financial institutions, with recent settlements including unprecedented monetary penalties as well as criminal sanctions. As a result, we may continue to be subject to increasing levels of liability and regulatory sanctions, and may be required to make greater expenditures and devote additional resources to addressing these liabilities and sanctions. Regulatory sanctions may include status changes to local licenses or orders to discontinue certain business practices.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       30
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

We and our subsidiaries are involved in various litigation proceedings, including civil class action lawsuits, arbitration proceedings and other disputes with third parties, as well as regulatory proceedings and investigations by both civil and criminal authorities in jurisdictions around the world. We expect that we will continue to experience a high level of litigation, regulatory proceedings and investigations. Litigation and regulatory matters are subject to many uncertainties, and the outcome of individual matters is not predictable with assurance. We may settle litigation or regulatory proceedings prior to a final judgment or determination of liability. We may do so for a number of reasons, including to avoid the cost, management efforts or negative business, regulatory or reputational consequences of continuing to contest liability, even when we believe we have valid defenses to liability. We may also do so when the potential consequences of failing to prevail would be disproportionate to the costs of settlement. Furthermore, we may, for similar reasons, reimburse counterparties for their losses even in situations where we do not believe that we are legally compelled to do so. The financial impact of legal risks might be considerable but may be hard or impossible to estimate and to quantify, so that amounts eventually paid may exceed the amount of provisions made or contingent liabilities assessed for such risks.

Actions currently pending against us or our current or former employees may not only result in judgments, settlements, fines or penalties, but may also cause substantial reputational harm to us. The risk of damage to our reputation arising from such proceedings is also hard or impossible to quantify. For example, we are unable to quantify the harm to our reputation that could arise from the investigation by the public prosecutor for the City of Munich of statements made by certain former and present management board members in connection with the litigation relating to the former Kirch Group.

Regulators have increasingly sought admissions of wrongdoing in connection with settlement of matters brought by them. This could lead to increased exposure in subsequent civil litigation or in consequences under so-called "bad actor" laws, in which persons or entities determined to have committed offenses under some laws can be subject to limitations on business activities under other laws, as well as adverse reputational consequences. In addition, the U.S. Department of Justice (DOJ) conditions the granting of cooperation credit in civil and criminal investigations of corporate wrongdoing on the company involved having provided to investigators all relevant facts relating to the individuals responsible for the alleged misconduct. This policy may result in increased fines and penalties if the DOJ determines that we have not provided sufficient information about applicable individuals in connection with an investigation. Other governmental authorities could adopt similar policies.

In addition, the financial impact of legal risks arising out of matters similar to some of those we face have been very large for a number of participants in the financial services industry, with fines and settlement payments greatly exceeding what market participants may have expected and, as noted above, escalating steeply over the last year to unprecedented levels. The experience of others, including settlement terms, in similar cases is among the factors we take into consideration in determining the level of provisions we maintain in respect of these legal risks. Recent developments in cases involving other financial institutions have led to greater uncertainty as to the predictability of outcomes and could lead us to add to our provisions. Moreover, the costs of our investigations and defenses relating to these matters are themselves substantial. Further uncertainty may arise as a result of a lack of coordination among regulators from different jurisdictions, which may make it difficult for us to reach concurrent settlements with each regulator. Should we be subject to financial impacts arising out of litigation and regulatory matters to which we are subject in excess of those we have calculated in accordance with our expectations and the relevant accounting rules and contrary to our publicly communicated expectation that the overall financial impact in 2016 will be below the 2015 levels, our provisions in respect of such risks may prove to be materially insufficient to cover these impacts. This could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations, financial condition or reputation.

Regulatory and law enforcement agencies globally are currently investigating us in connection with misconduct relating to manipulation of foreign exchange rates. The extent of our financial exposure to these matters could be material, and our reputation may suffer material harm as a result.

We have received requests for information from certain regulatory and law enforcement agencies globally who are investigating trading, and various other aspects, of the foreign exchange market. We are cooperating with these investigations. The investigations underway have the potential to result in the imposition of significant financial penalties and

 

 


Table of Contents
31   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

other consequences for us. Relatedly, we are conducting our own internal global review of foreign exchange trading and other aspects of our foreign exchange business.

We have also been named as a defendant in multiple putative class actions brought in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York alleging antitrust and U.S. Commodity Exchange Act claims relating to the alleged manipulation of foreign exchange rates. There are now three actions pending. A pending consolidated action has been brought on behalf of putative classes of over-the-counter traders and central-exchange traders and alleges illegal agreements to restrain competition with respect to and to manipulate both benchmark rates and spot rates, particularly the spreads quoted on those spot rates; the complaint further alleges that those supposed conspiracies, in turn, resulted in artificial prices on centralized exchanges for foreign exchange futures and options. A second action tracks the allegations in the consolidated action and asserts that such purported conduct gave rise to, and resulted in a breach of, defendants’ fiduciary duties under the U.S. Employment Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 (ERISA). The third putative class action alleges that we rejected FX orders placed over electronic trading platforms that were later filled at prices less favorable to putative class members. Plaintiff has asserted claims for breach of contract, quasi-contractual claims, and claims under New York statutory law. We have moved or intend to move to dismiss these actions.

We have also been named as a defendant in two Canadian class proceedings brought in the provinces of Ontario and Quebec. Filed on September 10, 2015, these class actions assert factual allegations similar to those made in the consolidated action in the United States and seek damages pursuant to the Canadian Competition Act as well as other causes of action.

Many of these matters are not advanced enough to estimate their outcome or any fines that may be levied by governmental bodies or damages that may be incurred from private litigation. A number of other financial institutions are also currently being investigated. Any settlements by these institutions may adversely affect the outcomes for other financial institutions, such as us, in similar actions, especially as large settlements may be used as the basis or template for other settlements. As a result, these matters may expose us to substantial monetary damages and defense costs in addition to criminal and civil penalties, and they could accordingly have a material adverse effect on our results of operations, financial condition or reputation.

We are currently the subject of regulatory and criminal industry-wide investigations relating to interbank offered rates, as well as civil actions. Due to a number of uncertainties, including those related to the high profile of the matters and other banks’ settlement negotiations, the eventual outcome of these matters is unpredictable, and may materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition and reputation.

We have received subpoenas and requests for information from various regulatory and law enforcement agencies in Europe, North America and Asia/Pacific, including various U.S. states attorneys general, in connection with industry-wide investigations concerning the setting of London Interbank Offered Rate (LIBOR), Euro Interbank Offered Rate (EURIBOR), Tokyo Interbank Offered Rate (TIBOR) and other interbank offered rates. We are cooperating with these investigations.

The investigations underway have the potential to result in the imposition of significant financial penalties and other consequences for the Bank.

As previously reported, we reached a settlement with the European Commission on December 4, 2013 as part of a collective settlement to resolve the European Commission’s investigations in relation to anticompetitive conduct in the trading of Euro interest rate derivatives and Yen interest rate derivatives. Under the terms of the settlement agreement, we agreed to pay  725 million in total.

Also as previously reported, on April 23, 2015, we entered into separate settlements with the U.S. Department of Justice (DOJ), the U.S. Commodity Futures Trading Commission (CFTC), the U.K. Financial Conduct Authority (FCA), and the New York State Department of Financial Services (NYSDFS) to resolve investigations into misconduct concerning the setting of LIBOR, EURIBOR, and TIBOR. Under the terms of these agreements, we agreed to pay penalties of U.S.$ 2.175 billion to the DOJ, CFTC and NYSDFS and GBP 226.8 million to the FCA. The agreements also contained provisions requiring various undertakings with respect to our benchmark rate submissions in the future, as well as

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       32
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

provisions requiring the appointment of an independent corporate monitor. We were also required to take further disciplinary action against certain employees who were working at the Bank at the time of the agreements.

As part of the resolution with the DOJ, we entered into a Deferred Prosecution Agreement with a three-year term pursuant to which it agreed (among other things) to the filing of a two-count criminal Information in the U.S. District Court for the District of Connecticut charging us with one count of wire fraud and one count of price-fixing, in violation of the Sherman Act. As part of the agreement, DB Group Services (UK) Ltd. (an indirectly held, wholly-owned subsidiary of Deutsche Bank AG) entered into a Plea Agreement with the DOJ, pursuant to which the company pled guilty to a one-count criminal Information filed in the same court and charging the company with wire fraud. A fine of U.S.$ 150 million, which is included in the U.S.$ 2.175 billion in total penalties referenced above, is (subject to court approval) expected to be paid by Deutsche Bank following sentencing of DB Group Services (UK) Ltd., expected in October 2016.

Factual admissions we have made in connection with these settlements could make it difficult for us to defend against pending and future claims.

Other regulatory investigations of us concerning the setting of various interbank offered rates remain ongoing, and we remain exposed to further regulatory action.

In addition, we are party to 47 civil actions concerning manipulation relating to the setting of various Interbank Offered Rates. Most of the civil actions, including putative class actions, are pending in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York (SDNY), against us and numerous other banks. All but six of the civil actions were filed on behalf of parties who allege losses as a result of manipulation relating to the setting of U.S. dollar LIBOR. The six civil actions pending against us that do not relate to U.S. dollar LIBOR are also pending in the SDNY, and include two actions concerning Yen LIBOR and Euroyen TIBOR, one action concerning EURIBOR, two actions concerning Pound Sterling (GBP) LIBOR and one action concerning Swiss franc (CHF) LIBOR.

We cannot predict the effect on us of the interbank offered rates matters, which could include fines levied by government bodies, damages from private litigation for which we may be liable, legal and regulatory sanctions (including possible criminal sanctions) and other consequences.

This uncertainty is further exacerbated by several factors outside of our control, such as the high profile of these matters and the contours of other financial institutions’ settlement negotiations. In addition, regulatory and law enforcement authorities may make assessments about the conduct of institutions in the industry as a whole, which may influence their actions with respect to us. Any fines, damages, legal or regulatory sanctions or other consequences may have a material adverse effect, beyond provisions taken, on our results of operations, financial condition or reputation.

We are defendants in civil actions asserting clawback claims in respect of the insolvency of Kaupthing hf. The extent of our financial exposure to this matter could be material, and our reputation may suffer material harm as a result of this matter.

In June 2012, Kaupthing hf, an Icelandic stock corporation, acting through its winding-up committee, issued Icelandic law clawback claims for approximately  509 million (plus interest calculated on a damages rate basis and penalty rate basis) against us in both Iceland and England. The claims relate to leveraged credit linked notes (“CLNs”), referencing Kaupthing, issued by us to two British Virgin Island special purpose vehicles (“SPVs”) in 2008. The SPVs were ultimately owned by high net worth individuals. Kaupthing claims to have funded the SPVs and alleges that we were or should have been aware that Kaupthing itself was economically exposed in the transactions. Kaupthing claims that the transactions are voidable by Kaupthing on a number of alternative grounds, including the ground that the transactions were improper because one of the alleged purposes of the transactions was to allow Kaupthing to influence the market in its own CDS (credit default swap) spreads and thereby its listed bonds. Additionally, we have been served with similar claims in England by Kaupthing and by the SPVs and their joint liquidators. We have filed a defense in these proceedings and continue to defend them. The extent of our financial exposure to this matter could be material, and our reputation may suffer material harm as a result of this matter.

 

 


Table of Contents
33   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

We have received inquiries from regulatory and law enforcement authorities, including requests for information and documents, pertaining to investigations of precious metals trading and related conduct. The investigations underway have the potential to result in the imposition of significant financial penalties and other consequences for us. We are also named as a defendant in several putative class action complaints in respect of precious metals trading and related conduct.

We have received inquiries from certain regulatory and law enforcement authorities, including requests for information and documents, pertaining to investigations of precious metals trading and related conduct. We are cooperating with these investigations and engaging with relevant authorities, as appropriate. The investigations underway have the potential to result in the imposition of significant financial penalties and other consequences for us. Relatedly, we have been conducting our own internal review of our historic participation in the precious metals benchmarks and other aspects of our precious metals trading and precious metals business.

We are also named as a defendant in several putative class action complaints, which have been consolidated in two lawsuits pending in the U. S. District Court for the Southern District of New York. These suits allege violations of U.S. antitrust law, the U.S. Commodity Exchange Act, and related state law arising out of the alleged manipulation of gold and silver prices through participation in the Gold and Silver Fixes, but do not specify the damages sought. The U.S. class action complaints are in the early stages. In addition, we have been named as a defendant in a Canadian class action proceeding in the Ontario Superior Court of Justice concerning gold, in which plaintiffs seek damages for alleged violations of the Canadian Competition Act as well as other causes of action. These complaints may result in material liability for us.

We are investigating the circumstances around equity trades entered into by certain clients in Moscow and London and have advised regulators and law enforcement authorities in several jurisdictions about those trades. In the event that violations of law or regulation are found to have occurred, any resulting penalties against us may materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition and reputation.

We are investigating the circumstances around equity trades entered into by certain clients with us in Moscow and London that offset one another. The total volume of the transactions under review is significant. Our internal investigation of potential violations of law, regulation and policy and into the related internal control environment remains ongoing; to date it has identified certain violations of our policies and deficiencies in our control environment. We have advised regulators and law enforcement authorities in several jurisdictions (including Germany, Russia, the U.K. and U.S.) of this investigation and have taken disciplinary measures with regards to certain individuals in this matter and will continue to do so with respect to others as warranted. In the event that violations of law or regulation are found to have occurred, legal and regulatory sanctions in respect thereof may materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition and reputation.

Regulatory and law enforcement agencies in the United States are investigating whether our historical processing of certain U.S. dollar payment orders for parties from countries subject to U.S. embargo laws complied with U.S. federal and state laws. While we have settled some matters, other investigations are still in progress and the eventual outcomes of these matters are unpredictable, and may materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition and reputation.

We have received requests for information from certain regulatory and law enforcement agencies concerning our historical processing of U.S. dollar payment orders through U.S. financial institutions for parties from countries subject to U.S. embargo laws. These agencies are investigating whether such processing complied with U.S. federal and state laws. On November 3, 2015, we entered into agreements with the New York State Department of Financial Services and the Federal Reserve Bank of New York to resolve their investigations of Deutsche Bank. We paid the two agencies U.S.$ 200 million and U.S.$ 58 million, respectively, and agreed to terminate certain employees, not rehire certain former employees and install an independent monitor for one year. In addition, the Federal Reserve Bank of New York ordered certain remedial measures, specifically, the requirement to ensure an effective OFAC compliance program and an annual review of such program by an independent party until the Federal Reserve Bank of New York is satisfied as to its effectiveness. We continue to provide information to and otherwise cooperate with other investigating agencies. While it is too early to predict, the eventual outcomes of the investigations to which we are subject may materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition and reputation.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       34
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

We have been subject to contractual claims, litigation and governmental investigations in respect of our U.S. residential mortgage loan business that may materially and adversely affect our results of operations, financial condition or reputation.

From 2005 through 2008, as part of our U.S. residential mortgage loan business, we sold approximately U.S.$ 84 billion of loans into private label securitizations and U.S.$ 71 billion through whole loan sales. We have been, and in the future may be, presented with demands to repurchase loans from or to indemnify purchasers, investors or financial insurers with respect to losses allegedly caused by material breaches of representations and warranties. Our general practice is to process valid repurchase claims that are presented in compliance with contractual rights and applicable statutes of limitations. As of December 31, 2015, we have approximately U.S.$ 2.4 billion of mortgage repurchase demands outstanding and not subject to agreements to rescind (based on original principal balance of the loans). Against these outstanding demands, we have established provisions of U.S.$ 445 million ( 409 million) as of December 31, 2015 (for part of which we are indemnified). As with provisions generally, however, it is possible that the provisions we have established may ultimately be insufficient, either with respect to particular claims or with respect to the full set of claims that have been or may be presented. There are other potential mortgage repurchase demands that we anticipate may be made, but we cannot reliably estimate their timing or amount. As of December 31, 2015, we have completed repurchases, obtained agreements to rescind or otherwise settled claims on loans with an original principal balance of approximately U.S.$ 7.2 billion. In connection with those repurchases, agreements and settlements, we have obtained releases for potential claims on approximately U.S.$ 93.0 billion of loans sold by us as described above.

From 2005 through 2008, we or our affiliates have also acted as an underwriter of approximately U.S.$ 105 billion of U.S. residential mortgage-backed securities (referred to as “RMBS”) for third-party originators.

As is the case with a significant number of other participants in the mortgage securitizations market and as described in Note 29 “Provisions” to the consolidated financial statements, we have received subpoenas and requests for information from certain regulators and government entities concerning our RMBS businesses. We are cooperating fully in response to those subpoenas and requests for information. Some of these investigations are similar in nature to those that led to other financial institutions entering into settlements with members of the Residential Mortgage-Backed Securities Working Group of the U.S. Financial Fraud Enforcement Task Force and paying significant penalties. We have a number of pending lawsuits against us or our affiliates as issuer, underwriter and/or trustee of RMBS. Such pending RMBS litigations are in various stages and we continue to defend these actions vigorously while seeking opportunities to achieve sensible out of court resolutions. Legal and regulatory proceedings are subject to many uncertainties, and the outcome of individual matters is not predictable.

Criminal and regulatory authorities are currently investigating or seeking information from us in connection with transactions with Monte dei Paschi di Siena. The extent of our financial exposure to these matters could be material, and our reputation may be harmed.

In February 2013 Banca Monte Dei Paschi Di Siena, which we refer to as “MPS”, issued civil proceedings in Italy against us alleging that we assisted former MPS senior management in an accounting fraud on MPS, by undertaking repo transactions with MPS and “Santorini”, a wholly owned SPV of MPS, which helped MPS defer losses on a previous transaction undertaken with us. Subsequently, in July 2013, the Fondazione Monte Dei Paschi, MPS’ largest shareholder, also issued civil proceedings in Italy for damages based on substantially the same facts. In December 2013, we reached an agreement with MPS in relation to the transactions that resolves the civil proceedings by MPS. The civil proceedings by the Fondazione Monte Dei Paschi remain pending.

A criminal investigation was launched by the Siena Public Prosecutor into the transactions and certain unrelated transactions entered into by a number of other international banks with MPS. Such investigation was moved in September 2014 from Siena to the Milan Public Prosecutors as a result of a change in the alleged charges being investigated. On February 16, 2016, the Milan Public Prosecutors issued a request of committal to trial against us and six current and former employees. The preliminary hearing before the judge for the preliminary investigation phase (who has to decide whether to adhere to the request of committal to trial or not) is scheduled to take place in March 2016. Separately, we have also received requests for information from certain regulators relating to the transactions, including with respect to our accounting for the transactions and alleged failures by our management adequately to supervise the individuals

 

 


Table of Contents
35   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

involved in the matter. We are cooperating with these regulators. The extent of our financial exposure to these matters could be material, and our reputation may suffer material harm as a result of these matters.

Guilty pleas by or convictions of us or our affiliates in criminal proceedings may have consequences that have adverse effects on certain of our businesses.

We and our affiliates have been and are subjects of criminal proceedings or investigations. In particular, as part of the resolution of the investigation of U.S. Department of Justice (DOJ) into misconduct relating to interbank offered rates, our subsidiary DB Group Services (UK) Ltd. entered into a plea agreement with the DOJ, pursuant to which the company pled guilty to one count of wire fraud. Also, in connection with the KOSPI Index unwind matters, our subsidiary Deutsche Securities Korea Co. was convicted of vicarious corporate criminal liability in respect of spot/futures linked market manipulation by its employees. We and our subsidiaries are also subjects of other criminal proceedings or investigations.

Guilty pleas or convictions against us or our affiliates could lead to our ineligibility to use an important trading exemption under the U.S. Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 (ERISA). In particular, such guilty pleas or convictions could cause our affiliates to no longer qualify as a “qualified professional asset manager” (QPAM) under the QPAM Prohibited Transaction Exemption, which exemption is relied on to provide asset management services to certain pension plans in connection with certain asset management strategies. Loss of QPAM status could cause customers who rely on such status (whether because they are legally required to do so or because we have agreed contractually with them to maintain such status) to cease to do business or refrain from doing business with us and could negatively impact our reputation more generally. This could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations, particularly those of our asset management and wealth management businesses in the United States. We have filed an application with the U.S. Department of Labor (DOL), the agency responsible for ERISA, for exemptive relief permitting us to retain our QPAM status despite both the guilty plea of DB Group Services (UK) Ltd. and the conviction of Deutsche Securities Korea Co. The DOL has tentatively denied our QPAM application but has granted us a temporary QPAM exemption, effective through October 25, 2016. We have provided additional information to the DOL in support of our QPAM application and are seeking to address the DOL’s concerns in connection with its tentative denial letter. It is unclear whether the QPAM application will be approved, and a denial, and thus loss of QPAM status, could occur, with the potential for the adverse effects described above.

Our non-traditional credit businesses materially add to our traditional banking credit risks.

As a bank and provider of financial services, we are exposed to the risk that third parties who owe us money, securities or other assets will not perform their obligations. Many of the businesses we engage in beyond the traditional banking businesses of deposit-taking and lending also expose us to credit risk.

In particular, much of the business we conduct through our Corporate Banking & Securities Corporate Division and our Non-Core Operations Unit entails credit transactions, frequently ancillary to other transactions. Nontraditional sources of credit risk can arise, for example, from holding securities of third parties; entering into swap or other derivative contracts under which counterparties have obligations to make payments to us; executing securities, futures, currency or commodity trades that fail to settle at the required time due to nondelivery by the counterparty or systems failure by clearing agents, exchanges, clearing houses or other financial intermediaries; and extending credit through other arrangements. Parties to these transactions, such as trading counterparties, may default on their obligations to us due to bankruptcy, political and economic events, lack of liquidity, operational failure or other reasons.

Many of our derivative transactions are individually negotiated and non-standardized, which can make exiting, transferring or settling the position difficult. Certain credit derivatives require that we deliver to the counterparty the underlying security, loan or other obligation in order to receive payment. In a number of cases, we do not hold, and may not be able to obtain, the underlying security, loan or other obligation. This could cause us to forfeit the payments otherwise due to us or result in settlement delays, which could damage our reputation and ability to transact future business, as well as impose increased costs on us. Recently enacted legislation in the European Union (EMIR) and the U.S. (the Dodd-Frank Act) has introduced requirements for the standardization, margining, central clearing and transaction reporting of certain over-the-counter derivatives. While such requirements are aimed at reducing the risk posed to coun-

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       36
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

terparties and the financial system by such derivatives, they may reduce the volume and profitability of the transactions in which we engage, and compliance with such provisions may impose substantial costs on us.

The exceptionally difficult market conditions experienced since the global financial crisis severely adversely affected certain areas in which we do business that entail nontraditional credit risks, including the leveraged finance and structured credit markets, and may do so in the future.

We have incurred losses, and may incur further losses, as a result of changes in the fair value of our financial instruments.

A substantial proportion of the assets and liabilities on our balance sheet comprise financial instruments that we carry at fair value, with changes in fair value recognized in the income statement. Fair value is defined as the price at which an asset or liability could be exchanged in an arm’s length transaction between knowledgeable, willing parties, other than in a forced or liquidation sale. If the value of an asset carried at fair value declines (or the value of a liability carried at fair value increases) a corresponding unfavorable change in fair value is recognized in the income statement. These changes have been and could in the future be significant. Additionally, in recent periods there has been a significant difference between fair value and book value for some assets.

Observable prices or inputs are not available for certain classes of financial instruments. Fair value is determined in these cases using valuation techniques we believe to be appropriate for the particular instrument. The application of valuation techniques to determine fair value involves estimation and management judgment, the extent of which will vary with the degree of complexity of the instrument and liquidity in the market. Management judgment is required in the selection and application of the appropriate parameters, assumptions and modeling techniques. If any of the assumptions change due to negative market conditions or for other reasons, subsequent valuations may result in significant changes in the fair values of our financial instruments, requiring us to record losses.

Our exposure and related changes in fair value are reported net of any fair value gains we may record in connection with hedging transactions related to the underlying assets. However, we may never realize these gains, and the fair value of the hedges may change in future periods for a number of reasons, including as a result of deterioration in the credit of our hedging counterparties. Such declines may be independent of the fair values of the underlying hedged assets or liabilities and may result in future losses.

Our risk management policies, procedures and methods leave us exposed to unidentified or unanticipated risks, which could lead to material losses.

We have devoted significant resources to developing our risk management policies, procedures and assessment methods and intend to continue to do so in the future. Nonetheless, the risk management techniques and strategies have not been and may in the future not be fully effective in mitigating our risk exposure in all economic market environments or against all types of risk, including risks that we fail to identify or anticipate. Some of our quantitative tools and metrics for managing risk are based upon our use of observed historical market behavior. We apply statistical and other tools to these observations to arrive at quantifications of our risk exposures. During the financial crisis, the financial markets experienced unprecedented levels of volatility (rapid changes in price direction) and the breakdown of historically observed correlations (the extent to which prices move in tandem) across asset classes, compounded by extremely limited liquidity. In this volatile market environment, our risk management tools and metrics failed to predict some of the losses we experienced, particularly in 2008, and may in the future fail to predict important risk exposures. In addition, our quantitative modeling does not take all risks into account and makes numerous assumptions regarding the overall environment, which may not be borne out by events. As a result, risk exposures have arisen and could continue to arise from factors we did not anticipate or correctly evaluate in our statistical models. This has limited and could continue to limit our ability to manage our risks especially in light of geopolitical developments, many of the outcomes of which are currently unforeseeable. Our losses thus have been and may in the future be significantly greater than the historical measures indicate.

 

 


Table of Contents
37   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

In addition, our more qualitative approach to managing those risks not taken into account by our quantitative methods could also prove insufficient, exposing us to material unanticipated losses. Also, if existing or potential customers or counterparties believe our risk management is inadequate, they could take their business elsewhere or seek to limit their transactions with us. This could harm our reputation as well as our revenues and profits. See “Management Report: Risk Report” beginning on page 79 of the Annual Report 2015 for a more detailed discussion of the policies, procedures and methods we use to identify, monitor and manage our risks.

Operational risks may disrupt our businesses.

We face operational risk arising from errors, inadvertent or intentional, made in the execution, confirmation or settlement of transactions or from transactions not being properly recorded, evaluated or accounted for. An example of this risk concerns our derivative contracts, which are not always confirmed with the counterparties on a timely basis. For so long as the transaction remains unconfirmed, we are subject to heightened credit and operational risk and in the event of a default may find it more difficult to enforce the contract. The European sovereign debt crisis and the global financial crisis, in which the risk of counterparty default increased, have increased the possibility that this operational risk materializes.

In addition, our businesses are highly dependent on our ability to process manually or through our systems a large number of transactions on a daily basis, across numerous and diverse markets in many currencies. Some of the transactions have become increasingly complex. Moreover, management relies heavily on its financial, accounting and other data processing systems that include manual processing components. If any of these processes or systems do not operate properly, or are disabled, or subject to intentional or inadvertent human error, we could suffer financial loss, a disruption of our businesses, liability to clients, regulatory intervention or reputational damage.

We are also dependent on our employees to conduct our business in accordance with applicable laws, regulations and generally accepted business standards. If our employees do not conduct our business in this manner, we may be exposed to material losses. Furthermore, if an employee’s misconduct reflects fraudulent intent, we could also be exposed to reputational damage. We categorize these risks as conduct risk, which comprises inappropriate business practices, including selling products that are not suitable for a particular customer, fraud, unauthorized trading and failure to comply with applicable regulations, laws and internal policies.

We in particular face the risk of loss events due to the instability, malfunction or outage of our IT system and IT infrastructure. Such losses could materially affect our ability to perform business processes and may, for example, arise from the erroneous or delayed execution of processes as either a result of system outages or degraded services in systems and IT applications. A delay in processing a transaction, for example, could result in an operational loss if market conditions worsen during the period after the error. IT-related errors may also result in the mishandling of confidential information, damage to our computer systems, financial losses, additional costs for repairing systems, reputational damage, customer dissatisfaction or potential regulatory or litigation exposure.

Business continuity risk is the risk of incurring losses resulting from the interruption of normal business activities. We operate in many geographic locations and are frequently subject to the occurrence of events outside of our control. Despite the contingency plans we have in place, our ability to conduct business in any of these locations may be adversely impacted by a disruption to the infrastructure that supports our business, whether as a result of, for example, events that affect our third party vendors or the community or public infrastructure in which we operate. Any number of events could cause such a disruption including deliberate acts such as sabotage, terrorist activities, bomb threats, strikes, riots and assaults on the bank’s staff; natural calamities such as hurricanes, snow storms, floods, disease pandemic and earthquakes; or other unforeseen incidents such as accidents, fires, explosions, utility outages and political unrest. Any such disruption could have a material adverse effect on our business and financial position.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       38
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

Our operational systems are subject to an increasing risk of cyber attacks and other internet crime, which could result in material losses of client or customer information, damage our reputation and lead to regulatory penalties and financial losses.

Among the operational risks we face is the risk of breaches of the security of our computer systems due to unauthorized access to networks or resources, the introduction of computer viruses or malware, or other forms of cyber attack or internet crime. Such breaches could threaten the confidentiality of our clients’ data and the integrity of our systems. We devote significant resources toward the protection of our computer systems against such breaches. To address the evolving cyber threat risk, we are currently expending significant additional resources to modify and enhance our protective measures and to investigate and remediate any information security vulnerabilities. Nevertheless, a residual risk remains that such measures may not be effective against all threats. Given our global footprint and the volume of transactions we process, certain errors or actions may be repeated or compounded before they are discovered and rectified.

We and other financial institutions have experienced attacks on computer systems, including attacks aimed at obtaining unauthorized access to confidential company or customer information or damaging or interfering with company data, resources or business activities. The increasing frequency and sophistication of recent cyber-attacks has resulted in an elevated risk profile for many organizations around the world, and significant attention by our management has been paid to the overall level of preparedness against such attacks. Cyber security is growing in importance due to factors such as the continued and increasing reliance on our technology environment. Although we have to date not experienced any material loss of data from these attacks, it is possible, given the use of new technologies and increasing reliance on the Internet and the varying nature and evolving sophistication of such attacks, that we may not be able to effectively anticipate and prevent all such attacks. A successful attack could have a significant negative impact on us, including as a result of disclosure or misappropriation of client or proprietary information, damage to computer systems, financial losses, additional costs to us (such as for investigation and reestablishing services), reputational damage, customer dissatisfaction and potential regulatory or litigation exposure.

The size of our clearing operations exposes us to a heightened risk of material losses should these operations fail to function properly.

We have large clearing and settlement businesses and an increasingly complex and interconnected information technology (IT) landscape. These give rise to the risk that we, our customers or other third parties could lose substantial sums if our systems fail to operate properly for even short periods. This will be the case even where the reason for the interruption is external to us. In such a case, we might suffer harm to our reputation even if no material amounts of money are lost. This could cause customers to take their business elsewhere, which could materially harm our revenues and profits.

We may have difficulty in identifying and executing acquisitions, and both making acquisitions and avoiding them could materially harm our results of operations and our share price.

We consider business combinations from time to time. Even though we review the companies, businesses, assets, liabilities or contracts we plan to acquire, it is generally not feasible for these reviews to be complete in all respects. As a result, we may assume unanticipated liabilities, or an acquisition may not perform as well as expected. Were we to announce or complete a significant business combination transaction, our share price could decline significantly if investors viewed the transaction as too costly or unlikely to improve our competitive position. In addition, we might have difficulty integrating any entity with which we combine our operations. Failure to complete announced business combinations or failure to integrate acquired businesses successfully into ours could materially and adversely affect our profitability. It could also affect investors’ perception of our business prospects and management, and thus cause our share price to fall. It could also lead to departures of key employees, or lead to increased costs and reduced profitability if we felt compelled to offer them financial incentives to remain.

 

 


Table of Contents
39   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

Intense competition, in our home market of Germany as well as in international markets, could materially adversely impact our revenues and profitability.

Competition is intense in all of our primary business areas, in Germany as well as in international markets. If we are unable to respond to the competitive environment in these markets with attractive product and service offerings that are profitable for us, we may lose market share in important areas of our business or incur losses on some or all of our activities. In addition, downturns in the economies of these markets could add to the competitive pressure, through, for example, increased price pressure and lower business volumes for us.

In recent years there has been substantial consolidation and convergence among financial services companies, culminating in unprecedented consolidations in the course of the global financial crisis. This trend has significantly increased the capital base and geographic reach of some of our competitors and has hastened the globalization of the securities and other financial services markets. As a result, we must compete with financial institutions that may be larger and better capitalized than we are and that may have a stronger position in local markets. Also, governmental action in response to the global financial crisis may place us at a competitive disadvantage.

Transactions with counterparties in countries designated by the U.S. State Department as state sponsors of terrorism or persons targeted by U.S. economic sanctions may lead potential customers and investors to avoid doing business with us or investing in our securities, harm our reputation or result in regulatory action which could materially and adversely affect our business.

We engage or have engaged in a limited amount of business with counterparties, including government-owned or -controlled counterparties, in certain countries or territories that are subject to comprehensive sanctions, including Iran and Cuba (referred to as “Sanctioned Countries”), or with persons targeted by U.S. economic sanctions (referred to as “Sanctioned Persons”). U.S. law generally prohibits U.S. persons or any other persons acting within U.S. jurisdiction from doing business with Sanctioned Countries or Sanctioned Persons. Thus, U.S. regulations may extend to activities in other geographic areas and by non-U.S. persons depending on the circumstances. Our U.S. subsidiaries, branch offices, and employees are and our non-U.S. subsidiaries, branch offices, and employees may become subject to those prohibitions and other regulations. We are a German bank and our activities with respect to Sanctioned Countries and Sanctioned Persons have been subject to policies and procedures designed to avoid the involvement of persons acting within U.S. jurisdiction in any managerial or operational role and to ensure compliance with United Nations, European Union and German embargoes; in reflection of legal developments in recent years, we further developed our policies and procedures with the aim of ensuring compliance with regulatory requirements extending to other geographic areas regardless of jurisdiction. However, should our policies prove to have been ineffective, we may be subject to regulatory action that could materially and adversely affect our business. By 2007, our Management Board decided that we will not engage in new business with counterparties in countries such as Iran, Syria, Sudan and North Korea and to exit existing business to the extent legally possible. It also decided to limit our business with counterparties in Cuba. Of these, Iran, Sudan and Syria are currently designated as state sponsors of terrorism by the U.S. State Department.

We had a representative office in Tehran, Iran, which we discontinued at December 31, 2007. Our remaining business with Iranian counterparties consists mostly of participations as lender and/or agent in a few large trade finance facilities arranged before 2007 to finance the export contracts of exporters in Europe and Asia. The lifetime of most of these facilities is ten years or more and we are legally obligated to fulfil our contractual obligations. We do not believe our business activities with Iranian counterparties are material to our overall business, with the outstanding loans to Iranian borrowers representing substantially less than 0.01 % of our total assets as of December 31, 2015 and the revenues from all such activities representing less than 0.01 % of our total revenues for the year ended December 31, 2015.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       40
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

In recent years, the United States has taken steps, including the passage of the Comprehensive Iran Sanctions, Accountability, and Divestment Act of 2010, the National Defense Authorization Act for Fiscal Year 2012, the Iran Threat Reduction and Syria Human Rights Act of 2012, the Iran Freedom and Counter-Proliferation Act of 2012, and a number of Executive Orders, to deter foreign companies from dealing with Iran by providing for possible sanctions against companies that provide services in support of certain Iranian activity in (among others) the financial, energy, shipping or military sectors or with certain Iranian counterparties, whether or not such dealings occur within U.S jurisdiction. Among the targets of these indirect, or “secondary”, U.S. economic sanctions are foreign financial institutions that, among other things, facilitate significant transactions with, or provide significant financial services to a wide range of Iranian entities, persons, and financial institutions. We do not believe we have engaged in activities sanctionable under these statutes, but the U.S. authorities have considerable discretion in applying the statutes, and any imposition of sanctions against us could be material. Following the occurrence on January 16, 2016 of “Implementation Day” of the Joint Comprehensive Plan of Action between the “P5+1” parties and Iran, pursuant to which Iran agreed to limits on its nuclear program and the P5+1 parties agreed to provide certain sanctions relief, secondary sanctions targeting Iran have been narrowed but not eliminated.

As required by Section 219 of the Iran Threat Reduction and Syria Human Rights Act of 2012 (Section 13(r) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended) we have disclosed certain information regarding our activities or transactions with persons subject to U.S. sanctions against Iran and other persons subject to such provision. Such disclosure is set forth in the section of this document entitled “Disclosures Under Iran Threat Reduction and Syria Human Rights Act of 2012”, which follows “Item 16H: Mine Safety Disclosure”.

We are also engaged in a limited amount of business with counterparties domiciled in Cuba, which is not subject to any United Nations, European Union or German embargo. The business consists of a limited number of letters of credit, as well as claims resulting from letters of credit, and it represented substantially less than 0.01 % of our assets as of December 31, 2015. The transactions served to finance commercial products such as machinery and electrical equipment as well as medical products.

We are aware of current or proposed laws, regulations, policies or other initiatives by governmental and nongovernmental entities in the United States and elsewhere to prohibit transactions with or investment in, or require divestment from, entities doing business with Sanctioned Countries, particularly Iran and Sudan. Such initiatives may result in our being unable to gain or retain entities subject to such prohibitions as customers or as investors in our securities. In addition, our reputation may suffer due to our association with such countries. Such a result could have significant adverse effects on our business or the price of our securities. It is also possible that new direct or indirect secondary sanctions could be imposed by the United States or other jurisdictions without warning as a result of geopolitical developments.

 

 


Table of Contents
41   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

Item 4: Information on the Company

History and Development of the Company

The legal and commercial name of our company is Deutsche Bank Aktiengesellschaft. It is a stock corporation organized under the laws of Germany.

Deutsche Bank Aktiengesellschaft originated from the reunification of Norddeutsche Bank Aktiengesellschaft, Hamburg, Rheinisch-Westfälische Bank Aktiengesellschaft, Düsseldorf, and Süddeutsche Bank Aktiengesellschaft, Munich. Pursuant to the Law on the Regional Scope of Credit Institutions, these were disincorporated in 1952 from Deutsche Bank, which had been founded in 1870. The merger and the name were entered in the Commercial Register of the District Court Frankfurt am Main on May 2, 1957.

We are registered under registration number HRB 30 000. Our registered address is Taunusanlage 12, 60325 Frankfurt am Main, Germany, and our telephone number is +49-69-910-00. Our agent in the United States is: Peter Sturzinger, Deutsche Bank Americas, c/o Office of the Secretary, 60 Wall Street, Mail Stop NYC60-2525, New York, NY 10005.

For information on significant capital expenditures and divestitures, please see “Management Report: Operating and Financial Review: Deutsche Bank Group: Significant Capital Expenditures and Divestitures” on page 38 of the Annual Report 2015.

Business Overview

Our Organization

Please see “Management Report: Operating and Financial Review: Deutsche Bank Group: Our Organization” on page 32 of the Annual Report 2015. For information on net revenues by geographic area and by corporate division please see Note 4 “Business Segments and Related Information: Entity-Wide Disclosures” to the consolidated financial statements and “Management Report: Operating and Financial Review: Results of Operations: Segment Results of Operations” on pages 48 through 50 of the Annual Report 2015.

Management Structure

Please see “Management Report: Operating and Financial Review: Deutsche Bank Group: Management Structure” on page 32 to 33 of the Annual Report 2015.

Our Business Strategy

Following a comprehensive strategic review of the Group, Deutsche Bank announced its new strategic plan (“Strategy 2020”) in April 2015. In October 2015, we provided further details around the Bank’s strategic goals, management actions in its business divisions, infrastructure functions, and regions, and updated performance targets for 2018 and 2020.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       42
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

The Bank conducted an examination of our business divisions, infrastructure functions, and regions, and an assessment of their ability to serve our clients’ future needs. Based on this assessment, the Bank’s management reinforced our commitment to a global platform and universal banking product offering in which all four of our businesses, Corporate Banking and Securities (“CB&S”), Global Transaction Banking (“GTB”), Deutsche Asset & Wealth Management (“Deutsche AWM”) and Private and Business Clients (“PBC”), remain core. The clear intention of Strategy 2020 is to focus our universal offering of products and services in order to become a less complex, more efficient, less risky and better capitalized bank.

In detail, the four strategic goals comprise the following:

 

 

First, to become simpler and more efficient by focusing on the markets, products, and clients where we are better positioned to succeed, which should lead to greater client satisfaction and lower costs. We want to achieve this via a material reduction in the number of locations, products and clients, as well as a simplified organization with fewer legal entities. Moreover, we intend to move towards a competitive cost structure, based on a more efficient infrastructure. Our execution plan includes the closure of onshore operations in ten countries, the transfer of trading activities to global and regional hubs and further centralization of booking locations in global and regional hubs. We aim to exit selected Global Markets business lines and to reduce the number of clients in CB&S. Furthermore, we intend to eliminate approximately 90 legal entities.

 

Second, to become less risky by modernizing our technology and withdrawing from higher-risk client relationships. We intend to (a) withdraw from those client relationships where in our view the risks are too high, to (b) improve our control framework, and to (c) implement automation in order to replace manual reconcil-iation. We seek to modernize our IT architecture, for instance by reducing the number of individual operating systems and by replacing the Bank’s end-of-life hardware and software applications. Automation of manual processes is aimed at driving efficiency and improving control. We intend to prioritize investments in the Know-Your-Client (“KYC”) and Anti-Money-Laundering (“AML”) infrastructure.

 

Third, to become better capitalized. We want to reduce risk-weighted assets (“RWAs”) by approximately  90 billion to approximately 320 billion by 2018 and approximately 310 billion by 2020, excluding RWA inflation on the back of changing regulatory requirements, which is expected to be at least 100 billion by 2019/2020. Furthermore, we seek to reduce our net CRD 4 leverage exposure by approximately 170 billion by 2018. Key components of our execution plan include the deconsolidation of Postbank, the planned sale of our entire noncontrolling 19.99 % stake in Hua Xia Bank and the substantial wind-down of the Non-Core Operations Unit (“NCOU”) as well as the exit of selected Global Markets business lines. We intend to par-tially reinvest some capital into our business in order to pursue growth in our Global Transaction Banking and Asset and Wealth Management businesses.

 

Fourth, to run Deutsche Bank with more disciplined execution. We strive to secure disciplined execution of our main targets through the establishment of a fully accountable management team with all businesses and functions represented. Furthermore, we are committed to favoring personal accountability over committees wherever possible. We intend to combine this with a better alignment of our reward system to good performance and conduct.

We have also set ourselves clear financial targets in key areas. Starting with the regulatory ratios, we aim to strengthen our capital position, with a target Common Equity Tier 1 capital ratio of at least 12.5 % from the end of 2018, and a target leverage ratio of at least 4.5 % at the end of 2018 and at least 5 % at the end of 2020. By 2018, we further aim to produce net savings in our adjusted costs (total non-interest expenses excluding restructuring and severance, litigation, impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets and policyholder benefits and claims) of approximately 1.0 to  1.5 billion, against restructuring and severance costs of approximately 3.0 to 3.5 billion, to reduce total adjusted costs to below  22 billion. In addition, we plan to dispose of assets before the end of 2017 that currently have a total cost base of approximately 4.0 billion. Additionally, we aim to achieve a cost-income ratio of approximately 70 % by 2018 and approximately 65 % by 2020. In respect of returns to our shareholders, we aim to achieve post-tax return on tangible equity of greater than 10 % by 2018. Execution of Strategy 2020 is already underway. In October 2015, we announced a reorganization of our operating businesses along our key client segments effective January 1, 2016. The Corporate Banking & Securities business division has been split into two business divisions. CB&S’s sales and trading activities have been combined in a newly created business division called Global Markets (“GM”) with a primary focus on institutional clients. A new business division called Corporate & Investment Banking (“CIB”) has been created by

 

 


Table of Contents
43   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

combining the Corporate Finance business in CB&S with the Global Transaction Banking division. CIB is focused primarily on servicing corporate clients. Furthermore, Deutsche Asset & Wealth Management has been split. Deutsche Bank Wealth Management (“WM”) is now run as a business unit alongside the Private and Business Client division to form the new Private, Wealth & Commercial Clients (“PW&CC”) business division focusing on private, commercial and high net worth clients. Deutsche Asset Management (“AM”) has become a stand-alone business division and focuses exclusively on institutional clients and the funds business. We believe that these structural changes better equip us to deliver on Strategy 2020 and we aim to have our cost reductions and capital measures materially completed by the end of 2018.

Strategy 2020 is expected to have a fundamental impact on Deutsche Bank’s structure, processes and culture. All of the strategic initiatives are designed to strengthen the Bank’s financial position and resilience. The Management Board is accountable for the Bank’s operating performance and execution against Strategy 2020. Its role is to provide oversight and decision-making on Strategy 2020 execution and financial performance. It also manages overall dependencies across projects and cross-divisional initiatives. All business divisions, key infrastructure functions and owners of cross-divisional tasks have developed detailed execution plans with concrete financial targets, milestones and interdependencies. These detailed plans form the basis for tracking subsequent implementation progress. We have enhanced our Performance Management Framework to monitor and track progress in implementing Strategy 2020 and to address and escalate deviations from the plan.

Strategy in CB&S

Under the old organizational structure, CB&S comprised the Markets and Corporate Finance businesses. The Markets business combines the sales, trading and structuring of a wide range of financial markets’ products, including bonds, equities and equity-linked products, exchange-traded and over-the-counter derivatives, foreign exchange, money market instruments, and securitized products. Coverage of institutional clients is provided by the Institutional Client Group, while Research provides analysis of markets, products and trading strategies for clients. Corporate Finance is responsible for mergers and acquisitions (“M&A”) as well as debt and equity advisory and origination. Regional, industry-focused teams saw to the delivery of the entire range of financial products and services to the Bank’s corporate clients.

CB&S was committed to being a global leader in investment banking. With operations in over 50 countries around the world, employing around 8,500 staff, CB&S was at home in Asia Pacific and the Americas as it was in Europe.

In 2015, CB&S continued to optimize resources across the platform, enabling the business to maintain a top tier client franchise (i.e., Top-3 in FX across all regions (Euromoney), Top-3 in Fixed Income in the U.S. and Japan, #4 in Europe and APAC excluding Japan (Greenwich)) while delivering a more efficient platform. We continued to reduce leverage exposure, adjusted costs (excluding restructuring and severance, litigation, impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets and policyholder benefits and claims) and headcount. The 2015 income before taxes result of (2,035) million was significantly impacted by litigation ( (2,790) million) and goodwill impairments ( (2,168) million).

As of January 1, 2016 the corporate-client focused Corporate Finance group of CB&S has been combined with GTB to form the new Corporate & Investment Banking (“CIB”) division, while the new Global Markets (“GM”) division focuses on institutional clients.

In Global Markets, our diversified client-focused business model delivered increased revenues in 2015 compared to the prior year. The business is now focused on executing initiatives to deliver Strategy 2020. These initiatives aim to reduce RWA and CRD 4 leverage exposure, improve profitability and reduce complexity. In addition to our previously-announced exit of uncleared CDS, we will exit from legacy Rates assets, Agency RMBS trading and high risk-weight securitized trading. We intend to rationalize activities in EM Debt, Rates & Credit OTC clearing and low-return client lending and target a reduction of leverage exposure consumption by our Fixed Income and Currencies (“FIC”) businesses, while continuing to optimize leverage and RWA consumption across the platform. In order to pursue identified growth opportunities, we will invest in Prime Brokerage and Credit Solutions with balance sheet released from exiting and optimizing other parts of the business. At the same time we intend to reduce our client and country footprint, rationalize our platform infrastructure and enhance the control environment.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       44
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

In Corporate Finance we were ranked number 6 globally in 2015 (based on Dealogic data). The creation of the new CIB division is intended to enable us to better serve corporate clients with our full set of banking products. We intend to retain strength in Debt Capital Markets with focused efforts to grow market share in Advisory and Equity Capital Markets.

Strategy in PBC

Deutsche Bank’s Private & Business Clients (“PBC”) division provides banking and other financial services to private and commercial clients in Germany and selected international markets. PBC’s products and services include payment and current account services, investment management and retirement planning, as well as personal loans, mortgages and deposits. For small and medium-sized commercial clients, PBC offers a full range of services, e.g. from start-up financing to structured finance. Together with the Group's business divisions, PBC leverages the possibilities of interest rate and foreign currency management, foreign trade and the capital markets. PBC contains the three business divisions Private & Commercial Banking, Advisory Banking International and Postbank. Private & Commercial Banking comprises all of PBC's activities in Germany under the Deutsche Bank brand. Advisory Banking International consists of PBC's franchises in its five European markets (excluding Germany): Italy, Spain, Belgium, Portugal and Poland and in India. Additionally, in China, PBC holds a 19.99 % stake in Hua Xia Bank.

PBC is a leading private bank in Deutsche Bank’s home market Germany and provides services to more than 22 million clients. In addition, PBC serves more than 5 million clients elsewhere in Europe and in India. PBC’s income before taxes of (3,291) million was strongly impacted by (3,603) million impairment of goodwill and other intangibles, (697) million valuation and transaction-related effect relating to the Hua Xia Bank stake as well as (670) million for restructuring and severances. Major business related drivers in 2015 were growth in Global Credit Products and Investment & Insurance Products revenues as well as strict cost discipline which compensated for continued headwinds from the persisting low interest rate environment and from regulatory change.

As of January 1, 2016 we have combined Private & Business Clients (“PBC”) and Deutsche Bank Wealth Management (“WM”) to create the new segment Private, Wealth & Commercial Clients (“PW&CC”). PW&CC pursues a strategy of creating a leading, digitally enabled advisory bank with a strong focus on growth in Private Banking, Commercial Banking and Wealth Management. PW&CC’s objectives include the provision of seamless client coverage with a distinct Private Banking and Wealth Management approach in Germany, a strengthened European presence, expansion of services to Ultra High Net Worth (“UHNW”) clients in Asia, Americas, and the Middle East, and a focus on entrepreneurs in Germany and across Europe. Furthermore, PW&CC expects to realize significant synergies to improve efficiency in product offering, digital investment, operations, overhead and support functions. Additionally, it seeks to improve capital efficiency by further strengthening advisory capabilities and less emphasis on capital intensive products.

As part of the creation of PW&CC, we transformed Private & Business Clients (“PBC”) into Private & Commercial Clients (“PCC”) by the separation of Postbank and the planned sale of our stake in Hua Xia Bank. The key components of our strategy relate to our client approach, our international business and our efficiency. PCC aims to sharpen the client strategy in Germany by increasing profitability of Personal Banking with standardized and streamlined processes and services and by emphasizing Private and Commercial Banking. We intend to strengthen PCC´s international business by focusing on affluent as well as SME clients and seeking to reap synergies from regulatory harmonization across the EU and seek to benefit from ongoing macroeconomic recovery. We aim to improve our cost efficiency and reduce complexity via a streamlined head office and management structure, end-to-end process automation and Europe wide centralization of services. In line with the changing behavior of our clients, we aim to sharpen our distribution model by strengthening our omni-channel capabilities with additional investments into our digital offerings and by closing more than 200 branches in Germany.

 

 


Table of Contents
45   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

In the context of Strategy 2020, the Bank decided to deconsolidate Deutsche Postbank. As a first step towards deconsolidation, Deutsche Bank pursued a squeeze out of the minority shareholders acquiring 100 % of Postbank by the end of 2015. In the course of 2016, Deutsche Bank will pursue implementation of the measures that will allow for a separation of Postbank. From the first quarter of 2016 onwards, Postbank will be reported as a separate segment within Deutsche Bank.

Strategy in Global Transaction Banking (GTB)

As a key building block of our Commercial/International Banking proposition, GTB serves corporate and institutional clients globally with solutions around deposit taking, domestic and cross-border payments, trade finance, supply chain finance and securities services (i.e., trust, agency, depositary, custody and related services). GTB is organized along its two main business areas, Trade Finance and Cash Management Corporates (“TF/CMC”) and Institutional Cash and Securities Services (“ICSS”).

Throughout 2015, overall business conditions for GTB continued to remain challenging. A relatively slow economic recovery particularly in Europe, low or even negative interest rate environment, and ongoing margin pressure and increased competition, not least from new entrants such as non banks, acted as headwinds to the business. However, despite these challenges, GTB delivered income before taxes of 1,439 million based on significant customer wins and increasing business volumes, distinct propositions in relation to the European Central Bank’s TARGET2-Securities (“T2S”) settlement engine which went live on June 22, 2015, and client centric solutions across a variety of industry segments, including for FinTech companies. GTB has continued to reduce the proportion of revenues stemming from interest income.

As of January 1, 2016, the GTB business has been combined with our CB&S Corporate Finance business to create the new division Corporate & Investment Banking (“CIB”). Within GTB, the business areas will be organized along three business lines: Trade Finance and Cash Management Corporates (“TF/CMC”), Institutional Cash Management (“ICM”), and Global Securities Services (“GSS”). This is intended to enable us to better serve our clients with our full set of banking products.

Within the new CIB division, GTB remains committed to executing on its strategic priorities: strengthening and deepening relationships with target clients; acquiring new target clients especially in Asia and the US; further building its capabilities to serve mid-cap clients in Germany; continuing its investments in operational excellence; optimizing its business portfolio while maintaining strict cost, risk and capital discipline.

The ongoing efforts of the division have led to Deutsche Bank receiving external recognition from some of the industry’s most respected bodies. The awards GTB received in 2015 include (but are not limited to) “Best Transaction Bank from Europe” (The Banker), “Best International Transaction Bank, Asia Pacific” (The Asian Banker), “Best Cash Manager for Financial Institutions” (Euromoney), “Best Trade Finance Provider” (Euromoney) and ”Global Corporate Trust Services Provider of the Year” (Infrastructure Investor Awards).

Strategy in Deutsche AWM

Deutsche AWM served individual, institutional and intermediary clients worldwide through asset management and wealth management solutions, including a full range of active, passive and alternative investments across all major asset classes, as well as investment solutions, wealth management advisory and private banking services.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       46
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

Throughout 2015, we maintained our position as a top-10 global bank-owned asset and wealth manager (based on invested assets, Pensions & Investments magazine and annual reports), with total invested assets reaching 1.1 trillion. Despite increasingly volatile financial markets and fierce competition, clients entrusted us with 24 billion in net new assets. This has resulted in an income before taxes of 1,250 million. Our strategic investments to serve clients include expanding private banker and wealth advisory teams to serve ultra-high-net-worth individuals (“UHNW”), as well as adding to institutional and intermediary sales coverage teams. We continued to expand our product offerings to address client demand, including launching new ETFs, alternative and active multi-asset funds. In parallel, we further focused the business portfolio through divestment of non-core areas (e.g. India Asset Management; U.S. brokerage-based private client services) and progressing in the full implementation of platform transformation initiatives, such as the BRS Aladdin investment management solution.

As of January 1, 2016 Deutsche AWM has been re-organized into two separate units, each oriented toward serving its clients and delivering growth for the Bank, while leveraging shared operating improvements made in recent years. Deutsche Bank Asset Management (“AM”) has become a new stand-alone business division of Deutsche Bank, while Deutsche Bank Wealth Management (“WM”), as described before, has become a business unit of the newly formed division PW&CC.

In AM, we intend to focus on delivering robust, sustainable investment performance across our funds products and investment solutions, and seek to gain market share globally while maintaining leadership in our home market of Germany. We foresee continued cooperation and connectivity, where appropriate, between AM and WM, as well as across the Bank, in offering solutions to retail and institutional clients.

In WM, we seek to build market share across our regions Germany, EMEA (excluding Germany), Americas and APAC whilst maintaining our focus on our core client segment of (U)HNW clients. We have the aim of delivering top quality products and solutions to our clients globally and providing greater access to offerings across Deutsche Bank, in collaboration with the new Global Markets and Corporate & Investment Banking divisions.

Strategy in the Non-Core Operating Unit (NCOU)

The NCOU was established in 2012 as our fifth corporate division and consists of two major businesses: Wholesale Assets and Operating Assets. Wholesale Assets mainly includes credit correlation trading positions, securitization assets, exposures to monoline insurers, assets reclassified under IAS 39, and assets and liabilities from PBC including Postbank. Operating Assets contains separate operating entities from the former Corporate Investments division (all of which have been transferred into NCOU) and some assets formerly within CB&S and Deutsche AWM. NCOU further contains several legal contingent risks transferred from Deutsche Bank’s core business divisions.

The strategy and mandate of the NCOU continues to be the de-risking of the portfolio which is aligned with the Bank’s overall strategic objectives. NCOU has embarked on an accelerated rundown of its portfolio with the intention to materially complete the wind-down of the division by the end of 2016. The aim is to free up capital by reducing risk-weighted assets and overall balance sheet in order to protect shareholder value by reducing risks from the above mentioned assets, liabilities and business activities.

 

 


Table of Contents
47   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

Our Corporate Divisions

Please see “Management Report: Operating and Financial Review: Deutsche Bank Group: Corporate Divisions” beginning on page 33 of the Annual Report 2015.

The Competitive Environment

Competitor Landscape

After a period earlier in 2015 when economic data appeared to be stabilizing or improving in many countries and the risk of a negative macro scenario and diminishing global growth appeared to be receding, developments late in the year 2015, as well as developments since the start of the new year, have caused these concerns to resurface, and markets, including equity markets in particular, have moved sharply downward. Eurozone data confirmed that the economy continued to grow at about its trend rate during much of 2015, propelled by real income gains provided by falling oil prices. Despite what appeared to be an improving growth background at the time, the European Central Bank (“ECB”) cut the deposit rate to -0.30 per cent in December 2015 and announced an extension of the asset purchase program until March 2017 or beyond if inflation and inflation expectations do not materially improve. The economic outlook has dimmed somewhat since the start of the year largely in the face of political concerns and concerns about the global outlook, however, and thus the ECB will probably make its monetary policy even more expansionary in the course of the year. Similarly, the Bank of England surprised by pivoting toward a more dovish policy stance. In the U.S., meanwhile, strong labour market data finally prompted the Federal Reserve to end seven years of zero interest rates by increasing the Fed Funds target rate by 0.25 percentage points in December. Since then, however, U.S. data have been mixed, pointing towards a somewhat weaker winter half and causing the Federal Reserve once again to question the wisdom of further monetary tightening in the near term. Moreover, we now expect a lower trend growth rate in the U.S. for the coming years. While in the past falling oil prices were overwhelmingly positive for the U.S. economy, U.S. production levels given the “fracking” boom, and the economics of this business, have largely broken this historical relationship. In Emerging Markets, growth remains weak; while it appears to be bottoming out in some economies, others, particularly those for which oil exports are critical to the economy, may not yet be reaching their nadir. Political uncertainty is also taking an increasing toll in Emerging Markets. In China, prospects remain uncertain and prognostication difficult. While some leading indicators are still compatible with a modest improvement in near-term growth, others are less optimistic, and perceived risks to the Chinese growth rate over the medium term is heavily pressuring commodities markets worldwide. While China is supporting its economy with more expansionary monetary and fiscal policies, looser policy is placing pressure on the currency and structural problems are likely to slow down the intended shift towards domestic demand driven growth and the health of the financial sector remains open to question. Monetary policy in China will probably become more expansive in order to bolster the economy. In Japan, fiscal measures and the ongoing extremely expansionary monetary policy (“Abenomics”) are supporting growth, while weak external demand has impacted negatively.

Focus across the industry in 2013 and 2014 was on strengthening capital ratios via capital raising, restructuring and retrenchment from capital intensive businesses. The focus in 2015 has been concentrated on resolving legal matters, responding to continued regulatory requirements and operational efficiency improvements. Despite unrelenting pressure on interest margins, total revenues are expanding. At the same time, asset quality is improving and industry profits are rising. Looking forward, however, the banking sector will continue to be challenged from the ongoing regulatory uncertainty and the risks to the growth of the global economy.

Deutsche Bank’s core competitors include other universal banks, commercial banks, savings banks, public sector banks, brokers and dealers, investment banking firms, asset management firms, private banks, investment advisors, payments services providers, and insurance companies. We compete with some of our competitors globally and with some others on a regional, product, or niche basis. We compete on the basis of a number of factors, including the quality of client relationships, transaction execution, our products and services, innovation, reputation and price.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       48
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

An emerging group of future competitors in the form of start-ups and technology firms are showing an increasing interest in banking services and products. We see potential for disruption from these new competitors in both core products, e.g., payments, basic accounts and loans and investment advisory, as well as in new products, e.g. peer to peer lending and equity crowd funding. Significant investment is ongoing across the banking industry to keep pace with technological advances and meet changing client needs.

In our home market, Germany, the retail banking market remains fragmented and our competitive environment is influenced by the three pillar system of private banks, public banks and cooperative banks. Competitive intensity has increased in recent years following some consolidation activity, particularly among public regional commercial banks (“Landesbanken”) and private banks, and increased activity levels from foreign players.

Regulatory Reform

In the past year, key areas of the post-financial crisis G20 regulatory agenda – strengthening international standards to create financially resilient institutions and ensuring resolvability of all banks – have continued to evolve with final rules becoming clearer.

Elements of the core Basel 3 capital adequacy, liquidity and leverage requirements have been implemented or further defined. In the European Union, the Capital Requirements Regulation and the Capital Requirements Directive (“CRR/CRD 4”) implementing the Basel 3 framework became effective on January 1, 2014, with some of the requirements, such as capital buffers, being phased in through 2019. Other requirements, such as a binding leverage ratio, still need to be finalized and formally implemented. In the United States, the U.S. implementation of the Basel 3 framework took effect on January 1, 2015 for Deutsche Bank Trust Corporation (“DBTC”), our U.S. bank holding company subsidiary. Beginning July 1, 2016, the U.S. Basel 3 framework and the related capital planning and stress testing requirements will apply to all of our U.S. non-branch operations – that is, excluding Deutsche Bank AG New York Branch.

2015 also saw progress in the regulation of the securities and derivatives markets. Given the global nature of these markets, a continuing key issue is the global cooperation and coordination of regulation and supervision. 2015 saw consultations at the European Union level on margining requirements, clearing rules and similar regulations in the U.S. as well as across Asia-Pacific. By the end of 2016, we expect the full implementation of clearing requirements and commencement of margin requirements in the European Union. Another key area of work in 2016 will be around the recovery and resolution of central counterparties (“CCPs”) – particularly in the European Union and in the U.S.

In connection with the structural reform of banks, 2015 saw further regulatory developments. In Germany, we have been granted a one year extension by the German Federal Financial Supervisory Authority (Bundesanstalt für Finanzdienstleistungsaufsicht, “BaFin”) for implementing the required cessation or separation of proprietary trading that does not constitute a service for others, high frequency trading (with the exception of market making), and credit or guarantee transactions with hedge funds and comparable enterprises, also in order to allow for possible alignment with expected European Union legislation. In Europe, political negotiations on European Union legislation covering the prohibition of proprietary trading and separation of risk trading activities are ongoing. A final text is not expected before the second half of 2016 with a minimum implementation period of two years. In the U.S., DBTC also participated for the first time in the Federal Reserve Board’s Comprehensive Capital Adequacy Review (“CCAR”) process, an annual capital planning and stress testing exercise. Additionally, the U.S. Volker Rule conformance date was reached in July 2015 (subject to an extension for certain legacy covered funds), in response to which we have implemented a comprehensive compliance program.

Importantly, in 2015 we continued to be subject to the Single Supervisory Mechanism (“SSM”), the new prudential supervisory regime in the eurozone led by the European Central Bank. We are cooperating closely with the ECB and the competent national supervisory authorities participating in the SSM. 2015 saw significant progress in adapting internal processes to meet the demands of such authorities. The advent of the ECB as competent authority for prudential supervision of large banks domiciled in the eurozone and other participating European Union member states is

 

 


Table of Contents
49   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

expected to enhance consistency of supervisory standards and transparency in the future, and we continue to participate in corresponding efforts such as reducing existing options and discretions under European Union legislation.

At the international level, in October 2014 the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (“BCBS”) published its final standards for the Net Stable Funding Ratio (“NSFR”). In December 2014, the BCBS finalized changes to the capital standards for securitization exposures held in the banking book. Subject to potential modifications in the legislative process, the NSFR and the new securitization standards are expected to be implemented and take effect by January 1, 2018. In addition, in January 2016, the BCBS completed its fundamental review of the trading book and published a corresponding final standard on the minimum capital requirements for market risk. We expect that European Union and U.S. authorities will propose rules implementing this new market risk standard in 2016 or 2017. Finally, in December 2015 the BCBS also proposed changes to the standardized approaches for credit risk that would generally increase the use of standardized assumptions to promote comparability across banks and jurisdictions. In 2016, the BCBS is expected to publish further proposals on the standardized approach for operational risk as well as a capital floor. We expect the BCBS to publish final standards on the standardized approaches for credit and operational risk, as well as on capital floors, in late 2016 or in 2017. While the expected impacts on capital requirements of the proposed new standardized approaches have been factored into our Strategy 2020 projections and objectives, their ultimate impact on us will depend on how they are implemented through binding legislation and regulation.

Other key post-crisis reforms, while agreed in final standards and, in many cases, primary legislation, are still at an early stage of their phase-in or implementation, particularly where regulators have yet to develop detailed rules and regulations or determine their cross-border application. Thus, the impact of the implementation of such final standards and primary legislation on specific institutions remains uncertain. Examples of such post-crisis reforms include:

 

 

Legislation for OTC derivatives clearing, reporting and margining has been enacted in the European Union and U.S. and some requirements are already in effect. By the end of 2016, clearing mandates in the European Union are expected to be fully implemented, and margin rules will be phased-in starting September 2016. While trade reporting has begun, phase-in of mandatory European Union clearing obligations is not expected to begin until June 2016 and relief from transaction-level requirements for swaps between non-U.S. swap dealers and non-U.S. persons has been extended until September 30, 2016. In addition, on February 10, 2016, the European Commission and the U.S. Commodity Futures Trading Commission (“CFTC”) announced a common approach to facilitate the cross-border recognition of CCPs. Margin requirements for non-cleared derivatives have been adopted in the U.S. and will phase in from September 2016 to September 2020. Similar requirements and timelines are expected in the European Union. We can expect the cost of trading OTC derivatives across the market to increase as a result of the margin requirements as well as a rise in demand for high quality collateral.

 

Updated European Union rules for market structure, pre- and post-trade transparency for equities, fixed income, currency and commodities transactions, investor protection, market abuse and sanctions through the Markets in Financial Instruments Directive (“MiFID 2”) and Regulation (“MiFIR”) and the Market Abuse Directive (“MAD 2”) and Regulation (“MAR”). MiFID 2/MiFIR will also introduce a trading obligation for those OTC derivatives which are subject to mandatory clearing and which are sufficiently standardized and liquid. Originally, most requirements introduced by MiFID 2/MiFIR and MAD 2/MAR were foreseen to be applicable to us starting on January 3, 2017 or July 3, 2016, respectively. On February 10, 2016, however, the European Commission published proposals to delay the application of MiFID 2/MiFIR by one year to January 3, 2018. This needs now to be agreed by the bodies of the European Union through the co-decision process. MiFID 2 and MAD 2 need yet to be transposed into national law, and the European Securities and Markets Authority (“ESMA”) and the European Commission have yet to finalize many of the required implementing regulations. Depending on the detailed rules being developed, the updated MiFID 2/MiFIR could have a substantial impact on the way we trade with clients, transparency requirements, the willingness to deploy our risk capital, and the way we distribute products.

 

Bank structural reforms requiring either separation of certain business activities or the creation of independently organized and capitalized subsidiaries continue to be discussed. In Germany, the end date for the cessation or separation of proprietary trading and certain other activities from deposit-taking under the German Act on the Separation of Risks and Recovery and Resolution Planning for Credit Institutions and Banking Groups (the “Separation Act”) has been extended for us by the BaFin to June 30, 2017. In the U.S., Federal Reserve Board final rules on enhanced prudential standards for the U.S. operations of foreign banking organizations require us to establish or

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       50
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

   

designate a U.S. intermediate holding company (“IHC”) by July 1, 2016 and transfer the ownership interests of substantially all of our U.S. subsidiaries to this U.S. intermediate holding company. Work is ongoing to ensure compliance with these rules and a fully operating IHC by the middle of the year. As of July 21, 2015, our activities must be in conformance with the prohibitions and restrictions of the regulations implementing Section 619 of the U.S. Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act of 2010, commonly referred to as the ‘Volcker Rule’, except for certain extensions for legacy funds which are expected to last until July 21, 2017 and possible further extensions for illiquid funds.

 

Capital planning and stress testing will continue to be a focus in 2016. In 2015, DBTC submitted its first capital plan and related information to the Federal Reserve Board in connection with the 2015 CCAR process. Although the Federal Reserve Board objected to DBTC’s capital plan on qualitative grounds, the Federal Reserve Board confirmed that DBTC’s capital ratios would significantly exceed the quantitative minimum requirements even under the supervisor’s hypothetical severely adverse economic stress scenario. We will be incorporating enhancements to our processes as we submit our 2016 CCAR filings for DBTC. At the international level, the BCBS has started working on global standards for stress testing as part of its work-plan.

 

Recovery and resolution – the major jurisdictions where we have significant group operations finalized implementation of the Financial Stability Board (“FSB“) Key Attributes for Effective Resolution Regimes. In particular, the European Union Bank Recovery and Resolution Directive (“BRRD”) was implemented in Germany and in the United Kingdom on January 1, 2015. The BRRD includes powers of the resolution authority to require legal and operational changes to bank structures to ensure resolvability, to transfer to another legal entity shares, assets, rights or liabilities of a bank which is failing or likely to fail, to reduce, including to reduce to zero, the nominal amount of shares, and to cancel shares. Furthermore, it may order the full or partial write-down of hybrid capital instruments and certain eligible liabilities or their conversion into shares (commonly referred to as “bail-in”). In addition, in January 2016, the European Union regulation (the “SRM Regulation”) establishing the Single Resolution Mechanism (“SRM“) and the Single Resolution Fund for banks domiciled in European Union member states participating in the SSM became fully effective and created a harmonized mechanism for the application of the BRRD under responsibility of a single European resolution authority (referred to as the Single Resolution Board or “SRB”). With the aim of ensuring cross-border group resolution of globally active banks, the BRRD and the SRM Regulation also contain rules regarding the cooperation with non-European Union member states and recognition of non-European Union resolution proceedings.

 

Loss-absorbing capacity and MREL – the FSB published a final term-sheet in November 2015 providing a global framework for minimum total loss-absorbing capacity (“TLAC”). The standard is designed to ensure that global systemically important banks (“G-SIBs”), such as us, maintain enough capital and long-term debt instruments that can be effectively bailed-in to absorb losses and recapitalize the bank. The TLAC standard is proposed to apply starting from January 1, 2019, and its ultimate impact on us will depend on how it is implemented into German law and into the laws of the countries in which we have significant subsidiaries. On October 30, 2015, the Federal Reserve Board proposed rules implementing the TLAC standard in the United States, with requirements that would apply to the U.S. IHCs of non-U.S. G-SIBs (such as ours). In addition, in the European Union, the SRM Regulation and national legislation implementing the BRRD require banks to meet a specific requirement for own funds and eligible liabilities (“MREL”) in order to prevent them from structuring their liabilities in a way that impedes the effectiveness of a bail-in or other resolution tools. The minimum MREL requirement will be determined for banks on a case-by-case basis by the competent resolution authorities, and the European Union is expected to review implementation of MREL in October 2016 in connection with implementation of the TLAC standard into European Union law. We expect that a specific MREL requirement will be determined for us in the course of 2016. Furthermore, in November 2015, the German Resolution Mechanism Act (Abwicklungsmechanismusgesetz) was published, which adapted German bank resolution laws to the SRM and changed the ranking in insolvency of certain senior unsecured debt instruments issued by banks in order to ensure that they would absorb losses after contractually subordinated debt but ahead of other senior liabilities in a resolution or insolvency proceeding. This new order of priority applies to insolvency proceedings commenced, and resolution measures imposed upon the relevant bank, on or after January 1, 2017, with effect for senior unsecured debt instruments outstanding at this time. The German Resolution Mechanism Act aims to facilitate bail-in while respecting the principle that no creditor should be worse off than in insolvency and also help meeting TLAC requirements.

 

Measures to further harmonize legislation in the European Union, including revised European Union legislation on anti-money laundering, payment services and distribution of bank products.

 

 


Table of Contents
51   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

Several regulatory proposals (including in connection with the implementation of existing laws) as discussed below are being contemplated which have not yet been finalized. Such proposals, depending on whether and in what form they become law, might have a material impact on our activities, balance sheet and profitability. To the extent possible, the impact of such proposals on us has been taken into account in our Strategy 2020 projections and objectives. The proposals include:

 

 

Further revisions to the Basel 3 framework, in particular several BCBS proposals that have yet to be finalized and implemented, including the proposed changes to the standardized approaches mentioned above, new rules for interest rate in the banking book and Credit Valuation Adjustments. On April 15, 2014, the BCBS published a standard, yet to be implemented, that would restrict a bank’s exposures to a single counterparty to 25 % of its Tier 1 capital (instead of 25 % of the sum of its Tier 1 and Tier 2 capital) and further limit exposures between banks designated as “global systemically important banks” such as us, to 15 % of Tier 1 capital. The proposal, if implemented, would be applicable starting on January 1, 2019. Additionally, certain areas are subject to ongoing review and revision, such as the calibration of the leverage ratio, capitalization for exposures to central counterparties and treatment of sovereign debt.

 

Further structural changes, as a result of the separation of certain business activities considered risky under the proposed European Union regulation on structural measures improving the resilience of European Union credit institutions or as a result of changes in the bank organization potentially required by the Single Resolution Board to ensure resolvability.

 

Additional direct costs as a result of financial sector specific tax and levies, for example the European Union enhanced cooperation financial transaction tax, which is still under negotiation, and contributions to the Single Resolution Fund, which starts from January 1, 2016. Legislation to increase contributions to statutory deposit guarantee schemes was also implemented in the European Union and a new proposal to create a eurozone deposit insurance system has been published by the European Commission.

 

Additional regulation of specific financial market activities, such as money market funds, benchmarks and indices, and securities financing transactions. Possible future proposals on capital markets, including investment funds, financial market infrastructures, and other proposals addressing so-called shadow banking activities may also impact us.

 

Cyber crime, which continued to be a focus of policy makers and the industry in 2015. Political work on this topic will likely continue in 2016 and beyond to seek a consistent regulatory and best-practice framework globally. Global banks are a key focus for future political initiatives on the prevention of cyber crime and legislative proposals in this area may have a material impact on us.

 

Further measures to harmonize banking regulation and supervision in the European Union – such as initiatives by the EBA and the ECB to reduce existing options and discretions and harmonize national supervisory practices under European Union legislation in connection with the CRR/CRD 4 legislative package.

Climate change, environmental and social issues

Many governments, corporations and investors are extending their focus on climate change, environmental and social issues by enacting legislation, changing business models, setting business operational policies and changing investment decision making. This activity has been accelerating in the lead up to the publication of the revised United Nation’s Sustainable Development Goals and the COP 21 Paris climate summit in December 2015. Respected authorities continue to estimate that the total impact of these actions will be insufficient to reduce the risks of climate change, increasing the risks to society and the economy from more frequent and stronger extreme weather events. However, at COP 21 in December 2015, the UN achieved a global agreement on climate, with the aim of keeping global warming below 2°C and accelerating the transformational changes needed to meet the challenge. This requires public and private sectors working together to achieve a common goal. The financial sector has a critical role to play in creating the financial infrastructure needed to facilitate the transition to a low-carbon economy.

The number and strength of government, corporate and investor actions are expected to continue to increase over time as climate change has a greater impact on society. This affects the financial services industry, in particular in connection to increasing demand for financing of projects that contribute to or mitigate climate change, as well as other environmental and societal impacts. Projects and products that contribute to climate change or have other negative

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       52
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

environmental or social impacts, as well as their financing and other services for these projects, are being reviewed more critically by investors, customers, environmental authorities, non-governmental organizations and others. At Deutsche Bank such a review is conducted based on the Environmental and Social Risk Framework. Where our own assessment of these issues so indicates, we may abstain from participating in such projects.

By contrast, projects and products that aim to mitigate climate change or other environmental pressures are increasingly seeking financing and other financial services; these offer growth opportunities for many of our businesses. Research indicates that companies incorporating the best environmental, social and governance practices are able to raise capital at a lower cost and may be able to achieve superior risk-adjusted returns. Moreover, we note that investors, customers and others increasingly take the overall approach of companies to climate change, including the direct and indirect carbon emissions of their operations, into consideration in their decisions.

We have undertaken a number of measures to reduce the carbon emissions of our business operations. Since 2012 our business operations have been carbon neutral. In 2015 we became the first commercial bank to become accredited to act as implementing entity for the UN Green Climate Fund, alongside public institutions such as the World Bank, European Bank for Reconstruction and Development and Inter-American Development Bank. In addition, we invested 800 million into a portfolio of high quality Green Bonds, as part of our goal of investing 1 billion into this developing market. This investment will be primarily in Green Bonds issued by Sovereigns, Supranationals and Agencies, as part of our liquidity reserve investments.

Regulation and Supervision

Overview

Our operations throughout the world are regulated and supervised by the relevant authorities in each of the jurisdictions where we conduct business. Such regulation relates to licensing, capital adequacy, liquidity, risk concentration, conduct of business as well as organizational and reporting requirements. It affects the type and scope of the business we conduct in a country and how we structure specific operations. In reaction to the crisis in the financial markets, the regulatory environment has undergone and is still undergoing significant changes.

In December 2010, the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision proposed revised minimum capital adequacy and liquidity standards that were significantly more stringent than the then-existing requirements. The set of comprehensive changes to the capital adequacy framework published by the Basel Committee, known as Basel 3, was implemented into European Union law by a legislative package referred to as “CRR/CRD 4”. The CRR/CRD 4 legislative package includes a European Union regulation (which is referred to as the Capital Requirements Regulation or “CRR”) which is directly enforceable as law in every member state of the European Union, and a European Union directive (which is referred to as the Capital Requirements Directive or “CRD 4”), which has been implemented into national (in our case German) law. CRR/CRD 4 contains, among other things, detailed rules on regulatory banking capital, increased capital requirements and the introduction of additional capital buffers, tightened liquidity standards and a non-risk based leverage ratio. Most of the new rules came into effect on January 1, 2014, with capital requirements and buffers increasing from year to year.

In addition to the continued implementation and refinement of the CRR/CRD 4 legislative package, the European Union is pursuing a deeper integration and harmonization of banking regulation and supervision by establishing a banking union. Currently, the banking union consists of two pillars, the Single Supervisory Mechanism (“SSM”) and the Single Resolution Mechanism (“SRM”) for banks domiciled in the eurozone as well as those domiciled in other member states of the European Union member states that decide to participate in the SSM and the SRM. The banking union shall be completed by a third pillar, a common European Deposit Insurance Scheme (“EDIS”), and is underpinned by an increasingly harmonized regulatory framework (the so-called “single rulebook”) for financial services in the European Union. While the SSM and the SRM have already become effective, the EDIS is currently debated among member states, based upon a proposal of the European Commission published on November 24, 2015.

 

 


Table of Contents
53   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

Under the SSM, since November 4, 2014, the European Central Bank (“ECB”) has become the primary supervisor of “significant” credit institutions (such as us) and their banking affiliates in the relevant member states. The competent national authorities continue to supervise the remaining, “less significant” banks under the oversight of the ECB. The SSM is based on a European Union regulation (which is referred to as the SSM Regulation) which is directly enforceable as law in every participating member state.

The SRM, which came into force on January 1, 2016, centralizes at a European level the key competences and resources for managing the failure of any bank in the participating member states. Under the SRM, broad resolution powers with respect to banks domiciled in the participating member states have been granted to the Single Resolution Board (“SRB”) as the single European resolution authority and to the competent national resolution authorities. Resolution powers in particular include the power to reduce, including to zero, the nominal value of shares, or to cancel shares outright, and to write down certain eligible unsecured liabilities, including to zero, or convert them into equity (commonly referred to as “bail-in”). The SRB is also in charge of the Single Resolution Fund (“SRF”), a pool of money financed by the banking sector which is set up to ensure that medium-term funding support is available for purposes of restructuring banks under the SRM. The SRM comprises a European Union regulation (referred to as the SRM Regulation) which is directly enforceable as law in every participating member state and a European Union directive (referred to as the Bank Recovery and Resolution Directive or “BRRD”) which has been implemented into national (in our case German) law. The BRRD is also applicable to member states that do not participate in the SRM.

In February 2012, the European Commission established a High-level Expert Group chaired by Erkki Liikanen to examine possible reforms to the structure of the European Union’s banking sector. In its final report of October 2, 2012 (the so-called “Liikanen report”), the expert group proposed, inter alia, a legal separation of certain particularly risky financial activities from deposit-taking banks within a banking group. Taking into account the recommendations of the Liikanen report, the German Federal Parliament, in 2013, adopted the German Act on the Separation of Risks and Recovery and Resolution Planning for Credit Institutions and Banking Groups (Trennbankengesetz, the “Separation Act”). From July 1, 2016 (unless such period is extended, as it has been for us, to June 30, 2017), the Separation Act prohibits deposit-taking banks and their affiliates from engaging in certain activities unless these activities are transferred to a separate legal entity as further describe below. Also based upon the Liikanen report, the European Commission published on January 29, 2014 a proposal which, if enacted, will impose measures similar to the Separation Act. The proposal is currently being negotiated at the European level and its ultimate impact on us will depend on the outcome of such negotiations.

Finally, as discussed below under “Regulation and Supervision in the United States”, in July 2013 U.S. federal bank regulators issued final rules implementing many elements of the Basel 3 framework and other U.S. capital reforms.

Further changes continue to be under consideration in the jurisdictions in which we operate. While the extent and nature of these changes cannot be predicted now, they may include a further increase in regulatory oversight and enhanced prudential standards relating to capital, liquidity, leverage, employee compensation, conduct of business, limitations on activities and other aspects of our operations that may have a material effect on the businesses and the services and products that we will be able to offer.

The following sections present a description of the supervision of our business by the authorities in Germany, our home market, in the contracting states to the European Economic Area, and in the U.S., which we view as the most significant for us. Beyond these regions, local country regulations generally have limited impact on our operations that are unconnected with these countries.

Regulation and Supervision in Germany – Basic Principles

We are authorized to conduct banking business and to provide financial services as set forth in the German Banking Act (Kreditwesengesetz) and the CRR. We are subject to comprehensive regulation and supervision by the ECB, the German Federal Financial Supervisory Authority (Bundesanstalt für Finanzdienstleistungsaufsicht, “BaFin“) and the Deutsche Bundesbank (“Bundesbank”), the German central bank.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       54
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

Since November 4, 2014, we are directly supervised by the ECB, which is the primary supervisor of “significant” credit institutions and their banking affiliates domiciled in the eurozone as well as those domiciled in other member states of the European Union that decide to participate in the SSM. The ECB is responsible for issuing new licenses to credit institutions and for assessing significant ownership changes in credit institutions established in a participating member state where notice of such changes must be provided, in each case regardless of whether an institution is significant or not. With respect to us and other “significant” credit institutions, the ECB is the primary supervisor and is responsible for most tasks of prudential supervision, such as those regarding compliance with regulatory requirements set forth in CRR/CRD 4 concerning own funds, large exposure limits, leverage, liquidity, securitizations, governance and risk management requirements. The ECB carries out its supervisory functions through a Joint Supervisory Team (“JST”) established for the Group. The JST is led by the ECB and comprises staff from the ECB and national supervisory authorities, including the BaFin and the Bundesbank.

The BaFin continues to be our supervisor for regulatory matters with respect to which we are not supervised by the ECB. These include the rules on business conduct in the securities markets and the regulation of anti-money laundering, terrorist financing and payment services, as well as certain special areas of bank regulation, such as those related to the issuance of covered bonds (Pfandbriefe) and the supervision of German home loan banks (Bausparkassen). Generally, the BaFin also continues to supervise us with respect to those requirements under the German Banking Act that are not based upon European law. The Bundesbank supports the BaFin and the ECB and closely cooperates with them. The cooperation includes the ongoing review and evaluation of reports submitted by us and of our audit reports as well as assessments of the adequacy of our capital base and risk management systems. The ECB, the BaFin and the Bundesbank receive comprehensive information from us in order to monitor our compliance with applicable legal requirements and to obtain information on our financial condition. Generally, supervision by the ECB (together with the BaFin and the Bundesbank) applies on an unconsolidated basis (company only) and on a consolidated basis (the company and the entities consolidated with it for German regulatory purposes). Banks forming part of a consolidated group may waive the application of capital adequacy requirements, large exposure limits and certain organizational requirements on an unconsolidated basis if certain conditions are met. Deutsche Bank AG meets these conditions and has had application of these rules waived since January 1, 2007.

The ECB and the BaFin have extensive supervisory and investigatory powers, including the ability to issue requests for information, to conduct regulatory investigations and on-site inspections, and to impose monetary and other sanctions.

We are in compliance with the German and European laws that are applicable to our business in all material respects.

The German Banking Act and the CRR

The German Banking Act and the CRR contain the principal rules for German banks, including the requirements for a banking license, and regulate the business activities of German banks. In particular, the German Banking Act requires that an enterprise that engages in one or more of the activities defined in the German Banking Act as “banking business” or “financial services” in Germany must be licensed as a “credit institution” (Kreditinstitut) or “financial services institution” (Finanzdienstleistungsinstitut), as the case may be. Deutsche Bank AG is licensed as a credit institution.

Significant parts of the regulatory framework for banks in the European Union are governed by the CRR. The CRR primarily sets forth the requirements applicable to us relating to regulatory capital, risk-based capital adequacy, monitoring and control of large exposures, consolidated supervision, leverage and liquidity. Additional regulatory and implementing technical standards are also applicable to us, and are developed by the European Banking Authority (“EBA”) and adopted by the European Commission. Certain other requirements applicable to us including those with respect to additional capital and organizational requirements, are set forth in the German Banking Act and other German laws.

The German Securities Trading Act

Under the German Securities Trading Act (Wertpapierhandelsgesetz), the BaFin regulates and supervises securities trading in Germany. The German Securities Trading Act contains, among other things, disclosure and transparency rules for issuers of securities that are listed on a German exchange and prohibits insider trading with respect to certain

 

 


Table of Contents
55   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

listed securities. The German Securities Trading Act also contains rules of conduct. These rules of conduct apply to all businesses that provide securities services. Securities services include, in particular, the purchase and sale of securities or derivatives for others and the intermediation of transactions in securities or derivatives and certain types of investment advice. The BaFin has broad powers to investigate businesses providing securities services to monitor their compliance with the rules of conduct and the reporting requirements. In addition, the German Securities Trading Act requires an independent auditor to perform an annual audit of the securities services provider’s compliance with its obligations under the German Securities Trading Act.

The European Union has completed several legislative proposals which result in further regulation of securities trading and the trading in derivatives in particular. Notably, the European Union adopted the European Regulation on OTC Derivatives, Central Counterparties and Trade Repositories (“EMIR”), which became effective on August 16, 2012. EMIR introduced requirements for standardized over-the-counter derivatives to be centrally cleared and derivative transactions to be reported to trade repositories. EMIR also includes additional capital and margin requirements for non-cleared trades. While a number of the compliance requirements introduced by EMIR have come into effect, the European Supervisory Authorities (mainly the European Securities and Markets Authority) are still in the process of finalizing certain implementing rules mandated by EMIR. Further legislative measures such as the Markets in Financial Instruments Directive (“MiFID 2”) and Regulation (“MiFIR”) and the Market Abuse Directive (“MAD 2”) and Regulation (“MAR”) provide for, among other things, greater regulation and oversight by covering additional markets and instruments, extension of pre- and post-trade transparency rules from equities to all financial instruments, stricter market abuse rules, greater restrictions on operating trading platforms, and greater sanctioning powers. MiFID 2/MiFIR will also introduce a trading obligation for those OTC derivatives which are subject to mandatory clearing and which are sufficiently standardized, and new investor protection rules which will significantly impact the way we distribute products. Originally, most of the requirements introduced by MiFID 2/MiFIR and MAD 2/MAR were foreseen to be applicable to us starting on January 3, 2017 or July 3, 2016, respectively. On February 10, 2016, however, the European Commission published proposals to delay the application of MiFID 2/MiFIR by one year to January 3, 2018. This needs now to be agreed by the bodies of the European Union through the co-decision process. MiFID 2 and MAD 2 need yet to be transposed into national law, and the European Securities and Markets Authority (“ESMA”) and the European Commission have yet to finalize several related implementing regulations.

Capital Adequacy Requirements

Since January 1, 2014, the minimum capital adequacy requirements for banks are primarily set forth in the CRR. The CRR requires German banks to maintain an adequate level of regulatory capital in relation to their risk positions. Risk positions (commonly referred to as “risk-weighted assets”) include credit risks, market risks and operational risks (including, among other things, risks related to certain external factors, as well as to technical errors and errors of employees). The most important type of capital for compliance with the capital requirements under the CRR (see below) is “Common Equity Tier 1” capital. Common Equity Tier 1 capital primarily consists of share capital, retained earnings and other reserves, subject to certain regulatory adjustments. Another component of capital is "Additional Tier 1” capital. Generally, all instruments recognized as Additional Tier 1 capital must be written down, or converted into Common Equity Tier 1 capital when the Common Equity Tier 1 capital ratio of the financial institution falls below a minimum of 5.125 %, although regulators may require an earlier conversion, for example for stress-testing purposes. Common Equity Tier 1 capital and Additional Tier 1 capital together constitute Tier 1 capital. Tier 1 capital requirements are aimed at ensuring the ability to absorb losses on a “going concern” basis. The other type of capital is “Tier 2” capital which generally consists of long-term subordinated debt instruments and must be able to absorb losses on a “gone concern” basis. Tier 1 capital and Tier 2 capital together constitute “own funds”. Pursuant to the CRR, hybrid capital instruments that qualified as Tier 1 or Tier 2 capital under Basel 2.5 cease to qualify as such and will be gradually phased out through the end of 2021. Tier 3 capital is no longer recognized as own funds under the CRR. In addition, the CRR tightened the regime for certain deductions from capital.

Under the CRR, banks are required to maintain a minimum ratio of Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets of 6 % and a minimum ratio of Common Equity Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets of 4.5 %. The minimum total capital ratio of own funds to risk-weighted assets is 8 %.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       56
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

The German Banking Act, as amended by the CRR/CRD 4 legislative package, also requires banks to build up a mandatory capital conservation buffer (Common Equity Tier 1 capital amounting to 2.5 % of risk-weighted assets), and authorizes the BaFin to require banks to build up an additional counter-cyclical buffer (Common Equity Tier 1 capital of generally 0 % to 2.5 % of risk-weighted assets, or more in particular circumstances) during periods of high credit growth. In addition, the BaFin may require banks to build up a systemic risk buffer (Common Equity Tier 1 capital of between 1 % and 3 % of risk-weighted assets for all exposures and – in exceptional cases – up to 5 % for domestic and third-country exposures) to prevent and mitigate long term non-cyclical systemic or macro-prudential risks not otherwise covered by CRR/CRD 4. Global systemically important banks (such as us) will be subject to an additional capital buffer of between 1 % and 3.5 % of risk-weighted assets which will be determined for the banks concerned based on a scoring system measuring their systemic importance. The provisions in the German Banking Act on capital buffers (except those for the systemic risk buffer, which are already fully effective) are being phased in gradually through January 1, 2019. The systemic risk buffer and buffers for systemically important banks will generally not be cumulative; only the higher of these two buffers will apply. If a bank fails to build up the required capital buffers, it will be subject to restrictions on the pay-out of dividends, share buybacks and discretionary compensation payments. The ECB may require us to maintain higher capital buffers than those required by the BaFin.

The Basel 3 framework also proposes a non-risk based leverage ratio as a complement to the risk-based capital requirements. While the CRR does not require banks immediately to comply with a specific leverage ratio, banks are required to report and publish their leverage ratios for a future assessment and calibration of the leverage ratio. According to a delegated act adopted by the European Commission on October 10, 2014, the way we calculate our exposure measure for the leverage ratio under the CRR was revised significantly. It is expected that banks will be required to fully comply with the leverage ratio starting in 2018.

The ECB may also, under certain circumstances, impose capital requirements on individual banks which are more stringent than the statutory requirements set forth in the CRR, the German Banking Act or the related regulations. In this context, in December 2014, the EBA published its final guidelines for common procedures and methodologies for the supervisory review and evaluation process (“SREP”). Competent supervisory authorities, including the ECB, are required to review the arrangements, strategies, processes and mechanisms of supervised banks on a regular basis, in order to evaluate risks to which they are or might be exposed, risks they could pose to the financial system, and risks revealed by stress testing, taking into account the nature, scale and complexity of their activities. At the end of the process, the competent supervisory authority prepares an SREP decision setting out, depending on the outcome of the SREP, specific capital and liquidity requirements for the supervised bank. In addition, also based on the outcome of the SREP, the competent supervisory authority may take a range of other measures in response to shortcomings in a bank’s governance and risk management processes as well as its capital or liquidity position, such as prohibiting dividend payments to shareholders or distributions to holders of regulatory capital instruments.

For details of Deutsche Bank’s regulatory capital, see “Management Report: Risk Report: Regulatory Capital” on pages 125 through 131 of our Annual Report 2015.

Limitations on Large Exposures

The CRR also contains the primary restrictions on large exposures, which limit a bank’s concentration of credit risks. The German Banking Act and the Large Exposure Regulation (Großkredit- und Millionenkreditverordnung) supplement the CRR. For example, the Large Exposure Regulation includes exemptions (in addition to those contained in the CRR) from the applicability of limits to large exposures. Under the CRR, our exposure to a customer (and any customers affiliated with it) is deemed to be a “large exposure” when the value of such exposure is equal to or exceeds 10 % of our “eligible regulatory capital”. All exposures to a single customer (and customers affiliated with it) are aggregated for these purposes. In general, no large exposure may exceed 25 % of our eligible regulatory capital. “Eligible regulatory capital” for this purpose means the sum of Tier 1 capital and Tier 2 capital which may not exceed one third of Tier 1 capital. During a transitional period, eligible regulatory capital may include Tier 2 capital up to 50 % of Tier 1 capital during 2016. If the customer is a credit institution or investment firm, the exposure is limited to the higher of 25 % of our eligible regulatory capital or  150 million. Competent authorities may set a lower limit than  150 million. On April 15, 2014, the Basel Committee published a standard, yet to be implemented, that would restrict a bank’s exposures to a

 

 


Table of Contents
57   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

single counterparty to 25 % of its Tier 1 capital (instead of 25 % of the sum of its Tier 1 and Tier 2 capital) and further limit exposures between banks designated as “global systemically important banks” such as us, to 15 % of Tier 1 capital. The proposal, if implemented, would be applicable starting on January 1, 2019.

Under certain conditions, the limits to large exposures may be exceeded by the exposures on the bank’s trading book. In this case, the bank must meet an additional own funds requirement.

Consolidated Regulation and Supervision

Deutsche Bank AG, headquartered in Frankfurt am Main, Germany, is the parent institution of the Deutsche Bank Group of institutions (the “regulatory group”), which is subject to the supervisory provisions of the KWG and the CRR. A regulatory group of institutions (Institutsgruppe) consists of an institution (meaning a credit institution or an investment firm within the meaning of the CRR that is responsible for the consolidation of the group) as the parent company, and all other institutions and financial institutions (comprising inter alia financial holding companies, payment institutions and asset management companies) that are the parent company’s subsidiaries as defined in the CRR or that are consolidated voluntarily. The provisions of the German Banking Act and the CRR on consolidated supervision require that a group of institutions taken as a whole complies with the requirements on capital adequacy, the limitations on large exposures and other prudential requirements under the CRR. The ECB is responsible for our supervision on a consolidated basis.

Financial groups which offer services and products in various financial sectors (banking and securities business, insurance and reinsurance business) are subject to supplementary supervision as a financial conglomerate (Finanzkonglomerat) once certain thresholds have been exceeded. Supervision of financial conglomerates comprises requirements regarding own funds, risk concentration, risk management, transactions within the conglomerate and organizational matters. We are a financial conglomerate and therefore are required to report capital adequacy requirements and risk concentrations also on a conglomerate level. In addition, we are required to report significant conglomerate internal transactions as well as significant risk concentrations. Our supervision at the conglomerate level is coordinated by the ECB.

Liquidity Requirements

The CRR introduced a new liquidity coverage requirement intended to ensure that banks have an adequate stock of unencumbered high quality liquid assets that can be easily and quickly converted into cash to meet their liquidity needs for a 30 calendar day liquidity stress scenario. The required “liquidity coverage ratio” is calculated as the ratio of a bank’s liquidity buffer to its net liquidity outflows. Also, banks must regularly report the composition of the liquid assets in their liquidity buffer to their competent authorities. The liquidity coverage requirement is being gradually phased in through January 1, 2018, with a minimum required level of liquidity of 70 % in 2016, which will subsequently be increased to 80 % in 2017 and 100 % in 2018. Details on the liquidity coverage requirement have been set forth by the European Commission in implementing legislation, which became applicable on October 1, 2015. The ECB supervises our compliance with the liquidity coverage requirement under the CRR.

In addition, Basel 3 contains a proposal to introduce a net stable funding ratio (“NSFR”) to reduce medium- to long-term funding risks by requiring banks to fund their activities with sufficiently stable sources of funding over a one-year period. The CRR contains interim reporting requirements on stable funding but does not include substantive provisions relating to the NSFR. On October 31, 2014, the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision published its final standards for the NSFR pursuant to which the NSFR is defined as the amount of available stable funding relative to the amount of required stable funding. The NSFR is expected to become a minimum standard for banks by January 1, 2018. Since the proposal has not yet been implemented into binding European law, the European Commission needs to decide by December 31, 2016 whether and how to introduce the NSFR into European law.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       58
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

National liquidity requirements under the German Banking Act and the German Liquidity Regulation (Liquiditäts- verordnung) will continue to be applicable to us until the full introduction of the liquidity coverage requirement at the European level on January 1, 2018. The German Banking Act generally requires banks and certain financial services institutions to invest their funds so as to maintain adequate liquidity at all times. The German Liquidity Regulation provides for minimum liquidity requirements based upon a comparison of the remaining terms of certain assets and liabilities. It requires maintenance of a ratio (Liquiditätskennzahl or “liquidity ratio”) of liquid assets to liquidity reductions expected during the month following the date on which the ratio is determined of at least one. The German Liquidity Regulation also allows banks and financial services institutions subject to it to use their own methodology and procedures to measure and manage liquidity risk if the BaFin has approved such methodology and procedures. The liquidity ratio (and estimated liquidity ratios for the next eleven months) must be reported to the Bundesbank on a monthly basis. Generally, the liquidity requirements do not apply on a consolidated basis.

The ECB and the BaFin may impose on individual banks liquidity requirements which are more stringent than the general statutory requirements if such bank’s continuous liquidity would otherwise not be ensured.

Financial Statements and Audits

As required by the German Commercial Code (Handelsgesetzbuch), we prepare our non-consolidated financial statements in accordance with German GAAP. Our consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards, and our compliance with capital adequacy requirements and large exposure limits is determined solely based upon such consolidated financial statements.

Under German law, we are required to be audited annually by a certified public accountant (Wirtschaftsprüfer). The accountant is appointed at the shareholders’ meeting. However, the supervisory board mandates the accountant and supervises the audit. The BaFin must be informed of and may reject the accountant’s appointment. The German Banking Act requires that a bank’s auditor inform the BaFin of any facts that come to the accountant’s attention which would lead it to refuse to certify or to limit its certification of the bank’s annual financial statements or which would adversely affect the bank’s financial position. The auditor is also required to notify the BaFin in the event of a material breach by management of the articles of association or of any other applicable law. The auditor is required to prepare a detailed and comprehensive annual audit report (Prüfungsbericht) for submission to the bank’s supervisory board, the BaFin and the Bundesbank. The BaFin and the Bundesbank share their information with the ECB.

Investigative and Enforcement Powers

Investigations and Official Audits

The ECB and the BaFin may conduct audits of banks on a random basis, as well as for cause. In particular, the ECB may audit our compliance with requirements with respect to which it supervises us, such as those set forth in CRR/CRD 4. The BaFin may also decide to audit our compliance with requirements with respect to which it supervises us, such as those relating to business conduct in the securities markets and the regulation of anti-money laundering, terrorist financing and payment services, as well as certain special areas of bank regulation, such as those related to the issuance of covered bonds (Pfandbriefe) and the supervision of German home loan banks (Bausparkassen).

The ECB as well as the BaFin may require a bank to furnish information and documents in order to ensure that the bank is complying with applicable bank supervisory laws. The ECB or the BaFin may conduct investigations without having to state a reason therefor. Such investigations may also take place at a foreign entity that is part of a bank’s group for regulatory purposes. Investigations of foreign entities are limited to the extent that the law of the jurisdiction where the entity is located restricts such investigations.

The ECB and the BaFin may attend meetings of a bank’s supervisory board and shareholders meetings. They also have the authority to require that such meetings be convened.

 

 


Table of Contents
59   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

Supervisory and Enforcement Powers

The ECB has a wide range of enforcement powers in the event it discovers any irregularities concerning requirements with respect to which it supervises us. It may, for example,

 

 

impose additional own funds or liquidity requirements in excess of statutory requirements;

 

restrict or limit a bank’s business;

 

require the cessation of activities to reduce risk;

 

require a bank to use net profits to strengthen its own funds;

 

restrict or prohibit dividend payments to shareholders or distributions to holders of regulatory capital instruments;

 

remove the members of the bank’s management or supervisory board members from office; or

 

prohibit them from exercising their current managerial capacities.

To the extent necessary to carry out the tasks granted to it, the ECB may also require national supervisory authorities to make use of their powers under national law. If these measures are inadequate, the ECB may revoke the bank’s license. Furthermore, the ECB has the power to impose severe administrative penalties in case of breaches of directly applicable European Union laws, such as the CRR, or of applicable ECB regulations and decisions. Penalties imposed by the ECB may amount to up to twice the amount of profits gained or losses avoided because of the violation, or up to 10 % of the total annual turnover of the relevant entity in the preceding business year. In addition, where necessary to carry out the tasks granted to it, the ECB may also require that the BaFin initiate proceedings to ensure that appropriate penalties are imposed on the affected bank.

The BaFin also retains a wide range of enforcement powers. As discussed above, it may take action if instructed by the ECB in connection with supervisory tasks granted to the ECB. With respect to supervisory tasks not granted to the ECB, the BaFin may still take, as in the past, action upon its own initiative. In particular, if a bank is in danger of defaulting on its obligations to creditors, the BaFin may take emergency measures to avert default. These emergency measures may include:

 

 

issuing instructions relating to the management of the bank;

 

prohibiting the acceptance of deposits and the extension of credit;

 

prohibiting or restricting the bank’s managers from carrying on their functions;

 

prohibiting payments and disposals of assets;

 

closing the bank’s customer services; and

 

prohibiting the bank from accepting any payments other than payments of debts owed to the bank.

The BaFin may also impose administrative pecuniary penalties under the German Banking Act and other German laws. Penalties under the German Banking Act may amount to generally up to  5 million. If the economic benefit derived from the offense is higher, the BaFin may impose penalties of up to 10 % of the net turnover of the preceding business year or double the amount of the economic benefit derived from the violation.

Finally, violations of the German Banking Act may result in criminal penalties against the members of the Management Board or senior management.

Recovery and Resolution Planning, Restructuring Powers

Germany participates in the SRM, which centralizes at a European level the key competences and resources for managing the failure of any bank in member states of the European Union participating in the banking union. The SRM is based on the SRM Regulation and the BRRD, which was implemented in Germany through the German Recovery and Resolution Act (Sanierungs- und Abwicklungsgesetz, “SAG”). In addition, the German Resolution Mechanism Act (Abwicklungsmechanismusgesetz) adapted German bank resolution laws to the SRM. The SRM Regulation and the German Recovery and Resolution Act require the preparation of recovery and resolution plans for banks and grant broad powers to public authorities to intervene in a bank which is failing or likely to fail. For a bank directly supervised by the ECB, such as us, the SRB assesses its resolvability and may require legal and operational changes to the

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       60
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

bank’s structure to ensure its resolvability. In the event that a bank is failing or likely to fail and certain other conditions are met, the SRB is responsible for adopting a resolution scheme for resolving the bank pursuant to the SRM Regulation. The European Commission and, to a lesser extent, the Council of the European Union, have a role in endorsing or objecting to the resolution scheme proposed by the SRB. The resolution scheme would be addressed to and implemented by the competent national resolution authorities (in Germany: the Federal Agency for Financial Market Stabilization, “FMSA”) in line with national company and insolvency law.

Resolution measures that could be imposed upon a failing bank may include a range of measures including the transfer of shares, assets or liabilities of the bank to another legal entity, the reduction, including to zero, of the nominal value of shares, the dilution of shareholders of a failing bank or the cancellation of shares outright, or the amendment, modification or variation of the terms of the bank’s outstanding debt instruments, for example by way of deferral of payments or a reduction of the applicable interest rate. Furthermore, certain eligible unsecured liabilities, in particular certain senior unsecured debt instruments specified by the Resolution Mechanism Act, may be written down, including to zero, or converted into equity (commonly referred to as “bail-in”). In addition, the SRB is charged with administering the SRF, a pool of money which is financed by bank levies raised at national level and is intended to reach a target level of 1 % of insured deposits of all banks in member states participating in the SRM by the end of 2023 (currently approximately  55 billion). It will be used for resolving failing banks after other options, such as the bail-in tool, have been exhausted. Financial public support for a failing bank should only be used as a last resort, after having assessed and exploited, to the maximum extent possible, resolution measures set forth in the SRM Regulation and the German Recovery and Resolution Act, including the bail-in tool.

Also under the German Resolution Mechanism Act, obligations of banks such as us under certain, specifically defined senior unsecured debt instruments issued by them would rank junior to, without constituting subordinated debt, in an insolvency proceeding of the issuing bank, all other outstanding unsecured unsubordinated obligations of such bank, but continue to rank in priority to contractually or statutorily subordinated debt instruments. Similarly, such senior unsecured debt instruments, in a resolution proceeding, would be bailed in first, prior to any other unsubordinated debt. This order of priority applies to insolvency proceedings commenced, and resolution measures imposed upon the relevant bank, on or after January 1, 2017.

To prevent banks from structuring their liabilities in a way that impedes the effectiveness of the bail-in or other resolution tools, the SRM Regulation and the Recovery and Resolution Act require banks to meet strict minimum requirements for own funds and eligible liabilities (“MREL”) which will be determined for banks on a case-by-case basis by the competent resolution authorities. The minimum MREL requirement will be calculated as the amount of own funds and liabilities eligible for a bail-in expressed as a percentage of the total liabilities and own funds.

In addition, on November 9, 2015, the Financial Stability Board (“FSB”) published a new standard that will require, when implemented as law, global systemically important banks (“G-SIBs”), such as us, to meet a new minimum requirement for total loss-absorbing capacity (“TLAC”) starting on January 1, 2019. The TLAC standard is designed to ensure that failing G-SIBs have sufficient loss-absorbing and recapitalization capacity available in resolution and will apply to G-SIBs after legal implementation in their respective jurisdictions. The FSB has proposed that competent authorities determine a firm-specific minimum TLAC requirement for each G-SIB of at least 16 % of risk-weighted assets as from January 1, 2019, rising to at least 18 % from January 1, 2022. In addition, the FSB has proposed that minimum TLAC must be at least 6 % of the Basel 3 leverage ratio denominator as from January 1, 2019, rising to 6.75 % from January 1, 2022. The ultimate impact of any TLAC requirements on us will depend on how the proposals are implemented into applicable law.

In addition to the SRM and the German Recovery and Resolution Act, under the German Credit Institution Reorganization Act (Gesetz zur Reorganisation von Kreditinstituten) a bank may submit a stabilization plan to the BaFin if, based upon the circumstances, it is likely that the bank will not be able to continuously fulfill the applicable statutory capital or liquidity requirements. A stabilization plan, if implemented, may in particular result in new loans or other financing taken out thereunder having priority over the claims of existing creditors if insolvency proceedings are opened within three years following the commencement of the stabilization proceedings. Also under the German Credit Institution Reorganization Act, if a bank considers a stabilization proceeding to be futile, it may initiate reorganization proceedings, provided

 

 


Table of Contents
61   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

that the requirements for resolution under the German Recovery and Resolution Act are met. In such proceedings, classes of creditors and shareholders may vote on a reorganization plan that, if adopted, may in particular provide for debt-to-equity swaps, contributions in kind, capital increases and reductions, an exclusion of subscription rights and the spin-off of parts of the bank. Under certain conditions, the reorganization plan may also be implemented without the approval of a class of creditors or the shareholders (i.e., it can be forced upon dissenting creditors or shareholders).

Separation of Proprietary Trading Activities by Universal Banks

The German Separation Act provides that deposit-taking banks and their affiliates are prohibited from engaging in proprietary trading that does not constitute a service for others, high-frequency trading (with the exception of market-making activities), and credit or guarantee transactions with hedge funds and comparable enterprises, unless such activities are transferred to a separate legal entity. The separation requirement applies if certain thresholds are exceeded, which we exceed. In addition, the German Separation Act authorizes the BaFin to prohibit the deposit-taking bank and its affiliates, on a case-by-case basis, from engaging in market-making and other activities that are comparable to the activities prohibited by law, if these activities may put the solvency of the deposit-taking bank or any of its affiliates at risk. In the event that the BaFin orders such a prohibition, the respective activities must be discontinued or transferred to a separate legal entity (referred to as financial trading institution (Finanzhandelsinstitut)). The separate legal entity may be established in the form of an investment firm or a bank and may be part of the same group as the deposit-taking bank. However, it must be economically and organizationally independent from the deposit-taking bank and its (other) affiliates, and it has to comply with enhanced risk management requirements. The prohibition for deposit-taking banks and their affiliates to conduct activities associated with increased risks became effective on July 1, 2015, with a further transitional period of twelve months to accomplish the separation requirement, unless the BaFin extends this period. For Deutsche Bank Group, the period to cease or transfer activities concerned was extended by the BaFin until June 30, 2017. Also starting on July 1, 2016, the BaFin may prohibit, on a case-by-case basis, deposit-taking banks and their affiliates from engaging in market-making and other activities that are comparable to the activities prohibited by law if such activities could put the solvency of the deposit-taking bank or any of its affiliates at risk. The implementation of the Separation Act will require ongoing surveillance of the activities of banks within the scope of the legislation and assessment of compliance and control frameworks to ensure that no prohibited activities are conducted.

On January 29, 2014, the European Commission published a proposal for a regulation on structural measures improving the resilience of European Union credit institutions (referred to as “Proposed Regulation”), which if enacted, will impose measures similar to the Separation Act. The Proposed Regulation would apply to large banks which are either identified as global systemically important institutions (such as us), or whose total assets and trading activities exceed certain thresholds (which we exceed). If the Proposed Regulation were enacted as drafted, it would ban proprietary trading in financial instruments and commodities. For this purpose, proprietary trading is defined as (subject to certain exemptions) trading on own account for the sole purpose of making profit for the bank through dedicated trading structures. Furthermore, the Proposed Regulation would grant supervisors the power, and, in certain instances, impose on them an obligation, to require the transfer of certain trading and other activities (such as market making, derivatives and securitization operations) to separate legal trading entities within the group. In this case, the group would be required to be structured in a manner that results in the creation of two distinct sub-groups. Only one such subgroup would be permitted to conduct the business of taking insured deposits (referred to as a “Core Bank”). Both sub-groups would be required to comply separately with the own funds and capital requirements, the large exposure limits and certain other obligations set forth in CRR/CRD 4. Moreover, the Core Bank sub-group would not be permitted to hold any capital instruments or voting rights in the other sub-group. According to the Proposed Regulation, the prohibition on proprietary trading would become effective 18 months after the publication of the final regulation. The provisions on separation of trading activities from Core Banks would become effective 36 months after such publication. On December 22, 2014, the Economic and Monetary Affairs Committee (“ECON”) of the European Parliament published significant changes to the Proposed Regulation. On June 19, 2015, the Council of the European Union agreed its position at first reading on the Proposed Regulation. The Proposed Regulation is currently being negotiated at the European level. Once enacted, the Proposed Regulation might overrule certain requirements set out in the Separation Act at the national level. The ultimate impact on us will depend on the content of the final version of the Proposed Regulation.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       62
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

Remuneration Rules

Under the German Banking Act and the German Credit Institution Remuneration Regulation (Institutsvergütungsverordnung), we are subject to certain restrictions on the remuneration we pay statutorily designated “material risk takers” and other affected employees. The remuneration rules have been revised on the basis of the CRR/CRD 4 framework, and since January 1, 2014, they impose a cap on bonuses. Pursuant to this cap, the variable remuneration for material risk takers and other affected employees generally must not exceed that employee’s fixed remuneration. The variable remuneration may be increased to twice the material risk taker’s and other affected employee’s fixed remuneration if expressly approved by the shareholders’ meeting with the required majority. In addition, between 40 % and 60 % of the variable remuneration of material risk takers must be deferred. The deferral period must be at least three to five years. Also, depending on the responsibilities, activities and position of an employee, at least 50 % of the variable remuneration must be paid in the form of shares or instruments linked to shares. Finally, we are required to comply with certain disclosure requirements relating to the remuneration we pay to, and our remuneration principles in respect of, our material risk takers and other affected employees.

Deposit Protection and Investor Compensation in Germany

The Deposit Protection Act and the Investor Compensation Act

The German Deposit Protection Act (Einlagensicherungsgesetz) and the German Investor Compensation Act (Anlegerentschädigungsgesetz) provide for a mandatory deposit protection and investor compensation system in Germany, based on a European Union directive on deposit guarantee schemes (“DGS Directive”), recast in 2014, and a European Union directive on investor compensation schemes.

The German Deposit Protection Act requires that each German bank participate in one of the licensed government-controlled deposit protection schemes (Entschädigungseinrichtungen). Entschädigungseinrichtung deutscher Banken GmbH acts as the deposit protection scheme for private sector banks such as us, collects and administers the contributions of the member banks, and settles any compensation claims of depositors in accordance with the German Deposit Protection Act.

Under the German Deposit Protection Act, deposit protection schemes are liable for obligations resulting from deposits denominated in any currency in an amount of up to  100,000 per depositor and bank. In addition, deposits made in connection with particular life events (such as the sale of private residential properties, marriage or severance payments) are protected up to an amount  500,000 for a period of six months after the amount has been deposited or become transferable. Deposit protection schemes are not liable for liabilities the existence of which can be proven only by financial instruments such as transferable securities, that are not repayable at par or the principal of which is repayable at par only under a particular guarantee or agreement provided by the bank or a third party. Deposits by certain entities, such as banks, financial institutions (Finanzinstitute), insurance companies, investment funds, the Federal Republic of Germany, the German federal states and municipalities, as well as liabilities arising out of own acceptances and promissory notes are not protected.

The deposit protection scheme must repay insured deposits in euro within twenty working days until May 31, 2016, and within seven working days as from June 1, 2016, after the BaFin has ascertained a compensation case for the bank concerned and without the requirement for depositors to specifically apply for repayment, except where they claim to be insured above the level of  100,000 in connection with specific life events.

Deposit protection schemes are financed by annual contributions of the participating banks. They must have “available financial means” proportionate to their potential liabilities and must reach a target level of such means of 0.8 % of the total covered deposits of their participating banks by July 3, 2024. The “financial means” must be contributed by the banks participating in the deposit protection scheme. The amount of contributions of each bank will be based upon the amount of its covered deposits and the degree of risk the bank is exposed to. Deposit protection schemes may also levy special contributions if required to settle compensation claims. There is no absolute limit on such special contributions.

 

 


Table of Contents
63   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

Deposit protection schemes will be required to contribute to bank resolution costs where resolution tools are used. The contribution made by the deposit protection scheme is limited to the compensation it would have to pay if the affected bank had become subject to insolvency proceedings. Furthermore, deposit protection schemes under certain circumstances may provide funding to its participating banks to avoid their failure.

Under the German Investor Compensation Act, in the event that the BaFin ascertains a compensation case, Entschädigungseinrichtung deutscher Banken GmbH as our deposit protection scheme is also required to compensate 90 % of any creditor’s aggregate claims arising from securities transactions denominated in euro or in a currency of any other European Union member state up to an amount of the equivalent of  20,000. Claims arising from securities transactions include claims of securities account holders for the return of instruments owned by, and held or deposited for them in connection with securities transactions. Claims arising from securities transactions of certain entities, such as banks, financial institutions (Finanzinstitute), insurance companies, investment funds, the Federal Republic of Germany, the German federal states, municipalities and medium-sized and large corporations, are not protected.

European Deposit Insurance Scheme

On November 24, 2015, the European Commission proposed a regulation to establish a European Deposit Insurance Scheme, or “EDIS” for bank deposits of all credit institutions which are members of any of the current national statutory deposit guarantee schemes member states participating in the banking union. The Commission’s proposal envisages a progressive integration of existing national deposit guarantee schemes in three stages, from a re-insurance of national deposit guarantee schemes, to a co-insurance system, and then to the final stage, which would be reached in 2024, when EDIS would fully insure all relevant national deposit guarantee schemes in case of a bank failure. EDIS would be administered by the SRB in all stages jointly with participating national deposit guarantee schemes or, where a deposit guarantee scheme does not administer itself, by the national designated authority responsible for administering the respective participating deposit guarantee scheme. The proposal is currently being negotiated at the European Union level and the ultimate impact on us is uncertain.

Voluntary Deposit Protection System

Liabilities to creditors that are not covered by a statutory compensation scheme may be covered by one of the various protection funds set up by the banking industry on a voluntary basis. We take part in the Deposit Protection Fund of the Association of German Banks (Einlagensicherungsfonds des Bundesverbandes deutscher Banken e. V.). The Deposit Protection Fund covers liabilities to customers up to an amount equal to 20 % of the bank’s own funds (Eigenmittel) as further specified in the Deposit Protection Fund’s by-laws. This limit will be reduced to 15 % from January 1, 2020 onwards and to 8.75 % from January 1, 2025 onwards. Liabilities to other banks and other specified institutions, obligations of banks represented by instruments in bearer form and covered bonds in registered form (Namenspfandbriefe) are not covered. To the extent the Deposit Protection Fund makes payments to customers of a bank, it will be subrogated to their claims against the bank.

Banks that participate in the Deposit Protection Fund make annual contributions to the fund based on their liabilities to customers, and may be required to make special contributions up to an amount of 50 % of their annual contributions to the extent requested by the Deposit Protection Fund to enable it to fulfill its purpose. If one or more German banks are in financial difficulties, we may therefore participate in their restructuring even where we have no business relationship or strategic interest, in order to avoid making special contributions to the Deposit Protection Fund in case of an insolvency of such bank or banks, or we may be required to make such special contributions.

Further Regulation and Supervision in the European Economic Area

Since 1989 the European Union has enacted a number of regulations and directives to create a single European Union-wide market with almost no internal barriers on banking and financial services. The Agreement on the European Economic Area extends this single market to Iceland, Liechtenstein and Norway. Within this market our branches generally operate under the so-called “European Passport”. Under the European Passport, our branches are subject to regulation and supervision primarily by the ECB and the BaFin. To the extent that activities are carried out within its

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       64
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

jurisdiction, the authorities of the host country supervise the conduct of banks. This includes, for example, rules on treating clients fairly and rules governing a bank’s conduct in the securities market.

On November 24, 2010, the European Union enacted regulations to further integrate the existing national supervisory authorities into a European System of Financial Supervision. A European Systemic Risk Board (“ESRB”) was established and the independent advisory committees to the European Commission for banks, insurance companies and securities markets which had existed since 2004 were transformed into new European authorities: the EBA, the European Insurance and Occupational Pensions Authority (“EIOPA”) and the ESMA.

The ESRB is responsible for the macro-prudential oversight of the financial system within the European Union. It will in particular collect and analyze all relevant information, identify systemic risks and issue warnings and recommendations for remedial action as appropriate. The secretariat of the ESRB is provided by the ECB. The tasks of the EBA, EIOPA, and ESMA are to further integrate and harmonize the work of the relevant national supervisory authorities and to ensure a consistent application of European Union law. To that effect they shall in particular develop technical standards for supervision, and help develop regulatory standards, which will become effective if the European Commission endorses them. They shall also issue guidelines and recommendations for supervisory practices and coordinate the work of competent supervisory authorities in emergency situations where the orderly functioning or integrity of the financial markets or the stability of the financial system in the European Union is jeopardized. In such case, the EBA and the other new authorities may give instructions to competent supervisory authorities and, in certain circumstances, directly to banks and other financial institutions, to take remedial measures.

Regulation and Supervision in the United States

Our operations are subject to extensive federal and state banking, securities and derivatives regulation and supervision in the United States. We engage in U.S. banking activities directly through our New York branch. We also control U.S. banking subsidiaries, including Deutsche Bank Trust Company Americas (“DBTCA”), and U.S. broker-dealers, such as Deutsche Bank Securities Inc., U.S. nondeposit trust companies and nonbanking subsidiaries.

On July 21, 2010, the United States enacted the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (the “Dodd-Frank Act”), which provides a broad framework for significant regulatory changes that extend to almost every area of U.S. financial regulation. While rulemaking in respect of many of the provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act has already taken place, implementation of the Dodd-Frank Act will require further detailed rulemaking over several years by different U.S. regulators, including the Department of the Treasury, the Federal Reserve Board, the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”), the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (“FDIC”), the Commodity Futures Trading Commission (“CFTC”) and the Financial Stability Oversight Council (“Council”), and uncertainty remains about the final details, timing and impact of many of the rules.

The Dodd-Frank Act provisions known as the “Volcker Rule” limit the ability of banking entities and their affiliates to engage as principal in certain types of proprietary trading unrelated to serving clients and to sponsor or invest in private equity or hedge funds or similar funds (“covered funds”), subject to certain exclusions and exemptions. In the case of non-U.S. banking entities such as Deutsche Bank AG, these exemptions permit certain activity conducted outside the U.S., provided that certain criteria are satisfied. The Volcker Rule also limits the ability of banking entities and their affiliates to enter into certain transactions with covered funds with which they or their affiliates have certain relationships. On December 10, 2013, U.S. regulators released the final version of the regulations implementing the Volcker Rule. Also on that date, the Federal Reserve Board extended the end of the conformance period for the Volcker Rule until July 21, 2015 (with the possibility of two one-year extensions under certain circumstances), by which time financial institutions subject to the rule, such as us, must bring their activities and investments into compliance and implement a specific compliance program. In December 2014, the Federal Reserve Board issued an order extending the Volcker Rule’s general conformance period until July 21, 2016 for investments in and relationships with covered funds and certain foreign funds that were in place on or prior to December 31, 2013 (“legacy covered funds”), and stated its intention to grant a final one-year extension of the general conformance period, to July 21, 2017, for banking entities to conform ownership interests in and relationships with legacy covered funds. This extension of the conformance period

 

 


Table of Contents
65   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

does not apply to the Volcker Rule’s prohibitions on proprietary trading or to any investments in and relationships with covered funds made or entered into after December 31, 2013.

The Dodd-Frank Act also provides regulators with tools to provide greater capital, leverage and liquidity requirements and other prudential standards, particularly for financial institutions that pose significant systemic risk. U.S. regulators will also be able to restrict the size and growth of systemically significant non-bank financial companies and large interconnected bank holding companies and will be required to impose bright-line debt-to-equity ratio limits on financial companies that the Council determines pose a grave threat to financial stability if the Council determines that the imposition of the limit is necessary to minimize the risk.

With respect to prudential standards, on February 18, 2014, the Federal Reserve Board adopted rules (the “FBO Rules”) that set forth how the U.S. operations of foreign banking organizations (“FBOs”), such as Deutsche Bank, will be required to be structured in the U.S., as well as the enhanced prudential standards that will apply to our U.S. operations.

Under the FBO Rules, a large FBO with U.S.$ 50 billion or more in U.S. non-branch assets, such as us, will be required to establish or designate a separately capitalized top-tier U.S. intermediate holding company (“IHC”) that would hold substantially all of the FBO’s ownership interests in U.S. subsidiaries by July 1, 2016. Beginning on that date, our IHC will be subject, on a consolidated basis, to the risk-based capital requirements under the U.S. Basel 3 capital framework, capital planning and stress testing requirements (on a phased-in basis), U.S. liquidity buffer requirements and other enhanced prudential standards comparable to those applicable to top-tier U.S. bank holding companies of a similar size. The Federal Reserve Board will have the authority to examine the IHC and any of its subsidiaries. U.S. leverage requirements applicable to the IHC will take effect beginning in January 2018. An FBO’s U.S. branches and agencies will not be held beneath an IHC; however, the U.S. branches and agencies of the FBO (and in certain cases, the entire U.S. operations of the FBO) will be subject to certain liquidity requirements, as well as other specific enhanced prudential standards, such as risk management and asset maintenance requirements under certain circumstances. Additionally, the FBO Rules will place requirements on the FBO itself related to the adequacy and reporting of the FBO’s home country capital and stress testing regime. The Federal Reserve Board did not finalize (but continues to consider) requirements relating to single counterparty credit limits and an “early remediation” framework under which the Federal Reserve Board would implement prescribed restrictions and penalties against the FBO and its U.S. operations and certain of its officers and directors, if the FBO and/or its U.S. operations do not meet certain requirements, and would authorize the termination of U.S. operations under certain circumstances.

Title I of the Dodd-Frank Act and the implementing regulations issued by the Federal Reserve Board and the FDIC require each bank holding company with assets of U.S.$ 50 billion or more, including Deutsche Bank AG, to prepare and submit annually a plan for the orderly resolution of subsidiaries and operations in the event of future material financial distress or failure (the “Title I US Resolution Plan”). For foreign-based covered companies such as Deutsche Bank AG, the Title I US Resolution Plan only relates to subsidiaries, branches, agencies and businesses that are domiciled in or conducted in whole or in material part in the United States. In addition to the Title I US Resolution Plan, in 2014, DBTCA, one of our insured depository institutions (“IDIs”) in the United States, became subject to the FDIC’s final rule requiring IDIs with total assets of U.S.$ 50 billion or more to submit periodically to the FDIC a plan for resolution in the event of failure (the “IDI Plan” and, together with the Title I US Resolution Plan, the “US Resolution Plan”) under the Federal Deposit Insurance Act (the “IDI Rule”). In 2014, Deutsche Bank AG expanded its Title I US Resolution Plan to also be responsive to the IDI Rule requirements. In 2015, DBTCA prepared and submitted a separate IDI Plan.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       66
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

The core elements of the US Resolution Plan are Material Entities (“MEs”), Core Business Lines (“CBLs”), Critical Operations (“COs”) and, for purposes of the IDI Plan, Critical Services. The US Resolution Plan lays out the resolution strategy for each ME, defined as those entities significant to the activities of a CO or CBL and demonstrates how each ME, CBL and CO, as applicable, can be resolved in a rapid and orderly manner and without systemic impact on U.S. financial stability. The US Resolution Plan also discusses the strategy for continuing Critical Services in resolution. Key factors addressed in the US Resolution Plan include how to ensure:

 

 

Continued access to services from other U.S. and non-U.S. legal entities as well as from third parties such as payment servicers, exchanges and key vendors;

 

Availability of funding from both external and internal sources;

 

Retention of key employees during resolution; and

 

Efficient and coordinated close-out of cross-border contracts.

The US Resolution Plan is drafted in coordination with the U.S. businesses and infrastructure groups so that it accurately reflects the business, critical infrastructure and key interconnections.

Our existing U.S. bank holding company subsidiary, Deutsche Bank Trust Corporation, is subject to various U.S. prudential requirements and will become subject to others prior to our establishing the IHC. As of January 1, 2015, Deutsche Bank Trust Corporation is subject to risk-based and leverage capital requirements, liquidity requirements, and other enhanced prudential standards applicable to large U.S. bank holding companies. Deutsche Bank Trust Corporation also became subject to capital planning and stress testing requirements on June 30, 2014. On March 11, 2015, the Federal Reserve Board objected to Deutsche Bank Trust Corporation’s 2015 capital plan due to weaknesses in its capital planning processes. Deutsche Bank Trust Corporation’s stressed Common Equity Tier 1 capital ratio was forecast by the Federal Reserve Board to fall to as low as 28.6 % under the supervisory severely adverse scenario. This hypothetical stressed ratio would be substantially above the minimum required ratio of 4.5 %. Stress testing results are based on hypothetical adverse scenarios and should not be viewed or interpreted as forecasts of expected outcomes or capital adequacy or of the actual financial condition of Deutsche Bank Trust Corporation. Deutsche Bank Trust Corporation will submit its 2016 capital plan, incorporating enhancements to its processes, on April 5, 2016. Deutsche Bank Trust Corporation will remain subject to the capital planning and stress-testing requirements and certain enhanced prudential standards until corresponding requirements applicable to the IHC become effective.

In September 2014, the Federal Reserve Board and other U.S. regulators approved a final rule implementing liquidity coverage ratio (“LCR”) requirements for certain U.S. banking holding companies and depositary institutions that are generally consistent with the Basel Committee’s revised Basel 3 liquidity standards. Deutsche Bank Trust Corporation, as a U.S. bank holding company with total assets of U.S.$ 50 billion or more that is not an advanced approaches bank holding company, became subject to a modified, less stringent version of the LCR beginning in January 2016. The Federal Reserve Board has reaffirmed its plans to issue an additional rulemaking to address the application of an LCR requirement to the U.S. operations of some or all foreign banking organizations with U.S.$ 50 billion or more in combined U.S. assets, which could impact the LCR requirements applicable to our IHC.

On October 30, 2015, the Federal Reserve Board published proposed rules that would implement the FSB’s TLAC standard in the United States. The proposed rules would require, among other things, the U.S. IHCs of non-U.S. G-SIBs, including our IHC, to maintain a minimum amount of internal TLAC, and would separately require them to maintain a minimum amount of internal long-term debt. Under the proposed rules, the required amounts of minimum internal TLAC required varies depending on the home country resolution authority’s preferred resolution strategy. The proposed rules would require our IHC to maintain, on a fully phased-in basis by 2022, (i) internal minimum TLAC of at least 16 % of its risk-weighted assets, 6 % of its Basel 3 leverage ratio denominator and 8 % of its average total consolidated assets, and (ii) internal long-term debt of at least 7 % of its risk-weighted assets, 3 % of its Basel 3 leverage ratio denominator and 4 % of its average total consolidated assets. Internal long-term debt instruments would be required to meet certain eligibility criteria, including issuance to a foreign parent entity (a non-US entity that controls the intermediate holding company) and the inclusion of a contractual trigger allowing for, in limited circumstances, the cancellation of, or immediate conversion or exchange of the instrument into Common Equity Tier 1 upon an order by

 

 


Table of Contents
67   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

the Federal Reserve Board. Internal TLAC requirements could be satisfied with a combination of eligible long-term debt instruments and Tier 1 capital. The proposed rules would also impose limitations on the types of financial transactions that our IHC could engage in.

Furthermore, the Dodd-Frank Act provides for an extensive framework for the regulation of over-the-counter (OTC) derivatives, including mandatory clearing, exchange trading and transaction reporting of certain OTC derivatives, as well as rules regarding the registration of, and capital, margin and business conduct standards for, swap dealers and major swap participants. In November 2013, also pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, the CFTC re-proposed regulations to impose position limits on certain commodities and economically equivalent swaps, futures and options. This proposal has not yet been finalized. At the end of 2015, the U.S. Prudential Regulators and the CFTC adopted final rules establishing margin requirements for non-cleared swaps and security based swaps. The final margin rules follow a phased implementation schedule, with variation margin requirements coming into effect in September 2016 or March 2017, and initial margin requirements phased in on an annual basis from September 2016 through September 2020, with the relevant compliance dates depending in each case on the transactional volume of the parties and their affiliates.

The Dodd-Frank Act also requires broader regulation of hedge funds and private equity funds, as well as credit rating agencies, and imposes new requirements with respect to securitization activities. In October 2014, federal regulatory agencies issued final rules to implement the credit risk retention requirements of Section 941 of the Dodd-Frank Act, which generally require securitizers of different types of asset-backed securitizations, including transactions backed by residential mortgages, commercial mortgages, and commercial, credit card and auto loans, to retain at least five percent of the credit risk of the assets being securitized, with an exemption for securitizations that are wholly composed of “qualified residential mortgages.” The regulations took effect on February 23, 2015. Compliance was required with respect to new securitization transactions backed by residential mortgages beginning December 24, 2015 and will be required with respect to new securitization transactions backed by other types of assets beginning December 24, 2016. We continue to evaluate the final rules and assess their impact on our securitization activities.

The Dodd-Frank Act also establishes a new regulatory framework and enhanced regulation for several other areas, including but not limited to the following. Under the Dodd-Frank Act and implementing regulations, a new regime for the orderly liquidation of systemically significant financial companies is established, which authorizes assessments on financial institutions that have U.S.$ 50 billion or more in consolidated assets to repay outstanding debts owed to the Treasury in connection with a liquidation of a systemically significant financial company under the new insolvency regime. In addition, the Dodd-Frank Act requires U.S. regulatory agencies to prescribe regulations with respect to incentive-based compensation at financial institutions in order to prevent inappropriate behavior that could lead to a material financial loss. Other provisions require issuers with securities listed on U.S. stock exchanges, which may include foreign private issuers such as us, to establish a “clawback” policy to recoup previously awarded executive compensation in the event of an accounting restatement; in July 2015, the SEC proposed rules to implement this that would cover foreign private issuers. The Dodd-Frank Act also grants the SEC discretionary rule-making authority to impose a new fiduciary standard on brokers, dealers and investment advisers, and expands the extraterritorial jurisdiction of U.S. courts over actions brought by the SEC or the United States with respect to violations of the antifraud provisions of the Securities Act of 1933, the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and the Investment Advisers Act of 1940.

Implementation of the Dodd-Frank Act and related final regulations will result in additional costs and could limit or restrict the way we conduct our business. Although uncertainty remains about many of the details, impact and timing of these reforms, we expect that there will be significant costs and may be significant limitations on our businesses resulting from these regulatory initiatives.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       68
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

Regulatory Authorities

We and Deutsche Bank Trust Corporation, our wholly owned subsidiary, are bank holding companies under the U.S. Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended (the “Bank Holding Company Act“), by virtue of, among other things, our ownership of DBTCA. As bank holding companies, we and Deutsche Bank Trust Corporation have elected to become financial holding companies. As a result, we and our U.S. operations are subject to regulation, supervision and examination by the Federal Reserve Board as our U.S. “umbrella supervisor”.

DBTCA is a New York state-chartered bank whose deposits are insured by the FDIC to the extent permitted by law. DBTCA is subject to regulation, supervision and examination by the Federal Reserve Board and the New York State Department of Financial Services and to relevant FDIC regulation. In addition, DBTCA is also subject to regulation by the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau in relation to its retail products and services offered to its customers. Deutsche Bank Trust Company Delaware is a Delaware state-chartered bank which is subject to regulation, supervision and examination by the FDIC and the Office of the State Bank Commissioner of Delaware. Deutsche Bank’s New York branch is supervised by the Federal Reserve Board and the New York State Department of Financial Services. Deutsche Bank’s federally chartered nondeposit trust companies are subject to regulation, supervision and examination by the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency. We and our subsidiaries are also subject to regulation, supervision and examination by state banking regulators of certain states in which they conduct banking operations.

Restrictions on Activities

As described below, federal and state banking laws and regulations restrict our ability to engage, directly or indirectly through subsidiaries, in activities in the United States. We are required to obtain the prior approval of the Federal Reserve Board before directly or indirectly acquiring the ownership or control of more than 5 % of any class of voting shares of U.S. banks, certain other depository institutions, and bank or depository institution holding companies. Under applicable U.S. federal banking law, our U.S. banking operations are also restricted from engaging in certain “tying” arrangements involving products and services.

Our two U.S. FDIC-insured bank subsidiaries, as well as our New York branch, are subject to requirements and restrictions under federal and state law, including requirements to maintain reserves against deposits, restrictions on the types and amounts of loans that may be made and the interest that may be charged thereon, and limitations on the types of investments that may be made and the types of services that may be offered.

In addition to the business of banking, and managing or controlling banks, so long as we are a financial holding company under U.S. law, we may also engage in nonbanking activities in the United States that are financial in nature, or incidental or complementary to such financial activity, including securities, merchant banking, insurance and other financial activities, subject to certain limitations on the conduct of such activities and to prior regulatory approval in some cases. As a non-U.S. bank, we are generally authorized under U.S. law and regulations to acquire a non-U.S. company engaged in nonfinancial activities as long as the company’s U.S. operations do not exceed certain thresholds and certain other conditions are met. On January 14, 2014, the Federal Reserve Board sought comment on the appropriateness of further restrictions on the physical commodity and merchant banking activities conducted by financial holding companies under several provisions of the Bank Holding Company Act in order to address various prudential considerations, including the potential risks of such activities to the safety and soundness of financial holding companies and financial stability more broadly.

 

 


Table of Contents
69   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

Our status as a financial holding company, and our resulting ability to engage in a broader range of nonbanking activities are dependent on Deutsche Bank AG, Deutsche Bank Trust Corporation and our two insured U.S. depository institutions meeting certain requirements under the Bank Holding Company Act and upon our insured U.S. depository institutions meeting certain requirements under the Community Reinvestment Act. The Federal Reserve Board’s and other U.S. regulators’ “well capitalized” standards are generally based on specified quantitative thresholds set at levels above the minimum requirements to be considered “adequately capitalized.” For our two insured depository institution subsidiaries, Deutsche Bank Trust Company Americas and Deutsche Bank Trust Company Delaware, the well-capitalized thresholds under the U.S. Basel 3 framework are a Common Equity Tier 1 capital ratio of 6.5 %, a Tier 1 capital ratio of 8 %, a Total capital ratio of 10 %, and a U.S. leverage ratio of 5 %. For bank holding companies, including Deutsche Bank AG and Deutsche Bank Trust Corporation, the well-capitalized thresholds are a Tier 1 capital ratio of 6 % and a Total capital ratio of 10 %, both of which are calculated for Deutsche Bank AG under its home country standards.

State-chartered banks (such as DBTCA) and state-licensed branches and agencies of foreign banks (such as our New York branch) may not, with certain exceptions that require prior regulatory approval, engage as a principal in any type of activity not permissible for their federally chartered or licensed counterparts. In addition, DBTCA and Deutsche Bank Trust Company Delaware are subject to their respective state banking laws pertaining to legal lending limits and permissible investments and activities. Likewise, the United States federal banking laws also subject state branches and agencies to the same single-borrower lending limits that apply to federal branches or agencies, which are substantially similar to the lending limits applicable to national banks. These single-borrower lending limits are based on the worldwide capital of the entire foreign bank (i.e., Deutsche Bank AG in the case of the New York branch).

The Federal Reserve Board may terminate the activities of any U.S. office of a foreign bank if it determines that the foreign bank is not subject to comprehensive supervision on a consolidated basis in its home country or that there is reasonable cause to believe that such foreign bank or its affiliate has violated the law or engaged in an unsafe or unsound banking practice in the United States or, for a foreign bank that presents a risk to the stability of the United States financial system, the home country of the foreign bank has not adopted, or made demonstrable progress toward adopting, an appropriate system of financial regulation to mitigate such risk.

The Dodd-Frank Act removed a longstanding prohibition on the payment of interest on demand deposits by our FDIC-insured bank subsidiaries and our New York branch. In addition, the lending limits applicable to our FDIC-insured state-chartered bank subsidiaries take into account credit exposures arising from derivative transactions, and the lending limits applicable to our New York branch take into account both credit exposures arising from derivative transactions as well as securities borrowing and lending transactions and repurchase and reverse repurchase agreements with counterparties.

Also, under the so-called swap “push-out” provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act, certain structured finance derivatives activities of FDIC-insured banks and U.S. branch offices of foreign banks (including our New York branch) are restricted, which may necessitate a restructuring of how we conduct certain of our derivatives activities. We and other U.S. banking organizations and FBOs were required to comply with the “push-out” provisions by July 2015.

In addition, the regulations which the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau may adopt could affect the nature of the consumer activities which a bank (including our FDIC-insured bank subsidiaries and our New York branch) may conduct, and may impose restrictions and limitations on the conduct of such activities.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       70
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

There are various qualitative and quantitative restrictions on the extent to which we and our nonbank subsidiaries can borrow or otherwise obtain credit from our U.S. banking subsidiaries or engage in certain other transactions involving those subsidiaries. In general, these transactions must be on terms that would ordinarily be offered to unaffiliated entities, must be secured by designated amounts of specified collateral and are subject to volume limitations. These restrictions also apply to certain transactions of our New York branch with our U.S. broker-dealers and certain of our other affiliates. Credit exposure arising from derivative transactions, securities borrowing and lending transactions, and repurchase/reverse repurchase agreements is subject to these collateral and volume limitations.

A major focus of U.S. governmental policy relating to financial institutions is aimed at preventing money laundering and terrorist financing and compliance with economic sanctions in respect of designated countries or activities. Failure of an institution to have policies and procedures and controls in place to prevent, detect and report money laundering and terrorist financing could in some cases have serious legal, financial and reputational consequences for the institution.

New York Branch

Our New York branch is licensed by the New York Superintendent of Financial Services to conduct a commercial banking business and is required to maintain eligible high-quality assets with banks in the State of New York (up to a maximum of U.S.$ 100 million of assets pledged so long as the New York branch remains “well-rated” by the New York State Superintendent of Financial Services). Should our New York branch cease to be “well-rated”, we may need to maintain substantial additional amounts of eligible assets. The Superintendent of Financial Services may also establish asset maintenance requirements for branches of foreign banks. In addition, the Federal Reserve Board is authorized to establish asset maintenance requirements for our New York branch under certain conditions, pursuant to the FBO Rules. Currently, no such requirements have been imposed upon our New York branch.

The New York State Banking Law authorizes the Superintendent of Financial Services to take possession of the business and property of a New York branch of a foreign bank under certain circumstances, generally involving violation of law, conduct of business in an unsafe manner, impairment of capital, suspension of payment of obligations, or initiation of liquidation proceedings against the foreign bank at its domicile or elsewhere. In liquidating or dealing with a branch’s business after taking possession of a branch, only the claims of depositors and other creditors which arose out of transactions with a branch are to be accepted by the Superintendent of Financial Services for payment out of the business and property of the foreign bank in the State of New York, without prejudice to the rights of the holders of such claims to be satisfied out of other assets of the foreign bank. After such claims are paid, the Superintendent of Financial Services will turn over the remaining assets, if any, to the foreign bank or its duly appointed liquidator or receiver.

Deutsche Bank Trust Company Americas

The Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act of 1991 (referred to as “FDICIA“) provides for extensive regulation of depository institutions (such as DBTCA and its direct and indirect parent companies), including requiring federal banking regulators to take “prompt corrective action” with respect to FDIC-insured banks that do not meet minimum capital requirements. As an insured bank’s capital level declines and the bank falls into lower categories (or if it is placed in a lower category by the discretionary action of its supervisor), greater limits are placed on its activities and federal banking regulators are authorized (and, in many cases, required) to take increasingly more stringent supervisory actions, which could ultimately include the appointment of a conservator or receiver for the bank (even if it is solvent). In addition, FDICIA generally prohibits an FDIC-insured bank from making any capital distribution (including payment of a dividend) or payment of a management fee to its holding company if the bank would thereafter be undercapitalized. If an insured bank becomes “undercapitalized”, it is required to submit to federal regulators a capital restoration plan guaranteed by the bank’s holding company. Since the enactment of FDICIA, both of our U.S. insured banks have been categorized as “well capitalized,” the highest capital category under applicable regulations.

 

 


Table of Contents
71   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

DBTCA, like other FDIC-insured banks, is required to pay assessments to the FDIC for deposit insurance under the FDIC’s Deposit Insurance Fund (calculated using the FDIC’s risk-based assessment system). The minimum reserve ratio for the Deposit Insurance Fund was increased under the Dodd-Frank Act from 1.15 % to 1.35 %, with the target of 1.35 % to be reached by 2020 and with the incremental cost charged to banks with more than U.S.$ 10 billion in assets. In addition, the FDIC has set the designated reserve ratio at 2 % as a long-term goal. This shift has had financial implications for all FDIC-insured banks, including DBTCA. In order to achieve the 1.35 % goal, in October 2015, the FDIC proposed an additional surcharge on the quarterly assessments of insured depository institutions with total consolidated assets of U.S.$ 10 billion or more, including DBTCA. The financial impact of such an additional surcharge may be material to the results of operation of DBTCA, although any final determination would be made when and if the FDIC’s proposal is finalized. If finalized as proposed, the additional surcharge would commence in 2016. Additionally, in 2015, the FDIC published further guidance on brokered deposits. This guidance has resulted in DBTCA having to classify more of its deposits as brokered deposits, which has resulted in a higher assessment charge for DBTCA.

The FDIC’s basic amount of deposit insurance is U.S.$ 250,000.

Other

In the United States, our U.S.-registered broker-dealers are regulated by the SEC. Broker-dealers are subject to regulations that cover all aspects of the securities business, including sales methods, trade practices among broker-dealers, use and safekeeping of customers’ funds and securities, capital structure, recordkeeping, the financing of customers’ purchases and the conduct of directors, officers and employees.

Our principal U.S. SEC-registered broker-dealer subsidiary, Deutsche Bank Securities Inc., is a member of the New York Stock Exchange and is regulated by the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority (“FINRA“) and the individual state securities authorities in the states in which it operates. The U.S. government agencies and self-regulatory organizations, as well as state securities authorities in the United States having jurisdiction over our U.S. broker-dealer affiliates, are empowered to conduct administrative proceedings that can result in censure, fine, the issuance of cease-and-desist orders or the suspension or expulsion of a broker-dealer or its directors, officers or employees. Deutsche Bank Securities Inc. is also registered with and regulated by the SEC as an investment adviser, and by the CFTC and the National Futures Association as a futures commission merchant and commodity pool operator.

Under the Dodd-Frank Act, with certain exceptions, our entities that are swap dealers, security-based swap dealers, major swap participants or major security-based swap participants will be required to register with the SEC or CFTC, or both. Currently, Deutsche Bank AG is provisionally registered as a swap dealer. At a future date, we will be required to register one or more subsidiaries as security-based swap dealers with the SEC and may be required to register additional subsidiaries as swap dealers with the CFTC and certain subsidiaries as CFTC-regulated major swap participants and/or SEC-regulated major security-based swap participants. Registration, including provisional registration, as swap dealers, security-based swap dealers, major swap participants or major security-based swap participants subjects us to requirements as to capital, margin, business conduct, and recordkeeping, among other requirements.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       72
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

Organizational Structure

We operate our business along the structure of our five corporate divisions. Deutsche Bank AG is the direct or indirect holding company for our subsidiaries. The following table sets forth the significant subsidiaries we own, directly or indirectly, as of December 31, 2015. We used the three-part test set out in Section 1-02 (w) of Regulation S-X under the U.S. Securities Exchange Act of 1934 to determine significance. We do not have any other subsidiaries we believe are material based on other, less quantifiable, factors.

We own 100 % of the equity and voting interests in these subsidiaries. Further detail is included in Note 3 “Acquisitions and Dispositions” to the consolidated financial statements. These subsidiaries prepare financial statements as of December 31, 2015 and are included in our consolidated financial statements. Their principal countries of operation are the same as their countries of incorporation.

 

Subsidiary

  

Place of Incorporation

DB USA Corporation 1

   Delaware, United States

Deutsche Bank Americas Holding Corporation 2

   Delaware, United States

German American Capital Corporation 3

   Delaware, United States

DB U.S. Financial Markets Holding Corporation 4

   Delaware, United States

Deutsche Bank Securities Inc. 5

   Delaware, United States

DB Structured Products Inc. 6

   Delaware, United States

 

  

 

Deutsche Bank Trust Corporation 7

   New York, United States

Deutsche Bank Trust Company Americas 8

   New York, United States

 

  

 

Deutsche Bank Luxembourg S.A. 9

   Luxembourg

 

  

 

Deutsche Bank Privat- und Geschäftskunden Aktiengesellschaft 10

   Frankfurt am Main, Germany

 

  

 

DB Finanz-Holding GmbH 11

   Frankfurt am Main, Germany

Deutsche Postbank AG 12

   Bonn, Germany

DWS Holding & Service GmbH 13

   Frankfurt am Main, Germany

 

1 

DB USA Corporation is one of two top-level holding companies for our subsidiaries in the United States.

2 

Deutsche Bank Americas Holding Corporation is a second tier holding company for subsidiaries in the United States.

3 

German American Capital Corporation is engaged in purchasing and holding loans from financial institutions, trading and securitization of mortgage whole loans and mortgage securities, and providing collateralized financing to counterparties.

4 

DB U.S. Financial Markets Holding Corporation is a second tier holding company for subsidiaries in the United States.

5 

Deutsche Bank Securities Inc. is a U.S. company registered as a broker dealer and investment advisor with the Securities and Exchange Commission and as a futures commission merchant with the Commodities Futures Trading Commission.

6 

DB Structured Products, Inc. is a U.S. subsidiary that has ceased engaging in new business and has surrendered the licenses it holds in respect of mortgage-related activities.

7 

Deutsche Bank Trust Corporation is a bank holding company under Federal Reserve Board regulations.

8 

Deutsche Bank Trust Company Americas is a New York State-chartered bank and member of the Federal Reserve System. It originates loans and other forms of credit, accepts deposits, arranges financings and provides numerous other commercial banking and financial services.

9 

The primary business of this company comprises Treasury and Markets activities, especially as a major supplier of Euro liquidity for Deutsche Bank Group. Further business activities are the international loan business, where the bank acts as lending office for continental Europe and as risk hub for the Credit Portfolio Strategies Group, and private banking. The company serves private individuals, affluent clients and small business clients with banking products.

10 

The company serves private individuals, affluent clients as well as small and medium sized corporate clients with banking products.

11 

The company holds the majority stake in Deutsche Postbank AG (remainder is held at Deutsche Bank AG) and in DWS Holding & Service GmbH.

12 

The business activities of this company comprise retail banking, business with corporate customers, money and capital markets activities as well as home savings loans.

13 

The business activities of this company comprise acquisition, management, coordination and sale of investments in especially investment companies both nationally and internationally for its own account as well as rendering services for general and administrative functions for the investments and other comparable companies.

Property and Equipment

As of December 31, 2015, we operated in 70 countries out of 2,790 branches around the world, of which 65 % were in Germany. We lease a majority of our offices and branches under long-term agreements.

We continue to review our property requirements worldwide taking into account cost containment measures as well as growth initiatives in selected businesses. Please see Note 23 “Property and Equipment” to the consolidated financial statements for further information.

 

 


Table of Contents
73   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

Information Required by Industry Guide 3

Please see pages S-1 through S-15 of the Supplemental Financial Information, which pages are incorporated by reference herein, for information required by SEC Industry Guide 3.

Item 4A: Unresolved Staff Comments

We have not received written comments from the Securities and Exchange Commission regarding our periodic reports under the Exchange Act, as of any day 180 days or more before the end of the fiscal year to which this annual report relates, which remain unresolved.

Item 5: Operating and Financial Review and Prospects

Overview

The following discussion and analysis should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements and the related notes to them included in “Item 18: Financial Statements” of this document, on which we have based this discussion and analysis.

We have prepared our consolidated financial statements in accordance with IFRS as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (“IASB”) and as endorsed by the European Union (“EU”).

Significant Accounting Policies and Critical Accounting Estimates

Our significant accounting policies are essential to understanding our reported results of operations and financial condition. Certain of these accounting policies require critical accounting estimates that involve complex and subjective judgments and the use of assumptions, some of which may be for matters that are inherently uncertain and susceptible to change. Such critical accounting estimates could change from period to period and have a material impact on our financial condition, changes in financial condition or results of operations. Critical accounting estimates could also involve estimates where management could have reasonably used another estimate in the current accounting period. Actual results may differ from these estimates if conditions or underlying circumstances were to change. See Note 1 “Significant Accounting Policies and Critical Accounting Estimates” to the consolidated financial statements for a discussion on our significant accounting policies and critical accounting estimates.

We have identified the following significant accounting policies that involve critical accounting estimates:

 

 

the impairment of associates

 

the impairment of financial assets available for sale

 

the determination of fair value

 

the recognition of trade date profit

 

the impairment of loans and provisions for off-balance sheet positions

 

the impairment of goodwill and other intangibles

 

the recognition and measurement of deferred tax assets

 

the accounting for legal and regulatory contingencies and uncertain tax positions

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       74
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

Recently Adopted Accounting Pronouncements and New Accounting Pronouncements

See Note 2 “Recently Adopted and New Accounting Pronouncements” to the consolidated financial statements for a discussion on our recently adopted and new accounting pronouncements.

Operating Results

You should read the following discussion and analysis in conjunction with our consolidated financial statements.

Executive Summary

Please see “Management Report: Operating and Financial Review: Executive Summary” on pages 30 through 32 of the Annual Report 2015.

Trends and Uncertainties

For insight into the trends impacting our performance please see the “Management Report: Operating and Financial Review” section of the Annual Report 2015. Key risks and uncertainties for the Bank are discussed in “Item 3: Key Information – Risk Factors”.

The Bank’s future performance and the implementation of our strategic goals could be influenced by a number of uncertainties. Challenges may arise from sustained market volatility, increasing competitive pressures, weakness of global, regional and national economic conditions and political instability in key markets.

In addition, regulatory and supervisory requirements continue to evolve. Regulatory changes have and may continue to increase our costs, restrict our operations, or require structural change, which could put pressure on our capital position. In addition, we are involved in litigation, arbitration and regulatory proceedings and investigations in Germany and in a number of jurisdictions outside Germany, especially in the U.S. Such matters are subject to many uncertainties.

While we seek to achieve efficiencies in our operations, the results of our operational restructuring and related cost savings and the realization of planned savings are dependent on the successful and timely execution of the measures we have identified Our business segments will be reorganized in 2016 however the operational trend and uncertainties are provided below as per the existing operational structure.

More specifically for CB&S related businesses, operations may continue to be challenged by factors including exposure of global macroeconomic growth to event risks, the potential impact of changes in US and European monetary policy, ongoing regulatory developments and the effects of further balance sheet de-leveraging, litigation charges and expenditures required to comply with regulation.

PBC related businesses may continue to face uncertainties in their operating environment. As a result of the ongoing expansionary monetary policy in the eurozone, we do not expect to experience any relief from the low interest rate environment in the near term. Additional changes in regulatory requirements may further affect overall revenue generation capacity.

For GTB related businesses, uncertainties arise from highly competitive markets and the continued low interest rate environment. Additionally GTB's performance in future periods may also continue to be impacted by increasing cost related to more expansive and rigorous regulatory requirements.

 

 


Table of Contents
75   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

Macroeconomic developments, such as further European sovereign debt issues, emerging market volatility and the changing regulatory environment could negatively impact the future performance of Deutsche AWM related business.

For NCOU, changes in the economic environment and market conditions could create uncertainty in the timeline for our accelerated de-risking strategy. A slowing in the de-risking strategy can create a heightened sensitivity to volatility in risk-weighted asset calculations thereby impacting overall capital delivery in the near term. Further to the uncertainty which arises from the NCOU de-risking strategy, we expect the litigation environment to continue to be challenging.

Performance in Consolidation & Adjustments is primarily impacted by timing differences from different accounting methods used for management reporting and IFRS, plus one-off unallocated items. We still expect volatility from these items in our future results.

Our effective tax rate was mainly impacted by significant non-tax deductible impairments of goodwill and litigation charges. The effective tax rate in future periods could continue to be influenced by the potential occurrence of specific factors.

Results of Operations

Please see “Management Report: Operating and Financial Review: Results of Operations” on pages 39 to 63 of the Annual Report 2015 and our discussion of non-GAAP financial measures in the “Supplementary Information” on pages 438 to 442 of the Annual Report 2015.

Financial Position

Please see “Management Report: Operating and Financial Review: Financial Position” on pages 64 to 67 of the Annual Report 2015.

Liquidity and Capital Resources

For a detailed discussion of our liquidity risk management, see “Management Report: Risk Report: Liquidity Risk” beginning on page 117 of the Annual Report 2015.

For a detailed discussion of our capital management, see “Management Report: Risk Report: Capital Management” on beginning on page 96 of the Annual Report 2015.

Post-Employment Benefit Plans

Please see “Management Report: Employees: Post-Employment Benefit Plans” on page 232 of the Annual Report 2015.

Exposure to Monoline Insurers

Please see “Management Report: Operating and Financial Review: Exposure to Monoline Insurers” on pages 66 to 67 of the Annual Report 2015.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       76
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

For information on the nature, purpose and extent of our off-balance sheet arrangements, please see Note 40 “Structured Entities” to the consolidated financial statements. For further information on off-balance sheet arrangements, including allowances for off-balance sheet positions, please refer to “Management Report: Risk Report: Asset Quality: Allowance for Credit Losses” on pages 167 to 168 of the Annual Report 2015 and Note 20 “Allowance for Credit Losses” to the consolidated financial statements. For information on irrevocable lending commitments and contingent liabilities with respect to third parties, please see Note 30 “Credit related Commitments and Contingent Liabilities” to the consolidated financial statements.

Tabular Disclosure of Contractual Obligations

Please see “Management Report: Operating and Financial Review: Tabular Disclosure of Contractual Obligations” on page 69 of the Annual Report 2015.

Research and Development, Patents and Licenses

Not applicable.

Item 6: Directors, Senior Management and Employees

Directors and Senior Management

In accordance with the German Stock Corporation Act (Aktiengesetz), we have a Management Board (Vorstand) and a Supervisory Board (Aufsichtsrat). The Stock Corporation Act prohibits simultaneous membership on both the Management Board and the Supervisory Board. The members of the Management Board are the executive officers of our company. The Management Board is responsible for managing our company and representing us in dealings with third parties. The Supervisory Board oversees the Management Board, appoints and removes its members and determines their remuneration and other compensation components, including pension benefits. According to German law, our Supervisory Board represents us in dealings with members of the Management Board. Therefore, no members of the Management Board may enter into any agreement with us without the prior consent of our Supervisory Board.

German law does not require the members of the Management Board nor the members of the Supervisory Board to own any of our shares to be qualified. Minimum shareholding policies, however, were implemented in 2013/2014. In addition, German law has no requirement that members of the Management Board retire based on an age limit. However, age limits for members of the Management Board are defined contractually. Age limits also exist for the members of the Supervisory Board according to the Terms of Reference for our Supervisory Board. There is a maximum age limit of 70 years for members of the Supervisory Board. In exceptional cases, a Supervisory Board member can be elected or appointed for a period that extends at the latest until the end of the fourth Ordinary General Meeting that takes place after he/she has turned the age of 70.

 

 


Table of Contents
77   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

The Supervisory Board may not make management decisions. However, German law and our Articles of Association (Satzung) require the Management Board to obtain the approval of the Supervisory Board for certain actions. The most important of these actions are:

 

 

granting general powers of attorney (Generalvollmachten). A general power of attorney authorizes its holder to represent the company in substantially all legal matters without limitation to the affairs of a specific office;

 

acquisitions and disposals (including transactions carried out by a subsidiary) of real estate when the value of the object exceeds 1 % of our regulatory banking capital (haftendes Eigenkapital);

 

granting of credits and the acquisition of participations in other companies, where the German Banking Act requires approval by the Supervisory Board. In particular, the German Banking Act requires the approval of the Supervisory Board if we grant a loan (to the extent legally permissible) to a member of the Management Board or the Supervisory Board or one of our employees who holds a procuration (Prokura) or general power of attorney; and

 

acquisitions and disposals (including transactions carried out by a subsidiary) of other participations, insofar as the object involves more than 2 % of our regulatory banking capital. The Supervisory Board must be informed without delay of any acquisition or disposal of such participations involving more than 1 % of our regulatory banking capital.

The Management Board must submit regular reports or ad-hoc reports, as the case may be, to the Supervisory Board on our current operations and future business planning as well as on our risk situation. The Supervisory Board may also request special reports from the Management Board at any time.

With respect to voting powers, a member of the Supervisory Board or the Management Board may not vote on resolutions open to a vote at a board meeting if the proposed resolution concerns:

 

 

a legal transaction between Deutsche Bank AG and the member; or

 

commencement, settlement or completion of legal proceedings between Deutsche Bank AG and the member.

A member of the Supervisory Board or the Management Board may not directly or indirectly exercise voting rights on resolutions open to a vote at a shareholders’ meeting (Hauptversammlung, which we refer to as the General Meeting) if the proposed resolution concerns:

 

 

ratification of the member’s acts;

 

a discharge of liability of the member; or

 

enforcement of a claim against the member by us.

Supervisory Board and Management Board

In carrying out their duties, members of both the Management Board and Supervisory Board must exercise the standard of care of a prudent and diligent business person, and they are liable to us for damages if they fail to do so. Both boards are required to take into account a broad range of considerations in their decisions, including our interests and those of our shareholders, employees and creditors.

The liability of the members of the Management Board or the Supervisory Board under the German Stock Corporation Act for breach of their fiduciary duties is to the company rather than individual shareholders. However, individual shareholders that hold at least 1 % or  100,000 of the subscribed capital and are granted standing by the court may also invoke such liability to the company. The underlying concept is that all shareholders should benefit equally from amounts received under this liability by adding such amounts to the company’s assets rather than disbursing them to plaintiff shareholders. We may waive the right to claim damages or settle these claims if at least three years have passed since the alleged breach and if the shareholders approve the waiver or settlement at the General Meeting with a simple majority of the votes cast, and provided that opposing shareholders do not hold, in the aggregate, one tenth or more of our share capital and do not have their opposition formally noted in the minutes maintained by a German notary.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       78
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

Supervisory Board

Our Articles of Association require our Supervisory Board to have twenty members. In the event that the number of members on our Supervisory Board falls below twenty, the Supervisory Board maintains its authority to pass resolutions so long as at least ten members participate in the passing of a resolution, either in person or by submitting their votes in writing. If the number of members remains below twenty for more than three months or falls below ten, upon application to a competent court, the court must appoint replacement members to serve on the board until official appointments are made.

The German Co-Determination Act of 1976 (Mitbestimmungsgesetz) requires that the shareholders elect half of the members of the supervisory board of large German companies, such as Deutsche Bank, and that employees in Germany elect the other half. None of the current members of either of our boards were selected pursuant to any arrangement or understandings with major shareholders, customers or others.

Each member of the Supervisory Board generally serves for a fixed term of approximately five years. For the election of shareholder representatives, the General Meeting may establish that the terms of office of up to five members may begin or end on differing dates. Pursuant to German law, the term expires at the latest at the end of the Annual General Meeting that approves and ratifies such member’s actions in the fourth fiscal year after the year in which the Supervisory Board member was elected. Supervisory Board members may also be re-elected. The shareholders may, by a majority of the votes cast in a General Meeting, remove any member of the Supervisory Board they have elected in a General Meeting. The employees may remove any member they have elected by a vote of three-quarters of the employee votes cast.

The members of the Supervisory Board elect the chairperson and the deputy chairperson of the Supervisory Board. Traditionally, the chairperson is a representative of the shareholders, and the deputy chairperson is a representative of the employees. At least half of the members of the Supervisory Board must be present at a meeting or must have submitted their vote in writing to constitute a quorum. In general, approval by a simple majority of the members of the Supervisory Board present and voting is required to pass a resolution. In the case of a deadlock, the resolution is put to a second vote. In the case of a second deadlock, the chairperson has the deciding vote.

For additional information on our Supervisory Board, including a table providing the names of and biographical information for the current members, see “Corporate Governance Statement/Corporate Governance Report: Management Board and Supervisory Board: Supervisory Board” on pages 423 to 428 of the Annual Report 2015.

Standing Committees

For information on the standing committees of our Supervisory Board, please see “Corporate Governance Statement/Corporate Governance Report: Management Board and Supervisory Board: Standing Committees” on pages 428 to 431 of the Annual Report 2015.

The business address of the members of the Supervisory Board is the same as our business address, Taunusanlage 12, 60325 Frankfurt am Main, Germany.

Management Board

Our Articles of Association require the Management Board to have at least three members. Our Management Board currently has ten members. The Supervisory Board has also appointed two Co-Chairmen of the Management Board.

The Supervisory Board appoints the members of the Management Board for a maximum term of five years and oversees them. They may be re-appointed or have their term extended for one or more terms of up to a maximum of five years each. The Supervisory Board may remove a member of the Management Board prior to the expiration of his or her term for good cause.

 

 


Table of Contents
79   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

Pursuant to our Articles of Association, two members of the Management Board, or one member of the Management Board together with a holder of procuration, may represent us for legal purposes. A holder of procuration is an attorney-in-fact who holds a legally defined power under German law, which cannot be restricted with respect to third parties. However, pursuant to German law, the Management Board itself must resolve on certain matters as a whole and may not delegate the decision to one or more individual members. In particular, it may not delegate the determination of our business and risk strategies, and the coordinating or controlling responsibilities. The Management Board is required to ensure that shareholders are treated on an equal basis and receive equal information. The Management Board is also responsible for ensuring our proper business organisation, which includes appropriate and effective risk management as well as compliance with legal requirements and internal guidelines, and for taking the necessary measures to ensure that adequate internal guidelines are developed and implemented.

Other selected responsibilities of the Management Board in accordance with the Terms of Reference (Ge-schäftsordnung) for the Management Board and/or German law are:

 

 

appointing key personnel at the level directly below the Management Board;

 

making decisions regarding significant credit exposures or other risks which have not been delegated to individual risk management units;

 

acquisition and disposal of equity investments, including capital actions in all cases in which (i) the law or our Articles of Association require approval by the Supervisory Board, or (ii) the equivalent of  100 million is exceeded;

 

acquisition and disposal of real estate – directly or by separate legal entities – in all cases in which: (i) the law or our Articles of Association require approval by the Supervisory Board, or (ii) the real estate’s equivalent exceeds  100 million;

 

individual vendor or intra Group-outsourcings (or material changes to those outsourcings) in all cases in which the equivalent of  100 million is exceeded on an annual basis or include the outsourcing of core organisational duties of the Management Board;

 

calling shareholders’ meetings;

 

filing petitions to set aside shareholders’ resolutions;

 

preparing and executing shareholders’ resolutions; and

 

reporting to the Supervisory Board.

For additional information on our Management Board, including the names of and biographical information for the current members, see “Corporate Governance Statement/Corporate Governance Report: Management Board and Supervisory Board: Management Board” on pages 419 to 423 of the Annual Report 2015. The Terms of Reference of the Management Board are published on our website www.db.com/ir/en/documents.htm.

Board Practices of the Management Board

The Terms of Reference for the Management Board are in accordance with the Supervisory Board resolution of December 21, 2015. These Terms of Reference provide that the members of the Management Board have the collective responsibility for managing Deutsche Bank. Notwithstanding this principle, the allocation of functional responsibilities to the individual members of the Management Board and their substitution (in case of temporary absence) are set out in the business allocation plan for the Management Board in accordance with the Supervisory Board resolution of January 27, 2016. The allocation of functional responsibilities does not exempt any member of the Management Board from collective responsibility for the management of the business. The members of the Management Board have primary responsibility for the proper performance and/or delegation of their duties and the clear allocation of accountabilities and responsibilities within the area of own functional responsibility (“Ressort”).

Members of the Management Board are bound to the corporate interest of Deutsche Bank. No member of the Management Board may pursue personal interests in his/her decisions or use business opportunities intended for the company for himself/herself. As permitted by German law, individual members of the Management Board may exercise Deutsche Bank Group-external mandates, honorary offices or special assignments. In order to effectively prevent any conflicts of interest, the members of the Management Board may accept such activities only upon the approval of the

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       80
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

other members of the Management Board and the Chairman’s Committee of the Supervisory Board. Management Board members generally do not accept the chair of supervisory boards of Group-external companies.

Section 161 of the Stock Corporation Act requires that the management board and supervisory board of any German stock exchange-listed company declare annually that the recommendations of the German Corporate Governance Code have been adopted by the company or which recommendations have not been so adopted. These recommendations go beyond the requirements of the Stock Corporation Act. The Management Board and Supervisory Board issued a new Declaration of Conformity in accordance with Section 161 German Stock Corporation Act on October 28, 2015, which is available on our Internet website at www.db.com/ir/en/documents.htm under the heading “Declarations of Conformity”.

For information on the Management Board’s terms of office, please see “Corporate Governance
Statement/Corporate Governance Report: Management Board and Supervisory Board: Management Board” on pages 419 to 423 of the Annual Report 2015. For details of the Management Board’s service contracts providing benefits upon termination, please see “Compensation Report: Pension and Transitional Benefits” and “Compensation Report: Other Benefits upon Premature Termination” on pages 221 to 223 of the Management Report.

Group Executive Committee

Please see “Corporate Governance Statement/Corporate Governance Report: Management Board and Supervisory Board: Group Executive Committee” on page 423 of the Annual Report 2015.

Compensation

For information on the compensation of the members of our Supervisory Board, see “Management Report: Compensation Report: Compensation System for Supervisory Board Members” on pages 225 to 228 of the Annual Report 2015.

For information on the compensation of the members of our Management Board, see “Management Report: Compensation Report: Management Board Report and Disclosure” on pages 202 to 211 of the Annual Report 2015 and “Management Report: Compensation Report: Board Compensation” on pages 212 to 220 of the Annual Report 2015. Additional information on our compensation approach and practices, some of which applies to compensation of the Management Board, is provided in “Management Report: Compensation Report” on pages 188 to 228 of the Annual Report 2015.

Employees

For information on our employees, see “Management Report: Employees” on pages 230 to 231 of the Annual Report 2015.

Share Ownership

For the share ownership of the Management Board, see “Management Report: Compensation Report: Management Board Share Ownership” on pages 224 to 225 of the Annual Report 2015.

For the share ownership of the members of the Supervisory Board, see “Corporate Governance Statement/Corporate Governance Report: Reporting and Transparency: Directors’ Share Ownership” on pages 431 to 432 of the Annual Report 2015.

For a description of our employee share programs, please see Note 35 “Employee Benefits” to the consolidated financial statements.

 

 


Table of Contents
81   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

Item 7: Major Shareholders and Related Party Transactions

Major Shareholders

On December 31, 2015, our issued share capital amounted to  3,530,939,215 divided into 1,379,273,131 no par value ordinary registered shares.

On December 31, 2015, we had 561,559 registered shareholders. 775,314,228 of our shares were registered in the names of 550,399 shareholders resident in Germany, representing 56.21 % of our share capital. 201,455,765 of our shares were registered in the names of 745 shareholders resident in the United States, representing 14.61 % of our share capital.

The German Securities Trading Act (Wertpapierhandelsgesetz) requires investors in publicly-traded corporations whose investments reach certain thresholds to notify both the corporation and the BaFin of such change within four trading days. The minimum disclosure threshold is 3 % of the corporation’s issued voting share capital.

Paramount Services Holdings Ltd., British Virgin Islands, an investment vehicle ultimately beneficially owned and controlled by His Excellency Sheikh Hamad Bin Jassim Bin Jabor Al-Thani, notified us that as of June 25, 2014 it held 5.83 % of our shares. It notified us that as of August 20, 2015 it held 3.05 % of our shares. We have received no further notification by Paramount Services Holdings Ltd., British Virgin Islands, through February 26, 2016.

Supreme Universal Holdings Ltd., Cayman Islands, an investment vehicle ultimately beneficially owned and controlled by His Highness Sheikh Hamad Bin Khalifa Al-Thani, has notified us that as of August 20, 2015 it held 3.05 % of our shares. We have received no further notification by Supreme Universal Holdings Ltd., Cayman Islands, through February 26, 2016.

We understand that the changes in ownership reflected in the two prior paragraphs were the result of a transfer of shares from the Paramount Services Holdings Ltd. to Supreme Universal Holdings Ltd.

BlackRock, Inc., New York, has notified us that as of February 19, 2016 it held 6.79 % of our shares. We have received no further notification by BlackRock, Inc., New York, through February 26, 2016.

We are neither directly nor indirectly owned nor controlled by any other corporation, by any government or by any other natural or legal person severally or jointly.

Pursuant to German law and our Articles of Association, to the extent that we may have major shareholders at any time, we may not give them different voting rights from any of our other shareholders.

We are aware of no arrangements which may at a subsequent date result in a change in control of our company.

Related Party Transactions

We have business relationships with a number of the companies in which we own significant equity interests. We also have business relationships with a number of companies where members of our Management Board also hold positions on boards of directors. Our business relationships with these companies cover many of the financial services we provide to our clients generally. For more detailed information, refer to Note 38 “Related Party Transactions” to the consolidated financial statements.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       82
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

We conduct our business with these companies on terms equivalent to those that would prevail if we did not have equity holdings in them or management members in common, and we have conducted business with these companies on that basis in 2015 and prior years. None of these transactions is or was material to us.

Among our business with related party companies in 2015, there have been and currently are loans, guarantees and commitments, which totaled  789 million (including loans amounting to  309 million) as of December 31, 2015, compared to  806 million (including loans amounting to  318 million) as of December 31, 2014.

All these credit exposures

 

 

were made in the ordinary course of business,

 

were made on substantially the same terms, including interest rates and collateral, as those prevailing at the time for comparable transactions with other persons, and

 

did not involve more than the normal risk of collectability or present other unfavorable features compared to loans to nonrelated parties at their initiation.

We have not conducted material business with parties that fall outside of the definition of related parties but with whom we or our related parties have a relationship that enables the parties to negotiate terms of material transactions that may not be available from other, more clearly independent parties on an arm’s-length basis.

Related Party Impaired Loans

In addition to our other shareholdings, we hold acquired equity interests in some of our clients arising from our efforts to protect our then-outstanding lending exposures to them.

Impaired loans to related parties which may exhibit more than normal risk of collectability or present other unfavorable features compared to performing loans to related parties decreased by  16 million to  3 million, from December 31, 2014, principally driven by a large loan that was impaired as of December 31, 2014 ceasing to be impaired. The following table presents an overview of the impaired loans we hold of some of our related parties as of December 31, 2015.

 

in m.

  Amount
outstanding
as of
December 31,

2015
    Largest amount
outstanding
January 1, to
December 31, 2015
    Provision for
loan losses
in 2015 1
    Allowance for
loan losses as of
December 31, 2015 1
   

Nature of the loan and transaction

in which incurred

Customer A

    1          1          0          1        Uncollateralized shareholder loan bearing interest at 7.55 % per annum. The loan is held at contractual terms but interest is accreted at the effective interest rate applied to the carrying amount.

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

Customer B

    2          2          0          1        Consisting of a claim from a collateralized real estate leasing finance unpaid at maturity, bearing interest at 6.62 % per annum. The exposure is past due and payable, interest is accreted at the effective interest rate applied to the carrying amount.

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

Customer C

    0          4          0          0        Consisting of a claim from a collateralized real estate leasing finance unpaid at maturity, bearing interest at 4,73 % per annum. The exposure is past due and payable, interest is accreted at the effective interest rate applied to the carrying amount.

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

Total

    3         n/a  2        0         1      

 

1 

The allowance for loan losses is calculated by subtracting the net present value of future expected cash flows from the current outstanding. The year-end balance of the loan loss allowance is in most cases lower than the amount of provision for credit losses required for the recognition due to unwinding effects based upon passage of time which are recognized in interest income.

2 

Simply adding the largest amounts outstanding of the individual borrowers during the reporting period to arrive at an aggregate outstanding is not applicable as it would imply the assumption that the largest outstandings for all borrowers occurred simultaneously.

 

 


Table of Contents
83   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

In the above table, customer A is an unconsolidated subsidiary of ours, customers B and C are investments held at equity. Impaired loans to all related party customers have been carried forward from the previous year end.

We have not disclosed the names of the related party customers described above because we have concluded that such disclosure would violate applicable privacy laws, such as customer confidentiality and data protection laws, and those customers have not waived application of these privacy laws. A legal opinion regarding the applicable privacy laws is filed as Exhibit 14.1 hereto.

Interests of Experts and Counsel

Not required because this document is filed as an annual report.

Item 8: Financial Information

Consolidated Statements and Other Financial Information

Consolidated Financial Statements

The Financial Statements of this Annual Report on Form 20-F consist of the Consolidated Financial Statements including Notes 1 to 45 thereto, which are set forth as Part 2 of the Annual Report 2015, and, as described in Note 1 “Significant Accounting Policies and Critical Accounting Estimates” thereto in the third paragraph under “Basis of Accounting”, certain parts of the Management Report set forth as Part 1 of the Annual Report 2015. Such Consolidated Financial Statements have been audited by KPMG AG Wirtschaftsprüfungsgesellschaft, as described in their “Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm” included on page 389 of the Annual Report 2015.

Legal Proceedings

General. We and our subsidiaries operate in a legal and regulatory environment that exposes us to significant litigation risks. As a result, we are involved in litigation, arbitration and regulatory proceedings and investigations in Germany and in a number of jurisdictions outside Germany, including the United States. Please refer to Note 29 “Provisions” to the Consolidated Financial Statements for descriptions of certain significant legal proceedings. Additional legal proceedings that may have, or have had in the recent past, significant effects on our financial position or profitability are described below.

Charter/BMY Matter. On December 8, 2014, the United States Department of Justice (“DOJ”) filed a civil complaint against, among others, Deutsche Bank, alleging that the bank owes more than U.S.$ 190 million in taxes, penalties, and interest relating to two transactions that occurred between March and May 2000. The DOJ’s complaint arises out of Deutsche Bank’s March 2000 acquisition of Charter Corp. (“Charter”) and its subsequent sale in May 2000 of Charter to an unrelated entity, BMY Statutory Trust (the “Trust”). Charter’s primary asset, both at the time of purchase by Deutsche Bank and sale to the Trust, was appreciated Bristol-Myers Squibb Company (“BMY”) stock. When the BMY stock was sold by the Trust, the Trust offset its gain with a loss from an unrelated transaction. The Internal Revenue Service subsequently disallowed the loss on audit exposing the BMY gain to taxation. The IRS assessed additional tax, penalties and interest against the Trust, which have not been paid. Relying on certain theories, including fraudulent conveyance, the DOJ is now seeking to recoup from Deutsche Bank the taxes, plus penalties and interest, owed by the Trust. On September 24, 2015, the court denied Deutsche Bank’s motion to dismiss. Discovery on plaintiff’s claims is ongoing.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       84
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

Corporate Securities Matters. Deutsche Bank and Deutsche Bank Securities Inc. (“DBSI”) regularly act in the capacity of underwriter and sales agent for debt and equity securities of corporate issuers and are from time to time named as defendants in litigation commenced by investors relating to those securities.

Deutsche Bank and DBSI, along with numerous other financial institutions, was sued in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York in various actions in their capacity as underwriters and sales agents for debt and equity securities issued by American International Group, Inc. (“AIG”) between 2006 and 2008. The complaint alleged, among other things, that the offering documents failed to reveal that AIG had substantial exposure to losses due to credit default swaps, that AIG’s real estate assets were overvalued, and that AIG’s financial statements did not conform to GAAP. On March 20, 2015, the court approved a settlement, funded by AIG, and releasing us from all claims.

DBSI, along with numerous other financial institutions, was named as a defendant in a putative class action lawsuit pending in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York relating to alleged misstatements and omissions in the registration statement of General Motors Company (“GM”) in connection with GM’s November 18, 2010 initial public offering (“IPO”). DBSI acted as an underwriter for the offering. On September 4, 2014, the court dismissed all of the plaintiffs’ claims with prejudice. The court also denied plaintiffs’ request for leave to further amend the complaint. On May 28, 2015, the Second Circuit affirmed the dismissal, and on July 9, 2015 the Second Circuit denied en banc review of plaintiffs’ appeal. The time allowed for plaintiffs to further appeal has expired. The underwriters, including DBSI, received a customary indemnification agreement from GM as issuer in connection with the offering.

CO2 Emission Rights. The Frankfurt am Main Office of Public Prosecution (the “OPP”) is investigating alleged value-added tax (VAT) fraud in connection with the trading of CO2 emission rights by certain trading firms, some of which also engaged in trading activity with Deutsche Bank. The OPP alleges that certain employees of Deutsche Bank knew that their counterparties were part of a fraudulent scheme to avoid VAT on transactions in CO2 emission rights, and it searched Deutsche Bank’s head office and London branch in April 2010 and issued various requests for documents. In December 2012, the OPP widened the scope of its investigation and again searched Deutsche Bank’s head office. It alleges that certain employees deleted e-mails of suspects shortly before the 2010 search and failed to issue a suspicious activity report under the Anti-Money Laundering Act which, according to the OPP, was required. It also alleges that Deutsche Bank filed an incorrect VAT return for 2009, which was signed by two members of the Management Board, and incorrect monthly returns for September 2009 to February 2010. Deutsche Bank is cooperating with the OPP. On February 15, 2016, a criminal trial began in the Frankfurt regional court of seven current and former Deutsche Bank employees who are accused of VAT evasion or of aiding and abetting VAT evasion due to their involvement in CO2 emissions trading.

Credit Correlation. On May 26, 2015, the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) issued a cease and desist order in a settled administrative proceeding against Deutsche Bank AG. The matter related to the manner in which Deutsche Bank valued “gap risk” associated with certain Leveraged Super Senior (LSS) synthetic CDO positions during the fourth quarter of 2008 and the first quarter of 2009, which was the height of the financial crisis. Gap risk is the risk that the present value of a trade could exceed the value of posted collateral. During the two quarters at issue, Deutsche Bank did not adjust its value of the LSS trades to account for gap risk, essentially assigning a zero value for gap risk. The SEC found that although there was no standard industry model to value gap risk and the valuation of these instruments was complex, Deutsche Bank did not reasonably adjust the value of the LSS trades for gap risk during these periods, resulting in misstatements of its financial statements for the two quarters at issue. The SEC also found that Deutsche Bank failed to maintain adequate systems and controls over the valuation process. The SEC found violations of Sections 13(a) (requirement to file accurate periodic reports with the SEC), 13(b)(2)(A) (requirement to maintain accurate books and records), and 13(b)(2)(B) (requirement to maintain reasonable internal accounting controls) of the U.S. Securities Exchange Act of 1934. Deutsche Bank paid a U.S.$ 55 million penalty, for which it had previously recorded a provision, and neither admitted nor denied the findings.

 

 


Table of Contents
85   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

Credit Default Swap Antitrust Investigations and Litigation. As previously disclosed, on July 1, 2013, the European Commission (EC) issued a Statement of Objections (the “SO”) against Deutsche Bank, Markit Group Limited (Markit), the International Swaps and Derivatives Association, Inc. (ISDA), and twelve other banks alleging anti-competitive conduct under Article 101 of the Treaty on the Functioning of the European Union (TFEU) and Article 53 of the European Economic Area Agreement (the “EEA Agreement”). The SO alleged that attempts by certain entities to engage in exchange trading of unfunded credit derivatives were foreclosed by improper collective action in the period from 2006 through 2009, which constituted a single and continuous infringement of Article 101 of the TFEU and Article 53 of the EEA Agreement. Deutsche Bank contested the EC’s preliminary conclusions during 2014 and on December 4, 2015, the EC announced the closure without action of its investigation of Deutsche Bank and the twelve other banks (but not Markit or ISDA).

A multi-district civil class action was filed in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York against Deutsche Bank and numerous other credit default swap (CDS) dealer banks, as well as Markit and ISDA. Plaintiffs filed a second consolidated amended class action complaint on April 11, 2014 alleging that the banks conspired with Markit and ISDA to prevent the establishment of exchange-traded CDS, with the effect of raising prices for over-the-counter CDS transactions. Plaintiffs represent a class of individuals and entities located in the United States or abroad who, during a period from January 1, 2008 through December 31, 2013, directly purchased CDS from or directly sold CDS to the dealer defendants in the United States. The second amended class action complaint did not specify the damages sought. Defendants moved to dismiss the second consolidated amended class action complaint on May 23, 2014. On September 4, 2014, the court granted in part and denied in part the motion to dismiss. On September 30, 2015, Deutsche Bank executed a settlement agreement to resolve the matter for U.S.$ 120 million, which is subject to court approval.

Dole Food Company. DBSI and Deutsche Bank AG New York Branch (“DBNY”) were named as co-defendants in a class action pending in Delaware Court of Chancery that was brought by former stockholders of Dole Food Company, Inc. (“Dole”). Plaintiffs alleged that defendant David H. Murdock and certain members of Dole’s board and management (who are also named as defendants) breached their fiduciary duties, and that DBSI and DBNY aided and abetted in those breaches, in connection with Mr. Murdock's privatization of Dole, which closed on November 1, 2013 (the “Transaction”). Trial in this matter concluded on March 9, 2015. On August 27, 2015, the court issued its post-trial decision, which found that (i) DBSI and DBNY were not liable for aiding and abetting breaches of fiduciary duties, and (ii) Mr. Murdock and Dole’s former President, Michael Carter, breached their fiduciary duties to Dole’s stockholders, holding them responsible for damages of approximately U.S.$ 148 million, prior to the application of interest.

On December 7, 2015, Mr. Murdock and the plaintiffs filed with the court a stipulation of settlement, pursuant to which, among other things, (i) Mr. Murdock agreed to make a payment of damages to Dole’s stockholders consistent with the court's decision and (ii) the defendants in the litigation will receive a release from liability with respect to the Transaction, including DBSI and DBNY. In filings dated January 25 and 27, 2016, three purported Dole stockholders objected to the settlement, although two of the three subsequently withdrew their objections. The remaining objector asserted that stockholders who sold their Dole shares after the announcement of the Transaction on June 10, 2013 but prior to the closing of the Transaction on November 1, 2013 should be considered part of the class for purposes of distributing the settlement proceeds. A fairness hearing took place on February 10, 2016 to determine whether the court would approve the stipulation of settlement. At the hearing on February 10, 2016, the court approved the settlement and entered a final order terminating the litigation.

EVAF Matter. RREEF European Value Added Fund I, L.P. (the “Fund” or “EVAF”) is a fund managed by Deutsche Bank’s subsidiary, Deutsche Alternative Asset Management (UK) Limited (the “Manager”). In March 2008, the Fund committed to invest in Highstreet Investment, a consortium that acquired a 49 % stake in the landlord that owned a German department store property portfolio. On September 4, 2015, the Fund (acting through a committee of independent advisers of the General Partner of the Fund, which is also a Deutsche Bank subsidiary) filed (in the English High Court) a claim against the Manager claiming that the Manager's decision to make the Highstreet Investment had been grossly negligent, based in part on an allegation that the investment exceeded the concentration limits set out in the Fund’s Investment Guidelines, and had caused the Fund losses of at least  158.9 million (plus interest), for which the Manager was liable in damages. The parties have filed and served their statements of case setting out their formal

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       86
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

pleaded positions. The Manager has denied acting in a grossly negligent manner and has disputed the Fund’s calculation of alleged losses. A case management conference (CMC) hearing took place on February 12, 2016. The CMC set the timetable for the remainder of the proceedings, up to and including trial (which the court has determined will not take place before April 25, 2017).

ISDAFIX. Deutsche Bank has received requests for information from certain regulatory authorities concerning the setting of ISDAFIX benchmarks, which provide average mid-market rates for fixed interest rate swaps. The Bank is cooperating with these requests. In addition, the Bank has been named as a defendant in five putative class actions that were consolidated in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York asserting antitrust, fraud, and other claims relating to an alleged conspiracy to manipulate the U.S. dollar ISDAFIX benchmark. Plaintiffs filed an amended complaint on February 12, 2015. Defendants filed a motion to dismiss the amended complaint on April 13, 2015, which was fully briefed as of July 15, 2015.

Monte Dei Paschi. In February 2013 Banca Monte Dei Paschi Di Siena (“MPS”) issued civil proceedings in Italy against Deutsche Bank alleging that Deutsche Bank assisted former MPS senior management in an accounting fraud on MPS, by undertaking repo transactions with MPS and “Santorini”, a wholly owned SPV of MPS, which helped MPS defer losses on a previous transaction undertaken with Deutsche Bank. Subsequently, in July 2013, the Fondazione Monte Dei Paschi, MPS’ largest shareholder, also issued civil proceedings in Italy for damages based on substantially the same facts. In December 2013, Deutsche Bank reached an agreement with MPS on the grounds of which the civil proceedings were settled and the transactions were unwound at a discount for MPS. The civil proceedings by the Fondazione Monte Dei Paschi, in which damages of between  120 million and  307 million are claimed, remain pending.

A criminal investigation was launched by the Siena Public Prosecutor into the transactions and certain unrelated transactions entered into by a number of other international banks with MPS. Such investigation was moved in September 2014 from Siena to the Milan Public Prosecutors as a result of a change in the alleged charges being investigated. On February 16, 2016, the Milan Public Prosecutors issued a request of committal to trial against Deutsche Bank AG and six current and former employees. The preliminary hearing before the judge for the preliminary investigation phase (who has to decide whether to adhere to the request of committal to trial or not) is scheduled to take place in March 2016. Separately, Deutsche Bank has also received requests for information from certain regulators relating to the transactions, including with respect to Deutsche Bank’s accounting for the transactions and alleged failures by Deutsche Bank’s management adequately to supervise the individuals involved in the matter. Deutsche Bank is cooperating with these regulators.

Ocala Litigation. Deutsche Bank is a secured creditor of Ocala Funding LLC (“Ocala”), a commercial paper vehicle sponsored by Taylor Bean & Whitaker Mortgage Corp. (“Taylor Bean”), which ceased mortgage lending operations and filed for bankruptcy protection in August 2009. Bank of America is the trustee, collateral agent, custodian and depository agent for Ocala. Deutsche Bank commenced a civil litigation in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York against Bank of America resulting from Bank of America’s failure to secure and safeguard cash and mortgage loans that secured Deutsche Bank’s commercial paper investment. On March 31, 2015, pursuant to the terms of a confidential settlement agreement, Deutsche Bank dismissed the action.

Parmalat Litigation. Following the bankruptcy of the Italian company Parmalat, prosecutors in Parma conducted a criminal investigation against various bank employees, including employees of Deutsche Bank, and brought charges of fraudulent bankruptcy against a number of Deutsche Bank employees and others. The trial commenced in September 2009 and is ongoing, although it is in its final stages and is anticipated will conclude in the course of 2016, possibly in the next few months.

Certain retail bondholders and shareholders have alleged civil liability against Deutsche Bank in connection with the above-mentioned criminal proceedings. Deutsche Bank has made a formal settlement offer to those retail investors who have asserted claims against Deutsche Bank. This offer has been accepted by some of the retail investors. The outstanding claims will be heard during the criminal trial process.

 

 


Table of Contents
87   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

In January 2011, a group of institutional investors (bondholders and shareholders) commenced a civil claim for damages, in an aggregate amount of approximately  130 million plus interest and costs, in the Milan courts against various international and Italian banks, including Deutsche Bank and Deutsche Bank S.p.A., on allegations of cooperation with Parmalat in the fraudulent placement of securities and of deepening the insolvency of Parmalat. On January 26, 2015, the court in Milan dismissed the claim on the merits and awarded costs to the banks. Deutsche Bank has subsequently entered into settlement agreements with the claimants and no further action will be taken.

Pas-de-Calais Habitat. On May 31, 2012, Pas-de-Calais Habitat (“PDCH”), a public housing office, initiated proceedings before the Paris Commercial Court against Deutsche Bank in relation to four swap contracts entered into in 2006, restructured on March 19, 2007 and January 18, 2008 and subsequently restructured in 2009 and on June 15, 2010. PDCH asks the Court to declare the March 19, 2007 and January 18, 2008 swap contracts null and void, or terminated, or to grant damages to PDCH in an amount of approximately 170 million on the grounds, inter alia, that Deutsche Bank committed fraudulent and deceitful acts, manipulated the LIBOR and EURIBOR rates which are used as a basis for calculating the sums due by PDCH under the swap contracts and has breached its obligations to warn, advise and inform PDCH. A decision on the merits is not expected until the second quarter of 2016 at the earliest.

Postbank Voluntary Public Takeover Offer. On September 12, 2010, Deutsche Bank announced the decision to make a takeover offer for the acquisition of all shares in Deutsche Postbank AG. On October 7, 2010, the Bank published the official offer document. In its takeover offer, Deutsche Bank offered to Postbank shareholders a consideration of  25 for each Postbank share.

In November 2010, a former shareholder of Postbank, Effecten-Spiegel AG, which had accepted the takeover offer, brought a claim against Deutsche Bank alleging that the offer price was too low and was not determined in accordance with the applicable law of the Federal Republic of Germany. The plaintiff alleges that Deutsche Bank had been obliged to make a mandatory takeover offer for all shares in Deutsche Postbank AG in 2009 already. The plaintiff avers that, in 2009, the voting rights of Deutsche Post AG in Deutsche Postbank AG had to be attributed to Deutsche Bank AG pursuant to Section 30 of the German Takeover Act.

The Cologne regional court dismissed the claim in 2011 and the Cologne appellate court dismissed the appeal in 2012. The Federal Court set aside the Cologne appellate court’s judgment and referred the case back to the appellate court. In its judgment, the Federal Court stated that the appellate court had not sufficiently considered the plaintiff’s allegation of an "acting in concert" between Deutsche Bank AG and Deutsche Post AG in 2009. The Cologne appellate court heard the chairman of Deutsche Post’s management board as a witness on February 24, 2016. The appelate court will grant the parties the opportunity to comment on the testimony in writing. Thereafter, there will be an additional hearing which is expected to occur in the second quarter of 2016 depending on the availability of the appelate court.

Starting in 2014, some further former shareholders of Deutsche Postbank AG, who accepted the 2010 tender offer, brought similar claims as Effecten-Spiegel AG against Deutsche Bank. The Bank is of the opinion that all these actions, including the action by Effecten-Spiegel AG, are without merit and is defending itself against the claims.

Sebastian Holdings Litigation. Deutsche Bank is in litigation in New York with Sebastian Holdings Inc. ("SHI") in respect of claims arising from FX trading activities in 2008. SHI seeks damages of at least U.S.$ 2.5 billion in an amended complaint filed on January 10, 2011. SHI’s claims and Deutsche Bank’s defences are substantially similar to those in litigation concluded in the UK Commercial Court in November 2013 arising from the same circumstances in which Deutsche Bank was awarded approximately U.S.$ 236 million plus interest and all of SHI’s claims were dismissed. On January 27, 2016, the New York court granted Deutsche Bank’s motion for summary judgment dismissing SHI’s action based on the UK Commercial Court’s judgment. The New York court also denied SHI’s motion for leave to file an amended complaint.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       88
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

In June 2014, Mr. Alexander Vik (SHI's sole shareholder and director) was ordered by the UK Commercial Court personally to pay GBP 34 million by way of an interim award in respect of Deutsche Bank’s costs in the UK litigation, plus a further GBP 2 million in accrued interest. Such sums were paid by Mr. Vik who has since sought to appeal this decision in the UK Court of Appeal, which dismissed his application and refused him permission to appeal.

Trust Preferred Securities Litigation. Deutsche Bank and certain of its affiliates and officers are the subject of a consolidated putative class action, filed in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York, asserting claims under the federal securities laws on behalf of persons who purchased certain trust preferred securities issued by Deutsche Bank and its affiliates between October 2006 and May 2008. The district court dismissed the plaintiffs’ second amended complaint with prejudice, which dismissal was affirmed by the United States Court of Appeals for the Second Circuit. On July 30, 2014, the plaintiffs filed a petition for rehearing and rehearing en banc with the Second Circuit. On October 16, 2014, the Second Circuit denied the petition. In February 2015, the plaintiffs filed a petition for a writ of certiorari seeking review by the United States Supreme Court. On June 8, 2015, the Supreme Court granted plaintiffs’ petition, vacated judgment, and remanded the case to the Second Circuit for further consideration in light of its recent decision in Omnicare, Inc. v. Laborers District Council Construction Industry Pension Fund. On June 16, 2015, Deutsche Bank filed a motion with the Second Circuit requesting leave to submit briefing on the question of whether the Second Circuit’s prior decision in this case is consistent with the Supreme Court’s Omnicare decision. On July 21, 2015, the Court of Appeals remanded the action to the district court for further consideration in light of the Omnicare decision, and denied Deutsche Bank’s motion as moot. Deutsche Bank renewed its motion in the district court. The district court denied Deutsche Bank’s motion as premature and granted plaintiffs leave to file a third consolidated amended complaint by October 15, 2015, with no further extensions. On October 15, 2015, plaintiffs filed their third consolidated amended complaint, wherein plaintiffs allege unquantified but substantial losses in connection with alleged class-member purchases of trust preferred securities. On December 14, 2015, defendants moved to dismiss the third consolidated amended complaint. The motion remains pending.

ZAO FC Eurokommerz. On December 17, 2013, the liquidator of ZAO FC Eurokommerz commenced proceedings in the Arbitrazh Court of the City of Moscow against Deutsche Bank. The claim amounts to approximately  210 million and relates to the repayment of a RUB 6.25 billion bridge loan facility extended to ZAO FC Eurokommerz on August 21, 2007. The bridge loan was repaid in full on December 21, 2007. LLC Trade House, a creditor of ZAO FC Eurokommerz, filed for bankruptcy on July 31, 2009. The liquidator alleges, among other things, (i) that Deutsche Bank must have known that ZAO FC Eurokommerz was in financial difficulties at the time of repayment and (ii) that the bridge loan was repaid from the proceeds of a securitization transaction which was found to be invalid and consequently the proceeds should not have been available to repay the bridge loan. The first instance hearing on the merits of the claim took place on December 23, 2014. The judge found in favor of Deutsche Bank on the basis of the statute of limitations and the absence of evidence to prove that ZAO FC Eurokommerz was in financial difficulties at the time the loan was repaid and that an abuse of rights was committed by Deutsche Bank when accepting the contested repayment. The liquidator did not file a notice of appeal with the court by the applicable deadline and accordingly we regard this matter as closed.

Dividend Policy

Historically, we have generally paid dividends each year. Dividends of  0.75 were paid for 2014 and for 2013. We may not pay dividends in the future at rates we have paid them in previous years. If we are not profitable, we may not pay dividends at all. Accordingly, no dividend is proposed for 2015 and we also do not intend to pay a dividend for 2016. Furthermore, if we fail to meet the capital adequacy requirements or the liquidity requirements under the Banking Act, the BaFin or the European Central Bank may suspend or limit the payment of dividends. See “Item 4: Information on the Company – Regulation and Supervision – Regulation and Supervision in Germany”.

Under German law, our dividends are based on the unconsolidated results of Deutsche Bank AG as prepared in accordance with German accounting rules. Our Management Board, which prepares the annual financial statements of Deutsche Bank AG on an unconsolidated basis, and our Supervisory Board, which reviews them, first allocate part of Deutsche Bank’s annual surplus (if any) to our statutory reserves and to any losses carried forward, as it is legally

 

 


Table of Contents
89   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

required to do. They then allocate the remainder between other revenue reserves (or retained earnings) and balance sheet profit. They may allocate up to one-half of this remainder to other revenue reserves, and must allocate at least one-half to balance sheet profit. A profit distribution from balance sheet profit is only permitted to the extent that the balance sheet profit plus distributable earnings exceeds potential dividend blocking items, which consist of deferred tax assets, self-developed software and unrealized gains on plan assets, all net of respective deferred tax liabilities.

We then distribute the full amount of the balance sheet profit not subject to dividend blocking of Deutsche Bank AG if the Annual General Meeting so resolves. The Annual General Meeting may resolve a non-cash distribution instead of, or in addition to, a cash dividend. However, we are not legally required to distribute our balance sheet profit to our shareholders to the extent that we have issued participatory rights (Genussrechte) or granted a silent participation (stille Gesellschaft) that accord their holders the right to a portion of our distributable profit.

We declare dividends by resolution of the Annual General Meeting and pay them once a year. Dividends approved at a General Meeting are payable on the first stock exchange trading day after that meeting, unless otherwise decided at that meeting. In accordance with the German Stock Corporation Act, the record date for determining which holders of our ordinary shares are entitled to the payment of dividends, if any, or other distributions whether cash, stock or property, is the date of the General Meeting at which such dividends or other distributions are declared.

Significant Changes

Except as otherwise stated in this document, there have been no significant changes subsequent to December 31, 2015.

Item  9: The Offer and Listing

Offer and Listing Details and Markets

Our share capital consists of ordinary shares issued in registered form without par value. Under German law, shares without par value are deemed to have a “nominal” value equal to the total amount of share capital divided by the number of shares. Our shares have a nominal value of  2.56 per share.

The principal trading market for our shares is the Frankfurt Stock Exchange. Our shares are also traded on the six other German stock exchanges (Berlin, Duesseldorf, Hamburg, Hanover, Munich and Stuttgart), on the Eurex and the New York Stock Exchange.

We maintain a share register in Frankfurt am Main and, for the purposes of trading our shares on the New York Stock Exchange, a share register in New York.

All shares on German stock exchanges trade in euros, and all shares on the New York Stock Exchange trade in U.S. dollars. The following table sets forth, for the calendar periods indicated, high, low and period-end prices for our shares as reported by the Frankfurt Stock Exchange and the New York Stock Exchange.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       90
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

    Price per share (Xetra)1     Price per share (NYSE)2  
     High  
(in )  
    Low  
(in )  
    Period-end  
(in )  
    High  
(in U.S.$)  
    Low  
(in U.S.$)  
    Period-end  
(in U.S.$)  
 

Monthly 2016:

           

February

    16.61          13.03          15.99          18.10          14.79          17.19     

January

    22.10          15.97          16.40          23.62          17.61          17.89     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Monthly 2015:

           

December

    24.67          20.69          22.53          26.18          22.83          24.15     

November

    26.20          23.37          24.31          28.82          25.10          25.69     

October

    27.98          23.52          25.47          30.82          26.21          27.95     

September

    27.03          22.95          24.07          30.23          26.05          26.96     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Quarterly 2015:

           

Fourth Quarter

    27.98          20.69          22.53          30.82          22.83          24.15     

Third Quarter

    32.31          22.95          24.07          35.37          26.05          26.96     

Second Quarter

    33.42          26.60          26.95          36.20          29.62          30.16     

First Quarter

    32.90          23.48          32.36          35.49          27.81          34.73     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Quarterly 2014:

           

Fourth Quarter

    28.02          22.66          24.99          35.20          29.35          30.02     

Third Quarter

    28.30          24.17          27.78          36.69          32.52          34.86     

Second Quarter

    32.05          25.47          25.70          46.09          34.83          35.18     

First Quarter

    38.15          29.33          30.97          54.48          42.79          44.83     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Annual:

           

2015

    33.42          20.69          22.53          36.20          22.83          24.15     

2014

    38.15          22.66          24.99          54.48          29.35          30.02     

2013

    36.94          28.05          33.07          52.92          38.18          48.24     

2012

    37.68          21.09          31.43          52.53          27.05          44.29     

2011

    46.45          19.82          28.08          66.00          28.58          37.86     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Note: Data is based on Bloomberg and NYSE Euronext.

1 

Historical share prices have been adjusted on June 5, 2014 with retroactive effect to reflect the capital increase by multiplying a correcting factor of 0.9538.

2 

Historical share prices are not adjusted for the capital increase in June 2014.

For a discussion of the possible effects of fluctuations in the exchange rate between the euro and the U.S. dollar on the price of our shares, see “Item 3: Key Information – Exchange Rate and Currency Information.”

You should not rely on our past share performance as a guide to our future share performance.

Plan of Distribution

Not required because this document is filed as an annual report.

Selling Shareholders

Not required because this document is filed as an annual report.

Dilution

Not required because this document is filed as an annual report.

Expenses of the Issue

Not required because this document is filed as an annual report.

 

 


Table of Contents
91   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

Item 10: Additional Information

Share Capital

Not required because this document is filed as an annual report.

Memorandum and Articles of Association

The following is a summary of certain information relating to certain provisions of our Articles of Association, our share capital and German law. This summary is not complete and is qualified by reference to our Articles of Association and German law in effect at the date of this filing. Copies of our Articles of Association are publicly available at the Commercial Register in Frankfurt am Main, and an English translation is filed as Exhibit 1.1 to this Annual Report.

Our Business Objectives

Section 2 of our Articles of Association sets out the objectives of our business:

 

 

to transact all aspects of banking business;

 

to provide financial and other services; and

 

to promote international economic relations.

Our Articles of Association permit us to pursue these objectives directly or through subsidiaries and affiliated companies.

Our Articles of Association also provide that, to the extent permitted by law, we may transact all business and take all steps that appear likely to promote our business objectives. In particular, we may:

 

 

acquire and dispose of real estate;

 

establish branches in Germany and abroad;

 

acquire, administer and dispose of participations in other enterprises; and

 

conclude intercompany agreements (Unternehmensverträge).

Supervisory Board and Management Board

For more information on our Supervisory Board and Management Board, see “Item 6: Directors, Senior Management and Employees.”

Voting Rights and Shareholders’ Meetings

Each of our shares entitles its registered holder to one vote at our General Meeting. Our Annual General Meeting takes place within the first eight months of our fiscal year. Pursuant to our Articles of Association, we may hold the meeting in Frankfurt am Main, Düsseldorf or any other German city with over 500,000 inhabitants. Unless a shorter period is permitted by law, we must give the notice convening the General Meeting at least 30 days before the last day on which shareholders can register their attendance of the General Meeting (which is the fifth day immediately preceding that General Meeting). We are required to include details regarding the shareholder attendance registration process and the issuance of admission cards in our invitation to the General Meeting.

The Management Board or the Supervisory Board may also call an extraordinary General Meeting. Shareholders holding in the aggregate at least 5 % of the nominal value of our share capital may also request that such a meeting be called.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       92
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

According to our Articles of Association our shares are issued in the form of registered shares. For purposes of registration in the share register, all shareholders are required to notify us of the number of shares they hold and, in the case of natural persons, of their name, address and date of birth and, in the case of legal persons, of their registered name, business address and registered domicile. Both being registered in our share register and the timely registration for attendance of the General Meeting constitute prerequisite conditions for any shareholder’s attendance and exercise of voting rights at the General Meeting. Shareholders may register their attendance of a General Meeting with the Management Board (or as otherwise designated in the invitation) by written notice or electronically, no later than the fifth day immediately preceding the date of that General Meeting. Any shareholders who have failed to comply with certain notification requirements summarized under “Notification Requirements” below are precluded from exercising any rights attached to their shares, including voting rights.

Under German law, upon our request a registered shareholder must inform us whether that shareholder owns the shares registered in its name or whether that shareholder holds the shares for any other person as a nominee shareholder. Both the nominee shareholder and the person for whom the shares are held have an obligation to provide the same personal data as required for registration in the share register with respect to the person for whom the shares are held. For so long as a registered shareholder does not provide the requested information as to its holding of the shares or, in the case of nominee shareholding, the required information about the person for whom the shares are held has not been provided, the shares held by the registered shareholder carry no voting rights.

Shareholders may appoint proxies to represent them at General Meetings. As a matter of German law, a proxy relating to voting rights granted by shares may be revoked at any time.

As a foreign private issuer, we are not required to file a proxy statement under U.S. securities law. The proxy voting process for our shareholders in the United States is substantially similar to the process for publicly held companies incorporated in the United States.

The Annual General Meeting normally adopts resolutions on the following matters:

 

 

appropriation of distributable balance sheet profits (Bilanzgewinn) from the preceding fiscal year;

 

formal ratification of the acts (Entlastung) of the members of the Management Board and the members of the Supervisory Board in the preceding fiscal year; and

 

appointment of independent auditors for the current fiscal year.

A simple majority of votes cast is generally sufficient to approve a measure, except in cases where a greater majority is otherwise required by our Articles of Association or by law. Under the Stock Corporation Act and the German Transformation Act (Umwandlungsgesetz), certain resolutions of fundamental importance require a majority of at least 75 % of the share capital represented at the General Meeting adopting the resolution, in addition to a majority of the votes cast. Such resolutions include the following matters, among others:

 

 

amendments to our Articles of Association changing our business objectives;

 

capital increases that exclude subscription rights;

 

capital reductions;

 

creation of authorized or conditional capital;

 

our dissolution;

 

“transformations” under the German Transformation Act (Umwandlungsgesetz) such as mergers, spin-offs and changes in our legal form;

 

transfer of all our assets;

 

integration of another company; and

 

intercompany agreements (in particular, domination and profit-transfer agreements).

Under certain circumstances, such as when a resolution violates our Articles of Association or the Stock Corporation Act, shareholders may file a shareholder action with the appropriate Regional Court (Landgericht) in Germany to set aside resolutions adopted at the General Meeting.

 

 


Table of Contents
93   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

Under German law, the rights of shareholders as a group can be changed by amendment of the company's articles of association. Any amendment of our Articles of Association requires a resolution of the General Meeting. The authority to amend our Articles of Association, insofar as such amendments merely relate to the wording, such as changes of the share capital as a result of the issuance of shares from authorized capital, has been assigned to our Supervisory Board by our Articles of Association. Pursuant to our Articles of Association, the resolutions of the General Meeting are taken by a simple majority of votes and, insofar as a majority of capital stock is required, by a simple majority of capital stock, except where law or our Articles of Association determine otherwise. The rights of individual shareholders can only be changed with their consent. Amendments to the Articles of Association become effective upon their registration in the Commercial Register.

Share Register

We maintain a share register with Registrar Services GmbH and our New York transfer agent, pursuant to an agency agreement between us and Registrar Services GmbH and a sub-agency agreement between Registrar Services GmbH and the New York transfer agent.

Our share register will be open for inspection by shareholders during normal business hours at our offices at Taunusanlage 12, 60325 Frankfurt am Main, Germany. The share register generally contains each shareholder's surname, first name, date of birth, address and the number or the quantity of our shares held. Shareholders may prevent their personal information from appearing in the share register by holding their securities through a bank or custodian. Although the shareholder would remain the beneficial owner of the securities, only the bank's or custodian's name would appear in the share register.

Dividend Rights

For a summary of our dividend policy and legal basis for dividends under German law, see “Item 8: Financial Information – Dividend Policy.”

Increases in Share Capital

German law and our Articles of Association permit us to increase our share capital in any of three ways:

 

 

Resolution by our General Meeting authorizing the issuance of new shares.

 

Resolution by our General Meeting authorizing the Management Board, subject to the approval of the Supervisory Board, to issue new shares up to a specified amount (no more than 50 % of existing share capital) within a specified period, which may not exceed five years. This is referred to as authorized capital (genehmigtes Kapital).

 

Resolution by our General Meeting authorizing the issuance of new shares up to a specified amount (no more than 50 % of existing share capital) for specific purposes, such as for employee stock options, for use as consideration in a merger or to issue to holders of convertible bonds or other convertible securities. This is referred to as conditional capital (bedingtes Kapital).

The issuance of new ordinary shares by resolution of the General Meeting requires the simple majority of the votes cast and of the share capital represented at the General Meeting. Resolutions of the General Meeting concerning the creation of authorized or conditional capital require the simple majority of the votes cast and a majority of at least 75 % of the share capital represented at the General Meeting.

Liquidation Rights

The Stock Corporation Act requires that if we are liquidated, any liquidation proceeds remaining after the payment of all our liabilities will be distributed to our shareholders in proportion to their shareholdings.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       94
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

Preemptive Rights

In principle, holders of our shares have preemptive rights allowing them to subscribe any shares, bonds convertible into, or attached warrants to subscribe for, our shares or participatory certificates we issue. Such preemptive rights exist in proportion to the number of shares currently held by the shareholder. Preemptive rights of shareholders may be excluded with respect to any capital increase, however, as part of the resolution by the General Meeting on such capital increase. Such a resolution by the General Meeting on a capital increase that excludes the shareholders’ preemptive rights with respect thereto requires both a majority of the votes cast and a majority of at least 75 % of the share capital represented at the General Meeting. A resolution to exclude preemptive rights requires that the proposed exclusion is expressly disclosed in the agenda to the General Meeting and that the Management Board presents the reasons for the exclusion to the shareholders in a written report. Under the Stock Corporation Act, preemptive rights may in particular be excluded with respect to capital increases not exceeding 10 % of the existing share capital with an issue price payable in cash not significantly below the stock exchange price at the time of issuance. In addition, shareholders may, in a resolution by the General Meeting on authorized capital, authorize the Management Board to exclude the preemptive rights with respect to newly issued shares from authorized capital in specific circumstances set forth in the resolution.

Shareholders are generally permitted to transfer their preemptive rights. Preemptive rights may be traded on one or more German stock exchanges for a limited number of days prior to the final day the preemptive rights can be exercised.

Notices and Reports

We publish notices pertaining to our shares and the General Meeting in the electronic German Federal Gazette (Bundesanzeiger) and, when so required, in at least one national newspaper designated for exchange notices.

We send our New York transfer agent, through publication or otherwise, a copy of each of our notices pertaining to any General Meeting, any adjourned General Meeting or our actions with respect to any cash or other distributions or the offering of any rights. We provide such notices in the form given or to be given to our shareholders. Our New York transfer agent is requested to arrange for the mailing of such notices to all shareholders registered in the New York registry.

We will make all notices we send to shareholders available at our principal office for inspection by shareholders. Registrar Services GmbH and our New York transfer agent will send copies of all notices pertaining to General Meetings to all registered shareholders. Registrar Services GmbH and our New York transfer agent will send copies of other notices or information material, such as quarterly reports or shareholder letters, to those registered shareholders who have requested to receive such notices or information material.

Charges of Transfer Agents

We pay Registrar Services GmbH and our New York transfer agent customary fees for their services as transfer agents and registrars. Our shareholders will not be required to pay Registrar Services GmbH or our New York transfer agent any fees or charges in connection with their transfers of shares in the share register. Our shareholders will also not be required to pay any fees in connection with the conversion of dividends from euros to U.S. dollars.

Liability of Transfer Agents

Neither Registrar Services GmbH nor our New York transfer agent will be liable to shareholders if prevented or delayed by law, or any circumstances beyond their control, from performing their obligations as transfer agents and registrars.

 

 


Table of Contents
95   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

Notification Requirements

Disclosure of Interests in a Listed Stock Corporation

Disclosure Obligations under the German Securities Trading Act

Pursuant to the German Securities Trading Act (Wertpapierhandelsgesetz), any shareholder whose voting interest in a listed company like Deutsche Bank AG, through acquisition, sale or by other means, reaches, exceeds or falls below a 3 %, 5 %, 10 %, 15 %, 20 %, 25 %, 30 %, 50 % or 75 % threshold must notify us and the BaFin of its current aggregate voting interest in writing and without undue delay, but at the latest within four trading days. In connection with this requirement, the German Securities Trading Act contains various provisions regarding the attribution of voting rights to the person who actually controls the voting rights attached to the shares.

Furthermore, the voting rights attached to a third party’s shares are attributed to a shareholder if the shareholder coordinates its conduct concerning the listed company with the third party (so-called “acting in concert”) either through an agreement or other means. Acting in concert is deemed to exist if the parties coordinate their voting at the listed company’s general meeting or, outside the general meeting, coordinate their actions with the goal of significantly and permanently modifying the listed company’s corporate strategy. Each party’s voting rights are attributed to each of the other parties acting in concert.

Shareholders failing to comply with their notification obligations are prevented from exercising any rights attached to their shares (including voting rights and the right to receive dividends) until they have complied with the notification requirements. In the event of a willful or grossly negligent breach of the notification obligations, shareholders are prevented from exercising their voting rights for a six-month period commencing upon the delayed submission of the notification, unless the shareholder submitted an incorrect notification deviating no more than 10 % from the actual percentage of voting rights and the shareholder notified the listed company that his or her holdings reached, exceeded or fell below the notification thresholds described above. Non-compliance with the disclosure requirement may also result in a fine.

Except for the 3 % threshold, similar notification obligations exist for reaching, exceeding or falling below the thresholds described above when a person holds either instruments that entitle their holder to unilaterally acquire existing shares of the listed company carrying voting rights or instruments with similar economic effect. Holdings in the relevant financial instruments are to be aggregated with the voting rights attached to shares for purposes of determining whether any of the relevant notification thresholds have been triggered.

Deutsche Bank must publish the foregoing notifications without undue delay, but no later than within three trading days after their receipt, and report the publication to the BaFin.

Shareholders whose voting rights reach or exceed thresholds of 10 % of the voting rights in a listed company, or higher thresholds, are obliged to inform the company within 20 trading days of the purpose of their investment and the origin of the funds used for such investment, unless the articles of association of the listed company provide otherwise. Our Articles of Association do not contain such a provision.

Disclosure Obligations under the German Securities Acquisition and Takeover Act

Pursuant to the German Securities Acquisition and Takeover Act, any person whose voting interest reaches or exceeds 30 % of the voting shares of a listed stock corporation must, within seven calendar days, publish this fact (including the percentage of its voting rights) on the Internet and by means of an electronically operated financial information dissemination system. In addition, the person must subsequently make a mandatory public tender offer within four weeks to all shareholders of the listed company unless an exemption has been granted. The German Securities Acquisition and Takeover Act contains a number of provisions intended to ensure that shareholdings are attributed to those persons who actually control the voting rights attached to the shares. The provisions regarding coordinated conduct as

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       96
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

part of the German Securities Acquisition and Takeover Act (so-called “acting in concert”) and the rules on the attribution of voting rights attached to shares of third parties are the same as the statutory securities trading provisions described above under “Disclosure Obligations under the German Securities Trading Act” except with respect to voting rights of shares underlying instruments whose holders are vested with the right to unilaterally acquire existing voting shares of the listed company or voting rights which may be acquired on the basis of instruments with similar economic effect. If a shareholder fails to provide notice on reaching or exceeding the 30 % threshold, or fails to make a public tender offer, the shareholder will be precluded from exercising any rights associated with its shares (including voting and dividend rights) until it has complied with the requirements under the German Securities Acquisition and Takeover Act. In addition, non-compliance with the disclosure requirement may result in a fine.

Disclosure of Participations in a Credit Institution

The German Banking Act (Kreditwesengesetz) requires any person intending to acquire, alone or acting in concert with another person, a qualifying holding (bedeutende Beteiligung) in a credit or financial services institution to notify the BaFin and the Bundesbank without undue delay and in writing of the intended acquisition. A qualifying holding is a direct or indirect holding in an undertaking which represents 10 % or more of the capital or voting rights or which makes it possible to exercise a significant influence over the management of such undertaking. The required notice must contain information demonstrating, among other things, the reliability of the person or, in the case of a corporation or other legal entity, the reliability of its directors and officers.

A person holding a qualifying holding shall also notify the BaFin and the Bundesbank without undue delay and in writing if he intends to increase the amount of the qualifying holding up to or beyond the thresholds of 20 %, 30 % or 50 % of the voting rights or capital or in such way that the institution comes under such person’s control or if such person intends to reduce the participation below 10 % or below one of the other thresholds described above.

If the qualifying holding notified relates to an interest in a credit institution under the Capital Requirements Regulation (CRR), such as Deutsche Bank AG, the BaFin is not competent to ultimately decide on the acquisition but is required, at least 15 working days prior to expiry of the applicable assessment period, to forward its draft decision to the European Central Bank which ultimately, in accordance with applicable law, is competent to decide upon whether or not to permit the acquisition of the qualifying holding notified.

The competent authority may, within the applicable assessment period of 60 business days, prohibit the intended acquisition if there appears to be reason to assume that the acquirer or its directors and officers are not reliable or financially sound, that the participation would impair the effective supervision of the relevant banking institution, that the prospective managing director (Geschäftsleiter) is not reliable or not qualified, that money laundering or financing of terrorism has occurred or been attempted in connection with the intended acquisition, or that there would be an increased risk of such illegal acts as a result of the intended acquisition. During the applicable assessment period the competent authority may request further information necessary for the assessment. Generally, such a request delays the expiration of the assessment period by up to 20 business days.

If a person acquires a qualifying holding despite such prohibition or without making the required notification, the competent authority may prohibit the person from exercising the voting rights attached to the shares. In addition, non-compliance with the disclosure requirement may result in the imposition of a fine in accordance with statutory provisions. Moreover, the competent authority may order that any disposition of the shares requires its approval and may ultimately appoint a trustee to exercise the voting rights attached to the shares or to sell the shares to the extent they constitute a qualifying holding.

Review of Acquisition of 25 % or more by the German Federal Ministry of Economics and Technology

Pursuant to the German Foreign Trade Act (Außenwirtschaftsgesetz) and the Foreign Trade Regulation (Außenwirtschaftsverordnung), the direct or indirect acquisition of 25 % or more of the voting rights in a German company by

 

 


Table of Contents
97   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

investors from outside the European Union and the European Free Trade Association (Iceland, Liechtenstein, Norway and Switzerland) or by entities which are owned by 25 % or more by investors from outside the aforementioned region may be reviewed by the German Federal Ministry of Economics and Technology. If the Ministry determines that the acquisition poses a threat to the public policy or public security of Germany, it may impose conditions on or suspend the acquisition or require that it is unwound. The decision to review an acquisition must be made within three months following the conclusion of the contract or publication of the decision to launch a take-over bid or publication of the acquisition of control. The review must be completed within two months following receipt of the complete acquisition documents. No notification of the acquisition is required but the acquirer may seek pre-clearance of a proposed acquisition from the Federal Ministry of Economics and Technology.

EU Short Selling Regulation (ban on naked short selling)

Regulation (EU) No 236/2012 of the European Parliament and of the Council of March 14, 2012 on short selling and certain aspects of credit default swaps (the “EU Short Selling Regulation”) came into force on November 1, 2012. The EU Short Selling Regulation, the regulations adopted by the EU Commission implementing it, and the German act implementing the EU Short Selling Regulation replace the previously applicable German federal provisions governing the ban on naked short selling of shares and certain debt securities. (Short sales are sales of securities that the seller does not own, with the intention of buying back an identical security at a later point in time in order to be able to deliver the security. A short sale is “naked” when the seller has not borrowed the securities at the time of the short sale, or ensured they can be borrowed.) Under the EU Short Selling Regulation, short sales of shares are permitted only under certain conditions. Significant net short positions in shares must be reported to the BaFin and, if a certain threshold is exceeded, they must also be publicly disclosed. Net short positions are calculated by netting the long and short positions held by a natural or legal person in the issued capital of the company concerned. The details are set forth in the EU Short Selling Regulation and the regulations adopted by the EU Commission implementing it. In certain situations described in greater detail in the EU Short Selling Regulation, the BaFin is permitted to limit short selling and comparable transactions.

Material Contracts

In the usual course of our business, we enter into numerous contracts with various other entities. We have not, however, entered into any material contracts outside the ordinary course of our business within the past two years.

Exchange Controls

As in other member states of the European Union, regulations issued by the competent European Union authorities to comply with United Nations resolutions have caused freeze orders on assets of certain legal and natural persons designated in such regulations. In addition, Regulation (EU) No. 267/2012 of March 23, 2012, as amended, on restrictive measures against Iran required that certain transfers of funds from or to Iranian persons, entities or bodies that exceed  100,000 (or the equivalent in a foreign currency) must be notified in advance in writing to the Bundesbank. If the amount to be transferred exceeded  400,000 (or the equivalent in a foreign currency), a prior authorization of the Bundesbank was required. These Iran-related measures were repealed on January 16, 2016.

With some exceptions, corporations or individuals residing in Germany are required to report to the Bundesbank any payment received from, or made to or for the account of, a nonresident corporation or individual that exceeds  12,500 (or the equivalent in a foreign currency). This reporting requirement is for statistical purposes.

Subject to the above-mentioned exceptions, there are currently no German laws, decrees or regulations that would prevent the transfer of capital or remittance of dividends or other payments to our shareholders who are not residents or citizens of Germany.

There are also no restrictions under German law or our Articles of Association concerning the right of nonresident or foreign shareholders to hold our shares or to exercise any applicable voting rights. Where the investment reaches or

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       98
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

exceeds certain thresholds, however, certain reporting obligations apply and the investment may become subject to review by the BaFin, the European Central Bank and other competent authorities. For more information see “Item 10: Additional Information – Notification Requirements”.

Taxation

The following is a summary of material German and United States federal income tax consequences of the ownership and disposition of shares for a resident of the United States for purposes of the income tax convention between the United States and Germany (the “Treaty”) who is fully eligible for benefits under the Treaty. A U.S. resident will generally be entitled to Treaty benefits if it is:

 

 

the beneficial owner of shares (and of the dividends paid with respect to the shares);

 

an individual resident of the United States, a U.S. corporation, or a partnership, estate or trust to the extent its income is subject to taxation in the United States in its hands or in the hands of its partners or beneficiaries;

 

not also a resident of Germany for German tax purposes; and

 

not subject to “anti-treaty shopping” articles under German domestic law or the Treaty that apply in limited circumstances.

The Treaty benefits discussed below generally are not available to shareholders who hold shares in connection with the conduct of business through a permanent establishment in Germany. The summary does not discuss the treatment of those shareholders.

The summary does not purport to be a comprehensive description of all of the tax considerations that may be relevant to any particular shareholder, including tax considerations that arise from rules of general application or that are generally assumed to be known by shareholders. In particular, the summary deals only with shareholders that will hold shares as capital assets and does not address the tax treatment of shareholders that are subject to special rules, such as fiduciaries of pension, profit-sharing or other employee benefit plans, banks, insurance companies, dealers in securities or currencies, persons that hold shares as a position in a straddle, conversion transaction, synthetic security or other integrated financial transaction, persons that elect mark-to-market treatment, persons that own, directly or indirectly, 10 % or more of our voting stock, persons that hold shares through a partnership or hybrid entity and persons whose “functional currency” is not the U.S. dollar. The summary is based on German and U.S. laws, treaties and regulatory interpretations, including in the United States current and proposed U.S. Treasury regulations as of the date hereof, all of which are subject to change (possibly with retroactive effect).

Shareholders should consult their own advisors regarding the tax consequences of the ownership and disposition of shares in light of their particular circumstances, including the effect of any state, local or other national laws.

Taxation of Dividends

Dividends that we pay are subject to German withholding tax at an aggregate rate of 26.375 % (consisting of a 25 % withholding tax and a 1.375 % surcharge). Under the Treaty, a U.S. resident will be entitled to receive a refund from the German tax authorities of 11.375 in respect of a declared dividend of 100. For example, for a declared dividend of 100, a U.S. resident initially will receive 73.625 and may claim a refund from the German tax authorities of 11.375 and, therefore, receive a total cash payment of 85 (i.e., 85 % of the declared dividend). For U.S. tax purposes, a U.S. resident will be deemed to have received total dividends of 100. The gross amount of dividends that a U.S. resident receives (which includes amounts withheld in respect of German withholding tax) generally will be subject to U.S. federal income taxation as foreign source dividend income, and will not be eligible for the dividends received deduction generally allowed to U.S. corporations. German withholding tax at the 15 % rate provided under the Treaty will be treated as a foreign income tax that, subject to generally applicable limitations under U.S. tax law, is eligible for credit against a U.S. resident’s U.S. federal income tax liability or, at its election, may be deducted in computing taxable income. Thus, for a declared dividend of 100, a U.S. resident will be deemed to have paid German taxes of 15. A U.S. resident cannot claim credits for German taxes that would have been refunded to it if it had filed a claim for refund. Foreign tax credits will not be allowed for withholding taxes imposed in respect of certain short-term or hedged positions. The creditability

 

 


Table of Contents
99   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                              
       

 

                    

of foreign withholding taxes may be limited in certain situations, including where the burden of foreign taxes is separated inappropriately from the related foreign income.

Subject to certain exceptions for short-term and hedged positions, “qualified dividends” received by certain non-corporate U.S. shareholders will generally be subject to taxation in the United States at a lower rate than other ordinary income. Dividends received will be qualified dividends if we (i) are eligible for the benefits of a comprehensive income tax treaty with the United States that the U.S. Internal Revenue Service (“IRS”) has approved for purposes of the qualified dividend rules and (ii) were not, in the year prior to the year in which the dividend was paid, and are not, in the year in which the dividend is paid, a passive foreign investment company (“PFIC”). The Treaty has been approved for purposes of the qualified dividend rules, and we believe we qualify for benefits under the Treaty. The determination of whether we are a PFIC must be made annually and is dependent on the particular facts and circumstances at the time. It requires an analysis of our income and valuation of our assets, including goodwill and other intangible assets. Based on our audited financial statements and relevant market and shareholder data, we believe that we were not a PFIC for U.S. federal income tax purposes with respect to our taxable years ended December 31, 2014 or December 31, 2015. In addition, based on our current expectations regarding the value and nature of our assets, the sources and nature of our income, and relevant market and shareholder data, we do not currently anticipate becoming a PFIC for our taxable year ending December 31, 2016, or for the foreseeable future. However, the PFIC rules are complex and their application to financial services companies is unclear. Each U.S. shareholder should consult its own tax advisor regarding the potential applicability of the PFIC regime to us and its implications for their particular circumstances.

If a U.S. resident receives a dividend paid in euros, it will recognize income in a U.S. dollar amount calculated by reference to the exchange rate in effect on the date of receipt, regardless of whether the payment is in fact converted into U.S. dollars. If dividends are converted into U.S. dollars on the date of receipt, a U.S. resident generally should not be required to recognize foreign currency gain or loss in respect of the dividend income but may be required to recognize foreign currency gain or loss on the receipt of a refund in respect of German withholding tax to the extent the U.S. dollar value of the refund differs from the U.S. dollar equivalent of that amount on the date of receipt of the underlying dividend.

Refund Procedures

To claim a refund, a U.S. resident must submit, within four years from the end of the calendar year in which the dividend is received, a claim for refund to the German tax authorities together with the original bank voucher (or certified copy thereof) issued by the paying entity documenting the tax withheld. For dividends received after 2011, the claim for refund must be accompanied by a withholding tax certificate (Kapitalertragsteuerbescheinigung) on an officially prescribed form and issued by the institution that withheld the tax.

Claims for refunds are made on a special German claim for refund form (Form E-USA), which must be filed with the German tax authorities: Bundeszentralamt für Steuern, An der Küppe 1, D-53225 Bonn, Germany. The German claim for refund forms may be obtained inter alia from the German tax authorities at the same address where the applications are filed or can be downloaded from the homepage of the Bundeszentralamt für Steuern (www.bzst.bund.de). A U.S. resident must also submit to the German tax authorities a certification (on IRS Form 6166) with respect to its last filed U.S. federal income tax return. Requests for IRS Form 6166 are made on IRS Form 8802, which requires payment of a user fee. IRS Form 8802 and its instructions can be obtained from the IRS website at www.irs.gov. Instead of the individual refund procedure described above, a U.S. resident may use an IT-supported quick-refund procedure (“Datenträgerverfahren – DTV”/“Data Medium Procedure – DMP”). If the U.S. resident’s bank or broker elects to participate in the DMP, it will perform administrative functions necessary to claim the Treaty refund for the beneficiaries. The refund beneficiaries must provide specified information to the DMP participant and confirm to the DMP participant that they meet the conditions of the Treaty provisions and that they authorize the DMP participant to file applications and receive notices and payments on their behalf.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       100
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

The refund beneficiaries also must provide a “certification of filing a tax return” on IRS Form 6166 with the DMP participant. In addition, if the individual refund procedure requires a withholding tax certificate (see above), such certificate is generally also necessary under the DMP.

The German tax authorities reserve the right to audit the entitlement to tax refunds for several years following their payment pursuant to the Treaty in individual cases. The DMP participant must assist with the audit by providing the necessary details or by forwarding the queries to the respective refund beneficiaries/shareholders.

The German tax authorities will issue refunds denominated in euros. In the case of shares held through banks or brokers participating in the Depository Trust Company, the refunds will be issued to the Depository Trust Company, which will convert the refunds to U.S. dollars. The resulting amounts will be paid to banks or brokers for the account of holders.

If a U.S. resident holds its shares through a bank or broker who elects to participate in the DMP, it could take at least three weeks for it to receive a refund after a combined claim for refund has been filed with the German tax authorities. If a U.S. resident files a claim for refund directly with the German tax authorities, it could take at least eight months for it to receive a refund. The length of time between filing a claim for refund and receipt of that refund is uncertain and we can give no assurances as to when any refund will be received.

Taxation of Capital Gains

Under the Treaty, a U.S. resident will not be subject to German capital gains tax in respect of a sale or other disposition of shares. For U.S. federal income tax purposes, a U.S. holder will recognize capital gain or loss on the sale or other disposition of shares in an amount equal to the difference between such holder’s tax basis in the shares and the U.S. dollar value of the amount realized from their sale or other disposition. Such gain or loss will be capital gain or loss and will be long-term capital gain or loss if the shares were held for more than one year. The net amount of long-term capital gain realized by an individual generally is subject to taxation at a lower rate than ordinary income. Any such gain generally would be treated as income arising from sources within the United States; any such loss would generally be allocated against U.S. source income. The ability to offset capital losses against ordinary income is subject to limitations.

Shareholders whose shares are held in an account with a German bank or financial services institution (including a German branch of a non-German bank or financial services institution) are urged to consult their own advisors. This summary does not discuss their particular tax situation.

United States Information Reporting and Backup Withholding

Dividends and payments of the proceeds on a sale of shares, paid within the United States or through certain U.S.-related financial intermediaries are subject to information reporting and may be subject to backup withholding unless the U.S. resident (i) is a corporation (other than an S corporation) or other exempt recipient or (ii) provides a taxpayer identification number and certifies (on IRS Form W-9) that no loss of exemption from backup withholding has occurred. Shareholders that are not U.S. persons generally are not subject to information reporting or backup withholding.

However, a non-U.S. person may be required to provide a certification (generally on IRS Form W-8BEN or W-8BEN-E) of its non-U.S. status in connection with payments received in the United States or through a U.S.-related financial intermediary.

Backup withholding tax is not an additional tax, and any amounts withheld under the backup withholding rules will be allowed as a refund or a credit against a holder’s U.S. federal income tax liability, provided the required information is furnished to the IRS.

Shareholders may be subject to other U.S. information reporting requirements. Shareholders should consult their own advisors regarding the application of U.S. information reporting rules in light of their particular circumstances.

 

 


Table of Contents
101   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

German Gift and Inheritance Taxes

Under the current estate, inheritance and gift tax treaty between the United States and Germany (the “Estate Tax Treaty”), a transfer of shares generally will not be subject to German gift or inheritance tax so long as the donor or decedent, and the heir, donee or other beneficiary, were not domiciled in Germany for purposes of the Estate Tax Treaty at the time the gift was made, or at the time of the decedent’s death, and the shares were not held in connection with a permanent establishment or fixed base in Germany.

The Estate Tax Treaty provides a credit against U.S. federal estate and gift tax liability for the amount of inheritance and gift tax paid in Germany, subject to certain limitations, where shares are subject to German inheritance or gift tax and United States federal estate or gift tax.

Other German Taxes

There are presently no German net wealth, transfer, stamp or other similar taxes that would apply to a U.S. resident as a result of the receipt, purchase, ownership or sale of shares.

Dividends and Paying Agents

Not required because this document is filed as an annual report.

Statement by Experts

Not required because this document is filed as an annual report.

Documents on Display

We are subject to the informational requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended. In accordance with these requirements, we file reports and other information with the Securities and Exchange Commission. You may inspect and copy these materials, including this document and its exhibits, at the Commission’s Public Reference Room at 100 F Street, N.E., Room 1580, Washington, D.C. 20549. You may also obtain copies of the materials from the Public Reference Room at prescribed rates. You may obtain information on the operation of the Commission’s Public Reference Room by calling the Commission in the United States at 1-800-SEC-0330. Our Securities and Exchange Commission filings are also available over the Internet at the Securities and Exchange Commission’s website at www.sec.gov under File Number 001-15242.

Subsidiary Information

Not applicable.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       102
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

Item 11: Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Credit, Market and Other Risk

For Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Credit, Market and Other Risk, please see “Management Report: Risk Report” beginning on page 79 of the Annual Report 2015.

Please see pages S-1 through S-15 of the Supplemental Financial Information, which pages are incorporated by reference herein, for information required by SEC Industry Guide 3.

Item 12: Description of Securities other than Equity Securities

Not required because this document is filed as an annual report and our ordinary shares are not represented by American Depositary Receipts.

 

 


Table of Contents
103   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

PART II

Item 13: Defaults, Dividend Arrearages and Delinquencies

Not applicable.

Item 14: Material Modifications to the Rights of Security Holders and Use of Proceeds

Not applicable.

Item 15: Controls and Procedures

Disclosure Controls and Procedures

An evaluation was carried out under the supervision and with the participation of our management, including our Co-Chairmen and Chief Financial Officer, of the effectiveness of the design and operation of our disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rule 13a-15(e) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934) as of December 31, 2015. There are, as described below, inherent limitations to the effectiveness of any control system, including disclosure controls and procedures. Accordingly, even effective disclosure controls and procedures can provide only reasonable assurance of achieving their control objectives. Based upon such evaluation, our Co-Chairmen and Chief Financial Officer concluded that the design and operation of our disclosure controls and procedures were effective as of December 31, 2015.

Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting

Management of Deutsche Bank Aktiengesellschaft, together with its consolidated subsidiaries, is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting. Our internal control over financial reporting is a process designed under the supervision of our co-principal executive officers and our principal financial officer to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of the firm’s financial statements for external reporting purposes in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board and as endorsed by the European Union. As of December 31, 2015, management conducted an assessment of the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting based on the framework established in Internal Control – Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). Based on the assessment performed, management has determined that our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2015 was effective based on the COSO framework (2013).

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       104
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

KPMG AG Wirtschaftsprüfungsgesellschaft, the registered public accounting firm that audited the financial statements included in this document, has issued an attestation report on our internal control over financial reporting, which attestation report is set forth below.

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

To the Supervisory Board of

Deutsche Bank Aktiengesellschaft:

We have audited Deutsche Bank Aktiengesellschaft and subsidiaries’ (the “Company” or “Deutsche Bank”) internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2015, based on criteria established in Internal Control – Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying ‘Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting’. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audit also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

A company's internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company's internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

In our opinion, Deutsche Bank maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2015, based on criteria established in Internal Control – Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO).

 

 


Table of Contents
105   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated balance sheets of Deutsche Bank Aktiengesellschaft and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, and the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, changes in equity, and cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2015, and the related notes, and the specific disclosures described in Note 1 to the consolidated financial statements as being part of the financial statements and our report dated March 2, 2016 expressed an unqualified opinion on those consolidated financial statements.

Frankfurt am Main, Germany

March 2, 2016

KPMG AG

Wirtschaftsprüfungsgesellschaft

Change in Internal Control over Financial Reporting

There was no change in our internal control over financial reporting identified in connection with the evaluation referred to above that occurred during the year ended December 31, 2015 that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.

A control system, no matter how well conceived and operated, can provide only reasonable, not absolute, assurance that the objectives of the control system are met. As such, disclosure controls and procedures or systems for internal control over financial reporting may not prevent all error and all fraud. Further, the design of a control system must reflect the fact that there are resource constraints, and the benefits of controls must be considered relative to their costs. Because of the inherent limitations in all control systems, no evaluation of controls can provide absolute assurance that all control issues and instances of fraud, if any, within the company have been detected. These inherent limitations include the realities that judgments in decision-making can be faulty, and that breakdowns can occur because of simple error or mistake. Additionally, controls can be circumvented by the individual acts of some persons, by collusion of two or more people, or by management override of the control. The design of any system of controls also is based in part upon certain assumptions about the likelihood of future events, and any design may not succeed in achieving its stated goals under all potential future conditions; over time, control may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate. Because of the inherent limitations in a cost-effective control system, misstatements due to error or fraud may occur and not be detected.

Item 16A: Audit Committee Financial Expert

Please see “Management Report: Corporate Governance Statement/Corporate Governance Report: Auditing and Controlling: Audit Committee Financial Expert” on page 432 of the Annual Report 2015.

Item 16B: Code of Ethics

Please see “Management Report: Corporate Governance Statement/Corporate Governance Report: Auditing and Controlling: Code of Business Conduct and Ethics” on page 433 of the Annual Report 2015.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       106
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

Item 16C: Principal Accountant Fees and Services

Please see “Management Report: Corporate Governance Statement/Corporate Governance Report: Auditing and Controlling: Principal Accountant Fees and Services” on pages 433 and 434 of the Annual Report 2015.

Item 16D: Exemptions from the Listing Standards for Audit Committees

Our common shares are listed on the New York Stock Exchange, the corporate governance rules of which require a foreign private issuer such as us to have an audit committee that satisfies the requirements of Rule 10A-3 under the U.S. Securities Exchange Act of 1934. These requirements include a requirement that the audit committee be composed of members that are “independent” of the issuer, as defined in the Rule, subject to certain exemptions, including an exemption for employees who are not executive officers of the issuer if the employees are elected or named to the board of directors or audit committee pursuant to the issuer’s governing law or documents, an employee collective bargaining or similar agreement or other home country legal or listing requirements. The German Co-Determination Act of 1976 (Mitbestimmungsgesetz) requires that the shareholders elect half of the members of the supervisory board of large German companies, such as us, and that employees in Germany elect the other half. Employee-elected members are typically themselves employees or representatives of labor unions representing employees. Pursuant to law and practice, committees of the Supervisory Board are typically composed of both shareholder- and employee-elected members. Of the current members of our Audit Committee, three – Henriette Mark, Gabriele Platscher and Bernd Rose – are current employees of Deutsche Bank who have been elected as Supervisory Board members by the employees. None of them is an executive officer. Accordingly, their service on the Audit Committee is permissible pursuant to the exemption from the independence requirements provided for by paragraph (b)(1)(iv)(C) of the Rule. We do not believe the reliance on such exemption would materially adversely affect the ability of the Audit Committee to act independently and to satisfy the other requirements of the Rule.

Item 16E: Purchases of Equity Securities by the Issuer and Affiliated Purchasers

In 2015, we repurchased a total of 29,016,156 shares, of which 4.7 million via derivatives, for group purposes pursuant to share buybacks authorized by the General Meeting. During the period from January 1, 2015 until the 2015 Annual General Meeting on May 21, 2015, we repurchased 8,360,000, of which 0.0 million via derivatives, of our ordinary shares pursuant to the authorization granted by the Annual General Meeting on May 22, 2014, at an average price of  26.51 and for a total consideration of  222 million. This authorization was replaced by a new authorization to buy back shares approved by the Annual General Meeting on May 21, 2015. Under the new authorization, up to 137,927,313 shares may be repurchased through April 30, 2020. Of these, 68,963,657 shares may be purchased by using derivatives. During the period from the 2015 Annual General Meeting until December 31, 2015, we repurchased 20,656,156 shares at an average price of  29.06 and for a total consideration of  600 million (excluding option premium). At December 31, 2015, the number of shares held in Treasury from buybacks totaled 296,192 shares. This figure stems from 101,034 shares at the beginning of the year, plus 29.0 million shares from buybacks in 2015, less 28.8 million shares which were used to fulfill delivery obligations in the course of share-based compensation of employees. We did not cancel any shares in 2015.

 

 


Table of Contents
107   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

In addition to these share buybacks for group purposes, pursuant to a shareholder authorization approved at our 2015 Annual General Meeting, we are authorized to buy and sell, for the purpose of securities trading, our ordinary shares through April 30, 2020, provided that the net number of shares held for this purpose at the close of any trading day may not exceed 5 % of our share capital on that day. The gross volume of these securities trading transactions is often large, and even the net amount of such repurchases or sales may, in a given month, be large, though over longer periods of time such transactions tend to offset and are in any event constrained by the 5 % of share capital limit. These securities trading transactions consist predominantly of transactions on major non-U.S. securities exchanges. We also enter into derivative contracts with respect to our shares.

The following table sets forth, for each month in 2015 and for the year as a whole, the total gross number of our shares repurchased by us and our affiliated purchasers (pursuant to both activities described above), the total gross number of shares sold, the net number of shares purchased or sold, the average price paid per share (based on the gross shares repurchased), the number of shares that were purchased for group purposes mentioned above and the maximum number of shares that at that date remained eligible for purchase under such programs.

Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities in 2015

 

Month

   Total number of  
shares  
purchased  
     Total number of  
shares sold  
     Net number of  
shares  
purchased or  
(sold) 
    Average price  
paid per share  
(in )  
     Number of  
shares  

purchased  for  
group purposes  
(incl. derivatives)  
     Maximum  
number of  
shares that may  
yet be  purchased  

under plans or  
programs  
 

January

     21,517,309           18,566,921           2,950,388          25.18           2,900,000           81,801,964     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

February

     48,576,343           51,320,581           (2,744,238 )       27.30           5,460,000           76,341,964     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

March

     25,492,875           25,559,162           (66,287 )       30.34           0           76,341,964     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

April

     33,745,218           33,763,988           (18,770 )       31.72           0           76,341,964     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

May

     27,933,813           27,962,776           (28,963 )       28.75           0           137,927,313     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

June

     24,925,806           24,940,380           (14,574 )       27.73           0           137,927,313     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

July

     60,268,804           42,118,554           18,150,250          29.53           18,194,999           119,732,341     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

August

     29,321,538           47,010,293           (17,688,755 )       29.21           2,461,157           117,271,157     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

September

     19,608,298           19,577,497           30,801          25.38           0           117,271,157     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

October

     9,330,203           9,538,806           (208,603 )       26.02           0           117,271,157     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

November

     6,358,249           6,573,242           (214,993 )       24.59           0           117,271,157     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

December

     19,568,552           19,600,126           (31,574 )       22.41           0           117,271,157     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total 2015

     326,647,008           326,532,326           114,682          28.10           29,016,156           117,271,157     

 

 

At December 31, 2015, our issued share capital consisted of 1,379,273,131 ordinary shares, of which 1,378,898,267 were outstanding and 374,864 were held by us in treasury.

Item 16F: Change in Registrant’s Certifying Accountant

Not applicable.

Item 16G: Corporate Governance

Our common shares are listed on the New York Stock Exchange, as well as on all seven German stock exchanges. Set forth below is a description of the significant ways in which our corporate governance practices differ from those applicable to U.S. domestic companies under the New York Stock Exchange’s listing standards as set forth in its Listed Company Manual (the “NYSE Manual”).

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       108
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

The Legal Framework. Corporate governance principles for German stock corporations (Aktiengesellschaften) are set forth in the German Stock Corporation Act (Aktiengesetz), the German Co-Determination Act of 1976 (Mitbestimmungsgesetz) and the German Corporate Governance Code (Deutscher Corporate Governance Kodex, referred to as the Code).

The Two-Tier Board System of a German Stock Corporation. The Stock Corporation Act provides for a clear separation of management and oversight functions. It therefore requires German stock corporations to have both a Supervisory Board (Aufsichtsrat) and a Management Board (Vorstand). These boards are separate; no individual may be a member of both. Both the members of the Management Board and the members of the Supervisory Board must exercise the standard of care of a diligent business person to the company. In complying with this standard of care they are required to take into account a broad range of considerations, including the interests of the company and those of its shareholders, employees and creditors.

The Management Board is responsible for managing the company and representing the company in its dealings with third parties. The Management Board is also required to ensure appropriate risk management within the corporation and to establish an internal monitoring system. The members of the Management Board, including its chairperson or speaker, are regarded as peers and share a collective responsibility for all management decisions.

The Supervisory Board appoints and removes the members of the Management Board. It also may appoint a chairperson of the Management Board. Although it is not permitted to make management decisions, the Supervisory Board has comprehensive monitoring functions with respect to the activities of the Management Board, including advising the Management Board and participating in decisions of fundamental importance to the company. To ensure that these monitoring functions are carried out properly, the Management Board must, among other things, regularly report to the Supervisory Board with regard to current business operations and business planning, including any deviation of actual developments from concrete and material targets previously presented to the Supervisory Board. The Supervisory Board may also request special reports from the Management Board at any time. Transactions of fundamental importance to the company, such as major strategic decisions or other actions that may have a fundamental impact on the company’s assets and liabilities, financial condition or results of operations, may be subject to the consent of the Supervisory Board. Pursuant to our Articles of Association (Satzung), such transactions include the granting of powers of attorney without limitation to the affairs of a specific office, major acquisitions or disposals of real estate or participations in companies and granting of loans and acquiring participations if the Banking Act (Kreditwesengesetz) requires approval by the Supervisory Board.

Pursuant to the Co-Determination Act, our Supervisory Board consists of representatives elected by the shareholders and representatives elected by the employees in Germany. Based on the total number of Deutsche Bank employees in Germany these employees have the right to elect one-half of the total of twenty Supervisory Board members. The chairperson of the Supervisory Board of Deutsche Bank is a shareholder representative who has the deciding vote in the event of a tie.

This two-tier board system contrasts with the unitary board of directors envisaged by the relevant laws of all U.S. states and the New York Stock Exchange listing standards for U.S. companies.

German companies which have their shares listed on a stock exchange must report each year on the company’s corporate governance in their annual report to shareholders.

The Recommendations of the Code. The Code was issued in 2002 by a commission composed of German corporate governance experts appointed by the German Federal Ministry of Justice in 2001. The Code was last amended in May 2015 and, as a general rule, will be reviewed annually and amended if necessary to reflect international corporate governance developments. The Code describes and summarizes the basic mandatory statutory corporate governance principles found in the provisions of German law. In addition, it contains supplemental recommendations and suggestions for standards on responsible corporate governance intended to reflect generally accepted best practice.

 

 


Table of Contents
109   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

The Code addresses six core areas of corporate governance. These are (1) shareholders and shareholders’ meetings, (2) the cooperation between the Management Board and the Supervisory Board, (3) the Management Board, (4) the Supervisory Board, (5) transparency and (6) financial reporting and audits.

The Code contains three types of provisions. First, the Code describes and summarizes the existing statutory, i.e., legally binding, corporate governance framework set forth in the Stock Corporation Act and in other German laws. Those laws – and not the incomplete and abbreviated summaries of them reflected in the Code – must be complied with. The second type of provisions is recommendations. While these are not legally binding, Section 161 of the Stock Corporation Act requires that any German exchange-listed company declare annually that the recommendations of the Code have been adopted by it or which recommendations have not been adopted. The third type of Code provisions comprises suggestions which companies may choose not to adopt without disclosure. The Code contains a significant number of such suggestions, covering almost all of the core areas of corporate governance it addresses.

In their last Declaration of Conformity of October 28, 2015, the Management Board and the Supervisory Board of Deutsche Bank stated that they will act in conformity with the recommendations of the Code, with certain specified exceptions. The Declaration of Conformity is available on Deutsche Bank’s internet website at www.db.com/ir/en/documents.htm.

Supervisory Board Committees. The Supervisory Board may form committees. The Co-Determination Act requires that the Supervisory Board form a mediation committee to propose candidates for the Management Board in the event that the two-thirds majority of the members of the Supervisory Board needed to appoint members of the Management Board is not met.

The Stock Corporation Act specifically mentions the possibility to establish an “audit committee” to handle issues of accounting and risk management, compliance, auditor independence, the engagement and compensation of outside auditors appointed by the shareholders’ meeting and the determination of auditing focal points. The Code recommends establishing such an “audit committee”. Since 2007 the Code also recommends establishing a “nomination committee” comprised only of shareholder elected Supervisory Board members to prepare the Supervisory Board’s proposals for the election or appointment of new shareholder representatives to the Supervisory Board. The Code also includes suggestions on the subjects that may be handled by Supervisory Board committees, including corporate strategy, compensation of the members of the Management Board, investments and financing. Under the Stock Corporation Act, any Supervisory Board committee must regularly report to the Supervisory Board. Sections 25d (7) to (12) of the German Banking Act require, depending on size and complexity of the respective credit institution, the establishment of Supervisory Board committees with specific tasks to be performed as follows: Risk Committee (Section 25d (8)), Audit Committee (Section 25d (9)), Nomination Committee (with different tasks and composition requirements than under the Code) (Section 25d (11)) and Compensation Control Committee (Section 25d (12)).

The Supervisory Board of Deutsche Bank has established a Chairman’s Committee (Präsidialausschuss) which is responsible for conclusion, amendment and termination of employment and pension contracts in consideration of the plenary Supervisory Board’s sole authority to decide on the remuneration of the members of the Management Board, a Nomination Committee (Nominierungsausschuss), an Audit Committee (Prüfungsausschuss), a Risk Committee (Risikoausschuss), an Integrity Committee (Integritätsausschuss), a Compensation Control Committee (Vergütungskontrollausschuss) and the required Mediation Committee (Vermittlungsausschuss). The functions of a nominating/corporate governance committee and of a compensation committee required by the NYSE Manual for U.S. companies listed on the NYSE are therefore performed by the Supervisory Board or one of its committees, in particular the Chairman’s Committee, the Compensation Control Committee and the Mediation Committee.

Independent Board Members. The NYSE Manual requires that a majority of the members of the board of directors of a NYSE listed U.S. company and each member of its nominating/corporate governance, compensation and audit committees be “independent” according to strict criteria and that the board of directors determines that such member has no material direct or indirect relationship with the company.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       110
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

As a foreign private issuer, Deutsche Bank is not subject to these requirements. However, its audit committee must meet the more lenient independence requirement of Rule 10A-3 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. German corporate law does not require an affirmative independence determination, meaning that the Supervisory Board need not make affirmative findings that audit committee members are independent. However, the Stock Corporation Act requires that at least one member of the supervisory board or, if an audit committee is established, such audit committee, must be independent and have expertise in accounting and audit matters, unless all members have been appointed before May 29, 2009. Moreover, both the Stock Corporation Act and the Code contain several rules, recommendations and suggestions to ensure the Supervisory Board’s independent advice to, and supervision of, the Management Board. As noted above, no member of the Management Board may serve on the Supervisory Board (and vice versa). Supervisory Board members will not be bound by directions or instructions from third parties. Any advisory, service or similar contract between a member of the Supervisory Board and the company is subject to the Supervisory Board’s approval. A similar requirement applies to loans granted by the company to a Supervisory Board member or other persons, such as certain members of a Supervisory Board member’s family. In addition, the Stock Corporation Act prohibits a person who within the last two years was a member of the management board from becoming a member of the supervisory board of the same company unless he or she is elected upon the proposal of shareholders holding more than 25 % of the voting rights of the company.

The Code also recommends that each member of the Supervisory Board inform the Supervisory Board of any conflicts of interest which may result from a consulting or directorship function with clients, suppliers, lenders or other business partners of the stock corporation. In the case of material conflicts of interest or ongoing conflicts, the Code recommends that the mandate of the Supervisory Board member be removed by the shareholders’ meeting. The Code further recommends that any conflicts of interest that have occurred be reported by the Supervisory Board at the Annual General Meeting, together with the action taken, and that potential conflicts of interest also be taken into account in the nomination process for the election of Supervisory Board members.

Audit Committee Procedures. Pursuant to the NYSE Manual the audit committee of a U.S. company listed on the NYSE must have a written charter addressing its purpose, an annual performance evaluation, and the review of an auditor’s report describing internal quality control issues and procedures and all relationships between the auditor and the company. The Audit Committee of Deutsche Bank operates under written terms of reference and reviews the efficiency of its activities regularly.

Disclosure of Corporate Governance Guidelines. Deutsche Bank discloses its Articles of Association, the Terms of Reference of its Management Board, its Supervisory Board, the Chairman’s Committee, the Audit Committee, the Risk Committee, the Integrity Committee, the Compensation Control Committee and the Nomination Committee, its Declaration of Conformity under the Code and other documents pertaining to its corporate governance on its internet website at www.db.com/ir/en/documents.htm.

Item 16H: Mine Safety Disclosure

Not applicable.

 

 


Table of Contents
111   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

Disclosures Under Iran Threat Reduction and Syria Human Rights Act of 2012

Under Section 219 of the Iran Threat Reduction and Syria Human Rights Act of 2012, which added
Section 13(r) of the U.S. Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, an issuer of securities registered under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 is required to disclose in its periodic reports filed under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 certain of its activities and those of its affiliates relating to Iranian government-controlled entities and to other persons sanctioned by the U.S. under programs relating to terrorism and proliferation of weapons of mass destruction that occurred during the period covered by the report. We describe below a number of potentially disclosable activities of Deutsche Bank AG and its affiliates. Disclosure is generally required regardless of whether the activities, transactions or dealings were conducted in compliance with applicable law. Following the occurrence on January 16, 2016 of “Implementation Day” of the Joint Comprehensive Plan of Action (JCPoA) between the “P5+1” parties and Iran, pursuant to which Iran agreed to limits on its nuclear program and the P5+1 parties agreed to provide certain sanctions relief, secondary sanctions targeting Iran have been narrowed but not eliminated.

Legacy Financing Arrangements. Despite having ceased entering into new business in or with Iran in 2007, we continue to be engaged as lender, sponsoring bank and/or facility agent or arranger in several long-term financing agreements relating to the construction or acquisition of plant or equipment for the petroleum and petrochemical industries, under which Iranian entities were the direct or indirect borrowers. Before 2007, as part of banking consortia, we entered into a number of financing arrangements, three of which remained outstanding as of December 31, 2015, with the National Petrochemical Company (NPC). The latest final maturity under these loan facilities is in 2019. These loan facilities were guaranteed by national export credit agencies representing two European governments. In principle, the obligations of the borrowers under these loan facilities are secured by assignments of receivables from oil and oil products exported by NPC and/or its trading subsidiaries to buyers, mostly in Asia. These delivery obligations, however, were waived for the period covered by this report, because of the sanctions environment at that time. For some of these arrangements, we act as escrow agent, holding escrow accounts for the Iranian borrowers mentioned above, into which receivables are, in principle, paid by the buyers of the oil and oil products. During the period covered by this report, no such receivables were paid to the said escrow accounts. Such accounts are pledged in favor of the relevant banking consortium. We have no involvement in the contractual arrangements related to, or in the physical settlement of, the oil and oil product exports mentioned above. Iranian entities in whose names the escrow accounts are held were not permitted to draw on such accounts, either because they are sanctioned parties or, where this is not the case, because of our business decision to not allow access to such accounts in light of the overall sanctions environment in the time period covered by this report.

As a remainder from a previously existing financing related to NIOC (which was fully repaid back in 2012) we still hold an account for NIOC (which was previously used as an escrow account in the context of the respective financing) with a balance in euro. NIOC was, however, not permitted to draw on this account given it was a sanctioned entity. In light of the lifting of the EU sanctions against NIOC pursuant to the Implementation Day sanctions relief, absent other legal restrictions, we intend to observe legally valid instructions to fully wind-down the remaining part of this engagement.

During 2015, approximately  43.0 million was paid into accounts of the borrower. We, in our role as agent, distributed to the participants in the banking consortia  45.0 million including portions attributable to us totaling  8.0 million.

We generated revenues in 2015 of approximately  0.7 million in respect of these financing arrangements, of which approximately  0.5 million consisted of escrow account revenues,  0.1 million consisted of loan interest revenues and  0.1 million consisted of fee revenues. The net profits were less than these amounts.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       112
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

In one financing arrangement, we are not ourselves a lender but act rather as agent for a lender, a state-owned development bank. In this capacity, we received fees from the Iranian borrower of approximately  4,000.

As of December 31, 2015, we have an undrawn commitment of approximately  1.3 million under one of the financing agreements referred to above. Due to the export credit agency coverage, this remainder cannot be cancelled without German government approval, for which we have applied but which we have not yet received. We do not intend to make further disbursements upon this undrawn commitment.

Our portion of the outstanding principal amount of the remaining loan facilities amounted to approximately  17 million as of December 31, 2015. We intend to continue pursuing repayment and fulfilling our administrative role under these agreements, but we currently do not intend to engage in any new extensions of credit to these or other Iranian entities.

Legacy Contractual Obligations Related to Guarantees and Letters of Credit. Prior to 2007, we provided guarantees to a number of Iranian entities. In almost all of these cases, we issued counter-indemnities in support of guarantees issued by Iranian banks because the Iranian beneficiaries of the guarantees required that they be backed directly by Iranian banks. In 2007, we made a decision to discontinue issuing new guarantees to Iranian or Iran-related beneficiaries. Although the pre-existing guarantees stipulate that they must be either extended or honored if we receive such a demand and we are legally not able to terminate these guarantees, we decided in 2011 to reject any “extend or pay” demands under such guarantees. Even though we exited, where possible, many of these guarantees, guarantees with an aggregate face amount of approximately  7.6 million are still outstanding as of year-end 2015. The gross revenues from this business in 2015 were approximately  20,000 and the net profit we derived from these activities was less than this amount.

We also have outstanding legacy guarantees in relation to a Syrian bank sanctioned by the U.S. under its non-proliferation program. The aggregate face amount of these legacy guarantees was approximately  10 million as of December 31, 2015, the gross revenues received from non-Syrian parties for these guarantees were approximately  41,000 in 2015 and the net profit we derived from these activities was less than this amount. In one case we paid cancellation fees of less than  300 to the frozen account of the Syrian bank.

We intend to exit these guarantee arrangements as soon as possible.

Payments Received. In 2015, we received less than 160 payments adding up to approximately  70 million in favor of non-Iranian clients in Germany, Spain, France, the Netherlands, Belgium and Japan, of which some stemmed ultimately from relevant Iranian entities and others were channelled through sanctioned Iranian intermediary banks. Revenues for these incoming payments were less than  40,000. These figures include relevant payments in favor of clients of our subsidiary Postbank. We expect that we will also have to execute such transactions in the future.

On behalf of one of our clients in Poland we transferred to an account of the Iranian embassy in Poland, held by another bank, two payments of approximately  100. We do not intend to execute such payments in the future.

Operations of Iranian Bank Branches and Subsidiaries in Germany and/or France. Several Iranian banks, including Bank Melli Iran, Bank Saderat, Bank Tejarat and Europäisch-Iranische Handelsbank, have branches or offices in Germany and/or France, even though their funds and other economic resources were frozen under European law prior to Implementation Day under the JCPoA (and Bank Saderat’s resources remain frozen). As part of the payment clearing system in Germany and other European countries, when these branches or offices need to make payments in Germany or Europe to cover their day-to-day operations such as rent, taxes, insurance premia and salaries for their remaining staff, or for any other kind of banking-related operations necessary to wind down their legacy trade business, the German Bundesbank and French banks accept fund transfers from these Iranian banks and disburse them to the applicable (mainly German) payees, some of whom hold accounts with us. In 2015, we received approximately  4.5 million in such disbursements in approximately 1,000 transactions via the German Bundesbank and French banks in respect of payments from the above-mentioned Iranian banks, and the gross revenues derived from these payments were less than 5,000. Relevant transactions of our subsidiary Postbank are included in these figures. We expect that we will also have to execute such transactions in the future.

 

 


Table of Contents
113   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                          
       

 

                    

Maintaining of Accounts for Iranian Consulates and Embassies. In 2015, Iranian embassies and consulates in Germany and the Netherlands were holding accounts with us as well as with Postbank. This includes the provision by a subsidiary of Postbank to the Iranian consulate of girocard (debitcard/ATM)-terminals as well as the processing of transactions of cardholders using the terminals; the terminals are used to facilitate the payment of fees for the issuance of visas and other administrative measures by the consulate. The additional purpose of these accounts was the funding of day-to-day operational costs of the embassies and consulates, such as salaries, rent, and electricity. One of the account relationships was between Deutsche Bank Netherlands N.V. and the Agent Bureau of the Embassy of the Islamic Republic of Iran in The Hague (which is responsible for all Iran-U.S. Claims Tribunal activities). The total volume of outgoing payments from these accounts was approximately  11 million in 2015, which payments were made with the involvement of the competent authorities in the relevant European countries under applicable law. We derived gross revenues of approximately  20,000 and net profits which were less than this amount from these activities. The relevant European governments have requested that we provide these services to enable the Government of Iran to conduct its diplomatic relations. The accounts at Deutsche Bank Netherlands N.V. of the Agent Bureau of the Embassy of the Islamic Republic of Iran in The Hague as well as the accounts of the Iranian embassy were closed during the second quarter of 2015.

Activities of Entities in Which We Have Interests. Section 13(r) requires us to provide the specified disclosure with respect to ourselves and our “affiliates,” as defined in Exchange Act Rule 12b-2. Although we have minority equity interests in certain entities that could arguably result in these entities being deemed “affiliates,” we do not have the authority or the legal ability to acquire in every instance the information from these entities that would be necessary to determine whether they are engaged in any disclosable activities under Section 13(r). In some cases, legally independent entities are not permitted to disclose the details of their activities to us because of German privacy and data protection laws or the applicable banking laws and regulations. In such cases, voluntary disclosure of such details could violate such legal and/or regulatory requirements and subject the relevant entities to criminal prosecution or regulatory investigations.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       114
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

PART III

Item 17: Financial Statements

Not applicable.

Item 18: Financial Statements

The Financial Statements of this Annual Report on Form 20-F consist of the Consolidated Financial Statements including Notes 1 to 45 thereto, which are set forth as Part 2 of the Annual Report 2015, and, as described in Note 1 “Significant Accounting Policies and Critical Accounting Estimates” thereto in the third paragraph under “Basis of Accounting”, certain parts of the Management Report set forth as Part 1 of the Annual Report 2015. Such Consolidated Financial Statements have been audited by KPMG AG Wirtschaftsprüfungsgesellschaft, as described in their “Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm” included on page 389 of the Annual Report 2015.

Item 19: Exhibits

We have filed the following documents as exhibits to this document.

 

Exhibit number    Description of Exhibit

 

1.1    English translation of the Articles of Association of Deutsche Bank AG, furnished as Exhibit 99.4 to our Report on Form 6-K dated July 30, 2015 and incorporated by reference herein.

 

2.1    The total amount of long-term debt securities of us or our subsidiaries authorized under any instrument does not exceed 10 percent of the total assets of our Group on a consolidated basis. We hereby agree to furnish to the Commission, upon its request, a copy of any instrument defining the rights of holders of long-term debt of us or of our subsidiaries for which consolidated or unconsolidated financial statements are required to be filed.

 

4.1    Equity Plan Rules 2011, furnished as Exhibit 4.3 to our 2010 Annual Report on Form 20-F and incorporated by reference herein.

 

4.2    Equity Plan Rules 2012, furnished as Exhibit 4.4 to our 2011 Annual Report on Form 20-F and incorporated by reference herein.

 

4.3    Equity Plan Rules 2013, furnished as Exhibit 4.4 to our 2012 Annual Report on Form 20-F and incorporated by reference herein.

 

4.4    Equity Plan Rules 2014, furnished as Exhibit 4.5 to our 2013 Annual Report on Form 20-F and incorporated by reference herein.

 

4.5    Equity Plan Rules 2015, furnished as Exhibit 4.5 to our 2014 Annual Report on Form 20-F and incorporated by reference herein.

 

4.6    Equity Plan Rules 2016.

 

7.1    Statement re Computation of Ratio of Earnings to Fixed Charges of Deutsche Bank AG for the periods ended December 31, 2015, 2014, 2013, 2012 and 2011 (also incorporated as Exhibit 12.6 to Registration Statement No. 333-206013 of Deutsche Bank AG).

 

8.1    List of Subsidiaries.

 

12.1    Principal Executive Officer Certifications Required by 17 C.F.R. 240.13a-14(a).

 

12.2    Principal Executive Officer Certifications Required by 17 C.F.R. 240.13a-14(a).

 

12.3    Principal Financial Officer Certifications Required by 17 C.F.R. 240.13a-14(a).

 

13.1    Chief Executive Officer Certification Required by 18 U.S.C. Section 1350.

 

13.2    Chief Executive Officer Certification Required by 18 U.S.C. Section 1350.

 

13.3    Chief Financial Officer Certification Required by 18 U.S.C. Section 1350.

 

14.1    Legal Opinion regarding confidentiality of related party customers.

 

15.1    Consent of KPMG AG Wirtschaftsprüfungsgesellschaft.

 

 

 


Table of Contents
115   Deutsche Bank    PART I – 8    Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F    PART II – 103    Annual Report – 116
     PART III – 114    Supplemental Financial Information
        (Unaudited) – 1
                              
       

 

                    

Signatures

The registrant hereby certifies that it meets all of the requirements for filing on Form 20-F and has duly caused and authorized the undersigned to sign this annual report on its behalf.

Date: March 11, 2016

Deutsche Bank Aktiengesellschaft

/s/        JOHN CRYAN                              

John Cryan

Co-Chairman of the Management Board

/s/        JUERGEN FITSCHEN                

Juergen Fitschen

Co-Chairman of the Management Board

/s/        MARCUS SCHENCK                

Marcus Schenck

Member of the Management Board

Chief Financial Officer

 


Table of Contents

LOGO


Table of Contents

 

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

 


Table of Contents
1 – Management Report
30    Operating and Financial Review
70    Outlook
77    Risks and Opportunities
79    Risk Report
188    Compensation Report
228    Corporate Responsibility
230    Employees
234    Internal Control over Financial Reporting
239    Information pursuant to Section 315 (4) of the German Commercial Code and Explanatory Report

 

2 – Consolidated Financial Statements

245    Consolidated Statement of Income
246    Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income
247    Consolidated Balance Sheet
248    Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity
250    Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows
251    Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements
283    Notes to the Consolidated Income Statement
289    Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet
353    Additional Notes
415    Confirmations

 

3 – Corporate Governance Statement/ Corporate Governance Report

419    Management Board and Supervisory Board
431    Reporting and Transparency
432    Related Party Transactions
432    Auditing and Controlling
435    Compliance with the German Corporate Governance Code

 

4 – Supplementary Information

438    Non-GAAP Financial Measures
443    Declaration of Backing
444    Year at a Glance
445    Imprint / Publications


Table of Contents
2      
     
     
     
     
     
                                  
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
3      
     
     
     
     
     
                                  
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
4      
     
     
     
     
     
                                  
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
5      
     
     
     
     
     
                                  
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
6      
     
     
     
     
     
                                  
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
7      
     
     
     
     
     
                                  
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
8      
     
     
     
     
     
                                  
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
9      
     
     
     
     
     
                                  
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
10      
     
     
     
     
     
                                  
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
11      
     
     
     
     
     
                                  
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
12      
     
     
     
     
     
                                  
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
13      
     
     
     
     
     
                                  
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
14      
     
     
     
     
     
                                  
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
15      
     
     
     
     
     
                                  
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
16      
     
     
     
     
     
                                  
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
17      
     
     
     
     
     
                                  
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
18      
     
     
     
     
     
                                  
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
19      
     
     
     
     
     
                                  
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
20      
     
     
     
     
     
                                  
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
21      
     
     
     
     
     
                                  
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
22      
     
     
     
     
     
                                  
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
23      
     
     
     
     
     
                                  
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
24      
     
     
     
     
     
                                  
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
25      
     
     
     
     
     
                                  
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
26      
     
     
     
     
     
                                  
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
27      
     
     
     
     
     
                                  
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
28      
     
     
     
     
     
                                  
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents

1 – Management Report

30    Operating and Financial Review
   Executive Summary – 30
   Deutsche Bank Group – 32
   Results of Operations – 39
   Financial Position – 64
   Liquidity and Capital Resources – 68
   Events after the Reporting Period – 69
70    Outlook
77    Risks and Opportunities
79    Risk Report
   Introduction – 80
81    Risk and Capital Overview
   Key Risk Metric – 81
   Overall Risk Assessment – 82
   Risk Profile – 83
85    Risk and Capital Framework
   Risk Management Principles and Governance – 85
   Risk Governance – 86
   Risk Culture – 90
   Risk Appetite and Capacity – 91
   Risk and Capital Plan – 92
   Stress testing – 93
   Recovery and Resolution Planning – 95
96    Risk and Capital Management
   Risk Identification and Assessment – 97
   Credit Risk Management – 98
   Market Risk Management – 105
   Operational Risk – 112
   Liquidity Risk Management – 117
   Business (Strategic) Risk Management – 122
   Reputational Risk Management – 122
   Model Risk Management – 122
   Compliance Risk Management – 123
   Insurance Specific Risk – 124
   Risk Concentration and Risk Diversification – 124
125    Risk and Capital Performance
   Capital and Leverage Ratio – 125
   Credit Risk Exposure – 138
   Equity Exposure – 159
   Asset Quality – 159
   Trading Market Risk Exposures – 169
   Nontrading Market Risk Exposures – 174
   Operational Risk Exposure – 175
   Liquidity Risk Exposure – 177
188    Compensation Report
   Group Compensation and Disclosure – 188
   Management Board Report and Disclosure – 202
   Compensation System for Supervisory Board Members – 225
228    Corporate Responsibility
230    Employees
234    Internal Control over Financial Reporting
239    Information pursuant to Section 315 (4) of the German Commercial Code and Explanatory Report
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    30
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Operating and Financial Review

The following discussion and analysis should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements and the related notes to them. Our Operating and Financial Review includes qualitative and quantitative disclosures on Segmental Results of Operations and Entity Wide disclosures on Net Revenue Components as required by International Financial Reporting Standard (IFRS) 8, “Operating Segments”. This information, which forms part of and is incorporated by reference into the financial statements of this report, is marked by a bracket in the margins throughout this Operating and Financial Review. For additional Business Segment disclosure under IFRS 8 please refer to Note 4 “Business Segments and Related Information” of the Consolidated Financial Statements.

Executive Summary

The Global Economy

 

Economic growth (in %)

  2015        2014       

Main driver

Global Economy1

Thereof:

Industrialized countries1

Thereof: Emerging markets1

   

 

 

          3.1   

1.8   

4.1   

  

  

  

   

 

 

          3.4   

1.7   

4.7   

  

  

  

  Global economic growth faltered during 2015 due to the slowdown in emerging markets, whose growth was dampened mainly by structural weaknesses and the weak oil price. The industrialized countries, by contrast benefited on balance from the low oil price and expansionary monetary policy, with the result that their growth rates picked up slightly. High debt levels and generally weak global trade weighed on growth, however.
     
     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

Eurozone Economy

Thereof: German economy

   

 

1.5   

1.7   

  

  

   

 

0.9   

1.6   

  

  

  Support from low oil prices and extremely expansionary monetary policy Strong growth in consumption, but external headwinds held back investment growth

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

U.S. Economy

    2.4           2.4         Strong U.S.$ is negative for export-oriented sectors, negative inventory cycle, solid performance by domestic economy

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

Japanese Economy

    0.5           (0.1)        Stockbuilding and net exports boosted growth

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

Asian Economy1

    6.2           6.4         Weak demand from China and the industrialized countries

Thereof: Chinese Economy

    6.9           7.3         Slowdown in the growth of exports and investment was partly offset by higher consumption

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

Source: National authorities

1 

2015 data is sourced from Deutsche Bank Research forecasts.

The Banking Industry

In the eurozone, 2015 brought a moderate rise in lending to the private sector for the first time since 2011 (+1.1 %). Lending to households was up by 2 % as compared to 2014, while lending to businesses remained stable. On the liability side, despite the prevailing low interest-rate environment, the volume of deposits from households and firms rose by 3.3 %, a similar increase to that in each of the previous two years. After a sharp rise in the first quarter, total assets of eurozone banks declined slightly and were down by 1.3 % on the year. Provisions for credit losses at European banks probably continued to decline, which may have led to a further normalization in the earnings situation. In Germany, household and corporate lending continued to expand in 2015 with growth again exceeding the eurozone average. This was partly due to an increase in consumer loans by 1.9 %.

In the U.S., the credit expansion continued, driven in particular by corporate lending and commercial mortgages, which maintained their double-digit growth rates. In the retail segment, residential mortgages grew by 2.5 %. Growth in private-sector deposits slowed somewhat compared with 2014 but, at 4.9 %, remained high.

Japan saw a moderate decline in lending growth to 2.3 %. In China, the low double-digit growth in private sector lending remained unchanged despite the slight cooling-off of the Chinese economy.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
31   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Deutsche Bank Performance

2015 was a difficult year for Deutsche Bank, as we were burdened by specific items such as goodwill and other intangible asset impairments, litigation, restructuring and severance charges totalling  12.4 billion post-tax. However, revenues were up versus 2014 and we made considerable progress on the implementation of our Strategy 2020, which intends to make Deutsche Bank a less complex and more efficient, less risky, better capitalized and better run institution with more disciplined execution.

Our Group Key Performance Indicators are as follows:

 

Group Key Performance Indicators

  Status end of 2015       Status end of 2014    

Net revenues

      33.5 bn           31.9 bn     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) before income taxes

      (6.1) bn          3.1 bn     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

    (6.8) bn          1.7 bn     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Post-tax return on average tangible shareholders’ equity1

    (12.3) %)          3.5 %     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Post-tax return on average active equity1

    (9.9) %)          2.7 %     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Adjusted Costs2

    26.5 bn          25.0 bn     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cost/income ratio3

    115.3 %          86.7 %     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cost savings4

                         4.5 bn                                3.3 bn     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Costs to achieve savings5

    3.6 bn          2.9 bn     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Risk-weighted assets

      396.7 bn           394.0 bn     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

CRR/CRD 4 fully loaded Common Equity Tier 1 ratio6

    11.1 %          11.7 %     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Fully loaded CRR/CRD 4 leverage ratio7

    3.5 %          3.5 %     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

1 

Based on Net Income attributable to Deutsche Bank shareholders. Calculation is based on an effective tax rate of (11) % for the year ended December 31, 2015 and 46 % for the year ended December 31, 2014. For further information, please refer to “Supplementary Information: Non-GAAP Financial Measures” of the report.

2 

Total noninterest expenses excluding restructuring and severance, litigation, impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets, policyholder benefits and claims. For further information, please refer to “Supplementary Information: Non-GAAP Financial Measures” of the report.

3 

Total noninterest expenses as a percentage of total net interest income before provision for credit losses plus noninterest income.

4 

Cost savings resulting from the implementation of the OpEx program.

5 

Costs-to-achieve (CtA) savings are costs which are directly required for the realisation of savings in the OpEx program.

6 

The CRR/CRD 4 fully loaded Common Equity Tier 1 ratio represents our calculation of our Common Equity Tier 1 ratio without taking into account the transitional provisions of CRR/CRD 4. Further detail on the calculation of this ratio is provided in the Risk Report.

7 

Further detail on the calculation of this ratio is provided in the Risk Report.

Net revenues in 2015 were 33.5 billion, up by 1.6 billion from 2014. Despite challenging market conditions all business segments except PBC reported increased net revenue in 2015 partly driven by positive foreign exchange movement. PBC reported a revenue decrease mainly due to valuation and transaction related effects relating to PBC’s stake in Hua Xia Bank.

Non-interest expenses in 2015 were 38.7 billion, an increase of 40 % from 2014, mainly driven by impairments of goodwill and other intangibles, a significant increase in litigation costs as well as restructuring and severance charges. Compensation and benefits were higher compared to 2014 primarily driven by foreign exchange rate effects.

The loss before income taxes of (6.1) billion in 2015, versus income before income taxes of 3.1 billion in 2014, is mainly driven by impairments booked in the third quarter 2015 as well as the higher litigation and restructuring and severance charges. The particularly high specific effects of 6.5 billion of impairments and  5.2 billion of litigation charges, both largely non-tax deductible, and an additional restructuring and severance charge of 1 billion, added to a net loss of (6.8) billion.

Cumulative OpEx program savings of 4.5 billion fully met the externally communicated target for 2015. Cumulative Costs to achieve of 3.6 billion were 0.4 billion less than planned.

Our CRR/CRD 4 fully loaded Common Equity Tier 1 ratio was 11.1 % at the end of 2015 down from 11.7 % at the end of 2014, resulted from the net loss driven by higher litigation and restructuring and severance costs. Our respective CRR/CRD 4 phase-in Common Equity Tier 1 ratio was 13.2 % at the end of 2015 down from 15.2 % at the end of 2014.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    32
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

As per the new Supervisory Review and Evaluation Process (SREP) requirements, the European Central Bank notified us that we need to maintain a CET 1 ratio of at least 10.25 % on a phase-in basis, which increases to 10.75 % in 2016 including the first stage of the phase-in in Deutsche Bank’s Global Systemically Important Banks (G-SIBs) buffers over the next four years. We currently have material buffers over the required minimum on a phased-in basis. This means that the Bank’s minimum CET 1 capital requirement will be 12.25 % by January 2019 once all buffers are phased in. This compares to our fully-loaded target of greater than 12.5 % by 2018.

Deutsche Bank Group

Deutsche Bank: Our Organization

Headquartered in Frankfurt am Main, Germany, we are the largest bank in Germany and one of the largest financial institutions in Europe and the world, as measured by total assets of  1,629 billion as of December 31, 2015. As of that date, we employed 101,104 people on a full-time equivalent basis and operated in 70 countries out of 2,790 branches worldwide, of which 65 % were in Germany. We offer a wide variety of investment, financial and related products and services to private individuals, corporate entities and institutional clients around the world.

As of December 31, 2015 we were organized into the following five corporate divisions:

 

 

Corporate Banking & Securities (CB&S)

 

Private & Business Clients (PBC)

 

Global Transaction Banking (GTB)

 

Deutsche Asset & Wealth Management (Deutsche AWM)

 

Non-Core Operations Unit (NCOU)

The five corporate divisions are supported by infrastructure functions. In addition, we have a regional management function that covers regional responsibilities worldwide. From 2016 onwards and in accordance with our Strategy 2020 our business operations are going to be organized under a new structure with the segments Global Markets (GM), Corporate & Investment Banking (CIB), Private, Wealth and Commercial Clients (PW&CC), Postbank, Deutsche Asset Management (AM) and Non-Core Operations Unit (NCOU).

We have operations or dealings with existing or potential customers in most countries in the world. These operations and dealings include:

 

 

subsidiaries and branches in many countries;

 

representative offices in many other countries; and

 

one or more representatives assigned to serve customers in a large number of additional countries.

Management Structure

The Management Board has structured the Group as a matrix organization, comprising (i) Corporate Divisions, (ii) Infrastructure Functions and (iii) a Regional Management Function. To support this structure, key governance bodies function as follows:

The Management Board has the overall responsibility for the management of Deutsche Bank, as provided by the German Stock Corporation Act. Its members are appointed and removed by the Supervisory Board, which is a separate corporate body. Our Management Board focuses on strategic management, corporate governance, resource allocation, risk management and control, assisted by functional committees.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
33   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

The Group Executive Committee was established in 2002. In accordance with the Strategy 2020 objective to reduce organizational complexity, it was dissolved in October 2015. The Group Executive Committee comprised the members of the Management Board and senior representatives from our regions, corporate divisions and certain infrastructure functions appointed by the Management Board. The Group Executive Committee was a body that is not required by the Stock Corporation Act. It served as a tool to coordinate our businesses and regions, discussed our strategy and prepared recommendations for Management Board decisions. It had no decision-making authority. Within each corporate division and region, coordination and management functions are handled by operating committees and executive committees, which helps ensure that the implementation of the strategy of individual businesses and the plans for the development of infrastructure areas are integrated with global business objectives.

Corporate Divisions

Corporate Banking & Securities Corporate Division

Corporate Division Overview

Until the recently announced reorganisation in October 2015, CB&S comprised the Global Markets and Corporate Finance businesses. These businesses offer financial products worldwide including the underwriting of stocks and bonds, trading services for investors and the tailoring of solutions for companies’ financial requirements.

Products and Services

The Global Markets business combines the sales, trading and structuring of a wide range of financial markets’ products, including bonds, equities and equity-linked products, exchange-traded and over-the-counter derivatives, foreign exchange, money market instruments, and securitized products. Coverage of institutional clients is provided by the Institutional Client Group, while Research provides analysis of markets, products and trading strategies for clients.

Corporate Finance offers mergers and acquisitions (M&A) services as well as debt and equity advisory and origination. Regional, industry-focused teams are responsible for the delivery of the entire range of financial products and services to our corporate clients.

All our trading activities are covered by our risk management procedures and controls which are described in detail in the Risk Report.

Distribution Channels and Marketing

As part of Strategy 2020, we are re-focusing and rationalising our client coverage model so as to keep clients at the core of our business. We are exiting client relationships where returns are too low or risks are too high while also strengthening our client on-boarding and KYC procedures.

We have made the following significant capital expenditures or divestitures since January 1, 2013:

In June 2015, Markit Ltd., a provider of financial information services, conducted a secondary public offering. As part of this offering, Markit also re-purchased own shares from a number of selling shareholders including Deutsche Bank. We offered and sold approximately 4 million of the 5.8 million shares (2.7 %) it held in Markit.

In December 2014, we completed the sale of 75 % of a U.S.$ 2.5 billion portfolio of U.S. special situation commercial real estate loans to a fund managed by the Texas Pacific Group. Deutsche Bank retains a 25 % stake in the portfolio and continues to originate and acquire new loans in the US special situations commercial real estate market.

In June 2014, Markit Ltd. initiated its listing on NASDAQ Stock Market via a sale of shares from existing shareholders. As part of this listing, we offered and sold 5.8 million of the 11.6 million shares (5.7 %) it held in Markit.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    34
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Private & Business Clients Corporate Division

Corporate Division Overview

PBC operates under a single retail banking business model across Europe and selected Asian markets. PBC serves retail and affluent clients as well as small and medium sized business clients.

The PBC Corporate Division comprises three business units under one strategic steering:

 

 

Private & Commercial Banking, which comprises all of PBC’s activities in Germany under the Deutsche Bank brand;

 

Advisory Banking International, which covers PBC’s activities in Europe (outside Germany) and Asia including our stake in and partnership with Hua Xia Bank Co. Ltd.; and

 

Postbank, which contains the major core business activities of Deutsche Postbank AG as well as BHW and norisbank.

The Private & Commercial Banking business unit focuses on private and commercial clients in Germany and offers an integrated commercial banking coverage model for small and medium sized corporate clients. This enables us to further capture opportunities from small and medium sized business clients by improving PBC’s client proximity and cross-divisional collaboration leveraging the expertise of Deutsche Bank Group.

In Advisory Banking International we operate in five major European banking markets: Italy, Spain, Poland, Belgium and Portugal. In Asia, India is our core market. In India, PBC operates a branch network of seventeen branches supported by a mobile sales force. Further, in Asia we currently hold a 19.99 % stake in Hua Xia Bank Co. Ltd. which we have agreed to sell.

Postbank continues to operate with its own brands, providing financial services for retail and corporate customers primarily in Germany.

We have made the following significant capital expenditures or divestitures since January 1, 2013:

On December 28, 2015, we announced the agreement to sell its entire 19.99 % stake in Hua Xia Bank Co. Ltd. to PICC Property and Casualty Company Limited for a consideration of RMB 23.0 billion to 25.7 billion subject to final price adjustment at closing (approximately 3.2 billion to  3.7 billion, based on December 2015 exchange rates). The completion of the transaction is subject to customary closing conditions and regulatory approvals, including that of the China Banking Regulatory Commission.

On April 22, 2015, we signed an agreement to purchase an additional 5.9 million (2.7 %) of the Postbank shares, thereby increasing the Deutsche Bank’s ownership stake from 94.1 % to 96.8 %. On April 27, 2015 Deutsche Bank requested Postbank to prepare a squeeze-out of the minority shareholders pursuant to Section 327a et seq. of the German Stock Corporation Act. In the squeeze-out request to Postbank on July 7, 2015, the amount of cash compensation was set at 35.05 per Postbank share. After a clearance preceding in front of the Higher District Court Cologne the squeeze-out was entered into the commercial register on December 21, 2015. At settlement on December 30, 2015, We acquired the remaining 3.2 % shares for a total of 245 million and now owns directly and indirectly 100 % of the shares. Postbank’s shares have been de-listed from all stock exchanges between December 21, 2015 and January 13, 2016.

In October 2014, we contributed ownership of the real estate of 90 retail banking branches in Italy to a closed-end institutional real estate fund, “Italian Banking Fund (IBF)”, managed by Hines Italy SGR. The contributed real estate had a total value of 134 million and will mostly be leased back for a period of at least 12 years.

In May 2014, we completed the sale of a 20.2 % stake in Deutsche Herold AG to Zürich Beteiligungs AG, a subsidiary of Zurich Insurance Group AG. We acquired the 20.2 % stake from a third party immediately ahead of selling it to Zurich. 15.2 % of the disposal to Zurich was based on a share purchase agreement that was entered into by Deutsche Bank and Zurich in 2001. The remaining 5.0 % stake was sold due to Zurich exercising a call option.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
35   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Products and Services

PBC offers a similar range of banking products and services throughout Europe and Asia, with some variations among countries that are driven by local market, regulatory and customer requirements.

We offer investment and insurance, mortgages, business products, consumer finance, payments, cards & accounts, deposits and mid-cap related products provided by other divisions as part of our mid-cap joint venture within Deutsche Bank, as well as postal services and non-bank products in Postbank.

Our investment products cover the full range of brokerage products (equities, bonds), mutual/closed-end funds (single- and multi-assets), structured products as well as discretionary portfolio management and securities custody services. In addition we provide life and non-life insurance products as well as corporate pension schemes to our clients.

We offer standard to complex mortgage solutions and our mortgage product portfolio is complemented by publicly subsidized mortgages, mortgage brokerage and mortgage-related insurance. Our business products focus on managing transactions, risk and liquidity for our clients. In commercial banking and international services we optimize cash flow and market volatility for our clients and support their business expansions. In addition our loan product offering consists of personal instalment loans, credit lines and overdrafts as well as point of sale (POS) business.

Our payments, cards and account products include domestic, international and SEPA payments, debit, credit and prepaid cards as well as current accounts for private and business clients. Our deposits portfolio consists of sight deposits, term deposits and savings.

Our lending businesses are subject to our credit risk management processes. Please see the “Credit Risk Management” and “Credit Risk Exposure” sections in the Risk Report.

Distribution Channels and Marketing

In following a client-centric banking approach, we seek to optimize the interaction with our customers as well as the accessibility and availability of our services. PBC uses a broad multi-channel approach to serve its customers and distribute financial solutions depending on local strategic positioning and business model.

 

 

Branches: Within our branches, we generally offer our entire range of products and advice.

 

Financial Agents: In most countries, we additionally market our retail banking products and services through self-employed financial agents.

 

Customer Contact Centers: Our Customer Contact Centers provide clients with remote services (i.e., account information, securities brokerage) supported by automated systems.

 

Online and Mobile Banking: On our websites, we offer clients a broad variety of relevant product information and services including interactive tools, tutorials and rich media content. We provide a high performing transaction-platform for banking, brokerage and self-services, combined with a highly frequented multi-mobile offering for smartphones and tablets. Moreover, we further invest in improvements of selected digital capabilities. This digitization program is being rolled out in all our businesses.

 

Self-service Terminals: These terminals support our branch network and allow clients to withdraw and transfer funds, receive custody account statements and make appointments with our financial advisors.

Moreover, we foster country-specific distribution and cooperation arrangements. In Germany, we maintain cooperation partnerships with companies such as DP DHL (Postbank cooperation) and Deutsche Vermögensberatung AG (DVAG). With DVAG, we distribute our mutual funds and other banking products through DVAG’s independent distribution network. In order to complement our product range, we have signed distribution agreements, in which PBC distributes the products of product suppliers. These include an agreement with Zurich Financial Services for insurance products, and product partnerships with twelve preferred fund companies for the active distribution of selected investment products.

To achieve a strong brand position internationally, we market our services consistently throughout the countries we consider to be part of our strategic focus.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    36
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Global Transaction Banking Corporate Division

Corporate Division Overview

GTB delivers commercial banking products and services to corporate clients and financial institutions, including domestic and cross-border payments, financing for international trade, lending, as well as the provision of trust, agency, depositary, custody and related services. Our business divisions consist of:

 

 

Trade Finance and Cash Management Corporates

 

Institutional Cash and Securities Services

We have made the following significant capital expenditures or divestitures since January 1, 2013:

On February 28, 2014, registrar services GmbH was sold to Link Market Services.

On June 1, 2013, the sale of Deutsche Card Services to EVO Payments International was completed.

Products and Services

Trade Finance offers local expertise, a range of international trade products and services (including financing), custom-made solutions for structured trade and the latest technology across our international network so that our clients can better manage the risks and other issues associated with their cross-border and domestic trades.

Cash Management caters to the needs of a diverse client base of corporates and financial institutions. With the provision of a comprehensive range of innovative and robust solutions, we handle the complexities of global and regional treasury functions including customer access, payment and collection services, liquidity management, information and account services and electronic bill presentation and payment solutions.

Securities Services provides a range of trust, payment, administration and related services for selected securities and financial transactions, as well as domestic securities custody in more than 30 markets.

Distribution Channels and Marketing

GTB develops and markets its own products and services in Europe, the Middle East, Asia and the Americas. The marketing is carried out in conjunction with the coverage functions in this division, in CB&S and in PBC. Leveraging the integrated commercial banking coverage model for small and medium sized corporate clients enables us to capture new opportunities from this client group.

Customers can be differentiated into two main groups: (i) financial institutions, such as banks, mutual funds and retirement funds, broker-dealers, fund managers and insurance companies, and (ii) multinational corporations, large local corporates and medium-sized companies, predominantly in Germany and the Netherlands.

Deutsche Asset & Wealth Management Corporate Division (Deutsche AWM)

Corporate Division Overview

With  1.1 trillion of invested assets as of December 31, 2015, Deutsche AWM is one of the world’s leading investment organizations. Deutsche AWM helps individuals and institutions worldwide to protect and grow their wealth, offering traditional active, passive and alternative investments across all major asset classes. Deutsche AWM also provides customized wealth management solutions and private banking services to high-net-worth and ultra-high-net-worth (UHNW) individuals and family offices.

Products and Services

Deutsche AWM’s investment capabilities span both active and passive strategies and a diverse array of asset classes including equities, fixed income, real estate, infrastructure, private equity and hedge funds. The division also offers customized wealth management solutions and private banking services, including lending and discretionary portfolio management.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
37   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Distribution Channels and Marketing

Global Coverage/Advisory teams manage client relationships, provide advice and assist clients to access Deutsche AWM’s products and services. Deutsche AWM also markets and distributes its offering through other business divisions of Deutsche Bank Group, notably PBC for retail customers and CB&S for selected institutional and corporate clients, as well as through third-party distributors. To ensure holistic service and advice, all clients have a single point of access to Deutsche AWM, with dedicated teams serving specific client groups.

Deutsche AWM created its Key Client Partners (KCP) advisory centers in 2013, to deliver its cross divisional investment banking, corporate banking and asset management capabilities. The global centres give professional investors access to cross-asset class and cross-border investment opportunities and financing solutions in tandem with CB&S.

Non-Core Operations Unit Corporate Division

In the second half of 2012, Non-Core Operations Unit (NCOU) was established as the fifth pillar of our business structure. Its aim was to help the Bank reduce risks associated with capital-intensive assets that are not core to the strategy, thereby reducing capital demand. As set out in our previous strategy announcements, our objectives in setting up the NCOU were to improve external transparency of our non-core positions; to increase management focus on the core operating businesses by separating the non-core activities; and to facilitate targeted accelerated de-risking.

Pursuant to our recent Strategy 2020 announcements, NCOU’s aim is to reduce leverage and risk-weighted assets with an ambition to materially unwind the remaining positions by end of December 2016, such that residual risk-weighted assets at that time will be less than 10 billion in aggregate. In carrying out this mandate, the NCOU will look to exit the remaining positions having less favorable capital and risk return profiles, thereby enabling us to strengthen our fully loaded Common Equity Tier 1 ratio.

The NCOU manages assets with a value of approximately  27 billion and a fully loaded RWA equivalent of  34 billion, as of December 31, 2015.

The NCOU’s portfolio includes activities that are non-core to our strategy going forward; assets materially affected by business, environment, legal or regulatory changes; assets earmarked for de-risking; assets suitable for separation; assets with significant capital absorption but low returns; and assets exposed to legal risks. In addition, certain liabilities were also assigned to the NCOU following similar criteria to those used for asset selection, e.g. liabilities of businesses in run-off or for sale, legacy bond issuance formats and various other short-dated liabilities, linked to assigned assets.

In RWA terms the majority of NCOU’s assets now relate to legacy CB&S assets, and includes credit correlation trading positions, securitization assets, exposures to monoline insurers and assets reclassified under IAS 39. NCOU’s portfolio also includes legacy PBC assets such as selected European residential mortgages and consumer assets as well as other financial investments no longer deemed strategic for Postbank. The assets previously managed in the former Group Division Corporate Investments relate to our global principal investment activities which now primarily consist of a stake in the port operator Maher Terminals.

We have made the following significant divestitures since January 1, 2013:

In April 2015, we reached an agreement to sell the Fairview Container Terminal in Port of Prince Rupert, Canada (a segment of Maher Terminals) to DP World (a Dubai-based marine terminal operator) for CAD 580 million, subject to regulatory approvals. All regulatory approvals have in the meantime been obtained and we have successfully completed the sale

On December 19, 2014, we closed the sale of Nevada Property 1 LLC, the owner of The Cosmopolitan of Las Vegas, to Blackstone Real Estate Partners VII for U.S.$ 1.73 billion, subject to closing purchase price adjustments.

In March 2014, we completed the sale of BHF-BANK to Kleinwort Benson Group and RHJ International for a total consideration of 347 million primarily in cash ( 316 million) and the remainder in the form of new shares in RHJ International issued at par value. These shares have also subsequently been sold.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    38
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

In December 2013, our subsidiary Deutsche Postbank AG completed the sale of an approximately £ 1.4 billion UK commercial real estate loan portfolio to GE Capital Real Estate.

In June 2013, our subsidiary PB Capital Corporation completed the sale of an approximately U.S.$ 3.7 billion commercial real estate loan portfolio to San Francisco based Union Bank, N.A., an indirect subsidiary of Mitsubishi UFJ Financial Group, Inc.

In May 2013, Sicherungseinrichtungsgesellschaft deutscher Banken mbH (“SdB”) fully repaid the remaining exposure (of which  0.8 billion was allocated to the former Corporate Investments, now part of the NCOU) of ECB-eligible notes guaranteed by the SOFFin (Sonderfonds Finanzmarktstabilisierung, established in October 2008 by the German government in the context of the financial crisis).

In January 2013, we completed the sale of our 15 % participation in Dedalus GmbH & Co. KGaA, through which we indirectly held approximately 1.1 % of the shares in EADS N.V., for a consideration of approximately  250 million.

Infrastructure and Regional Management

The infrastructure functions perform control and service functions and, in particular, tasks relating to Group-wide, supra-divisional resource-planning, steering and control as well as to risk, liquidity and capital management.

The infrastructure functions are organized in the following areas of responsibility:

 

 

Co-Chairmen: Communications, CSR, Group Audit, Corporate Strategy, Research and Group Incident & Investigation Management

 

Chief Financial Officer: Group Finance, Group Tax, Group Treasury, Investor Relations and Group M&A

 

Chief Risk Officer: Functions managing Credit Risk, Operational Risk, Market Risk, Liquidity Risk, Strategic Risk, Enterprise Risk and Corporate Insurance

 

Chief Regulatory Officer: Group Regulatory Affairs, Group Structuring, Public Affairs, Compliance, Anti-Financial Crime

 

Chief Administrative Officer: Legal, Global Corporate Governance and Human Resources

 

Chief Operating Officer and Information Officer: Group Technology and Operations, Corporate Services, Digital Transformation and responsible for Chief Information Office and Group Data Management

Regional Management has the task to protect the Group’s integrity and reputation and to coordinate and align local activity and strategic development across the Group’s businesses, infrastructure and legal entities.

All expenses and revenues incurred within the Infrastructure and Regional Management areas are fully allocated to our five corporate divisions.

Significant Capital Expenditures and Divestitures

Information on each Corporate Division’s significant capital expenditures and divestitures from the last three financial years has been included in the above descriptions of the Corporate Divisions.

Since January 1, 2015, there have been no public takeover offers by third parties with respect to our shares and we have not made any public takeover offers in respect of any other company’s shares.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
39   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Results of Operations

Consolidated Results of Operations

You should read the following discussion and analysis in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements.

Condensed Consolidated Statement of Income

 

in m.                     2015 increase (decrease)
from 2014
    2014 increase (decrease)
from 2013
 

(unless stated otherwise)

  2015       2014       2013       in   m.             in  %       in   m.       in %    
Net interest income     15,881          14,272          14,834          1,610          11          (562)         (4)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Provision for credit losses     956          1,134          2,065          (178)         (16)         (931)         (45)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Net interest income after provision for credit losses     14,925          13,138          12,769          1,788          14          369          3     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Commissions and fee income1     12,765          12,409          12,308          356          3          101          1     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss1     3,842          4,299          3,817          (457)         (11)         481          13     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Net gains (losses) on financial assets available for sale     203          242          394          (39)         (16)         (152)         (39)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Net income (loss) from equity method investments     164          619          369          (455)         (73)         251          68     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other income (loss)     669          108          193          561          N/M          (85)         (44)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total noninterest income     17,644          17,677          17,082          (33)         (0)         596          3     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total net revenues2     32,569          30,815          29,850          1,754          6          965          3     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Compensation and benefits     13,293          12,512          12,329          781          6          183          1     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
General and administrative expenses     18,632          14,654          15,126          3,977          27          (472)         (3)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Policyholder benefits and claims     256          289          460          (32)         (11)         (172)         (37)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets     5,776          111          79          5,665          N/M          33          42     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Restructuring activities     710          133          399          577          N/M          (267)         (67)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total noninterest expenses     38,667          27,699          28,394          10,968          40          (695)         (2)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Income (loss) before income taxes     (6,097)         3,116          1,457          (9,213)         N/M          1,660          114     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Income tax expense     675          1,425          775          (750)         (53)         650          84     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Net income (loss)     (6,772)         1,691          681          (8,463)         N/M          1,010          148     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Net income attributable to noncontrolling interests     21          28          15          (6)         (23)         13          83     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Net income (loss) attributable to Deutsche Bank shareholders and additional equity components     (6,794)         1,663          666          (8,457)         N/M          997          150     

 

 

Note: Prior periods have been restated.

N/M – Not meaningful

1 

For further detail please refer to Note 1 “Significant Accounting Policies and Critical Accounting Estimates” of this report.

2 

After provision for credit losses.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    40
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Net Interest Income

 

in m.                     2015 increase (decrease)
from 2014
    2014 increase (decrease)
from 2013
 

(unless stated otherwise)

  2015       2014       2013       in m.             in %       in   m.       in %    

Total interest and similar income

    25,967          25,001          25,601          966          4          (600)         (2)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total interest expenses

    10,086          10,729          10,768          (643)         (6)         (39)         (0)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income

    15,881          14,272          14,834          1,610          11          (562)         (4)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Average interest-earning assets1

    1,031,827          1,040,908          1,136,662          (9,080)         (1)         (95,754)         (8)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Average interest-bearing liabilities1

    814,541          851,714          979,245          (37,172)         (4)         (127,531)         (13)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross interest yield2

    2.52 %          2.40 %          2.25 %          0.12 ppt          5          0.15 ppt          7     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross interest rate paid3

    1.24 %          1.26 %          1.10 %          (0.02) ppt          (2)         0.16 ppt          15     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest spread4

    1.28 %          1.14 %          1.15 %          0.14 ppt          12          (0.01) ppt          (1)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest margin5

    1.54 %          1.37 %          1.31 %          0.17 ppt          12          0.06 ppt          5     

 

 

ppt – Percentage points

1 

Average balances for each year are calculated in general based upon month-end balances.

2 

Gross interest yield is the average interest rate earned on our average interest-earning assets.

3 

Gross interest rate paid is the average interest rate paid on our average interest-bearing liabilities.

4 

Net interest spread is the difference between the average interest rate earned on average interest-earning assets and the average interest rate paid on average interest-bearing liabilities.

5 

Net interest margin is net interest income expressed as a percentage of average interest-earning assets.

2015

The increase in net interest income in 2015 of 1.6 billion, or 11 %, to 15.9 billion compared to 14.3 billion in 2014, was primarily driven by higher interest income on trading assets in CB&S, mainly driven by strong client activity and increased client balances. Also contributing to the increase were favorable foreign exchange movements and organic growth in Deutsche AWM. Overall, the net interest spread increased by 14 basis points and the net interest margin improved by 17 basis points primarily driven by lower interest related volume, an increase in interest income and a decrease in interest expenses in 2015 as compared to prior year.

2014

The decrease in net interest income in 2014 of  562 million, or 4 %, to  14.3 billion compared to  14.8 billion in 2013, was primarily driven by lower interest income in NCOU due to asset reductions as a result of our continued de-risking. Overall, the net interest spread decreased by 1 basis point as a result of slightly lower increase of gross interest yield as compared to gross interest rate paid. The net interest margin improved by 6 basis points, mainly due to effects resulting from the aforementioned asset reductions.

Net Gains (Losses) on Financial Assets/Liabilities at Fair Value through Profit or Loss

 

in m.                     2015 increase (decrease)
from 2014
    2014 increase (decrease)
from 2013
 

(unless stated otherwise)

          2015               2014               2013               in € m.                in %              in € m.                in %   
             
CB&S – Sales & Trading (equity)     870          1,066          1,120          (196)         (18)         (54)         (5)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
CB&S – Sales & Trading (debt and other products)     3,654          2,487          2,548          1,167          47          (61)         (2)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Non-Core Operations Unit     (552)         (663)         (374)         111          (17)         (289)         77     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other     (130)         1,408          523          (1,538)         N/M          886          169     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total net gains (losses) on financial assets/ liabilities at fair value through profit or loss     3,842          4,299          3,817          (457)         (11)         482          13     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Note: Prior periods have been restated.

2015

Net gains on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss decreased by  457 million to  3.8 billion for the full year 2015. The main driver for this was an increase in net losses on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss of  1.5 billion in the category Other. Contributing factors were losses on long swap exposure in CB&S due to unfavorable interest rate and foreign exchange movement partly offset by an increase of  1.2 billion in Sales and Trading (debt and other products) mainly reflecting increased market volatility primarily in the first quarter 2015 resulting in new client and deal flow.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
41   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

2014

Net gains on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss increased by  482 million to  4.3 billion for the full year 2014. The main driver for this was an increase of  886 million in Other, mainly reflecting mark to market gains from interest rate movements in CB&S which was partly offset by an increase in net losses on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss of  289 million in NCOU, which included a loss related to the Special Commodities Group from our exposure to traded products in the U.S. power sector in 2014.

Net Interest Income and Net Gains (Losses) on Financial Assets/Liabilities at Fair Value through Profit or Loss

Our trading and risk management businesses include significant activities in interest rate instruments and related derivatives. Under IFRS, interest and similar income earned from trading instruments and financial instruments designated at fair value through profit or loss (i.e., coupon and dividend income) and the costs of funding net trading positions are part of net interest income. Our trading activities can periodically shift income between net interest income and net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss depending on a variety of factors, including risk management strategies.

In order to provide a more business-focused discussion, the following table presents net interest income and net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss by corporate division and by product within CB&S.

 

in m.                         2015 increase (decrease)   
from 2014   
     2014 increase (decrease)   
from 2013   
 

(unless stated otherwise)

   2015         2014         2013        in   m.         in %         in   m.         in %     

Net interest income

     15,881            14,272            14,834           1,610           11            (562)           (4)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Total net gains (losses) on financial assets/ liabilities at fair value through profit or loss      3,842            4,299            3,817           (457)           (11)           481            13      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Total net interest income and net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss      19,723            18,570            18,651           1,153            6            (81)           (0)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
                    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Breakdown by Corporate Division/product: 1                     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Sales & Trading (equity)

     2,502            2,302            2,111           200            9            191            9      

Sales & Trading (debt and other products)

     7,909            6,591            5,976           1,318            20            615            10      

Total Sales & Trading

     10,411            8,893            8,087           1,518            17            806            10      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Loan products 2

     623            688            587           (65)           (9)           101            17      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Remaining products 3

     (440)           (62)           69           (378)           N/M            (131)           N/M      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Corporate Banking & Securities

     10,594            9,519            8,743           1,074            11            776            9      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Private & Business Clients

     5,837            5,893            5,817           (56)           (1)           75            1      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Global Transaction Banking

     2,133            2,205            1,940           (73)           (3)           265            14      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deutsche Asset & Wealth Management

     1,615            1,500            1,550           115            8            (50)           (3)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Non-Core Operations Unit

     (631)           (612)           176           (19)           3            (788)           N/M      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Consolidation & Adjustments

     176            65            423           112            174            (359)           (85)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Total net interest income and net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss      19,723            18,570            18,651           1,153            6            (81)           (0)     

 

 

Note: Prior periods have been restated.

N/M – Not meaningful

1 

This breakdown reflects net interest income and net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss only. For a discussion of the corporate divisions’ total revenues by product please refer to Note 4 “Business Segments and Related Information”.

2 

Includes the net interest spread on loans as well as the fair value changes of credit default swaps and loans designated at fair value through profit or loss.

3 

Includes net interest income and net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss of origination, advisory and other products.

Corporate Banking & Securities (CB&S)

2015

Combined net interest income and net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss were  10.6 billion in 2015, an increase of  1.1 billion, or 11 %, compared to 2014. In Sales & Trading (debt and other products), revenues were significantly higher due to favorable foreign exchange movements and a strong first half of the year. The higher revenues in Sales and Trading (debt and other products) were partly offset by three valuation adjustment items totalling a loss of 187 million including a loss of 146 million relating to a refinement in calculation

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    42
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

of IFRS Credit Valuation Adjustments (CVA), a Funding Valuation Adjustment (FVA) loss of 143 million (including a loss of 26 million relating to a calculation refinement) and a mark to market gain of 102 million relating to RWA mitigation efforts on CVA. The increase in Sales & Trading (equity) net revenues was primarily driven by increased client balances in Prime Finance. Equity Derivatives revenues were significantly lower, due to lower client activity and a challenging risk management environment in the second half of the year.

2014

Combined net interest income and net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss were  9.5 billion in 2014, an increase of  776 million, or 9 %, compared to 2013. In Sales & Trading (debt and other products), the main drivers for the increase were higher revenues in RMBS after having been impacted by de-risking activity and challenging market conditions in 2013, mark-to-market gains in relation to RWA mitigation efforts arising on CVA compared to a loss in 2013, and higher revenues in Credit Solutions due to increased financing. The increase in Sales & Trading (equity) in 2014 was primarily driven by client financing balances in Prime Finance and favorable trading conditions in Equity Derivatives. Revenue from Loan products also increased in the year reflecting investment in the Commercial Real Estate business. These revenue increases were partly offset by a decrease in Remaining products, mainly due to a Debt Valuation Adjustment (DVA) loss of  126 million (full year 2013: a loss of  21 million).

Private & Business Clients (PBC)

2015

Combined net interest income and net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss were  5.8 billion in 2015, a decrease of  56 million, compared to 2014. The decrease was mainly driven by transaction related effects relating to PBC’s stake in Hua Xia Bank Co. Ltd. This was partly offset by an extraordinary dividend payment received subsequent to an investee’s sales transaction. Also contributing to the development was the ongoing challenging interest rate environment in 2015.

2014

Combined net interest income and net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss were  5.9 billion in 2014, increased by  75 million, compared to 2013, including the positive impact of a subsequent gain related to a business sale closed in a prior period. Despite this effect, net interest income was impacted by a continued challenging interest rate environment in Europe.

Global Transaction Banking (GTB)

2015

Combined net interest income and net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss were  2.1 billion in 2015, a decrease of  73 million, or 3 %, compared to 2014, primarily driven by persistent low interest rates, heightened geopolitical headwinds and strong market competition.

2014

Combined net interest income and net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss were  2.2 billion in 2014, an increase of  265 million, or 14 %, compared to 2013. The increase was primarily driven by a change of our hedging instruments to manage the interest rate risk which increases our revenues at fair value through profit or loss but is offset in other revenues. Overall, net interest income remained under pressure due to the low interest rate environment.

Deutsche Asset & Wealth Management (Deutsche AWM)

2015

Combined net interest income and net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss were  1.6 billion in 2015, an increase of  115 million, or 8 %, compared to 2014. Higher net interest revenues were driven by favorable foreign exchange rate movements, increased lending volume and reduced funding costs. This increase was partly offset by an unfavorable change in the fair value of guarantees.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
43   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

2014

Combined net interest income and net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss were  1.5 billion in 2014, a decrease of  50 million, or 3 %, compared to 2013. Higher net interest revenues in lending, deposits and alternatives were more than offset by an unfavorable change in the fair value of guarantees and negative effects from mark-to-market movements on policyholder positions in Abbey Life.

Non-Core Operations Unit (NCOU)

2015

Combined net interest income and net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss was a net loss of  631 million in 2015, an increase of  19 million, compared to 2014. The main driver of the development was lower net interest revenues due to asset reductions in NCOU as a result of our de-risking strategy partly offset by the absence of a one-time loss in 2014 related to the Special Commodities Group from our exposure to traded products in the U.S.

2014

Combined net interest income and net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss was a net loss of  612 million in 2014. This was a decrease of  788 million, compared to 2013. The main driver of the decrease was lower net interest revenues due to asset reductions in NCOU as a result of our de-risking strategy. Fair value losses continued to have a negative impact on revenues and included a one-time loss related to the Special Commodities Group from our exposure to traded products in the U.S. power sector during the first quarter 2014.

Consolidation & Adjustments (C&A)

2015

Combined net interest income and net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss was  176 million in 2015 versus  65 million in 2014, an increase of  112 million. This increase was primarily due to a positive impact from FVA on internal uncollateralized derivatives.

2014

Combined net interest income and net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss was a positive  65 million in 2014, compared with a gain of  423 million in 2013. This decrease was largely driven by negative effects from timing differences from different accounting methods used for management reporting and IFRS. This was partially offset by higher income from our capital account, largely resulting from the capital increase in 2014.

Provision for Credit Losses

2015

Provision for credit losses in 2015 was  956 million, down by  178 million, or 16 % versus 2014 driven by significant reductions in NCOU in relation to IAS 39 reclassified assets and real estate exposures as well as in PBC due to sales of non-performing loans, the favorable credit environment in Germany and the stabilizing economic conditions in southern Europe. These reductions were partly offset by increases in CB&S caused by the Shipping and Leveraged Finance portfolios.

2014

Provision for credit losses in 2014 was  1.1 billion, down by  931 million, or 45 % versus 2013 reflecting material reductions in all businesses. Reduction in NCOU was driven by decreased provision for credit losses in IAS 39 reclassified assets and commercial real estate assets. Our Core Bank benefited from increased releases and a non-recurrence of large single name bookings.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    44
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Remaining Noninterest Income

 

in m.                         2015 increase (decrease)  
from 2014  
     2014 increase (decrease)  
from 2013  
 

(unless stated otherwise)

   2015        2014        2013        in   m.      in %        in   m.        in %    

Commissions and fee income1

     12,765           12,409           12,308           356           3           101           1     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Net gains (losses) on financial assets available for sale      203           242           394           (39)          (16)          (152)          (39)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Net income (loss) from equity method investments      164           619           369           (455)          (73)          251           68     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other income (loss)

     669           108           193           561           N/M           (85)          (44)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Total remaining noninterest income      13,802           13,379           13,264           423           3           115           1     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

1   includes:

                    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Commissions and fees from fiduciary activities:

                    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Commissions for administration

     432           404           435           28           7           (31)          (7)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Commissions for assets under management

     3,666           3,057           2,963           609           20           94           3     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Commissions for other securities business

     382           283           247           99           35           36           14     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     4,480           3,745           3,645           735           20           100           3     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Commissions, broker’s fees, mark-ups on securities underwriting and other securities activities:

                    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Underwriting and advisory fees

     2,388           2,545           2,378           (157)          (6)          167           7     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Brokerage fees

     1,746           1,488           1,542           258           17           (54)          (3)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     4,134           4,033           3,920           101           3           113           3     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Fees for other customer services

     4,151           4,632           4,742           (480)          (10)          (111)          (2)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total commissions and fee income

     12,765           12,409           12,308           356           3           101           1     

 

 

N/M – Not meaningful

Commissions and fee income

2015

Total Commissions and fee income increased from  12.4 billion in 2014 by  356 million to  12.8 billion in 2015. Fees for assets under management increased due to a strong operating performance of our businesses reflecting a favorable market, impact from net asset inflows and performance fees in Active Asset Management. This was partially offset by a decrease in Fees for other customer services, including a decline in PBC due to a new contract with Deutsche Post DHL and a decline in underwriting and advisory fees.

2014

Total Commissions and fee income increased from  12.3 billion in 2013 by  101 million to  12.4 billion in 2014. Advisory revenues were higher than in the prior year reflecting a higher fee pool and market share gains. Fees for assets under management increased due to a favorable development in European & U.S. exchange traded funds. This was offset by a decrease in Fees for other customer services, mainly triggered by changes in regulatory requirements with regard to payment and card fees as well as lower revenues from Postal Services. Additionally a change in the reporting classification of certain product-related expenses resulted in a further decline.

Net gains (losses) on financial assets available for sale

2015

Net gains on financial assets available for sale were  203 million in 2015 compared to  242 million in 2014. The decline in 2015 mainly resulted from prior year period gain related to a business sale as well as gains from securities sales in DB Bauspar.

2014

Net gains on financial assets available for sale were  242 million in 2014 compared to  394 million in 2013. The decline in 2014 mainly resulted from de-risking activities related to the NCOU.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
45   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Net income (loss) from equity method investments

2015

Net gains from equity investments decreased from  619 million in 2014 to  164 million in 2015 primarily due to valuation effects in 2015 relating to Hua Xia Bank.

2014

Net gains from equity investments increased from  369 million in 2013 to  619 million in 2014. The drivers for this positive effect were prior year impairments in NCOU and an increased equity pick up related to the investment in Hua Xia Bank.

Other income (loss)

2015

Other income increased from  108 million in 2014 to  669 million in 2015. The increase in 2015 was primarily driven by asset sales related to accelerated de-risking in NCOU.

2014

Other income declined from  193 million in 2013 to  108 million in 2014. The decline in 2014 was primarily related to the restructuring of the debt financing of Maher Terminals, which resulted in a reclassification of the cumulative mark-to-market loss from other comprehensive income to other income in NCOU.

Noninterest Expenses

 

in m.                     2015 increase (decrease)   
from 2014   
    2014 increase (decrease)   
from 2013   
 

(unless stated otherwise)

  2015       2014       2013       in   m.       in %        in   m.        in %     

Compensation and benefits

    13,293          12,512          12,329          781          6           183           1      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

General and administrative expenses 1

    18,632          14,654          15,126          3,977          27           (472)          (3)     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Policyholder benefits and claims

    256          289          460          (32)          (11)          (172)          (37)     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets

    5,776          111          79          5,665          N/M           33           42      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Restructuring activities

    710          133          399          577          N/M           (266)          (67)     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total noninterest expenses

    38,667          27,699          28,394          10,968          40           (695)          (2)     

 

 
N/M – Not meaningful              

1     includes:

             

 

  2015       2014       2013       in   m.       in %       in   m.       in %     

IT costs

    3,664          3,333          3,074          331          10          259          8      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Occupancy, furniture and equipment expenses

    1,944          1,978          2,073          (34)          (2)          (95)          (5)     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Professional service fees 2

    2,283          2,029          1,772          255          13          256          14      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Communication and data services 2

    807          725          706          82          11          18          3      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Travel and representation expenses 2

    505          521          516          (16)          (3)          5          1      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Banking and transaction charges 2

    598          660          743          (62)          (9)          (83)          (11)     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Marketing expenses 2

    294          293          294          2          1          (1)          (0)     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Consolidated investments

    406          811          797          (405)          (50)          14          2      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other expenses 2,3

    8,129          4,305          5,151          3,824          89          (847)          (16)     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total general and administrative expenses

    18,632          14,654          15,126          3,977          27          (472)          (3)     

 

 
2 

In 2015, prior period comparatives have been restated in order to reflect changes in the Group’s cost reporting.

3

Included litigation related expenses of 5.2 billion in 2015, 1.6 billion for litigation and 0.4 billion for loan processing fees of PBC in 2014 and  3.0 billion for litigation in 2013.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    46
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Compensation and benefits

2015

Compensation and benefits increased by  781 million, or 6 %, to  13.3 billion in 2015 compared to  12.5 billion in 2014 which primarily reflects unfavorable foreign exchange developments.

2014

Compensation and benefits increased by  183 million, or 1 %, to  12.5 billion in 2014 compared to  12.3 billion in 2013. This primarily reflects higher fixed compensation costs to comply with regulatory requirements, driven significantly by CB&S, as well as strategic hires in our business and control functions. This increase was partly offset by positive effects from the ongoing implementation of the OpEx program across our Core businesses.

General and administrative expenses

2015

General and administrative expenses increased by 4.0 billion, or 27 %, to 18.6 billion in 2015 compared to  14.7 billion in 2014. The increase was primarily driven by higher litigation costs of 5.2 billion compared to  1.6 billion of litigation for the Group and 0.4 billion for loan processing fees in PBC in 2014, unfavorable foreign exchange rate effects, higher software amortizations and impairments as well as significant higher charges for bank levies. These effects were partly offset by lower costs due to the disposal of assets in NCOU in 2014 and other cost reductions.

2014

General and administrative expenses decreased by 472 million, or 3 %, to 14.7 billion in 2014 compared to  15.1 billion in 2013. The decrease was primarily driven by lower litigation costs of 1.6 billion of litigation and  0.4 billion for loan processing fees in PBC compared to 3.0 billion in 2013 as well as savings from the OpEx program. The decrease was partly offset by higher expenses from regulatory requirements and investments in our Core businesses.

Policyholder benefits and claims

2015

Policyholder benefits and claims decreased by 32 million from 289 million in 2014 to 256 million in 2015 and were solely driven by insurance-related charges regarding the Abbey Life business. These charges were offset by net gains on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss on policyholder benefits and claims.

2014

Policyholder benefits and claims decreased by  172 million from  460 million in 2013 to  289 million in 2014 and were solely driven by insurance-related charges regarding the Abbey Life business. These charges are offset by net gains on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss on policyholder benefits and claims.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
47   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets

2015

The impairment charges on goodwill and other intangible assets of 5.8 billion were attributable to 3.6 billion (thereof 2.8 billion impaiment of goodwill and 0.8 billion other intangible assets) in PBC and 2.2 billion in CB&S. The charge represents a full impairment of goodwill in CB&S and PBC and a partial impairment of other intangible assets in PBC. Impairments largely were due to expected higher regulatory capital requirements and disposals within PBC, as discussed further under the discussions of our individual corporate divisions below.

2014

In 2014, the impairment charges on goodwill and other intangibles of  111 million were mainly attributable to a  194 million impairment to our Maher Terminal investment, with a partial offset from a write-up on Scudder of  84 million.

Restructuring

2015

Restructuring expenses amounted to 710 million in 2015 compared to 133 million in 2014. The increase was driven by 616 million for the implementation of our Strategy 2020 introduced in 2015, partly offset by the lower spending for our OpEx program which was completed as planned in 2015.

2014

Restructuring expenses from our OpEx program decreased by  266 million, or 67 %, to  133 million in 2014 compared to  399 million in 2013.

Income Tax Expense

2015

Income tax expense was  675 million (2014:  1.4 billion). The effective tax rate of negative 11 % (2014: 46 %) was mainly impacted by significant non-tax deductible impairments of goodwill and litigation charges.

2014

Income tax expense was  1.4 billion (2013:  775 million). The effective tax rate of 46 % (2013: 53 %) was mainly impacted by non-tax deductible litigation charges and income taxes of prior periods which were partially offset by changes in the recognition and measurement of deferred taxes.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    48
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Segment Results of Operations

The following is a discussion of the results of our business segments. See Note 4 “Business Segments and Related Information” to the consolidated financial statements for information regarding:

 

 

changes in the format of our segment disclosure;

 

the framework of our management reporting systems and

 

definitions of non-GAAP financial measures that are used with respect to each segment.

The criterion for segmentation into divisions is our organizational structure as it existed at December 31, 2015. Segment results were prepared in accordance with our management reporting systems.

                       
             2015  
     in m. (unless stated otherwise)   Corporate
Banking &
Securities
    Private &
Business
Clients
    Global
Transaction
Banking
    Deutsche
Asset &
Wealth
Management
    Non-Core
Operations
Unit
    Total
Management
Reporting
    Consoli-
dation &
Adjustments
    Total
Consolidated
 
   

Net revenues1

    14,219        8,911        4,616        5,408        401        33,556        (30)        33,525   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    Provision for credit losses     265        501        127        9        54        955        1        956   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    Compensation and benefits     3,739        2,847        679        1,605        94        8,964        4,329        13,293   
    General and administrative expenses     9,932        4,664        2,368        2,286        2,986        22,236        (3,604)        18,632   
    Policyholder benefits and claims     0        0        0        256        0        256        0        256   
    Impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets     2,168        3,603        0        6        0        5,776        0        5,776   
    Restructuring activities     124        587        3        (4)        (1)        710        0        710   
    Total noninterest expenses     15,963        11,700        3,050        4,149        3,079        37,942        724        38,667   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    Noncontrolling interests     26        1        0        (0)        1        27        (27)        0   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    Income (loss) before income taxes     (2,035)        (3,291)        1,439        1,250        (2,732)        (5,368)        (729)        (6,097)   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    Cost/income ratio     112 %        131 %        66 %        77 %        N/M        113 %        N/M        115 %   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    Assets2     1,145,004        257,121        99,953        89,001        27,172        0        10,880        1,629,130   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    Expenditures for additions to long-lived assets     1        113        1        2        (0)        116        643        758   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    Risk-weighted assets3     195,096        80,016        52,062        23,795        34,463        385,431        11,283        396,714   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    Average active equity     30,948        15,099        7,607        8,023        6,674        68,351        7        68,359   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    Post-tax return on average tangible shareholders’ equity     (5) %        (18) %        14 %        30 %        N/M        (6) %        N/M        (12) %   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    Pre-tax return on average active equity     (7) %        (22) %        19 %        16 %        N/M        (8) %        N/M        (9) %   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    Post-tax return on average active equity4     (4) %        (14) %        12 %        10 %        N/M        (5) %        N/M        (10) %   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    1 Includes:                
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Net interest income

    6,382        5,968        2,038        1,288        (79     15,597        285        15,881   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
        Net income (loss) from equity method
    investments
    64        40        4        34        20        162        3        164   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    2 Includes:                
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

    Equity method investments

    524        21        53        182        166        945        68        1,013   
   

 

 
   

 

N/M – Not meaningful

 

 

  

 

    3   Risk-weighted assets and capital ratios are based upon CRR/CRD 4 fully-loaded since January 1, 2014.   
    4   The post-tax return on average active equity at the Group level reflects the reported effective tax rate for the Group, which was (11 %) for the year ended December 31, 2015. For the post-tax return on average active equity of the segments, the Group effective tax rate was adjusted to exclude the impact of permanent differences not attributed to the segments, so that the segment tax rates were 35 % for the year ended December 31, 2015.     
                       

 

        

 


Table of Contents
49   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

 

                   
    2014       

in m.

(unless stated otherwise)

  Corporate
Banking &
Securities
    Private &
Business
Clients
    Global
Transaction
Banking
    Deutsche
Asset &
Wealth
Management
    Non-Core
Operations
Unit
    Total
Management
Reporting
    Consoli-
dation &
Adjustments
    Total
Consolidated
      
Net revenues1     13,629        9,565        4,119        4,704        172        32,189        (240)        31,949       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
Provision for credit losses     103        622        156        (7)        259        1,133        1        1,134       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
Compensation and benefits     3,712        2,863        634        1,398        107        8,714        3,798        12,512       
General and administrative expenses     6,769        4,880        2,166        2,090        2,508        18,413        (3,759)        14,654       
Policyholder benefits and claims     0        0        0        289        0        289        0        289       
Impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets     0        0        0        (83)        194        111        0        111       
Restructuring activities     112        9        10        (3)        4        133        0        133       
Total noninterest expenses     10,593        7,753        2,811        3,691        2,813        27,660        39        27,699       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
Noncontrolling interests     25        1        0        4        (2)        28        (28)        0       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
Income (loss) before income taxes     2,909        1,189        1,152        1,016        (2,899)        3,367        (251)        3,116       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
Cost/income ratio     78 %        81 %        68 %        78 %        N/M        86 %        N/M        87 %       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
Assets2     1,213,612        258,381        106,252        81,132        38,853        1,698,230        10,474        1,708,703       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
Expenditures for additions to long-lived assets     0        108        0        1        0        109        517        626       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
Risk-weighted assets3     175,575        79,571        43,265        16,597        58,524        373,532        20,437        393,969       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
Average active equity     25,445        14,853        6,033        6,532        7,762        60,624        0        60,624       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
Post-tax return on average tangible shareholders’ equity     9 %        7 %        15 %        36 %        N/M        5 %        N/M        4 %       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
Pre-tax return on average active equity     11 %        8 %        19 %        16 %        N/M        6 %        N/M        5 %       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
Post-tax return on average active equity4     7 %        5 %        12 %        10 %        N/M        4 %        N/M        3 %       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
1 Includes:                    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Net interest income

    5,338        5,818        1,849        1,047        51        14,103        168        14,272       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Net income (loss) from equity method

investments

    128        431        3        22        34        617        2        619       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
2 Includes:                    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

    Equity method

    investments

    521        3,154        50        163        170        4,058        85        4,143       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

 

Note: Prior periods have been restated.

N/M – Not meaningful

 

3    Risk-weighted assets and capital ratios are based upon CRR/CRD 4 fully-loaded since January 1, 2014.

4    The post-tax return on average active equity at the Group level reflects the reported effective tax rate for the Group, which was 46 % for the year ended December 31, 2014. For the post-tax return on average active equity of the segments, the Group effective tax rate was adjusted to exclude the impact of permanent differences not attributed to the segments, so that the segment tax rates were 35 % for the year ended December 31, 2014.

  

  

  

    

   
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    50
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

                       
             2013  
    

in m.

(unless stated otherwise)

  Corporate
Banking &
Securities
    Private &
Business
Clients
    Global
Transaction
Banking
    Deutsche
Asset &
Wealth
Management
    Non-Core
Operations
Unit
    Total
Management
Reporting
    Consoli-
dation &
Adjustments
    Total
Consolidated
 
   

Net revenues1

    13,400        9,395        4,025        4,718        896        32,434        (519)        31,915   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    Provision for credit losses     189        719        315        23        818        2,064        0        2,065   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    Compensation and benefits     3,591        2,955        614        1,291        234        8,685        3,644        12,329   
    General and administrative expenses     6,583        4,329        1,932        1,997        3,299        18,139        (3,013)        15,126   
    Policyholder benefits and claims     0        0        0        460        0        460        0        460   
    Impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets     0        7        57        14        0        79        0        79   
    Restructuring activities     130        22        54        170        25        399        0        399   
    Total noninterest expenses     10,303        7,312        2,657        3,932        3,558        27,763        631        28,394   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    Noncontrolling interests     16        0        0        1        (3)        15        (15)        0   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    Income (loss) before income taxes     2,891        1,363        1,053        762        (3,478)        2,592        (1,136)        1,457   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    Cost/income ratio     77 %        78 %        66 %        83 %        N/M        86 %        N/M        89 %   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    Assets2     1,102,007        265,360        97,240        72,613        63,810        0        10,371        1,611,400   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    Expenditures for additions to long-lived assets     12        176        9        7        0        203        539        742   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    Risk-weighted assets3     114,729        73,001        36,811        12,553        52,443        289,537        10,832        300,369   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    Average active equity     20,161        13,976        5,136        5,864        10,296        55,434        0        55,434   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    Post-tax return on average tangible shareholders’ equity     13 %        9 %        17 %        43 %        N/M        4 %        N/M        2 %   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    Pre-tax return on average active equity     14 %        10 %        21 %        13 %        N/M        5 %        N/M        3 %   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    Post-tax return on average active equity4     10 %        7 %        14 %        9 %        N/M        3 %        N/M        1 %   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    1     Includes:                
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

  Net interest

  income

    5,284        5,814        1,886        971        550        14,505        328        14,834   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

  Net income (loss)

  from equity method

  investments

    78        375        3        18        (106)        368        1        369   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    2    Includes:                
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Equity method

investments

    628        2,563        48        143        171        3,554        28        3,581   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Note: Prior periods have been restated.

N/M – Not meaningful

 

  

  

   

3     

  Risk-weighted assets and capital ratios are based upon Basel 2.5.   
   

4     

  The post-tax return on average active equity at the Group level reflects the reported effective tax rate for the Group, which was 53 % for the year ended December 31, 2013. For the post-tax return on average active equity of the segments, the Group effective tax rate was adjusted to exclude the impact of permanent differences not attributed to the segments, so that the segment tax rates were 32 % for the year ended December 31, 2013.     
                     

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
51   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

 

Corporate Divisions                       
                        
Corporate Banking & Securities Corporate Division                
                        
                          2015 increase (decrease)  
from 2014  
     2014 increase (decrease)  
from 2013  
      

in m.

(unless stated otherwise)

     2015           2014           2013           in m.           in %           in m.           in %         

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

     

Net revenues:

                        

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

     
Sales & Trading (debt and other products)      7,391           6,747           6,709           644           10           37           1         

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

     
Sales & Trading (equity)      3,091           2,917           2,719           174           6           197           7         

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

     
Origination (debt)      1,449           1,522           1,557           (73)          (5)          (36)          (2)        

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

     
Origination (equity)      658           761           732           (103)          (14)          29           4         

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

     
Advisory      586           578           478           8           1           100           21         

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

     
Loan products      1,094           1,189           1,222           (96)          (8)          (33)          (3)        

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

     
Other products      (50)          (84)          (18)          34           (41)          (66)          N/M         

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

     

Total net revenues

     14,219           13,629           13,400           589           4           229           2         

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

     

Provision for credit losses

     265           103           189           162           158           (87)          (46)        

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

     
Compensation and benefits      3,739           3,712           3,591           28           1           121           3         

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

     
General and administrative expenses      9,932           6,769           6,583           3,163           47           186           3         

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

     
Policyholder benefits and claims      0           0           0           0           N/M           0           N/M         

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

     
Impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets      2,168           0           0           2,168           N/M           0           N/M         

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

     
Restructuring activities      124           112           130           12           11           (17)          (13)        

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

     

Total noninterest expenses

     15,963           10,593           10,303           5,371           51           289           3         

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

     

Noncontrolling interests

     26           25           16           0           1           9           57         

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

     

Income (loss) before income taxes

     (2,035)          2,909           2,891           (4,944)          N/M           17           1         

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

     
Cost/income ratio      112%          78%          77%          N/M           35 ppt           N/M           1 ppt         

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

     
Assets1      1,145,004           1,213,612           1,102,007           (68,608)          (6)          111,605           10         

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

     
Risk-weighted assets2      195,096           175,575           114,729           19,521           11           60,846           53         

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

     
Average active equity 3      30,948           25,445           20,161           5,503           22           5,284           26         

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

     
Pre-tax return on average active equity      (7)%         11%          14%          N/M           (18) ppt          N/M           (3) ppt         

 

     

N/M – Not meaningful

1   Segment assets represent consolidated view, i.e., the amounts do not include intersegment balances.

2   Risk-weighted assets and capital ratios are based upon Basel 2.5 rules through December 31, 2013 and upon CRR/CRD 4 fully-loaded since January 1, 2014.

3   See Note 4 “Business Segments and Related Information” to the consolidated financial statements for a description of how average active equity is allocated to the divisions.

  

  

  

  

   
                        

2015

CB&S reported solid revenues in full year 2015 driven by favorable movements in foreign exchange rates and a strong first half of the year. In the second half of the year revenues were impacted by reduced client activity and a challenging market environment.

Full year 2015 net revenues were  14.2 billion, an increase of  589 million, or 4 % from  13.6 billion in 2014.

Sales & Trading (debt and other products) net revenues were  7.4 billion, an increase of  644 million, or 10 %. Revenues in Foreign Exchange were significantly higher driven by increased market volatility and strong client activity. Revenues in Core Rates were significantly higher driven by strong performance in Europe and North America. Flow Credit revenues were significantly higher reflecting improved market conditions in North America and Europe. Emerging Market revenues were higher despite challenging markets and our exit from Russia, reflecting strong performance in Latin America. Revenues in RMBS were significantly lower reflecting challenging market conditions. Credit Solutions revenues were lower driven by lower client activity and a weaker market environment particularly in APAC. Global Liquidity Management and Distressed Products revenues were in line with the prior year. Sales & Trading (debt and other products) net revenues included three valuation adjustment items totalling a loss of  187 million. First, a mark-to-market gain of  102 million (full year 2014: a gain of  7 million) relating to RWA mitigation efforts arising on Credit Valuation Adjustment (CVA). Second, a loss of  146 million (full year 2014: loss of 58 million) relating to a refinement in the calculation of IFRS CVA. Third, a Funding Valuation Adjustment (FVA) loss of  143 million (full year 2014: a loss of  122 million) including a negative impact of  26 million due to a calculation refinement.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    52
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Sales & Trading (equity) net revenues were  3.1 billion, an increase of  174 million, or 6 %. Prime Finance revenues were significantly higher driven by increased client balances. Equity Derivatives revenues were significantly lower, reflecting lower client activity and a challenging risk management environment in the second half of the year. Equity Trading revenues were in line with the prior year.

Origination and Advisory net revenues were  2.7 billion for the full year 2015, a decrease of  168 million, or 6 % reflecting a decline in market share and lower risk appetite. Revenues in Equity Origination were lower, reflecting a lower fee pool in the second half of the year. Debt Origination and Advisory revenues were in line with the prior year.

Loan products net revenues were  1.1 billion for the full year 2015, a decrease from the prior year ( 1.2 billion).

Net revenues from Other products were a loss of  50 million (2014: a loss of  84). Net revenues from Other products included a gain of  48 million (full year 2014: a loss of  126 million) relating to the impact of a Debt Valuation Adjustment (DVA) on certain derivative liabilities.

In provisions for credit losses, CB&S recorded a net charge of  265 million (2014: net charge of 103 million), driven by increased provisions taken in the Shipping and Leveraged Finance portfolios.

Noninterest expenses increased by  5.4 billion or 51 % compared to full year 2014. The increase was due to goodwill impairment charges, higher litigation costs, adverse foreign exchange movements and regulatory required expenditures.

Income before income taxes was a loss of  2.0 billion, compared to a gain of  2.9 billion in the prior year, driven by goodwill impairment of  2.2 billion and higher litigation charges of  2.8 billion partly offset by higher revenues.

2014

CB&S reported solid revenues in full year 2014 despite a challenging market environment with low market volatility and client activity in the first half of the year. In the second half of 2014 volatility increased and CB&S saw stronger revenue momentum across the franchise.

Full year 2014 net revenues were  13.6 billion, an increase of  229 million, or 2 % from  13.4 billion in 2013.

Sales & Trading (debt and other products) net revenues were  6.7 billion, in line with the prior year. Revenues in RMBS were significantly higher, reflecting de-risking activity and a challenging market environment in 2013. Revenues in Distressed Products were higher driven by strong performance in Europe. Revenues in Flow Credit were significantly lower than the prior year driven by weaker performance in North America. Core Rates revenues were significantly lower than the prior year driven by FVA losses due to market movements and a calculation refinement, coupled with weaker performance in APAC and Europe. Foreign Exchange, Global Liquidity Management and Credit Solutions revenues were in line with the prior year. Sales & Trading (debt and other products) net revenues included three valuation adjustment items totalling a loss of  173 million. First, a mark-to-market gain of  7 million (full year 2013: a loss of  240 million) relating to RWA mitigation efforts arising on Credit Valuation Adjustment (CVA). Second, a loss of  58 million (full year 2013: nil) relating to a refinement in the calculation of IFRS CVA. Third, a Funding Valuation Adjustment (FVA) loss of  122 million (full year 2013: a gain of  67 million) including a negative impact of  51 million due to a calculation refinement.

Sales & Trading (equity) net revenues were  2.9 billion, an increase of  197 million, or 7 %. Prime Finance revenues were higher driven by increased client balances. Equity Trading revenues and Equity Derivatives revenues were both in line with the prior year.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
53   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Origination and Advisory net revenues were  2.9 billion for the full year 2014, an increase of  93 million, or 3 %. Revenues in Advisory were significantly higher driven by increased fee pool and market share. Revenues in Equity Origination and Debt Origination were both in line with the prior year.

Loan products net revenues were  1.2 billion for the full year 2014, in line with the prior year (2013:  1.2 billion).

Net revenues from Other products were a loss of  84 million, compared to a loss of  18 million in 2013. Net revenues from Other products included a Debt Valuation Adjustment (DVA) loss of  126 million (full year 2013: a loss of  21 million), including a gain of  37 million related to a refinement in the calculation of IFRS CVA.

In provision for credit losses, CB&S recorded a net charge of  103 million, a decrease of  87 million, or 46 %, driven by decreased provisions in the Shipping portfolio and a net release of provisions in our Leveraged Finance Portfolio.

Noninterest expenses increased by  289 million or 3 %. The increase was due to regulatory required expenditures, platform enhancements and adverse foreign exchange movements. These more than offset the progress on OpEx cost reduction initiatives and lower litigation costs.

Income before income taxes was  2.9 billion, in line with the prior year, driven by solid revenue performance and lower litigation costs partly offset by higher regulatory costs and cost-to-achieve (CtA) spend.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    54
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

   

Private & Business Clients Corporate Division

  

                               2015 increase (decrease)  
from 2014  
     2014 increase (decrease)  
from 2013  
 
    

in m.

(unless stated otherwise)

   2015        2014        2013        in m.        in %        in m.        in %    
   

Net revenues:

                    
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Credit products      3,715           3,423           3,345           292           9           78           2     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Deposit products      2,696           2,975           3,009           (279)          (9)          (34)          (1)    
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Payments, cards & account products      952           982           1,017           (30)          (3)          (35)          (3)    
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Investment & insurance products      1,392           1,305           1,220           87           7           85           7     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Postal and supplementary Postbank

Services

     247           416           433           (169)          (41)          (17)          (4)    
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Other products      (91)          463           371           (554)          N/M           92           25     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Total net revenues      8,911           9,565           9,395           (654)          (7)          170           2     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Provision for credit losses      501           622           719           (121)          (20)          (97)          (13)    
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Compensation and benefits      2,847           2,863           2,955           (16)           (1)          (92)          (3)    
    General and administrative expenses      4,664           4,880           4,329           (216)           (4)          551           13     
    Policyholder benefits and claims      0           0           0           0           N/M           0           N/M     
    Impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets      3,603           0           7           3,603           N/M           (7)          N/M     
    Restructuring activities      587           9           22           578           N/M           (12)          (57)    
    Total noninterest expenses      11,700           7,753           7,312           3,948           51           440           6     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Noncontrolling interests      1           1           0           (0)          (17)          0           46     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Income (loss) before income taxes      (3,291)          1,189           1,363           (4,480)          N/M           (174)          (13)    
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Cost/income ratio      131%           81%           78%           N/M           50 ppt           N/M           3 ppt     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Assets1      257,121           258,381           265,360           (1,260)          (0)          (6,978)          (3)    
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Risk-weighted assets2      80,016           79,571           73,001           445           1           6,570           9     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Average active equity3      15,099           14,853           13,976           246           2           876           6     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Pre-tax return on average active equity      (22)%           8%           10%           N/M           (30) ppt           N/M           (2) ppt     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
 
    Breakdown of PBC by business4                     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Private & Commercial Banking:                     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Net revenues      3,794           3,845           3,685           (51)          (1)          159           4     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Provision for credit losses      53           79           128           (26)          (33)          (49)          (38)    
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Noninterest expenses      4,514           3,520           3,234           994           28           287           9     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Income before income taxes      (774)          245           323           (1,019)          N/M           (78)          (24)    
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
                        
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Advisory Banking International:                     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Net revenues      1,556           2,100           1,966           (545)          (26)          134           7     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Provision for credit losses      229           272           248           (42)          (16)          24           10     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Noninterest expenses      1,505           1,250           1,181           255           20           69           6     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Income before income taxes      (179)          579           538           (757)          N/M           41           8     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
                        
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Postbank:5                     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Net revenues      3,562           3,620           3,744           (58)          (2)          (124)          (3)    
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Provision for credit losses      218           271           343           (54)          (20)          (71)          (21)    
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Noninterest expenses      5,682           2,982           2,898           2,699           90           85           3     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Noncontrolling interests      1           1           0           (0)          (13)          0           69     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Income before income taxes      (2,338)          365           502           (2,704)          N/M           (137)          (27)    
   

 

 
   

N/M – Not meaningful

1   Segment assets represent consolidated view, i.e., the amounts do not include intersegment balances.

2   Risk-weighted assets and capital ratios are based upon Basel 2.5 rules through December 31, 2013 and upon CRR/CRD 4 fully-loaded since January 1, 2014.

3   See Note 4 “Business Segments and Related Information” to the consolidated financial statements for a description of how average active equity is allocated to the divisions.

4   Effective January 1, 2015, PBC has refined its internal cost allocation among the business units Private & Commercial Banking and Advisory Banking International.

5   Contains the major core business activities of Postbank AG as well as BHW and norisbank.

  

  

  

   

  

  

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
55   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                                  
     

 

                    

Additional information

                       2015 increase (decrease)  
from 2014  
     2014 increase (decrease)  
from 2013  
 

in bn.

(unless stated otherwise)

  2015       2014       2013        in   bn.        in %        in   bn.        in %    

Invested assets1

          288                291                282           (3)          (1)          9           3     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net new money

    (4)         6          (15)          (10)          N/M           21           N/M     

 

 

N/M – Not meaningful

1 

We define invested assets as (a) assets we hold on behalf of customers for investment purposes and/or (b) client assets that are managed by us. We manage invested assets on a discretionary or advisory basis, or these assets are deposited with us.

2015

PBC’s business environment remained challenging during 2015. Furthermore PBC’s 2015 results were significantly adversely impacted by three material effects amounting to 5.0 billion in total. First, the current expectations regarding the disposal of Postbank and the impact of expected higher regulatory capital requirements triggered an impairment of  2.8 billion of PBC’s entire goodwill and of  837 million Postbank-related other intangible assets, mainly the Postbank trademark and customer-related intangibles. Second, the agreement to sell the stake in Hua Xia Bank Co. Ltd. combined with the share price development triggered valuation effects and other transaction-related impacts of 697 million in total. Third, noninterest expenses included 670 million in provisions for restructuring and severances, mainly related to PBC’s restructuring of its head office and branch network. Excluding these effects, PBC achieved a stable result in 2015.

Net revenues in PBC decreased by 654 million, or 7 %, compared to 2014. This was driven by the aforementioned 697 million valuation and transaction-related effects relating to PBC’s stake in Hua Xia Bank Co. Ltd. recorded in other product revenues. On the other hand Other product revenues included higher equity pickups from Hua Xia Bank Co. Ltd. as well as a positive effect of  115 million from an extraordinary dividend payment received subsequent to an investee’s sales transaction. In 2014, Other product revenues included a non-recurring gain as well as gains from securities sales in DB Bauspar. The decline in net revenues from Deposit products of 279 million, or 9 %, compared to 2014 was mainly caused by the continued low interest rate environment in Europe. Net revenues from Postal and supplementary Postbank Services decreased by 169 million, or 41 %, due to a contract alignment with Deutsche Post DHL, partly offset by lower costs related to the same contractual changes. The decrease in net revenues from Payments, cards & account products of 30 million, or 3 %, compared to 2014, was mainly driven by tighter regulations with regard to card fees. These declines were partly compensated by an increase in Credit product revenues of  292 million, or 9 %. This was driven by higher loan volumes, especially in Mortgages and Consumer Finance and a modest overall portfolio margin increase, accompanied by specific effects from successful contract alignments with business partners from Postbank and impacts related to updates of internal funding models in Private & Commercial Banking. Higher net revenues from Investment & insurance products of 87 million, or 7 %, reflected a continuing strong performance in Investment business across PBC’s business units leveraging the positive market momentum.

Provision for credit losses decreased by  121 million, or 20 % in 2015, reflecting the benefits of selective portfolio sales as well as the quality of PBC’s loan book across PBC’s business units and the ongoing benign economic environment in Germany.

Noninterest expenses increased by  3.9 billion, significantly impacted by the aforementioned impairment of  3.6 billion in total of all of PBC’s goodwill and Postbank-related other intangible assets. Further, 2015 included  587 million provisions for restructuring and 83 million severance payments, mainly related to PBC’s head office and branch network restructuring and a 131 million partial write-off of software related to the strategic decisions on the use of the joint IT platform with Postbank. In comparison, noninterest expenses in 2014 included  400 million charges for loan processing fees triggered by a change in German legal practice as well as 156 million provisions for severances and restructuring. Beyond that, 2014 also included a positive effect from the disposition of real estate in Europe. Apart from the above mentioned effects, PBC continued to realize incremental savings from efficiency measures in 2015, which were offset by higher expense caused by regulatory requirements and inflationary cost increases (e.g. tariff, pensions, rental cost increases).

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    56
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Loss before income taxes was  3.3 billion in 2015, including the aforementioned charges of 5.0 billion in 2015. This compares to income before income taxes of  1.2 billion in 2014 which was affected by the aforementioned  400 million charges for loan processing fees and 156 million provision for restructuring and severances.

Invested assets of 288 billion decreased by  3 billion compared to December 31, 2014 driven by  8 billion outflows in deposits. This was partially compensated by  3 billion inflows in securities combined with 1 billion in market appreciation.

2014

PBC’s business environment remained challenging during 2014 with headwinds including further declines in interest rates, tighter regulation and significant non-recurring charges regarding loan processing fees triggered by two rulings in May and October 2014 of the German Federal Court of Justice (Bundesgerichtshof). Despite the challenging environment, PBC’s revenues grew on a year-on-year basis reflecting an upturn in client activity in respect of Investment & Insurance Products and growth in certain Credit products, primarily in Germany. Provision for credit losses also improved in the period reflecting the quality of the loan portfolio.

PBC’s reported full year result declined compared with 2013 due to the above-mentioned impact of 400 million for the reimbursement of loan processing fees.

Net revenues in PBC increased by 170 million, or 2 %, compared to 2013. Growth in revenues from Investment & Insurance products of 85 million, or 7 %, reflected net asset inflows and higher transaction levels, mainly in securities. Net revenues from Credit products increased by 78 million, or 2 %, primarily driven by increased loan volumes, especially in German Mortgages. Net revenues from Other products increased by  92 million, or 25 %, mainly reflecting the impacts of a subsequent gain in Private & Commercial Banking related to a business sale closed in a prior period, gains from securities sales in DB Bauspar, as well as growth in the performance of the Hua Xia Bank Co. Ltd. equity investment. This was partly offset by decreased revenues related to Postbank nonoperating activities. Additionally, 2013 was positively impacted by a partial release of loan loss allowances in Postbank, which were reported in Other product revenues as the allowances were recognized prior to consolidation. Net revenues from Payments, Cards & Accounts decreased by 35 million, or 3 %, mainly triggered by changes in regulatory requirements with regard to payment and card fees. Net revenues from Deposits decreased by 34 million, or 1 %, due to the continued challenging interest rate environment in Europe as well as a result of de-leveraging mainly in Postbank. Net revenues from Postal and supplementary Postbank Services declined by 17 million, or 4 %, due to a change in the reporting classification of certain product-related expenses previously reported in other revenues.

Provision for credit losses decreased by 97 million, or 13 %, versus prior year period, benefiting from a favorable environment in Germany. In the prior year, an additional credit of 86 million was recorded in other interest income, representing a partial release of loan loss allowances in Postbank as well as improved credit quality of Postbank loans recorded at fair value on initial consolidation by the Group.

Noninterest expenses increased by 440 million, or 6 %, compared to 2013. 2014 was significantly impacted by 400 million of charges relating to loan processing fees following the above-mentioned changes triggered by recent German legal decisions. Additionally, higher infrastructure expenses, mainly caused by regulatory requirements, resulted in cost increases. Offsetting these expense increases in 2014 was the gain from the disposition of real estate in Europe. Noninterest expenses in 2013 also included an item of comparable size which was related to a release of a provision in respect of the Hua Xia Bank Co. Ltd. credit card cooperation. Expenditures for our OpEx and Postbank integration programs decreased by 42 million, or 8 %, in line with the progress of these programs. Additionally, PBC continued to realize incremental savings from efficiency measures implemented under the OpEx program.

Income before income taxes decreased by 174 million, or 13 %, compared to 2013, mainly driven by charges for loan processing fees as mentioned above.

Invested assets increased by 9 billion versus December 31, 2013, due to 6 billion in net inflows, mainly in securities, and additional market appreciation.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
57   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                                  
     

 

                    

 

Global Transaction Banking Corporate Division              
                          2015 increase (decrease)  
from 2014  
     2014 increase (decrease)  
from 2013  
       

in m.

(unless stated otherwise)

   2015        2014        2013        in m.        in %        in m.        in %          

Net revenues:

                         

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

      

Trade Finance & Cash Management

Corporates

     2,750           2,537           2,547           213           8           (10)          (0)         

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

      

Institutional Cash & Securities Services

     1,870           1,587           1,481           284           18           106           7          

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

      

Other products

     (4)          (5)          (2)          1           (20)          (2)          91          

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

      

Total net revenues

     4,616           4,119           4,025           497           12           94           2          

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

      

Provision for credit losses

     127           156           315           (29)          (18)          (159)          (50)         

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

      

Compensation and benefits

     679           634           614           45           7           20           3          

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

      

General and administrative expenses

     2,368           2,166           1,932           201           9           235           12          

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

      

Policyholder benefits and claims

     0           0           0           0           N/M           0           N/M          

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

      

Impairment of goodwill and other intangible

assets

     0           0           57           0           N/M           (57)          N/M          

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

      

Restructuring activities

     3           10           54           (7)          (68)          (44)          (81)         

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

      

Total noninterest expenses

     3,050           2,811           2,657           239           9           154           6          

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

      

Noncontrolling interests

     0           0           0           0           N/M           0           N/M          

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

      

Income (loss) before income taxes

     1,439           1,152           1,053           287           25           99           9          

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

      

Cost/income ratio

     66 %           68 %           66 %           N/M           (2) ppt           N/M           2 ppt          

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

      

Assets1

     99,953           106,252           97,240           (6,299)          (6)          9,012           9          

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

      

Risk-weighted assets2

     52,062           43,265           36,811           8,797           20           6,454           18          

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

      

Average active equity3

     7,607           6,033           5,136           1,574           26           897           17          

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

      

Pre-tax return on average active equity

     19 %           19 %           21 %           N/M           (0) ppt           N/M           (1) ppt          

 

      

N/M – Not meaningful

1   Segment assets represent consolidated view, i.e., the amounts do not include intersegment balances.

2   Risk-weighted assets and capital ratios are based upon Basel 2.5 rules through December 31, 2013 and upon CRR/CRD 4 fully-loaded since January 1, 2014.

3   See Note 4 “Business Segments and Related Information” to the consolidated financial statements for a description of how average active equity is allocated to the divisions.

  

  

  

  

    

2015

2015 was characterized by continuously challenging market conditions with persistently low interest rates and even heightened geopolitical risks. The business environment remained highly competitive and was impacted by increased market volatility in certain GTB markets. Despite this environment, GTB managed to realize a strong increase in income before income taxes. This takes into account the effects of movements in foreign exchange rates in 2015, which favorably impacted the revenue contribution from activities denominated in foreign currencies, whereas noninterest expenses were adversely impacted.

Net revenues increased by 497 million, or 12 %, with revenue growth across all regions. Trade Finance benefited specifically from structured as well as flow trade business activities. Revenues in Cash Management for corporate clients were supported by favorable foreign exchange rate movements as well as increased volumes. Revenues in Institutional Cash and Securities Services grew on the back of strong business activity as well as volume growth. 2014 included a gain on sale of registrar services GmbH.

Provision for credit losses decreased by 29 million, or 18 %, primarily driven by lower loan loss provisions related to commercial banking activities in the Netherlands.

Noninterest expenses increased by 239 million, or 9 %, impacted by the foreign exchange rate development, an increase of litigation reserves as well as higher expenses related to regulatory requirements. Cost-to-achieve, mainly related to the OpEx program which was completed as planned in 2015, were at 62 million compared to 97 million in prior year period.

As a result, GTB reported the highest income before income taxes since the division was established in 2001. The increase of 287 million, or 25 %, was mainly driven by a very strong revenue development as well as lower provision for credit losses.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    58
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

2014

In 2014, net revenues and income before income taxes developed solidly, despite a persistently challenging market environment, as reflected by further cuts to already low interest rates, heightened geopolitical risks and a highly competitive business environment. Noninterest expenses in 2014 and 2013 were impacted by specific items. 2014 contained a litigation-related charge, whereas the performance in 2013 included higher expenses for the turn-around of our commercial banking activities in the Netherlands as well as an impairment of an intangible asset.

Net revenues increased by 94 million, or 2 %, including a gain on the sale of registrar services GmbH in 2014 and the sale of Deutsche Card Services in 2013. While Trade Finance revenues increased due to strong volumes and stabilizing margins especially in Asia Pacific and Europe, Cash Management for corporate clients remained under pressure in the ongoing low interest rate environment. Institutional Cash and Securities Services revenues increased across regions mainly driven by volume growth.

Provision for credit losses decreased by  159 million, or 50 %, primarily related to the non-recurrence of a single client credit event in Trade Finance recorded in 2013.

Noninterest expenses increased by 154 million, or 6 %. As mentioned above, 2014 included a litigation-related charge, while the prior year was impacted by higher expenses related to the implementation of strategic initiatives. This contained higher cost-to-achieve related to the OpEx program for the turn-around in the Netherlands and an impairment of an intangible asset. Excluding those items, noninterest expenses increased due to higher revenue related expenses as well as increased costs to comply with regulatory requirements. Furthermore, investments to enable business growth contributed to the cost increase.

Income before income taxes increased by  99 million, or 9 %, due to lower provision for credit losses following the single client credit event in 2013 as well as higher revenues. This was partly offset by an increased cost base.

 

      Deutsche Asset & Wealth Management Corporate Division   
 
                                  2015 increase (decrease)  
from 2014  
     2014 increase (decrease)  
from 2013  
 
   

in m.

(unless stated otherwise)

     2015           2014           2013           in  m.            in %           in  m.            in %     
   

Net revenues:

                    
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Management Fees and other recurring

revenues

     3,083           2,551           2,380           532           21           171           7     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Performance and transaction fees and

other non recurring revenues

     777           826           924           (50)          (6)          (97)          (11)    
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Net Interest revenues

     745           607           560           138           23           47           8     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Other product revenues

     546           429           360           116           27           69           19     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Mark-to-market movements on

policyholder positions in Abbey Life

     258           291           494           (34)          (12)          (202)          (41)    
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Total net revenues

     5,408           4,704           4,718           705           15           (14)          (0)    
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Provision for credit losses

     9           (7)          23           16           N/M           (30)          N/M     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Compensation and benefits

     1,605           1,398           1,291           206           15           107           8     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

General and administrative expenses

     2,286           2,090           1,997           197           9           93           5     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Policyholder benefits and claims

     256           289           460           (32)          (11)          (172)          (37)    
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Impairment of goodwill and other

intangible assets

     6           (83)          14           89           N/M           (97)          N/M     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Restructuring activities

     (4)          (3)          170           (0)          13           (173)          N/M   
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Total noninterest expenses

     4,149           3,691           3,932           459           12           (241)          (6)    
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Noncontrolling interests

     (0)          4           1           (4)          N/M           2           N/M     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Income (loss) before income taxes

     1,250           1,016           762           234           23           254           33     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Cost/income ratio

     77 %           78 %           83 %           N/M           (2) ppt           N/M           (5) ppt     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Assets1

     89,001           81,132           72,613           7,869           10           8,519           12     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Risk-weighted assets2

     23,795           16,597           12,553           7,198           43           4,045           32     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Average active equity3

     8,023           6,532           5,864           1,492           23           667           11     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Pre-tax return on average active equity

     16 %           16 %           13 %           N/M           0 ppt           N/M           3 ppt     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     

N/M – Not meaningful

1   Segment assets represent consolidated view, i.e., the amounts do not include intersegment balances.

2   Risk-weighted assets and capital ratios are based upon Basel 2.5 rules through December 31, 2013 and upon CRR/CRD 4 fully-loaded since January 1, 2014.

3   See Note 4 “Business Segments and Related Information” to the consolidated financial statements for a description of how average active equity is allocated to the divisions.

  

  

  

  

 

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
59   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

2015

In 2015, Deutsche AWM continued to grow across products and regions benefitting from higher market levels, increased net new money and resulting higher assets under management relative to the prior period, and the favorable movement in foreign exchange rates, which positively increased recurring revenue streams. Performance continued to be impacted by increased regulatory costs and an ongoing low interest rate environment, which challenged deposit revenue margins.

Net revenues for full year 2015 were  5.4 billion, an increase of  705 million, or 15 %.

Management Fees and other recurring revenues increased by  532 million, or 21 %, due to an increase in the average assets under management driven by positive flows, higher average market levels, and favorable movements in foreign exchange rates. Performance and transaction fees and other non-recurring revenues were down  50 million, or 6 %, following lower performance fees from alternative products in the EMEA region and decreased transactional revenues from wealth management following lower volumes from alternative products across EMEA and APAC. Net interest income increased by  138 million, or 23 %, due to favorable movements in foreign exchange rates, reduced funding costs and increased lending volume. Other product revenues increased by  116 million, or 27 %, mainly due to higher revenues from alternative products offset by a write-down of  86 million in Active products with regard to HETA exposure. Mark-to-market movements on policyholder positions in Abbey Life decreased by  34 million, or 12 %, largely offset in noninterest expenses.

Provision for credit losses remained at very low levels, while the prior year includes a recovery from a written off exposure in the U.S.

Noninterest expenses were up  459 million, or 12 %, mainly driven by unfavorable movement in foreign exchange rates, prior year reversal of intangible write-downs for Scudder, higher asset under management related costs, and higher compensation costs partly offset by lower costs related to the OpEx program and lower policyholder benefits and claims.

Income before income taxes was  1.25 billion in 2015, an increase of  234 million, or 23 %, driven by the aforementioned increase in net revenues.

Invested assets in Deutsche AWM were  1.1 trillion as of December 31, 2015, an increase of  75 billion, or 7 %, mainly driven by foreign currency movements of  53 billion, inflows of  24 billion, and market appreciation of  4 billion, partially offset by divestment and other movements of 5 billion.

The following table provides a roll-forward of invested assets during 2015, broken down by product type as well as the respective average fee rates earned:

 

in bn.

   WM Advisory        Alternatives        Cash        Equity        Fixed Income        Multi Asset        Total Invested  
Assets  
 
Balance as of December 31, 2014      263           97           73           162           315           130           1,039     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Inflows

     54           18           11           85           95           40           301     

Outflows

     (49)          (22)          (12)          (60)          (109)          (26)          (278)    
Net Flows      4           (4)          (1)          25           (15)          14           24     
FX impact      13           5           5           7           19           4           53     
Market Development      (2)          (1)          2           6           (2)          1           4     
Other      0           (4)          (1)          (1)          2           0           (5)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Balance as of December 31, 2015      279           93           77           199           319           148           1,114     

 

 
Average fee rate (in bps)      43           52           7           49           14           48        

 

 
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    60
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

2014

In 2014, Deutsche AWM benefited from higher assets under management following elevated market levels, increased net new money, and the favorable movement in foreign exchange rates, which positively increased recurring revenue streams. Performance continued to be impacted by increased regulatory costs and an ongoing low interest rate environment, which challenged deposit revenue margins. Overall net revenues decreased following lower mark-to-market movements on policyholder positions in Abbey Life, which were offset by lower Policyholder benefits and claims within noninterest expenses.

In Deutsche AWM, net revenues for full year 2014 were  4.7 billion, a decrease of  14 million.

Management Fees and other recurring revenues increased by  171 million, or 7 %, due to an increase of average assets under management driven by positive net new money from clients, favorable movement in foreign exchange rates and market appreciation. Performance and transaction fees and other non-recurring revenues were down  97 million, or 11 %, driven by lower performance fees in asset management, and lower transactional revenues from fixed income and foreign exchange products for private clients. Net interest revenues increased by  47 million, or 8 %, due to increased lending volumes, recovery of prior period interest, and improved lending margins. Other product revenues increased by  69 million, or 19 %, partly due to higher revenues from alternatives partially offset by unfavorable change in fair value of guarantees, which were impacted by the fall in long-term interest rates. Mark-to-market movements on policyholder positions in Abbey Life decreased by  202 million, or 41 %, largely offset in noninterest expenses.

Provision for credit losses decreased by  30 million mainly resulting from lower specific client-related lending provisions and the recovery of prior charges in 2014.

Noninterest expenses were down  241 million, or 6 %, mainly driven by lower policyholder benefits, reversal of intangible write-downs for Scudder, lower costs-to-achieve related to the OpEx program and the positive impact of ongoing OpEx program measures and lower litigation costs. This was partially offset by strategic hiring and one-time effects in compensation to comply with regulatory requirements and pension changes.

Income before income taxes was  1.0 billion in 2014, an increase of  254 million compared to 2013. Slightly lower revenue performance was more than offset by decreased provision for credit losses and noninterest expenses.

Invested assets in Deutsche AWM were  1.0 trillion as of December 31, 2014, an increase of  116 billion, or 13 %, mainly driven by foreign currency movements of  50 billion, market appreciation of  43 billion and inflows of  40 billion.

The following table provides a roll-forward of invested assets during 2014, broken down by product type as well as the respective average fee rates earned:

 

in bn.         WM Advisory          Alternatives          Cash          Equity          Fixed Income          Multi Asset          Total Invested
Assets
 
Balance as of December 31, 2013         231           79           63           145           294           111           923   

Inflows

        55           26           11           50           102           34           278   

Outflows

        (45 )         (18 )         (7        (48 )         (96 )         (23 )         (238
Net Flows         10           9           4           2           6           11           40   
FX impact         15           4           5           6           17           3           50   
Market Development         5           5           2           10           14           7           43   
Other         2           (0 )         0           (0 )         (16 )         (3 )         (18
Balance as of December 31, 2014           263             97             73             163             314             130             1,039   
Average fee rate (in bps)           42             56             8             50             16             49                

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
61   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

 

Non-Core Operations Unit Corporate Division

 

  

   
in m.                     2015 increase (decrease)  
from 2014  
    2014 increase (decrease)  
from 2013  
      

(unless stated otherwise)

    2015          2014          2013          in m.          in %          in m.          in %         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Net revenues

    401          172          896          229          133          (724)         (81)        

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

thereof:

                 

Net interest income and net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss

    (631)         (612)         176          (19)         3          (788)         N/M         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
Provision for credit losses     54          259          818          (206)         (79)         (559)         (68)        

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
Compensation and benefits     94          107          234          (13)         (12)         (128)         (54)        

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
General and administrative expenses     2,986          2,508          3,299          478          19          (791)         (24)        

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
Policyholder benefits and claims     0          0          0          0          N/M          0          N/M         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
Impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets     0          194          0          (194)         N/M          194          N/M         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
Restructuring activities     (1)         4          25          (6)         N/M          (20)         (83)        

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
Total noninterest expenses     3,079          2,813          3,558          265          9          (745)         (21)        

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
Noncontrolling interests     1          (2)         (3)         3          N/M          1          (24)        

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
Income (loss) before income taxes     (2,732)         (2,899)         (3,478)         167          (6)         579          (17)        

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
Cost/income ratio     N/M          N/M          N/M          N/M          N/M          N/M          N/M         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
Assets1     27,172          38,853          63,810          (11,681)         (30)         (24,957)         (39)        

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
Risk-weighted assets2     34,463          58,524          52,443          (24,062)         (41)         6,081          12       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
Average active equity3     6,674          7,762          10,296          (1,088)         (14)         (2,535)         (25)        

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
Pre-tax return on average active equity     (41) %          (37) %          (34) %          N/M          (4) ppt          N/M          (4) ppt         

 

     

N/M – Not meaningful

1   Segment assets represent consolidated view, i.e., the amounts do not include intersegment balances.

2   Risk-weighted assets and capital ratios are based upon Basel 2.5 rules through December 31, 2013 and upon CRR/CRD 4 fully-loaded since January 1, 2014

3   See Note 4 “Business Segments and Related Information” to the consolidated financial statements for a description of how average active equity is allocated to the divisions.

  

  

  

   

   

 

2015

 

During 2015, NCOU has continued to execute its de-risking strategy with specific focus on capital contribution and de-leveraging initiatives. De-risking activity included the sale of Maher Prince Rupert as well as various exposures from legacy banking assets. The IBIT profile improved overall but was impacted by an increase in noninterest expenses, specifically related to the developments in litigation-related provisions. Asset de-risking in 2015 delivered net gains of  415 million.

 

Net revenues increased by 229 million, or 133 %, mainly due to specific impacts including  219 million from a specific litigation recovery and a gain of 195 million on the sale of Maher Prince Rupert. Lower portfolio revenues following asset sales, including The Cosmopolitan of Las Vegas were partially offset by lower valuation adjustments and mark-to-market impacts. Net revenues in 2014 included mark-to-market losses of  314 million related to a Maher Terminals debt re-financing and a 151 million loss related to the Special Commodities Group from our exposure to traded products in the U.S. power sector.

 

Provisions for credit losses decreased by 206 million, or 79 %, in comparison to 2014. This reduction was predominantly driven by lower credit losses for IAS 39 reclassified assets which included releases related to real estate exposures.

  

      

        

    

 
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    62
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Noninterest expenses increased by 265 million, or 9 %, predominately driven by higher litigation-related expenses. Noninterest expenses excluding litigation charges were 40 % lower year-on year, driven by asset sales including The Cosmopolitan of Las Vegas and the non-recurrence of a one-time impairment in the prior year related to Maher Terminals.

The loss before income taxes was 2.7 billion, an improvement of 167 million compared to 2014. Higher revenues and lower credit losses were the main drivers, while noninterest expenses were higher with regard to litigation related matters.

2014

In 2014, the focus of NCOU de-risking activity was to progress the disposal of operating assets previously held in the former Corporate Investments division. Sales completed in 2014 included BHF-BANK and The Cosmopolitan of Las Vegas. These were supplemented by the further winding down of legacy banking assets, such as the early termination of some of the credit derivative protection in the monoline portfolio together with the sale of underlying bonds as well as a significant reduction in CRD 4 exposure from the credit correlation portfolio. Asset de-risking in 2014 delivered net gains of 181 million.

Net revenues for the NCOU in the reporting period decreased by 724 million, or 81 %, to 172 million. This reflects a lower level of portfolio revenues in line with the asset reductions achieved and lower de-risking gains partially offset by lower valuation adjustments in the period. In 2014 specific items included 314 million of accumulated mark-to-market loss on a swap transaction relating to the restructuring of the debt financing of Maher Terminals which resulted in a reclassification of the cumulative mark-to-market loss from other comprehensive income to other income and a  151 million loss related to the Special Commodities Group from our exposure to traded products in the U.S. power sector. Net revenues in 2013 included a 183 million loss related to the sale of BHF-BANK, 171 million negative effect from the first-time application of Funding Valuation Adjustment (FVA) and mortgage repurchase costs of  122 million.

Provisions for credit losses decreased by 559 million, or 68 %, in comparison to 2013, driven by a decrease in provisions for credit losses in IAS 39 reclassified and commercial real estate assets.

Noninterest expenses decreased by 745 million, or 21 %, in comparison to 2013, predominately due to lower litigation-related expenses. Direct costs also decreased by 327 million, or 21 % driven by the sale of BHF-BANK in the year as well as other de-risking measures. This was offset by a specific impairment charge of 194 million taken against our investment in Maher Terminals in 2014.

The loss before income taxes was 2.9 billion, an improvement of 579 million compared to the prior year. Lower revenues and lower credit losses reflect the progress of de-risking, while noninterest expenses were lower but continued to be impacted by the timing and nature of specific items.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
63   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

 

Consolidation & Adjustments

 

      
                                           2015 increase (decrease)
from 2014
         2014 increase (decrease)
from 2013
      

in m.

(unless stated otherwise)

        2015           2014           2013           in   m.           in %           in  m.           in %       

Net revenues1

        (30        (240        (519        210           (87        279           (54    

Provision for credit losses

        1           1           0           0           18           0           38       

Compensation and benefits

        4,329           3,798           3,644           531           14           154           4       

General and administrative expenses

        (3,604        (3,759        (3,013        155           (4        (746        25       

Policyholder benefits and claims

        0           0           0           0           N/M           0           N/M       
Impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets         0           0           0           0           N/M           0           N/M       

Restructuring activities

        0           (0        0           0           N/M           (0        N/M       

Total noninterest expenses

        724           39           631           686           N/M           (593        (94    

Noncontrolling interests

        (27        (28        (15        1           (4        (13        82       

Income (loss) before income taxes

        (729        (251        (1,136        (478        190           884           (78    

Assets2

        10,880           10,474           10,371           407           4           102           1       

Risk-weighted assets3

        11,283           20,437           10,832           (9,154        (45        9,606           89       

Average active equity4

          7             0             0             7             N/M             0             N/M       

N/M – Not meaningful

1   Net interest income and noninterest income.

2   Assets in C&A reflect corporate assets, such as deferred tax assets or central clearing accounts, outside the management responsibility of the business segments.

3   Risk-weighted assets are based upon Basel 2.5 rules through December 31, 2013 and upon CRR/CRD 4 fully-loaded since January 1, 2014. Risk-weighted assets in C&A reflect corporate assets outside the management responsibility of the business segments, primarily those corporate assets related to the Group’s pension schemes. The decrease of risk-weighted assets in 2013 was primarily driven by the de-risking initiatives in our pension assets.

4   Average active equity assigned to C&A reflects the residual amount of equity that is not allocated to the segments as described in Note 4 “Business Segments and Related Information”.

  

  

  

    

   

   
   

 

2015

 

In 2015, C&A net revenues of negative  30 million included negative  146 million in valuation and timing differences driven by a narrowing of our own credit spread, and a narrowing of the basis spread between EUR/USD, as well as an impact from a change in valuation methodology for debt held at fair value. Revenues also included negative  130 million resulting from the Postbank squeeze out. These negative effects were partly offset by a positive  72 million from FVA on internal uncollateralized intercompany derivatives.

 

Noninterest expenses of  724 million were mainly driven by  358 million litigation costs related to infrastructure functions as well as  68 million costs associated with the deconsolidation of Postbank including a related real estate transfer tax. Noninterest expenses also include a  54 million provision for compensation related costs.

 

Loss before income taxes was at  729 million in 2015 compared to a loss of  251 million in 2014. The development was primarily driven by the litigation costs related to infrastructure functions.

 

2014

 

In 2014, C&A net revenues of negative  240 million included negative  172 million in valuation and timing differences, compared to negative  249 million in 2013 as volatility in USD/EUR cross-currency basis spreads was down and effect from own credit spread decreased. Revenues also included a  66 million loss from FVA on internal uncollateralized intercompany derivatives.

 

Noninterest expenses of  39 million declined by 94 % compared to prior year mainly due to a  528 million non-recurring major litigation charge in 2013.

 

Loss before income taxes at  251 million compared to a loss of  1.1 billion in 2013. The development was primarily driven by the non-recurrence of the aforementioned major litigation item.

  

      

    

   

  

     

   

   

 
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    64
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Financial Position

 

                                  2015 increase (decrease) from 2014  
in m.         Dec 31, 2015           Dec 31, 2014           in m.          in %  
Cash and central bank balances1         96,940            74,482            22,458           30   
Interbank balances (w/o central banks)1         12,842            9,090            3,752           41   
Central bank funds sold, securities purchased under resale agreements and securities borrowed         56,013            43,630            12,383           28   
Trading assets         196,035            195,681            354           0   
Positive market values from derivative financial instruments         515,594            629,958            (114,364        (18
Financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss         109,253            117,285            (8,033        (7

thereof:

                      

Securities purchased under resale agreements

        51,073            60,473            (9,400        (16

Securities borrowed

        21,489            20,404            1,085           5   
Loans         427,749            405,612            22,137           5   
Brokerage and securities related receivables         94,939            115,054            (20,115        (17
Remaining assets         119,765            117,911            1,854           2   
Total assets         1,629,130            1,708,703            (79,573        (5
Deposits         566,974            532,931            34,043           6   
Central bank funds purchased, securities sold under repurchase agreements and securities loaned         13,073            13,226            (153        (1
Trading liabilities         52,304            41,843            10,461           25   
Negative market values from derivative financial instruments         494,076            610,202            (116,126        (19
Financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss         44,852            37,131            7,721           21   

thereof:

                      

Securities sold under repurchase agreements

        31,637            21,053            10,585           50   

Securities loaned

        554            1,189            (635        (53
Other short-term borrowings         28,010            42,931            (14,921        (35
Long-term debt         160,016            144,837            15,179           10   
Brokerage and securities related payables         134,637            143,210            (8,574        (6
Remaining liabilities         67,564            69,170            (1,605        (2
Total liabilities         1,561,506            1,635,481            (73,975        (5
Total equity           67,624              73,223              (5,599          (8
1 

In 2015, comparatives have been restated. See Note 1 “Significant Accounting Policies and Critical Accounting Estimates – Significant Changes in Estimates and Changes in Presentation” for detailed information.

Movements in Assets

Total assets decreased by  80 billion (or 5 %) compared to December 31, 2014. This movement included an increase of  86 billion due to foreign exchange rate movements mainly driven by the depreciation of the euro against all other major currencies during the period, of which  71 billion was related to the significant strengthening of the U.S. dollar versus the euro. These effects from foreign exchange rate movements are also reflected in the development of the balance sheet line items discussed in this section. Assuming the period-end exchange rates for the euro had not changed, we would have reduced our balance sheet by  165 billion over the period.

The primary driver of the net decrease during the period was a  114 billion decrease in positive market values from derivative financial instruments during the period ( 142 billion net of foreign exchange rate movements). This decrease particularly for interest rate products was primarily related to market movements including rising swap spreads as well as the Bank’s focus on deleveraging programs.

Brokerage and securities related receivables were down by  20 billion, mainly due to a decrease in receivables from pending settlements to record low levels as a result of reduced trading activities towards the end of the year.

To align our financial reporting with regulatory reporting requirements, we have changed our presentation of cash and due from banks, now allowing for a separate reporting of cash and central bank balances versus interbank balances. The split for prior periods was restated accordingly. See Note 1 “Significant Accounting Policies and Critical Accounting Estimates – Significant Changes in Estimates and Changes in Presentation” for detailed information. During the year 2015, cash and central bank balances increased by  22 billion, largely driven by increased deposits held with central

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
65   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

banks in selected jurisdictions. These increases supported an increase in our overall group liquidity stress test position, and enabled us to satisfy local liquidity requirements for certain EU entities following the implementation of the EU Liquidity Coverage Ratio.

Loans increased by  22 billion, with more than half of the increase relating to foreign exchange rate movements. Exposure increases in CB&S Structured Finance, Deutsche AWM and PBC were partly being offset by managed reductions in NCOU.

Financial assets available for sale (reported as part of Remaining Assets) increased by  9 billion mainly driven by increases in highly liquid securities held in the Group’s Strategic Liquidity Reserve. These increases are the result of the Group’s ongoing optimization of its liquidity reserves.

Movements in Liabilities

As of December 31, 2015, total liabilities decreased by  74 billion (or 5 %) compared to year-end 2014. Similar to total assets, foreign exchange rate movements during the period had a significant offsetting impact which is already embedded in the overall movements in liabilities as discussed in this section.

Negative market values from derivative financial instruments and brokerage and securities related payables decreased by  116 billion ( 143 billion net of foreign exchange rate movements) and  9 billion, respectively, primarily due to the same factors as the movements in positive market values from derivative financial instruments and brokerage and securities related receivables as discussed above.

Other short-term borrowings decreased by  15 billion, mainly from reductions in our funding through Financing Vehicles, and, to a lesser extent, in GTB.

These decreases were partially offset by the following movements:

Deposits increased by  34 billion, primarily in our funding through transaction banking, largely related to increased current account deposits stemming from clearing activities, as well as in retail and unsecured wholesale funding. Almost half of the increase was related to foreign exchange rate movements.

Long-term debt increased by  15 billion, primarily driven by higher funding activities which exceeded the amount of debt that matured during the period as well as foreign exchange rate movements.

Trading liabilities increased by  10 billion, with more than half of the increase relating to equity securities, primarily in our Prime Finance business, and the remainder to debt securities.

Central bank funds purchased, securities sold under repurchase agreements and securities loaned, under both accrual and fair value accounting, increased by  10 billion in total, largely impacted by higher secured funding of highly liquid inventory.

Liquidity

Liquidity reserves amounted to 215 billion as of December 31, 2015 (compared to 184 billion as of December 31, 2014). We maintained a positive liquidity stress result as of December 31, 2015 (under the combined scenario).

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    66
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Equity

Total Equity as of December 31, 2015 decreased by 5.6 billion. The main factors contributing to this development were a net loss attributable to Deutsche Bank shareholders and additional equity components of  6.8 billion, cash dividends paid to Deutsche Bank shareholders of 1.0 billion, unrealized net losses on financial assets available for sale of  291 million, which mainly resulted from lower market prices of debt securities from European issuers as well as coupons paid on additional equity components of 228 million net of tax. Partly offsetting was a positive effect from exchange rate changes of  2.0 billion (especially in the U.S. dollar).

Regulatory Capital

Our CET 1 capital according to CRR/CRD 4 as of December 31, 2015 was  52.4 billion, compared to  60.1 billion as of December 31, 2014. Mainly due to the decreased CET 1 capital the CRR/CRD 4 CET 1 capital ratio as of December 31, 2015 decreased to 13.2 % compared to 15.2 % as of December 31, 2014. Risk-weighted assets according to CRR/CRD 4 changed only slightly to 397.4 billion as of December 31, 2015, compared to 396.6 billion as of December 31, 2014.

Our fully loaded CRR/CRD 4 CET 1 capital as of December 31, 2015 amounted to  44.1 billion resulting in a fully loaded CRR/CRD 4 CET 1 capital ratio of 11.1 %, with corresponding amounts of 46.1 billion and 11.7 % in 2014. Fully loaded CRR/CRD 4 RWA were  396.7 billion as of December 31, 2015, compared to  394.0 billion as of December 31, 2014. For details of the development please refer to “Management Report: Risk and Capital Performance: Capital and Leverage Ratio”.

Amendments to IAS 39 and IFRS 7, “Reclassification of Financial Assets”

As of December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014 the carrying value of reclassified assets was  4.4 billion and  7.4 billion, respectively, compared with a fair value of  4.3 billion and  7.4 billion as of December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, respectively. These assets are held in the NCOU.

Please refer to Note 13 “Amendments to IAS 39 and IFRS 7, ‘Reclassification of Financial Assets’” for additional information on these assets and on the impact of their reclassification.

Exposure to Monoline Insurers

The deterioration of the U.S. subprime mortgage and related markets has generated large exposures to financial guarantors, such as monoline insurers, that have insured or guaranteed the value of pools of collateral referenced by CDOs and other market-traded securities. Actual claims against monoline insurers will only become due if actual defaults occur in the underlying assets (or collateral). There is ongoing uncertainty as to whether some monoline insurers will be able to meet all their liabilities to banks and other buyers of protection. Under certain conditions (i.e., liquidation) we can accelerate claims regardless of actual losses on the underlying assets.

The following tables summarize the fair value of our counterparty exposures to monoline insurers with respect to U.S. residential mortgage-related activity and other activities, respectively, in each case on the basis of the fair value of the assets compared with the notional value guaranteed or underwritten by monoline insurers. The other exposures described in the second table arise from a range of client and trading activity, including collateralized loan obligations, commercial mortgage-backed securities, trust preferred securities, student loans and public sector or municipal debt. The tables show the associated Credit Valuation Adjustments (“CVA”) that we have recorded against the exposures. For monolines with actively traded CDS, the CVA is calculated using a full CDS-based valuation model. For monolines without actively traded CDS, a model-based approach is used with various input factors, including relevant market driven default probabilities, the likelihood of an event (either a restructuring or an insolvency), an assessment of any potential settlement in the event of a restructuring, and recovery rates in the event of either restructuring or insolvency.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
67   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

The ratings in the tables below are the lowest of Standard & Poor’s, Moody’s or our own internal credit ratings. The table reflects the migration of balances from non investment-grade to investment-grade following the acquisition of Radian Asset Assurance Inc by Assured Guaranty Corp during 2015.

 

Monoline exposure related to U.S.

residential mortgages

   Dec 31, 2015        Dec 31, 2014  
in m.   

Notional  

amount  

    

Value  

prior to  

CVA  

     CVA       

Fair value  

after CVA  

    

Notional  

amount  

    

Value  

prior to  

CVA  

     CVA       

  Fair value

after CVA  

 

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

AA Monolines:

                       

Other subprime

     97           24           (5)          19           95           30           (7)          23     

Alt-A

     400           97           (12)          85           1,405           423           (61)          361     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total AA Monolines

     497           121           (17)          104           1,500           452           (68)          384     

 

 
Other Monoline exposure    Dec 31, 2015        Dec 31, 2014    
in m.   

Notional  

amount  

    

Value  

prior to  

CVA  

     CVA       

Fair value  

after CVA  

    

Notional  

amount  

    

Value  

prior to  

CVA  

     CVA       

Fair value  

after CVA  

 

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

AA Monolines:

                       

TPS-CLO

     1,288           332           (64)          268           1,269           254           (43)          210     

CMBS

     378           0           0           0           712           (2)          0           (2)    

Corporate single name/Corporate CDO

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

Student loans

     360           52           (14)          38           322           44           (9)          35     

Other

     749           84           (29)          55           506           72           (14)          59     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total AA Monolines

     2,775           468           (107)          361           2,810           368           (66)          302     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Non investment-grade Monolines:

                       

TPS-CLO

     23           5           (2)          3           329           77           (16)          61     

CMBS

     1,443           (1)          0           (1)          1,476           (2)          0           (2)    

Corporate single name/Corporate CDO

     24           4           (1)          3           28           5           0           5     

Student loans

     746           84           (14)          70           679           66           (9)          57     

Other

     502           97           (31)          66           774           136           (50)          86     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Non investment-grade Monolines

     2,738           189           (48)          141           3,285           282           (75)          207     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     5,513           657           (155)          502           6,095           650           (141)          509     

 

 

The tables exclude counterparty exposure to monoline insurers that relates to wrapped bonds. A wrapped bond is one that is insured or guaranteed by a third party. As of December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, there was no exposure on wrapped bonds related to U.S. residential mortgages and the exposure on wrapped bonds other than those related to U.S. residential mortgages was  23 million and  22 million, respectively. In each case, the exposure represents an estimate of the potential mark-downs of wrapped assets in the event of monoline defaults.

A proportion of the mark-to-market monoline exposure has been mitigated with CDS protection arranged with other market counterparties and other economic hedge activity.

The total Credit Valuation Adjustment held against monoline insurers as of December 31, 2015 was  172 million. The reduction in the overall monoline CVA reserve versus December 31, 2014, is driven by the reduced exposure as a result of derisking activity completed during the period.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    68
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

 

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
69   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

 

[Portion of page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

Tabular Disclosure of Contractual Obligations

Cash payment requirements outstanding as of December 31, 2015.

 

Contractual obligations         Payment due by period  
in m.         Total          

Less than

1 year

          1–3 years           3–5 years          

More than

5 years

 

Long-term debt obligations 1

        177,953            29,250            58,927            34,190            55,585   

Trust preferred securities 1

        8,516            1,459            5,148            624            1,285   
Long-term financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss 2         9,071            2,084            2,721            740            3,526   

Finance lease obligations

        97            6            13            8            70   

Operating lease obligations

        5,170            773            1,325            1,073            1,999   

Purchase obligations

        2,012            502            866            487            157   

Long-term deposits 1

        28,139            0            10,842            4,537            12,761   

Other long-term liabilities

        6,365            1,473            821            1,087            2,983   

Total

          237,322              35,548              80,662              42,746              78,366   
1 

Includes interest payments.

2 

Long-term debt and long-term deposits designated at fair value through profit or loss.

Figures above do not include the revenues of noncancelable sublease rentals of  91 million on operating leases. Purchase obligations for goods and services include future payments for, among other things, information technology services and facility management. Some figures above for purchase obligations represent minimum contractual payments and actual future payments may be higher. Long-term deposits exclude contracts with a remaining maturity of less than one year. Under certain conditions future payments for some long-term financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss may occur earlier. See the following notes to the consolidated financial statements for further information: Note 5 “Net Interest Income and Net Gains (Losses) on Financial Assets/Liabilities at Fair Value through Profit or Loss”, Note 24 “Leases”, Note 28 “Deposits” and Note 32 “Long-Term Debt and Trust Preferred Securities”.

Events after the Reporting Period

On February 23, 2016 we announced the successful completion of the tender offer to repurchase up to  3 billion of five Euro-denominated issues of senior unsecured debt securities. The resulting accepted total volume amounted to  1.27 billion. In addition, on February 29, 2016 we announced the initial results of the tender offer to repurchase up to U.S.$ 2 billion of eight U.S. dollar-denominated issues of senior unsecured debt securities. The resulting accepted total volume amounted to U.S.$ 740 million. We expect to record a positive income in the first quarter of 2016 related to these transactions of approximately 55 million.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    70
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
71   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    72
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
73   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    74
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
75   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    76
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
77   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    78
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

                    

 


Table of Contents

Risk Report

 

  Introduction – 80
81   Risk and Capital Overview
  Key Risk Metric – 81
  Overall Risk Assessment – 82
  Risk Profile – 83
85   Risk and Capital Framework
  Risk Management Principles and Governance – 85
  Risk Governance – 86
  Risk Culture – 90
  Risk Appetite and Capacity – 91
  Risk and Capital Plan – 92
  Stress testing – 93
  Recovery and Resolution Planning – 95
96   Risk and Capital Management
  Risk Identification and Assessment – 97
  Credit Risk Management – 98
  Market Risk Management – 105
  Operational Risk – 112
  Liquidity Risk Management – 117
  Business (Strategic) Risk Management – 122
  Reputational Risk Management – 122
  Model Risk Management – 122
  Compliance Risk Management – 123
  Insurance Specific Risk – 124
  Risk Concentration and Risk Diversification – 124
125   Risk and Capital Performance
  Capital and Leverage Ratio – 125
  Credit Risk Exposure – 138
  Equity Exposure – 159
  Asset Quality – 159
  Trading Market Risk Exposures – 169
  Nontrading Market Risk Exposures – 174
  Operational Risk Exposure – 175
  Liquidity Risk Exposure – 177
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    80
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Introduction

Disclosures in line with IFRS 7 and IAS 1, as well as IFRS 4

The following Risk Report provides qualitative and quantitative disclosures about credit, market and other risks in line with the requirements of International Financial Reporting Standard 7 (IFRS 7) Financial Instruments: Disclosures, and capital disclosures required by International Accounting Standard 1 (IAS 1) Presentation of Financial Statements, as well as qualitative and quantitative disclosures about insurance risks in line with the requirements of International Financial Reporting Standard 4 (IFRS 4) Insurance contracts. Information which forms part of and is incorporated by reference into the financial statements of this report is marked by a bracket in the margins throughout this Risk Report.

Disclosures according to Pillar 3 of the Basel 3 Capital Framework

Most disclosures according to Pillar 3 of the Basel 3 Capital Framework, which are implemented in the European Union by the CRR and supported by EBA Implementing Technical Standards are published in our re-established additional Pillar 3 report, which can be found on our webpage. In cases where disclosures in this Risk Report also support Pillar 3 disclosure requirements these are highlighted by references from the Pillar 3 Report into the Risk Report.

Disclosures according to principles and recommendations of the Enhanced Disclosure Task Force (EDTF)

In 2012 the Enhanced Disclosure Task Force (“EDTF”) was established as a private sector initiative under the auspice of the Financial Stability Board, with the primary objective to develop fundamental principles for enhanced risk disclosures and to recommend improvements to existing risk disclosures. As a member of the EDTF we adhered to the disclosure recommendations in this Risk Report and also partly in our re-established additional Pillar 3 Report.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
81   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Overview   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                               
     

 

                    

Risk and Capital Overview

Key Risk Metrics

The following selected key risk ratios and corresponding metrics form part of our holistic risk management across individual risk types. Common Equity Tier 1 Ratio (CET 1), Internal Capital Adequacy Ratio (ICA), Leverage Ratio (LR), Liquidity Coverage Ratio (LCR), and Stressed Net Liquidity Position (SNLP) as high level metrics are fully integrated across strategic planning, risk appetite framework, stress testing, and recovery & resolution planning practices, which are reviewed and approved by our Management Board at least annually. Apart from Internal Capital Adequacy Ratio and Total Economic Capital, the following ratios and metrics are based on the fully loaded CRR/CRD 4 rules.

 

Common Equity Tier 1 Ratio

2015: 11.1 %

2014: 11.7 %

  

Total Risk-Weighted Assets

2015: € 396.7 billion

2014: 394.0 billion

Internal Capital Adequacy Ratio

2015: 146 %

2014: 174 %

  

Total Economic Capital

2015: € 38.4 billion

2014: 31.9 billion

Leverage Ratio

2015: 3.5 %

2014: 3.5 %

  

Leverage Exposure

2015: € 1,395 billion

2014: 1,445 billion

Liquidity Coverage Ratio

2015: 119 %

20141: 119 %

  

Stressed Net Liquidity Position

2015: € 46 billion

2014: 24 billion

  

 

1 

Calculated in accordance with the Basel 3 specification.

For further details please refer to sections “Risk Appetite and Capacity, Recovery and Resolution Planning, Stress Testing, Risk Profile, Internal Capital Adequacy Assessment Process, Capital Instruments, Development of Regulatory Capital, Development of Risk-Weighted Assets, Leverage Ratio, Liquidity Coverage Ratio, Liquidity Buffer, Stress Testing and Scenario Analysis, and High Quality Liquidity Assets”.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    82
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Overall Risk Assessment

Key risk categories include 1) financial risks such as credit risk (counterparty risk, industry risk, country risk and product risk), market risk (trading, non-trading and traded default risk), liquidity risk, business risk (including tax and strategic risk), and 2) non-financial risks (NFRs) including reputational risk and operational risk (with important sub-categories compliance risk, legal risk, model risk, information security risks, fraud risks, and money laundering risks). We manage the identification, assessment and mitigation of top and emerging risks through an internal governance process and the use of risk management tools and processes. Our approach to identification and impact assessment aims to ensure that we mitigate the impact of these risks on our financial results, long term strategic goals and reputation. Please refer to section "Risk and Capital Management" for detailed information on the management of our material risks.

As part of our regular risk and cross-risk analysis, sensitivities of the key portfolio risks are reviewed using a bottom-up risk assessment and through a top-down macro-economic and political scenario analysis. This two-pronged approach allows us to capture not only risks that have an impact across our risk inventories and business divisions but also those that are relevant only to specific portfolios.

Current portfolio-wide risks on which we continue to focus include: the economic slowdown and financial market volatility in China and potential contagion to other economies, the impact of the ongoing slump in oil prices on key producing countries and related industries and the potential increases in interest rates by the U.S. Federal Reserve Bank, which could drive further capital outflows from Emerging Markets. In addition, global geopolitical risks remain elevated and have intensified in recent months.

Our credit exposure from the Oil & Gas sector accounts for less than 2 % of our total main credit exposure and approximately 16 billion, of which gross loans account for 5 billion and irrevocable lending commitments account for 8 billion. In our view we do not have over-sized concentrations in Emerging Markets countries. Our China credit portfolio is mainly with systemically important local Financial Institutions, financially strong state-owned, privately owned corporates and subsidiaries of Multinational Companies. More information is included in “Credit Risk Exposure” section.

The assessment of the potential impacts of these risks is made through integration into our group-wide stress tests which assess our ability to absorb these events should they occur. The results of these tests showed that we currently have adequate capital and liquidity reserves to absorb the impact of these risks if they were to materialize in line with the tests’ parameters. Information about risk and capital positions for our portfolios can be found in the “Risk and Capital Performance” section.

Consistent with prior years, the year 2015 continued to demonstrate the trend of increasing global regulation of the financial services industry, which we view as likely to persist through the coming years. We are focused on identifying potential political and regulatory changes and assessing the possible impact on our business model and processes.

The overall focus of Risk and Capital Management throughout 2015 was on maintaining our risk profile in line with our risk strategy, increasing our capital base and supporting our strategic management initiatives with a focus on balance sheet optimization. This approach is reflected across the different risk metrics summarized below.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
83   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Overview   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Risk Profile

The table below shows our overall risk position as measured by the economic capital usage calculated for credit, market, operational and business risk for the dates specified. To determine our overall (economic capital) risk position, we generally consider diversification benefits across risk types.

Overall risk position as measured by economic capital usage by risk type

 

                 2015 increase (decrease)
from 2014
 

in m. (unless stated otherwise)

   Dec 31, 2015     Dec 31, 2014     in   m.     in %  

Credit risk

     13,685        12,885        799        6   

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Market risk

     17,436        14,852        2,583        17   

Trading market risk

     4,557        4,955        (397     (8

Nontrading market risk

     12,878        9,898        2,981        30   

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operational risk

     10,243        7,598        2,644        35   

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Business risk

     5,931        3,084        2,846        92   

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Diversification benefit 1

     (8,852     (6,554     (2,297     35   

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total economic capital usage

     38,442        31,866        6,576        21   

 

 
1 

Diversification benefit across credit, market, operational and strategic risk (largest part of business risk).

As of December 31, 2015, our economic capital usage amounted to  38.4 billion, which was  6.6 billion, or 21 %, above the  31.9 billion economic capital usage as of December 31, 2014. The higher overall risk position was mainly driven by a higher loss profile for strategic risk and operational risk, methodology enhancements in nontrading market risk and internal model recalibration in credit risk.

The economic capital usage for credit risk increased to  13.7 billion as of December 31, 2015, 799 million or 6 % higher compared to year-end 2014. This change mainly reflects increases from the internal model recalibration.

The economic capital usage for trading market risk decreased by 397 million and was mainly driven by reductions in the credit spread and foreign exchange components. Nontrading market risk economic capital usage increased by 3.0 billion or 30 % to 12.9 billion as of December 31, 2015. The increase is mainly driven by methodology enhancements with regards to capturing credit spread risk of securities held as liquidity reserve, participation and equity compensation risk as well as an increased structural foreign exchange risk exposure mostly due to appreciation of the US dollar against the Euro.

The operational risk economic capital usage totaled  10.2 billion as of December 31, 2015, which is  2.6 billion or 35 % higher compared to year-end 2014. The increase was mainly driven by legal operational risk losses including legal provisions and an increased operational risk loss profile of the industry as a whole. This is reflected in the operational risk loss data that has given rise to the increased economic capital usage and which is largely due to the outflows related to litigation, investigations and regulatory enforcement actions.

Our business risk economic capital methodology captures strategic risk, which also implicitly includes elements of non-standard risks including refinancing and reputational risk, and a tax risk component. The business risk increased by 2.8 billion to  5.9 billion as of December 31, 2015. This increase reflected a higher economic capital usage for the strategic risk component driven by a combination of planned restructuring costs and conservative earnings expectations for 2016.

The inter-risk diversification effect of the economic capital usage across credit, market, operational and strategic risk increased by  2.3 billion, or 35 %, as of December 31, 2015, due to an increase in economic capital usage before diversification and a methodology update in the first quarter 2015.

Our mix of various business activities results in diverse risk taking by our business divisions. We also measure the key risks inherent in their respective business models through the undiversified Total Economic Capital (EC) metric, which mirrors each business division’s risk profile before taking into account cross-risk effects at the Group level.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    84
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Risk profile of our business divisions as measured by economic capital and risk-weighted assets

 

     Dec 31, 2015     

in m. (unless
stated otherwise)

   Corporate  
Banking &  
Securities  
     Private &  
Business  
Clients  
     Global  
Transaction  
Banking  
     Deutsche  
Asset &  
Wealth  
Management  
     Non-Core  
Operations  
Unit  
     Consoli-  
dation &  
Adjustments  
     Total  
in m.  
     Total   
in %   
 

Credit Risk

     6,634           3,724           2,076           456           777           18           13,685           36      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Market Risk

     5,722           4,264           203           2,248           695           4,303           17,436           45      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Operational Risk

     6,778           871           1,077           1,054           463           0           10,243           27      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Business Risk

     5,662           0           7           1           261           0           5,931           15      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Diversification Benefit 1

     (5,691)          (1,314)          (622 )         (714)          (377)          (133)          (8,852)          (23)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total EC in € m.

     19,105           7,544           2,741           3,045           1,819           4,188           38,442           100      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

in %

     50           20           7           8           5           11           100           N/M      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Risk-weighted assets 2

     195,096           80,016           52,062           23,795           34,463           11,283           396,714           N/M      

 

 

N/M - Not meaningful

 

1 Diversification benefit across credit, market, operational and strategic risk (largest part of business risk).
2 Risk-weighted assets and capital ratios are based upon CRR/CRD 4 fully-loaded.

 

     Dec 31, 2014     

in m. (unless stated
otherwise)

   Corporate  
Banking  
&  
Securities  
     Private &  
Business  
Clients  
     Global  
Transaction  
Banking  
     Deutsche  
Asset &  
Wealth  
Management  
     Non-Core  
Operations  
Unit  
     Consoli-  
dation &  
Adjustments  
     Total in
   m.  
     Total   
in %   
 

Credit Risk

     5,799           3,547           2,302           323           868           46           12,885           40      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Market Risk

     5,153           3,200           185           1,987           1,308           3,020           14,852           47      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Operational Risk

     3,569           1,088           150           722           2,070           0           7,598           24      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Business Risk

     2,581           0           4           1           499           0           3,084           10      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Diversification Benefit 1

     (3,441)          (1,095)          (262)          (611)          (1,087)          (59)          (6,554)          (21)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total EC in € m.

     13,661           6,740           2,379           2,420           3,658           3,008           31,866           100      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

in %

     43           21           7           8           11           9           100           N/M      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Risk-weighted assets 2

     175,575           79,571           43,265           16,597           58,524           20,437           393,969           N/M      

 

 

N/M - Not meaningful

 

1 

Diversification benefit across credit, market, operational and strategic risk (largest part of business risk).

2 

Risk-weighted assets and capital ratios are based upon CRR/CRD 4 fully-loaded. Amounts allocated to the business segments have been restated to reflect comparatives according to the structure as of December 31, 2015.

Corporate Banking & Securities’ (CB&S) risk profile is dominated by its trading in support of origination, structuring and market making activities, which gives rise to market risk and credit risk. Further credit risks originate from exposures to corporates and financial institutions. The share of the operational risk in CB&S’ risk profile has increased significantly over the last year reflecting a higher loss profile in the industry, internal losses as well as a change in the allocation methodology within the Group. The remainder of CB&S’ risk profile is derived from strategic risk component of the business risk in light of the less optimistic earnings outlook for 2016.

Private & Business Clients’ (PBC) risk profile comprises credit risk from retail and small and medium-sized enterprises (SMEs) lending as well as nontrading market risk from investment risk, modeling of client deposits and credit spread risk. The increase in PBC’s overall risk profile over 2015 was mainly driven by methodology update for investment risk (primarily related to Hua Xia Bank Co. Ltd.) as well as higher credit spread risk.

Global Transaction Banking’s (GTB) revenues are generated from various products with different risk profiles. The vast majority of its risk relates to credit risk in the Trade Finance business and operational risk. The relatively low market risk mainly results from modeling of client deposits.

The main risk driver of Deutsche Asset & Wealth Management’s (Deutsche AWM) business are guarantees on investment funds, which we report as nontrading market risk. Otherwise Deutsche AWM’s advisory and commission focused business attracts primarily operational risk. The increased economic capital usage over 2015 was mainly driven by a higher non-trading market risk from increased credit spread and default risk in guaranteed funds’ portfolio composition as well as an increased share from group operational risk capital based on the change in the divisional allocation methodology within the AMA model.

 

                    G

 


Table of Contents
85   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Framework   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

 

The Non-Core Operations Unit (NCOU) portfolio includes activities that are non-core to the Bank’s future strategy; assets earmarked for de-risking; assets suitable for separation; assets with significant capital absorption but low returns; and assets exposed to legal risks. NCOU’s risk profile covers risks across the entire range of our operations primarily comprising credit and market risks targeted where possible for accelerated de-risking. The share of the operational risk in NCOU’s risk profile has decreased significantly over the last year reflecting a change in the allocation methodology within the Group.

 

Consolidation & Adjustments mainly comprises nontrading market risk for structural foreign exchange risk, pension risk and equity compensation risk. The increase in nontrading market risk compared to 2014 was mainly driven a higher structural foreign exchange risk and a methodology change for equity compensation risk.

 

Risk and Capital Framework

 

Risk Management Principles and Governance

 

The diversity of our business model requires us to identify, assess, measure, aggregate and manage our risks, and to allocate our capital among our businesses. Risk and capital are managed via a framework of principles, organizational structures and measurement and monitoring processes that are closely aligned with the activities of the divisions and business units:

 

  

—   Core risk management responsibilities are embedded in the Management Board and delegated to senior risk management committees responsible for execution and oversight. The Supervisory Board regularly monitors the risk and capital profile.

—   We operate a Three Lines of Defense (“3LoD”) risk management model. The 1st Line of Defense (“1st LoD”) are all the business divisions and service providing infrastructure areas (Group Technology Operations and Corporate Services) who are the "owners" of the risks. The 2nd Line of Defense (“2nd LoD”) are all the independent risk and control infrastructure functions. The 3rd Line of Defense (“3rd LoD”) is Group Audit, which assures the effectiveness of our controls. The 3LoD model and the underlying design principles apply to all levels of the organization, i.e., group-level, regions, countries, branches and legal entities. All 3LoD are independent of one another and accountable for maintaining structures that ensure adherence to the design principles at all levels.

—   Risk strategy is approved by the Management Board on an annual basis and is defined based on the Group Risk Appetite and Strategic and Capital Plan in order to align risk, capital and performance targets.

—   Cross-risk analysis reviews are conducted across the Group to validate that sound risk management practices and a holistic awareness of risk exist.

—   All material risk types are managed via risk management processes, including: credit risk, market risk, operational risk, liquidity risk, business risk, reputational risk, model risk and compliance risk. Modeling and measurement approaches for quantifying risk and capital demand are implemented across the material risk types. Non-standard risks (reputational risk, model risk, compliance risk) are implicitly covered in our economic capital framework, primarily within operational and strategic risk. For more details, refer to section “Risk and Capital Management” for the management process of our material risks.

—   Monitoring, stress testing tools and escalation processes are in place for key capital and liquidity thresholds and metrics.

—  Systems, processes and policies are critical components of our risk management capability.

—   Recovery planning provides the escalation path for crisis management governance and supplies senior management with a list of actions designed to improve the capital and liquidity positions in a stress event.

—   Resolution planning is closely supervised by our resolution authority, the Single Resolution Board (“SRB”). It provides a strategy to manage Deutsche Bank in case of default. It is designed to prevent the need for tax payer bailout and strengthen financial stability by the continuation of critical services delivered to the wider economy.

    
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    86
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

   

Risk Governance

 

Our operations throughout the world are regulated and supervised by relevant authorities in each of the jurisdictions in which we conduct business. Such regulation focuses on licensing, capital adequacy, liquidity, risk concentration, conduct of business as well as organizational and reporting requirements. The European Central Bank in connection with the competent authorities of EU countries which joined the Single Supervisory Mechanism via the Joint Supervisory Team act in cooperation as our primary supervisors to monitor our compliance with the German Banking Act and other applicable laws and regulations as well as the CRR/CRD 4 framework and respective implementations into German law.

 

 

European banking regulators assess our capacity to assume risk in several ways, which are described in more detail in the section “Regulatory Capital” of this report.

 

Several layers of management provide cohesive risk governance:

 

   

—   The Supervisory Board is informed regularly and – as necessary – on special developments in our risk situation, risk management and risk controlling, as well as on our reputation and material litigation cases. It has formed various committees to handle specific tasks.

—   At the meetings of the Risk Committee, the Management Board reports on credit, market, liquidity, business, compliance, model, operational as well as litigation and reputational risks. It also reports on credit risk strategy, credit portfolios, loans requiring a Supervisory Board resolution pursuant to law or the Articles of Association, questions of capital resources and matters of special importance due to the risks they entail. The Risk Committee deliberates with the Management Board on issues of the aggregate risk disposition and the risk strategy and supports the Supervisory Board in monitoring the implementation of this strategy.

—   The Integrity Committee monitors the Management Board’s measures that promote the company’s compliance with legal requirements, authorities’ regulations and the company’s own in-house policies. It also reviews the Bank’s Code of Business Conduct and Ethics, monitors and analyzes the Bank’s legal and reputational risks and advocates their avoidance.

—   The Audit Committee monitors, among other matters, the effectiveness of the risk management system, particularly the internal control system and the internal audit system.

—   The Management Board is responsible for managing Deutsche Bank Group in accordance with the law, the Articles of Association and its Terms of Reference with the objective of creating sustainable value in the interest of the company, thus taking into consideration the interests of the shareholders, employees and other stakeholders. The Management Board is responsible for establishing a proper business organization, encompassing an appropriate and effective risk management. In agreement with the Supervisory Board and with the aim to ensure an effective governance of resources and risk, the Management Board has established the Capital and Risk Committee (“CaR”), the Risk Executive Committee (“Risk ExCo”),the Non-Financial Risk Executive Committee (“NFR ExCo”), and the Group Reputational Risk Committee (“GRRC”) whose roles are described in more detail below. In the fourth quarter of 2015, the Management Board streamlined the number of directly established committees. Hence, a revised committee governance structure is being prepared which will, going forward, combine risk management-relevant matters under one committee, starting 1. April 2016.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
87   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Framework   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

 

Risk Management Governance Structure of the Deutsche Bank Group

 

LOGO

 

The following functional committees are central to the management of risk in Deutsche Bank:

 

—   The CaR oversees and controls integrated planning and monitoring of our risk profile and capital capacity, providing an alignment of risk appetite, capital requirements and funding/liquidity needs with Group, divisional and sub-divisional business strategies. It provides a platform to discuss and agree strategic issues impacting capital, funding and liquidity among Risk, Government & Regulatory Affairs, Finance and the business divisions. The CaR initiates actions and/or makes recommendations to the Management Board. It is also responsible for monitoring our risk profile against our risk appetite on a regular basis and determining whether a matter should be escalated or other actions should be taken. The CaR monitors the performance of our risk profile against early warning indicators and recovery triggers, and provides recommendations to the Management Board to invoke defined processes and/or actions under the recovery governance framework if required.

—   The Risk ExCo identifies, controls and manages all risks including risk concentrations at Group level. It is responsible for risk policy, the organization and governance of risk management and oversees the execution of risk and capital management including identification, assessment and risk mitigation, within the scope of the risk and capital strategy (Risk and Capital Demand Plan) approved by the Management Board.

—   The Non-Financial Risk Executive Committee (“NFR ExCo”) oversees, governs and coordinates the management of non-financial risks in Deutsche Bank Group and establishes a cross-risk and holistic perspective of the key non-financial risks of the Group. It is tasked to define the non-financial risk appetite framework, to monitor and control the non-financial risk operating model, including the Three Lines of Defense principles and interdependencies between business divisions and control functions and within control functions.

—   The Group Reputational Risk Committee (“GRRC”) is responsible for the oversight, governance and coordination of the reputational risk management and provides for an appropriate look-back and a lessons learnt process. It reviews

    
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    88
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

    

and decides all Reputational Risk issues escalated by the Regional Reputational Risk Committees (“RRRCs”) and RRRC decisions which have been appealed by the Units. It provides guidance on Group-wide reputational risk matters, including communication of sensitive topics, to the appropriate levels of Deutsche Bank Group. The RRRCs which are sub-committees of the GRRC, are responsible for the oversight, governance and coordination of the management of reputational risk in the respective regions on behalf of the Management Board.

—   The Portfolio Risk Committee (“PRC”) supports the Risk ExCo and the CaR with particular emphasis on the management of Group-wide risk patterns including the review and governance of key concentration risks.

—   The Living Wills Committee (“LWC”) is the dedicated sub-committee of the CaR with focus on recovery and resolution planning. It oversees the implementation of our recovery and resolution plans and enhancements to the Group’s operational readiness to respond to severe stress or the threat of a severe stress.

—   The Regulatory Capital Committee (“RCC”) is a further sub-committee of our Capital and Risk Committee. It is tasked with oversight on our risk quantification models. The RCC has also responsibility for the oversight and control of our Internal Capital Adequacy Assessment Process (“ICAAP”). Together with the PRC, It oversees our Group-wide stress tests, reviews the results and proposes management action, if required. It monitors the effectiveness of the stress test process and aims to drive continuous improvement of our stress testing framework.

 

Multiple senior members are members of the CaR as well as the Risk ExCo, NFR ExCo and/or GRRC, which facilitates the information flow between these committees.

  

 

We will continue to enhance the aforementioned committee structure going forward culminating into a single committee overseeing risk matters that are established by the Management Board namely the Group Risk Committee.

 

    

Our Chief Risk Officer (“CRO”), who is a member of the Management Board, has Group-wide, supra-divisional responsibility for the management of all credit, market and operational risks as well as for the comprehensive control of risk, i.e., including liquidity risk, and continuing development of methods for risk measurement. In addition, the Chief Risk Officer is responsible for monitoring, analyzing and reporting risk on a comprehensive basis, including asset and liability gap, capital, liquidity, legal, compliance and regulatory risks, as well as other non-financial risks.

 

The CRO has direct management responsibility for the following risk management functions: Credit Risk Management, Market Risk Management, Operational Risk Management and Liquidity Risk Control.

 

These are established with the mandate to:

 

—   Support that the business within each division is consistent with the risk appetite that the CaR has set within a framework established by the Management Board;

—   Determine and implement risk and capital management policies, procedures and methodologies that are appropriate to the businesses within each division;

—   Approve credit, market and liquidity risk limits;

—   Conduct periodic portfolio reviews to keep the portfolio of risks within acceptable parameters; and

—   Develop and implement risk and capital management infrastructures and systems that are appropriate for each division.

 

Dedicated divisional Chief Risk Officers as well as regional Chief Risk Officers for Germany, for the Americas and for Asia-Pacific have been appointed to establish holistic risk management coverage. Since January 2016, along with Deutsche Bank’s business divisions, the responsibilities of the divisional CROs have been aligned.

 

The heads of the aforementioned risk management functions as well as the regional and divisional Chief Risk Officers have a reporting line into the CRO.

 

In 2015 our 3LoD program concluded and ownership for maintenance and development of the 3LoD framework was transferred to ORM. The 3LoD program established Divisional Control Officers (“DCO”) to strengthen capabilities across the 1st LoD as risk owners, while clarifying control accountabilities and enhanced standards across 2nd LoD control functions. A new non-financial Risk and Control Management framework and IT platform was established

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
89   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Framework   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

to manage the effectiveness of the control environment by the 1st and 2nd LoD and is currently being rolled out and further enhanced.

 

Several teams within the risk management functions cover overarching aspects of risk management. Their mandate is to provide an increased focus on holistic risk management and cross-risk oversight to further enhance our risk portfolio steering. Key objectives are to:

 

—   Drive key strategic cross-risk initiatives and establish greater cohesion between defining portfolio strategy and governing execution, including regulatory adherence;

—   Provide a strategic and forward-looking perspective on the key risk issues for discussion at senior levels within the bank (risk appetite, stress testing framework);

—   Strengthen risk culture in the bank; and

—   Foster the implementation of consistent risk management standards.

 

Since January 2016, these tasks have been consolidated into the newly created Enterprise Risk Management (ERM) function. ERM also sets the bank-wide risk management framework aimed at identifying and controlling risks across the institution within the agreed risk appetite.

 

Also since January 1, 2016, the second line of defence oversight for both the Group Data Management Office (GDMO) and the Chief Information Security Office (CISO) transferred to the Risk organization as well as Corporate Security & Business Continuity (CSBC), demonstrating our increased focus on holistic management of non-financial risks.

 

Our Finance, Risk and Group Audit functions operate independently of our business divisions. It is the responsibility of the Finance and Risk departments to quantify and verify the risk that we assume and maintain the quality and integrity of our risk-related data. Group Audit as our 3rd Line of Defence, independently examines, evaluates and reports on the adequacy of both the design and effectiveness of the systems of internal control including the risk management systems.

 

The integration of the risk management of our subsidiary Deutsche Postbank AG is promoted through harmonized processes for identifying, assessing, managing, monitoring, and communicating risk, the strategies and procedures for determining and safe guarding risk-bearing capacity, and corresponding internal control procedures. Key features of the joint governance are:

 

—   Functional reporting lines from the Postbank Risk Management to Deutsche Bank Risk;

—   Participation of voting members from Deutsche Bank from the respective risk functions in Postbank’s key risk committees and vice versa for selected key committees; and

—   Implementation of key Group risk policies at Postbank.

 

The key risk management committees of Postbank, in all of which Postbank’s Chief Risk Officer or senior risk managers of Deutsche Bank are voting members, are:

 

—   The Bank Risk Committee, which advises Postbank’s Management Board with respect to the determination of overall risk appetite and risk and capital allocation;

—   The Credit Risk Committee, which is responsible for limit allocation and the definition of an appropriate limit framework;

—   The Market Risk Committee, which decides on limit allocations as well as strategic positioning of Postbank’s banking and trading book and the management of liquidity risk;

—   The Operational Risk Management Committee, which defines the appropriate risk framework as well as the limit allocation for the individual business areas; and

—   The Model and Validation Risk Committee, which monitors validation of all rating systems and risk management models.

    
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    90
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

   

In 2014, the full integration of large clients was completed. These are now centrally managed on our credit platform and the regulator extended acceptance for the use of the joint model parameters for large cap corporate clients and financial institutions.

 

Following the announcement of Strategy 2020 at the end of April 2015 – in the context of which we intend to de-consolidate and sell Postbank and its subsidiaries – further system integration was halted. However, the achieved level of integration and joint risk management described above is planned to be maintained unchanged until Postbank ceases to be a part of Deutsche Bank Group.

 

 

In parallel, work has commenced to prepare the complete separation of Postbank sub-group. The principal pre-condition guiding all preparations for a separation is to maintain Postbank’s continuous operational capability and its adherence to regulatory requirements at all times.

 

Risk Culture

 

We seek to promote a strong risk culture throughout our organization. Our aim is to help reinforce our resilience by encouraging a holistic approach to the management of risk and return throughout our organization as well as the effective management of our risk, capital and reputational profile. We actively take risks in connection with our business and as such the following principles underpin risk culture within our group:

 

—   Risk is taken within a defined risk appetite;

—   Every risk taken needs to be approved within the risk management framework;

—   Risk taken needs to be adequately compensated; and

—   Risk should be continuously monitored and managed.

 

Employees at all levels are responsible for the management and escalation of risks. We expect employees to exhibit behaviors that support a strong risk culture. To promote this our policies require that behavior assessment is incorporated into our performance assessment and compensation processes. We have communicated the following risk culture behaviors through various communication vehicles:

 

—   Being fully responsible for our risks;

—   Being rigorous, forward looking and comprehensive in the assessment of risk;

—   Inviting, providing and respecting challenges;

—   Trouble shooting collectively; and

—   Placing Deutsche Bank and its reputation at the heart of all decisions.

 

To reinforce these expected behaviors and strengthen our risk culture, we conduct a number of group-wide activities. Our Board members and senior management frequently communicate the importance of a strong risk culture to support a consistent tone from the top. In addition, to drive staff understanding and knowledge of risk culture, a dedicated risk culture library of industry reports and articles has been established on DB’s internal social media platform.

 

Throughout 2015, and into 2016, there has been increased focus on the effectiveness of training. Rather than introducing additional training modules, where feasible we are embedding new messages into existing courses to keep them up to date and timely, and to avoid ‘learner overload’.

 

In addition, along with other measures to strengthen our performance management processes, we have designed and implemented a process to tie formal measurement of risk culture-related behaviors to our employee performance assessment, promotion and compensation processes. This process was first piloted in CB&S and GTB in 2010, and subsequently implemented in all divisions, with PBC International being the latest to have rolled out the process in July 2015. This process is designed to further strengthen employee accountability.

 

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
91   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Framework   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

To aid with the holistic assessment of risk culture, 2015 saw the development of a Risk Culture Framework. The Framework defines the levers that contribute to the evolution of a strong risk culture, as well as the minimum criteria which should be met at Group and divisional level. 2016 will see the launch and application of this Framework across the Business.

Based on the newly developed Risk Culture Framework, a Risk Culture Annual Report was produced and presented to the Management Board as well as the Risk Committee of the Supervisory Board at the end of 2015. This forms part of DB’s commitment to ensure senior management are informed with regards to the risk culture of the Bank.

Risk Appetite and Capacity

Risk appetite expresses the level of risk that we are willing to assume within our risk capacity in order to achieve our business objectives, as defined by a set of minimum quantitative metrics and qualitative standards. Risk capacity is defined as the maximum level of risk we can assume in both normal and distressed situations before breaching regulatory constraints and our obligations to stakeholders.

Risk appetite is an integral element in our business planning processes via our Risk and Capital Demand Plan, to promote the appropriate alignment of risk, capital and performance targets, while at the same time considering risk capacity and appetite constraints from both financial and non-financial risks. We leverage the stress testing process to test the compliance of the plan also under stressed market conditions. Top-down risk appetite serves as the limit for risk-taking for the bottom-up planning from the business functions.

The Management Board reviews and approves our risk appetite and capacity on an annual basis, or more frequently in the event of unexpected changes to the risk environment, with the aim of ensuring that they are consistent with our Group’s strategy, business and regulatory environment and stakeholders’ requirements.

In order to determine our risk appetite and capacity, we set different group level triggers and thresholds on a forward looking basis and define the escalation requirements for further action. We assign risk metrics that are sensitive to the material risks to which we are exposed and which are able to function as key indicators of financial health. In addition to that, we link our risk and recovery management governance framework with the risk appetite framework. In detail, we assess a suite of metrics under stress (CRR/CRD 4 fully loaded Common Equity Tier 1 (“CET 1”) ratio, Internal Capital Adequacy (“ICA”) ratio, and Stressed Net Liquidity Position (“SNLP”)) within the regularly performed benchmark and more severe group-wide stress tests and compare them to the Red-Amber-Green (“RAG”) levels as defined in the table below.

Risk Appetite Thresholds for key metrics

 

RAG levels

   CRR/CRD 4 fully loaded  
CET 1 ratio  
     Internal capital  
adequacy  
     Stressed net liquidity position    

Normal

     > 8.5 %           > 140 %            5 billion     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Critical

     8.5 % – 5.5 %           140 % – 120 %            5 billion –  0 billion     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Crisis

     < 5.5 %           < 120 %           < 0 billion     

 

 

Reports relating to our risk profile as compared to our risk appetite and strategy and our monitoring thereof are presented regularly up to the Management Board. Throughout the year 2015, our actual risk profile has remained in the normal levels as defined in the table above. In the event that our desired risk appetite is breached under either normal or stressed scenarios, a predefined escalation governance matrix is applied so these breaches are highlighted to the respective committees, and ultimately to the Chief Risk Officer and the Management Board. Amendments to the risk appetite and capacity must be approved by the Chief Risk Officer or the full Management Board, depending on their significance. In November 2015 as part of our annual risk appetite thresholds calibration exercise, we adjusted our normal and crisis level of CRR/CRD 4 fully loaded CET 1 ratio to >10 % and <7.25 % respectively. Furthermore, we enhanced the key metrics to include Liquidity Coverage Ratio (LCR) and Leverage Ratio (LR) with normal and crisis level of LCR set at >105 % and <100 % and LR (CRR/CRD 4 fully loaded) level at >3.2 % and <3.1 % respectively. All these changes are effective January 1, 2016.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    92
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Risk and Capital Plan

Strategic and Capital Plan

We conduct annually an integrated strategic planning process which lays out the development of our future strategic direction as a group and for our business areas/units. The strategic plan aims to create a holistic perspective on capital, funding and risk under risk-return considerations. This process translates our long term strategic targets into measurable short to medium term financial targets and enables intra-year performance monitoring and management. Thereby we aim to identify optimal growth options by considering the risks involved and the allocation of available capital resources to drive sustainable performance. Risk specific portfolio strategies complement this framework and allow for an in-depth implementation of the risk strategy on portfolio level, addressing risk specifics including risk concentrations.

The strategic planning process consists of two phases: a top-down target setting and a bottom-up substantiation.

In a first phase – the top down target setting – our key targets for profit and loss (including revenues and costs), capital supply, and capital demand as well as leverage and funding and liquidity are discussed for the group and the key business areas. In this process, the targets for the next three years are based on our global macro-economic outlook and the expected regulatory framework. Subsequently, the targets are approved by the Management Board.

In a second phase, the top-down objectives are substantiated bottom-up by detailed business unit plans, which for the first year consist of a month by month operative plan; years two and three are annual plans. The proposed bottom-up plans are reviewed and challenged by Finance and Risk and are discussed individually with the business heads. Thereby, the specifics of the business are considered and concrete targets decided in line with our strategic direction. The bottom-up plans include targets for key legal entities to review local risk and capitalization levels. Stress tests complement the strategic plan to also consider stressed market conditions.

The resulting Strategic and Capital Plan is presented to the Board for discussion and approval. Following the approval of the Management Board, the final plan is presented to the Supervisory Board.

The Strategic and Capital Plan is designed to support our vision of being a leading client-centric global universal bank and aims to ensure:

 

 

Balanced risk adjusted performance across business areas and units;

 

High risk management standards with focus on risk concentrations;

 

Compliance with regulatory requirements;

 

Strong capital and liquidity position; and

 

Stable funding and liquidity strategy allowing for the business planning within the liquidity risk appetite and regulatory requirements.

The Strategic and Capital Planning process allows us to:

 

 

Set earnings and key risk and capital adequacy targets considering the bank’s strategic focus and business plans;

 

Assess our risk-bearing capacity with regard to internal and external requirements (i.e., economic capital and regulatory capital); and

 

Apply an appropriate stress test to assess the impact on capital demand, capital supply and liquidity.

The specific limits e.g. for regulatory capital demand, economic capital, and leverage exposures are derived from the Strategic and Capital Plan to align risk, capital and performance targets at all relevant levels of the organization.

All externally communicated financial targets are monitored on an ongoing basis in appropriate management committees. Any projected shortfall from targets is discussed together with potential mitigating strategies seeking to ensure that we remain on track to achieve our targets. Amendments to the strategic and capital plan must be approved by the Management Board. Achieving our externally communicated solvency targets ensures that we also comply with the

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
93   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Framework   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Group Supervisory Review and Evaluation Process requirements as articulated by our home supervisor. In December 2015, the ECB informed Deutsche Bank that the consolidated Group has to keep a CET 1 ratio of at least 10.25 % on a phase-in basis at all times. Deutsche Bank’s G-SIB buffer of currently 2.0 % is not included in the minimum level subject to a 4 year phase-in period.

Internal Capital Adequacy Assessment Process

The lnternal Capital Adequacy Assessment Process (“ICAAP”) requires banks to identify and assess risks, maintain sufficient capital to face these risks and apply appropriate risk-management techniques to maintain adequate capitalization on an ongoing and forward looking basis, i.e., internal capital supply to exceed internal capital demand (figures are described in more detail in the section “Internal Capital Adequacy”).

We, at a Group level, maintain compliance with the lCAAP as required under Pillar 2 of Basel 3 and its local implementation in Germany, the Minimum Requirements for Risk Management (MaRisk), through a Group-wide risk management and governance framework, methodologies, processes and infrastructure.

In line with MaRisk and Basel requirements, the key instruments to help us maintain our adequate capitalization on an ongoing and forward looking basis are:

 

 

A strategic planning process which aligns risk strategy and appetite with commercial objectives;

 

A continuous monitoring process against approved risk, leverage and capital targets set;

 

Regular risk, leverage and capital reporting to management; and

 

An economic capital and stress testing framework which also includes specific stress tests to underpin our recovery monitoring processes.

Stress testing

We have a strong commitment to stress testing performed on a regular basis in order to assess the impact of a severe economic downturn on our risk profile and financial position. These exercises complement traditional risk measures and represent an integral part of our strategic and capital planning process. Our stress testing framework comprises regular Group-wide stress tests based on internally defined benchmark and more severe macroeconomic global downturn scenarios. We include all material risk types into our stress testing exercises. The time-horizon of internal stress tests is generally one year and can be extended to multi-year, if required by the scenario assumptions. Our methodologies undergo regular scrutiny from internal experts as well as regulators to review whether they correctly capture the impact of a given stress scenario. These analyses are complemented by portfolio- and country-specific stress tests as well as regulatory requirements, such as annual reverse stress tests and additional stress tests requested by our regulators on group or legal entity level. Moreover, capital plan stress testing is performed to assess the viability of our capital plan in adverse circumstances and to demonstrate a clear link between risk appetite, business strategy, capital plan and stress testing. An integrated procedure allows us to assess the impact of ad-hoc scenarios that simulate potential imminent financial or geopolitical shocks.

The initial phase of our internal stress tests consists of defining a macroeconomic downturn scenario by dbResearch in cooperation with business specialists. dbResearch monitors the political and economic development around the world and maintains a macro-economic heat map that identifies potentially harmful scenarios. Based on quantitative models and expert judgments, economic parameters such as foreign exchange rates, interest rates, GDP growth or unemployment rates are set accordingly to reflect the impact on our business. The scenario parameters are translated into specific risk drivers by subject matter experts in the risk units. Based on our internal models framework for stress testing, the following major metrics are calculated under stress: risk-weighted assets, impacts on profit and loss and economic capital by risk type. These results are aggregated at the Group level, and key metrics such as the SNLP, the CET 1 ratio and ICA ratio under stress are derived. Stress testing results and the underlying scenarios are reviewed across risk types on various levels by senior managers within Risk, Finance and the business units. After comparing these results against our defined risk appetite, senior management decides on specific mitigation actions to remediate the stress impact in alignment with the overall strategic and capital plan if certain limits are breached. The results also

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    94
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

feed into the recovery planning which is crucial for the recoverability of the bank in times of crisis. The outcome is presented to senior management up to the Management Board to raise awareness on the highest level as it provides key insights into specific business vulnerabilities and contributes to the overall risk profile assessment of the bank. In 2015 we remained well capitalized within our internal stress testing program under various severe stress events. By choosing actions out of our pool of maintained recovery measures we would have been able to mitigate shortfalls under those stress scenarios directly. A reverse stress test is performed annually in order to challenge our business model to determine the severity of scenarios that would cause us to become unviable. Such a reverse stress test is based on a hypothetical macroeconomic scenario or idiosyncratic event and takes into account severe impacts of major risks on our results. Comparing the hypothetical macroeconomic scenario that would be necessary to result in our non-viability according to the reverse stress, to the current economic environment, we consider that the probability of occurrence of such a hypothetical macroeconomic scenario is extremely low. Given the extremely low probability of the reverse stress test scenario, we do not believe that our business continuity is at risk.

Stress Testing Framework of Deutsche Bank Group

 

LOGO

Risk Reporting and Measurement Systems

Our risk data systems support regulatory reporting and external disclosures, as well as internal management reporting for credit, market, operational (including legal risk), business, reputational, liquidity risk, model risk and compliance risk. The risk infrastructure incorporates the relevant legal entities and business divisions and provides the basis for reporting on risk positions, capital adequacy and limit utilization to the relevant functions on a regular and ad-hoc basis. Established units within Finance and Risk assume responsibility for measurement, analysis and reporting of risk while promoting sufficient quality and integrity of risk-related data. Our risk management systems are reviewed by Group Audit following a risk-based audit approach.

The main reports on risk and capital management that are used to provide the central governance bodies with information relating to Group risk exposures are the following:

 

 

Our Risk and Capital Profile is presented monthly to the CaR and the Management Board and is subsequently submitted to the Risk Committee of the Supervisory Board for information. It comprises an overview of the current risk, capital and liquidity status of the Group, also incorporating information on regulatory capital and internal capital adequacy.

 

An overview of our capital, liquidity and funding is presented to the CaR by Group Capital Management and the Group Treasurer every month. It comprises information on key metrics including CRR/CRD 4 Common Equity Tier 1 capital and the CRR/CRD 4 leverage ratio, as well as an overview of our current funding and liquidity status, the liquidity stress test results and contingency measures.

 

Results of the group-wide macroeconomic stress tests that are performed twice per quarter and/or more frequently are reported to and discussed at the PRC.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
95   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Framework   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

The above reports are complemented by a suite of other standard and ad-hoc management reports of Risk and Finance, which are presented to several different senior committees responsible for risk and capital management at Group level.

Recovery and Resolution Planning

The 2007/2008 financial crisis exposed banks and the broader financial market to unprecedented pressures. These pressures led to certain banks seeking significant support from their governments and to large scale interventions by central banks. The crisis also forced many financial institutions to significantly restructure their businesses and strengthen their capital, liquidity and funding bases. This crisis revealed that many financial institutions were insufficiently prepared for a fast-evolving systemic crisis and thus were unable to act and respond in a way that would avoid potential failure and prevent material adverse impacts on the financial system and ultimately the economy and society.

In response to the crisis, the Financial Stability Board (FSB) has published a list of global systemically important banks (G-SIBs) and has advised its member institutions to mandate and to support the development of recovery and resolution plans within G-SIBs. Corresponding legislation has been enacted or proposed, as the case may be, in several jurisdictions, including the member states of the European Union (EU), Germany, UK and the U.S. As we have been identified as one of the G-SIBs, we have developed the Group’s recovery plan (‘Recovery Plan’) and submitted this to our relevant regulators. The Recovery Plan is updated at least annually to reflect changes in the business and the regulatory requirements.

The Recovery Plan prepares us to restore our financial strength and viability during an extreme stress situation. The Recovery Plan’s more specific purpose is to outline how we can respond to a financial stress situation that would significantly impact our capital or liquidity position. Therefore it lays out a set of defined actions aimed to protect us, our customers and the markets and prevent a potentially more costly resolution event. In line with regulatory guidance, we have identified a wide range of recovery measures that will mitigate different types of stress scenarios. These scenarios originate from both idiosyncratic and market-wide events, which would have led to severe capital and liquidity impacts as well as impacts on our performance and balance sheet. The Recovery Plan, including its corresponding policy, is intended to enable us to effectively monitor, escalate, plan and execute recovery actions in the event of a crisis situation.

The Recovery Plan’s key objective is to help us to recover from a crisis situation by selecting appropriate recovery actions to stay sufficiently capitalised and funded. This plan extends beyond our risk management framework and can be executed in extreme scenarios where crises may threaten our survival (i.e., substantial loss of capital or inability to access market liquidity when needed). The Management Board determines when the Recovery Plan has to be invoked and which recovery measures are deemed appropriate.

The Recovery Plan is designed to cover multiple regulations including those applicable to us in the EU under the Bank Recovery and Resolution Directive (as implemented in Germany) and the Single Resolution Mechanism Regulation as well as other key jurisdictions. Furthermore, the plan incorporates feedback from extensive discussions with our Supervisory authority and the Crisis Management Group (CMG), formed by key home and host authorities. We report to this CMG with the objective of enhancing preparedness for, and facilitating the management and resolution of a cross-border financial crisis affecting us. This CMG is also intended to cooperate closely with authorities in other jurisdictions where we have a systemic presence.

We are also working closely with our resolution authority to create a Group Resolution Plan for Deutsche Bank as set out in the Bank Recovery and Resolution Directive, the Single Resolution Mechanism Regulation and the German Recovery and Resolution Act (“Sanierungs- und Abwicklungsgesetz” or “SAG”).

In addition, Title I of the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act and the implementing regulations issued by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System and the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (“FDIC”) require each bank holding company with assets of U.S.$ 50 billion or more, including Deutsche Bank AG, to prepare and submit annually a plan for the orderly resolution of subsidiaries and operations in the event of future material financial distress or failure (the “Title I US Resolution Plan”). For foreign-based covered companies such

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    96
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

 

as us, the Title I US Resolution Plan only relates to subsidiaries, branches, agencies and businesses that are domiciled in or conducted in whole or in material part in the United States. In addition to the Title I US Resolution Plan, in 2014, Deutsche Bank Trust Company Americas (“DBTCA”), one of our insured depository institutions (“IDIs”) in the United States, became subject to the FDIC’s final rule requiring IDIs with total assets of U.S.$ 50 billion or more to submit periodically to the FDIC a plan for resolution in the event of failure (the “IDI Plan” and, together with the Title I US Resolution Plan, the “US Resolution Plan”) under the Federal Deposit Insurance Act (the “IDI Rule”). In 2014, we expanded our Title I US Resolution Plan to also be responsive to the IDI Rule requirements. In 2015, DBTCA prepared and submitted a separate IDI Plan.

 

The core elements of the US Resolution Plan are Material Entities (“MEs”), Core Business Lines (“CBLs”), Critical Operations (“COs”) and, for purposes of the IDI Plan, Critical Services. The US Resolution Plan lays out the resolution strategy for each ME, defined as those entities significant to the activities of a CO or CBL and demonstrates how each ME, CBL and CO, as applicable, can be resolved in a rapid and orderly manner and without systemic impact on U.S. financial stability. The US Resolution Plan also discusses the strategy for continuing Critical Services in resolution. Key factors addressed in the US Resolution Plan include how to ensure:

 

—  Continued access to services from other U.S. and non-U.S. legal entities as well as from third parties such

     as payment servicers, exchanges and key vendors;

—  Availability of funding from both external and internal sources;

—  Retention of key employees during resolution; and

—  Efficient and coordinated close-out of cross-border contracts.

 

The US Resolution Plan is drafted in coordination with the U.S. businesses and infrastructure groups so that it accurately reflects the business, critical infrastructure and key interconnections.

 

Risk and Capital Management

 

Capital Management

 

   

Our Treasury function manages solvency, capital adequacy and leverage ratios at Group level and locally in each region. Treasury implements our capital strategy, which itself is developed by the Capital and Risk Committee and approved by the Management Board, including issuance and repurchase of shares and capital instruments, hedging of capital ratios against foreign exchange swings, limit setting for key financial resources, design of book equity allocation, and regional capital planning. We are fully committed to maintaining our sound capitalization both from an economic and regulatory perspective. We continously monitor and adjust our overall capital demand and supply in an effort to achieve the optimal balance of the economic and regulatory considerations at all times and from all perspectives. These perspectives include book equity based on IFRS accounting standards, regulatory and economic capital as well as specific capital requirements from rating agencies.

 

Treasury manages the issuance and repurchase of capital instruments, namely Common Equity Tier 1, Additional Tier 1 and Tier 2 capital instruments. Treasury constantly monitors the market for liability management trades. Such trades represent a countercyclical opportunity to create Common Equity Tier 1 capital by buying back our issuances below par.

 

Our core currencies are Euro, US Dollar and Pound Sterling. Treasury manages the sensitivity of our capital ratios against swings in core currencies. The capital invested into our foreign subsidiaries and branches in the other non-core currencies is largely hedged against foreign exchange swings. Treasury determines which currencies are to be hedged, develops suitable hedging strategies in close cooperation with Risk Management and finally executes these hedges.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
97   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Management   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Resource Limit Setting

 

Key financial resources are influenced through following governance processes and incentives.

 

Target resource capacities are reviewed in our annual strategic plan in line with our CET 1 and Leverage Ratio ambitions. In a quarterly process, the Capital and Risk Committee approves divisional resource limits for Total Capital Demand and leverage exposure that are based on the strategic plan however account for market conditions and the short-term outlook. The limits are enforced through a close monitoring process and an excess mechanism.

 

During the reporting period, we have extended our methodology of internal capital allocation framework to acknowledge the growing importance of leverage requirements for the bank. Regulatory requirements are driven by the higher of CET 1 ratio (solvency) and leverage ratio (leverage) requirements. In terms of order for the internal capital allocation, solvency-based allocation comes first, then incremental leverage-driven allocation. The new methodology utilises a two step approach: Allocation of Average Active Equity solvency-based first until the externally communicated target of a 12.5 % CET 1 solvency ratio (CRR/CRD 4 calculated on a fully loaded basis) is met, and then incremental leverage capital allocation based on pro-rata leverage exposure of divisions to satisfy the externally communicated target of a 4.5 % leverage ratio (CRR/CRD 4 calculated on a fully loaded basis). The allocation will be reviewed if the externally communicated targets for the CET 1 and leverage ratio should be adjusted. The new methodology also applies different rates for the cost of equity for each of the business segments, reflecting in a more differentiated way the earnings volatility of the individual business models. This enables improved performance management and investment decisions.

 

Regional capital plans covering the capital needs of our branches and subsidiaries across the globe are prepared on an annual basis and presented to the Group Investment Committee. Most of our subsidiaries are subject to legal and regulatory capital requirements. In developing, implementing and testing our capital and liquidity, we fully take such legal and regulatory requirements into account.

 

Further, Treasury is represented on the Investment Committee of the largest Deutsche Bank pension fund which sets the investment guidelines. This representation is intended to ensure that pension assets are aligned with pension liabilities, thus protecting our capital base.

   

Risk Identification and Assessment

 

We face a variety of risks as a result of our business activities, these risks include credit risk, market risk, business risk, liquidity risk, operational risk, compliance risk, reputational risk and model risk as described in the following sections below. Our risk identification and assessment processes leverage intelligence across organisational levels and utilise existing information whenever possible. Operating processes are in place across the organisation to capture relevant measures and indicators. The core aim of all processes is to provide adequate transparency and understanding of the existing and emerging risk issues, and to ensure a holistic cross-risk perspective. We update the risk inventory at least once a year or at other times if needed, by running a risk identification and materiality assessment process in line with MaRisk.

 

To align with the Three Lines of Defense taxonomy, we categorize our material risks into financial risks and non-financial risks effective January 1, 2016. Financial risks comprise credit risk (including counterparty, country, product and industry risks), market risk (including non-trading, trading and traded default risk), liquidity risk, and business risk. Non-financial risks comprise operational risks and reputational risks with compliance risk, legal risk, model risk and information security risk captured in our operational risk framework. The aim is to have a better control environment over our material risks.

   
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    98
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

     Credit risk, market risk and operational risk attract regulatory capital. As part of our internal capital adequacy assessment process, we calculate the amount of economic capital for credit, market, operational and business risk to cover risks generated from our business activities taking into account diversification effects across those risk types. Furthermore, our economic capital framework implicitly covers additional risks, e.g. reputational risk and refinancing risk, for which no dedicated economic capital models exist. We exclude liquidity risk from economic capital and govern this in a dedicated liquidity risk management.

Credit Risk Management

Credit Risk Framework

 

    

Credit risk arises from all transactions where actual, contingent or potential claims against any counterparty, borrower, obligor or issuer (which we refer to collectively as “counterparties”) exist, including those claims that we plan to distribute. These transactions are typically part of our traditional nontrading lending activities (such as loans and contingent liabilities), traded bonds and debt securities available for sale or our direct trading activity with clients (such as OTC derivatives like foreign exchange forwards and Forward Rate Agreements). Carrying values of equity investments are also disclosed in our Credit Risk section. We manage the respective positions within our market risk and credit risk frameworks.

 

Based on the annual risk identification and materiality assessment, credit risk contains four material categories, namely default risk, industry risk, country risk, and product risk.

 

— Default risk, the most significant element of credit risk, is the risk that counterparties fail to meet contractual obligations in relation to the claims described above;

— Industry risk is the risk of adverse developments in the operating environment for a specific industry segment leading to deterioration in the financial profile of counterparties operating in that segment and resulting in increased credit risk across this portfolio of counterparties;

— Country risk is the risk that we may experience unexpected default or settlement risk and subsequent losses, in a given country, due to a range of macro-economic or social events primarily affecting counterparties in that jurisdiction including: a material deterioration of economic conditions, political and social upheaval, nationalization and expropriation of assets, government repudiation of indebtedness, or disruptive currency depreciation or devaluation. Country risk also includes transfer risk which arises when debtors are unable to meet their obligations owing to an inability to transfer assets to non-residents due to direct sovereign intervention; and

— Product Risk captures product-specific credit risk of transactions that could arise with respect to specific borrowers. These take into account the likelihood of having an actual credit exposure at the time of a default, recovery expectations and the tenor of exposure. This category also includes “Settlement risk”; the risk that the settlement or clearance of a transaction may fail and arises whenever the exchange of cash, securities and/or other assets is not simultaneous leaving us exposed to a potential loss should the counterparty default.

 

We measure, manage/mitigate and report/monitor our credit risk using the following philosophy and principles:

 

— Our credit risk management function is independent from our business divisions and in each of our divisions, credit decision standards, processes and principles are consistently applied.

— A key principle of credit risk management is client credit due diligence. Our client selection is achieved in collaboration with our business division counterparts who stand as a first line of defence.

— We aim to prevent undue concentration and tail-risks (large unexpected losses) by maintaining a diversified credit portfolio. Client, industry, country and product-specific concentrations are assessed and managed against our risk appetite.

— We maintain underwriting standards aiming to avoid large directional credit risk on a counterparty and portfolio level. In this regard we assume unsecured cash positions and actively use hedging for risk mitigation purposes. Additionally, we strive to secure our derivative portfolio through collateral agreements and may additionally hedge concentration risks to further mitigate credit risks from underlying market movements.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
99   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Management   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

 

— Every new credit facility and every extension or material change of an existing credit facility (such as its tenor, collateral structure or major covenants) to any counterparty requires credit approval at the appropriate authority level. We assign credit approval authorities to individuals according to their qualifications, experience and training, and we review these periodically.

— We measure and consolidate all our credit exposures to each obligor across our consolidated Group on a global basis, in line with regulatory requirements.

— We manage credit exposures on the basis of the “one obligor principle”, under which all facilities to a group of borrowers which are linked to each other (i.e., by one entity holding a majority of the voting rights or capital of another) are consolidated under one group.

— We have established within Credit Risk Management – where appropriate – specialized teams for deriving internal client ratings, analyzing and approving transactions, monitoring the portfolio or covering workout clients. The credit coverage for assets transferred to the NCOU utilizes the expertise of our core credit organization.

   

Measuring Credit Risk

 

Credit risk is measured by credit rating, regulatory and internal capital demand and key credit metrics mentioned below.

 

The credit rating is an essential part of the Bank’s underwriting and credit process and builds the basis for risk appetite determination on a counterparty and portfolio level, credit decision and transaction pricing as well the determination of credit risk regulatory capital. Each borrower must be rated and each rating has to be reviewed at least annually. Ongoing monitoring of counterparties helps keep ratings up-to-date. There must be no credit limit without a credit rating. For each credit rating the appropriate rating approach has to be applied and the derived credit rating has to be established in the relevant systems. Different rating approaches have been established to best reflect the specific characteristics of exposure classes, including central governments and central banks, institutions, corporates and retail.

 

Counterparties in our non-homogenous portfolios are rated by our independent Credit Risk Management function. Country risk related ratings are provided by dbResearch.

 

Our rating analysis is based on a combination of qualitative and quantitative factors. When rating a counterparty we apply in-house assessment methodologies, scorecards and our 21-grade rating scale for evaluating the credit-worthiness of our counterparties.

   

 

All of our rating methodologies, excluding Postbank, have to be approved by the Capital Methodology Committee (“CMC”), a sub-committee of the Regulatory Capital Committee, before the methodologies are used for credit decisions and capital calculation for the first time or before they are significantly changed. Regulatory approval may be required in addition. The methodology validation is performed independently of model development by Global Model Validation and Governance. The results of the regular validation processes as stipulated by internal policies have to be brought to the attention of the CMC, even if the validation results do not lead to a change. The validation plan for rating methodologies is presented to CMC at the beginning of the calendar year and a status update is given on a quarterly basis.

 

For Postbank, responsibility for implementation and monitoring of internal rating systems effectiveness rests with Postbank’s Risk Analytics unit and Postbank’s validation committee, chaired by Postbank’s Head of Credit Risk Controlling. All rating systems are subject to approval by Postbank’s Bank Risk Committee chaired by the Chief Risk Officer. Effectiveness of rating systems and rating results are reported to the Postbank Management Board on a regular basis. Joint governance is ensured via a cross committee membership of Deutsche Bank senior managers joining Postbank committees and vice versa.

 

 

Besides the credit rating the key credit risk metric we apply for managing our credit portfolio, including transaction approval and the setting of risk appetite, are internal limits and credit exposures under these limits. Credit limits set forth maximum credit exposures we are willing to assume over specified periods. In determining the credit limit for a counterparty, we consider the counterparty’s credit quality by reference to our internal credit rating. Credit limits and credit exposures are both measured on a gross and net basis where net is derived by deducting hedges and certain    
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    100
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

     collateral from respective gross figures. For derivatives, we look at current market values and the potential future exposure over the lifetime of a transaction. We generally also take into consideration the Risk-Return characteristics of individual transactions and portfolios. Risk-Return metrics explain the development of client revenues as well as capital consumption. In this regard we also look at the client revenues with respect to the balance sheet consumption.

 

  

We measure the risk-weighted assets to determine the regulatory capital demand for credit risk using advanced, foundation and standard approaches of which advanced and foundation are approved by our regulator.

 

The advanced Internal Ratings Based Approach (“IRBA”) is the most sophisticated approach available under the regulatory framework for credit risk and allows us to make use of our internal credit rating methodologies as well as internal estimates of specific other risk parameters. These methods and parameters represent long-used key components of the internal risk measurement and management process supporting the credit approval process, the economic capital and expected loss calculation and the internal monitoring and reporting of credit risk. The relevant parameters include the probability of default (“PD”), the loss given default (“LGD”) and the maturity (“M”) driving the regulatory risk-weight and the credit conversion factor (“CCF”) as part of the regulatory exposure at default (“EAD”) estimation. For the majority of derivative counterparty exposures as well as securities financing transactions (“SFT”), we make use of the internal model method (“IMM”) in accordance with CRR and SolvV to calculate EAD. For most of our internal rating systems more than seven years of historical information is available to assess these parameters. Our internal rating methodologies reflect a point-in-time rather than a through-the-cycle rating.

 

We apply the foundation IRBA to the majority of our remaining foundation IRBA eligible credit portfolios at Postbank to the extent these have not been newly assigned to the advanced IRBA during 2015. The foundation IRBA is an approach available under the regulatory framework for credit risk allowing institutions to make use of their internal rating methodologies while using pre-defined regulatory values for all other risk parameters. Parameters subject to internal estimates include the probability of default (“PD”) while the loss given default (“LGD”) and the credit conversion factor (“CCF”) are defined in the regulatory framework.

 

We apply the standardized approach to a subset of our credit risk exposures. The standardized approach measures credit risk either pursuant to fixed risk weights, which are predefined by the regulator, or through the application of external ratings. We assign certain credit exposures permanently to the standardized approach in accordance with Article 150 CRR. These are predominantly exposures to the Federal Republic of Germany and other German public sector entities as well as exposures to central governments of other European Member States that meet the required conditions. These exposures make up more than half of the exposures carried in the standardized approach and receive predominantly a risk weight of zero percent. For internal purposes, however, these exposures are subject to an internal credit assessment and fully integrated in the risk management and economic capital processes.

 

In addition to the above described regulatory capital demand, we determine the internal capital demand for credit risk via an economic capital model.

 

We calculate economic capital for the default risk, country risk and settlement risk as elements of credit risk. In line with our economic capital framework, economic capital for credit risk is set at a level to absorb with a probability of 99.98 % very severe aggregate unexpected losses within one year. Our economic capital for credit risk is derived from the loss distribution of a portfolio via Monte Carlo Simulation of correlated rating migrations. The loss distribution is modeled in two steps. First, individual credit exposures are specified based on parameters for the probability of default, exposure at default and loss given default. In a second step, the probability of joint defaults is modeled through the introduction of economic factors, which correspond to geographic regions and industries. The simulation of portfolio losses is then performed by an internally developed model, which takes rating migration and maturity effects into account. Effects due to wrong-way derivatives risk (i.e., the credit exposure of a derivative in the default case is higher than in nondefault scenarios) are modeled by applying our own alpha factor when deriving the exposure at default for derivatives and securities financing transactions under the CRR. The alpha factor is identical with the one used for the risk-weighted assets calculation, yet subject to a lower floor of 1.0. For December 31, 2015 the alpha factor was calibrated to 1.13. We allocate expected losses and economic capital derived from loss distributions down to transaction level to enable management on transaction, customer and business level.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
101   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Management   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Managing and Mitigation of Credit Risk

Managing Credit Risk on Counterparty Level

 

Credit-related counterparties are principally allocated to credit officers within credit teams which are aligned to types of counterparty (such as financial institutions, corporates or private individuals) or economic area (i.e., emerging markets) and dedicated rating analyst teams. The individual credit officers have the relevant expertise and experience to manage the credit risks associated with these counterparties and their associated credit related transactions. For retail clients credit decision making and credit monitoring is highly automated for efficiency reasons. Credit Risk Management has full oversight of the respective processes and tools used in the retail credit process. It is the responsibility of each credit officer to undertake ongoing credit monitoring for their allocated portfolio of counterparties. We also have procedures in place intended to identify at an early stage credit exposures for which there may be an increased risk of loss.

 

In instances where we have identified counterparties where there is a concern that the credit quality has deteriorated or appears likely to deteriorate to the point where they present a heightened risk of loss in default, the respective exposure is generally placed on a “watch list”. We aim to identify counterparties that, on the basis of the application of our risk management tools, demonstrate the likelihood of problems well in advance in order to effectively manage the credit exposure and maximize the recovery. The objective of this early warning system is to address potential problems while adequate options for action are still available. This early risk detection is a tenet of our credit culture and is intended to ensure that greater attention is paid to such exposures.

 

Credit limits are established by the Credit Risk Management function via the execution of assigned credit authorities. This also applies to settlement risk that must fall within limits pre-approved by CRM considering risk appetite and in a manner that reflects expected settlement patterns for the subject counterparty. Credit approvals are documented by the signing of the credit report by the respective credit authority holders and retained for future reference.

 

Credit authority is generally assigned to individuals as personal credit authority according to the individual’s professional qualification and experience. All assigned credit authorities are reviewed on a periodic basis to help ensure that they are adequate to the individual performance of the authority holder.

 

Where an individual’s personal authority is insufficient to establish required credit limits, the transaction is referred to a higher credit authority holder or where necessary to an appropriate credit committee such as the Underwriting Committee. Where personal and committee authorities are insufficient to establish appropriate limits, the case is referred to the Management Board for approval.

   

Mitigation of Credit Risk on Counterparty Level

 

In addition to determining counterparty credit quality and our risk appetite, we also use various credit risk mitigation techniques to optimize credit exposure and reduce potential credit losses. Credit risk mitigants are applied in the following forms:

 

— Comprehensive and enforceable credit documentation with adequate terms and conditions.

— Collateral held as security to reduce losses by increasing the recovery of obligations.

— Risk transfers, which shift the probability of default risk of an obligor to a third party including hedging executed by our Credit Portfolio Strategies Group.

— Netting and collateral arrangements which reduce the credit exposure from derivatives and repo- and repo-style transactions.

 

   
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    102
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

    

Collateral

 

We regularly agree on collateral to be received from or to be provided to customers in contracts that are subject to credit risk. Collateral is security in the form of an asset or third-party obligation that serves to mitigate the inherent risk of credit loss in an exposure, by either substituting the borrower default risk or improving recoveries in the event of a default. While collateral can be an alternative source of repayment, it generally does not replace the necessity of high quality underwriting standards and a thorough assessment of the debt service ability of the borrower

 

We segregate collateral received into the following two types:

 

— Financial and other collateral, which enables us to recover all or part of the outstanding exposure by liquidating the collateral asset provided, in cases where the borrower is unable or unwilling to fulfil its primary obligations. Cash collateral, securities (equity, bonds), collateral assignments of other claims or inventory, equipment (i.e., plant, machinery and aircraft) and real estate typically fall into this category.

— Guarantee collateral, which complements the borrower’s ability to fulfil its obligation under the legal contract and as such is provided by third parties. Letters of credit, insurance contracts, export credit insurance, guarantees, credit derivatives and risk participations typically fall into this category.

 

Our processes seek to ensure that the collateral we accept for risk mitigation purposes is of high quality. This includes seeking to have in place legally effective and enforceable documentation for realizable and measureable collateral assets which are evaluated regularly by dedicated teams. The assessment of the suitability of collateral for a specific transaction is part of the credit decision and must be undertaken in a conservative way, including collateral haircuts that are applied. We have collateral type specific haircuts in place which are regularly reviewed and approved. In this regard, we strive to avoid “wrong-way” risk characteristics where the borrower’s counterparty risk is positively correlated with the risk of deterioration in the collateral value. For guarantee collateral, the process for the analysis of the guarantor’s creditworthiness is aligned to the credit assessment process for borrowers.

 

  

Risk Transfers

 

Risk transfers to third parties form a key part of our overall risk management process and are executed in various forms, including outright sales, single name and portfolio hedging, and securitizations. Risk transfers are conducted by the respective business units and by our Credit Portfolio Strategies Group (CPSG), in accordance with specifically approved mandates.

 

CPSG manages the residual credit risk of loans and lending-related commitments of the institutional and corporate credit portfolio; the leveraged portfolio and the medium-sized German companies’ portfolio within our Corporate Divisions of CB&S and GTB.

 

Acting as a central pricing reference, CPSG provides the respective CB&S and GTB Division businesses with an observed or derived capital market rate for loan applications; however, the decision of whether or not the business can enter into the credit risk remains exclusively with Credit Risk Management.

 

CPSG is concentrating on two primary objectives within the credit risk framework to enhance risk management discipline, improve returns and use capital more efficiently:

 

— to reduce single-name credit risk concentrations within the credit portfolio and

— to manage credit exposures by utilizing techniques including loan sales, securitization via collateralized loan obligations, default insurance coverage and single-name and portfolio credit default swaps.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
103   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Management   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

 

Netting and Collateral Arrangements for Derivatives and Securities Financing Transactions

 

Netting is applicable to both exchange traded derivatives and OTC derivatives. Netting is also applied to securities financing transactions as far as documentation, structure and nature of the risk mitigation allow netting with the underlying credit risk.

 

All exchange traded derivatives are cleared through central counterparties (“CCPs”), which interpose themselves between the trading entities by becoming the counterparty to each of the entities. Where available and to the extent agreed with our counterparties, we also use CCP clearing for our OTC derivative transactions. The Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (“DFA”) introduced mandatory CCP clearing for certain standardized OTC derivative transactions in 2013. The European Regulation (EU) No 648/2012 on OTC Derivatives, Central Counterparties and Trade Repositories (“EMIR”) will introduce mandatory CCP clearing for standardized OTC derivatives transactions; mandatory CCP clearing for certain interest rate derivatives will start on 21 June 2016. The rules and regulations of CCPs usually provide for the bilateral set off of all amounts payable on the same day and in the same currency (“payment netting”) and thereby reducing our settlement risk. Depending on the business model applied by the CCP, this payment netting applies either to all of our derivatives cleared by the CCP or at least to those that form part of the same class of derivatives. Many CCP rules and regulations also provide for the termination, close-out and netting of all cleared transactions upon the CCP’s default (“close-out netting”), which reduced our credit risk. In our risk measurement and risk assessment processes we apply close-out netting only to the extent we have satisfied ourselves of the legal validity and enforceability of the relevant CCP’s close-out netting provisions.

 

 

In order to reduce the credit risk resulting from OTC derivative transactions, where CCP clearing is not available, we regularly seek the execution of standard master agreements (such as master agreements for derivatives published by the International Swaps and Derivatives Association, Inc. (ISDA) or the German Master Agreement for Financial Derivative Transactions) with our counterparts. A master agreement allows for the close-out netting of rights and obligations arising under derivative transactions that have been entered into under such a master agreement upon the counterparty’s default, resulting in a single net claim owed by or to the counterparty. For parts of the derivatives business (i.e., foreign exchange transactions) we also enter into master agreements under which payment netting applies in respect to transactions covered by such master agreements, reducing our settlement risk. In our risk measurement and risk assessment processes we apply close-out netting only to the extent we have satisfied ourselves of the legal validity and enforceability of the master agreement in all relevant jurisdictions.

 

Also, we enter into credit support annexes (“CSA”) to master agreements in order to further reduce our derivatives-related credit risk. These annexes generally provide risk mitigation through periodic, usually daily, margining of the covered exposure. The CSAs also provide for the right to terminate the related derivative transactions upon the counterparty’s failure to honour a margin call. As with netting, when we believe the annex is enforceable, we reflect this in our exposure measurement.

   

 

Certain CSAs to master agreements provide for rating dependent triggers, where additional collateral must be pledged if a party’s rating is downgraded. We also enter into master agreements that provide for an additional termination event upon a party’s rating downgrade. These downgrading provisions in CSAs and master agreements usually apply to both parties but may also apply to us only. We analyze and monitor our potential contingent payment obligations resulting from a rating downgrade in our stress testing approach for liquidity risk on an ongoing basis. For an assessment of the quantitative impact of a downgrading of our credit rating please refer to table “Stress Testing Results” in the section “Liquidity Risk”.  

 

Concentrations within Credit Risk Mitigation

 

Concentrations within credit risk mitigations taken may occur if a number of guarantors and credit derivative providers with similar economic characteristics are engaged in comparable activities with changes in economic or industry conditions affecting their ability to meet contractual obligations. We use a range of quantitative tools and metrics to monitor our credit risk mitigating activities. These also include monitoring of potential concentrations within collateral types supported by dedicated stress tests.

   

 

For more qualitative and quantitative details in relation to the application of credit risk mitigation and potential concentration effects please refer to the section “Maximum Exposure to Credit Risk”.  
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    104
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Managing Credit Risk on Portfolio Level

 

    

On a portfolio level, significant concentrations of credit risk could result from having material exposures to a number of counterparties with similar economic characteristics, or who are engaged in comparable activities, where these similarities may cause their ability to meet contractual obligations to be affected in the same manner by changes in economic or industry conditions.

 

Our portfolio management framework supports a comprehensive assessment of concentrations within our credit risk portfolio in order to keep concentrations within acceptable levels.

 

Industry Risk Management

 

To manage industry risk, we have grouped our corporate and financial institutions counterparties into various industry sub-portfolios. For each of these sub-portfolios an “Industry Batch report” is prepared usually on an annual basis. This report highlights industry developments and risks to our credit portfolio, reviews concentration risks, analyses the risk/reward profile of the portfolio and incorporates an economic downside stress test. Finally, this analysis is used to define the credit strategies for the portfolio in question.

 

The Industry Batch reports are presented to the CRM Portfolio Committee, a sub-committee of the Portfolio Risk Committee, which is a sub-committee of our Risk Executive Committee and Capital and Risk Committee, and are submitted afterwards to the Management Board. In accordance with an agreed schedule, a select number of Industry Batch reports are also submitted to the Risk Committee of the Supervisory Board. In addition to these Industry Batch reports, the development of the industry sub-portfolios is regularly monitored during the year and is compared with the approved sub-portfolio strategies. Regular overviews are prepared for the CRM Portfolio Committee to discuss recent developments and to agree on actions where necessary.

 

Country Risk Management

 

Avoiding undue concentrations from a regional perspective is also an integral part of our credit risk management framework. In order to achieve this, country risk limits are applied to Emerging Markets as well as selected Developed Markets countries (based on internal country risk ratings). Emerging Markets are grouped into regions and for each region, as well as for the Higher Risk Developed Markets, a “Country Batch report” is prepared, usually on an annual basis. These reports assess key macroeconomic developments and outlook, review portfolio composition and concentration risks and analyse the risk/reward profile of the portfolio. Based on this, limits and strategies are set for countries and, where relevant, for the region as a whole. Country risk limits are approved by either our Management Board or by our Portfolio Risk Committee, pursuant to delegated authority, and by the Postbank Management Board for respective portfolios.

 

In our Country Limit framework, limits are established for counterparty credit risk exposures in a given country to manage the aggregated credit risk subject to country-specific economic and political events. These limits include exposures to entities incorporated locally as well as subsidiaries of foreign multinational corporations. Separate Transfer Risk limits are established which apply to any cross-border exposures (credit and trading) with our clients in above countries. Also, gap risk limits are set to control the risk of loss due to intra-country wrong-way risk exposure.

 

Beyond credit risk, our Country Risk Framework comprises Market Risk in trading positions in emerging markets and is set based on the P&L impact of potential stressed market events on these positions. Furthermore we take in consideration treasury risk comprising capital positions and exposure of Deutsche Bank entities in above countries (Funding, Margin or Guarantees) which are subject to limits given the transfer risk inherent in these cross-border positions.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
105   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Management   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

 

Our country risk ratings represent a key tool in our management of country risk. They are established by the independent dbResearch function within Deutsche Bank and include:

 

— Sovereign rating: A measure of the probability of the sovereign defaulting on its foreign or local currency obligations.

— Transfer risk rating: A measure of the probability of a “transfer risk event”, i.e., the risk that an otherwise solvent debtor is unable to meet its obligations due to inability to obtain foreign currency or to transfer assets as a result of direct sovereign intervention.

— Event risk rating: A measure of the probability of major disruptions in the market risk factors relating to a country (interest rates, credit spreads, etc.). Event risks are measured as part of our event risk scenarios, as described in the section “Market Risk Monitoring” of this report.

 

All sovereign and transfer risk ratings are reviewed, at least quarterly, by the Portfolio Risk Committee, although more frequent reviews are undertaken when deemed necessary.

 

Product specific Risk Management

 

Complementary to our counterparty, industry and country risk approach, we focus on product specific risk concentrations and selectively set limits where required for risk management purposes. Specific product limits are set in particular if a concentration of transactions of a specific type might lead to significant losses under certain cases. In this respect, correlated losses might result from disruptions of the functioning of financial markets, significant moves in market parameters to which the respective product is sensitive, macroeconomic default scenarios or other factors affecting certain credit products. Specific product limits can either be set with regards to exposure to certain industries or affecting the total credit portfolio. We manage credit related product limits within CB&S and GTB under a uniform framework .Exposures are monitored regularly; re-mediatory action is required in case of an excess of utilization over the approved limit.

 

A key focus is put on underwriting caps. These caps limit the combined risk for transactions where we underwrite commitments with the intention to sell down or distribute part of the risk to third parties. These commitments include the undertaking to fund bank loans and to provide bridge loans for the issuance of public bonds. The risk is that we may not be successful in the distribution of the facilities, meaning that we would have to hold more of the underlying risk for longer periods of time than originally intended. These underwriting commitments are additionally exposed to market risk in the form of widening credit spreads. We dynamically hedge this credit spread risk to be within the approved market risk limit framework.

 

Furthermore, in our PBC businesses, we apply product-specific strategies setting our risk appetite for sufficiently homogeneous portfolios where tailored client analysis is secondary, such as the retail portfolios of mortgages, business and consumer finance products. In Wealth Management, target levels are set for global concentrations along products as well as based on the liquidity of the underlying collateral.

   

Market Risk Management

Market Risk Framework

 

The vast majority of our businesses are subject to market risk, defined as the potential for change in the market value of our trading and invested positions. Risk can arise from changes in interest rates, credit spreads, foreign exchange rates, equity prices, commodity prices and other relevant parameters, such as market volatility and market implied default probabilities.    
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    106
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

    

One of the primary objectives of Market Risk Management, a part of our independent Risk function, is to ensure that our business units do not expose us to unacceptable losses outside of our risk appetite. To achieve this objective, Market Risk Management works closely together with risk takers (“the business units”) and other control and support groups.

 

We distinguish between three substantially different types of market risk:

 

— Trading market risk arises primarily through the market-making activities of the CB&S Division. This involves taking positions in debt, equity, foreign exchange, other securities and commodities as well as in equivalent derivatives.

— Traded default risk arising from defaults and rating migrations relating to trading instruments.

— Nontrading market risk arises from market movements, primarily outside the activities of our trading units, in our banking book and from off-balance sheet items. This includes interest rate risk, credit spread risk, investment risk and foreign exchange risk as well as market risk arising from our pension schemes, guaranteed funds and equity compensation. Nontrading market risk also includes risk from the modeling of client deposits as well as savings and loan products.

 

Market Risk Management governance is designed and established to promote oversight of all market risks, effective decision-making and timely escalation to senior management.

 

Market Risk Management defines and implements a framework to systematically identify, assess, monitor and report our market risk. Market risk managers identify market risks through active portfolio analysis and engagement with the business areas.

 

  

Market Risk Measurement

 

We aim to accurately measure all types of market risks by a comprehensive set of risk metrics reflecting economic and regulatory requirements.

 

In accordance with economic and regulatory requirements, we measure market risks by several internally developed key risk metrics and regulatory defined market risk approaches.

 

Trading Market Risk

 

    

Our primary mechanism to manage trading market risk is the application of our Risk Appetite framework of which the limit framework is a key component. Our Management Board supported by Market Risk Management, sets group-wide value-at-risk, economic capital and portfolio stress testing limits for market risk in the trading book. Market Risk Management allocates this overall appetite to our Corporate Divisions and individual business units within CB&S (i.e., Structured Finance, Equities, etc.) based on established and agreed business plans. We also have business aligned heads within Market Risk Management to establish business limits, by allocating the limit down to individual portfolios or geographical regions.

 

Value-at-risk, economic capital and Portfolio Stress Testing limits are used for managing all types of market risk at an overall portfolio level. As an additional and complementary tool for managing certain portfolios or risk types, Market Risk Management performs risk analysis and business specific stress testing. Limits are also set on sensitivity and concentration/liquidity, business-level stress testing and event risk scenarios.

 

Business units are responsible for adhering to the limits against which exposures are monitored and reported. The market risk limits set by Market Risk Management are monitored on a daily, weekly and monthly basis.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
107   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Management   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Internally developed Market Risk Models

Value-at-Risk (VaR)

 

VaR is a quantitative measure of the potential loss (in value) of Fair Value positions due to market movements that will not be exceeded in a defined period of time and with a defined confidence level.

 

Our value-at-risk for the trading businesses is based on our own internal model. In October 1998, the German Banking Supervisory Authority (now the BaFin) approved our internal model for calculating the regulatory market risk capital for our general and specific market risks. Since then the model has been continually refined and approval has been maintained.

 

We calculate VaR using a 99 % confidence level and a one day holding period. This means we estimate there is a 1 in 100 chance that a mark-to-market loss from our trading positions will be at least as large as the reported VaR. For regulatory purposes, which include the calculation of our capital requirements and risk-weighted assets, the holding period is ten days.

 

We use one year of historical market data as input to calculate VaR. The calculation employs a Monte Carlo Simulation technique, and we assume that changes in risk factors follow a well-defined distribution, e.g. normal or non-normal (t, skew-t, Skew-Normal). To determine our aggregated VaR, we use observed correlations between the risk factors during this one year period.

 

Our VaR model is designed to take into account a comprehensive set of risk factors across all asset classes. Key risk factors are swap/government curves, index and issuer-specific credit curves, funding spreads, single equity and index prices, foreign exchange rates, commodity prices as well as their implied volatilities. To help ensure completeness in the risk coverage, second order risk factors, e.g. CDS index vs. constituent basis, money market basis, implied dividends, option-adjusted spreads and precious metals lease rates are considered in the VaR calculation.

 

For each business unit a separate VaR is calculated for each risk type, e.g. interest rate risk, credit spread risk, equity risk, foreign exchange risk and commodity risk. For each risk type this is achieved by deriving the sensitivities to the relevant risk type and then simulating changes in the associated risk drivers. “Diversification effect” reflects the fact that the total VaR on a given day will be lower than the sum of the VaR relating to the individual risk types. Simply adding the VaR figures of the individual risk types to arrive at an aggregate VaR would imply the assumption that the losses in all risk types occur simultaneously.

 

The model incorporates both linear and, especially for derivatives, nonlinear effects through a combination of sensitivity-based and revaluation approaches on grids.

 

The VaR measure enables us to apply a consistent measure across all of our trading businesses and products. It allows a comparison of risk in different businesses, and also provides a means of aggregating and netting positions within a portfolio to reflect correlations and offsets between different asset classes. Furthermore, it facilitates comparisons of our market risk both over time and against our daily trading results.

 

When using VaR estimates a number of considerations should be taken into account. These include:

 

— The use of historical market data may not be a good indicator of potential future events, particularly those that are extreme in nature. This “backward-looking” limitation can cause VaR to understate risk (as in 2008), but can also cause it to be overstated.

— Assumptions concerning the distribution of changes in risk factors, and the correlation between different risk factors, may not hold true, particularly during market events that are extreme in nature. The one day holding period does not fully capture the market risk arising during periods of illiquidity, when positions cannot be closed out or hedged within one day.

   
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    108
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

    

—  VaR does not indicate the potential loss beyond the 99th quantile.

—  Intra-day risk is not reflected in the end of day VaR calculation.

—  There may be risks in the trading book that are partially or not captured by the VaR model.

We are committed to the ongoing development of our internal risk models, and we allocate substantial resources to reviewing, validating and improving them. Additionally, we have further developed and improved our process of systematically capturing and evaluating risks currently not captured in our value-at-risk model. An assessment is made to determine the level of materiality of these risks and material risks are prioritized for inclusion in our internal model. All risks not in value-at-risk are monitored and assessed on a regular basis through our RNIV framework.

Stressed Value-at-Risk

 

     Stressed Value-at-Risk calculates a stressed value-at-risk measure based on a one year period of significant market stress. We calculate a stressed value-at-risk measure using a 99 % confidence level. The holding period is one day for internal purposes and ten days for regulatory purposes. Our stressed value-at-risk calculation utilizes the same systems, trade information and processes as those used for the calculation of value-at-risk. The only difference is that historical market data from a period of significant financial stress (i.e., characterized by high volatilities) is used as an input for the Monte Carlo Simulation.

The time window selection process for the stressed value-at-risk calculation is based on the identification of a time window characterized by high levels of volatility and extreme movements in the top value-at-risk contributors. The results from these two indicators (volatility and number of outliers) are combined using chosen weights intended to ensure qualitative aspects are also taken into account (i.e., inclusion of key crisis periods).

Incremental Risk Charge

 

     Incremental Risk Charge captures default and credit migration risks for credit-sensitive positions in the trading book. It applies to credit products over a one-year capital horizon at a 99.9 % confidence level, taking into account the liquidity horizons of individual positions or sets of positions. We use a Monte Carlo Simulation for calculating incremental risk charge as the 99.9 % quantile of the portfolio loss distribution and for allocating contributory incremental risk charge to individual positions.

The model captures the default and migration risk in an accurate and consistent quantitative approach for all portfolios. Important parameters for the incremental risk charge calculation are exposures, recovery rates and default probabilities, ratings migrations, maturity, and liquidity horizons of individual positions.

Comprehensive Risk Measure

 

    

Comprehensive Risk Measure captures incremental risk for the correlation trading portfolio calculated using an internal model subject to qualitative minimum requirements as well as stress testing requirements. The comprehensive risk measure for the correlation trading portfolio is based on our own internal model.

 

We calculate the comprehensive risk measure based on a Monte Carlo Simulation technique to a 99.9 % confidence level and a capital horizon of one year. Our model is applied to the eligible corporate correlation trading positions where typical products include collateralized debt obligations, nth-to-default credit default swaps, and commonly traded index- and single-name credit default swaps.

Trades subject to the comprehensive risk measure have to meet minimum liquidity standards to be eligible. The model incorporates concentrations of the portfolio and nonlinear effects via a full revaluation approach.

For regulatory reporting purposes, the comprehensive risk measure represents the higher of the internal model spot value at the reporting dates, their preceding 12-week average calculation, and the floor, where the floor is equal to 8 % of the equivalent capital charge under the standardized approach securitization framework.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
109   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Management   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Market Risk Standardized Approach

Market Risk Management monitors exposures and addresses risk issues and concentrations for certain exposures under the specific Market Risk Standardized Approach (“MRSA”). We use the MRSA to determine the regulatory capital charge for the specific market risk of trading book securitizations which fall outside the scope of the regulatory correlation trading portfolio.

We also use the MRSA to determine the regulatory capital charge for longevity risk as set out in CRR/CRD 4 regulations. Longevity risk is the risk of adverse changes in life expectancies resulting in a loss in value on longevity linked policies and transactions. For risk management purposes, stress testing and economic capital allocations are also used to monitor and manage longevity risk. Furthermore, certain types of investment funds require a capital charge under the MRSA. For risk management purposes, these positions are also included in our internal reporting framework.

Market Risk Stress Testing

Stress testing is a key risk management technique, which evaluates the potential effects of extreme market events and extreme movements in individual risk factors. It is one of the core quantitative tools used to assess the market risk of Deutsche Bank’s positions and complements VaR and Economic Capital. Market Risk Management performs several types of stress testing to capture the variety of risks: Portfolio stress testing, individual specific stress tests, Event Risk Scenarios, and also contributes to Group-wide stress testing

Trading Market Risk Economic Capital (TMR EC)

Our trading market risk economic capital model - scaled Stressed VaR based EC (SVaR based EC) - comprises two core components, the “common risk” component covering risk drivers across all businesses and the “business-specific risk” component, which enriches the Common Risk via a suite of Business Specific Stress Tests (BSSTs). Both components are calibrated to historically observed severe market shocks. Common risk is calculated using a scaled version of the Regulatory SVaR framework while BSSTs is desired to capture more product/business-related bespoke risks (e.g. complex basis risks) as well as higher order risks (e.g. for equity options) not captured in the common risk component.

Traded Default Risk Economic Capital (TDR EC)

TDR captures the credit exposures across our trading books and it is monitored via single name concentration and portfolio limits which are set based upon rating, size and liquidity. Single name concentration risk limits are set for two key metrics: Default Exposure, i.e., the P&L impact of an instantaneous default at the current recovery rate (RR), and bond equivalent Market Value (MV), i.e. default exposure at 0 % recovery. In order to capture diversification and concentration effects we perform a joint calculation for traded default risk economic capital and credit risk economic capital. Important parameters for the calculation of traded default risk are exposures, recovery rates and default probabilities as well as maturities. The probability of joint rating downgrades and defaults is determined by the default and rating correlations of the portfolio model. These correlations are specified through systematic factors that represent countries, geographical regions and industries.

Trading Market Risk Reporting

Market Risk Management reporting creates transparency on the risk profile and facilitates the understanding of core market risk drivers to all levels of the organization. The Management Board and Senior Governance Committees receive regular reporting, as well as ad hoc reporting as required, on market risk, regulatory capital and stress testing. Senior Risk Committees receive risk information at a number of frequencies, including weekly or monthly.

Additionally, Market Risk Management produces daily and weekly Market Risk specific reports and daily limit excess reports for each asset class.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    110
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Regulatory prudent valuation of assets carried at fair value

Pursuant to Article 34 CRR institutions shall apply the prudent valuation requirements of Article 105 CRR to all assets measured at fair value and shall deduct from CET 1 capital the amount of any additional value adjustments necessary.

We determined the amount of the additional value adjustments based on the methodology defined in the EBA final draft Regulatory Technical Standard.

We agreed with the ECB to apply this standard in our regulatory capital calculation from 30 September 2015.

At 31 December 2015 the amount of the additional value adjustments was  1.9 billion.

Based on Article 159 CRR the total amount of general and specific credit risk adjustments and additional value adjustments for exposures that are treated under the Internal Ratings Based Approach for credit risk and that are in scope of the expected loss calculation may be subtracted from the total expected loss amount related to these exposures. Any remaining positive difference must be deducted from CET 1 capital pursuant to Article 36 (1) lit. d. CRR.

At 31 December 2015 the reduction of the expected loss from subtracting the additional value adjustments was  0.6 billion, which partly mitigated the negative impact of the additional value adjustments on our CET 1 capital.

Nontrading Market Risk

 

    Nontrading market risk arises primarily from outside the activities of our trading units, in our banking book and from certain off-balance sheet items. Significant market risk factors the bank is exposed to and are overseen by risk management groups in that area are:
 
      Interest rate risk (including model risk from embedded optionality and from modeling behavioral assumptions for certain product types), credit spread risk, foreign exchange risk, equity risk (including investments in public and private equity as well as real estate, infrastructure and fund assets).
      Market risks from off-balance sheet items such as pension schemes and guarantees as well as structural foreign exchange risk and equity compensation risk.

Interest Rate Risk in the Banking Book

The majority of our interest rate risk arising from nontrading asset and liability positions, with the exception of some entities and portfolios, has been transferred through internal transactions to the CB&S division. This internally transferred interest rate risk is managed on the basis of value-at-risk, as reflected in trading portfolio figures. The treatment of interest rate risk in our trading portfolios and the application of the value-at-risk model is discussed in the “Trading Market Risk” section of this document.

The most notable exceptions from the aforementioned paragraph are in the PBC Corporate Division in Germany including Postbank and the Deutsche AWM mortgage business in the U.S. Unit. These entities manage interest rate risk separately through dedicated Asset and Liability Management departments subject to banking book value-at-risk limits set and monitored by Market Risk Management. The measurement and reporting of interest rate risk managed by these dedicated Asset and Liability functions is performed daily. In addition, the Group holds selected positions managed by Treasury, where the measurement and reporting of interest rate risk is performed also daily. The global interest rate risk in the banking book is reported on a monthly basis.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
111   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Management   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

The maximum negative change of present values of the banking book positions when applying the regulatory required parallel yield curve shifts of (200) and +200 basis points floored by a rate of zero was less than 2 % of our total regulatory capital at December 31, 2015.

Our PBC, GTB and Deutsche AWM businesses are subject to risk of behavioral change with regard to client deposits as well as savings and loan products. Measuring interest rate risks for these product types in the banking book is based upon assumptions with respect to client behavior, future availability of deposit balances and sensitivities of deposit rates versus market interest rates resulting in a longer than contractual effective duration. Those parameters are subject to stress testing within our Economic Capital framework. Additionally, consideration is made regarding early prepayment behavior for loan products. The parameters are based on historical observations, statistical analyses and expert assessments. If the future evolution of balances, rates or client behavior differs from these assumptions, then this could have an impact on our interest rate risks in the banking book.

Credit Spread Risk in the Banking Book

Deutsche Bank is exposed to credit spread risk of bonds held in the banking book. This risk category is closely associated with interest rate risk in the banking book.

Foreign Exchange Risk

Foreign exchange risk arises from our nontrading asset and liability positions, denominated in currencies other than the functional currency of the respective entity. The majority of this foreign exchange risk is transferred through internal hedges to trading books within CB&S and is therefore reflected and managed via the value-at-risk figures in the trading books. The remaining foreign exchange risks that have not been transferred are mitigated through match funding the investment in the same currency, therefore only residual risk remains in the portfolios. Small exceptions to above approach follow the general MRM monitoring and reporting process, as outlined for the trading portfolio.

The bulk of nontrading foreign exchange risk is related to unhedged structural foreign exchange exposure, mainly in our U.S., U.K. and China entities. Structural foreign exchange exposure arises from local capital (including retained earnings) held in the Bank’s consolidated subsidiaries and branches and from investments accounted for at equity. Change in foreign exchange rates of the underlying functional currencies result in revaluation of capital and retained earnings and are recognized in other comprehensive income booked as Currency Translation Adjustments (“CTA”).

The primary objective for managing our structural foreign exchange exposure is to stabilize consolidated capital ratios from the effects of fluctuations in exchange rates. Therefore the exposure remains unhedged for a number of core currencies with considerable amounts of risk-weighted assets denominated in that currency in order to avoid volatility in the capital ratio for the specific entity and the Group as a whole.

Investment Risk

Nontrading market risk from investment exposure is predominantly the equity risk arising from our non-consolidated investment holdings in the banking book categorized into strategic and alternative investment assets.

Strategic investments typically relate to acquisitions made to support our business franchise and are undertaken with a medium to long-term investment horizon. Alternative assets are comprised of principal investments and other non-strategic investment assets. Principal investments are direct investments in private equity (including leveraged buy-out fund commitments and equity bridge commitments), real estate (including mezzanine debt) and venture capital, undertaken for capital appreciation. In addition, principal investments are made in hedge funds and mutual funds in order to establish a track record for sale to external clients. Other non-strategic investment assets comprise assets recovered in the workout of distressed positions or other legacy investment assets in private equity and real estate of a non-strategic nature.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    112
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Pension Risk

Deutsche Bank is exposed to market risk from a number of defined benefit pension schemes for past and current employees. The ability of the pension schemes to meet the projected pension payments, is maintained through investments and ongoing plan contributions. Market risk materializes due to a potential decline in the market value of the assets or an increase in the liability of each of the pension plans. Market Risk Management monitors and reports all market risks both on the asset and liability side of our defined benefit pension plans including interest rate risk, inflation risk, credit spread risk, equity risk and longevity risk. For details on our defined benefit pension obligation see additional Note 35 “Employee Benefits”.

Other Risks

In addition to the above risks, Market Risk Management has the mandate to monitor and manage market risks that arise from capital, funding and liquidity risk management activities of our treasury department. Besides the structural foreign exchange capital hedging process this includes market risks arising from our equity compensation plans.

Market risks in our asset management activities in Deutsche AWM, primarily results from principal guaranteed funds or accounts, but also from co-investments in our funds.

Nontrading market risk measurement.

 

    Non-trading market risk economic capital is being calculated either by applying the standard traded market risk EC methodology (SVaR based EC model) or through the use of non-traded market risk models that are specific to each risk class and which consider, among other factors, large historically observed market moves, the liquidity of each asset class, and changes in client behavior in relation to deposit products.

Operational Risk Management

Operational Risk Framework

Operational risk is the risk of loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes, people and systems, or from external events. It includes legal risk but excludes business and reputational risk.

In 2015, Deutsche Bank further enhanced its capabilities in Operational Risk Management (“ORM”), in conjunction with the Three Lines of Defence (“3LoD”) Program. This included the increased clarification of the roles and responsibilities of the first and second line in managing operational risk, strengthening governance and delivery of improved tools to support risk identification and assessment. As of 2016 the responsibility for the 3LoD program resides at Group ORM.

Group Operational Risk Management (Group ORM) has responsibility for the design, implementation and maintenance of the Operational Risk Management Framework (ORMF) including the associated governance structures. Group ORM also has the responsibility for providing a cross-risk assessment and aggregation of risks to provide a holistic portfolio view of the non-financial risk profile of the Bank, which includes oversight of risk and control mitigation plans to return risk within risk tolerance, where required.

We take decisions to manage operational risks, both strategically as well as in day-to-day business. Four principles form the foundation of operational risk management at Deutsche Bank:

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
113   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Management   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Operational Risk Principle I: Risk Owners have full accountability for their operational risks and have to manage against a defined risk specific appetite. Risk owners are defined to be: First LoD (CB&S, GTB, AWM, PBC, NCOU and first LoD Infrastructure Functions GTO, CS), for all of their operational risks and second LoD (Infrastructure Functions), for the operational risks that arise in their control processes.

Risk owners are accountable for managing all operational risks in their business/processes with an end-to-end process view, within defined operational risk specific appetite and for identifying, establishing and maintaining first level controls. In addition they mitigate identified and assessed risk within the risk specific appetite through remediation actions, insurance, risk acceptance or by ceasing/reducing business activities.

Divisional Control Officers (“DCO”) support the Risk Owners. They are responsible for embedding the framework within the relevant business division or infrastructure function. They assess the first level controls effectiveness, monitor the aggregated risk profile and put the appropriate control and mitigating actions in place within the relevant division. The DCOs also establish appropriate governance forums to oversee the Operational Risk (OR) profile and support decision making.

Operational Risk Principle II: Risk Type Controllers (Second LoD control functions) establish the risk management framework and define specific Risk Appetite statements for the Risk Type they own and perform independent controls. Risk Type Controllers are independent second LoD control functions which control specific risk types as identified in the risk taxonomy. We are working towards full implementation of these responsibilities.

The Risk Type Controllers are responsible for establishing an effective risk management framework for the risk type, including setting and monitoring minimum control standards. They challenge, assess and report risks within their risk types and set the risk specific appetite in accordance with the Group’s Risk Appetite statement. Risk Type Controllers monitor group-wide tolerances, perform second level controls, complementary to the first level controls and define the risk taxonomy for the risk type they own. Finally they establish independent non-financial risk governance, and prepare aggregated reporting into the Group Non-Financial Risk Executive Committee (“NFR ExCo”).

Operational Risk Principle III: Group Operational Risk Management establishes and maintains the Group Operational Risk Management Framework. Group ORM develops and maintains the Group's framework, defining the roles and responsibilities for the management of operational risk across the bank and for defining the process to identify, assess, mitigate, monitor, report and escalate operational risks. Group ORM also maintains an operational risk taxonomy and oversees the completeness of coverage of risk types identified in the taxonomy by 2nd Line Control Functions. It also monitors execution and results of Deutsche Bank Group’s Risk and Control Assessment process and operational risk concentrations.

Group ORM also provides independent challenge of the Group’s operational risk profile providing independent risk views to facilitate forward looking management of the risks. The function independently monitors, reviews and assesses material risks and key controls at a divisional and infrastructure level across the Bank. It further monitors and reports on the Group's operational risk profile in comparison to the Bank’s Group Risk Appetite, to systematically identify operational risk themes and concentrations, and to agree risk mitigating measures and priorities. To adhere to reporting requirements, Group ORM establishes reporting and escalating procedures up to the Management Board for risk assessment results and identified material control gaps, while informing Group Audit of material control gaps.

Operational Risk Principle IV: Group Operational Risk Management aims to maintain sufficient capital to underpin Operational Risk. Group ORM is accountable for the design, implementation and maintenance of an appropriate approach to determine a sufficient level of capital demand for Operational Risk for recommendation to the Management Board. To fulfil this requirement Group ORM is accountable for the calculation and allocation of Operational Risk Capital demand and Expected Loss planning under the Advanced Measurement Approach (“AMA”) approach. Group ORM is also accountable for the execution of data input controls for the Operational Risk capital calculation and for the facilitation of the annual OR Capital budgeting and monthly review process.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    114
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Organizational & Governance Structure

Group Operational Risk Management is part of the Group Risk function which is headed by the Chief Risk Officer (“CRO”). The CRO appoints the Head of Group Operational Risk Management.

Within Group ORM the Head of Group Operational Risk Management is accountable for the design, implementation and maintenance of an effective and efficient Group Operational Risk Management Framework.

The NFR ExCo, which is chaired by the Chief Risk Officer, is responsible for the oversight, governance and coordination of the Non-Financial Risk management in the Deutsche Bank Group on behalf of the Management Board by establishing a cross-risk and holistic perspective of the key Non-Financial Risks of the Group. The decision-making and policy related authorities include the review, advice and management in a diligent manner of all Non-Financial Risk issues which may impact the holistic / cross risk profile reported by a business division or infrastructure function.

The Regulatory Capital Committee (“RCC”) has delegated parts of its authority for operational risk capital demand management to the AMA Committee (“AMAC”) within defined limits. The AMAC is mandated to oversee the regulatory and economic capital process for operational risk. It aims to ensure adherence to regulatory requirements for the AMA model and its calculation process as well as their adherence to internal policies. The committee either directly approves, or endorses to the RCC for approval, all quantitative and qualitative changes impacting Deutsche Bank's regulatory or economic capital. Additionally, the committee oversees all relevant aspects of model risk for operational risk models.

While the day-to-day management of operational risk is the primary responsibility of our business divisions and infrastructure functions, Group ORM manages the cross divisional and cross regional operational risk as well as risk concentrations and promotes a consistent application of the ORMF across the bank. Through our business partnership model, we aim to maintain close monitoring and high awareness of operational risks.

Managing Our Operational Risk

We manage operational risk using the Group Operational Risk Management framework which enables us to determine our operational risk profile in comparison to our risk tolerance, to systematically identify operational risk themes and concentrations, and to define risk mitigating measures and priorities.

In order to cover the broad range of risk types underlying operational risk, our framework contains a number of operational risk management techniques. These aim to efficiently manage the operational risk in our business and are used to identify, assess and mitigate operational risks:

 

 

Loss Data Collection: The continuous collection of operational risk loss events, as a prerequisite for operational risk management, includes detailed analyses, the identification of mitigating actions, and provision of timely information to senior management. All losses above  10,000 are collected in our incident reporting system (“dbIRS”).

 

The Lessons Learned process is triggered for events, including near misses, above  500 thousand. This process includes, but is not limited to:

   

systematic risk analyses, including a description of the business environment in which the loss occurred, previous events, near misses and event-specific Key Risk Indicators (“KRI”),

   

root cause analysis,

   

review of control improvements and other actions to prevent or mitigate the recurrence, and

   

assessment of the residual risk exposure.

The execution of corrective actions identified in this process are systematically tracked and reported monthly to senior management.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
115   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Management   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

 

 

Scenario Analyses: We complete our risk profile using a set of scenarios including relevant external cases provided by a public database and additional internal scenarios. We thereby systematically utilize information on external loss events occurring in the banking industry to prevent similar incidents from happening to us, for example through particular deep dive analyses or risk profile reviews.

 

Emerging Risk Identification: We assess and approve the impact of changes on our risk profile as a result of new products, outsourcing activities, strategic initiatives, acquisitions and divestments as well as material systems and process changes. Once operational risks are identified and assessed, they are compared to the relevant specific risk appetite statement and either mitigated or accepted. Risks which violate applicable national or international regulations and legislation cannot be accepted; once identified, such risks must always be mitigated.

 

Read-across Analysis: We continuously seek to enhance the process to assess whether identified issues require a broader approach across multiple entities and locations within Deutsche Bank. A review of material findings is performed in order to assess their relevance to areas of the Bank other than where they originated. We are developing business intelligence software to identify risk clusters across the bank accessing various sources of information. We aim to increase our predictive analysis and clustering capabilities and to identify risk concentrations in a timely manner through the use of this tool.

 

Risk Mitigation: When we implement risk mitigating measures, we systematically monitor their resolution. Residual operational risks rated significant or above need to be accepted by the risk bearing division and reviewed for decision by the Head of Group ORM.

 

We perform Top Risk Analyses in which the results of the aforementioned activities are considered. The Top Risk Analyses are a primary input for the annual operational risk management strategy and planning process and aim to identify our most critical risks in terms of probability and severity.

 

Key Risk Indicators are used to monitor the operational risk profile and alert the organization to impending problems in a timely fashion. KRIs enable the monitoring of the bank’s control culture and business environment and trigger risk mitigating actions. They facilitate the forward looking management of operational risks, based on early warning signals.

 

In our bottom-up Self-Assessment (“SA”) process, which is conducted at least annually, areas with high risk potential are highlighted, and risk mitigating measures to resolve issues are identified. On a regular basis we conduct risk workshops aiming to evaluate risks specific to local legal entities and the countries we operate in, and take appropriate risk mitigating actions. We are in the course of replacing this existing SA process by an enhanced Risk and Control Assessment process, supported by a group wide IT tool. We plan to substantially cover the Bank’s nonfinancial operating units under this enhanced approach in 2016.

Additional functions, methodologies and tools implemented by the responsible second line Risk Type Controllers are utilized to complement the Group Operational Risk Framework and specifically address the risk types. These include but are not limited to:

 

Legal Risk is a significant risk factor for DB, which as described in detail in the “Provisions” note of our Consolidated Financial Statements. A Legal Risk Management (“LRM”) function within our Legal Depart-ment is exclusively dedicated to the identification and management of legal risk. It undertakes a broad variety of tasks aimed at proactively managing legal risk, including: devising, implementing and overseeing an annual Legal Risk Assessment Program analyzing existing and historic legal risks; agreeing and participating in resulting portfolio reviews and mitigation plans; and administering the Legal Lessons Learned process.

 

The operational risk from outsourcing is managed by the Vendor Risk Management (“VRM”) Process. The outsourcing risk is assessed and managed for all outsourcing arrangements individually, following our Vendor Risk Management Policy and in line with the overall Group Operational Risk Management Framework. A broad governance structure is established to promote appropriate risk levels.

 

Fraud Risk is managed based on section 25a of the German Banking Act (“KWG”) as well as other legal and regulatory requirements via a risk based approach, governed by our Global Anti-Fraud Policy and corresponding Compliance and Anti-Money-Laundering (“AML”) framework. In line with regulatory requirements, a global risk assessment is performed on a regular basis. Within the general management of operational risks, dedicated Fraud Risk relevant aspects are part of the self-assessment process.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    116
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

 

We manage Business Continuity Risk with its Business Continuity Management (“BCM”) Program which outlines core procedures for the relocation or the recovery of operations in response to varying levels of disruption. Within this program, each of our core businesses functions and infrastructure groups set up, maintain and periodically test business continuity plans to promote continuous and reliable service. The BCM Program has defined roles and responsibilities which are documented in corporate standards. Compliance with these standards is monitored regionally by dedicated business continuity teams. Furthermore, key information on the established BCM control environment feed into operational risk KRIs.

 

The Operational Risk in Technology is managed within the Group Technology Organization, following international standards for IT management. Applications and IT infrastructure are catalogued and assessed on a regular basis. Stability monitoring is established. Key outcomes of the established assessment and control environment are used as input for KRIs or self-assessments.

Measuring Our Operational Risks

We calculate and measure the regulatory and economic capital requirements for operational risk using the Advanced Measurement Approach (AMA) methodology. Our AMA capital calculation is based upon the loss distribution approach (“LDA”). Gross losses from historical internal and external loss data (Operational Riskdata eXchange Association (ORX) consortium data) and external scenarios from a public database (IBM OpData) complemented by internal scenario data are used to estimate the risk profile (i.e., a loss frequency and a loss severity distribution). Our LDA model includes conservatism by recognizing losses on events that arise over multiple years as single events in our historical loss profile.

Moreover, we have submitted an additional model change request to our Germany supervisory authority BaFin to replace the 1 billion regulatory capital safety margin, which we have continuously applied since its implementation in 2011. This change will make our model more risk sensitive by including reasonably possible litigation losses in our “Relevant Loss Data” set. Reasonably possible litigation losses may result from ongoing and new legal matters which are reviewed quarterly and are based on the judgment provided by our Legal Department.

While our dialogue with the joint supervisory team on these model enhancements is ongoing, management had decided to recognize the impact of material model changes in the second quarter 2014 wherever they will lead to an increase in the capital requirement over the models that have previously been approved by BaFin.

Within the LDA model, the frequency and severity distributions are combined in a Monte Carlo simulation to generate potential losses over a one year time horizon. Finally, the risk mitigating benefits of insurance are applied to each loss generated in the Monte Carlo simulation. Correlation and diversification benefits are applied to the net losses in a manner compatible with regulatory requirements to arrive at a net loss distribution at Group level, covering expected and unexpected losses. Capital is then allocated to each of the business divisions after considering qualitative adjustments and expected loss.

The regulatory capital requirement for operational risk is derived from the 99.9 % percentile. The economic capital is set at a level to absorb at a 99.98 % percentile very severe aggregate unexpected losses within one year. Both regulatory and economic capital requirements are calculated for a time horizon of one year.

The Regulatory and Economic Capital demand calculations are performed on a quarterly basis. Group ORM aims to ensure that for the approach for capital demand quantification appropriate development, validation and change governance processes are in place, whereby the validation is performed by an independent validation function and in line with Deutsche Bank’s model risk management process.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
117   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Management   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

 

Liquidity Risk Management

 

 

Liquidity risk is the risk arising from our potential inability to meet all payment obligations when they come due or only being able to meet these obligations at excessive costs. The objective of the Group’s liquidity risk management framework is to ensure that the Group can fulfil its payment obligations at all times and can manage liquidity and funding risks within its risk appetite. The framework considers relevant and significant drivers of liquidity risk, whether on-balance sheet or off-balance sheet.

 

Our liquidity risk management framework has been an important factor in maintaining adequate liquidity and in managing our funding profile during 2015.

   

 

Liquidity Risk Management Framework

 

 

In accordance with the ECB’s Supervisory Review and Evaluation Process (SREP), Deutsche Bank has implemented an annual Internal Liquidity Adequacy Assessment Process (“ILAAP”), which is reviewed and approved by the Management Board. The ILAAP provides comprehensive documentation of the Bank’s Liquidity Risk Management framework, including: identifying the key liquidity and funding risks to which the Group is exposed; how these risks are identified, monitored and measured and describes the techniques and resources used to manage and mitigate these risks.

 

The Management Board defines the liquidity and funding risk strategy for the bank, as well as the risk appetite, based on recommendations made by the Capital and Risk Committee (“CaR”). At least annually the Management Board reviews and approves the limits which are applied to the Group to measure and control liquidity risk as well as our long-term funding and issuance plan.

 

Treasury is mandated to manage the overall liquidity and funding position of the bank, with Liquidity Risk Control acting as an independent control function, responsible for the validation of Liquidity Risk models which are developed by Treasury, to measure and manage the Group’s liquidity risk profile.

 

Treasury manages liquidity and funding, in accordance with the Management Board approved risk appetite across a range of relevant metrics, and implements a number of tools to monitor these and ensure compliance. In addition, Treasury works closely in conjunction with Liquidity Risk Control (“LRC”), and the business, to analyse and understand the underlying liquidity characteristics of the business portfolios. These parties are engaged in regular and frequent dialogue to understand changes in the bank’s position arising from business activities and market circumstances. Dedicated business targets are allocated to ensure the Group meets its overall liquidity and funding appetite.

 

The Management Board is informed of performance against these risk appetite metrics, via a weekly Liquidity Scorecard. As part of the annual strategic planning process, we project the development of the key liquidity and funding metrics based on the underlying business plans to ensure that the plan is in compliance with our risk appetite.

   

 

Capital Markets Issuance

 

 
Deutsche Bank has a wide range of funding sources, including retail and institutional deposits, unsecured and secured wholesale funding and debt issuance in the capital markets. Debt issuance, encompassing senior unsecured bonds, covered bonds as well as capital securities, is a key source of term funding for the Bank and is managed directly by Treasury. At least once a year Treasury submits an annual long-term Funding Plan to the Capital and Risk Committee for recommendation and then to the Management Board for approval. This plan is driven by global and local funding and liquidity requirements based on expected business development. Our capital markets portfolio is dynamically managed through our yearly issuance plans to avoid excessive maturity concentrations.  

 

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    118
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Short-term Liquidity and Wholesale Funding

 

   

Deutsche Bank tracks all contractual cash flows from wholesale funding sources, on a daily basis, over a 12-month horizon. For this purpose, we consider wholesale funding to include unsecured liabilities raised primarily by Treasury

 

Pool Management, as well as secured liabilities raised by our Markets Division. Our wholesale funding counterparties typically include corporates, banks and other financial institutions, governments and sovereigns.

 

The Group has implemented a set of Management Board approved limits to restrict DB’s exposure to wholesale counterparties, which have historically shown to be the most susceptible to market stress. These wholesale funding limits are calibrated against monthly stress-testing results, to ensure the Group remains liquid under our most severe stress scenario, even if limits are fully utilized.

 

The wholesale funding limits are monitored daily, and apply to the total combined currency amount of all wholesale funding currently outstanding, both secured and unsecured with specific tenor limits covering the first 8 weeks. Our Liquidity Reserves are the primary mitigant against potential stress in short-term wholesale funding market.

The tables starting on page 184 show the contractual maturity of our short-term wholesale funding and capital markets issuance.

Liquidity Stress Testing and Scenario Analysis

 

   

Global liquidity stress testing and scenario analysis is one of the key tools for measuring liquidity risk and evaluating the Group’s short-term liquidity position within the liquidity framework. It complements the intraday operational liquidity management process and the long-term liquidity strategy, represented by the Funding Matrix.

 

Our global liquidity stress testing process is managed by Treasury in accordance with the Management Board approved risk appetite. Treasury is responsible for the design of the overall methodology, including the definition of the stress scenarios, the choice of liquidity risk drivers and the determination of appropriate assumptions (parameters) to translate input data into model results. Liquidity Risk Control Oversight and Validation (“LRC O&V”) are responsible for the independent validation of methodologies and Liquidity Risk Control Reporting and Analytics (“LRC R&A”) for implementing these methodologies in conjunction with Treasury and IT. LRC R&A is also responsible for the stress test calculation.

 

We use stress testing and scenario analysis to evaluate the impact of sudden and severe stress events on our liquidity position. The scenarios we apply are based on historic events, such as the 2008 financial markets crisis.

 

Deutsche Bank has selected five scenarios to calculate the Group’s stressed Net Liquidity Position (“sNLP”). These scenarios capture the historical experience of Deutsche Bank during periods of idiosyncratic and/or market-wide stress and are assumed to be both plausible and sufficiently severe as to materially impact the Group’s liquidity position. A global market crisis, for example, is covered by a specific stress scenario (systemic market risk) that models the potential consequences as seen, e.g., during the recent financial crisis. Additionally, we have introduced regional market stress scenarios. Under each of the scenarios we assume a high degree of maturing loans to non-wholesale customers is rolled-over, to support our business franchise. Wholesale funding, from the most risk sensitive counterparties (including banks, and money-market mutual funds) is assumed to roll-off at contractual maturity or even be bought back, in the acute phase of the stress.

 

In addition, we include the potential funding requirements from contingent liquidity risks which might arise, including credit facilities, increased collateral requirements under derivative agreements, and outflows from deposits with a contractual rating linked trigger.

 

We then model the actions we would take to counterbalance the outflows incurred. Countermeasures include our Liquidity Reserves and asset liquidity from other unencumbered securities.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
119   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Management   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

 

Stress testing is conducted at a global and individual legal entity level and across significant non-eurozone currencies, in particular, U.S. dollar and GBP as the major non-EUR funding currencies. We review our stress-testing assumptions on a regular basis and have increased the severity of a number of these assumptions throughout the course of 2015.

 

We run the liquidity stress test over an eight-week horizon, which we consider the most critical time span in a liquidity crisis, and apply the relevant stress assumptions to risk drivers from on-balance sheet and off-balance sheet products on a daily basis. Beyond the eight week time horizon, we analyze the impact of a more prolonged stress period, extending to twelve months. This stress testing analysis is performed monthly.

 

   

Our internal risk appetite is to maintain a surplus of at least  5 billion throughout the 8 week stress horizon under all scenarios for our monthly aggregate currency stress test.

 

The table on page 181 shows the results of our internal liquidity stress test under the various different scenarios.

 

Liquidity Coverage Ratio

 

In addition to our internal stress test result, the Group has a Management Board approved risk appetite for the Liquidity Coverage Ratio (“LCR”). Finalized by the Basel Committee in January 2013, the LCR is intended to promote the short-term resilience of a bank’s liquidity risk profile over a 30 day stress scenario. The ratio is defined as the amount of High Quality Liquid Assets (“HQLA”) that could be used to raise liquidity, measured against the total volume of net cash outflows, arising from both actual and contingent exposures, in a stressed scenario.

 

This requirement has been implemented into European law, via the Commission Delegated Regulation (EU) 2015/61, adopted in October 2014. Compliance with the LCR was required in Europe from October 1, 2015. The Liquidity Coverage Ratio is subject to a transitional phase-in period, which started at 60 % on October 1, 2015, rising to 70 % from January 1,, 2016, 80 % in 2017 and 100 % in 2018.

 

The LCR complements the internal stress testing framework. By maintaining a ratio in excess of minimum regulatory requirements, the LCR ensure that the Group holds adequate liquidity resources to mitigate a short-term liquidity stress.

 

Our internal risk appetite is to maintain a LCR ratio of at least 105 %.

 

Key differences between the liquidity stress test and LCR include the time horizon (eight weeks versus 30 days), classification and haircut differences between Liquidity Reserves and the LCR HQLA, outflow rates for various categories of funding, and inflow assumption for various assets (for example, loan repayments).Our liquidity stress test also includes outflows related to intraday liquidity assumptions, which the LCR excludes.

 

Funding Risk Management

 

Structural Funding

 

 

Deutsche Bank’s primary tool for monitoring and managing funding risk is the Funding Matrix. The Funding Matrix assesses the Group’s structural funding profile for the greater than one year time horizon. To produce the Funding Matrix, all funding-relevant assets and liabilities are mapped into time buckets corresponding to their contractual or modeled maturities. This allows the Group to identify expected excesses and shortfalls in term liabilities over assets in each time bucket, facilitating the management of potential liquidity exposures.

 

The liquidity maturity profile is based on contractual cash flow information. If the contractual maturity profile of a product does not adequately reflect the liquidity maturity profile, it is replaced by modelling assumptions. Short-term balance sheet items (<1yr) or matched funded structures (asset and liabilities directly matched with no liquidity risk) can be excluded from the term analysis.

   
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    120
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

   

The bottom-up assessment by individual business line is combined with a top-down reconciliation against the Group’s IFRS balance sheet. From the cumulative term profile of assets and liabilities beyond 1 year, any long-funded surpluses or short-funded gaps in the Group’s maturity structure can be identified. The cumulative profile is thereby built up starting from the above 10 year bucket down to the above 1 year bucket.

 

The funding matrix analysis together with the strategic liquidity planning process, which forecasts the funding supply and demand across business units, provides the key input parameter for our annual capital market issuance plan. Upon approval by the Management Board the capital markets issuance plan establishes issuing targets for securities by tenor, volume and instrument. We also maintain a stand-alone U.S. dollar and GBP funding matrix which limits the maximum short position in any time bucket (>1 year to >10 years) to  10 billion and  5 billion respectively. This supplements the risk appetite for our aggregate currency funding matrix which requires us to maintain a positive funding position in any time bucket (>1 year to > 10 years).

Net Stable Funding Ratio

The Net Stable Funding Ratio was proposed as part of Basel 3, as the regulatory metric for assessing a bank’s structural funding profile. The NSFR is intended to reduce medium to long-term funding risks by requiring banks to maintain a stable funding profile in relation to their on- and off-balance sheet activities. The ratio is defined as the amount of Available Stable Funding (the portion of capital and liabilities expected to be a stable source of funding), relative to the amount of Required Stable Funding (a function of the liquidity characteristics of various assets held).

Although the NSFR is scheduled to become a minimum standard internationally, by January 1, 2018, the ratio is subject to national implementation. In Europe, rules on the NSFR are due to be finalized by the European Commission, in the form of a Legislative Proposal due at the end of 2016. Therefore, for European banks, the final format of the ratio and associated implementation timeframe has not yet been confirmed.

We are currently in the process of assessing the impacts of the NSFR, and would expect to formally embed this metric within our overall liquidity risk management framework, once the relevant rules and timing within Europe have been finally determined.

Funding Diversification

 

   

Diversification of our funding profile in terms of investor types, regions, products and instruments is an important element of our liquidity risk management framework. Our most stable funding sources come from capital markets and equity, retail, and transaction banking clients. Other customer deposits and secured funding and shorts are additional sources of funding. Unsecured wholesale funding represents unsecured wholesale liabilities sourced primarily by our Treasury Pool division. Given the relatively short-term nature of these liabilities, they are primarily used to fund cash and liquid trading assets.

 

To promote the additional diversification of our refinancing activities, we hold a Pfandbrief license allowing us to issue mortgage Pfandbriefe. In addition, we have established a program for the purposes of issuing Covered Bonds under Spanish law (Cedulas).

 

Unsecured wholesale funding comprises a range of unsecured products e.g. Certificates of Deposit (CDs), Commercial Paper (CP) as well as term, call and overnight deposits across tenors primarily up to one year.

 

To avoid any unwanted reliance on these short-term funding sources, and to promote a sound funding profile, which complies with the defined risk appetite, we have implemented limits (across tenors) on these funding sources, which are derived from our monthly stress testing analysis. In addition, we limit the total volume of unsecured wholesale funding to manage the reliance on this funding source as part of the overall funding diversification.

 

The chart on page 178 shows the composition of our external funding sources that contribute to the liquidity risk position, both in EUR billion and as a percentage of our total external funding sources.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
121   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Management   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

 

Funds Transfer Pricing

 

The funds transfer pricing framework applies to all businesses and regions and promotes pricing of (i) assets in accordance with their underlying liquidity risk, (ii) liabilities in accordance with their liquidity value and funding maturity and (iii) contingent liquidity exposures in accordance with the cost of providing for commensurate liquidity reserves to fund unexpected cash requirements.

 

Deutsche Bank’s funds transfer pricing framework reflects regulatory principles and guidelines. Within this framework all funding and liquidity risk costs and benefits are allocated to the firm’s business units based on market rates. Those market rates reflect the economic costs of liquidity for Deutsche Bank. Treasury might set further financial incentives in line with the bank’s liquidity risk guidelines. While the framework promotes a diligent group-wide allocation of the bank's funding costs to the liquidity users, it also provides an incentive based compensation framework for businesses generating stable long-term and stress compliant funding. Funding relevant transactions are subject to liquidity (term) premiums and/or other funds transfer pricing mechanisms depending on market conditions. Liquidity premiums are set by Treasury and reflected in a segregated Treasury liquidity account which is the aggregator of liquidity costs and benefits. The management and allocation of the liquidity account cost base is the key variable for funds transfer pricing within Deutsche Bank.

 

Liquidity Reserves

 

 
Liquidity reserves comprise available cash and cash equivalents, highly liquid securities (includes government, agency and government guaranteed) as well as other unencumbered central bank eligible assets.    

 

The volume of our liquidity reserves is a function of our expected daily stress result, both at an aggregate level as well as at an individual currency level. To the extent we receive incremental short-term wholesale liabilities which attract a high stress roll-off, we will largely keep the proceeds of such liabilities in cash or highly liquid securities as a stress mitigant. Accordingly, the total volume of our liquidity reserves will fluctuate as a function of the level of short-term wholesale liabilities held, although this has no material impact on our overall liquidity position under stress. Our liquidity reserves include only assets that are freely transferable within the Group, or can be applied against local entity stress outflows. We hold the vast majority of our liquidity reserves centrally, at our parent and our foreign branches with further reserves held at key locations in which we are active. While we hold our reserves across major currencies, their size and composition are subject to regular senior management review.

 

Asset Encumbrance

 

Encumbered assets primarily comprise those on- and off-balance sheet assets that are pledged as collateral against secured funding, collateral swaps, and other collateralized obligations. We generally encumber loans to support long-term capital markets secured issuance such as Pfandbriefe or other self-securitisation structures, while financing debt and equity inventory on a secured basis is a regular activity for our Global Markets business. Additionally, in line with the EBA technical standards on regulatory asset encumbrance reporting, we consider assets placed with settlement systems, including default funds and initial margins as encumbered, as well as other assets pledged which cannot be freely withdrawn such as mandatory minimum reserves at central banks. We also include derivative margin receivable assets as encumbered under these EBA guidelines.

 
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    122
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Business (Strategic) Risk Management

Strategic Risk is the risk of a potential earnings downside due to revenues and/or costs underperforming plan targets. Strategic Risk may arise from poor strategic positioning, failure to execute strategy or lack of effective responses to material negative plan deviations caused by either external or internal factors (including macro, financial and idiosyncratic drivers). Strategic Risk has been defined as part of overall Business Risk.

The key aim of Strategic Risk Management is to strengthen the bank´s earnings resilience and protect it against undue earnings volatility to support overall risk appetite targets (especially CET 1 ratio and Leverage Ratios). We aim to achieve this by identifying, assessing, limiting, mitigating and monitoring key strategic risks.

Currently, the modelling and quantitative measurement of Strategic Risk is primarily covered by our internal economic capital (EC) framework. In 2016, we will implement a comprehensive framework to manage Strategic Risk.

Reputational Risk Management

Within our risk management process, we define reputational risk as the risk of possible damage to DB’s brand and reputation, and the associated risk to earnings, capital or liquidity, arising from any association, action or inaction which could be perceived by stakeholders to be inappropriate, unethical or inconsistent with DB’s values and beliefs.

Our reputational risk is governed by the Reputational Risk Framework (the Framework). The Framework was established to provide consistent standards for the identification, assessment and management of reputational risk issues. While every employee has a responsibility to protect DB’s reputation, the primary responsibility for the identification, assessment, management, monitoring and, if necessary, referring or reporting, of reputational risk matters lies with DB’s Business Divisions. Each employee is under an obligation, within the scope of his/her activities, to be alert to any potential causes of reputational risk and to address them according to the Framework.

If a potential reputational risk is identified, it is required to be referred for further consideration within the Business Division through their Unit Reputational Risk Assessment Process. In the event that a matter is deemed to carry a material reputational risk and/or meets one of the mandatory referral criteria, it must be referred through to one of the four Regional Reputational Risk Committees (RRRCs) for further review as the 2nd line of defence. The RRRCs are sub-committees of the Group Reputational Risk Committee (GRRC) and are responsible for the oversight, governance and coordination of the management of reputational risk in their respective regions of Deutsche Bank on behalf of the Management Board. In exceptional circumstances, matters can also be referred by the RRRCs to the GRRC.

The modelling and quantitative measurement of reputational risk internal capital is implicitly covered in our economic capital framework primarily within operational and strategic risk.

Model Risk Management

Model Risk is the risk of possible adverse consequences of decisions based on models that are inappropriate, incorrect, or misused. In this context, a model is defined as a quantitative method, system, or approach that applies statistical, economic, financial, or mathematical theories, techniques, and assumptions to process input data into quantitative estimates.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
123   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Management   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

A new Model risk function was established in 2014, aggregating all core model risk management activities across the bank into one independent function:

 

 

Model validation provides independent validation of the methodological aspects of models. The key objectives of model validation are to verify that models are performing as expected, in line with their design objectives and business uses, and to aim to ensure that models are logically and conceptually sound and assess the appropriateness and accuracy of the implementation methodology;

 

Model risk governance supports establishment of a front-to-back model risk management framework which includes defining common standards for model development, usage and validation; identification and remediation of issues and inconsistencies in modeling; and maintenance of a bank-wide model inventory; and

 

Key senior management forums to address model risk are the Group Model Risk Management Committee (“GMRMC”) and the Pricing Model Risk Management Committee (“PMRMC”). Both are subcommittees of the CaR and act on behalf of the Management Board. The PMRMC is responsible for management and oversight of model risk from valuation models (front office models that are used for official pricing and risk management of trading positions). The GMRMC is responsible for management and oversight of model risk from risk and capital models.

The modeling and quantitative measurement of model risk internal capital is implicitly covered in our economic capital framework primarily within operational and strategic risk.

Compliance Risk Management

Compliance Risk is defined as the current or prospective risk to earnings and capital arising from violations or non-compliance with laws, rules, regulations, agreements, prescribed practices or ethical standards and can lead to fines, damages and/ or the voiding of contracts and can diminish an institution’s reputation.

Compliance manages this risk through the following:

 

 

Identifying material rules and regulations where non-compliance could lead to endangerment of the Bank’s assets (supported by the bank’s business divisions, infrastructure functions or Regional Management);

 

Advising and supporting the Management Board concerning the adherence to material rules and regulations as well as acting to implement effective procedures for compliance with applicable material rules and regulations, and the setup of the corresponding controls;

 

Monitoring the coverage of new or changed material rules and regulations by our business divisions, infrastructure functions or Regional Management including potential implementation plans for appropriate controls. Compliance is not explicitly requested to run its own monitoring programs but has the right to carry out monitoring activities;

 

Assessing the coverage of all existing material rules and regulations by the bank’s business divisions, infrastructure functions or Regional Management and existence of a corresponding control environment; and

 

Reporting to the Management and Supervisory Boards on at least an annual basis and on an ad hoc basis.

The modeling and quantitative measurement of compliance risk internal capital is implicitly covered in our economic capital framework primarily within operational and strategic risk.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    124
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Insurance Specific Risk Management

 

   

Our exposure to insurance risk relates primarily to Abbey Life Assurance Company Limited and our defined benefit pension obligations. There is also some insurance-related risk within the Pensions and Insurance Risk Markets business. In our risk management framework, we consider insurance-related risks primarily as nontrading market risk that has been classified as material risk. We monitor the underlying assumptions in the calculation of these risks regularly and seek risk mitigating measures such as reinsurances, if we deem this appropriate. We are primarily exposed to the following insurance-related risks:

 

      Longevity risk: the risk of faster or slower than expected improvements in life expectancy on immediate and deferred annuity products;
      Mortality and morbidity risks: the risks of a higher or lower than expected number of death or disability claims on insurance products and of an occurrence of one or more large claims;
      Expenses risk: the risk that policies cost more or less to administer than expected; and
      Persistency risk: the risk of a higher or lower than expected percentage of lapsed policies.
   

 

To the extent that actual experience is less favorable than the underlying assumptions, or it is necessary to increase provisions due to more onerous assumptions, the amount of capital required in the insurance entities may increase.

Risk Concentration and Risk Diversification

Risk Concentrations

 

   

Risk concentrations refer to clusters of the same or similar risk drivers within specific risk types (intra-risk concentrations in credit, market, operational, liquidity and other risks) as well as across different risk types (inter-risk concentrations). They could occur within and across counterparties, businesses, regions/countries, industries and products. The management of concentrations is integrated as part of the management of individual risk types and monitored on an ongoing basis. The key objective is to avoid any undue concentrations in the portfolio, which is achieved through a quantitative and qualitative approach, as follows:

 

      Intra-risk concentrations are assessed, monitored and mitigated by the individual risk disciplines (credit, market, operational, liquidity risk management and others). This is supported by limit setting on different levels and/or management according to risk type.
      Inter-risk concentrations are managed through quantitative top-down stress-testing and qualitative bottom-up reviews, identifying and assessing risk themes independent of any risk type and providing a holistic view across the bank.
   

 

The most senior governance body for the oversight of risk concentrations throughout 2015 was the Portfolio Risk Committee (PRC), which is a subcommittee of the Capital and Risk Committee (CaR) and the Risk Executive Committee (Risk ExCo).

Risk Type Diversification Benefit

The risk type diversification benefit quantifies diversification effects between credit, market, operational and strategic risk in the economic capital calculation. To the extent correlations between these risk types fall below 1.0, a risk type diversification benefit results. The calculation of the risk type diversification benefit is intended to ensure that the standalone economic capital figures for the individual risk types are aggregated in an economically meaningful way.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
125   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Performance   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Risk and Capital Performance

Capital and Leverage Ratio

Regulatory Capital

 

The calculation of our regulatory capital incorporates the capital requirements following the “Regulation (EU) No 575/2013 on prudential requirements for credit institutions and investment firms” (Capital Requirements Regulation or “CRR”) and the “Directive 2013/36/EU on access to the activity of credit institutions and the prudential supervision of credit institutions and investment firms” (Capital Requirements Directive 4 or “CRD 4”) as implemented into German law. The information in this section as well as in the section “Development of risk-weighted Assets” is based on the regulatory principles of consolidation.    

 

When referring to results according to full application of the final CRR/CRD 4 framework (without consideration of applicable transitional methodology) we use the term “CRR/CRD 4 fully loaded”. In some cases, CRR/CRD 4 maintains transitional rules that had been adopted in earlier capital adequacy frameworks through Basel 2 or Basel 2.5. These relate e.g. to the risk weighting of certain categories of assets and include rules permitting the grandfathering of equity investments at a risk-weight of 100 %. In these cases, our CRR/CRD 4 fully loaded methodology assumes that the impact of the expiration of these transitional rules will be mitigated through sales of the underlying assets or other measures prior to the expiration of the grandfathering provisions.

 

 

This section refers to the capital adequacy of the group of institutions consolidated for banking regulatory purposes pursuant to the CRR and the German Banking Act (“Kreditwesengesetz” or “KWG”). Therein not included are insurance companies or companies outside the finance sector. Our insurance companies are included in an additional capital adequacy (also “solvency margin”) calculation under the German Solvency Regulation for Financial Conglomerates. Our solvency margin as a financial conglomerate remains dominated by our banking activities.

 

The total regulatory capital pursuant to the effective regulations as of year-end 2015 comprises Tier 1 and Tier 2 (T2) capital. Tier 1 capital is subdivided into Common Equity Tier 1 (CET 1) capital and Additional Tier 1 (AT1) capital.

 

Common Equity Tier 1 (CET 1) capital consists primarily of common share capital (reduced by own holdings) including related share premium accounts, retained earnings (including losses for the financial year, if any) and accumulated other comprehensive income, subject to regulatory adjustments (i.e. prudential filters and deductions). Prudential filters for CET 1, according to Articles 32 to 35 CRR, include (i) securitization gain on sale, (ii) cash flow hedges and changes in the value of own liabilities, and (iii) additional value adjustments. CET 1 capital deductions comprise (i) intangible assets, (ii) deferred tax assets that rely on future profitability, (iii) negative amounts resulting from the calculation of expected loss amounts, and (iv) net defined benefit pension fund assets, (v) reciprocal cross holdings in the capital of financial sector entities, (vi) significant and non-significant investments in the capital (CET 1, AT1, T2) of financial sector entities above certain thresholds. All items not deducted (i.e. amounts below the threshold) are subject to risk-weighting.

 

Additional Tier 1 (AT1) capital consists of AT1 capital instruments and related share premium accounts as well as noncontrolling interests qualifying for inclusion in consolidated AT1, and during the transitional period grandfathered instruments eligible under earlier frameworks. To qualify as AT1 under CRR/CRD 4 instruments must have principal loss absorption through a conversion to common shares or a write-down mechanism allocating losses at a trigger point and must also meet further requirements (perpetual with no incentive to redeem; institution must have full dividend/coupon discretion at all times, etc.).

   
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    126
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

   

Tier 2 (T2) capital comprises eligible capital instruments, the related share premium accounts and subordinated long-term debt, certain loan loss provisions and noncontrolling interests that qualify for inclusion in consolidated T2. To qualify as T2 capital instruments or subordinated debt must have an original maturity of at least five years. Moreover, eligible capital instruments may inter alia not contain an incentive to redeem, a right of investors to accelerate repayment, or a credit sensitive dividend feature.

 

Capital instruments that no longer qualify as AT1 or T2 capital under the CRR/CRD 4 fully loaded rules are subject to grandfathering rules during transitional period and are phased out from 2013 to 2022 with their recognition capped at 70 % in 2015 and the cap decreasing by 10 % every year.

Capital Instruments

 

   

The 2014 Annual General Meeting granted our Management Board the authority to buy back up to 101.9 million shares before the end of April 2019. Thereof 51.0 million shares can be purchased by using derivatives. These authorizations replaced the authorizations of the 2013 Annual General Meeting. We have received approval from the BaFin for the execution of these authorizations for 2014 as required under new CRR/CRD 4 rules. During the period from the 2014 Annual General Meeting until the 2015 Annual General Meeting (May 21, 2015), we purchased 25.6 million shares. The shares purchased were used for equity compensation purposes in the same period so that the number of shares held in Treasury from buybacks was 0.2 million as of the 2015 Annual General Meeting.

 

Our Management Board received approval from the 2015 Annual General Meeting to buy back up to 137.9 million shares before the end of April 2020. Thereof 69.0 million shares can be purchased by using derivatives. These authorizations substitute the authorizations of the previous year. We have received approval from the BaFin for share buybacks for 2015 according to new CRR/CRD 4 rules. During the period from the 2015 Annual General Meeting until December 31, 2015, 20.7 million shares have been purchased, of which 4.7 million shares through exercise of call options. The shares purchased were used for equity compensation purposes in the same period so that the number of shares held in Treasury from buybacks was 0.3 million as of December 31, 2015. For 2016, we have received approval from the ECB for share buybacks according to new CRR/CRV 4 rules up to a maximum amount of 28 million shares.

 

Until the 2015 Annual General meeting, the authorized capital available to the Management Board was  257 million (100 million shares). The conditional capital stood at 486 million (190 million shares). Moreover, the 2014 Annual General Meeting authorized the issuance of participatory notes for the purpose of Additional Tier 1 capital.

 

New authorized capital of 1,760 million (688 million shares) replacing old authorizations has been approved by the 2015 Annual General Meeting and the new authorizations have been legally registered. The conditional capital remains unchanged at 486 million (190 million shares).

 

Our legacy Hybrid Tier 1 capital instruments (substantially all noncumulative trust preferred securities) are no longer fully recognized under fully loaded CRR/CRD 4 rules, mainly because they have no write-down or equity conversion feature. However, they are to a large extent recognized as Additional Tier 1 capital under CRR/CRD 4 transitional provisions and can still be partially recognized as Tier 2 capital under the fully loaded CRR/CRD 4 rules. During the transitional phase-out period the maximum recognizable amount of Additional Tier 1 instruments from Basel 2.5 compliant issuances as of December 31, 2012 will be reduced at the beginning of each financial year by 10 % or 1.3 billion, through 2022. For December 31, 2015, this resulted in eligible Additional Tier 1 instruments of 11.1 billion (i.e. 4.6 billion newly issued AT1 Notes plus 6.5 billion of legacy Hybrid Tier 1 instruments recognizable during the transition period). Eight Hybrid Tier 1 capital instruments with a notional of 4.7 billion and an eligible equivalent amount of 4.4 billion have been called in 2015.  5.9 billion of the legacy Hybrid Tier 1 instruments can still be recognized as Tier 2 capital under the fully loaded CRR/CRD 4 rules.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
127   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Performance   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

 

On February 17, 2015, we issued new fixed rate subordinated Tier 2 notes with an aggregate amount of 1.25 billion. The notes pay a coupon of 2.75 %, have a denomination of 1,000 and are due February 17, 2025. They were issued in transactions outside of the United States not subject to the registration requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and were not offered or sold in the United States.

 

On April 1, 2015, we issued new fixed rate subordinated Tier 2 notes with an aggregate amount of U.S.$ 1.50 billion. The notes pay a coupon of 4.50 %, have a denomination of U.S.$ 200,000 and integral multiples of U.S.$ 1,000 in excess thereof and are due April 1, 2025. They were issued as transactions under the registration requirements of the US Securities Act of 1933.

 

Furthermore, we issued new callable fixed to fixed reset rate subordinated Tier 2 notes with an aggregate amount of CNY 1.41 billion on April 10, 2015. The notes have a denomination of CNY 1,000,000 and are due April 10, 2025. They were issued in transactions outside of the United States, not subject to the registration requirements of the US Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and were not offered or sold in the United States.

 

The total of our Tier 2 capital instruments as of December 31, 2015 recognized during the transition period under CRR/CRD 4 was 6.6 billion. As of December 31, 2015, there are no further legacy Hybrid Tier 1 instruments that are counted as Tier 2 capital under transitional rules. The gross notional value of the Tier 2 capital instruments was 8.0 billion. Four Tier 2 capital instruments with a notional of 0.7 billion and an eligible equivalent amount of 0.2 billion have been called in 2015.

   

Minimum capital requirements and additional capital buffers

 

The CET 1 minimum capital requirements applicable to the Group increased from 4 % of risk-weighted assets (RWA) in 2014 to 4.5 % of RWA from 2015 onwards. The total capital requirement of 8 % demands further resources that may be met with up to 1.5 % AT1 capital and up to 2 % Tier 2 capital from 2015 onwards.

 

 
Failure to meet minimum capital requirements can result in supervisory measures such as restrictions of profit distributions or limitations on certain businesses such as lending. We complied with the regulatory capital adequacy requirements in 2015. Our subsidiaries which were not included in our regulatory consolidation due to their immateriality did not have to comply with own minimum capital standards in 2015.    

 

In addition to these minimum capital requirements, the following capital buffer requirements will be phased-in starting 2016 (other than the systemic risk buffer, if any, which is not subject to any phase-in) and will become fully effective from 2019 onwards. The buffer requirements must be met in addition to the minimum capital requirements, but can be drawn down in times of economic stress.

 

In March 2015, Deutsche Bank was designated as a global systemically important institution (G-SII) by the German Federal Financial Supervisory Authority (BaFin) in agreement with the Deutsche Bundesbank resulting in a G-SII buffer requirement of 2 % CET 1 capital of RWA in 2019. This is in line with the Financial Stability Board (FSB) assessment of systemic importance based on the indicators as published in 2014. The additional buffer requirement of 2 % for G-SIIs will be phased in starting 2016 with 0.5 %. We will continue to publish our indicators on our website.

 

The capital conservation buffer is implemented in Section 10c German Banking Act, based on Article 129 CRD 4 and equals a requirement of 2.5 % CET 1 of RWA. The additional buffer requirement of 2.5 % will be phased in starting 2016 with 0.625 %.

 

The countercyclical capital buffer is deployed in a jurisdiction when excess credit growth is associated with an increase in system wide risk. It may vary between 0 % and 2.5 % CET 1 of RWA by 2019. In exceptional cases, it could also be higher than 2.5 %. The institution-specific countercyclical buffer that applies to Deutsche Bank is the weighted average of the countercyclical capital buffers that apply in the jurisdictions where our relevant credit exposures are located. No institution-specific countercyclical buffer applied to Deutsche Bank in 2015. The countercyclical capital buffer is expected to be insignificant in 2016.

 
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    128
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

In addition to the aforementioned buffers, national authorities, such as the BaFin, may require a systemic risk buffer to prevent and mitigate long-term non-cyclical systemic or macro-prudential risks that are not covered by the CRR. They can require an additional buffer of up to 5 % CET 1 of RWA. It is to be noted that unless certain exceptions apply only the higher of the systemic risk buffer and the G-SII buffer must be applied. As of year-end 2015, no systemic risk buffer applied to Deutsche Bank.

The following graph gives an overview of the different minimum capital requirements and capital buffer requirements:

 

 

LOGO

In addition, pursuant to the Supervisory Review and Evaluation Process (SREP), the ECB may impose capital requirements on individual banks which are more stringent than statutory requirements. On February 20, 2015, the ECB notified us that we are required to maintain a CET 1 ratio of at least 10.00 % (on a phase-in basis) going forward. On December 4, 2015, the ECB informed Deutsche Bank that the consolidated Group has to keep a CET 1 ratio of at least 10.25 % on a phase-in basis under applicable transitional rules under CRR/CRD 4 at all times. This requirement includes the capital conservation buffer, but does not include all other buffers (e.g. the G-SII buffer).

Consequently, in December 2015 our SREP CET 1 requirements amounted to 10.25 %. Considering the phasing of the G-SII buffer but not the countercyclical buffer, our 2016 SREP CET 1 requirements increase to 10.75 %.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
129   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Performance   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Development of regulatory capital

Our CRR/CRD 4 Tier 1 capital as of December 31, 2015 amounted to  58.2 billion, consisting of a Common Equity Tier 1 (CET 1) capital of  52.4 billion and Additional Tier 1 (AT1) capital of  5.8 billion. The CRR/CRD 4 Tier 1 capital was  5.7 billion lower than at the end of 2014, primarily driven by a decrease in CET 1 capital of  7.7 billion since year end 2014 while AT1 capital increased by  2.0 billion in the same period.

The  7.7 billion decrease of CRR/CRD 4 CET 1 capital was largely the result of the net loss attributable to Deutsche Bank shareholders and additional equity components of  6.8 billion in 2015. The 5.8 billion net loss attributable to the impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets in the third quarter of 2015 was to the extent neutral to which goodwill and other intangible assets were deducted from CET 1 and AT1 capital on a phase-in basis before the impairment. The Decision (EU) (2015/4) of the ECB enforces the recognition of the year end loss in CET 1 capital. Deutsche Bank’s revised common share dividend policy refers to the ECB decision as long as the Management Board does not decide and officially announce a different dividend level for the respective year. Following the announcement in 2015 to pay no dividend to common shareholders, no common share dividend has been accrued for 2015. The decrease in CET 1 capital was furthermore driven by the first-time consideration of additional value adjustments (based on the Regulatory Technical Standard on prudent valuation issued by the EBA) in September 30, 2015. Additional value adjustments amounted to 1.9 billion as per December 31, 2015. The effect on CRR/CRD 4 CET 1 capital was partly compensated by a benefit from the related reduction of the negative amounts resulting from the calculation of expected loss amounts. Deductions of deferred tax assets increased by  1.0 billion in 2015 mainly as a result of higher deferred tax assets largely due to the net loss as well as threshold effects under the 10/15 % rule. Overall, regulatory adjustments increased due the higher phase-in rate of 40 % in 2015 compared to 20 % in 2014. CRR/CRD 4 CET 1 capital was positively impacted by Currency Translation Adjustments of 2.0 billion and further positive foreign exchange effects in 2015.

The 2.0 billion increase in CRR/CRD 4 AT1 capital was mainly the result of reduced regulatory adjustments ( 5.5 billion lower than at year end 2014, also impacted by the impairments of goodwill and other intangible assets) that were phased out from AT1 capital. These deductions reflect the residual amount of certain CET 1 deductions that are subtracted from CET 1 capital under fully loaded rules, but are allowed to reduce AT1 capital during the transitional period. The phase-in rate for these deductions on the level of CET 1 capital increased to 40 % in 2015 (20 % in 2014) and decreased correspondingly on the level of AT1 capital to 60 % in 2015 (80 % in 2014). The reduction of regulatory adjustments on the level of AT1 capital over-compensated the decrease in our CRR/CRD 4 AT1 capital instruments of  3.5 billion (compared to December 31, 2014) that resulted mainly from our redemptions of legacy Hybrid Tier 1 capital instruments.

Our fully loaded CRR/CRD 4 Tier 1 capital as of December 31, 2015 was 48.7 billion, compared to  50.7 billion at the end of 2014. Our fully loaded CRR/CRD 4 CET 1 capital amounted to  44.1 billion as of December 31, 2015, compared to 46.1 billion as of December 31, 2014. Our fully loaded CRR/CRD 4 Additional Tier 1 capital amounted to 4.6 billion as per end of December 2015, nearly unchanged compared to year end 2014.

The decrease of our fully loaded CET 1 capital of  2.0 billion compared to year end 2014 was due to the fact that the negative impacts (net loss of  6.8 billion, first-time prudent valuation deduction of  1.9 billion) were partially reduced by positive counter-effects. These constitute predominantly lower deductions of goodwill and other intangible assets mainly due to impairments ( 4.5 billion lower deduction compared to year end 2014), a reduced deduction of negative amounts from the calculation of expected loss amounts ( 0.6 billion lower deduction compared to year end 2014 as a consequence of the prudent valuation assessment) and a positive impact from the change of the foreign currency exchange rates since year end 2014.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    130
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

   

Transitional template for regulatory capital, RWA and capital ratios

 

  

          Dec 31, 2015        Dec 31, 2014    
    

in m.

   CRR/CRD 4  
fully-loaded  
     CRR/CRD 4        CRR/CRD 4  
fully loaded  
     CRR/CRD 4    
   

Common Equity Tier 1 (CET 1) capital: instruments and reserves

           
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Capital instruments and the related share premium accounts

     37,088           37,088           37,144           37,144     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Retained earnings

     27,607           27,607           26,509           26,509     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax

     4,096           4,281           1,617           1,923     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Independently reviewed interim profits net of any foreseeable charge or dividend

     (7,025)          (7,025)          481           481     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Other

     0           92           0           118     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Common Equity Tier 1 (CET 1) capital before regulatory adjustments      61,766           62,042           65,750           66,175     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Common Equity Tier 1 (CET 1) capital: regulatory adjustments

           
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Additional value adjustments (negative amount)

     (1,877)          (1,877)          0           0     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Other prudential filters (other than additional value adjustments)

     (622)          (330)          (725)          (391)    
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Goodwill and other intangible assets (net of related tax liabilities) (negative amount)

     (8,439)          (3,376)          (12,979)          (2,596)    
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Deferred tax assets that rely on future profitability excluding those arising from temporary differences (net of related tax liabilities where the conditions in Art. 38 (3) CRR are met) (negative amount)

     (3,310)          (1,324)          (2,620)          (524)    
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Negative amounts resulting from the calculation of expected loss amounts

     (106)          (58)          (712)          (147)    
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Defined benefit pension fund assets (negative amount)

     (1,173)          (469)          (961)          (192)    
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Direct, indirect and synthetic holdings by an institution of own CET 1 instruments (negative amount)

     (76)          (39)          (54)          (11)    
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Direct, indirect and synthetic holdings by the institution of the CET 1 instruments of financial sector entities where the institution has a significant investment in those entities (amount above the 15 % threshold and net of eligible short positions) (negative amount)

     (818)          (278)          (499)          (84)    
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Deferred tax assets arising from temporary differences (net of related tax liabilities where the conditions in Art. 38 (3) CRR are met) (amount above the 15 % threshold) (negative amount)

     (953)          (324)          (778)          (133)    
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Other regulatory adjustments

     (291)          (1,537)          (345)          (1,994)    
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Total regulatory adjustments to Common Equity Tier 1 (CET 1) capital      (17,665)          (9,613)          (19,674)          (6,072)    
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Common Equity Tier 1 (CET 1) capital

     44,101           52,429           46,076           60,103     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Additional Tier 1 (AT1) capital: instruments

           
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Capital instruments and the related share premium accounts

     4,676           4,676           4,676           4,676     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Amount of qualifying items referred to in Art. 484 (4) CRR and the related share premium accounts subject to phase out from AT1

     N/M           6,482           N/M           10,021     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Additional Tier 1 (AT1) capital before regulatory adjustments

     4,676           11,157           4,676           14,696     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Additional Tier 1 (AT1) capital: regulatory adjustments

           
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Direct, indirect and synthetic holdings by an institution of own AT1 instruments (negative amount)

     (125)          (48)          (57)          (57)    
   

Residual amounts deducted from AT1 capital with regard to deduction from CET 1 capital during the transitional period pursuant to Art. 472 CRR

     N/M           (5,316)          N/M           (10,845)    
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Other regulatory adjustments

     0           0           0           0     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Total regulatory adjustments to Additional Tier 1 (AT1) capital

     (125)          (5,365)          (57)          (10,902)    
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Additional Tier 1 (AT1) capital

     4,551           5,793           4,619           3,794     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Tier 1 capital (T1 = CET 1 + AT1)

     48,651           58,222           50,695           63,898     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Tier 2 (T2) capital

     12,325           6,299           12,376           4,395     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Total capital (TC = T1 + T2)

     60,976           64,522           63,072           68,293     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Total risk-weighted assets

     396,714           397,382           393,969           396,648     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Capital ratios

           
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Common Equity Tier 1 capital ratio (as a percentage of risk-weighted assets)      11.1           13.2           11.7           15.2     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Tier 1 capital ratio (as a percentage of risk-weighted assets)      12.3           14.7           12.9           16.1     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Total capital ratio (as a percentage of risk-weighted assets)      15.4           16.2           16.0           17.2     
   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
                                         

 

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
131   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Performance   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

 

Reconciliation of shareholders’ equity to regulatory capital        
 
     Dec 31, 2015        Dec 31, 2014         

in m.

   CRR/CRD 4        CRR/CRD 4         
Total shareholders’ equity per accounting balance sheet      62,678           68,351         

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

     
Deconsolidation/Consolidation of entities      (681)          (1,419)        

Thereof:

         

Additional paid-in capital

     (5)          (5)        

Retained earnings

     (369)          (1,107)        

Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax

     (307)          (306)        

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

     
Total shareholders' equity per regulatory balance sheet      61,997           66,932         

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

     
Noncontrolling interest based on transitional rules      92           118         

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

     
Accrual for dividend and AT1 coupons      (231)          (1,182)        

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

     
Reversal of deconsolidation/consolidation of the position Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax, during transitional period      184           306         

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

     
Common Equity Tier 1 (CET 1) capital before regulatory adjustments      62,042           66,175         

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

     
Additional value adjustments      (1,877)          0         

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

     
Other prudential filters (other than additional value adjustments)      (330)          (391)        

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

     
Regulatory adjustments relating to unrealized gains and losses pursuant to Art. 467 and 468 CRR      (1,246)          (1,648)        

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

     
Goodwill and other intangible assets (net of related tax liabilities)      (3,376)          (2,596)        

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

     
Deferred tax assets that rely on future profitability      (1,648)          (657)        

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

     
Defined benefit pension fund assets      (469)          (192)        

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

     
Direct, indirect and synthetic holdings by the institution of the CET 1 instruments of financial sector entities where the institution has a significant investment in those entities      (278)          (84)        

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

     
Other regulatory adjustments      (389)          (503)        

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

     
Common Equity Tier 1 capital      52,429           60,103         

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

     
                       
Development of regulatory capital        
     CRR/CRD 4        

in m.

   Dec 31, 2015        Dec 31, 2014        
Common Equity Tier 1 (CET 1) capital—opening amount      60,103           38,534       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

Common shares, net effect

     0           921       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

Additional paid-in capital

     (53)          7,429       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

Retained earnings

     (6,097)          1,077       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

Common shares in treasury, net effect/(+) sales (–) purchase

     (3)          6       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

Movements in accumulated other comprehensive income

     2,759           2,947       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

Accrual for dividend and AT1 coupons

     (231)          (1,182)      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

Additional value adjustments

     (1,877)          0       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

Goodwill and other intangible assets (net of related tax liabilities)

     (780)          8,870       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

Deferred tax assets that rely on future profitability (excluding those arising from temporary differences)

     (800)          (524)      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

Negative amounts resulting from the calculation of expected loss amounts

     89           283       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

Defined benefit pension fund assets

     (277)          (192)      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

Direct, indirect and synthetic holdings by the institution of the CET 1 instruments of financial sector entities where the institution has a significant investment in those entities

     (194)          1,505       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

Securitization positions not included in risk-weighted assets

     0           945       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

Deferred tax assets arising from temporary differences (amount above 10 % and 15 % threshold, net of related tax liabilities where the conditions in Art. 38 (3) CRR are met)

     (191)          (133)      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

Other, including regulatory adjustments

     (19)          (383)      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   
Common Equity Tier 1 (CET 1) capital - closing amount      52,429           60,103       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   
Additional Tier 1 (AT1) Capital – opening amount      3,794           12,182       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

New Additional Tier 1 eligible capital issues

     0           0       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

Matured and called instruments

     (4,289)          (2,512)      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

Transitional arrangements

     5,529           (11,292)      

Thereof:

       

Goodwill and other intangible assets (net of related tax liabilities)

     5,320           (10,383)      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

Other, including regulatory adjustments

     759           5,416       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   
Additional Tier 1 (AT1) Capital – closing amount      5,793           3,794       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   
Tier 1 capital      58,222           63,898       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   
Tier 2 (T2) capital – closing amount      6,299           4,395       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   
Total regulatory capital      64,522           68,293       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    132
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Development of risk-weighted assets

The table below provides an overview of RWA broken down by model approach and business division. They include the aggregated effects of the segmental reallocation of infrastructure related positions, if applicable, as well as reallocations between the segments.

Within credit risk, the line item “Other” in advanced IRBA reflects RWA from securitization positions in the banking book, specific equity positions and other non-credit obligation assets. Within the Standardized Approach, the line item “Other” includes RWA from banking book securitizations as well as exposures assigned to the further exposure classes apart from central governments or central banks, institutions, corporates and retail.

Risk-weighted assets by model approach and business division according to transitional rules

 

     Dec 31, 2015    

in m.

   Corporate  
Banking &  
Securities  
     Private &  
Business  
Clients  
     Global  
Transaction  
Banking  
     Deutsche  
Asset & Wealth  
Management  
     Non-Core  
Operations  
Unit  
     Consolidation &  
Adjustments  
and Other  
     Total    

Credit Risk

     89,811           72,171           42,435         12,942           13,028           11,633           242,019     

Segment reallocation

     (3,515)          536           4,854           376           76           (2,328)          0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Advanced IRBA

     85,249           61,655           32,253           10,346           7,858           12,862           210,223     

Central Governments and Central Banks

     3,990           45           1,077           1           6           9,500           14,619     

Institutions

     8,497           1,303           3,472           140           382           355           14,149     

Corporates

     59,482           11,369           26,837           3,945           2,944           882           105,459     

Retail

     192           38,910           23           130           725           0           39,980     

Other

     13,088           10,028           844           6,131           3,801           2,125           36,016     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Foundation IRBA

     2,083           3,076           174           0           0           0           5,333     

Central Governments and Central Banks

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

Institutions

     0           5           0           0           0           0           5     

Corporates

     2,083           3,072           174           0           0           0           5,329     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Standardized Approach

     5,172           6,792           5,154           2,219           5,093           1,099           25,530     

Central Governments or Central Banks

     24           146           30           2           0           0           202     

Institutions

     539           86           33           11           2           0           671     

Corporates

     2,473           1,441           3,511           1,147           739           573           9,884     

Retail

     6           4,172           239           34           567           0           5,018     

Other

     2,129           948           1,342           1,027           3,785           525           9,755     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Risk exposure amount for default funds contributions

     821           111           0           0           0           0           933     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Settlement Risk

     9           0           0           0           0           0           9     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Credit Valuation

Adjustment (CVA)

     12,012           434           2           347           3,083           0           15,877     

Internal Model Approach

     11,957           396           2           343           3,082           0           15,780     

Standardized Approach

     55           38           0           4           1           0           97     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Market Risk

     33,795           32           173           1,268           14,286           0           49,553     

Internal Model Approach

     28,776           0           173           373           8,741           0           38,063     

Standardized Approach

     5,019           32           0           895           5,545           0           11,491     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Operational Risk 1

     59,503           7,644           9,456           9,252           4,069           0           89,923     

Advanced measurement approach

     59,503           7,644           9,456           9,252           4,069           0           89,923     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     195,130           80,280           52,066           23,808           34,465           11,633           397,382     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
1 

The movements for the business divisions are due to a change in the allocation methodology performed in the first quarter 2015.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
133   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Performance   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

 

     Dec 31, 2014    

in m.

   Corporate  
Banking &  
Securities  
     Private &  
Business  
Clients  
     Global  
Transaction  
Banking  
     Deutsche  
Asset & Wealth  
Management  
     Non-Core  
Operations  
Unit  
     Consolidation &  
Adjustments  
and Other  
     Total    

Credit Risk

     83,548           69,584           41,740           7,310           19,280           22,666           244,128     

Segment reallocation

     (2,200)          520           3,327           330           94           (2,071)          0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Advanced IRBA

     77,263           58,786           31,763           3,910           13,062           14,638           199,422     

Central Governments and Central Banks

     3,948           124           1,020           0           74           218           5,385     

Institutions

     8,359           1,538           3,103           73           623           171           13,869     

Corporates

     55,678           9,938           26,916           2,740           5,062           1,199           101,533     

Retail

     121           37,852           30           91           773           0           38,867     

Other

     9,157           9,334           694           1,006           6,529           13,049           39,769     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Foundation IRBA

     2,079           3,303           107           0           1           0           5,491     

Central Governments and Central Banks

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

Institutions

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

Corporates

     2,079           3,303           107           0           1           0           5,490     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Standardized Approach

     4,804           6,884           6,542           3,070           6,122           10,099           37,522     

Central Governments or Central Banks

     21           63           27           3           0           0           114     

Institutions

     593           124           51           4           3           35           810     

Corporates

     2,841           1,401           4,747           1,111           1,075           584           11,759     

Retail

     7           4,064           422           45           1,141           18           5,697     

Other

     1,341           1,232           1,296           1,908           3,903           9,462           19,142     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Risk exposure amount for default funds contributions

     1,601           90           1           0           1           0           1,693     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Settlement Risk

     25           0           0           0           0           1           27     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Credit Valuation

                    

Adjustment (CVA)

     16,024           445           7           445           4,019           262           21,203     

Internal Model Approach

     15,953           417           7           443           3,953           1           20,774     

Standardized Approach

     71           28           0           2           66           261           428     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Market Risk

     44,469           92           199           2,483           16,967           0           64,209     

Internal Model Approach

     31,439           0           199           1,339           8,625           0           41,602     

Standardized Approach

     13,029           92           0           1,144           8,342           0           22,607     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Operational Risk

     31,512           9,605           1,321           6,368           18,275           0           67,082     

Advanced measurement approach

     31,512           9,605           1,321           6,368           18,275           0           67,082     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     175,578           79,725           43,268           16,607           58,541           22,929           396,648     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The RWA according to CRR/CRD 4 were  397.4 billion as of December 31, 2015, compared with  396.6 billion at the end of 2014. The overall increase of 0.8 billion largely reflects an increase in operational risk RWA assets of  22.8 billion that is offset by reductions in the other risk categories. Operational Risk RWA are up primarily due to legal operational risk losses including legal provisions as well as an increased operational risk loss profile of the banking industry. Credit Risk RWA are  2.1 billion lower mainly as a result of a revised treatment of pension fund exposure calculation as well as de-risking activities partly offset by increases from foreign exchange movements. The lower RWA for market risk are largely attributable to lower risk levels coming from the market risk standardized approach for securitisation positions. The  5.3 billion reduction in RWA for CVA is mainly driven by de-risking and hedging activities.

RWA calculated on CRR/CRD 4 fully loaded basis were 396.7 billion as of December 31, 2015 compared with  394.0 billion at the end of 2014. The increase was driven by the same movements as outlined for transitional rules. The fully loaded RWA were 668 million lower than the risk-weighted assets under the transitional rules due to lower risk-weighted assets coming from our deferred tax assets that arise from temporary differences and from our significant holdings of CET 1 instruments of financial sector entities, which are both subject to the threshold exemptions as outlined in Article 48 CRR.

More specifically the following key drivers of RWA movements have been observed.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    134
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Credit Risk RWA decreased by 0.9 % or 2.1 billion, reflecting:

 

 

Book size, reflecting organic changes in our portfolio size and composition, decreased by  4.8 billion in 2015, compared to a decline of 5 billion in 2014. This decline was primarily driven by derivatives and security financing transaction positions mainly in our Core Bank reflecting de-risking activities.

 

Methodology and policy, reflecting RWA movements resulting from externally, regulatory-driven changes, decreased by 3.3 billion in 2015, compared to an increase of 24 billion in 2014, mainly as a result from the application of a revised treatment to defined benefit pension fund exposure, partly offset by a change in the applicable risk weight exposure to insurance companies.

 

Book quality, representing the effects from portfolio rating migrations, loss given default, model parameter recalibrations as well as collateral coverage activities, decreased by  2.1 billion in 2015, compared to  2.3 billion in 2014, driven by improvements in the underlying exposure risk profile partly offset by the impact from recalibrations of risk parameter and process enhancements.

 

The decrease in the category “Other”, which represents changes not included in the other categories described in this paragraph, of 2.7 billion in 2015, compared to an increase of 5.0 billion in 2014, was mainly driven by movements resulting from the transitional treatment of our defined benefit pension fund assets as well as from movements applying the 10/15 % threshold rule.

 

Credit Risk RWA were also impacted by foreign exchange movements  10.4 billion in 2015, compared to  11.8 billion in 2014, mainly resulting from a strengthening US Dollar.

Market Risk RWA decreased by 23 % or 14.7 billion, reflecting:

 

 

Movements in risk levels, reflecting movements in our internal models for value-at-risk, stressed value-at-risk, incremental risk charge and comprehensive risk measure as well as results from the market risk standardized approach, contributed to 27.7 billion in 2015, compared to a decline of 10.2 billion in 2014, and were predominantly due to lower risk levels in the Market Risk Standard Approach, Value-at-Risk, Stressed Value-at-Risk and Incremental Risk Charge components, mainly reflecting de-risking activities in the Non-Core Operations Unit (which particularly impacted the Market Risk Standardized Approach).

 

Offsetting effects in the category methodology and policy, representing changes in our internal models, such as methodology enhancements, of 5.7 billion in 2015, compared to 20.1 billion in 2014, resulted from the termination of the transitional period granted by Article 337 (4) CRR for the Market Risk Standardized Approach, as well as in market data changes and recalibrations by 3.9 billion. As a result, the calculation is now based on the sum of the weighted net long positions and the sum of the weighted net short positions rather than the larger of the two sums.

 

Market data changes, resulting from fluctuations in market data levels, volatilities, correlations, liquidity and ratings, resulted in a market risk RWA impact of 3.9 billion, compared to a decrease of  0.7 billion in 2014.

 

Market risk RWA were also impacted by foreign exchange movements of  1.9 billion compared to  2.7 billion in 2014, which were predominately reflected in the Market Risk Standardized Approach.

Operational Risk RWA increased by 34 % or 22.8 billion reflecting:

 

 

Loss profile changes (internal and external) contributed  24.2 billion in 2015, compared to  9.3 billion in 2014, mainly driven by the early recognition of enhancements to our Advanced Measurement Approach model (contributing additional RWA of 7.7 billion), further effects from a model change related to reasonable possible litigation losses and by large external market operational risk events, which are reflected in our AMA model, such as settlements of regulatory matters by financial institutions. From the third quarter 2014, further effects from the model change related to reasonably possible litigation losses are shown under the category “loss profile changes”.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
135   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Performance   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Credit Valuation Adjustment RWA decreased by 25 % or 5.3 billion reflecting:

 

 

Movement in risk levels, which includes changes to the portfolio size and composition, decreased by  5.2 billion primarily due to de-risking of the portfolio throughout the year and due to re-optimization of the CVA RWA hedging program and market volatility.

 

Credit valuation adjustment RWA were also impacted by foreign exchange movements of  1.9 billion, mainly resulting from a strengthening US Dollar.

Economic Capital

Internal Capital Adequacy

As the primary measure of our Internal Capital Adequacy Assessment Process (ICAAP) we assess our internal capital adequacy based on our “gone concern approach” as the ratio of our total capital supply divided by our total capital demand as shown in the table below. Our capital supply definition has been further aligned with the CRR/CRD 4 capital framework. Additional valuation adjustments, expected loss shortfall, home loans and savings protection and holdings of own capital instruments are now deducted from Pillar 2 capital supply. The prior year information has been revised accordingly.

Internal Capital Adequacy

 

in m.

(unless stated otherwise)

     Dec 31, 2015          Dec 31, 2014    

Capital supply

     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Shareholders' equity

     62,678           68,351     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Fair value gains on own debt and debt valuation adjustments, subject to own credit risk 1

     (407)          (544)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Defined benefit pension fund assets 2

     (1,173)          (961)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deferred tax assets

     (7,762)          (6,865)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Additional valuation adjustments

     (1,877)          0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Expected Loss Shortfall

     (106)          (712)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Home loans and savings protection

     (291)          (345)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Holdings of own capital instruments

     (62)          (54)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Fair Value adjustments for financial assets reclassified to loans 3

     (147)          0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Noncontrolling Interests 4

     0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Hybrid Tier 1 capital instruments

     11,962           16,158     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Tier 2 capital instruments

     8,016           6,620     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Capital supply

     70,832           81,648     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Capital demand

     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total economic capital requirement

     38,442           31,866     

Credit risk

     13,685           12,885     

Market risk

     17,436           14,852     

Operational risk

     10,243           7,598     

Business risk

     5,931           3,084     

Diversification benefit

     (8,852)          (6,554)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Intangible assets

     10,078           14,951     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Capital demand

     48,520           46,817     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Internal capital adequacy ratio

     146 %           174 %     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 
1 

Includes deduction of fair value gains on own credit-effect relating to own liabilities designated under the fair value option as well as the debt valuation adjustments.

2 

Reported as net assets (assets minus liabilities) of a defined pension fund, i.e. applicable for overfunded pension plans.

3 

Includes fair value adjustments for assets reclassified in accordance with IAS 39 and for banking book assets where no matched funding is available. A positive adjustment is not considered.

4 

Includes noncontrolling interest up to the economic capital requirement for each subsidiary.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    136
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

A ratio of more than 100 % signifies that the total capital supply is sufficient to cover the capital demand determined by the risk positions. This ratio was 146 % as of December 31, 2015, compared with 174 % as of December 31, 2014. The change of the ratio was driven by a decrease in capital supply and a higher economic capital usage. Shareholders’ equity decreased by 5.7 billion mainly driven by goodwill impairments. Hybrid Tier 1 capital instruments decreased by 4.2 billion mainly driven by called capital instruments. Tier 2 capital instruments increased by 1.4 billion mainly due to the issuance of new instruments. The increase in capital demand was driven by higher economic capital requirement as explained in the section “Risk Profile”, partly offset by a decrease in intangible assets due to goodwill impairments as explained in the section “Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets”.

The above capital adequacy measures apply to the consolidated Group as a whole (including Postbank) and form an integral part of our Risk and Capital Management framework.

Leverage Ratio

We manage our balance sheet on a Group level and, where applicable, locally in each region. In the allocation of financial resources we favour business portfolios with the highest positive impact on our profitability and shareholder value. We monitor and analyze balance sheet developments and track certain market-observed balance sheet ratios. Based on this we trigger discussion and management action by the Capital and Risk Committee. Following the publication of the CRR/CRD 4 framework, we established a leverage ratio calculation according to that framework.

Leverage Ratio according to revised CRR/CRD 4 framework (fully loaded)

The CRR/CRD 4 framework introduced a non-risk based leverage ratio that is intended to act as a supplementary measure to the risk based capital requirements. Its objectives are to constrain the build-up of leverage in the banking sector, helping avoid destabilizing deleveraging processes which can damage the broader financial system and the economy, and to reinforce the risk based requirements with a simple, non-risk based “backstop” measure.

We calculate our leverage ratio exposure on a fully loaded basis in accordance with Art. 429 of the CRR as per Delegated Regulation (EU) 2015/62 of 10 October 2014 published in the Official Journal of the European Union on January 17, 2015 amending Regulation (EU) No 575/2013.

Our total leverage ratio exposure consists of the components derivatives, securities financing transactions (SFTs), off-balance sheet exposure and other on-balance sheet exposure (excluding derivatives and SFTs).

The leverage exposure for derivatives is calculated by using the regulatory mark-to-market method for derivatives comprising the current replacement cost plus a regulatory defined add-on for the potential future exposure. Variation margin received in cash from counterparties is deducted from the current replacement cost portion of the leverage ratio exposure measure and variation margin paid to counterparties is deducted from the leverage ratio exposure measure related to receivables recognized as an asset on the balance sheet, provided certain conditions are met. The effective notional amount of written credit derivatives, i.e., the notional reduced by any negative fair value changes that have been incorporated in Tier 1 capital is included in the leverage ratio exposure measure; the resulting exposure measure is further reduced by the effective notional amount of a purchased credit derivative on the same reference name provided certain conditions are met.

The SFT component includes the gross receivables for SFTs, which are netted with SFT payables if specific conditions are met. In addition to the gross exposure a regulatory add-on for the counterparty credit risk is included.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
137   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Performance   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

The Off-balance sheet exposure component follows the credit risk conversion factors (CCF) of the standardized approach for credit risk (0 %, 20 %, 50 %, or 100 %), which depend on the risk category subject to a floor of 10 %.

The other on-balance sheet exposure component (excluding derivatives and SFTs) reflects the accounting values of the assets (excluding derivatives and SFTs) as well as regulatory adjustments for asset amounts deducted in determining Tier 1 capital.

The following tables show the leverage ratio exposure and the leverage ratio, both on a fully loaded basis:

Summary reconciliation of accounting assets and leverage ratio exposures

in bn.

   Dec 31, 2015        Dec 31, 2014    

Total assets as per published financial statements

     1,629           1,709     

 

 

Adjustment for entities which are consolidated for accounting purposes but are outside the scope of regulatory consolidation

     3           (28)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Adjustments for derivative financial instruments

     (263)          (276)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Adjustment for securities financing transactions (SFTs)

     25           16     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Adjustment for off-balance sheet items (i.e., conversion to credit equivalent amounts of off-balance sheet exposures)

     109           127     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other adjustments

     (107)          (103)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Leverage ratio total exposure measure

     1,395           1,445     

 

 

Leverage ratio common disclosure

 

in bn.

(unless stated otherwise)

   Dec 31, 2015        Dec 31, 2014    

Total derivative exposures

     215           318     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total securities financing transaction exposures

     164           152     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total off-balance sheet exposures

     109           127     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other Assets

     924           866     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Asset amounts deducted in determining Tier 1 capital fully loaded

     (17)          (19)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Tier 1 capital fully loaded

     48.7           50.7     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Exposures

     1,395           1,445     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Leverage Ratio – using a fully loaded definition of Tier 1 capital (in %)

     3.5           3.5     

 

 

Description of the factors that had an impact on the leverage ratio in 2015

As of December 31, 2015, our fully loaded CRR/CRD 4 leverage ratio was 3.5 % compared to 3.5 % as of De- cember 31, 2014, taking into account as of December 31, 2015 a fully loaded Tier 1 capital of  48.7 billion over an applicable exposure measure of  1,395 billion ( 50.7 billion and  1,445 billion as of December 31, 2014, respectively).

Over the year 2015 the active management of our leverage exposure resulted in a decrease of the leverage ratio exposure amounting to  129 billion, though this decrease was partly offset by foreign exchange impacts of  79 billion primarily related to the appreciation of the U.S. dollar to the euro. The decrease of  50 billion mainly reflects reductions in derivatives and securities financing transaction of  91 billion. Off-balance sheet exposures reduced  18 billion primarily from the application of revised EBA treatment to defined benefit pension fund assets. This was offset by increases on our balance sheet for cash, central bank and interbank balances by  26 billion, loans by  22 billion and financials assets available for sale by  9 billion.

Our leverage ratio calculated as the ratio of total assets under IFRS to total equity under IFRS was 24 as of December 31, 2015 compared to 23 as of December 31, 2014.

For main drivers of the Tier 1 capital development please refer to section Regulatory Capital in this report.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    138
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

 

 

Credit Risk Exposure

 

Counterparty credit exposure arises from our traditional nontrading lending activities which include elements such as loans and contingent liabilities, as well as from our direct trading activity with clients in certain instruments including OTC derivatives like foreign exchange forwards and Forward Rate Agreements. A default risk also arises from our positions in equity products and traded credit products such as bonds.

 

We define our credit exposure by taking into account all transactions where losses might occur due to the fact that counterparties may not fulfil their contractual payment obligations.

 

  

     

   

 

Maximum Exposure to Credit Risk

 

  

   

The maximum exposure to credit risk table shows the direct exposure before consideration of associated collateral held and other credit enhancements (netting and hedges) that do not qualify for offset in our financial statements for the periods specified. The netting credit enhancement component includes the effects of legally enforceable netting agreements as well as the offset of negative mark-to-markets from derivatives against pledged cash collateral. The collateral credit enhancement component mainly includes real estate, collateral in the form of cash as well as securities related collateral. In relation to collateral we apply internally determined haircuts and additionally cap all collateral values at the level of the respective collateralized exposure.

        

 
    Maximum Exposure to Credit Risk   
     Dec 31, 2015          Credit Enhancements    
    

in m.1

   Maximum  
exposure  
to credit risk2
    Netting       Collateral       Guarantees and  
Credit derivatives3
    Total credit  
enhancements  
 
   

Cash and central bank balances

     96,940          0          22          0          22     
   

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Interbank balances (w/o central banks)

     12,842          0          57          13          70     
   

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    Central bank funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements      22,456          0          22,037          0          22,037     
   

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Securities borrowed

     33,557          0          32,031          0          32,031     
   

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Financial assets at fair value through profit or loss 4

     734,449          409,317          152,858          699          562,874     
   

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Trading assets

     119,991          0          4,615          519          5,134     
   

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Positive market values from derivative financial instruments

     515,594          407,171          69,008          106          476,285     
   

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss

     98,864          2,146          79,235          74          81,455     
   

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

thereof:

          
   

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Securities purchased under resale agreement

     51,073          2,146          47,664          0          49,811     
   

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Securities borrowed

     21,489          0          21,154          0          21,154     
   

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Financial assets available for sale 4

     71,368          0          760          0          760     
   

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Loans 5

     432,777          0          207,923          30,188          238,111     
   

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Other assets subject to credit risk

     78,978          58,478          386          365          59,229     
   

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    Financial guarantees and other credit related contingent liabilities 6      57,325          0          5,730          8,166          13,897     
   

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    Irrevocable lending commitments and other credit related commitments 6      174,549          0          6,973          6,275          13,248     
   

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Maximum exposure to credit risk

     1,715,241         467,795         428,777         45,707         942,279     
   

 

 
   

1  All amounts at carrying value unless otherwise indicated.

     

   

2  Does not include credit derivative notional sold ( 655,584 million) and credit derivative notional bought protection. Cash and central bank balances mainly relate to Liquidity Reserves.

      

   

3  Bought credit protection is reflected with the notional of the underlying.

     

   

4  Excludes equities, other equity interests and commodities.

     

   

5  Gross loans less deferred expense/unearned income before deductions of allowance for loan losses.

     

   

6  Figures are reflected at notional amounts.

     

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
139   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Performance   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

 

Dec 31, 2014         Credit Enhancements         

in m.1

  Maximum  
exposure  
to credit risk2
    Netting       Collateral       Guarantees and  
Credit derivatives3
    Total credit  
enhancements  
      

Cash and central bank balances 4

    74,482          0          7          0          7         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Interbank balances (w/o central banks) 4

    9,090          0          53          21          74         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
Central bank funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements     17,796          0          16,988          0          16,988         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Securities borrowed

    25,834          0          24,700          0          24,700         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Financial assets at fair value through profit or loss 5

    862,035          522,373          163,576          1,102          687,051         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Trading assets

    125,130          0          3,537          533          4,070         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Positive market values from derivative financial instruments

    629,958          519,590          76,512          336          596,439         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss

    106,947          2,782          83,527          233          86,542         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

thereof:

             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Securities purchased under resale agreement

    60,473          2,415          58,058          0          60,473 6       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Securities borrowed

    20,404          368          19,955          0          20,323 6       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Financial assets available for sale 5

    62,038          0          938          -          938         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Loans 7

    410,825          0          205,376          28,496          233,872         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Other assets subject to credit risk

    85,061          67,009          768          363          68,140         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
Financial guarantees and other credit related contingent liabilities 8     62,087          0          6,741          8,723          15,464         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     
Irrevocable lending commitments and other credit related commitments 8     154,446          0          5,958          8,582          14,540         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Maximum exposure to credit risk

    1,763,695         589,381         425,106         47,287         1,061,774         

 

     

1  All amounts at carrying value unless otherwise indicated.

2  Does not include credit derivative notional sold ( 680,699 million) and credit derivative notional bought protection. Cash and central bank balances mainly relate to Liquidity Reserves.

3  Bought credit protection is reflected with the notional of the underlying.

4  In 2015, comparatives have been restated. See Note 1 “Significant Accounting Policies and Critical Accounting Estimates – Significant Changes in Estimates and Changes in Presentation” for detailed information.

5  Excludes equities, other equity interests and commodities.

6  Comparatives have been restated to include Netting.

7  Gross loans less deferred expense/unearned income before deductions of allowance for loan losses.

8  Figures are reflected at notional amounts.

     

      

     

      

     

     

     

     

   
The overall decrease in maximum exposure to credit risk for December 31, 2015 was predominantly driven by a  114.4 billion decrease in positive market values from derivative financial instruments during the period, partly offset by a 22.5 billion increase in cash and central bank balances, 22.0 billion increase in loans,  20.1 billion increase in irrevocable loan commitments and other credit related commitments as well as foreign exchange impacts across various products.         
 
Included in the category of trading assets as of December 31, 2015, were traded bonds of  103.2 billion ( 107.8 billion as of December 31, 2014) that are over 79 % investment-grade (over 80 % as of December 31, 2014). The above mentioned financial assets available for sale category primarily reflected debt securities of which more than 95 % were investment-grade (more than 94 % as of December 31, 2014).          
 
Credit Enhancements are split into three categories: netting, collateral, and guarantees and credit derivatives. A prudent approach is taken with respect to haircuts, parameter setting for regular margin calls as well as expert judgements for collateral valuation to prevent market developments from leading to a build-up of uncollateralized exposures. All categories are monitored and reviewed regularly. Overall credit enhancements received are diversified and of adequate quality being largely cash, highly rated government bonds and third-party guarantees mostly from well rated banks and insurance companies. These financial institutions are mainly domiciled in Western European countries and the United States. Furthermore we have collateral pools of highly liquid assets and mortgages (principally consisting of residential properties mainly in Germany) for the homogeneous retail portfolio.              
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    140
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

   Credit Quality of Financial Instruments neither Past Due nor Impaired   
 
     We derive our credit quality from internal ratings and group our exposures into classes as shown below. Please refer to section “Measuring Credit Risk” for more details about our internal ratings.    
 
     Credit Quality of Financial Instruments neither Past Due nor Impaired   
           Dec 31, 2015    
    

in m. 1

     iAAA–iAA           iA            iBBB           iBB            iB           
 
iCCC  
and below  
  
  
     Total     
     Cash and central bank balances      91,154           2,377           1,918           1,311           68           111           96,940     
    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     Interbank balances (w/o central banks)      4,606           5,450           877           957           18           935           12,842     
    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     Central bank funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements      3,607           15,590           1,870           1,234           37           118           22,456     
    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     Securities borrowed      24,306           5,380           1,461           2,361           49           0           33,557     
    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     Financial assets at fair value through profit or loss2      287,102           302,873           65,479           59,148           13,177           6,669           734,449     
    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    

Trading assets

     55,319           14,526           15,837           24,971           5,558           3,780           119,991     
    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    

Positive market values from derivative financial instruments

     184,183           271,328           36,100           17,265           4,894           1,824           515,594     
    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    

Financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss

     47,601           17,019           13,543           16,912           2,724           1,065           98,864     
    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    

thereof:

                    
    

Securities purchased under resale agreement

     15,371           10,120           10,053           13,699           968           863           51,073     
    

Securities borrowed

     17,629           3,819           8           33           0           0           21,489     
    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     Financial assets available for sale2      59,157           4,519           2,070           3,404           159           219           69,528     
    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     Loans 3      52,022           59,376           123,334           136,404           40,348           9,387           420,871     
    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    

thereof:

                    
    

IAS 39 reclassified loans

     1,672           461           878           627           76           397           4,110     
    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     Other assets subject to credit risk      30,724           26,465           6,924           13,615           941           308           78,978     
    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     Financial guarantees and other credit related contingent liabilities4      6,384           15,464           18,283           10,827           4,668           1,700           57,325     
    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     Irrevocable lending commitments and other credit related commitments4      23,035           46,220           44,603           37,643           21,212           1,834           174,549     
    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
     Total      582,099           483,714           266,820           266,904           80,678           21,282           1,701,495     
    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
    

1     All amounts at carrying value unless otherwise indicated.

2     Excludes equities, other equity interests and commodities.

3     Gross loans less deferred expense/unearned income before deductions of allowance for loan losses.

4     Figures are reflected at notional amounts.

        

        

        

        

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
141   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Performance   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

 

       Dec 31, 2014          

in m. 1

    iAAA–iAA           iA            iBBB            iBB            iB           
 
iCCC  
and below  
  
  
    Total          

Cash and central bank balances2

    70,744           1,202           1,694           686           51           105          74,482          

 

 

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

      

Interbank balances (w/o central banks)2

    3,651           4,208           547           618           25           40          9,090          

 

 

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

      
Central bank funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements     854           13,564           1,553           1,414           332           79          17,796          

 

 

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

      

Securities borrowed

    18,705           5,200           1,114           727           88           0          25,834          

 

 

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

      
Financial assets at fair value through profit or loss3     312,470           385,335           81,930           58,678           16,094           7,529          862,036          

 

 

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

      

Trading assets

    58,014           15,973           18,230           21,767           7,061           4,085          125,130          

 

 

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

      

Positive market values from derivative financial instruments

    208,057           348,179           46,675           20,062           5,120           1,865          629,958          

 

 

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

      

Financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss

    46,399           21,183           17,025           16,848           3,914           1,578          106,947          

 

 

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

      

thereof:

                       

Securities purchased under resale agreement

    17,213           13,820           12,432           14,219           1,529           1,259          60,473          

Securities borrowed

    17,110           3,266           20           7           0           0          20,404          

 

 

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

      

Financial assets available for sale3,4

    50,810           3,375           1,782           3,958           194           1,719          61,838          

 

 

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

      

Loans 5

    47,554           56,865           112,106           130,438           39,181           10,313          396,458          

 

 

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

      

thereof:

IAS 39 reclassified loans

    2,109           1,353           1,408           1,051           685           274          6,880          

 

 

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

      

Other assets subject to credit risk

    13,538           48,714           7,049           13,927           1,105           728          85,061          

 

 

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

      
Financial guarantees and other credit related contingent liabilities6     6,281           17,696           20,190           11,640           4,929           1,352          62,087          

 

 

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

      
Irrevocable lending commitments and other credit related commitments6     22,938           39,336           40,145           31,492           18,924           1,612          154,446          

 

 

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

      

Total

    547,546           575,494           268,110           253,577           80,924           23,477         1,749,129          

 

      

1  All amounts at carrying value unless otherwise indicated.

2  In 2015, comparatives have been restated. See Note 1 “Significant Accounting Policies and Critical Accounting Estimates – Significant Changes in Estimates and Changes in Presentation” for detailed information.

3  Excludes equities, other equity interests and commodities.

4  Includes past due instruments in order to be consistent with the Asset Quality section of this report.

5  Gross loans less deferred expense/unearned income before deductions of allowance for loan losses.

6  Figures are reflected at notional amounts.

     

      

     

     

     

     

    

The overall decline in total credit exposure of 47.6 billion for December 31, 2015 is mainly due to an decrease in positive market value from derivative financial instruments in investment-grade rating categories and here mainly in the category iA, partly offset by foreign exchange impacts across various products.

Main Credit Exposure Categories

The tables in this section show details about several of our main credit exposure categories, namely loans, irrevocable lending commitments, contingent liabilities, over-the-counter (“OTC”) derivatives, traded loans, traded bonds, debt securities available for sale and repo and repo-style transactions:

 

 

“Loans” are net loans as reported on our balance sheet at amortized cost but before deduction of our allowance for loan losses.

 

“Irrevocable lending commitments” consist of the undrawn portion of irrevocable lending-related commitments.

 

“Contingent liabilities” consist of financial and performance guarantees, standby letters of credit and other similar arrangements (mainly indemnity agreements).

 

“OTC derivatives” are our credit exposures from over-the-counter derivative transactions that we have entered into, after netting and cash collateral received. On our balance sheet, these are included in financial assets at fair value through profit or loss or, for derivatives qualifying for hedge accounting, in other assets, in either case, before netting and cash collateral received.

 

“Traded loans” are loans that are bought and held for the purpose of selling them in the near term, or the material risks of which have all been hedged or sold. From a regulatory perspective this category principally covers trading book positions.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    142
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

 

“Traded bonds” include bonds, deposits, notes or commercial paper that are bought and held for the purpose of selling them in the near term. From a regulatory perspective this category principally covers trading book positions.

 

“Debt securities available for sale” include debentures, bonds, deposits, notes or commercial paper, which are issued for a fixed term and redeemable by the issuer, which we have classified as available for sale.

 

“Repo and repo-style transactions” consist of reverse repurchase transactions, as well as securities or commodities borrowing transactions before application of netting and collateral received.

Although considered in the monitoring of maximum credit exposures, the following are not included in the details of our main credit exposure: brokerage and securities related receivables, cash and central bank balances, interbank balances (w/o central banks), assets held for sale, accrued interest receivables, traditional securitization positions as well as equity investments.

Main Credit Exposure Categories by Business Divisions

 

    Dec 31, 2015  

in m.

  Loans1     Irrevocable  
lending  
commitments2
    Contingent
liabilities
    OTC  
derivatives3
    Traded
Loans
    Traded
Bonds
    Debt securities
available for
sale
    Repo and  
repo-style  
transactions4
    Total  
Corporate Banking & Securities     79,610          134,514          4,629          44,862          14,815          89,136        45,494        111,276          524,337   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Private & Business Clients     218,451          11,174          1,662          501          0          1        17,146        7,132          256,067   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Global Transaction Banking     76,125          20,410          47,699          692          266          28        168        10,149          155,537   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Deutsche Asset & Wealth Management     45,135          6,071          2,477          372          10          7,112        3,441        5          64,623   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Non-Core Operations Unit     13,321          1,642          784          2,625          368          6,934        1,932        14          27,620   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Consolidation & Adjustments     135          738          74          0          0          0        85        0          1,031   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    432,777          174,549          57,325          49,053          15,459          103,212        68,266        128,575          1,029,215   

 

 
1 

Includes impaired loans amounting to  8.2 billion as of December 31, 2015.

2 

Includes irrevocable lending commitments related to consumer credit exposure of  9.2 billion as of December 31, 2015.

3 

Includes the effect of netting agreements and cash collateral received where applicable. Excludes derivatives qualifying for hedge accounting.

4 

Before reflection of collateral and limited to securities purchased under resale agreements and securities borrowed.

 

    Dec 31, 2014  

in m.

  Loans1     Irrevocable  
lending  
commitments2
    Contingent
liabilities
    OTC  
derivatives3
    Traded
Loans
    Traded
Bonds
    Debt securities
available for
sale
    Repo and  
repo-style  
transactions4
    Total  
Corporate Banking & Securities     61,820          119,995          4,865        43,407          14,865        92,272        34,411        112,605          484,239   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Private & Business Clients     214,688          11,687          1,735        464          0        2        16,665        8,714          253,955   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Global Transaction Banking     77,334          17,121          51,663        595          614        87        184        3,159          150,758   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Deutsche Asset & Wealth Management     38,676          4,158          2,681        839          12        7,940        3,403        11          57,719   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Non-Core Operations Unit     18,049          954          1,072        1,760          1,163        7,509        4,358        17          34,883   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Consolidation & Adjustments     258          530          71        13          0        (0     111        0          983   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total     410,825          154,446          62,087        47,078          16,654        107,808        59,132        124,507          982,537   

 

 
1 

Includes impaired loans amounting to  9.3 billion as of December 31, 2014.

2 

Includes irrevocable lending commitments related to consumer credit exposure of  9.4 billion as of December 31, 2014.

3 

Includes the effect of netting agreements and cash collateral received where applicable. Excludes derivatives qualifying for hedge accounting.

4 

Before reflection of collateral and limited to securities purchased under resale agreements and securities borrowed.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
143   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Performance   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Our main credit exposure increased by  46.7 billion.

 

 

From a divisional perspective, CB&S increased by  40.1 billion, Deutsche AWM by  6.9 billion and GTB by  4.8 billion. NCOU achieved a managed reduction of  7.3 billion

 

From a product perspective, strong exposure increases have been observed for loans, irrevocable lending commitments and debt securities available for sale. Exposure reductions were observed for contingent liabilities and traded bonds.

Main Credit Exposure Categories by Industry Sectors

 

    Dec 31, 2015     

in m.

  Loans1     Irrevocable  
lending  
commitments2
    Contingent  
liabilities  
    OTC  
derivatives3
    Traded  
Loans  
    Traded  
Bonds  
    Debt  
securities  
available  
for sale  
    Repo and  
repo-style  
transactions4
    Total    
Financial intermediation     56,665          33,194          11,717          26,539          3,815          24,761          23,772          124,340          304,804     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Fund management activities     24,839          8,935          381          1,601          118          2,303          461          237          38,875     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Manufacturing     26,800          40,930          17,192          2,885          1,500          2,341          314          0          91,963     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Wholesale and retail trade     16,719          12,544          5,424          1,038          499          564          95          1          36,884     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Households     200,817          11,638          2,013          719          128          0          0          34          215,350     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Commercial real estate activities5     42,792          5,835          681          1,812          3,429          738          205          40          55,533     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Public sector     17,050          2,450          280          6,170          491          55,774          39,085          2,242          123,543     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other     47,0946        59,023          19,636          8,289          5,478          16,731          4,333          1,680          162,263     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total     432,777          174,549          57,325          49,053          15,459          103,212          68,266          128,575          1,029,215     

 

 

 

1 

Includes impaired loans amounting to  8.2 billion as of December 31, 2015.

2 

Includes irrevocable lending commitments related to consumer credit exposure of  9.2 billion as of December 31, 2015.

3 

Includes the effect of netting agreements and cash collateral received where applicable. Excludes derivatives qualifying for hedge accounting.

4 

Before reflection of collateral and limited to securities purchased under resale agreements and securities borrowed.

5 

Commercial real estate activities are based on counterparty industry classification, irrespective of business division attribution.

6 

Loan exposures for Other include lease financing.

 

    Dec 31, 2014     

in m.

  Loans 1     Irrevocable  
lending  
commitments2
    Contingent  
liabilities  
    OTC  
derivatives3
    Traded  
Loans  
    Traded  
Bonds  
    Debt  
securities  
available  
for sale  
    Repo and  
repo-style  
transactions4
    Total    
Financial intermediation5     59,580          30,481          13,698          21,309          4,421          26,784          21,668          122,155          300,097     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Fund management activities5     12,145          6,696          507          3,065          149          2,966          349          49          25,925     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Manufacturing5     25,633          40,607          18,137          2,292          1,604          2,312          204          —          90,788     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Wholesale and retail trade5     15,781          11,937          6,080          1,156          865          839          94          —          36,752     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Households5     197,853          11,082          1,864          739          183          2          0          35          211,758     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Commercial real estate activities5,6     35,743          3,875          705          2,054          3,129          606          74          576          46,762     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Public sector 5     18,051          1,753          216          7,346          651          56,217          32,105          716          117,056     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other 5     46,0377          48,015          20,880          9,116          5,654          18,083          4,638          975          153,399     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total     410,825          154,446          62,087          47,078          16,654          107,808          59,132          124,507          982,537     

 

 

 

1 

Includes impaired loans amounting to  9.3 billion as of December 31, 2014.

2 

Includes irrevocable lending commitments related to consumer credit exposure of  9.4 billion as of December 31, 2014.

3 

Includes the effect of netting agreements and cash collateral received where applicable. Excludes derivatives qualifying for hedge accounting.

4 

Before reflection of collateral and limited to securities purchased under resale agreements and securities borrowed.

5 

Comparatives have been restated to reflect changes in industry sectors.

6 

Commercial real estate activities are based on counterparty industry classification, irrespective of business unit attribution.

7 

Loan exposures for Other include lease financing.

The above table gives an overview of our credit exposure by industry; allocated based on the NACE code of the counterparty we are doing business with.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    144
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

From an industry perspective, our credit exposure is higher compared with last year mainly due to an increase in Fund management activities of 13.0 billion and Commercial real estate activities of 8.8 billion, driven by higher loan exposure, as well as increases in the category Other by 8.9 billion mainly attributable to Irrevocable lending commitments.

Loan exposures to the industry sectors financial intermediation, manufacturing and public sector comprise predominantly investment-grade loans. The portfolio is subject to the same credit underwriting requirements stipulated in our “Principles for Managing Credit Risk”, including various controls according to single name, country, industry and product-specific concentration.

Material transactions, such as loans underwritten with the intention to syndicate, are subject to review by senior credit risk management professionals and (depending upon size) an underwriting credit committee and/or the Management Board. High emphasis is placed on structuring such transactions so that de-risking is achieved in a timely and cost effective manner. Exposures within these categories are mostly to good quality borrowers and also subject to further risk mitigation as outlined in the description of our Credit Portfolio Strategies Group’s activities.

Our household loans exposure amounting to  200.8 billion as of December 31, 2015 ( 197.9 billion as of December 2014) is principally associated with our PBC portfolio.  155.5 billion (78 %) of the portfolio comprises mortgages, of which  120.0 billion are held in Germany. The remaining exposures ( 45.3 billion, 22 %) are predominantly consumer finance business related. Given the largely homogeneous nature of this portfolio, counterparty credit worthiness and ratings are predominately derived by utilizing an automated decision engine.

Mortgage business is principally the financing of owner occupied properties sold by various business channels in Europe, primarily in Germany but also in Spain, Italy and Poland, with exposure normally not exceeding real estate value. Consumer finance is divided into personal instalment loans, credit lines and credit cards. Various lending requirements are stipulated, including (but not limited to) maximum loan amounts and maximum tenors and are adapted to regional conditions and/or circumstances of the borrower (i.e., for consumer loans a maximum loan amount taking into account household net income). Interest rates are mostly fixed over a certain period of time, especially in Germany. Second lien loans are not actively pursued.

The level of credit risk of the mortgage loan portfolio is determined by assessing the quality of the client and the underlying collateral. The loan amounts are generally larger than consumer finance loans and they are extended for longer time horizons. Consumer finance loan risk depends on client quality. Given that they are uncollateralized, compared with mortgages they are also smaller in value and are extended for shorter time. Based on our underwriting criteria and processes, diversified portfolio (customers/properties) and low loan-to-value (LTV) ratios, the mortgage portfolio is categorized as lower risk and consumer finance medium risk.

Our commercial real estate loans are generally secured by first mortgages on the underlying real estate property, and follow the credit underwriting requirements stipulated in the “Principles for Managing Credit Risk” noted above (i.e., rating followed by credit approval based on assigned credit authority) and are subject to additional underwriting and policy guidelines such as LTV ratios of generally less than 75 %. Additionally, given the significance of the underlying collateral independent external appraisals are commissioned for all secured loans by our valuation team (part of the independent Credit Risk Management function). Our valuation team is responsible for reviewing and challenging the reported real estate values regularly.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
145   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Performance   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Excluding the exposures transferred into the NCOU, the Commercial Real Estate Group only in exceptional cases retains mezzanine or other junior tranches of debt (although we do underwrite mezzanine loans), though the Postbank portfolio holds an insignificant sub-portfolio of junior tranches. Loans originated for securitization are carefully monitored under a pipeline limit. Securitized loan positions are entirely sold (except where regulation requires retention of economic risk), while we frequently retain a portion of syndicated bank loans. This hold portfolio, which is held at amortized cost, is also subject to the aforementioned principles and policy guidelines. We also participate in conservatively underwritten unsecured lines of credit to well-capitalized real estate investment trusts and other public companies (generally investment-grade). We provide both fixed rate (generally securitized product) and floating rate loans, with interest rate exposure subject to hedging arrangements. In addition, sub-performing and non-performing loans and pools of loans are acquired from other financial institutions at generally substantial discounts to both the notional amounts and current collateral values. The underwriting process for these is stringent and the exposure is managed under separate portfolio limits. Commercial real estate property valuations and rental incomes can be significantly impacted by macro-economic conditions and underlying properties to idiosyncratic events. Accordingly, the portfolio is categorized as higher risk and hence subject to the aforementioned tight restrictions on concentration.

The category other loans, with exposure of  47.1 billion as of December 31, 2015 ( 46.0 billion as of December 31, 2014), relates to numerous smaller industry sectors with no individual sector greater than 5 % of total loans.

Our credit exposure to our ten largest counterparties accounted for 7 % of our aggregated total credit exposure in these categories as of December 31, 2015 compared with 7 % as of December 31, 2014. Our top ten counterparty exposures were with well-rated counterparties or otherwise related to structured trades which show high levels of risk mitigation.

Our credit exposure to each of the focus industries “Oil and Gas”, “Metals, Mining & Steel” and “Shipping” is less than 2 % of our total credit exposure.

Our credit exposure to the “Oil & Gas” industry is approximately  16 billion, of which gross loans account for  5 billion, and irrevocable lending commitments account for  8 billion. Around 60 % of our credit exposure is to investment-grade rated borrowers, mainly in the more resilient segments Oil Majors and National Oil & Gas companies. Less than 20 % of our “Oil & Gas” credit portfolio is to sectors that we consider higher risk and more impacted by the low oil price, namely sub-investment-grade Exploration & Production (predominantly senior secured) and Oil & Gas Services & Equipment segments.

Our credit exposure in our “Metals, Mining and Steel” portfolio is approximately  10 billion, of which gross loans account for  5 billion, and irrevocable lending commitments account of  3 billion. This portfolio is of lower quality compared to our overall Corporate credit portfolio, and has an investment-grade ratio of just 35 %. In line with the structure of the industry, a significant share of our portfolio is in Emerging Markets countries. Our strategy is to reduce this credit portfolio due to elevated risks of this industry, namely material oversupply with resulting pressure on prices and margins.

Out credit exposure to Shipping accounts for approximately  7 billion, of which gross loans account for  6 billion, and is largely collateralised. The portfolio is diversified across ship types with global associated risks due to diversified trading income albeit the counterparties mainly domiciled in Europe. A high proportion of the portfolio is sub investment-grade rated in reflection of the pro-longed challenging market conditions over recent years. Exposure to the German “KG” sector (non-recourse financing of vessels via closed end funds) is less than 10 % of the total Shipping exposure.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    146
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

   

Main credit exposure categories by geographical region

  

   
         Dec 31, 2015     
    

in m.

  Loans1       Irrevocable  
lending  
commitments2
    Contingent  
liabilities   
    OTC  
derivatives3
    Traded  
Loans  
    Traded
Bonds  
    Debt  
securities  
available  
for sale  
    Repo and  
repo-style  
transactions4
    Total    
   

Germany

    203,387          23,621          11,663          3,044          530          5,065          20,080          6,568          273,957     
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    Western Europe                  
    (excluding Germany)     100,414          42,700          17,525          21,156          3,237          21,463          37,684          30,240          274,420     
   

thereof:

                 
   

France

    2,335          5,904          1,535          1,015          279          3,445          6,875          3,514          24,901     
   

Luxembourg

    19,890          3,140          648          1,629          481          1,746          9,937          318          37,790     
   

Netherlands

    10,405          5,851          2,348          3,498          297          2,508          6,243          456          31,606     
   

United Kingdom

    8,828          9,880          1,608          6,161          508          4,614          4,762          16,352          52,713     
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Eastern Europe

    10,319          1,946          1,650          450          1,409          2,738          244          55          18,811     
   

thereof:

                 
   

Poland

    7,434          705          281          50          0          1,640          85          0          10,195     
   

Russia

    1,295          533          583          42          953          113          0          1          3,520     
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

North America

    72,008          96,310          14,154          14,468          6,784          50,842          7,890          74,061          336,517     
   

thereof:

                 
   

Canada

    1,481          2,391          590          1,764          54          1,016          659          1,676          9,631     
   

Cayman Islands

    2,882          1,931          91          919          149          1,724          62          12,459          20,216     
   

U.S.

    60,991          90,773          12,966          11,367          6,146          47,786          7,158          58,496          295,683     
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Central and South America

    6,506          1,111          1,218          1,706          731          2,345          25          1,240          14,883     
   

thereof:

                 
   

Brazil

    2,267          344          587          458          53          1,191          4          526          5,430     
   

Mexico

    731          102          91          331          107          363          19          378          2,121     
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Asia/Pacific

    37,202          7,685          10,321          7,901          2,201          20,372          2,075          14,794          102,551     
   

thereof:

                 
   

China

    5,646          1,005          954          571          32          976          0          964          10,149     
   

Japan

    848          336          357          1,348          41          3,930          22          5,556          12,438     
   

South Korea

    2,158          16          919          1,000          0          1,359          8          0          5,460     
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Africa

    2,123          501          537          300          227          324          100          351          4,464     
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Other

    817          674          258          29          340          62          166          1,266          3,612     
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Total

    432,777          174,549          57,325          49,053          15,459          103,212          68,266          128,575          1,029,215     
   

 

 
   

 

1  Includes impaired loans amounting to  8.2 billion as of December 31, 2015.

2  Includes irrevocable lending commitments related to consumer credit exposure of 9.2 billion as of December 31, 2015.

3  Includes the effect of netting agreements and cash collateral received where applicable. Excludes derivatives qualifying for hedge accounting.

4  Before reflection of collateral and limited to securities purchased under resale agreements and securities borrowed.

     

     

     

     

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
147   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Performance   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

    Dec 31, 2014         

in m.

  Loans1     Irrevocable  
lending  
commitments2
    Contingent  
liabilities   
    OTC  
derivatives3
    Traded  
Loans  
    Traded  
Bonds  
    Debt  
securities  
available  
for sale  
    Repo and  
repo-style  
transactions4
    Total         

Germany

    202,658          26,176          14,356          3,250          1,206          6,679          16,339          13,533          284,198         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Western Europe

                     

(excluding Germany)

    94,386          36,781          18,984          18,190          3,295          21,516          33,683          23,935          250,771         

thereof:

                     

France

    2,674          6,053          2,434          936          423          3,684          5,346          3,656          25,207         

Luxembourg

    14,156          3,835          754          1,766          552          2,028          6,240          190          29,522         

Netherlands

    10,630          5,548          2,548          5,257          436          2,726          7,751          348          35,244         

United Kingdom

    7,878          9,118          1,911          1,058          586          4,530          5,141          13,607          43,828         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Eastern Europe

    10,524          1,755          2,136          927          1,542          2,494          561          243          20,183         

thereof:

                     

Poland

    7,055          651          315          74          —          1,353          64          —          9,511         

Russia

    2,068          524          693          205          1,081          238          —          39          4,848         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

North America

    55,540          83,400          14,291          14,338          7,531          52,898          5,736          71,306          305,040         

thereof:

                     

Canada

    880          2,237          932          1,087          240          1,309          278          1,325          8,287         

Cayman Islands

    2,571          1,982          61          542          322          2,256          124          12,660          20,519         

U.S.

    45,899          77,960          12,881          12,614          6,725          48,669          5,323          56,630          266,702         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Central and South America

    5,071          777          1,445          1,350          604          2,936          24          1,151          13,358         

thereof:

                     

Brazil

    1,787          210          781          241          175          1,558          —          656          5,409         

Mexico

    363          90          51          447          199          450          19          301          1,919         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Asia/Pacific

    40,081          4,774          10,062          8,643          2,226          20,677          2,467          13,818          102,747         

thereof:

                     

China

    9,372          331          950          523          180          1,698          —          1,320          14,373         

Japan

    866          489          397          3,398        173          2,371          90          4,250          12,032         

South Korea

    2,069          11          1,095          591          0          842          —          342          4,949         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Africa

    1,924          627          805          351          124          541          49          520          4,941         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Other

    640          156          7          29          126          67          273          —          1,297         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Total

    410,825          154,446          62,087          47,078          16,654          107,808          59,132          124,507          982,537         

 

     

1  Includes impaired loans amounting to  9.3 billion as of December 31, 2014.

2  Includes irrevocable lending commitments related to consumer credit exposure of  9.4 billion as of December 31, 2014.

3  Includes the effect of netting agreements and cash collateral received where applicable. Excludes derivatives qualifying for hedge accounting.

4  Before reflection of collateral and limited to securities purchased under resale agreements and securities borrowed.

     

     

     

     

   

 

The above table gives an overview of our credit exposure by geographical region, allocated based on the counterparty’s country of domicile, see also section “Credit Exposure to Certain Eurozone Countries” of this report for a detailed discussion of the “country of domicile view”.

 

    

 

Our largest concentration of credit risk within loans from a regional perspective is in our home market Germany, with a significant share in households, which includes the majority of our mortgage lending business.

 

Within the OTC derivatives business, tradable assets as well as repo and repo-style transactions, our largest concentrations from a regional perspective were in Western Europe (excluding Germany) and North America. From the industry perspective, exposures from OTC derivative as well as repo and repo-style transactions have a significant share in highly rated financial intermediation companies. For tradable assets, a large proportion of exposure is also with public sector companies.

   

     

   

 

As of December 31, 2015 our loan book increased to  432.8 billion (versus  410.8 billion as of December 31, 2014) mainly in North America and Western Europe (excluding Germany) with fund management and commercial real estate companies experienced largest increases. The increase in loans for Luxembourg is due to ETF related collateral restructuring within CB&S which involved replacing our physical securities exposure by entering into fully funded total returns swaps. The increase in irrevocable lending commitments ( 20.1 billion) was primarily in the industry sector other mainly in North America and Western Europe (excluding Germany). Credit exposure to Russia has decreased by  1.3 billion to  3.5 billion as a result of successful de-risking. Credit exposure to Ukraine is relatively small at  404 million.

        

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    148
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Our portfolio in China of  10.1 billion is concentrated on trade finance and flow Markets business with large, systemically important local Financial Institutions, financially strong state-owned, privately owned corporates and subsidiaries of Multinational Companies. The tenor structure of our portfolio is mostly short-term.

Brazil is our by far largest credit portfolio in Latin America with  5.4 billion of exposure. The main focus of the portfolio is on largest, investment-grade rated, financial institutions and corporates. The corporate portfolio is diversified across different industries. The tenor structure of our portfolio is also mostly short-term.

Credit Exposure to Certain Eurozone Countries

Certain eurozone countries are presented within the tables below due to concerns relating to sovereign risk. This heightened risk is driven by a number of factors impacting the associated sovereign including high public debt levels and/or large deficits, limited access to capital markets, proximity of debt repayment dates, poor economic fundamentals and outlook (including low gross domestic product growth, weak competitiveness, high unemployment and political uncertainty). Fundamentals have improved to some extent, with the growth outlook for most of these economies stabilising, competitiveness improving and external imbalances (i.e., current account deficits) narrowing. This adjustment process has been supported by the ECB’s Outright Monetary Transactions (OMT) program and the European Stability Mechanism (ESM) which have provided a credible (if untested) backstop and helped to contain funding costs. The Quantitative Easing (QE) program has also helped to lower funding costs across the eurozone. The effectiveness of these measures helped limit the contagion to other eurozone bond markets despite the rising uncertainty around the future of Greece’s program in the first half of the year following Syriza’s election victory in January 2015.

For the presentation of our exposure to these certain eurozone countries we apply two general concepts as follows:

 

 

In our “risk management view”, we consider the domicile of the group parent, thereby reflecting the one obligor principle. All facilities to a group of borrowers which are linked to each other (i.e., by one entity holding a majority of the voting rights or capital of another) are consolidated under one obligor. This group of borrowers is usually allocated to the country of domicile of the respective parent company. As an example, a loan to a counterparty in Spain is Spanish risk as per a domicile view but considered a German risk from a risk management perspective if the respective counterparty is linked to a parent company domiciled in Germany following the above-mentioned one obligor principle. In this risk management view we also consider derivative netting and present exposures net of hedges and collateral. The collateral valuations follow the same stringent approach and principles as outlined separately. Also, in our risk management we classify exposure to special purpose entities based on the domicile of the underlying assets as opposed to the domicile of the special purpose entities. Additional considerations apply for structured products. If, for example, a structured note is issued by a special purpose entity domiciled in Ireland, it will be considered an Irish risk in a “country of domicile” view, but if the underlying assets collateralizing the structured note are German mortgage loans, then the exposure would be included as German risk in the “risk management” view.

 

In our “country of domicile view” we aggregate credit risk exposures to counterparties by allocating them to the domicile of the primary counterparty, irrespective of any link to other counterparties, or in relation to credit default swaps underlying reference assets from, these eurozone countries. Hence we also include counterparties whose group parent is located outside of these countries and exposures to special purpose entities whose underlying assets are from entities domiciled in other countries.

Net credit risk exposure with certain eurozone countries – Risk Management View

 

in m.

   Dec 31, 2015        Dec 31, 20141    

Greece

     473           416     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Ireland

     2,809           1,398     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Italy

     13,269           14,920     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Portugal

     729           1,002     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Spain

     8,884           8,273     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     26,164           26,009     

 

 
1 

Prior year figures were adjusted by 0.8 billion exposure with Ireland and Italy to Securitization and Real Estate counterparties erroneously not included as at December 31, 2014.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
149   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Performance   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Net credit risk exposure slightly up by 0.2 billion since year-end 2014. This was mainly driven by increases in Ireland Securitization portfolio and Spain short-term liquidity exposure, partly offset by decrease in Italy and Portugal largely driven by lower traded credit positions. Greece exposure marginally up driven by vessel collateral revaluations and USD strengthening, excluding the U.S. dollar denominated Shipping portfolio of  0.3 billion, remaining exposure stands at  0.1 billion and continues to be closely monitored.

Our above exposure is principally to highly diversified, low risk retail portfolios and small and medium enterprises in Italy and Spain, as well as stronger corporate and diversified mid-cap clients. Our financial institutions exposure is predominantly geared towards larger banks in Spain and Italy, typically collateralised. Sovereign exposure is at what we view as a manageable level.

The following tables, which are based on the country of domicile view, present our gross position, the included amount thereof of undrawn exposure and our net exposure to these eurozone countries. The gross exposure reflects our net credit risk exposure grossed up for net credit derivative protection purchased with underlying reference assets domiciled in one of these countries, guarantees received and collateral. Such collateral is particularly held with respect to the retail portfolio, but also for financial institutions predominantly based on derivative margining arrangements, as well as for corporates. In addition the amounts also reflect the allowance for credit losses. In some cases, our counterparties’ ability to draw on undrawn commitments is limited by terms included in the specific contractual documentation. Net credit exposures are presented after effects of collateral held, guarantees received and further risk mitigation, including net notional amounts of credit derivatives for protection sold/(bought). The provided gross and net exposures to certain European countries do not include credit derivative tranches and credit derivatives in relation to our correlation business which, by design, is structured to be credit risk neutral. Additionally the tranche and correlated nature of these positions does not allow a meaningful disaggregated notional presentation by country, e.g., as identical notional exposures represent different levels of risk for different tranche levels.

Gross position, included undrawn exposure and net exposure to certain eurozone countries – Country of Domicile View

 

    Sovereign     Financial Institutions     Corporates     Retail     Other     Total1  

in m.

  Dec 31,
2015
    Dec 31,
2014
    Dec 31,
2015
    Dec 31,
20142
    Dec 31,
2015
    Dec 31,
20142
    Dec 31,
2015
    Dec 31,
20142
    Dec 31,
2015
    Dec 31,
20142
    Dec 31,
20151
    Dec 31,  
20142
 

Greece

                       

Gross

    0          100          732        716        1,539        1,167          7        6        0          34          2,277        2,022     

Undrawn

    0          0          23        20        118        63          0        1        0          0          142        84     

Net

    0          89          237        107        95        125          1        2        0          34          333        357     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ireland

                       

Gross

    459          553          998        1,100        8,752        8,230          35        39        4,361 3      2,350 3      14,605        12,273     

Undrawn

    0          0          23        48        2,568        2,206          0        0        393 3      476 3      2,984        2,730     

Net

    28          (21)         528        524        5,327        5,103          5        5        4,347 3      2,350 3      10,235        7,960     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Italy

                       

Gross

    4,048          4,673          2,421        5,736        10,642        8,509          17,841        19,310        470          1,310          35,421        39,537     

Undrawn

    25          0          73        952        4,622        3,061          148        179        24          28          4,892        4,220     

Net

    507          244          754        3,431        7,093        5,897          6,989        6,749        448          1,229          15,792        17,551     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Portugal

                       

Gross

    112          (5)         260        404        1,509        1,052          1,743        2,023        59          205          3,684        3,679     

Undrawn

    0          0          22        37        210        121          25        30        0          0          258        189     

Net

    64          (76)         181        357        1,111        503          202        220        59          205          1,616        1,209     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Spain

                       

Gross

    729          696          1,292        2,465        9,350        9,332          9,928        10,580        257          839          21,556        23,911     

Undrawn

    0          0          203        738        4,235        3,819          298        476        14          15          4,750        5,048     

Net

    757          275          516        2,084        6,838        6,8284         1,872        1,890        476          790          10,458        11,8674    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total gross

    5,348          6,018          5,703        10,421        31,792        28,290          29,553        31,958        5,147          4,736          77,544        81,423     

Total undrawn

    25          0          344        1,795        11,754        9,271          472        687        431          519          13,026        12,272     

Total net5

    1,356          511          2,216        6,503        20,463        18,4574         9,069        8,866        5,330          4,608          38,434        38,9444    

 

 
1 

Approximately 63 % of the overall exposure will mature within the next 5 years.

2 

Comparatives as per Financial Report 2014 have been restated down by 107 million gross exposure and 101 million net exposure in order to exclude revocable loan commitments in line with other credit exposure disclosures in this report.

3 

Other exposures to Ireland include exposures to counterparties where the domicile of the group parent is located outside of Ireland as well as exposures to special purpose entities whose underlying assets are from entities domiciled in other countries.

4 

Decrease of CRE collateral of 4 million in comparison to the Financial Statement in September 2015 due to valuation adjustments in the Postbank portfolio.

5 

Total net exposure excludes credit valuation reserves for derivatives amounting to  159 million as of December 31, 2015 and 300 million as of December 31, 2014.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    150
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Total net exposure to the above selected eurozone countries decreased by  510 million in 2015 driven largely by reductions in exposure to Italy and Spain, partially offset by increased exposure in Ireland and Portugal.

Aggregate net credit risk to certain eurozone countries by type of financial instrument

 

    Financial assets carried at amortized cost       Financial assets  
measured at  
fair value  
    Financial instruments  
at fair value  through profit or loss  
    Dec 31, 2015    

in m.

  Loans  
before loan  
loss allowance  
    Loans  
after loan  
loss allowance  
    Other1     Financial assets  
available  
for sale2
    Derivatives       Other       Total3  

Greece

    139          104          177          0          54          28          363     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ireland

    3,616          3,615          2,845          852          988          2,092          10,392     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Italy

    11,249          10,298          4,094          671          3,433          1,480          19,976     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Portugal

    604          545          392          12          39          776          1,763     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Spain

    5,205          4,598          3,355          198          335          1,539          10,025     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    20,813          19,160          10,863          1,733          4,849          5,915          42,520     

 

 
1 

Primarily includes contingent liabilities and undrawn lending commitments.

2 

Excludes equities and other equity interests.

3 

After loan loss allowances.

 

    Financial assets carried at amortized cost       Financial assets  
measured at  
fair value  
    Financial instruments  
at fair value  through profit or loss  
    Dec 31, 2014    

in m.

  Loans  
before loan  
loss allowance1
    Loans  
after loan  
loss allowance1
    Other1,2     Financial assets  
available for  
sale3
    Derivatives       Other       Total1,4  

Greece

    191          172          92          0          85          28          377     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ireland

    2,049          2,016          2,706          481          843          1,728          7,775     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Italy

    10,764          9,753          3,791          672          4,071          3,085          21,372     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Portugal

    638          587          306          20          36          558          1,506     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Spain

    5,6175        4,9785        3,635          231          510          2,015          11,3695   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    19,2595        17,5065        10,530          1,404          5,545          7,414          42,3995   

 

 
1 

Comparatives as per Financial Report 2014 have been restated down by 101 million in order to exclude revocable loan commitments in line with other credit exposure disclosures in this report.

2 

Primarily includes contingent liabilities and undrawn lending commitments.

3 

Excludes equities and other equity interests.

4 

After loan loss allowances.

5 

Decrease of CRE collateral of 4 million in comparison to the Financial Statement in September 2015 due to valuation adjustments in the Postbank portfolio.

The above tables exclude credit derivative exposure, which is separately reported in the following table. For our credit derivative exposure with these eurozone countries we present the notional amounts for protection sold and protection bought on a gross level as well as the resulting net notional position and its fair value.

Credit derivative exposure with underlying assets domiciled in certain eurozone countries

 

    Notional amounts        Dec 31, 2015    

in m.

  Protection  
sold  
    Protection  
bought  
    Net protection  
sold/(bought)  
    Net fair value    

Greece

    1,144          (1,174)         (31)         (2)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ireland

    3,332          (3,489)         (157)         4     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Italy

    44,132          (48,316)         (4,184)         (35)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Portugal

    4,497          (4,645)         (147)         23     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Spain

    18,489          (18,056)         433          (2)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    71,594          (75,680)         (4,086)         (13)    

 

 
    Notional amounts        Dec 31, 2014    

in m.

  Protection
sold  
    Protection  
bought  
    Net protection  
sold/(bought)  
    Net fair value    

Greece

    901          (921)         (20)         2     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ireland

    4,344          (4,158)         186          4     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Italy

    41,433          (45,253)         (3,821)         156     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Portugal

    5,876          (6,173)         (297)         6     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Spain

    18,061          (17,563)         498          10     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    70,614          (74,068)         (3,454)         177     

 

 

 

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
151   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Performance   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

In line with common industry practice, we use credit default swaps (CDS) as one important instrument to manage credit risk in order to avoid any undue concentrations in the credit portfolio. CDS contracts are governed by standard ISDA documentation which defines trigger events which result in settlement payouts. Examples of these triggers include bankruptcy of the reference entity, failure of reference entity to meeting contractual obligations (i.e., interest or principal repayment) and debt restructuring of the reference entity. These triggers also apply to credit default protection contracts sold. Our purchased credit default swap protection acting as a risk mitigant is predominantly issued by highly rated financial institutions governed under collateral agreements. While we clearly focus on net risk including hedging/collateral we also review our gross positions before any CDS hedging in reflection of the potential risk that a CDS trigger event does not occur as expected.

The exposures associated with these countries noted above are managed and monitored using the credit process explained within the “Credit Risk Management” section of this Risk Report including detailed counterparty ratings, ongoing counterparty monitoring as well as our framework for managing concentration risk as documented within our “Country Risk Management” and “Industry Risk Management” sections as outlined above. This framework is complemented by regular management reporting including targeted portfolio reviews of these countries and portfolio de-risking initiatives.

For credit protection purposes we strive to avoid any maturity mismatches. However, this depends on the availability of required hedging instruments in the market. Where maturity mismatches cannot be avoided, these positions are tightly monitored. We take into account the sensitivities of hedging instruments and underlying assets to neutralize the maturity mismatch.

Our governance framework is intended to enable adequate preparation for and an ability to manage euro crisis events in terms of risk mitigation and operational contingency measures, which we consider to have been effective when Cyprus stresses escalated, with close coordination between Risk, Legal, business and other infrastructure functions to promote consistent operational and strategic responses across the Bank.

Overall, we have managed our exposures to certain eurozone countries since the early stages of the debt crisis and believe our credit portfolio to be well-positioned following selective early de-risking focused on sovereign risk and weaker counterparties.

Sovereign Credit Risk Exposure to Certain Eurozone Countries

The amounts below reflect a net “country of domicile view” of our sovereign exposure.

 

                   

Sovereign credit risk exposure to certain eurozone countries

  

   
   
    Dec 31, 2015     Dec 31, 2014       

in m.

  Direct  
Sovereign  
exposure1
    Net Notional  
of CDS  
referencing  
sovereign  
debt  
    Net sovereign  
exposure  
    Memo Item:  
Net fair value  
of CDS  
referencing  
sovereign  
debt2
    Direct  
Sovereign  
exposure1
    Net Notional  
of CDS  
referencing  
sovereign  
debt  
    Net sovereign  
exposure  
    Memo Item:  
Net fair value  
of CDS  
referencing  
sovereign  
debt2
      

Greece

    0          0          0          0          100          (11)         89          1         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Ireland

    55          (28)         28          1          (26)         4          (21)         2         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Italy

    3,989          (3,482)         507          36          4,600          (4,356)         244          133         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Portugal

    112          (48)         64          (9)         (5)         (71)         (76)         2         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Spain

    725          32          757          (12)         688          (413)         275          1         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

     

Total

    4,881          (3,526)         1,356          17          5,358          (4,848)         511          139         

 

     

1 Includes sovereign debt classified as financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss, available for sale and loans carried at amortized cost.

2 The amounts reflect the net fair value in relation to credit default swaps referencing sovereign debt of the respective country representing the counterparty credit risk.

   

   

   

The increase of  845 million in net sovereign exposure compared with year-end 2014 mainly reflects movements from credit default swaps, derivative positions and debt securities. The movement in our net sovereign exposure is mainly driven by a significant increase in Italian and Spanish exposure, which primarily reflects exposure changes in credit default swaps, trading debt securities and positive market values from derivatives.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    152
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

The above represented direct sovereign exposure included the carrying value of loans held at amortized cost to sovereigns, which as of December 31, 2015, amounted to 273 million for Italy and  478 million for Spain and as of December 31,2014 amounted to  279 million for Italy and  580 million for Spain.

Fair value of sovereign credit risk exposure to certain eurozone countries classified as financial assets at fair value through profit or loss

 

    Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 2014    

in m.

  Fair value of  
sovereign debt  
    Fair value of  
derivatives with  
sovereign  
counterparties  
(net position)1
    Total fair value  
of sovereign  
exposures  
    Fair value of  
sovereign debt  
    Fair value of  
derivatives with  
sovereign  
counterparties  
(net position)1
    Total fair value  
of sovereign  
exposures  
 

Greece

    0          0          0          20          80          100     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ireland

    60          (4)          55          (22)          0          (22)     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Italy

    5162          3,104          3,620          3852          3,459          3,844     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Portugal

    (111)          (1)          (112)          (8)          0          (8)     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Spain

    232          15          247          66          20          86     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    697          3,114          3,811          441          3,559          4,000     

 

 
1 

Includes the impact of master netting and collateral arrangements.

2 

Long sovereign debt position for Italy predominantly related to structured trades with corresponding credit derivatives offset.

Sovereign credit risk exposure to certain eurozone countries classified as financial assets available for sale

 

    Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 2014    

in m.

  Fair value of  
sovereign debt  
    Original carrying  
amount  
    Accumulated  
impairment  
losses  
recognized in  
net income  
(after tax)  
    Fair value of  
sovereign debt  
    Original carrying  
amount  
    Accumulated  
impairment  
losses  
recognized in  
net income  
(after tax)  
 

Greece

    0          0          0          0          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ireland

    0          0          0          0          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Italy

    72          72          0          77          81          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Portugal

    4          4          0          4          4          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Spain

    0          0          0          0          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    76          76          0          81          85          0     

 

 

Credit Exposure Classification

We also classify our credit exposure under two broad headings: consumer credit exposure and corporate credit exposure.

 

 

Our consumer credit exposure consists of our smaller-balance standardized homogeneous loans, primarily in Germany, Italy and Spain, which include personal loans, residential and non-residential mortgage loans, overdrafts and loans to self-employed and small business customers of our private and retail business.

 

Our corporate credit exposure consists of all exposures not defined as consumer credit exposure.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
153   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Performance   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Corporate Credit Exposure

The tables below show our Corporate Credit Exposure by product types and internal rating bands. Please refer to section "Measuring Credit Risk" for more details about our internal ratings.

Main corporate credit exposure categories according to our internal creditworthiness categories of our counterparties – gross

 

in m.

(unless stated otherwise)  

   Dec 31, 2015  

Ratingband

 

Probability of  
default in %1

   Loans      

Irrevocable  
lending  
commitments2

  

Contingent  
liabilities  

  

OTC  
derivatives3

   Debt  
securities  
available  
for sale  
   

Total  

iAAA–iAA

  > 0.00 £ 0.04        50,712        23,035      6,384      22,753        59,157        162,042  

 

 

 

  

 

 

   

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

 

   

 

iA

  > 0.04 £ 0.11        49,197        46,220      15,464      10,998        4,515        126,394  

 

 

 

  

 

 

   

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

 

   

 

iBBB

  > 0.11 £ 0.5        62,044        44,603      18,283      7,871        1,911        134,711  

 

 

 

  

 

 

   

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

 

   

 

iBB

  > 0.5 £ 2.27        51,454        37,643      10,827      5,358        2,621        107,904  

 

 

 

  

 

 

   

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

 

   

 

iB

  > 2.27 £ 10.22        20,610        21,212      4,668      1,558        57        48,105  

 

 

 

  

 

 

   

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

 

   

 

iCCC and below

  > 10.22 £ 100        9,853        1,834      1,700      515        4        13,906  

 

 

 

  

 

 

   

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

 

   

 

Total

       243,871       174,548      57,325      49,053        68,266       593,063  

 

1 

Reflects the probability of default for a one year time horizon.

2 

Includes irrevocable lending commitments related to consumer credit exposure of  9.2 billion as of December 31, 2015.

3 

Includes the effect of netting agreements and cash collateral received where applicable.

 

in m.

(unless stated otherwise)

   Dec 31, 2014  

Ratingband

 

Probability of  
default in %1

   Loans      

Irrevocable  
lending  
commitments2

  

Contingent  
liabilities  

  

OTC  
derivatives3

   Debt  
securities  
available  
for sale  
    

Total  

iAAA–iAA

  > 0.00 £ 0.04        46,493        22,938      6,281      23,068        50,808         149,589  

 

 

 

  

 

 

   

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

iA

  > 0.04 £ 0.11        44,799        39,336      17,696      9,469        3,371         114,670  

 

 

 

  

 

 

   

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

iBBB

  > 0.11 £ 0.5        54,167        40,145      20,190      7,810        1,746         124,057  

 

 

 

  

 

 

   

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

iBB

  > 0.5 £ 2.27        50,183        31,492      11,640      3,926        3,140         100,380  

 

 

 

  

 

 

   

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

iB

  > 2.27 £ 10.22        19,359        18,924      4,929      2,253        17         45,482  

 

 

 

  

 

 

   

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

iCCC and below

  > 10.22 £ 100        9,417        1,612      1,352      552        50         12,983  

 

 

 

  

 

 

   

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

Total

       224,418       154,446      62,087      47,078        59,132         547,161  

 

1 

Reflects the probability of default for a one year time horizon.

2 

Includes irrevocable lending commitments related to consumer credit exposure of  9.4 billion as of December 31, 2014.

3 

Includes the effect of netting agreements and cash collateral received where applicable.

The above table shows an overall increase in our corporate credit exposure in 2015 of  45.9 billion or 8.4 %. The increase in irrevocable lending commitments of 20.1 billion was primarily attributable to North America and Western Europe (excluding Germany). Loans increased by 19.5 billion, mainly attributable to North America and Western Europe (excluding Germany) with more than half of the increase relating to foreign exchange rate movements. This includes a significant increase of  16.5 billion in the investment-grade rating band, which is mainly driven by collateral restructuring related to ETF business within CB&S. Debt securities available for sale increased by  9.1 billion mainly driven by increase in highly liquid securities held in the Group’s Strategic Liquidity Reserve. These increases are the result of the ongoing optimization of our liquidity reserves. The increase in debt securities available for sale is almost entirely related to the top rating band. The quality of the corporate credit exposure before risk mitigation has remained stable at 71 % share of investment-grade rated exposures compared to December 31, 2014.

We use risk mitigation techniques as described above to optimize our corporate credit exposure and reduce potential credit losses. The tables below disclose the development of our corporate credit exposure net of collateral, guarantees and hedges.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    154
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Main corporate credit exposure categories according to our internal creditworthiness categories of our counterparties – net

 

in m.

(unless stated otherwise)

  

Dec 31, 20151

 

Ratingband

  

Probability

of default in %2

   Loans        Irrevocable
lending
commitments
     Contingent
liabilities
     OTC derivatives      Debt securities  
available for sale  
     Total  

iAAA–iAA

   > 0.00  £ 0.04        37,450           20,567           4,963           14,844           59,157           136,982     

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

iA

   > 0.04 £ 0.11        31,446           42,466           13,256           7,983           4,515           99,666     

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

iBBB

   > 0.11 £ 0.5        31,706           41,190           15,230           6,848           1,911           96,885     

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

iBB

   > 0.5 £ 2.27        23,865           35,173           6,811           4,139           2,621           72,609     

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

iB

   > 2.27  £ 10.22        8,698           20,309           2,411           1,516           57           32,990     

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

iCCC and below

   > 10.22 £ 100        4,532           1,670           759           514           4           7,479     

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

        137,696           161,375           43,429           35,844           68,266           446,610     

 

 
1 

Net of eligible collateral, guarantees and hedges based on IFRS requirements.

2 

Reflects the probability of default for a one year time horizon.

 

in m.

(unless stated otherwise)

  

Dec 31, 20141

 

Ratingband

  

Probability of
default in %2

   Loans3      Irrevocable
lending
commitments
     Contingent
liabilities
     OTC derivatives      Debt securities  
available for sale  
     Total3  

iAAA–iAA

   > 0.00  £ 0.04        33,125           19,407           4,282           15,843           50,808           123,464     

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

iA

   > 0.04 £ 0.11        29,396           36,137           15,268           3,957           3,370           88,128     

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

iBBB

   > 0.11 £ 0.5        28,178           35,807           16,377           6,487           1,746           88,595     

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

iBB

   > 0.5 £ 2.27        24,403           29,634           7,274           2,746           3,140           67,196     

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

iB

   > 2.27  £ 10.22        8,546           17,514           2,865           2,164           17           31,107     

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

iCCC and below

   > 10.22  £ 100        4,320           1,451           556           552           50           6,929     

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

        127,968           139,950           46,622           31,748           59,131           405,420     

 

 
1 

Net of eligible collateral, guarantees and hedges based on IFRS requirements.

2 

Reflects the probability of default for a one year time horizon.

3 

Prior year figures were adjusted to include 1.1 billion of CRE collateral relating to Postbank.

The corporate credit exposure net of collateral amounted to 446.6 billion as of December 31, 2015 resulting in a risk mitigation of 25 % or  146.5 billion compared to the corporate gross exposure. This includes a more significant reduction of 44 % for our loans exposure which includes a reduction by 55 % for the lower rated sub-investment-grade rated loans and 38 % for the higher rated investment-grade rated loans. The risk mitigation for the total exposure in the weakest rating band was 46 %, which was significantly higher than 15 % in the strongest rating band.

The risk mitigation of  146.5 billion is split into 29 % guarantees and hedges and 71 % other collateral.

CPSG Risk Mitigation for the Corporate Credit Exposure

Our Credit Portfolio Strategies Group (“CPSG”) helps mitigate the risk of our corporate credit exposures. The notional amount of CPSG’s risk reduction activities increased from 38.2 billion as of December 31, 2014, to  45.0 billion as of December 31, 2015, due primarily to the strengthening of the USD.

As of year-end 2015, CPSG mitigated the credit risk of 41.4 billion of loans and lending-related commitments as of December 31, 2015, through synthetic collateralized loan obligations supported predominantly by financial guarantees. This position totalled 31.4 billion as of December 31, 2014.

CPSG also held credit derivatives with an underlying notional amount of  3.6 billion. The position totalled  6.8 billion as of December 31, 2014. The credit derivatives used for our portfolio management activities are accounted for at fair value.

CPSG has elected to use the fair value option under IAS 39 to report loans and commitments at fair value, provided the criteria for this option are met. The notional amount of CPSG loans and commitments reported at fair value decreased during the year to 8.2 billion as of December 31, 2015, from 14.1 billion as of December 31, 2014.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
155   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Performance   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Consumer Credit Exposure

In our consumer credit exposure we monitor consumer loan delinquencies in terms of loans that are 90 days or more past due and net credit costs, which are the annualized net provisions charged after recoveries.

Consumer credit exposure, consumer loan delinquencies and net credit costs

 

     Total exposure in m.        90 days or more past due  
as a % of total exposure   
     Net credit costs  
as a % of total exposure3
 

 

   Dec 31, 2015        Dec 31, 20141      Dec 31, 2015        Dec 31, 20141      Dec 31, 2015        Dec 31, 20141  
Consumer credit exposure Germany:      150,202           147,647           0.87           1.15           0.16           0.22     

Consumer and small business financing

     20,326           19,980           2.77           3.93           0.89           1.09     

Mortgage lending

     129,877           127,667           0.57           0.71           0.05           0.08     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Consumer credit exposure outside Germany      38,704           38,761           4.95           5.35           0.56           0.69     

Consumer and small business financing

     13,259           11,913           9.55           11.19           1.20           1.64     

Mortgage lending

     25,444           26,848           2.55           2.76           0.22           0.26     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Total consumer credit exposure2      188,906           186,408           1.70           2.02           0.24           0.32     

 

 
1 

Beginning 2015 we have refined our classification resulting in a reclassification of  427 million of Small Business Financing into Mortgage lending (mainly loans relating to development banks) in Germany and  1.1 billion of Mortgage lending into Small Business Financing (mainly Commercial Real Estate) outside Germany.

2 

Includes impaired loans amounting to 3.6 billion as of December 31, 2015 and  4.4 billion as of December 31, 2014.

3 

Net credit costs for the twelve months period ended at the respective balance sheet date divided by the exposure at that balance sheet date.

The volume of our consumer credit exposure increased from year-end 2014 to December 31, 2015 by  2.5 billion, or 1.3 %, driven by our loan books in Germany, which increased by 2.6 billion, in India, which increased by  407 million, and in Poland, which increased by 314 million. The increase was partly offset by 587 million decreased consumer credit exposure in Italy, mainly driven by reduced Non-Core Operations Unit (NCOU) mortgage book, and 102 million decreased consumer credit exposure in Spain.

The 90 days or more past due ratio of our consumer credit exposure decreased from 2.02 % as per year-end 2014 to 1.70 % as of December 31, 2015.

The total net credit costs as a percentage of our consumer credit exposure decreased from 0.32 % as per year-end 2014 to 0.24 % as of December 31, 2015. This ratio was affected by non-performing portfolio sales in Germany, but also driven by the further improved and stabilized environment in Germany and countries in Southern Europe in which we operate.

Consumer mortgage lending exposure grouped by loan-to-value buckets1

 

 

   Dec 31, 2015        Dec 31, 2014    

£ 50 %

     68 %           68 %     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

> 50 £ 70 %

     16 %           16 %     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

> 70 £ 90 %

     9 %           9 %     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

> 90 £ 100 %

     3 %           2 %     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

> 100 £ 110 %

     2 %           1 %     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

> 110 £ 130 %

     1 %           1 %     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

> 130 %

     2 %           1 %     

 

 
1 

When assigning the exposure to the corresponding LTV buckets, the exposure amounts are distributed according to their relative share of the underlying assessed real estate value.

The LTV expresses the amount of exposure as a percentage of assessed value of real estate.

Our LTV ratios are calculated using the total exposure divided by the current assessed value of the respective properties. These values are updated on a regular basis. The exposure of transactions that are additionally backed by liquid collaterals is reduced by the respective collateral values, whereas any prior charges increase the corresponding total exposure. The LTV calculation includes exposure which is secured by real estate collaterals. Any mortgage lending exposure that is collateralized exclusively by any other type of collateral is not included in the LTV calculation.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    156
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

The creditor’s creditworthiness, the LTV and the quality of collateral is an integral part of our risk management when originating loans and when monitoring and steering our credit risks. In general, we are willing to accept higher LTV’s, the better the creditor’s creditworthiness is. Nevertheless, restrictions of LTV apply for countries with negative economic outlook or expected declines of real estate values.

As of December 31, 2015, 68 % of our exposure related to the mortgage lending portfolio had a LTV ratio below or equal to 50 %, unchanged to the previous year.

Credit Exposure from Derivatives

All exchange traded derivatives are cleared through central counterparties (“CCPs”), the rules and regulations of which provide for daily margining of all current and future credit risk positions emerging out of such transactions. To the extent possible, we also use central counterparty clearing services for OTC derivative transactions (“OTC clearing”); we thereby benefit from the credit risk mitigation achieved through the central counterparty’s settlement system.

The Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (“DFA”) introduced mandatory OTC clearing for certain standardized OTC derivative transactions in 2013. The European Regulation (EU) No 648/2012 on OTC Derivatives, Central Counterparties and Trade Repositories (“EMIR”) introduced a number of risk mitigation techniques for non-centrally cleared OTC derivatives in 2013 and the reporting of OTC and exchange traded derivatives in 2014. Mandatory clearing for certain standardized OTC derivatives transactions is expected to start from June 2016, and margin requirements for uncleared OTC derivative transactions are expected to be phased in from September 2016.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
157   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Performance   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

The following table shows a breakdown of notional amounts and gross market value of derivative transactions along with a breakdown of notional amounts of OTC derivative assets and liabilities on the basis of clearing channel.

Notional amounts of OTC derivatives on basis of clearing channel and type of derivative

 

     Dec 31, 2015    
     Notional amount maturity distribution                         

in m.

   Within 1 year        > 1 and  
< 5 years  
     After 5 years        Total        Positive  
market  
value  
     Negative  
market  
value  
     Net  
market  
value  
 

Interest rate related:

                    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

OTC

     10,955,593           9,682,810           6,375,377           27,013,781           345,998           325,179           20,819     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Bilateral (Amt)

     3,906,875           4,952,043           3,205,837           12,064,755           316,736           298,220           18,516     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

CCP (Amt)

     7,048,718           4,730,767           3,169,540           14,949,025           29,261           26,959           2,302     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Exchange-traded

     4,452,134           1,400,495           3,742           5,856,371           272           237           35     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Interest rate related

     15,407,727           11,083,305           6,379,119           32,870,152           346,270           325,416           20,854     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Currency related:

                    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

OTC

     4,672,846           1,134,801           531,085           6,338,731           116,007           115,379           628     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Bilateral (Amt)

     4,644,414           1,134,686           531,085           6,310,184           115,900           115,270           630     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

CCP (Amt)

     28,432           115           0           28,547           107           109           (2)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Exchange-traded

     33,064           15           0           33,079           109           174           (65)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Currency related

     4,705,910           1,134,815           531,085           6,371,810           116,116           115,553           563     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Equity/index related:

                    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

OTC

     394,193           197,092           23,521           614,806           25,063           28,818           (3,756)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Bilateral (Amt)

     394,193           197,092           23,521           614,806           25,063           28,818           (3,756)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

CCP (Amt)

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Exchange-traded

     501,706           66,571           8,993           577,270           5,533           6,164           (631)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Equity/index related

     895,899           263,663           32,514           1,192,076           30,596           34,983           (4,387)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Credit derivatives related

                    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

OTC

     270,524           949,312           129,622           1,349,458           23,548           20,992           2,556     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Bilateral (Amt)

     176,492           445,572           72,423           694,486           14,784           12,386           2,399     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

CCP (Amt)

     94,032           503,741           57,199           654,972           8,763           8,606           157     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Exchange-traded

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Credit derivatives related

     270,524           949,312           129,622           1,349,458           23,548           20,992           2,556     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Commodity related:

                    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

OTC

     5,998           1,260           9,516           16,775           776           891           (115)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Bilateral (Amt)

     5,998           1,260           9,516           16,775           776           891           (115)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

CCP (Amt)

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Exchange-traded

     78,204           27,066           10           105,279           497           604           (107)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Commodity related

     84,202           28,326           9,526           122,054           1,273           1,496           (223)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other:

                    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

OTC

     20,621           5,378           43           26,043           906           1,953           (1,048)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Bilateral (Amt)

     20,618           5,378           43           26,039           902           1,953           (1,051)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

CCP (Amt)

     3           0           0           3           3           0           3     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Exchange-traded

     8,430           11           0           8,441           22           49           (27)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Other

     29,051           5,389           43           34,484           928           2,002           (1,074)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total OTC business

     16,319,775           11,970,654           7,069,164           35,359,593           512,297           493,213           19,084     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total bilateral business

     9,148,589           6,736,032           3,842,425           19,727,045           474,162           457,538           16,623     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total CCP business

     7,171,186           5,234,622           3,226,739           15,632,548           38,135           35,674           2,461     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total exchange-traded business

     5,073,538           1,494,157           12,746           6,580,441           6,433           7,229           (795)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     21,393,313           13,464,811           7,081,910           41,940,034           518,730           500,441           18,289     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Positive market values after netting and cash collateral received      0           0           0           0           53,202           0           0     

 

 
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    158
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

     Dec 31, 2014  
     Notional amount maturity distribution                         

in m.

   Within 1 year        > 1 and  
< 5 years  
     After 5 years        Total        Positive  
market  
value  
     Negative  
market  
value1  
     Net  
market  
value1  
 

Interest rate related:

                    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

OTC

     16,193,068           13,319,460           8,081,916           37,594,443           439,519           413,696           25,823     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Bilateral (Amt)

     5,524,005           6,526,046           3,779,863           15,829,914           407,156           382,615           24,542     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

CCP (Amt)

     10,669,063           6,793,413           4,302,052           21,764,529           32,363           31,082           1,281     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Exchange-traded

     3,253,648           841,043           714           4,095,406           152           152           (1)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Interest rate related

     19,446,716           14,160,503           8,082,630           41,689,849           439,671           413,849           25,822     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Currency related:

                    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

OTC

     4,783,759           1,307,251           609,549           6,700,559           130,775           134,567           (3,792)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Bilateral (Amt)

     4,760,349           1,307,251           609,549           6,677,149           130,639           134,420           (3,780)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

CCP (Amt)

     23,410           0           0           23,410           135           147           (12)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Exchange-traded

     12,428           103           0           12,531           55           106           (51)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Currency related

     4,796,187           1,307,354           609,549           6,713,090           130,829           134,673           (3,844)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Equity/index related:

                    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

OTC

     1,203,958           203,328           35,678           1,442,964           27,404           31,949           (4,545)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Bilateral (Amt)

     1,203,958           203,328           35,678           1,442,964           27,404           31,949           (4,545)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

CCP (Amt)

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Exchange-traded

     499,899           71,213           4,240           575,353           7,406           7,230           176     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Equity/index related

     1,703,857           274,542           39,919           2,018,317           34,810           39,179           (4,369)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Credit derivatives related

                    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

OTC

     337,245           935,967           119,549           1,392,760           25,370           23,074           2,296     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Bilateral (Amt)

     287,697           689,003           92,335           1,069,035           20,732           18,936           1,796     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

CCP (Amt)

     49,548           246,963           27,214           323,725           4,638           4,138           500     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Exchange-traded

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Credit derivatives related

     337,245           935,967           119,549           1,392,760           25,370           23,074           2,296     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Commodity related:

                    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

OTC

     13,708           2,549           7,115           23,371           2,030           1,804           226     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Bilateral (Amt)

     13,691           2,546           7,115           23,352           2,026           1,802           224     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

CCP (Amt)

     17           2           0           19           4           2           2     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Exchange-traded

     89,656           22,218           66           111,939           605           697           (92)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Commodity related

     103,364           24,766           7,181           135,311           2,635           2,501           134     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other:

                    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

OTC

     34,340           8,945           0           43,285           1,017           1,929           (912)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Bilateral (Amt)

     34,340           8,945           0           43,285           1,017           1,929           (912)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

CCP (Amt)

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Exchange-traded

     9,186           1,037           0           10,223           28           60           (32)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Other

     43,526           9,982           0           53,509           1,045           1,989           (944)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total OTC business

     22,566,078           15,777,500           8,853,806           47,197,384           626,115           607,019           19,096     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total bilateral business

     11,824,040           8,737,121           4,524,540           25,085,700           588,975           571,650           17,325     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total CCP business

     10,742,038           7,040,379           4,329,266           22,111,683           37,140           35,369           1,771     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total exchange-traded business

     3,864,818           935,614           5,021           4,805,453           8,246           8,246           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     26,430,896           16,713,114           8,858,826           52,002,836           634,361           615,265           19,096     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Positive market values after netting and cash collateral received      0           0           0           0           49,416           0           0     

 

 

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
159   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Performance   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Equity Exposure

The table below presents the carrying values of our equity investments according to IFRS definition split by trading and nontrading for the respective reporting dates. We manage our respective positions within our market risk and other appropriate risk frameworks.

Composition of our Equity Exposure

 

in m.

   Dec 31, 2015        Dec 31, 2014    

Trading Equities

     76,044           69,831     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Nontrading Equities1

     3,228           6,402     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Equity Exposure

     79,273           76,233     

 

 

1  Includes equity investment funds amounting to 642 million as of December 31, 2015 and  338 million as of December 31, 2014.

     

As of December 31, 2015, our Trading Equities exposure was mainly comprised of  71.4 billion from CB&S activities and  4.6 billion from Deutsche AWM business. Overall Trading Equities increased by  6.2 billion year on year driven by increased exposure in CB&S.

Asset Quality

This section describes the asset quality of our loans. All loans where known information about possible credit problems of borrowers causes our management to have serious doubts as to the collectability of the borrower’s contractual obligations are included in this section.

Overview of performing, renegotiated, past due and impaired loans by customer groups

 

     Dec 31, 2015        Dec 31, 20141  
in m.   

Corporate  

loans  

    

Consumer  

loans  

     Total       

Corporate  

loans  

    

Consumer  

loans  

     Total    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Loans neither past due, nor renegotiated or impaired      237,758           182,306           420,064           217,672           177,904           395,576     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Past due loans, neither renegotiated nor impaired      1,143           2,544           3,687           1,304           3,650           4,954     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Loans renegotiated, but not impaired      438           437           875           452           496           947     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Impaired loans      4,532           3,619           8,151           4,990           4,358           9,348     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Total      243,871           188,906           432,777           224,418           186,408           410,825     

 

 

1  Comparatives for forborne assets as per Financial Report 2014 have been restated. As a result, the renegotiated not impaired volume has been increased by  126 million erroneously not included in prior disclosure. The volume for past due and performing exposure have been adjusted by  126 million accordingly.

      

 

 

Past Due Loans

 

       

Loans are considered to be past due if contractually agreed payments of principal and/or interest remain unpaid by the borrower, except if those loans are acquired through consolidation. The latter are considered to be past due if payments of principal and/or interest, which were expected at a certain payment date at the time of the initial consolidation of the loans, are unpaid by the borrower.

 

Non-impaired past due loans at amortized cost by past due status

 

   

in m.

  

Dec 31, 2015  

  

Dec 31, 2014

    

Loans less than 30 days past due

   2,387      3,223      

 

  

 

  

 

   

Loans 30 or more but less than 60 days past due

   547      534      

 

  

 

  

 

   

Loans 60 or more but less than 90 days past due

   281      363      

 

  

 

  

 

   

Loans 90 days or more past due

   540      898      

 

  

 

  

 

   

Total

   3,755      5,018      

 

   
         

 

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    160
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Non-impaired past due loans at amortized cost by industry

 

in m.

  Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 20141    

Financial intermediation

    69          104     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Fund management activities

    2          95     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Manufacturing

    100          141     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Wholesale and retail trade

    91          159     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Households

    2,495          3,388     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Commercial real estate activities

    672          801     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Public sector

    3          5     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other

    323          326     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    3,755          5,018     

 

 

1  Comparatives have been restated to reflect changes in industry sectors.

     

Non-impaired past due loans at amortized cost by region

 

in m.

  Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 2014    

Germany

    1,430          2,410     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Western Europe (excluding Germany)

    1,417          1,694     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Eastern Europe

    139          143     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

North America

    641          678     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Central and South America

    8          29     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Asia/Pacific

    106          63     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Africa

    15          1     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other

    0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    3,755          5,018     

 

 

Our non-impaired past due loans decreased by  1.3 billion to  3.8 billion as of December 31, 2015, mainly driven by PBC amongst others reflecting the benign environment in the German credit market.

 

   

Aggregated value of collateral – with the fair values of collateral capped at loan outstandings – held against our non-impaired past due loans

 

   

    

in m.

  Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 2014    
   

Financial and other collateral

    2,254          2,854     
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Guarantees received

    133          226     
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Total

    2,387          3,080     
   

 

 
       

Our aggregated value of collateral held against our non-impaired past due loans as of December 31, 2015 decreased in line with the reduction of non-impaired past due loans compared to prior year.

Forborne Loans

For economic or legal reasons we might enter into a forbearance agreement with a borrower who faces or will face financial difficulties in order to ease the contractual obligation for a limited period of time. A case by case approach is applied for our corporate clients considering each transaction and client specific facts and circumstances. For consumer loans we offer forbearances for a limited period of time, in which the total or partial outstanding or future instalments are deferred to a later point of time. However, the amount not paid including accrued interest during this period must be re-compensated at a later point of time. Repayment options include distribution over residual tenor, a one-off payment or a tenor extension. Forbearances are restricted and depending on the economic situation of the client, our risk management strategies and the local legislation. In case of a forbearance agreement is entered into, an impairment measurement is conducted as described below, an impairment charge is taken if necessary and the loan is subsequently recorded as impaired.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
161   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Performance   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Loans that have been renegotiated in such a way that, for economic or legal reasons related to the borrower’s financial difficulties, we granted a concession to the borrower that we would not otherwise have considered are disclosed as renegotiated loans and are a subset of forborne loans.

On February 20, 2014, the EBA issued the final draft Implementing Technical Standards (ITS) on Supervisory reporting on forbearance and non-performing exposures under article 99(4) of Regulation (EU) No 575/2013.

During 2014 we introduced the new EBA definition for forbearances replacing the definition of renegotiated and restructured loans. The scope of the new definition goes far beyond the prior definitions applied and now includes those measures to clients which will face financial difficulties. Once the conditions mentioned in the ITS are met, we report the loan as being forborne; we remove the loan from our forbearance reporting, once the discontinuing criteria in the ITS are met.

Forborne Loans

 

    Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 20141  
    Performing       Non-  
performing  
    Total  
forborne  
loans  
    Performing       Non-  
performing  
    Total  
forborne  
loans  
 

in m.

  Nonimpaired       Nonimpaired       Impaired      

 

    Nonimpaired       Nonimpaired       Impaired      

 

 
German     1,067          441          1,096          2,605          1,121          296          1,284          2,701     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Non-German     619          716          1,801          3,136          1,013          651          1,933          3,597     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total     1,686          1,157          2,897          5,741          2,134          947          3,217          6,298     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
1 

Comparatives for forborne assets as per Financial Report 2014 have been restated by 395 million erroneously not included in prior disclosure.

 

The reduction in Total forborne loans in 2015 of  557 million mainly results from PBC, reflecting the benign environment in the German credit market as well as the stabilisation in Southern Europe along with NCOU driven by IAS 39 reclassified and real estate assets.

 

Impaired Loans

 

Credit Risk Management regularly assesses whether there is objective evidence that a loan or group of loans is impaired. A loan or group of loans is impaired and impairment losses are incurred if:

 

—  there is objective evidence of impairment as a result of a loss event that occurred after the initial recognition of the asset and up to the balance sheet date (“a loss event”). When making our assessment we consider information on such events that is reasonably available up to the date the financial statements are authorized for issuance in line with the requirements of IAS 10;

—  the loss event had an impact on the estimated future cash flows of the financial asset or the group of financial assets, and

—  a reliable estimate of the loss amount can be made.

 

Credit Risk Management’s loss assessments are subject to regular review in collaboration with Group Finance. The results of this review are reported to and approved by Group Finance and Risk Senior Management.

 

For further details with regard to impaired loans please refer to Note 1 “Significant Accounting Policies and Critical Accounting Estimates”.

     
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    162
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

 

Impairment Loss and Allowance for Loan Losses

 

   

If there is evidence of impairment the impairment loss is generally calculated on the basis of discounted expected cash flows using the original effective interest rate of the loan. If the terms of a loan are renegotiated or otherwise modified because of financial difficulties of the borrower without qualifying for de-recognition of the loan, the impairment loss is measured using the original effective interest rate before modification of terms. We reduce the carrying amount of the impaired loan by the use of an allowance account and recognize the amount of the loss in the consolidated statement of income as a component of the provision for credit losses. We record increases to our allowance for loan losses as an increase of the provision for loan losses in our income statement. Charge-offs reduce our allowance while recoveries, if any, are credited to the allowance account. If we determine that we no longer require allowances which we have previously established, we decrease our allowance and record the amount as a reduction of the provision for loan losses in our income statement. When it is considered that there is no realistic prospect of recovery and all collateral has been realized or transferred to us, the loan and any associated allowance for loan losses is charged off (i.e., the loan and the related allowance for loan losses are removed from the balance sheet).

 

While we assess the impairment for our corporate credit exposures individually, we assess the impairment of our smaller-balance standardized homogeneous loans collectively.

 

Our collectively assessed allowance for non-impaired loans reflects allowances to cover for incurred losses that have neither been individually identified nor provided for as part of the impairment assessment of smaller-balance homogeneous loans.

 

For further details regarding our accounting policies regarding impairment loss and allowance for credit losses please refer to Note 1 “Significant Accounting Policies and Critical Accounting Estimates”.

 

Impaired loans, allowance for loan losses and coverage ratios by business division

 

        

Dec 31, 2015

 

Dec 31, 2014

 

2015 increase (decrease)

from 2014

    

in m.

 

Impaired

loans

 

Loan loss
allowance

 

Impaired loan
coverage

ratio in %

 

Impaired

loans

 

Loan loss
allowance

 

Impaired loan
coverage

ratio in %

 

Impaired

loans

 

Impaired loan
coverage

ratio in ppt

    Corporate Banking & Securities   852   537   63   637   318   50   215   13
   

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

    Private & Business Clients   3,800   2,365   62   4,269   2,486   58   (469)   4
   

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

    Global Transaction Banking   1,306   921   71   1,574   995   63   (268)   7
   

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

    Deutsche Asset & Wealth Management   76   34   45   66   33   50   10   (5)
   

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

    Non-Core Operations Unit   2,117   1,168   55   2,803   1,380   49   (686)   6
   

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

   

thereof: assets reclassified to loans and receivables according to IAS 39

  667   389   58   986   518   53   (319)   6
   

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

   

Total

  8,151   5,028   62   9,348   5,212   56   (1,197)   6
   

 

                   

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
163   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Performance   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

 

Impaired loans, allowance for loan losses and coverage ratios by industry

 

  

   
    Dec 31, 2015       
    Impaired Loans     Loan loss allowance              

in m.

  Individually
assessed
    Collectively
assessed
    Total     Individually
assessed
allowance
    Collectively
assessed
allowance for
impaired
loans
    Collectively
assessed
allowance for
non-impaired
loans
    Total      Impaired loan
coverage
ratio in %
      
Financial intermediation     150        5        155        38        5        55        98         63       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     
Fund management activities     6        2        8        1        0        7        8         95       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     
Manufacturing     498        215        712        470        149        70        688         97       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     
Wholesale and retail trade     275        222        497        182        154        45        381         77       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     
Households     332        2,931        3,263        324        1,805        74        2,202         67       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     
Commercial real estate activities     1,365        281        1,646        503        36        36        576         35       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     
Public sector     16        0        16        2        0        2        5         29       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     
Other1     1,594        260        1,854        733        186        153        1,071         58       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     

Total

    4,236        3,915        8,151        2,252        2,335        442        5,028         62       

 

     

1   Thereof “Transportation, storage and communication’: Total Impaired Loans 858 million (44 %), Total Loan loss allowance 375 million (35 %). The rest is split across various industries (of which no single one contributes 25 % or more o the total of the category ‘Other’).

       

   
 
    Dec 31, 20141       
    Impaired Loans     Loan loss allowance              

in m.

  Individually
assessed
    Collectively
assessed
    Total     Individually
assessed
allowance
    Collectively
assessed
allowance for
impaired
loans
    Collectively
assessed
allowance for
non-impaired
loans
    Total      Impaired loan
coverage
ratio in %
      
Financial intermediation     263        7        270        91        2        19        111         41       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     
Fund management activities     64        0        64        1        0        5        6         9       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     
Manufacturing     525        232        757        428        126        71        625         83       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     
Wholesale and retail trade     362        229        591        211        148        36        395         67       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     
Households     451        3,299        3,750        370        1,947        85        2,402         64       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     
Commercial real estate activities     1,734        314        2,048        475        39        21        535         26       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     
Public sector     54        0        54        29        0        0        30         55       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     
Other2     1,539        277        1,815        758        193        157        1,108         61       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     

Total

    4,990        4,359        9,348        2,364        2,455        393        5,212         56       

 

     

1   Comparatives have been restated to reflect changes in industry sectors.

2   Thereof ‘Transportation, storage and communication’: Total Impaired Loans 804 million (39 %), Total Loan loss allowance 303 million (28 %). The rest is split across various industries (of which no single one contributes 25 % or more o the totals of the category ‘Other’).

 

Impaired loans, allowance for loan losses and coverage ratios by region

 

      

       

  

   
    Dec 31, 2015       
    Impaired Loans     Loan loss allowance              

in m.

  Individually
assessed
    Collectively
assessed
    Total     Individually
assessed
allowance
    Collectively
assessed
allowance for
impaired
loans
    Collectively
assessed
allowance for
non-impaired
loans
    Total      Impaired loan
coverage
ratio in %
      
Germany     1,362        1,642        3,004        647        930        105        1,682         56       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     
Western Europe (excluding Germany)     2,280        2,057        4,337        1,294        1,237        132        2,662         61       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     
Eastern Europe     76        179        255        38        165        10        213         83       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     
North America     340        2        342        150        0        107        257         75       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     
Central and South America     0        6        6        0        0        12        12         187       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     
Asia/Pacific     155        23        178        100        2        60        162         91       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     
Africa     21        5        26        23        0        5        28         107       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     
Other     2        0        2        0        0        10        10         553       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

     

Total

    4,236        3,915        8,151        2,252        2,335        442        5,028         62       

 

     
                    
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    164
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

         Dec 31, 2014  
         Impaired Loans     Loan loss allowance         
    

in m.

  Individually
assessed
    Collectively
assessed
    Total     Individually
assessed
allowance
    Collectively
assessed
allowance for
impaired
loans
    Collectively
assessed
allowance for
non-impaired
loans
    Total      Impaired loan
coverage
ratio in %
 
    Germany     1,604        1,896        3,499        740        1,017        116        1,873         54   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Western Europe (excluding Germany)     2,683        2,303        4,986        1,302        1,311        128        2,741         55   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Eastern Europe     107        152        259        51        125        10        186         72   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 
    North America     423        2        425        204        0        70        274         64   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Central and South America     2        0        3        3        0        6        9         356   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Asia/Pacific     170        5        174        63        1        50        114         65   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Africa     0        1        1        0        0        3        4         346   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 
    Other     1        0        1        0        0        11        11         0   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Total

    4,990        4,359        9,348        2,364        2,455        393        5,212         56   
   

 

 
                   

Development of Impaired Loans

 

      Dec 31, 2015         Dec 31, 2014     

in m.

   Individually   
assessed   
     Collectively   
assessed   
     Total         Individually   
assessed   
     Collectively   
assessed   
     Total    
Balance, beginning of year      4,990            4,359            9,348            5,922            4,221            10,143      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Classified as impaired during the year      898            1,176            2,073            2,112            2,181            4,293      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Transferred to not impaired during the year1      (1,010)           (859)           (1,869)           (1,425)           (1,182)           (2,607)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Charge-offs      (537)           (717)           (1,254)           (1,037)           (613)           (1,651)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Disposals of impaired loans      (239)           (53)           (292)           (514)           (254)           (768)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Exchange rate and other movements      135            10            145            (68)           6            (62)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Balance, end of year      4,236             3,915            8,151            4,990            4,359            9,348      

 

 

1  Includes repayments.

     

In 2015 our impaired loans decreased by  1.2 billion or 12.8 % to  8.2 billion. The reduction in our individually assessed impaired loans portfolio is mainly driven by NCOU among others resulting from charge-offs and disposals of primarily IAS 39 reclassified assets, partly offset by an increase in CB&S mainly caused by our Shipping and Leveraged Finance Portfolios. The reduction in our collectively assessed impaired loans portfolio mainly reflects charge-offs (also largely related to disposals) in Postbank and PBC Italy.

The impaired loans coverage ratio (defined as total on-balance sheet allowances for all loans individually impaired or collectively assessed divided by IFRS impaired loans (excluding collateral) slightly increased from 56 % as of year-end 2014 to 62 %.

Our impaired loans included  667 million of loans reclassified to loans and receivables in accordance with IAS 39, down  319 million from prior year’s level.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
165   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Performance   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Provision for loan losses and recoveries by Industry

 

    2015        20141     
    Provision for loan losses before recoveries                    

in m.

  For individually  
assessed loans  
    For collectively   
assessed   
impaired loans   
    For collectively   
assessed   
non-impaired   
loans   
    Total        Recoveries        Provision for   
loan losses   
before   
recoveries   
(total)   
    Recoveries     
Financial intermediation     (12)          1           6           (5)          1           0           2      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Fund management activities     0           0           2           2           0           1           0      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Manufacturing     32           35           (6)          61           16           56           11      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Wholesale and retail trade     40           32           6           78           4           67           9      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Households     36           472           6           513           101           690           101      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Commercial real estate activities     12           12           9           33           18           182           5      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Public sector     (18)          0           0           (17)          0           8           0      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other2     299           56           22           378           21           265           13      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total     390           607           45           1,043           161           1,270           141      

 

   

 

 

 
1 

Comparatives have been restated to reflect changes in industry sectors.

2 

The largest driver of Total Provision for loan losses before recoveries was the sector ‘Transportation, storage and communication’ with 154 million (41 %) in 2015 and 109 million (40 %) in 2014. The rest is split across various industries (of which no single one contributes 25 % or more o the total of the category ‘Other’).

 

Our existing commitments to lend additional funds to debtors with impaired loans amounted to  54 million as of December 31, 2015 and  76 million as of December 31, 2014.

 

Collateral held against impaired loans, with fair values capped at transactional outstanding

 

  

   

in m.

  Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 2014         

Financial and other collateral

    2,722          3,215         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

     

Guarantees received

    223          296         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

     

Total collateral held for impaired loans

    2,945          3,511         

 

     
       

Our total collateral held for impaired loans as of December 31, 2015 decreased by  566 million or 16 % compared to previous year, while coverage ratio including collateral (defined as total on-balance sheet allowances for all loans individually impaired or collectively assessed plus collateral held against impaired loans, with fair values capped at transactional outstanding, divided by IFRS impaired loans) increased to 98 % as of December 31, 2015 compared to 93 % as of December 31, 2014.

 

Financial assets available for sale

 

The impairment concept is also applicable for available for sale debt instruments, which are otherwise carried at fair value with changes in fair value reported in other comprehensive income. If an available for sale debt instrument is considered impaired, the cumulative impairment loss reflects the difference between the amortized cost and the current fair value of the instrument. For a detailed discussion of our accounting procedures please refer to Note 1 “Significant Accounting policies and Critical Accounting Estimates”.

   
   
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    166
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

   

Non-impaired past due and impaired financial assets available for sale, accumulated impairments, coverage ratio and collateral held against impaired financial assets available for sale

 

   

    

in m.

  Dec 31, 20151       Dec 31, 2014    
   

Financial assets non-impaired past due available for sale

    1,610          N/M     
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

thereof:

   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Less than 30 days past due

    47          N/M     
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

30 or more but less than 60 days past due

    0          N/M     
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

60 or more but less than 90 days past due

    0          N/M     
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

90 days or more past due

    1,563          N/M     
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Impaired financial assets available for sale

    229          200     
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Accumulated impairment for financial assets available for sale

    109          68     
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Impaired financial assets available for sale coverage ratio in %

    47          34     
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Collateral held against impaired financial assets available for sale

    19          N/M     
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

thereof:

   
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Financial and other collateral

    19          N/M     
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Guarantees received

    0          N/M     
   

 

 
   

1   First time data collection for non-impaired past due and collateral held against impaired financial assets available for sale.

      

   

 

Collateral Obtained

 

We obtain collateral on the balance sheet by taking possession of collateral held as security or by calling upon other credit enhancements. Collateral obtained is made available for sale in an orderly fashion or through public auctions, with the proceeds used to repay or reduce outstanding indebtedness. Generally we do not occupy obtained properties for our business use. The commercial and residential real estate collateral obtained in 2015 refers predominantly to our exposures in Spain.

 

Collateral obtained during the reporting periods

 

  

      

  

    

in m.

  2015       2014    
   

Commercial real estate

    5          21     
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Residential real estate

    43          44     
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Other

    0          0     
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Total collateral obtained during the reporting period

    48          65     
   

 

 
   

 

The collateral obtained, as shown in the table above, excludes collateral recorded as a result of consolidating securitization trusts under IFRS 10. In 2015, the group did not obtain any collateral related to these trusts compared to  6 million in 2014.

    

       

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
167   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Performance   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Allowance for Credit Losses

Development of allowance for credit losses

 

    2015   
     Allowance for Loan Losses      Allowance for Off-Balance Sheet Positions         

in m.

  Individually 
assessed 
    Collectively 
assessed 
    Subtotal      Individually 
assessed 
    Collectively 
assessed 
    Subtotal      Total   

Balance, beginning of year

    2,364         2,849         5,212         85         141         226         5,439    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Provision for credit losses

    334         548         882         58         16         74         956    

thereof: (Gains)/Losses from disposal of impaired loans

    (64)        (51)        (116)                             (116)   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net charge-offs:

    (482)        (612)        (1,094)                             (1,094)   

Charge-offs

    (538)        (717)        (1,255)                             (1,255)   

Recoveries

    56         105         161                              161    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other changes     36         (8)        28                10         11         39    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Balance, end of year     2,252         2,776         5,028         144         168         312         5,340    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
             
Changes compared to prior year              

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Provision for credit losses              

Absolute

    (164)        (83)        (247)        71         (1)        70         (178)   

Relative

    (33%)        (13%)        (22%)        (538%)        (8%)        N/M 1      (16%)   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net charge-offs

             

Absolute

    515        (100)        415                              415   

Relative

    (52)%         19%         (28)%         0%         0%         0%         (28)%    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, end of year

             

Absolute

    (112)        (72)        (184)        59         27         86         (99)   

Relative

    (5%)        (3)%        (4%)        69%        19%        38%        (2%)   

 

 

N/M – Not meaningful

Allowance for credit losses as at December 2015 amounted to 5.3 billion compared to 5.4 billion as at the end of 2014. The reduction is mainly driven by charge offs in part relating to disposals.

Provision for credit losses decreased by 178 million compared to prior year, driven by a reduction in provision for loan losses of 247 million. The reduction in 2015 in provisions for loan losses in our individually assessed loan portfolio of  164 million is driven by IAS 39 reclassified assets and other real estate exposures recorded in NCOU, partly offset by higher provisioning in our Shipping and Leveraged Finance Portfolios in CB&S. The reduction in our collectively assessed loan portfolio of 83 million mainly results from higher releases related to disposals along with an ongoing positive credit environment in Germany and a stabilization of Southern European markets. The increase in provisions for off-balance sheet exposures of 70 million compared to 2014 is driven by GTB mainly reflecting one large item and Postbank.

The reduction in charge offs of 415 million compared to 2014 is mainly driven by Postbank and results from high prior year levels caused by a one-off effect due to the alignment of processes.

Our allowance for loan losses for IAS 39 reclassified assets, which are reported in NCOU, amounted to  389 million at the end of 2015, representing 8 % of our total allowance for loan losses, down 25 % from the level at the end of the prior year which amounted to  518 million (10 % of total allowance for loan losses). This reduction was driven by net charge offs of 113 million along with net releases of 44 million and partly offset by increases related to foreign exchange as most IAS 39 reclassified assets are denominated in non-Euro currencies.

Compared to 2014, provision for loan losses for IAS 39 reclassified assets dropped by  129 million and net charge-offs increased by  98 million in 2015. Both changes were partly related to disposals.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    168
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

    2014   
     Allowance for Loan Losses      Allowance for Off-Balance Sheet Positions         

in m.

  Individually 
assessed 
    Collectively 
assessed 
    Subtotal      Individually 
assessed 
    Collectively 
assessed 
    Subtotal      Total   

Balance, beginning of year

    2,857         2,732         5,589         102         114         216         5,805    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Provision for credit losses

    499         631        1,129         (13)        18                1,134    

thereof: (Gains)/Losses from disposal of impaired loans

    (45)        (16)        (61)                             (61)   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net charge-offs:

    (997)        (512)        (1,509)                             (1,509)   

Charge-offs

    (1,037)        (613)        (1,650)                             (1,650)   

Recoveries

    40         101         141                              141    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other changes            (2)               (4)        10                  

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, end of year

    2,364         2,849         5,212         85         141         226         5,439    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
             

Changes compared to prior year

             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Provision for credit losses

             

Absolute

    (878)        (52)        (930)               (3)        (1)        (931)   

Relative

    (64)%         (8)%         (45)%         (14)%         (14)%         (12%)        (45)%    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net charge-offs

             

Absolute

    (296)        (160)        (456)                             (456)   

Relative

    42%         45%         43%         0%         0%         0%         43%    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, end of year

             

Absolute

    (494)        117         (376)        (17)        28         11         (366)   

Relative

    (17)%        4%        (7)%        (17%)        24%        5%        (6)%    

 

 

The reduction in 2014 in provisions for loan losses in our individually assessed loan portfolio of  878 million reflects material reductions across all businesses. The reduction in NCOU was driven by decreased provision for credit losses in IAS 39 reclassified and commercial real estate assets, while the performance in our Core Bank benefited from increased releases and a non-recurrence of large single name bookings. Provisions for our collectively assessed portfolio decreased compared to prior year reflecting among other factors the ongoing good environment in the German credit market.

The main driver of the increase in charge-offs against our individually assessed loan portfolio was an alignment of processes in Postbank. This alignment resulted in an adjustment of the level of loan loss allowance for loans recorded at Postbank by  233 million reflecting accelerated write-offs as well as the elimination of previous misclassification of recoveries in the credit quality of Postbank loans, which had been impaired after change of control, as interest income. Additionally, higher charge-offs in GTB relating to a single client credit event in the prior year contributed to the overall increase which was partly offset by reductions in charge-offs for IAS 39 reclassified assets. The increase in charge-offs against our collectively assessed loan portfolio mainly related to the disposal of impaired loan portfolios in Italy.

Our allowance for loan losses for IAS 39 reclassified assets, which are reported in NCOU, amounted to  518 million at the end of 2014, representing 10 % of our total allowance for loan losses, up 8 % from the level at the end of the prior year which amounted to  479 million (9 % of total allowance for loan losses). This increase was largely driven by foreign exchange as most IAS 39 reclassified assets are denominated in non-Euro currencies while additional provisions for loan losses of  54 million were largely offset by net charge-offs of  43 million. Compared to 2013, provision for loan losses for IAS 39 reclassified assets dropped by  319 million and net charge-offs decreased by  305 million in 2014. Both reductions result from the non-recurrence of large items in the present year compared to high levels in the comparison period.

Derivatives – Credit Valuation Adjustment

We establish counterparty Credit Valuation Adjustment (“CVA”) for OTC derivative transactions to cover expected credit losses. The adjustment amount is determined by assessing the potential credit exposure to a given counterparty and taking into account any collateral held, the effect of any relevant netting arrangements, expected loss given default and the credit risk, based on available market information, including CDS spreads.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
169   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
   

u Risk and Capital Performance

  Explanatory Report – 239
   

Compensation Report – 188

 
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Treatment of Default Situations under Derivatives

Unlike standard loan assets, we generally have more options to manage the credit risk in our derivatives transactions when movement in the current replacement costs or the behavior of our counterparty indicate that there is the risk that upcoming payment obligations under the transactions might not be honored. In these situations, we are frequently able under the relevant derivatives agreements to obtain additional collateral or to terminate and close-out the derivate transactions at short notice.

The master agreements for OTC derivative transactions executed with our clients usually provide for a broad set of standard or bespoke termination rights, which allow us to respond swiftly to a counterparty’s default or to other circumstances which indicate a high probability of failure. We have less comfort under the rules and regulations applied by clearing CCPs, which rely primarily on the clearing members default fund contributions and guarantees and less on the termination and close-out of contracts, which will be considered only at a later point in time after all other measures failed. Considering the severe systemic disruptions to the financial system, that could be caused by a disorderly failure of a CCP, the Financial Stability Board (“FSB”) recommended in October 2014 to subject CCPs to resolution regimes that apply the same objectives and provisions that apply to global systematically important banks (G-SIBs).

Our contractual termination rights are supported by internal policies and procedures with defined roles and responsibilities which ensure that potential counterparty defaults are identified and addressed in a timely fashion. These procedures include necessary settlement and trading restrictions. When our decision to terminate derivative transactions results in a residual net obligation owed by the counterparty, we restructure the obligation into a non-derivative claim and manage it through our regular work-out process. As a consequence, for accounting purposes we typically do not show any nonperforming derivatives.

Wrong-way risk occurs when exposure to a counterparty is adversely correlated with the credit quality of that counterparty. In compliance with Article 291(2) and (4) CRR we, excluding Postbank, had established a monthly process to monitor several layers of wrong-way risk (specific wrong-way risk, general explicit wrong-way risk at country/industry/region levels and general implicit wrong-way risk, whereby exposures arising from transactions subject to wrong-way risk are automatically selected and presented for comment to the responsible credit officer. A wrong-way risk report is then sent to Credit Risk senior management on a monthly basis. In addition, we, excluding Postbank, utilized our established process for calibrating our own alpha factor (as defined in Article 284 (9) CRR) to estimate the overall wrong-way risk in our derivatives and securities financing transaction portfolio. Postbank derivative counterparty risk is immaterial to the Group and collateral held is typically in the form of cash.

Trading Market Risk Exposures

Value-at-Risk Metrics of Trading Units of Deutsche Bank Group (excluding Postbank)

 

                               
The tables and graph below present the value-at-risk metrics calculated with a 99 % confidence level and a one-day holding period for our trading units. They exclude contributions from Postbank trading book which are calculated on a stand-alone basis.         
                               
Value-at-Risk of our Trading Units by Risk Type     
                             
    Total       Diversification  
effect  
    Interest rate  
risk  
    Credit spread  
risk  
    Equity price  
risk  
    Foreign exchange  
risk 1  
    Commodity price  
risk  
     

in m.

  2015       2014       2015       2014       2015       2014       2015       2014       2015       2014       2015       2014       2015       2014        

Average

    43.3          51.6          (40.9)         (34.9)         20.3          25.1          30.9          31.2          16.6          14.8          15.0          13.2          1.3          2.2       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

Maximum

    65.6          71.4          (59.2)         (61.9)         30.2          42.8          40.3          38.9          28.3          24.6          25.0          21.2          4.0          10.2       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

Minimum

    28.7          35.4          (31.0)         (24.4)         16.2          15.7          24.0          25.9          9.2          9.9          6.0          6.9          0.5          0.7       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

Period-end

    33.3          49.0          (38.8)         (36.0)         18.3          18.1          26.2          29.6          11.7          15.5          15.1          20.5          0.9          1.3         

 

   

1Includes value-at-risk from gold and other precious metal positions.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    170
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

 

 

LOGO  

 

The average value-at-risk over 2015 was 43.3 million, which is a decrease of 8.3 million compared with the full year 2014. The average interest rate value-at-risk decreased on average, and there were increases in the average Foreign Exchange and Equity value-at-risk. Foreign Exchange value at risk increased due to an increase in U.S. dollar exposure on average compared to the full year 2014. Equity value-at-risk increased resulting from an increase in exposure on individual equities. Additionally increases in market volatility within the one year time horizon used in VaR have also contributed to the increased Foreign Exchange and Equity value-at-risk numbers. The overall reduction in VaR is driven by the reduction in the Interest Rate value-at-risk and an improvement in the portfolio diversification.

 

Regulatory Trading Market Risk Measures (excluding Postbank)

 

  

         

  

   

The table below presents the stressed value-at-risk metrics calculated with a 99 % confidence level and a one-day holding period for our trading units. It excludes contributions from Postbank trading book which are calculated on a stand-alone basis.

    

 

 

Average, Maximum and Minimum Stressed Value-at-Risk by Risk Type

 

  

        Total       Diversification  
effect  
    Interest rate  
risk  
    Credit spread  
risk  
    Equity price  
risk  
    Foreign exchange  
risk 1  
    Commodity price  
risk  
 
   

in m.

  2015       2014       2015       2014       2015       2014       2015       2014       2015       2014       2015       2014       2015       2014    
 

Average

    105.1          109.6          (114.5)         (125.4)         60.7          64.4          106.7          124.0          22.8          11.5          26.7          29.7          2.5          5.4     
 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
 

Maximum

    135.7          161.1          (186.7)         (168.0)         84.2          85.9          154.5          142.8          68.7          42.6          59.8          70.3          7.6          16.7     
 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
 

Minimum

    82.4          81.6          (71.7)         (102.3)         45.1          48.8          82.6          100.7          0.1          0.0          5.7          13.7          0.7          1.4     
 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

Period-end

    106.3          120.7          (98.0)         (139.3)         45.5          52.3          90.9          140.8          44.1          18.8          22.6          46.2          1.2          1.8     
 

 

 
 

1    Includes value-at-risk from gold and other precious metal positions.

 

The average stressed value-at-risk was  105.1 million over 2015, a decrease of  4.5 million compared with the full year 2014. There was a reduction in the credit spread stressed value-at-risk, partly offset by an increase in equity stressed value-at-risk. Equity stressed value-at-risk increased due to increased single name exposures and a reduction in loss protection on average compared to the full year 2014. The average and period end credit spread stressed value-at-risk decreases were driven by an improvement to the correlations approach used to aggregate certain components within credit spread value-at-risk.

       

       

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
171   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Performance   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

The following graph compares the development of the daily value-at-risk with the daily stressed value-at-risk and their 60 day averages, calculated with a 99 % confidence level and a one-day holding period for our trading units. Amounts are shown in millions of euro and exclude contributions from Postbank’s trading book which are calculated on a stand-alone basis.

 

LOGO  

 

     

  

 
For regulatory reporting purposes, the incremental risk charge for the respective reporting dates represents the higher of the spot value at the reporting dates, and their preceding 12-week average calculation. In contrast to this, the incremental risk charge amounts presented for the reporting dates and periods below are the spot values and the average, maximum and minimum values for the 12-week period preceding these reporting dates.          

 

Average, Maximum and Minimum Incremental Risk Charge of Trading Units (with a 99.9 % confidence level and one-year capital horizon)1,2,3

 

   

 
     Total        Fixed Income &  
Currencies  
     Structured  
Finance  
     Emerging  
Markets  - Debt  
     NCOU        Other        

in m.

     2015           2014           2015           2014           2015           2014           2015           2014           2015           2014           2015           2014       

Average

     974.9           811.9           520.3           532.8           298.4           152.2           235.2           164.1           17.6           (3.6)          (96.8)          (33.5)      

Maximum

     1,020.8           1,065.4           673.2           719.3           404.6           189.3           299.7           220.2           84.8           39.4           (56.6)          64.7       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

Minimum

     843.8           647.9           448.2           381.8           203.4           106.3           144.2           119.5           (4.8)          (25.8)          (124.1)          (88.0)      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

Period-end

     843.8           1,037.8           448.2           603.4           203.4           159.8           264.4           170.5           3.0           39.4           (75.2)          64.7         

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

1      Amounts show the bands within which the values fluctuated during the 12-week period preceding December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014.

2      All liquidity horizons are set to 12 months

3      For year-end 2014, the spot IRC was calculated as the weekly spot plus the average unrated add-on calculated from the period 14-November to 31-December 2014 to reflect the time period from the date of the BaFin letter to the end of the year. For year-end 2015, the spot IRC was calculated as the weekly spot plus the spot unrated add-on.

 

The incremental risk charge as at the end of 2015 was  844 million a decrease of  194 million (19 %) compared with year end 2014. The 12-week average incremental risk charge as at the end of 2015 was 975 million and thus 163 million (20 %) higher compared with the average for the 12-week period ended December 31, 2014. The decrease in the year-end charge was driven by inventory reductions in Distressed Products and Credit Flow Trading. For the 2014 year-end calculation, the bank was requested by BaFin to include new add-ons for Defaulted Debt and Unrated positions. As these add-ons were included for the entire Q4 2015, the average charge was higher than during the same period in 2014.

   

  

    

        

 
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    172
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

    For regulatory reporting purposes, the comprehensive risk measure for the respective reporting dates represents the higher of the internal spot value at the reporting dates, their preceding 12-week average calculation, and the floor, where the floor is equal to 8 % of the equivalent capital charge under the standardised approach securitization framework.      
 

 

Average, Maximum and Minimum Comprehensive Risk Measure of Trading Units (with a 99.9 % confidence level and one-year capital horizon)1,2,3

 

   

   

in m.

       2015            2014    
 

Average

     188.4           246.9     
 

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 
 

Maximum

     197.3           257.5     
 

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 
 

Minimum

     180.3           223.0     
 

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 
   

Period-end

     190.2           222.0     
 

 

 
 

1     Regulatory Comprehensive Risk Measure calculated for the 12-week period ending December 31.

2     Period end is based on the internal model spot value.

3     All liquidity horizons are set to 12 months.

 

The comprehensive risk measure as at the end of 2015 was  190 million and decreased by  32 million (14 %) compared with year end 2014. The 12-week average of our comprehensive risk measure as at the end of 2015 was  188 million and thus  59 million (24 %) lower compared with the average for the 12-week period ended December 31, 2014. The reduction was due to continued de-risking on this portfolio.

 

Market Risk Standardized Approach

 

As of December 31, 2015, the securitization positions, for which the specific interest rate risk is calculated using the market risk standardized approach, generated capital requirements of  810.8 million corresponding to risk weighted-assets of  10.1 billion. As of December 31, 2014 these positions generated capital requirements of  1,682 million corresponding to risk weighted-assets of  21.0 billion. The reduction is due to de-risking, which has been offset by an increase following the end of the transitional period granted by Article 337 (4) CRR as the calculation is now based on the sum of the weighted net long positions and the sum of the weighted net short positions rather than the larger of the two sums. Additionally there has been an increase from foreign exchange.

 

For nth-to-default credit default swaps the capital requirement increased to  6 million corresponding to risk weighted-assets of  78 million compared with  1 million and  19 million as of December 31, 2014 caused by the aforementioned regulatory change.

 

Additionally, the capital requirement for investment funds under the market risk standardized approach was  70 million corresponding to risk weighted-assets of  873 million as of December 31, 2015, compared with  91 million and  1,139 million as of December 31, 2014.

 

The capital requirement for longevity risk under the market risk standardized approach was  36 million for NCOU and PIRM corresponding to risk weighted-assets of  451 million as of December 31, 2015, compared with  26 million and  326 million as of December 31, 2014.

 

Value-at-Risk at Postbank

 

The value-at-risk of Postbank’s trading book calculated with a 99 % confidence level and a one-day holding period amounted to zero as of December 31, 2015 and at year-end 2014. Postbank’s current trading strategy does not allow any new trading activities with regard to the trading book. Therefore, Postbank’s trading book did not contain any positions as of December 31, 2015 and at year-end 2014. Nevertheless, Postbank will remain classified as a trading book institution.

        

        

        

     

  

         

     

     

     

  

      

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
173   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Performance   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Results of Regulatory Backtesting of Trading Market Risk

In 2015 we observed three global outliers, where our loss on a buy-and-hold basis exceeded the value-at-risk, compared with one outlier in 2014. The first outlier occurred in January 2015 and was primarily driven by losses in the Global Foreign Exchange business following the Swiss National Bank removing the Euro Swiss Franc floor. The other two outliers occurred in November and December 2015, and were driven by de-risking activity in the Non-Core Operating Unit. Based on the backtesting results, our analysis of the underlying reasons for outliers and enhancements included in our value-at-risk methodology we continue to believe that our value-at-risk model will remain an appropriate measure for our trading market risk under normal market conditions.

The following graph shows the trading units daily buy-and-hold income in comparison to the value-at-risk as of the close of the previous business day for the trading days of the reporting period. The value-at-risk is presented in negative amounts to visually compare the estimated potential loss of our trading positions with the buy and hold income. Figures are shown in millions of euro and exclude contributions from Postbank’s trading book which is calculated on a stand-alone basis. The chart shows that our trading units achieved a positive buy and hold income for 51 % of the trading days in 2015 (versus 52 % in 2014), as well as displaying the three global outlier in 2015.

 

 

LOGO

Daily Income of our Trading Units

The following histogram shows the distribution of daily income of our trading units (excluding Postbank). Daily income is defined as total income which consists of new trades, fees & commissions, buy & hold income, reserves, carry and other income. It displays the number of trading days on which we reached each level of trading income shown on the horizontal axis in millions of euro.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    174
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

 

LOGO

 

Our trading units achieved a positive revenue for 91 % of the trading days in 2015 compared with 95 % in the full year 2014.

 

Nontrading Market Risk Exposures

 

Carrying Value and Economic Capital Usage for Nontrading Market Risk Portfolios

   

 

Carrying Value and Economic Capital Usage for Nontrading Portfolios.

 

        

Carrying value  

 

Economic capital usage  

    

in m.

 

Dec 31, 2015  

 

Dec 31, 2014  

 

Dec 31, 2015  

 

Dec 31, 2014  

   

Strategic investments

  829     4,051     332     1,676  
   

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

   

Alternative assets

  6,363     3,414     2,764     1,171  
   

    Principal investments

  1,735     1,900     504     902  
   

    Other nonstrategic investment assets

  4,627     1,514     2,260     269  
   

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

   

Other nontrading market risks1

  N/M     N/M     9,782     7,051  
   

    Interest rate risk

  N/M     N/M     2,057     1,683  
   

    Credit spread risk

  N/M     N/M     1,654     319  
   

    Equity compensation risk

  N/M     N/M     405     (237) 
   

    Pension risk

  N/M     N/M     828     1,189  
   

    Structural foreign exchange risk

  N/M     N/M     3,183     2,672  
   

    Guaranteed funds risk

  N/M     N/M     1,655     1,425  
   

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

   

Total nontrading market risk portfolios

  7,192     7,465     12,878     9,898  
   

 

   

N/M – Not meaningful

1    N/M – Indicates that the risk is mostly related to off-balance sheet and liabilities items.

 

The total economic capital figures do take into account diversification benefits between interest rate & credit spread risks, equity compensation risk, pension risk and structural foreign exchange risk.

 

—  Strategic investments. Economic capital usage decreased significantly mainly driven by the reclass of our participation in Hua Xia Bank Company Limited to Non Strategic Investments.

—  Alternative assets. The nontrading market risk economic capital increased during 2015 mainly driven from the re-classification of Hua Xia Bank to Non Strategic Investments. Further increases were driven by methodology enhancements as the alignment of the Investment Risk EC model to the standard market risk SVAR based EC model.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
175   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Performance   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

—   Other nontrading market risks:

—     Interest rate risk. Besides the allocation of economic capital to outright interest rate risk in the nontrading market risk portfolio, a main component in this category is the maturity transformation of contractually short term deposits. The effective duration of contractually short term deposits is based upon observable client behavior, elasticity of deposit rates to market interest rates (“DRE”) and volatility of deposit balances. Economic capital is derived by stressing modelling assumptions in particular the DRE – for the effective duration of overnight deposits. Behavioral and economic characteristics are taken into account when calculating the effective duration and optional exposures from our mortgages businesses. In total the economic capital usage for December 31, 2015 was  2,057 million, versus  1,683 million for December 31, 2014, predominantly driven by PBC including Postbank, BHW and Deutsche Bank Bauspar and by Treasury, reflected under Consolidation & Adjustments.

—     Credit spread risk. Economic capital charge for portfolios in the banking book subject to material credit spread risk. Economic capital usage was  1,654 million as of December 31, 2015, versus  319 million as of December 31, 2014. The increase in economic capital usage was driven by methodology enhancements with regard to capturing spread risk of securities held as liquidity reserve.

—     Equity compensation risk. Risk arising from structural short position in our own share price arising from restricted equity units. The economic capital usage was  405 million as of December 31, 2015 on a diversified basis, compared with  (237) million as of December 31, 2014. The increase was predominantly driven by methodology alignment to the standard traded market risk EC model.

—     Pension risk. Risk arising from our defined benefit obligations, including interest rate risk and inflation risk, credit spread risk, equity risk and longevity risk. The economic capital usage was  828 million and  1,189 million as of December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014 respectively. The decrease is mainly caused by additional diversification benefits with other Nontrading market risk.

—     Structural foreign exchange risk. Our foreign exchange exposure arising from unhedged capital and retained earnings in non-euro currencies in certain subsidiaries. Our economic capital usage was  3,183 million as of December 31, 2015 on a diversified basis versus 2,672 million as of December 31, 2014. The increase is largely caused by the appreciation of the US dollar against the Euro.

—     Guaranteed funds risk. The increase in economic capital usage from 1.4 billion as of December 31, 2014 to  1.7 billion as of December 31, 2015 was triggered predominately by changed diversification effects and methodology enhancements.

    

           

     

      

      

      

     

   

 

Operational Risk Exposure

 

Operational Risk – Risk Profile

 

Operational Risk Losses by Event Type (Profit and Loss view)

 

  

  

  

 

in m.

       2015        20141        

Clients, Products and Business Practices

     3,667           1,806       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

Internal Fraud

     1,338           523       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

External Fraud

     475           20       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

Execution, Delivery and Process Management

     280           70       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

Others

     22           61       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

Group

     5,782           2,480       

 

   

1     Changed 2014 loss figures due to subsequent capture of losses and reclassification.

 

Profit and loss based operational losses increased by  3.3 billion or 133 % compared to year-end 2014. The increase was predominantly driven by the event types “Clients, Products and Business Practices” and “Internal Fraud”, due to settlements reached and increased litigation reserves for unsettled cases. The increase in the event type “External Fraud” is caused by a provision for equity trading fraud. The event type “Execution, Delivery and Process Management” increased, other event types decreased slightly.

        

      

 
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    176
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

LOGO

1 

Percentages in brackets correspond to loss frequency respectively to loss amount for losses occurred in 2010-2014 period. Frequency and amounts can change subsequently.

The above left pie chart “Frequency of Operational Losses” summarizes operational risk events which occurred in 2015 compared to the five-year period 2010-2014 in brackets based on the period in which a loss was first recognized for that event. For example, for a loss event that was first recognized in 2002 with an additional profit/loss event recognized in 2015, the frequency chart would not include the loss event, but the loss distribution chart would include the profit/loss recognized in the respective period.

Frequencies are driven by the event type “External Fraud” with a frequency of 44 % of all observed loss events. The event types “Clients, Product and Business Practices” contribute 42 % of the events and “Execution, Delivery and Process Management” contribute 11 %. Others are stable at 2 %. The event type “Internal Fraud” has a low frequency, resulting in less than 1 % of the loss events in the period 2015. This is unchanged compared to 2010-2014.

The above right pie chart “Distribution of Operational Losses” summarizes operational risk loss postings recognized in the profit/loss in 2015 compared to the five-year period 2010-2014. The event type “Clients, Product and Business Practices” dominates the operational loss distribution with a share of 63 % and is determined by outflows related to litigation, investigations and enforcement actions. “Internal Fraud” has the second highest share (23 %) which is related to regulatory events we have experienced in recent years. Finally, the event types “External Fraud” (8 %) and “Execution, Delivery and Process Management” (5 %) can be considered minor, compared to other event types.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
177   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Performance   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

 

Liquidity Risk Exposure

 

Funding Markets and Capital Markets Issuance

 

 

Credit markets in 2015 were affected by continued political uncertainties in the eurozone, the ongoing low interest rate environment as well as the implementation in a number of jurisdictions, including Germany, of measures intended to reduce the levels of implicit sovereign support for banks, with a consequential impact on bank senior ratings. Our 5 year CDS traded within a range of 61 to 110 bps, peaking in July. Since then, the spread has slightly declined and as of year-end was trading at the higher end of the range for the year. The spreads on our bonds exhibited similar volatility. For example, our 1.25 % EUR benchmark maturing in September 2021 traded in a range of 29 to 101 bps, closing in the middle of the range at year end.

 

Our 2015 funding plan of up to 35 billion, comprising debt issuance with an original maturity in excess of one year, was fully completed and we concluded 2015 having raised 39.1 billion in term funding. This funding was broadly spread across the following funding sources: unsecured and covered benchmark issuance ( 8.4 billion), Tier 2 benchmark issuance ( 2.8 billion), unsecured retail-targeted issuance ( 11.3 billion) and other unsecured and covered private placements ( 16.6 billion). Of the 39.1 billion total, the majority was in Euro (18.6 billion). We also issued 16.5 billion in U.S. dollar and smaller amounts in JPY and CHF. In addition to direct issuance, we use long-term cross currency swaps to manage our funding needs outside of EUR. Our investor base comprised retail customers (29 %), banks (16 %), asset managers and pension funds (22 %), insurance companies (9 %) and other institutional investors (25 %). The geographical distribution was split between Germany (22 %), rest of Europe (41 %), US (18 %), Asia/Pacific (13 %) and Other (5 %). Of our total capital markets issuance outstanding as of December 31, 2015, approximately 86 % was issued on an unsecured basis.

 

The average spread of our issuance over the relevant floating index (i.e., Libor) was 57 bps for the full year with an average tenor of 6.3 years. Our issuance activities were higher in the first half of the year with volumes decreasing in the second half of the year 2015. We issued the following volumes over each quarter:  16.9 billion, 5.5 billion, 10.4 billion and 6.3 billion, respectively.

   

 

In 2016, our base case funding plan is up to  35 billion which we plan to cover by accessing the above sources, without being overly dependent on any one source. We also plan to raise a portion of this funding in U.S. dollar and may enter into cross currency swaps to manage any residual requirements. We have total capital markets maturities, excluding legally exercisable calls of approximately 22.4 billion in 2016.

 

Funding Diversification

 

 
In 2015, total external funding grew by 56.7 billion (6 %) during the year of which the majority came in our CB&S business, in particular the increases in secured funding and shorts by 29.6 billion (37 %), in other customers by 7.4 billion (10 %) and unsecured wholesale funding by 5.6 billion (10 %) reflect increasing business activities in comparison to very low year-end levels in 2014, mainly driven by deleveraging activities in that year. We also saw increases in retail, including wealth management clients ( 10.8 billion, 4 %) and transaction banking ( 12.5 billion, 7 %). These increases more than offset the reductions in financing vehicles ( 7.9 billion, 67 %) and in capital markets and equity ( 1.5 billion, 1 %). The overall proportion of our most stable funding sources (comprising capital markets and equity, retail, and transaction banking) decreased from 76 % to 74 %. The overall volume of unsecured wholesale funding and secured funding fluctuated between reporting dates based on our underlying business activities. These fluctuations are dependent on client-related securities financing activities as well as changes in liquid trading inventories during the quarter.    
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    178
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

   

 

LOGO  

1    Other includes fiduciary, self-funding structures (e.g. X-markets), margin/Prime Brokerage cash balances (shown on a net basis).

2    Includes ABCP-Conduits.

Reference: Reconciliation to total balance sheet: Derivatives & settlement balances 528 billion ( 660 billion), add-back for netting effect for Margin & Prime Brokerage cash balances (shown on a net basis) 71 billion ( 75 billion), other non-funding liabilities 54 billion ( 54 billion) for December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014 respectively; figures may not add up due to rounding.

  

        

       

      

 

 

Maturity of unsecured wholesale funding, ABCP and capital markets issuance1

  

                                                  Dec 31, 2015  
   

 

 

 
    in m.  

Not more

than

1 month

   

Over

1 month

but not

more than

3 months

   

Over

3 months

but not

more than

6 months

   

Over

6 months

but not
more than

1 year

   

Sub-total

less than

1 year

   

Over

1 year

but not

more than

2 years

   

Over

2 years

    Total  
 

 

 

 

 

 
  Deposits from banks     11,101        8,073        3,196        1,399        23,769        143        69        23,981   
 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  Deposits from other wholesale customers     2,872        8,911        5,090        4,078        20,950        319        191        21,460   
 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  CDs and CP     1,216        3,718        3,984        5,636        14,555        298        1        14,853   
 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  ABCP     0        0        0        0        0        0        0        0   
 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  Senior unsecured plain vanilla     2,794        6,651        3,166        3,082        15,694        17,136        41,052        73,882   
 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  Senior unsecured structured notes     512        2,045        1,296        3,368        7,221        5,404        21,053        33,679   
 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  Covered bonds/ABS     0        51        1,371        75        1,496        2,460        18,056        22,012   
 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  Subordinated liabilities     734        680        263        310        1,987        1,376        16,199        19,562   
 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  Other     0        0        0        0        0        0        0        0   
 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
 

Total 2

    19,229        30,129        18,367        17,948        85,673        27,136        96,621        209,430   
 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  thereof:                
 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
 

Secured

    0        51        1,371        75        1,496        2,460        18,056        22,012   
 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
 

Unsecured

    19,229        30,078        16,996        17,873        84,176        24,677        78,565        187,418   
 

 

 
 

1    Includes additional tier 1 notes reported as additional equity components in the financial statements, numbers for 2014 were restated accordingly.

2    Liabilities with call features are shown at earliest legally exercisable call date. No assumption is made as to whether such calls would be exercised.

        

        

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
179   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Performance   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

The total volume of unsecured wholesale liabilities, ABCP and capital markets issuance maturing within one year amount to  86 billion as of December 31, 2015, and should be viewed in the context of our total Liquidity Reserves of  215 billion.

 

                                                      Dec 31, 2014    
  

 

 

 

in m.

  

Not more  
than  

1 month  

    

Over  

1 month  
but not  
more than  

3 months  

    

Over  

3 months  
but not  
more than  
6 months  

    

Over  

6 months  
but not  
more than  
1 year  

     Sub-total  
less than  
1 year  
    

Over  

1 year  

but not  
more than  
2 years  

    

Over  

2 years  

     Total    
  

 

 

 
Deposits from banks      7,816           5,373           7,930           2,541           23,661           42           350           24,053     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Deposits from other wholesale customers      2,828           1,569           2,979           2,387           9,763           306           404           10,473     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
CDs and CP      1,747           4,629           8,080           5,623           20,080           20           28           20,128     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
ABCP      2,849           233           0           0           3,082           0           0           3,082     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Senior unsecured plain vanilla      756           2,823           4,589           4,978           13,145           12,904           40,031           66,080     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Senior unsecured structured notes      528           1,721           2,384           3,655           8,288           3,698           22,242           34,227     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Covered bonds/ABS      0           11           1,223           458           1,693           1,701           20,325           23,719     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Subordinated liabilities      636           2,352           1,772           799           5,559           537           14,508           20,604     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Other      0           0           0           166           166           13           131           310     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total 1

     17,161           18,711           28,958           20,607           85,437           19,220           98,020           202,676     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

thereof:

                       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Secured

     2,849           244           1,223           458           4,775           1,701           20,325           26,801     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Unsecured

     14,311           18,467           27,735           20,149           80,662           17,519           77,695           175,875     

 

 
  1 

Liabilities with call features are shown at earliest legally exercisable call date. No assumption is made as to whether such calls would be exercised.

The following table shows the currency breakdown of our short-term unsecured wholesale funding, of our ABCP funding and of our capital markets issuance.

Unsecured wholesale funding, ABCP and capital markets issuance (currency breakdown)

 

                       Dec 31,2015                          Dec 31,2014  
  

 

 

   

 

 

 
in m.    in EUR       in USD       in GBP       in other  
CCYs  
    Total       in EUR        in USD        in GBP        in other  
CCYs  
     Total    

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Deposits from banks      4,875          17,066          1,053          987          23,981          6,123           15,738           284           1,907           24,053     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Deposits from other whole- sale customers      15,912          4,257          476          815          21,460          3,379           4,621           800           1,673           10,473     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
CDs and CP      10,771          1,202          1,843          1,038          14,853          13,572           3,216           1,655           1,685           20,128     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
ABCP      0          0          0          0          0          312           2,674           96           0           3,082     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Senior unsecured plain vanilla      47,576          20,573          110       

 

5,623  

  

    73,882          43,498           16,923           378           5,282           66,080     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Senior unsecured structured notes      10,342          19,322          176          3,838          33,679          12,136           16,884           168           5,038           34,227     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Covered bonds/ ABS      21,952          60          0          0          22,012          23,653           66           0           0           23,719     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Subordinated liabilities      8,507          9,858          800          397          19,562          9,617           9,802           791           394           20,604     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other

     0          0          0          0          0          72           218           0           20           310     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     119,935          72,338          4,459          12,698          209,430          112,363           70,141           4,173           16,000           202,676     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

thereof:

                        

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Secured

     21,952          60          0          0          22,012          23,965           2,740           96           0           26,801     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Unsecured

     97,984         72,278         4,459         12,697         187,418         88,398           67,402           4,076           16,000           175,875     

 

 

 

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    180
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Liquidity Reserves

 

Composition of our freely transferable liquidity reserves by parent company (including branches) and subsidiaries

  

   

            Dec 31, 2015               Dec 31, 2014    
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

in bn.

     Carrying Value           Liquidity Value           Carrying Value           Liquidity Value     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Available cash and cash equivalents (held primarily at central banks)

     98           98           65           65     

Parent (incl. foreign branches)

     75           75           54           54     

Subsidiaries

     23           23           11           11     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Highly liquid securities (includes government, government guaranteed and agency securities)      100           94           103           96     

Parent (incl. foreign branches)

     78           73           81           75     

Subsidiaries

     22           21           23           20     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Other unencumbered central bank eligible securities      17           13           16           11     

Parent (incl. foreign branches)

     14           11           14           10     

Subsidiaries

     3           2           2           1     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total liquidity reserves

     215           205           184           171     

Parent (incl. foreign branches)

     167           159           149           139     

Subsidiaries

     48          46          35          32     

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2015, our freely transferable liquidity reserves amounted to  215 billion compared with  184 billion as of December 31, 2014. The primary driver of the increase of  31 billion in 2015 was a growth of  34 billion in our available-cash and cash equivalents during the year mainly driven by increased external funding sources, together with small decrease in our highly-liquid securities. Our average liquidity reserves during the year were  202.2 billion compared with  189.8 billion during 2014. In the table above the carrying value represents the market value of our liquidity reserves while the liquidity value reflects our assumption of the value that could be obtained, primarily through secured funding, taking into account the experience observed in secured funding markets at times of stress.

 

The liquidity value (weighted) of our Liquidity Reserves of  205 billion exceeds the liquidity value (weighted) of our High Quality Liquid Assets (HQLA) of  192 billion. The major drivers of this difference are: Liquidity Reserves include central bank eligible but otherwise less liquid securities (for example traded loans, other investment-grade corporate bonds and ABS) which are not recognised in HQLA; HQLA includes major index equities, but excludes cash balances deposited with central banks to satisfy a minimum cash requirements as well as cash balances deposited with non EU Central Banks rated below AA- which are included in the LCR but not as part of the HQLA.

 

Liquidity Coverage Ratio

 

Our LCR of 119 % as of December 31, 2015 has been calculated in accordance with the Commission Delegated Regulation (EU) 2015/61 (calculated in accordance with the EBA’s Implementing Technical Standard on Supervisory Reporting with regard to the LCR).

 

LCR components

 

         

         

  

    

  

 

     Dec 31, 2015  

 

  

 

 

 
in bn.    Liquidity Value
(weighted)
 

 

  

 

 

 

High quality liquid assets

     192   

 

  

 

 

 

Gross inflows

     111   

 

  

 

 

 

Gross outflows

     272   

 

  

 

 

 

Net outflows

     161   

 

  

 

 

 

LCR ratio in %

     119   

 

  

 

 

 
  

Funding Risk Management

Structural Funding

Both the aggregate currency and the U.S. dollar funding matrices were in line with the respective risk appetite as of year ends 2015 and 2014, and the GBP funding matrix exceeded risk appetite as of year end 2015.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
181   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Performance   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Stress Testing and Scenario Analysis

Global All Currency Monthly Stress Testing Results

 

                   Dec 31, 2015                       Dec 31, 20141         
  

 

 

    

 

 

   
in bn.        Funding  
Gap2  
     Gap  
Closure3  
     Net Liquidity  
Position4  
     Funding  
Gap2  
     Gap  
Closure3  
     Net Liquidity  
Position4  
     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   
Systemic market risk      71            218            147            49            183            134        

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   
Emerging markets      14            190            176            9            185            176        

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   
1 notch downgrade (DB specific)      51            200            148            42            166            124        

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   
Severe downgrade (DB specific)      188            240            53            163            202            38        

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   
Combined 5      218            264            46            190            214            24          

 

     
       
1 

2014 figures are based on the prevailing methodology at the time and are not restated to reflect any changes to stress testing assumptions that have been implemented during the year.

2 

Funding gap caused by impaired rollover of liabilities and other projected outflows.

3 

Based on liquidity generation through Liquidity Reserves and other countermeasures.

4 

All scenarios showing 8 week point.

5 

Combined impact of systemic market risk and severe downgrade.

Global USD Monthly Stress Testing Results

 

                   Dec 31, 2015                    Dec 31, 20141    
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
in bn.      Funding  
Gap2  
     Gap  
  Closure3  
       Net Liquidity  
Position4  
       Funding  
Gap2  
     Gap  
  Closure3  
       Net Liquidity  
Position4  
 

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Combined5      102           163            61            92            149            56      

 

 

 

1 

2014 figures are based on the prevailing methodology at the time and are not restated to reflect any changes to stress testing assumptions that have been implemented during the year.

2 

Funding gap caused by impaired rollover of liabilities and other projected outflows.

3 

Based on liquidity generation through Liquidity Reserves and other countermeasures.

4 

All scenarios showing 8 week point.

5 

Combined impact of systemic market risk and severe downgrade.

Global GBP Monthly Stress Testing Results

 

                   Dec 31, 2015  
  

 

 

 
in bn.     
 
Funding  
Gap1  
  
  
    
 
Gap  
Closure2  
  
  
    
 
Net Liquidity  
Position3  
  
  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Combined4      10           32           22     

 

 
1 

Funding gap caused by impaired rollover of liabilities and other projected outflows.

2 

Based on liquidity generation through Liquidity Reserves and other countermeasures.

3 

All scenarios showing 8 week point.

4 

Combined impact of systemic market risk and severe downgrade.

The following table presents the amount of additional collateral required in the event of a one- or two-notch downgrade by rating agencies for all currencies.

Additional Contractual Obligations

 

            Dec 31, 2015               Dec 31, 2014    
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
in m.    One-notch  
downgrade  
     Two-notch  
downgrade  
     One-notch  
downgrade  
     Two-notch  
downgrade  
 

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Contractual derivatives funding or margin requirements

     4,332           6,472           6,806           7,893     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other contractual funding or margin requirements

     317           1,459           529           689     

 

 

Asset Encumbrance

This section refers to asset encumbrance in the group of institutions consolidated for banking regulatory purposes pursuant to the German Banking Act. Thereunder not included are insurance companies or companies outside the finance sector. Assets pledged by our insurance subsidiaries are included in Note 22 “Assets Pledged and Received as Collateral” of the Consolidated Financial Statements, and restricted assets held to satisfy obligations to insurance companies’ policy holders are included within Note 39 “Information on Subsidiaries” of the Consolidated Financial Statements.

Encumbered assets primarily comprise those on- and off-balance sheet assets that are pledged as collateral against secured funding, collateral swaps, and other collateralized obligations. Additionally, in line with the EBA technical standards on regulatory asset encumbrance reporting, we consider assets placed with settlement

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    182
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

systems, including default funds and initial margins as encumbered, as well as other assets pledged which cannot be freely withdrawn such as mandatory minimum reserves at central banks. We also include derivative margin receivable assets as encumbered under these EBA guidelines.

Readily available assets are those on- and off-balance sheet assets that are not otherwise encumbered, and which are in freely transferrable form. Unencumbered financial assets at fair value, other than securities borrowed or purchased under resale agreements and positive market value from derivatives, and available for sale investments are all assumed to be readily available.

The readily available value represents the current balance sheet carrying value rather than any form of stressed liquidity value (see the “Liquidity Reserves” for an analysis of unencumbered liquid assets available under a liquidity stress scenario). Other unencumbered on- and off-balance sheet assets are those assets that have not been pledged as collateral against secured funding or other collateralized obligations, or are otherwise not considered to be ready available. Included in this category are securities borrowed or purchased under resale agreements and positive market value from derivatives. Similarly, for loans and other advances to customers, these would only be viewed as readily available to the extent they are already in a pre-packaged transferrable format, and have not already been used to generate funding. This represents the most conservative view given that an element of such loans currently shown in other could be packaged into a format that would be suitable for use to generate funding.

Encumbered and unencumbered assets

 

                          Dec 31, 2015    
  

 

 

 
                          Carrying value    
  

 

 

 
                   Unencumbered assets    
        

 

 

 

in bn.

(unless stated otherwise)

   Assets        Encumbered  
assets  
     Readily  
available  
     Other    

 

  

 

 

 

Debt securities

     215           74           141           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Equity instruments

     76           49           28           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other assets:

           

Cash and due from banks & Interest earning deposits with Banks

     107           11           96           0     

Securities borrowed or purchased under resale agreements1

     56           0           0           56     

Financial assets at fair value through profit and loss2

           

Trading assets

     17           0           17           0     

Positive market value from derivative financial instruments

     518           0           0           518     

Securities borrowed or purchased under resale agreements1

     73           0           0           73     

Other financial assets at fair value through profit or loss

     12           0           12           0     

Financial assets available for sale2

     3           0           3           0     

Loans

     424           45           11           368     

Other assets

     132           59           0           74     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     1,632           238           307           1,087     

 

 
1 

Securities borrowed and securities purchased under resale agreements are all shown as other unencumbered. The use of the underlying collateral is separately captured in the off-balance sheet table below.

2 

Excludes Debt securities and Equity instruments (separately disclosed above).

 

                          Dec 31, 2015    
  

 

 

 
            Fair value of collateral received    
  

 

 

 
                   Unencumbered assets    

in bn.

(unless stated otherwise)

   Assets        Encumbered  
assets  
     Readily  
available  
     Other    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Collateral received:

     285           238           46           1     

Debt securities

     197           152           45           0     

Equity instruments

     87           86           1           0     

Other collateral received

     1           0           0           1     

 

 

 

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
183   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
   

u Risk and Capital Performance

  Explanatory Report – 239
   

Compensation Report – 188

 
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

                          Dec 31, 2014    
  

 

 

 
                          Carrying value    
  

 

 

 
                   Unencumbered assets    
        

 

 

 

in bn.

(unless stated otherwise)

   Assets        Encumbered  
assets  
     Readily  
available   
     Other    

 

  

 

 

 

Debt securities

     184           42           142           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Equity instruments

     70           50           20           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other assets:

           

Cash and due from banks & Interest earning deposits with Banks

     82           7           75           0     

Securities borrowed or purchased under resale agreements1

     44           0           0           44     

Financial assets at fair value through profit and loss2

           

Trading assets

     17           0           17           0     

Positive market value from derivative financial instruments

     630           0           0           630     

Securities borrowed or purchased under resale agreements1

     81           0           0           81     

Other financial assets at fair value through profit or loss

     15           0           15           0     

Financial assets available for sale2

     3           0           3           0     

Loans

     398           45           19           334     

Other assets

     158           63           0           95     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     1,681           207           291           1,183     

 

 

 

                          Dec 31, 2014    
  

 

 

 
            Fair value of collateral received    
  

 

 

 
                   Unencumbered assets    
in bn.
(unless stated otherwise)
   Assets        Encumbered  
assets  
     Readily  
available  
     Other    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Collateral received:

     253           202           50           1     

Debt securities

     175           127           48           0     

Equity instruments

     76           75           1           0     

Other collateral received

     1           0           0           1     

 

 

The above tables set out a breakdown of on- and off-balance sheet items, broken down between encumbered, readily available and other. Any securities borrowed or purchased under resale agreements are shown based on the fair value of collateral received.

The above tables of encumbered assets include assets that are not encumbered at an individual entity level, but which may be subject to restrictions in terms of their transferability within the group. Such restrictions may be due to local connected lending requirements or similar regulatory restrictions. In this situation it is not feasible to identify individual balance sheet items that cannot be transferred.

Maturity Analysis of Assets and Financial Liabilities

Treasury manages the maturity analysis of assets and liabilities. Modelling of assets and liabilities is necessary in cases where the contractual maturity does not adequately reflect the liquidity risk position. The most significant example in this context would be immediately repayable deposits from retail and transaction banking customers which have consistently displayed high stability throughout even the most severe financial crises.

The modelling profiles are part of the overall liquidity risk management framework (see section “Stress Test” for short-term liquidity positions £ 1year and section “Funding Matrix” for long-term liquidity positions > 1year) which is defined and approved by the Management Board.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    184
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

The following tables present a maturity analysis of our total assets based on carrying value and upon earliest legally exercisable maturity as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

Analysis of the earliest contractual maturity of assets

 

   

 

    Dec 31, 2015    

in m.

  On  
demand  
(incl.  
Overnight  
and  

one day  
notice)  
    Up to  
one  
month  
    Over  
1 month  
to no  
more  
than  

3 months  
    Over  
3 months  
but no  
more  
than  

6 months  
    Over  
6 months  
but no  
more  
than  

9 months  
    Over  
9 months  
but no  
more  
than  

1 year  
    Over  
1 year  
but no   
more  
than  

2 years  
    Over  
2 years  
but no  
more  
than 5  
years  
    Over  
5 years  
    Total    
Cash and central bank balances     94,290          337          0          0          0          2,313          0          0          0          96,940     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Interbank balances (w/o central banks)     7,703          2,115          434          341          1          2,025          83          100          40          12,842     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Central bank funds sold     0          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Securities purchased under resale agreements     450          8,293          5,530          4,539          1,861          568          888          328          0          22,456     

With banks

    426          7,050          5,091          3,648          1,601          311          647          0          0          18,773     

With customers

    24          1,243          440          890          260          258          241          328          0          3,683     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Securities borrowed     30,335          3,221          0          0          0          0          0          1          0          33,557     

With banks

    3,462          159          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          3,622     

With customers

    26,873          3,062          0          0          0          0          0          1          0          29,935     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Financial assets at fair value through profit or loss – trading     735,748          35,190          6,176          3,652          1,318          1,298          5,173          6,599          25,727          820,883     

Trading assets

    196,035          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          196,035     

Fixed-income securities and loans

    118,671          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          118,671     

Equities and other variable- income securities

    76,044          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          76,044     

Other trading assets

    1,320          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          1,320     

Positive market values from derivative financial instruments

    515,594          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          515,594     

Financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss

    24,119          35,190          6,176          3,652          1,318          1,298          5,173          6,599          25,727          109,253     

Securities purchased under resale agreements

    6,139          31,257          5,449          2,344          503          341          1,690          2,384          965          51,073     

Securities borrowed

    17,898          3,544          47          0          0          0          0          0          0          21,489     

Fixed-income securities and loans

    79          376          656          1,303          791          448          3,483          4,214          14,532          25,883     

Equities and other variable- income securities

    0          4          0          0          0          155          0          0          10,230          10,389     

Other financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss

    2          9          24          5          24          354          0          1          0          419     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Positive market values from derivative financial instruments qualifying for hedge accounting     0          9          71          75          139          58          142          716          1,925          3,136     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Financial assets available for sale     18          966          1,941          1,543          893          1,998          8,832          22,880          34,513          73,583     

Fixed-income securities and loans

    6          481          1,937          1,543          893          952          8,815          22,869          33,873          71,368     

Equities and other variable- income securities

    12          485          3          0          0          1,046          17          12          640          2,215     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loans

    20,375          31,464          27,851          30,337          9,142          11,313          24,272          71,890          201,104          427,749     

To banks

    543          2,137          3,829          1,858          1,703          870          726          1,592        926          14,183     

To customers

    19,832          29,327          24,022          28,480          7,439          10,442          23,546          70,299          200,177          413,565     

Retail

    5,363          6,048          6,102          3,065          2,536          2,874          6,743          18,787          149,127          200,646     

Corporates and other customers

    14,470          23,279          17,920          25,415          4,903          7,568          16,803          51,512          51,050          212,919     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other financial assets     94,078          932          1,479          564          254          1,003          115          62          66          98,555     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total financial assets     982,997          82,528          43,483          41,051          13,608          20,577          39,505          102,576          263,374          1,589,700     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other assets     26,341          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          13,089          39,430     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

    1,009,338          82,528          43,483          41,051          13,608          20,577          39,505          102,576          276,463          1,629,130     

 

 

 

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
185   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Performance   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

Analysis of the earliest contractual maturity of assets

 

    Dec 31, 2014    

in m.

  On  
demand  
(incl.  

Overnight  
and  
one day  
notice)  
    Up to  
one  
month  
    Over 1  
month  
to no  
more  
than 3  
months  
    Over 3  
months  
but no  
more  
than 6  
months  
    Over 6  
months  
but no  
more  
than 9  
months  
    Over 9  
months  
but no  
more  
than 1  
year  
    Over 1  
year  
but no  
more  
than 2  
years  
    Over 2  
years  
but no  
more  
than 5  
years  
    Over 5  
years  
    Total    

Cash and central bank balances 1

    73,515          198          104          0          0          562          0          0          103          74,482     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Interbank balances

(w/o central banks) 1

    4,987          2,497          90          16          15          1,217          101          120          48          9,090     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Central bank funds sold

    0          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Securities purchased under resale agreements     4          3,553          2,416          8,143          1,659          1,719          51          240          12          17,796     

With banks

    4          2,154          533          647          333          561          0          2          12          4,245     

With customers

    0          1,399          1,883          7,496          1,326          1,159          51          238          0          13,551     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Securities borrowed

    21,598          4,202          0          0          0          0          0          0          34          25,834     

With banks

    550          964          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          1,515     

With customers

    21,047          3,238          0          0          0          0          0          0          34          24,319     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Financial assets at fair value through profit or loss – trading     840,858          43,382          12,360          5,371          2,068          2,090          4,855          7,624          24,316          942,924     

Trading assets

    195,681          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          195,681     

Fixed-income securities and loans

    124,462          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          124,462     

Equities and other variable- income securities

    69,831          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          69,831     

Other trading assets

    1,387          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          1,387     

Positive market values from derivative financial instruments

    629,958          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          629,958     

Financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss

    15,219          43,382          12,360          5,371          2,068          2,090          4,855          7,624          24,316          117,285     

Securities purchased under resale agreements

    1,757          36,255          11,109          4,568          1,883          501          1,530          1,849          1,021          60,473     

Securities borrowed

    13,462          5,783          1,159          0          0          0          0          0          0          20,404     

Fixed-income securities and loans

    0          1,344          92          660          184          1,588          3,010          5,775          12,957          25,612     

Equities and other variable- income securities

    0          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          10,339          10,339     

Other financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss

    0          0          0          142          0          1          315          0          0          459     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Positive market values from derivative financial instruments qualifying for hedge accounting     0          30          140          108          69          37          177          791          3,050          4,403     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial assets available for sale

    20          1,895          1,610          2,797          643          774          4,702          25,756          26,099          64,297     

Fixed-income securities and loans

    20          1,895          1,610          2,797          643          774          4,408          25,754          24,137          62,038     

Equities and other variable- income securities

    0          0          0          0          0          0          295          2          1,962          2,259     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loans

    19,917          35,866          32,121          26,780          9,101          11,591          26,638          69,501          174,098          405,612     

To banks

    880          4,744          4,945          4,986          1,321          944          2,859          1,974          408          23,059     

To customers

    19,037          31,122          27,176          21,794          7,780          10,647          23,779          67,528          173,690          382,553     

Retail

    3,947          10,852          4,038          4,836          2,884          3,288          9,491          25,572          131,277          196,186     

Corporates and other customers

    15,090          20,270          23,138          16,959          4,896          7,359          14,288          41,955          42,412          186,367     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other financial assets

    119,485          474          387          349          113          99          18          76          4,050          125,050     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total financial assets     1,080,383          92,098          49,228          43,564          13,668          18,089          36,542          104,108          231,809          1,669,490     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other assets     15,514          1,322          707          626          196          260          268          763          19,559          39,214     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total assets     1,095,897          93,421          49,935          44,189          13,864          18,349          36,809          104,871          251,368          1,708,703     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
1 

In 2015, comparatives have been restated. See Note 1 “Significant Accounting Policies and Critical Accounting Estimates – Significant Changes in Estimates and Changes in Presentation” for detailed information.


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    186
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

The following tables present a maturity analysis of our total liabilities based on carrying value and upon earliest legally exercisable maturity as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

Analysis of the earliest contractual maturity of liabilities

 

     Dec 31, 2015    

in m.

   On  
demand  
(incl. Over-  
night  

and  
one day  
notice)  
     Up to  
one  
month  
     Over 1  
month  

to no  
more  
than 3  

months  
     Over 3  
months  
but no  
more  
than 6  

months  
     Over 6  
months  
but no  
more  
than 9  
months  
     Over 9  
months  
but no  
more  
than 1  
year  
     Over 1  
year  
but no  
more  
than 2  
years  
     Over 2  
years  

but no  
more  
than 5  
years  
     Over 5  
years  
     Total    

Deposits

     345,569           37,777           117,943           21,500           10,169           8,600           7,356           6,935           11,126           566,974     

Due to banks

     72,304           5,131           15,770           5,884           1,616           2,106           2,188           5,214           8,852           119,065     

Due to customers

     273,265           32,646           102,173           15,616           8,552           6,494           5,168           1,721           2,273           447,909     

Retail

     113,016           13,588           80,124           3,270           2,131           1,805           2,524           642           220           217,321     

Corporates and other customers

     160,249           19,058           22,049           12,346           6,422           4,689           2,644           1,079           2,053           230,588     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Trading liabilities

     546,381           0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0           546,381     

Trading securities

     51,327           0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0           51,327     

Other trading liabilities

     977           0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0           977     

Negative market values from derivative financial instruments

     494,076           0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0           494,076     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Financial liabilities designed at fair value through profit or loss (without loan commitments and financial guarantees)      18,423           4,725           1,569           1,760           1,240           10,069           1,809           1,652           3,526           44,773     

Securities sold under repurchase agreements

     17,600           2,712           690           1,172           140           9,322           0           0           0           31,637     

Long-term debt

     269           47           342           426           879           513           1,669           1,384           3,183           8,710     

Other financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss

     554           1,966           537           162           221           233           141           268           343           4,425     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Investment contract liabilities

     0           35           70           70           70           734           108           1,593           5,843           8,522     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Negative market values from derivative financial instruments qualifying for hedge accounting      0           43           513           414           203           301           278           1,630           2,983           6,365     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Central bank funds purchased

     574           0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0           574     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Securities sold under repurchase agreements      7,492           1,567           53           117           0           0           0           0           0           9,229     

Due to banks

     2,757           1,554           53           117           0           0           0           0           0           4,481     

Due to customers

     4,734           13           0           0           0           0           0           0           0           4,747     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Securities loaned

     2,846           10           1           0           0           0           0           0           414           3,270     

Due to banks

     290           6           0           0           0           0           0           0           0           295     

Due to customers

     2,556           5           1           0           0           0           0           0           414           2,975     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other short term borrowings

     17,776           1,311           2,052           2,666           3,006           1,199           0           0           0           28,010     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Long-term debt

     0           3,327           8,638           6,923           4,251           2,990           39,801           45,435           48,652           160,016     

Debt securities – senior

     0           3,184           8,444           5,815           3,782           2,631           24,701           40,061           36,599           125,217     

Debt securities – subordinated

     0           0           0           619           150           100           0           1,314           4,231           6,414     

Other long-term debt – senior

     0           143           194           247           173           162           14,978           3,575           7,502           26,973     

Other long-term debt – subordinated

     0           0           0           243           146           97           121           486           319           1,412     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Trust Preferred Securities

     0           733           0           262           0           0           735           4,373           918           7,020     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Other financial liabilities      146,678           931           2,859           198           83           170           340           14           36           151,309     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Total financial liabilities      1,085,739           50,458           133,696           33,911           19,023           24,063           50,426           61,633           73,496           1,532,443     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Other liabilities      28,984           0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0           28,984     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Total equity      0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0           67,624           67,624     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total liabilities and equity

     1,114,722           50,458           133,696           33,911           19,023           24,063           50,426           61,633           141,120           1,629,051     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Off-balance sheet commitments given

     6,433           9,833           8,772           17,963           10,036           14,221           29,240           107,376           27,999           231,874     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Banks

     425           406           1,405           2,354           1,301           1,059           1,512           1,213           177           9,852     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Retail

     231           166           103           687           678           945           2,272           1,605           7,272           13,958     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Corporates and other customers

     5,778           9,261           7,265           14,923           8,057           12,218           25,456           104,559           20,549           208,063     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 


Table of Contents

187

  Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    u Risk and Capital Performance   Explanatory Report – 239
    Compensation Report – 188  
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

Analysis of the earliest contractual maturity of liabilities

 

    Dec 31, 2014    

in m.

  On  
demand  
(incl. Over-  
night  

and  
one day  
notice)  
    Up to  
one  
month  
    Over 1  
month  

to no  
more  
than 3  

months  
    Over 3  
months  
but no  
more  
than 6  

months  
    Over 6  
months  
but no  
more  
than 9  
months  
    Over 9  
months  
but no  
more  
than 1  
year  
    Over 1  
year  
but no  
more  
than 2  
years  
    Over 2  
years  

but no  
more  
than 5  
years  
    Over 5  
years  
    Total    

Deposits

    298,701          45,396          114,001          31,733          9,820          8,832          5,557          7,618          11,276          532,931     

Due to banks

    55,538          6,866          12,896          10,400          3,243          1,862          2,593          5,741          9,212          108,350     

Due to customers

    243,163          38,530          101,105          21,333          6,577          6,970          2,964          1,878          2,064          424,584     

Retail

    96,651          18,777          83,460          4,919          2,105          1,816          1,095          744          215          209,781     

Corporates and other customers

    146,512          19,753          17,645          16,414          4,473          5,154          1,869          1,134          1,849          214,803     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Trading liabilities

    652,045          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          652,045     

Trading securities

    41,112          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          41,112     

Other trading liabilities

    731          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          731     

Negative market values from derivative financial instruments

    610,202          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          610,202     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Financial liabilities designed at fair value through profit or loss (without loan commitments and financial guarantees)     2,560          6,612          4,573          12,082          1,300          1,047          2,263          2,909          3,686          37,032     

Securities sold under repurchase agreements

    1,361          4,241          3,711          11,058          393          0          288          0          0          21,053     

Long-term debt

    6          116          334          734          553          672          1,582          2,716          3,205          9,919     

Other financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss

    1,193          2,255          527          289          355          375          394          193          481          6,061     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Investment contract liabilities

    0          30          61          61          61          726          93          1,493          5,999          8,523     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Negative market values from derivative financial instruments qualifying for hedge accounting     0          42          240          350          231          55          398          1,145          2,602          5,063     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Central bank funds purchased

    986          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          986     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Securities sold under repurchase agreements     3,677          1,397          3,225          1,001          202          400          0          0          0          9,901     

Due to banks

    3,518          1,170          3,155          1,001          202          400          0          0          0          9,445     

Due to customers

    158          227          70          0          0          0          0          0          0          456     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Securities loaned

    1,960          15          1          0          0          0          0          0          363          2,339     

Due to banks

    130          5          0          0          0          0          0          0          1          136     

Due to customers

    1,830          10          1          0          0          0          0          0          361          2,203     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other short term borrowings

    26,642          5,099          2,766          4,499          1,995          1,929          0          0          0          42,931     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Long-term debt

    0          1,027          4,778          6,261          6,401          7,272          24,219          51,257          43,622          144,837     

Debt securities – senior

    0          923          3,833          5,190          5,616          6,767          18,224          46,138          32,755          119,446     

Debt securities – subordinated

    0          0          645          262          601          236          500          169          2,633          5,047     

Other long-term debt – senior

    0          104          300          750          148          124          5,291          4,351          7,930          18,999     

Other long-term debt – subordinated

    0          0          0          59          35          145          205          598          304          1,345     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Trust Preferred Securities

    0          832          3,053          655          89          277          726          4,757          184          10,573     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other financial liabilities     155,055          884          3,126          217          78          174          352          20          23          159,929     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total financial liabilities     1,141,627          61,336          135,822          56,857          20,177          20,712          33,608          69,200          67,754          1,607,093     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other liabilities     28,288          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          28,288     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total equity     0          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          73,223          73,223     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities and equity

    1,169,915          61,336          135,822          56,857          20,177          20,712          33,608          69,200          140,976          1,708,604     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Off-balance sheet commitments given

    6,924          10,505          10,433          16,063          10,182          15,092          28,165          93,727          25,441          216,533     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Banks

    203          815          1,995          2,316          696          1,009          1,873          1,700          761          11,368     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Retail

    682          324          284          548          526          1,009          2,183          1,010          6,817          13,383     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Corporates and other customers

    6,039          9,366          8,154          13,199          8,960          13,075          24,108          91,017          17,864          191,782     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    188
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Compensation Report

Introduction

The 2015 Compensation Report provides detailed qualitative and quantitative compensation information with regard to the overall Deutsche Bank Group (except for Deutsche Postbank AG, who provides disclosures separately). Furthermore, it contains disclosures specific to the Management Board members and employees identified as Material Risk Takers (MRTs) in accordance with the German regulation on the supervisory requirements for compensation systems of banks (Institutsvergütungsverordnung, “InstVV”).

The report comprises the following sections:

 

 

Group compensation overview and disclosure

 

Management Board report and disclosure

 

Supervisory Board report and disclosure

The report complies with the requirements of Section 314 (1) No. 6 of the German Commercial Code (Handelsgesetzbuch, “HGB”), the German Accounting Standard No. 17 “Reporting on Executive Body Remuneration”, CRR, InstVV, and the recommendations of the German Corporate Governance Code.

 

Group Compensation and Disclosure

Executive Summary

Year 2015 was strongly influenced by the launch of Strategy 2020 and the impact on the Bank’s financial results of extraordinary items, foremost the impairment of goodwill.

The Bank’s compensation decisions for 2015 had to carefully balance the loss reported for the 2015 against the positive revenue developments and the overall capital position. In light of these considerations, the Management Board decided to grant Variable Compensation (VC) in the amount of  2.4 billion to its employees. Applying the foreign exchange rates used for the 2015 VC pool to the 2014 VC pool, this represents a decrease compared to 2014 by approximately 17 %.

The Bank remains committed to align compensation with the long-term performance of the institution. Against this background, the proportion of VC which will be paid or delivered at a later stage remains high at 49 % (including equity upfront compensation elements). To further underpin this alignment, 33 % was awarded in shares. For Material Risk Takers (MRTs), the proportion subject to a payment or delivery at a later stage amounted to 88 %.

In light of the negative result for 2015, the VC for 2015 was also granted with a view to ensuring stability of the franchise and with the expectation of a positive and sustainable development over the next years. Against this background, it was important to the Bank that this expectation is also reflected in the structure of the VC. The Bank therefore decided to take additional steps towards an alignment between VC and a sustainable performance by increasing the minimum deferral period for the deferred compensation elements from three to four years for all employees receiving deferred compensation elements. Additionally, the retention period for equity upfront compensation elements for MRTs was increased to one year. These measures are accompanied by the introduction of strengthened methods for an ex post risk adjustment of VC which allow for a subsequent decrease or complete elimination of VC.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
189   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

With the aim to ensure that the Bank’s approach to compensation remains aligned to its multi-year objectives under Strategy 2020, the Bank has also implemented a new compensation structure for 2016 onwards (the New Compensation Framework). This new structure places stronger emphasis on fixed compensation as well as a closer and more transparent link between the overall Group performance and individual VC decisions.

 

Compensation Strategy

Compensation plays an integral role in the successful delivery of Deutsche Bank’s strategic objectives. The Group Compensation Strategy is predicated on supporting a global, client-centric banking model with safe and sound compensation practices that operate within the Bank’s capital, liquidity and risk-bearing capacity, and in alignment with the Bank’s strategic objectives and its stated values and beliefs.

 

  Five key objectives of our compensation practices

      

  Core remuneration principles

—     To support the delivery of Deutsche Bank’s client-focused, global bank strategy by attracting and retaining talent across the range of diverse business models and across numerous country locations

—     To support the long term performance of the Bank, the sustainable development of the institution and the risk strategies that derive from this

—     To support long-term performance that is predicated on cost discipline and efficiency

—     To ensure that the Bank’s compensation practices are safe in terms of risk-adjusting performance outcomes, preventing inappropriate risk taking, ensuring compatibility with capital and liquidity planning and complying with regulation

—     To underscore the Bank’s stated values of integrity, sustainable performance, client centricity, innovation, discipline and partnership

 

LOGO

  

 

—     Align compensation to shareholder interests and sustained firm-wide profitability, taking account of risk and the cost of capital

—     Maximize sustainable employee and firm performance

—     Attract and retaining the best talent

—     Calibrate compensation to different divisions and levels of responsibility

—     Apply a simple and transparent compensation design

—     Ensure compliance with regulatory requirements

The Group Compensation Policy is an internal document focused on informing and educating employees with regard to the Bank’s compensation strategy, governance processes as well as compensation practices and structures. Together, the Group Compensation Strategy and the Group Compensation Policy provide a clear and demonstrable link between compensation practices and the wider Group strategy. Both documents have been published on the Bank’s intranet site and are available to all employees.

Regulatory Compliance

Ensuring compliance with regulatory requirements is an overriding consideration in the Bank’s Group Compensation Strategy. The Bank has strived to be at the forefront of compensation regulatory changes and will continue to work with its prudential supervisor, the European Central Bank (ECB), to be in compliance with all existing and new requirements.

As an EU-headquartered institution, Deutsche Bank is subject to the CRD 4 requirements, as translated into German national law in the German Banking Act and InstVV, globally. The Bank adopted the rules for all subsidiaries and branches globally to the extent required in accordance with Sec. 27 InstVV. The Bank also identifies all employees whose work is deemed to have a material impact on the overall risk profile (“Material Risk Takers” or “MRTs”) in accordance with the InstVV. MRTs are identified on a Group level and also on a single legal entity level for significant institutions in the meaning of Sec. 17 InstVV.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    190
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Pursuant to CRD 4 and the requirements subsequently adopted in the German Banking Act, the Bank is subject to a ratio of 1:1 with regard to fixed to variable components, provided that the shareholders may approve an increase to 1:2. At the Bank’s Annual General Meeting on May 22, 2014, and in accordance with Sec. 25a (5) German Banking Act, shareholder approval was granted to increase the ratio to 1:2. To emphasize the fixed compensation component in respect of remuneration for control functions employees, the Management Board has determined that individuals within the independent control functions are subject to a 1:1 ratio.

As a result of sector specific legislation and in accordance with the InstVV, certain Asset and Wealth Management subsidiaries specifically managing alternative investments are governed under the Alternative Investments Fund Managers Directive (“AIFMD”). AIFMD contains provisions on remuneration which outline the rules that Alternative Investment Fund Managers (“AIFMs”) have to comply with when establishing and applying the remuneration policies for certain categories of their employees. AIFMD Material Risk Takers are to be identified at the AIFM level. One notable difference to CRD 4 and its implementation in German law is that AIFMD Material Risk Takers are not subject to the fixed to variable ratio stipulated in CRD 4. The Bank also identifies AIMFD Material Risk Takers for Alternative Investment Fund Managers in accordance with AIFMD. The Bank applies the remuneration provisions for InstVV MRTs also to AIFMD MRTs except for the 1:2 ratio with regard to fixed to variable components.

The Bank will continue to closely monitor the regulatory environment. Major regulatory developments for 2016 include the adoption of the Undertakings for Collective Investments in Transferable Securities (“UCITS”) Directive and the expected revision of the InstVV in light of the publication of the “Guidelines on sound remuneration policies” by the European Banking Authority in December 2015.

Total Compensation Structure

As part of the Compensation Strategy, the Bank employs a Total Compensation philosophy, which comprises Fixed Pay (FP) and Variable Compensation (VC).

 

Element

  

Description

Fixed Pay (FP)   

FP is used to compensate employees for their skills, experience and competencies, commensurate with the requirements, size and scope of their role. For the majority of Deutsche Bank employees, FP is the primary compensation component, and the share of fixed compensation within Total Compensation is far greater than 50 %. This is appropriate to many businesses and will continue to be a significant feature of Total Compensation going forward.

 

As part of their fixed compensation, a limited number of employees receives an Additional Fixed Pay Supplement (AFPS). The AFPS was introduced primarily for benefits and pensions cost management purposes.

Variable Compensation (VC)   

VC is predicated on the industry objective of retaining cost flexibility while attracting and retaining the right talent. VC also has the advantage of being able to differentiate performance outcomes and drive behaviors through appropriate incentive systems that can also positively influence culture. As a result, VC is a key feature of market practice compensation in many business lines in the banking environment globally. Combined with FP, this drives Total Compensation outcomes that are cost effective, flexible and aligned to performance.

Benefits&Pensions    In accordance with the respective local market practice, requirements and demands, the Bank also grants benefits (including company pension schemes) that are linked to employment with the Bank, to certain seniority or to certain length of service but that have no direct link to performance.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
191   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Compensation approach for 2016 onwards: Outlook on the New Compensation Framework

One of the main objectives of Strategy 2020 is to align reward more closely with performance and conduct. In order to achieve this goal, the Bank has assessed its compensation approach over the course of 2015 and, in 2016, has started putting in place a New Compensation Framework that is designed to align pay more closely with sustainable performance at all levels of the Bank by rebalancing fixed and variable remuneration elements and providing for a closer link between VC and the Bank-wide performance. The New Compensation Framework provides guidance on the target proportion of fixed to variable compensation elements by seniority and by division or function.

In addition, variable remuneration from 2016 onwards is intended to include two components. The first, the group component, reflects the performance of Deutsche Bank, tying individual Total Compensation more closely to the Bank’s performance and recognizing the contribution of every single employee to the Bank’s results. The second, the individual component, is more discretionary and recognises individual performance in the context of divisional performance.

Compensation Governance

In accordance with the German two-tier board structure, the Supervisory Board governs the compensation of the Management Board members while the Management Board oversees compensation matters for all other employees in the Group. Both the Supervisory Board and the Management Board are supported by specific committees and functions in accordance with InstVV.

Our robust governance structure enables us to operate within the clear parameters of our Compensation Strategy and Compensation Policy. All compensation matters, and overall compliance with regulatory requirements, are overseen by the key committees that form the global Reward Governance Structure.

 

LOGO

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    192
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Compensation Control Committee

The Compensation Control Committee (CCC) was established by the Supervisory Board in accordance with Sec. 25d (12) German Banking Act. It consists of the Chairperson of the Supervisory Board and three further Supervisory Board Members, two from among the employee representatives, and had 10 meetings in the calendar year 2015, two of them being joint meetings with the Risk Committee.

The responsibilities of the CCC includes supporting the Supervisory Board in establishing and monitoring the appropriate structure of the compensation system for the Management Board Members of Deutsche Bank AG, considering, in particular, the effects on the risks and risk management in accordance with the InstVV. Furthermore, the CCC monitors the appropriate structure of the compensation system for the employees, as established by the Management Board and the Senior Executive Compensation Committee. The CCC checks regularly whether the total amount of VC is appropriate and set in accordance with the InstVV.

The CCC also assesses the impact of the compensation systems on the management of risk, capital and liquidity and seeks to ensure that the compensation systems are aligned to the business and risk strategies. Furthermore, the CCC supports the Supervisory Board in monitoring whether the internal controls and the other relevant areas are properly involved in the structuring of the compensation systems.

Compensation Officer

In accordance with Sec. 23 InstVV, the Management Board, in cooperation with the CCC, has appointed a Compensation Officer. The Compensation Officer supports the Supervisory Board and the CCC in performing their duties relating to all compensation systems and cooperates closely with the Chairperson of the CCC. The Compensation Officer is involved in the conceptual review, development, monitoring and the application of the employee’s compensation systems on an ongoing basis.

The Compensation Officer performs his monitoring obligations independently and provides an assessment on the appropriateness of the design and practices of the compensation systems for employees to the Management Board, the Supervisory Board and the CCC at least annually.

Senior Executive Compensation Committee

The Senior Executive Compensation Committee (SECC) is a delegated committee established by the Management Board which has the mandate to develop sustainable compensation principles, to prepare recommendations on Total Compensation levels and to ensure appropriate compensation governance and oversight. In accordance with its mandate the SECC establishes compensation strategy, policy and guiding principles and coordinates compensation decisions. The SECC establishes quantitative and qualitative factors to assess performance as a basis for compensation related decisions and makes appropriate recommendations to the Management Board regarding the annual VC pool and its allocation across the business divisions and infrastructure functions. Additional committees, as delegated bodies of the SECC, are an integral part of the overall governance structure; the inclusion of these committees is designed to ensure that diversified expertise from multiple stakeholders is taken into consideration when making compensation decisions and applying compensation practices.

In order to maintain its independence, only employees from control functions who are not aligned to any of our business divisions are members of the SECC. During 2015, the SECC saw a number of membership changes, in line with the membership changes of the Management Board. From November 2015, the SECC comprises the Chief Administration Officer and the Chief Financial Officer, both of whom are also Members of the Management Board, as Co-Chairpersons, as well as the Chief Risk Officer (also a Management Board Member), the Global Head of Human Resources and an additional Finance representative as Voting Members. The Compensation Officer, the Deputy Compensation Officer and the Global Head of Reward are Non-Voting Members. The SECC generally meets on a monthly basis and it had 21 meetings with regard to the performance year 2015 compensation process.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
193   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Determination of Variable Compensation – Methodology

The Bank has a robust methodology in place to ensure that the determination of VC reflects risk-adjusted performance as well as the capital position of the Bank and its divisions. The ultimate Group VC pool is primarily driven by (i) Group affordability (i.e., what “can” the Bank award in alignment with regulatory requirements) and (ii) Group strategy (what “should” the Bank award in order to provide an appropriate compensation while protecting the long-term health of the franchise).

 

Parameter

  

Description

Group

affordability

  

Group affordability is assessed, as a first step, to determine if the Bank is in a position to award VC and still meet the liquidity and capital requirements. Group affordability is the overriding consideration of the VC pool decisions. The metrics used are linked to the Bank’s Risk Appetite Framework and include, but are not limited to, Common Equity Tier 1 Ratio (CET 1 Ratio), Economic Capital Adequacy Ratio, Leverage Ratio, Stressed Net Liquidity and Basel 3 Liquidity Coverage Ratio, as well as to the Bank’s “negative results test” (which was first defined for the 2015 performance year).

Risk-adjusted performance   

Having assessed Group affordability, risk-adjusted performance is the starting point of VC pool determination.

 

The Bank uses economic capital (EC) scaled to align with the Bank’s forward looking unexpected losses to risk-adjust the VC pools across the divisions. The EC model is the Bank’s primary method for calculating the degree of future potential risk to which the Bank may be exposed and measures the amount of capital that the Bank would need in order to absorb very severe unexpected losses arising from the Bank’s exposures. The risk adjustment takes into account credit, market, operational and business risk. The EC charge increases in case of an increase of the risk profile of the Bank, thereby reducing Bank-wide economic profitability and, by extension, the amount of VC awarded.

 

As part of the range of considerations, the SECC compares and contrasts the view of actual performance through this formulaic VC pool calculation with a view of VC pools aligned with underlying performance and other factors such as:

 

—     Group & Divisional Key Performance Indicators (KPIs): Both Group and divisional scorecards, which consolidate a consistent set of financial and non-financial KPIs, provided by control functions, are used to assess performance against targets.

—     Qualitative risk and regulatory assessments: The VC pool decision must be sustain-able and, as such, items such as new regulatory matters and pending litigation, overdue audit findings and Risk Red Flag scores are key considerations in the VC determination process.

—     Relative performance: Both Group and divisional performance is assessed in the context of performance vis-á-vis defined peers.

—     Market position and trends: Environmental factors, market data and market trends, including benchmarking data on various elements of compensation, as well as infor-mation on developing pay practices, are used to support fair, competitive and cost-effective compensation decisions.

—     Infrastructure pools: Infrastructure VC pools are not dependent on the performance of the division(s) they oversee, but are aligned with divisional or functional bonus builds and overall Group affordability. As stated above, performance against key strategic infrastructure indicators is also carefully considered.

—     Payout Rates: Appropriate payout rates are applied to each business division with reference to historical payout rates and market context.

 

Ultimate VC pool decision   

The SECC recommends the derived Group VC pool to the Management Board for formal ratification. Taking all the factors into account, in careful assessment of additional considerations discretion may also be exercised, for example where strategic investments require time to contribute to performance, where one-off business or market dynamics are expected to reverse or in the context of relevant strategic factors, especially under employee retention and franchise protection or strengthening considerations.

 

After ratification, the Compensation Control Committee is formally notified.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    194
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Consideration of Individual Performance

While individual VC decisions are discretionary, all decisions must be performance-based and linked to a number of factors, including, but not limited to, risk-adjusted Group, divisional and individual performance as well as retention considerations and behavioral aspects. Managers, when exercising discretion, must fully understand both the absolute and relative risk-taking activities of individuals to ensure that VC allocations are balanced and risk-taking is not inappropriately incentivized.

This applies, in particular, to managers of MRTs who are required to attest that they have thoroughly reviewed and considered all of the relevant financial, non-financial and risk metrics when determining individual compensation. In addition, narrative commentary is also required to articulate how the compensation parameters (both quantitative and qualitative) and the individual’s performance and behavioral factors have influenced the ultimate compensation decision. Inputs (both positive and negative) from internal control functions were collected on MRTs and provided to managers. These inputs were intended to ensure an appropriate impact on decisions with regard to the employees’ performance assessment, promotion potential and VC.

Variable Compensation for 2015

Achieving a sustainable balance between shareholder and employee interests is a key aspect of Strategy 2020. For 2015, the Bank’s compensation decisions had to carefully balance Deutsche Bank’s reported a loss for 2015 against the Bank’s positive revenue developments and overall capital position as well as its franchise protection considerations.

The SECC has monitored the affordability of VC throughout 2015. In assessing the affordability of the Bank’s proposed 2015 VC pool, the SECC has concluded that, although the Bank has had an overall negative result (negative result test), the Bank’s capital and liquidity positions remain above regulatory minimum requirements and that the significant impairment charges taken in 3Q 2015 have only had a marginal impact on the Bank’s fully loaded CET 1 ratio and therefore affordability parameters are met. The Bank’s 2015 financial statements and plans for the financial years 2016 and 2017 exceed both internal risk appetite metrics and expected regulatory minimum requirements.

Under consideration of underlying risk-adjusted financial performance, the Management Board confirmed a Group VC pool to be granted in March 2016 of  2.4 billion. Applying the foreign exchange rates used for the 2015 VC pool to the 2014 VC pool, this represents a decrease compared to 2014 by approximately 17 %. The decision to grant and communicate VC for the performance year 2015 in March 2016, rather than in February as in previous years was made in order to allow for more time to assess the full year performance, and only then to finalize compensation decisions.

While the pool determination had to factor in the negative results and the overall shareholder return, it also had to take into account that the revenues were solid and that the negative results for 2015 are mainly driven by extraordinary items not stemming from the divisions’ performance in 2015.

Furthermore, a more significant reduction would have jeopardized the implementation of Strategy 2020 as it would have compromised the Bank’s ability to attract and retain talent. The Bank’s employees are the key factor in achieving the goals of Strategy 2020. In order to sustain the momentum that has been built up over the last months it is essential that the employees are rewarded adequately.

As part of their VC for the performance year 2015, select employees who are critical for the Bank and the targeted achievements of Strategy 2020 received a Key Position Award (KPA). Whilst the amount of KPAs granted to these individuals reflects the individual performance for 2015, it was especially important to employ specific structural elements to the KPA which allow for an even stronger link to the long-term sustainable performance of the Bank. In order to achieve this stronger link, the KPA is granted completely in Deutsche Bank shares with a deferral period of four years without pro-rata vesting (“cliff-vesting”) as well as an additional retention period of one year. All these structural elements exceed the current corresponding regulatory requirements of payment in instruments, deferral period and retention period.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
195   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Furthermore, a certain proportion of the individual’s KPA is subject to an additional share price hurdle, meaning this award proportion only vests in the event that the Bank’s share price reaches a certain share target price. This additional hurdle aims to link the Variable Compensation for 2015 even more closely to the future performance of the Bank and the targeted achievements of the Bank’s Strategy 2020. It also underpins the Bank’s expectation of a continued strong performance for the next years by the individuals receiving this award.

 

LOGO

 

      2015        2014    

in m. (unless stated otherwise)

   CB&S        GTB        Deutsche AWM        PBC        NCOU        Group Total        Group Total    

Total Compensation 1

     4,751           1,025           1,646           2,924           182           10,528           10,020     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

thereof:

                    

Fixed Pay

     3,298           810           1,178           2,692           144           8,122           7,313     

Variable Compensation

     1,453           215           468           232           38           2,406           2,707     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
# of employees (full-time equivalent) at period end      28,280           10,791           11,299           49,196           1,538           101,104           98,138     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
1 

Total Compensation defined as FP for 2015 plus VC granted in March 2016. As in previous years, variable remuneration granted by Deutsche Postbank AG is not included in the above variable amount. For Deutsche Postbank AG, a total amount of variable remuneration of 38 million is envisaged (2014: 40 million). All figures in the table include the allocation of Infrastructure and Regional Management related compensation and number of employees according to our established cost allocation key. The table may contain marginal rounding differences.

Recognition and Amortization of Variable Compensation Granted

As of December 31, 2015, including awards granted in early March 2016, unamortized deferred VC expenses amount to approximately  2.0 billion. The following graph visualizes the amount of VC recognized on the balance sheet for 2015 and the projected future amortization of outstanding VC over the next financial years (future grants and forfeitures excluded).

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    196
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

LOGO

Of the VC for 2015,  1.2 billion are charged to the income statement for 2015 and  1.2 billion will be charged to future years. In addition, the income statement for 2015 was charged with a VC of  1.4 billion stemming from prior years’ deferrals.

 

 

LOGO

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
197   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Variable Compensation Structure and Vehicles

VC has been used by the Bank for many years to incentivize, reward and retain strong performing employees and thereby differentiate Total Compensation outcomes.

The compensation structures are designed not to provide incentives for excessive risk-taking. Against this background, the Bank chose to go beyond the regulatory requirements as in previous years, aligning the VC of an even broader group of employees to the long-term performance of the Bank. Furthermore, MRTs are on average subject to deferral rates in excess of the minimum 40 % - 60 % regulatory requirements. Additionally, the Bank has decided to increase the minimum deferral period for all employees receiving deferred VC to four years. These compensation structures aim to ensure that the alignment of the VC to the sustainable performance of the Group increases with the level of responsibility and the overall compensation.

 

Employee Group

  

Description

  

Impact on Variable Compensation

Material Risk Takers    The Bank identifies all employees whose work is deemed to have a material impact on the overall risk profile in accordance with the InstVV. InstVV MRTs are identified for the whole Group on a Group level but also on a single legal entity level for the significant institutions in the meaning of Sec. 17 InstVV. In addition to Deutsche Bank AG, 18 other legal entities in Deut-sche Bank Group (excl. Postbank) fall under the criteria of Sec. 17 InstVV and are therefore deemed to be significant.   

At least 40 %-60 % of the VC is deferred for four years on a pro rata vesting schedule. All MRTs receive 50 % in restricted equity and 50 % in restricted cash. In addition, 50 % of the upfront VC award is also awarded in equity. 100 % of any VC above 500,000 is fully deferred. Furthermore, employees with a FP in excess of  500,000 are subject to a 100 % VC deferral.

 

In accordance with respective guidance provided by the BaFin, these requirements do not apply for MRTs whose VC is less than  50,000.

 

  

 

  

 

Senior Management Group (“SMG”)    As the significant influencers and stewards of the Bank’s long-term health and performance, it is prudent that the majority of their compensation should be linked to the long-term development and success of the Group. All members of the Senior Management Group are MRTs.    To further align the compensation of this group with the long-term, sustained performance of the Bank, the deferred equity awards are subject to a combined deferral and retention period of five years (“cliff-vesting”).

 

  

 

  

 

All other employees    All employees are subject to the Bank’s deferral matrix. The deferral matrix continues to be geared towards protecting lower earners, whilst ensuring an appropriate amount of deferral for higher earners.    The deferral threshold is set at  100,000 above which at least 50 % of any VC was deferred. 50 % of the deferred VC is received in restricted cash and 50 % in restricted equity.

 

The overall benefits of deferred awards and the positive aspects from a retention and risk management perspective must also be carefully balanced with the management of compensation costs for future years and the implications of increasing levels of deferral. Reflecting what the Bank deems to be an appropriate balance, 49 % of the overall Group VC pool for 2015 is paid or delivered later than March 2016.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    198
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Overview on Award Types

 

Award Type

  

Description

  

Beneficiaries

  

Deferral Period

  

Retention
Period1

  

Proportion

Cash Bonus    Upfront cash proportion    All employees2    N/M    N/M   

50 % of upfront (non-deferred) compensation for InstVV MRTs

100 % of upfront (non-deferred) compensation for all other employees

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

Equity Upfront Award (“EUA”)    Upfront equity proportion; The value of the EUA is linked to the Bank’s share price and is therefore tied to the long-term sustained performance of the Bank    All MRTs2 with VC ³ 50,000    N/M    12 months (increased from 6 months in 2014)    50 % of upfront (non-deferred) compensation for MRTs

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

Restricted Incentive Award (“RIA”) 3    Non-equity based portion (deferred cash compensation)    All employees with deferred VC    Pro rata vesting over four years (increased from three years in 2014)    N/M    50 % of deferred compensation

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

Restricted Equity Award (“REA”) 4    Deferred equity portion; The value of the REA is linked to the Bank’s share price over the vesting and retention period and is therefore tied to the long-term sustained performance of the Bank    All employees with deferred VC    Pro rata vesting over four years (increased from three years in 2014); Cliff-vesting after 4.5 years for SMG    6 months for MRTs    50 % of deferred compensation

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

Key Position Award (“KPA”)    Specific deferred equity award for selected employees who are deemed to be key contributors in the achievement of Strategy 2020    Selected employees    Cliff-vesting after four years    1 year    N/M
1 All equity awards for MRTs are subject to a retention period upon the vesting of each tranche during which time employees are not permitted to sell their shares.
2 Employees with a Fixed Pay of more than 500,000 are subject to a 100 % VC deferral and receive no upfront VC.
3 A limited number of senior employees/MRTs in our Deutsche AWM division received a portion of their deferred award in the form of an Employee Investment Plan (EIP) Award. These are cash settled awards based on the value of funds managed by the business. Deferral and forfeiture provisions under the EIP remain the same as all other awards. These employees still receive 50 % of their deferred award in equity (as a REA) as required by regulation.
4 Employees in the Private Client Services (“PCS”) business of Deutsche AWM receive a PCS award instead of REA.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
199   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Overview on 2015 Deferral Schedule

 

          2016    2017    2018    2019    2020    2021
     Award
Type
   Mar    Sep    Mar    Sep    Mar    Sep    Mar    Sep    Mar    Sep    Mar
Senior Management Group    Cash
Bonus
   Payment                                                  
   EUA    Vesting       Delivery                        
  

 

   RIA              1/4
Vesting
&
Payment
        1/4
Vesting
&
Payment
        1/4
Vesting
&
Payment
        1/4
Vesting
&
Payment
         
   REA                                                 Cliff-
Vesting
   Delivery
   KPA                            Cliff-
Vesting
      Delivery

 

All other Material Risk Takers    Cash
Bonus
   Payment                                                  
   EUA    Vesting       Delivery                        
  

 

   RIA              1/4
Vesting
&
Payment
        1/4
Vesting
&
Payment
        1/4
Vesting
&
Payment
        1/4
Vesting
&
Payment
         
   REA              1/4
Vesting
   Delivery    1/4
Vesting
   Delivery    1/4
Vesting
   Delivery    1/4
Vesting
   Delivery     
   KPA                            Cliff-
Vesting
      Delivery

 

All other employees    Cash
Bonus
   Payment                              
  

 

   RIA              1/4
Vesting
&
Payment
        1/4
Vesting
&
Payment
        1/4
Vesting
&
Payment
        1/4
Vesting
&
Payment
         
   REA              1/4
Vesting
&
Delivery
        1/4
Vesting
&
Delivery
        1/4
Vesting
&
Delivery
        1/4
Vesting
&
Delivery
         
   KPA                            Cliff-
Vesting
      Delivery

 

Ex post Risk Adjustment of Variable Compensation

Performance conditions and forfeiture provisions are key elements of the Bank’s deferred compensation structures and support the alignment of awards with future conduct and performance while also allowing for an appropriate back-testing of the initial performance assessment. As illustrated by the statistics in this report, the percentage of VC awards subject to deferral, and therefore performance conditions and forfeiture provisions, increases in line with Total Compensation. In conjunction with the scope of the risk adjustment measures, the duration for which they are applicable is equally important and is reflected in the application of such conditions up to the settlement of awards.

The VC decisions for 2015 were accompanied by the decision to increase the ability to apply measures for an appropriate ex post risk adjustment. Increasing the minimum deferral period to four years allows for the application of an ex post risk adjustment for a longer timeframe. Additionally, to underpin the importance of an appropriate ex post risk adjustment, the Bank reviewed and chose to further strengthen its performance conditions and forfeiture provisions.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    200
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Overview on Performance Conditions and Forfeiture Provisions of Variable Compensation for 2015

 

Performance
Conditions
and Forfeiture
Provisions

  

Description

  

Material Risk Takers

  

Other
employees with
Deferred
Awards

     

EUA

  

REA/
KPA

  

RIA

  

REA/
KPA

  

RIA

Group’s Common Equity Tier 1 capital ratio performance condition    If at the quarter end prior to vesting or settlement the Group’s CET 1 ratio is below a certain threshold    Whole unde-
livered award will be forfeited
   All unde
livered tranches will be forfeited
      All unde-
livered tranches will be forfeited
  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

Negative Group IBIT performance condition    If, in any financial year during the vesting period, the Management Board determines that prior to delivery Group Income before Income Taxes (IBIT) is negative       Next tranche due for delivery will be forfeited*    Next tranche due for delivery will be forfeited    Next tranche due for delivery will be forfeited*   

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

Negative Divisional IBIT performance condition    If, in any financial year during the vesting period, the Management Board determines that prior to delivery Divisional Income before Income Taxes (IBIT) is negative, even if Group IBIT condition is met (Divisional IBIT condition is not applicable for employees in Regional Management, Infrastructure and NCOU)       Next tranche due for delivery will be forfeited*    Next tranche due for delivery will be forfeited      

 

  

 

  

 

Impairment provision    In the event that it is discovered that the award (or the grant, vesting or settlement of any other award made to the participant) was based on performance measures or assumptions that are later deemed to be materially inaccurate or if a deal, trade or transaction considered to be attributable to an employee has a significant adverse effect on any Group entity, division or the Group as a whole    Up to 100 % of undelivered awards will be forfeited

 

  

 

  

 

Policy / Regulatory Breach provision    In the event of a discovery of an internal policy or procedure breach, or breach of any applicable laws or regulations imposed externally prior to settlement    Up to 100 % of undelivered awards will be forfeited

 

  

 

  

 

Material Control Failure   

If a Material Control Failure occurs, whether arising by act or omission (or series of acts or omissions), which is considered to be attributable to the Participant (whether in whole or in part, directly or indirectly, in a supervisory or managerial capacity, as a member of a committee or panel or otherwise)

  

Up to 100 % of undelivered awards will be forfeited

 

  

 

  

 

Regulatory Requirements   

If forfeiture is required to comply with prevailing regulatory requirements (which, for the avoidance of doubt, includes any legislation or guidance published by a regulator from time to time)

  

Up to 100 % of undelivered awards will be forfeited

 

* For the award types subject to a cliff-vesting, a certain proportion of the award (20 % for REAs of the SMG, 25 % for KPAs) will be forfeited in respect of a year, if the IBIT is negative for that respective year.

With respect to deferred awards scheduled to be delivered in the first quarter of 2016, the Management Board has confirmed that the performance conditions relating to Group-wide and divisional IBIT for the Financial Year 2015 have been met. In exercising its discretion to make this determination, the Management Board recognized the unique circumstances that the Bank’s loss for the Financial Year 2015 reflects strategic decisions, adjustments for goodwill impairments and business restructuring costs. Consequently, deferred awards are delivered as planned in the first quarter in 2016.

Compensation Disclosure pursuant to Section 16 InstVV and Art. 450 CRR

On a global basis, 3,005 employees were identified as InstVV Material Risk Takers (MRTs) for FY 2015, spanning 50 countries. The collective remuneration elements for InstVV MRTs are detailed in the tables below in accordance with Sec. 16 InstVV and Art. 450 CRR.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
201   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Aggregate remuneration for Material Risk Takers

 

     2015    
                   Further MRTs           

in m.

(unless stated otherwise)1

   Senior  
Management2
     Supervisory  
Function3
     CB&S        PBC        GTB        Deutsche  
AWM  
     NCOU        Group  
Total  
 

Number of employees

     181           60           1,871           179           212           452           50           3,005     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Pay

     343           N/M           1,689           85           114           391           48           2,670     

thereof:

                       

Fixed Pay

     189           N/M           909           49           62           191           23           1,423     

Variable Pay

     153           N/M           780           35           52           200           25           1,246     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Variable Pay4

     153           N/M           780           35           52           200           25           1,246     

thereof:

                       

Variable in cash

     51           N/M           283           18           27           107           13           498     

Variable in shares

     102           N/M           497           18           26           90           13           745     

Variable in share-linked instruments

     0           N/M           0           0           0           0           0           0     

Variable in other types of instruments

     0           N/M           0           0           0           3           0           3     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

N/M – Not meaningful

1 

All figures in the table include the allocation of Infrastructure related compensation and number of employees according to our established cost allocation key. The table may contain marginal rounding differences.

2 

Senior Management refers to Management Board Members/ Executive Directors of significant institutions in accordance with Sec. 17 InstVV and to members of the Senior Management Group.

3 

Supervisory Function refers to non-executive Board members and Supervisory Board members of significant institutions in accordance with Sec. 17 InstVV. Compensation information is not reported for non-executive Board members and Supervisory Board members.

4 

Variable Pay is reported which includes VC as well as other discretionary remuneration elements.

Deferred Compensation

 

     2015    

in m.

   Senior  
Management  
     Further MRTs        Group  
Total  
 

Outstanding deferred Variable Pay

     470           1,831           2,301     

thereof:

        

Vested awards

     25           30           55     

Unvested awards

     445           1,802           2,246     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deferred Variable Pay granted for 2015

     144           760           904     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deferred Variable Pay granted during 20151

     215           915           1,131     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deferred Variable Pay forfeited due to ex-post risk-adjustment in 2015

     0           26           26     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deferred Variable Pay from previous years vested during 2015

     148           989           1,137     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
1 

Does not include Variable Compensation granted in March 2016 for the Financial Year 2015.

During the course of 2015, 13 InstVV MRTs had awards subject to forfeiture as a result of being terminated for cause or as a result of a finding of a Policy Breach. The total amount forfeited (based on the value of the awards at grant) was  26.2 million.

Sign-on and termination payments

 

     2015    

 

   Senior  
Management  
     Further MRTs        Group  
Total  
 

Sign On payments (in m.)

     0           1           1     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Number of beneficiaries

     2           8           10     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Termination payments granted (in m.)

     10           27           38     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Number of beneficiaries

     3           67           70     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The highest termination payment granted to an InstVV MRT was  5.2 million.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    202
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Remuneration of high earners

 

    

2015  

in

  

            Number of employees  

Total Pay

  

1,000,000 to 1,499,999

   385  

1,500,000 to 1,999,999

   151  

2,000,000 to 2,499,999

   84  

2,500,000 to 2,999,999

   48  

3,000,000 to 3,499,999

   29  

3,500,000 to 3,999,999

   21  

4.000,000 to 4,499,999

   10  

4,500,000 to 4,999,999

   8  

5,000,000 to 5,999,999

   8  

6,000,000 to 6,999,999

   6  

7,000,000 to 7,999,999

   3  

8,000,000 to 8,999,999

   1  

9,000,000 to 9,999,999

   0  

10,000,000 to 10,999,999

   1  

11,000,000 to 11,999,999

   1  

 

Management Board Report and Disclosure

Compensation System for Management Board Members

Responsibility

The Supervisory Board as a plenary body is responsible for the structuring of the compensation system for the members of the Management Board as well as for determining their individual compensation. The Supervisory Board is supported by the Compensation Control Committee.

As required by law, the Compensation Control Committee comprises four members, of which at least one must have sufficient expertise and professional experience in the area of risk management and risk controlling and at least one other must be an employee representative. With regard to the Management Board, it is the task of the Compensation Control Committee to support and monitor the Supervisory Board in the appropriate structuring of the compensation system and prepare the resolutions of the Supervisory Board regarding the individual compensation of the Management Board members.

Approval of the compensation system by the General Meeting

The Supervisory Board regularly reviews the compensation system for the members of the Management Board. In the case of a change or restructuring of the compensation framework, the Supervisory Board uses the possibility provided in the German Act on the Appropriateness of Management Board Remuneration (Gesetz zur Angemessenheit der Vorstandsvergütung – VorstAG) for the General Meeting to approve the system of compensation for Management Board members. Most recently, in May 2013, the General Meeting approved a new compensation system for the members of the Management Board by a large majority of 88.71 % retroactive to January 1, 2013.

With effect from January 1, 2016, the Supervisory Board changed the compensation system for Management Board members with regard to the amount of fixed compensation, the contributions to the company pension plan, the variable compensation components and their target figures. In May 2016, the General Meeting will be given the opportunity to vote on a resolution on the approval of the changed compensation system.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
203   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Regulatory and statutory requirements

The structuring of the compensation system for members of the Management Board takes place in consideration of and within the framework of the statutory and regulatory requirements. Pursuant to the regulatory approaches under CRD 4, effective since the 2014 financial year, the ratio of fixed to variable compensation is generally limited to 1:1 (cap regulation) for Management Board members, i.e., the amount of variable compensation must not exceed that of fixed compensation. The thought behind this is that excessively high variable compensation could create an increased incentive to enter into inappropriately high risks.

However, lawmakers have also stipulated that shareholders can resolve to soften the requirement by setting the ratio of fixed to variable compensation to 1:2. In May 2014, the General Meeting made use of this statutory possibility and approved the before-mentioned setting to 1:2 with a large majority of 90.84 %.

Principles of the compensation system

The widely varying requirements applicable worldwide present the Supervisory Board with the challenge of being able to offer, within the regulatory requirements, overall compensation packages that continue to be in line with customary market practices and therefore competitive.

When designing the specific structure of the compensation system, determining individual compensation amounts, and structuring its delivery and allocation, the focus is on ensuring a close link between the interests of both the Management Board members and shareholders. While defining the variable compensation, this is achieved through the utilization of clearly defined key financial figures which are directly linked to the performance of Deutsche Bank and granting equity-based compensation components amounting to at least 50 % of the total Variable Compensation. When determining the variable compensation, the equity-based compensation components are directly linked to the performance of the Deutsche Bank share price, and only become eligible for payment after a period of several years.

Through the structure of the compensation system the members of the Management Board are motivated to achieve the objectives set out in the Bank’s strategies, to work continuously towards the positive development of the Group and to avoid unreasonably high risks.

In the context of its review of the compensation system and the determination of the Variable Compensation the Supervisory Board uses the expertise of independent external compensation consultants and, if necessary, legal consultants.

Compensation Structure

The compensation system approved by the Supervisory Board and the compensation structures it encompasses are reflected in the individual Management Board members’ contracts.

At the beginning of the financial year, the Supervisory Board reviews the fixed compensation and the target figures for the Variable Compensation components. Furthermore, it defines the general Group-wide and individual objectives for the Management Board members and verifies that the standardized target objectives set for the Long-Term Performance Award are still aligned to the Bank’s long-term strategy. The performance of individual Management Board members is evaluated by the Supervisory Board and discussed with the Management Board members at the end of the year.

The total compensation resulting from the new compensation system is divided into both non-performance-related and performance-related components.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    204
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Non-Performance-Related Components (fixed compensation)

The fixed compensation is not linked to performance. It consists of a base salary. The base salary is disbursed in twelve equal monthly payments. In 2015, the base salary was as follows:

 

in    2015        2014    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Base salary

     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Co-Chairmen

     3,800,000           3,800,000     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Ordinary Board member

     2,400,000           2,400,000     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

The InstVV provides for the possibility to define contributions to the company pension plan as fixed compensation and thus to include these in the basis for calculating the ratio between fixed and variable compensation components.

In the 2015 financial year, the contributions to the company pension plan amounted to:

 

in    2015        2014    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Contributions to the company pension plan

     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Co-Chairmen

     650,000           650,000     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Ordinary Board member

     400,000           400,000     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Additional non-performance-related components include “other benefits”. The “other benefits” comprise the monetary value of non-cash benefits such as company cars and driver services, insurance premiums, expenses for company-related social functions and security measures including payments, if applicable, of taxes on these benefits as well as taxable reimbursements of expenses.

Performance-Related Components (Variable Compensation)

The Variable Compensation is performance-related and consists of two components:

 

 

the Annual Performance Award and

 

the Long-Term Performance Award.

Annual Performance Award (APA)

The APA rewards the achievement of the Bank’s short and medium-term business policy and corporate objectives that were set as part of the objective setting agreement for the respective financial year’s performance evaluation. Not only is financial success taken into account in the process, but also the conduct towards staff members and clients as part of carrying out business activities.

The total amount of the APA is determined on the basis of several components:

 

 

60 % of the Award amount depends on general Group-wide objectives that are identical for all Management Board members;

 

The remaining 40 % of the Award amount is based on individual performance and individual objectives that are set by the Supervisory Board for each member of the Management Board separately considering the member’s individual function.

Objectives are generally aligned with the categories “capital”, “costs”, “competencies”, “clients” and “culture” and thus not only reflect quantitative objectives, but also address qualitative aspects of the performance delivered.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
205   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Objectives for the 2015 Financial Year

The following Group-wide key financial figures were agreed to as metrics for the 2015 financial year and apply equally to all Management Board members. The targets to be achieved may also generally include other aspects, such as return-on-investment targets, derived from the five identified categories:

 

 

Category Capital: Common Equity Tier 1 Ratio (CET 1) and Leverage Ratio;

 

Category Costs: Cost-Income-Ratio (CIR);

 

Category Competencies: Value added reported; and

 

Categories Culture/Clients: Employee Commitment, Behavior and Reputation.

Each category of these objectives is weighted at 15 % in the determination of the Award amount. Thus, the proportion of these categories as part of the overall APA is equal to 60 %.

In assessing the individual performance component, the Supervisory Board agrees with each Board member separately on

 

 

a quantitative objective from the categories Capital/Costs/Competencies and

 

a qualitative objective from the categories Culture/Clients.

Each of these two objectives is also weighted at 15 % in the determination of the Award amount. Thus, the proportion of these objectives as part of the overall APA is 30 %.

Altogether, the sum of Group-wide and individually agreed objectives amounts to 90 % of the overall APA. An additional maximum of 10 % remain for the Supervisory Board to reward outstanding contributions, including project-specific contributions over the course of the financial year as an exercise of its wide discretionary authority.

As part of the annual objective setting process, corresponding factors are set for all objectives that the Supervisory Board will use as the basis for evaluating achievement at the end of the year. The level of the respective target achievement and the final amount of the APA is no longer defined on the basis of a formula, but is determined on a discretionary basis by the Supervisory Board as part of an informed judgment based on the pre-defined factors. The following factors are considered: the actual value delivered, plan values and externally announced target values, comparable figures of the Bank’s peers, the prior-year values in terms of a multi-year review of development as well as a qualitative analysis of the achievement level and also the overall risk orientation of the Bank.

If the objectives were not achieved during the period being evaluated, the Supervisory Board may determine that an APA will not be granted.

The annual minimum, target and maximum values applicable to the APA for the year 2015 for an ordinary Management Board member and for the Co-Chairmen of the Management Board are as follows:

 

    

 

     2015        2014    

in

   Minimum        Target        Maximum        Target    

Co-Chairmen

           
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Amount per 15 % objective

     0           225,000           450,000           225,000     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

APA total

     0           1,500,000           3,000,000           1,500,000     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Ordinary Board member

           

Amount per 15 % objective

     0           150,000           300,000           150,000     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

APA total

     0           1,000,000           2,000,000           1,000,000     

 

 

 

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    206
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Long-Term Performance Award (LTPA)

The level of the Long-Term Performance Award is determined on the basis of the relative performance of the Deutsche Bank share in comparison to selected peer institutions. Through the additional inclusion of non-financial parameters, it is also oriented towards how the targets are achieved. This will further promote sustainable performance development.

Accordingly, the level of the LTPA is linked to the Relative Total Shareholder Return and will additionally be based on a Culture & Client Factor. The level of the LTPA is in general formula-based and calculated on the basis of pre-defined target figures. The long-term nature of this compensation component is supported by the determination of the Relative Total Shareholder Return on the basis of a three-year assessment.

Relative Total Shareholder Return of Deutsche Bank

The Relative Total Shareholder Return (RTSR) of Deutsche Bank is derived from the Total Shareholder Return of Deutsche Bank in relation to the average total shareholder returns of a select peer group (calculated in Euro). The level of the Award portion is calculated from the average of the annual RTSR for the last three financial years (compensation year and the two preceding years).

If the three-year average of the relative total shareholder return of Deutsche Bank is greater than 100 %, then the value of the RTSR portion increases proportionately to an upper limit of 150 % of the target figure, i.e., the value increases by 1 % for each percentage point above 100 %. If the three-year average of the relative total shareholder return is lower than 100 %, the value declines disproportionately. If the relative total shareholder return is calculated to be in the range of less than 100 % to 80 %, the value of the Award portion is reduced for each lower percentage point by 2 percentage points. In the range between 80 % and 60 %, the value of the Award portion is reduced for each lower percentage point by 3 percentage points. If the three-year average of the RTSR does not exceed 60 %, the value of the Award portion is set to zero.

The peer group used for the calculation of the relative total shareholder return was selected based on the criteria of generally comparable business activities, comparable size and international presence and is regularly reviewed. The peer group now comprises the following banks:

 

 

BNP Paribas and Société Générale (both from the eurozone),

 

Barclays, Credit Suisse and UBS (from Europe outside the eurozone), as well as

 

Bank of America, Citigroup, Goldman Sachs, JP Morgan Chase and Morgan Stanley (all from the U.S.A.).

Culture & Client Factor

Through the Culture & Client Factor, client satisfaction and dealings with clients will be measured to foster a sustainable development of the relationships to clients.

The Supervisory Board will assess the status of the Bank’s development in these aspects at its discretion based on divisionally specific survey results as well as other market analyses along the four categories “below average”, “average”, “good” and “excellent”. For a classification in the “excellent” category, 150 % of the Culture & Client Factor target figure is assigned, 100 % for “good”, and 50 % for “average”. For “below average”, the value of the Award portion is set to zero.

Taking into account the adjustments of the compensation system to the CRD 4 requirements, the LTPA will be calculated based on the modified target figures in conjunction with the achieved RTSR as well as the Culture & Client Factor. The LTPA can be a maximum of 150 % of the respective target figures.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
207   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

The weighting of these two performance metrics is two-thirds for the RTSR value and one-third for the Culture & Client value.

 

     2015        2014    

in

   Minimum        Target        Maximum        Target    

Co-Chairmen

           

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

RTSR component

     0           2,533,333           3,800,000           2,533,333     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Culture & Client component

     0           1,266,667           1,900,000           1,266,667     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

LTPA total

     0           3,800,000           5,700,000           3,800,000     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Ordinary Board member

           

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

RTSR component

     0           1,600,000           2,400,000           1,600,000     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Culture & Client component

     0           800,000           1,200,000           800,000     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

LTPA total

     0           2,400,000           3,600,000           2,400,000     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Maximum Compensation

Following the implementation of the regulatory requirements and based on the before-stated individual compensation components, the annual maximum amounts are as follows.

 

     2015        2014    

in

   Base  
salary  
     APA        LTPA        Total  
compensation  
     Total  
compensation  
 

Co-Chairmen

              

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Target

     3,800,000           1,500,000           3,800,000           9,100,000           9,100,000     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Maximum

     3,800,000           3,000,000           5,700,000           12,500,000           12,500,000     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Ordinary Board member

              

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Target

     2,400,000           1,000,000           2,400,000           5,800,000           5,800,000     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Maximum

     2,400,000           2,000,000           3,600,000           8,000,000           8,000,000     

 

 

The total compensation of a Management Board member is subject to a separate cap of  9.85 million which has been set by the Supervisory Board for the overall total compensation for the 2015 financial year. Accordingly, the calculated maximum of the total compensation of  12.5 million for the Co-Chairmen cannot take effect and therefore, the potential maximum Variable Compensation for each Co-Chairman is limited to  6.05 million.

Long-Term Incentive/Sustainability

According to the requirements of the InstVV at least 60 % of the total Variable Compensation must be granted on a deferred basis. Not less than half of this deferred portion may comprise equity-based compensation components, while the remaining portion must be granted as deferred cash compensation. Both compensation components must be deferred over a multi-year period which, for the equity-based compensation components, must be followed by a retention period. During the period until payment or delivery, the compensation portions awarded on a deferred basis may be forfeited. A maximum of 40 % of the total Variable Compensation may be granted on a non-deferred basis. However, at least half of this must consist of equity-based compensation components and only the remaining portion may be paid out directly in cash. Of the total Variable Compensation, no more than a maximum of 20 % may be paid out in cash immediately, while at least 80 % must be paid or delivered at a later date. Since 2014, the total variable compensation for Management Board members has only been granted on a deferred basis. The APA is in principle granted in the form of deferred, non-equity-based cash compensation components (“Restricted Incentive Awards”). The Restricted Incentive Awards vest over a period of no less than four years.

The LTPA is also granted 100 % on a deferred basis and only in the form of equity-based compensation components (“Restricted Equity Award”). The Restricted Equity Awards vest after four and a half years in one tranche (“cliff vesting”) and have an additional retention period of six months. Accordingly, Management Board members are first permitted to dispose of the equities after approximately five years. During the deferral and retention period, the value of the Restricted Equity Awards is linked to the Bank’s share price and is therefore tied to the sustained performance of the Bank. Specific forfeiture provisions apply for Restricted Incentive Awards and Restricted Equity Awards during the deferral and retention period.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    208
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

The following chart shows the time period for the payment or the delivery of the Variable Compensation components in the five consecutive years following the grant year.

 

 

LOGO

For Restricted Incentive Awards granted for the financial year 2014, a one-time premium in the amount of 2 % is added upon grant.

The equity-based awards granted for the financial year 2014 were entitled to a dividend equivalent. The dividend equivalent was determined according to the following formula:

 

LOGO

Forfeiture Conditions

Because some of the compensation components are deferred or spread out over several years (Restricted Equity Awards, Restricted Incentive Awards and Equity Upfront Awards) certain forfeiture conditions are applicable until vesting or the end of the retention periods, in order to create a long-term incentive. Awards may be fully or partially forfeited, for example, due to individual misconduct (including a breach of regulations) or termination for cause, and – with regard to Restricted Equity Awards and Restricted Incentive Awards – also due to a negative Group result or individual negative contributions to results. In addition, the LTPA will be forfeited completely if the statutory or regulatory minimum requirements for the core capital ratio are not met during this period.

Limitations in the Event of Exceptional Developments

In the event of exceptional developments, the total compensation for each Management Board member is limited to a maximum amount. In addition, the Supervisory Board and the members of the Management Board agreed on a possible limitation of the variable compensation which is included in the service agreements of the Management Board members and according to which the variable compensation may be limited to amounts below the provided maximum amounts or may not be granted altogether. Furthermore, statutory regulations provide that the Supervisory Board may reduce the compensation of the Management Board members to an appropriate level, if the situation of the company deteriorates in such a way following the determination of the

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
209   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

compensation that the continuous granting of the compensation would be unreasonable for the company. A payment of Variable Compensation elements will also not take place if the payment of Variable Compensation components is prohibited or restricted by the German Federal Financial Supervisory Authority in accordance with existing statutory requirements.

Shareholding Guidelines

To foster the identification with Deutsche Bank and its shareholders, the Management Board members are required to invest a portion of their private funds in Deutsche Bank shares. For this purpose, the Management Board members will continuously hold a number of Deutsche Bank shares in their securities accounts. Deferred, equity-based compensation may be taken into account at 75 % of its value towards fulfillment of the obligation.

Since 2014, the number of shares to be held amounts to two times the annual base salary for the Co-Chairmen and one time the annual base salary for ordinary Management Board members.

There is a waiting period of 36 months for the Co-Chairmen and 24 months for ordinary Management Board members until which this requirement must be fulfilled. All Management Board members fulfilled the retention obligations for shares in 2015. Observance of the requirement is reviewed semi-annually as of June 30 and December 31. If the required number of shares is not met, the Management Board members must correct any deficiencies by the next review.

As compensation components are deferred or spread out over several years, another link to the performance of the Deutsche Bank share is established that should generally continue to exist even for the period after leaving the Management Board.

Compensation structure as of January 2016

With effect from January 1, 2016, the Supervisory Board changed the compensation system for Management Board members.

The changed compensation system follows the new structure of the Bank’s business divisions and thus the reorganization of the Bank’s leadership structure. Effective January 1, 2016, all four core business divisions (front offices) are represented directly by members on the Management Board. For Management Board members with front office responsibility, the previous variable compensation components will be supplemented by the newly introduced Division Performance Award component. The implementation of the Division Performance Award seeks to reflect market requirements and ensure competitive pay levels for Management Board members with front office responsibility. The individual amount is determined based on performance-oriented criteria.

The key changes are set out below:

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    210
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Non-Performance-Related Components (fixed compensation)

The fixed compensation is not linked to performance and continues to consist of the base salary, contributions to the company pension plan and “other benefits” comprising the monetary value of non-cash benefits such as company cars and driver services, insurance premiums, expenses for company-related social functions and security measures including payments, if applicable, of taxes on these benefits as well as taxable reimbursements of expenses.

The base salary remains unchanged in its amounts. However, the annual contributions to the company pension plan are to be determined on an individual basis by the Supervisory Board as of 2016.

Performance-Related-Components (variable compensation)

The variable compensation is performance-related. It continues to consist for all members of the Management Board of the two previous components:

 

 

the Annual Performance Award and

 

the Long-Term Performance Award

and, for Management Board members with front office responsibility, of the following additional component:

 

 

the Division Performance Award.

Division Performance Award (DPA)

The DPA rewards the achievement of the Bank’s short and medium-term business policy and strategic objectives established in the context of the objective setting process for the performance evaluation for the respective year. The key objectives underlying the determination of the DPA are designed to contribute to the applicable business policy and strategic objectives of the relevant division, in line with its business and risk strategy and the individual objectives set separately for each member of the Management Board on the basis of the member’s area of responsibility. Not only is financial success taken into account in the process, but also the conduct towards staff members and clients as part of carrying out business activities. In principle, the DPA thereby follows the same decision-making and determination logic as the Annual Performance Award, while allowing for a stronger focus on the business success parameters of client-oriented business units.

As part of the annual objective setting process, corresponding factors are set for all objectives that will be used by the Supervisory Board following the end of the year as the basis for evaluating performance. The degree to which the respective target is achieved as well as the ultimate amount of the DPA is determined on a discretionary basis by the Supervisory Board as part of an informed judgment on the basis of several components. The relevant factors for the determination of the DPA are the objective achievement level and the weighting of the relevant objectives.

If the objectives were not achieved during the period being evaluated, the Supervisory Board may determine that a DPA will not be granted.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
211   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

The following chart provides a comparison of the compensation structure applicable until December 31, 2015 and the structure applicable as of January 1, 2016:

 

 

LOGO

The new compensation structure will be presented in detail to the General Meeting in May 2016; the General Meeting will be given the opportunity to vote on a resolution on the approval of the changed compensation system.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    212
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Board Compensation

Base Salary

In the 2015 financial year, the annual base salary of the Management Board Co-Chairmen was  3,800,000 each and for an ordinary Management Board member  2,400,000.

Variable Compensation

The Supervisory Board, based on the proposal of the Compensation Control Committee, decided to reduce the variable compensation for the 2015 financial year for all Management Board members in office during the 2015 financial year to zero for the duration of their Management Board membership. The reduction is due to the deterioration of key performance indicators of the Bank in the 2015 financial year.

Total Compensation

The members of the Management Board collectively received in/for the 2015 financial year compensation (without fringe benefits and pension service costs) totaling  22,660,000 (2014:  35,277,666) for their service on the Management Board. This amount was for base salaries only (2014:  19,600,000).  0 (2014:  15,677,666) were received for performance-related components with long-term incentives.

The Supervisory Board determined the compensation on an individual basis for 2015 as follows (table does not include amounts that departing Management Board members received in connection with their severance, which are described below in “Other Benefits upon Premature Termination”):

 

     2015        2014    

in

   Base  
salary  
     APA1        LTPA2        Total  
compensation  
     Total  
compensation  
 

John Cryan3

     1,900,000           0           0           1,900,000           –     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Jürgen Fitschen

     3,800,000           0           0           3,800,000           6,661,958     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Anshuman Jain4

     1,900,000           0           0           1,900,000           6,661,958     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Stefan Krause5

     2,400,000           0           0           2,400,000           4,352,500     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Dr. Stephan Leithner5

     2,000,000           0           0           2,000,000           4,467,250     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Stuart Lewis

     2,400,000           0           0           2,400,000           4,429,000     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Sylvie Matherat6

     400,000           0           0           400,000           –     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Rainer Neske4

     1,200,000           0           0           1,200,000           4,352,500     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Henry Ritchotte

     2,400,000           0           0           2,400,000           4,352,500     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Karl von Rohr6

     400,000           0           0           400,000           –     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Dr. Marcus Schenck7

     1,460,000           0           0           1,460,000           –     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Christian Sewing8

     2,400,000           0           0           2,400,000           –     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     22,660,000           0           0           22,660,000           35,277,666     

 

 
1 

APA = Annual Performance Award.

2 

LTPA = Long-Term Performance Award.

3 

Member of the Management Board from July 1, 2015.

4 

Member of the Management Board until June 30, 2015.

5 

Member of the Management Board until October 31, 2015.

6 

Member of the Management Board from November 1, 2015.

7 

Member of the Management Board from May 22, 2015.

8 

Member of the Management Board from January 1, 2015.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
213   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

Compensation in accordance with the German Corporate Governance Codex (GCGC)

The compensation for the members of the Management Board in accordance with the requirements of section 4.2.5 paragraph 3 of the GCGC is provided below. This comprises the benefits granted for the year under review including the fringe benefits, and including the maximum and minimum achievable compensation for variable compensation components. In addition, the disbursals of fixed compensation, short-term variable compensation and long-term variable compensation in/for the year under review, broken down into the relevant reference years are reported.

The following table provides the compensation granted for the 2015 financial year:

Compensation granted in 2015 (2014) according to GCGC

 

    John Cryan1  
Co-Chairman  
 

in

  2015 (determined)       2015 (target)       2015 (Min)       2015 (Max)       2014 (determined)       2014 (target)    

Fixed compensation (base salary)

    1,900,000          1,900,000          1,900,000          1,900,000          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Fringe benefits

    29,697          29,697          29,697          29,697          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    1,929,697          1,929,697          1,929,697          1,929,697          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

One-year variable compensation

    0          0          0          0          0          0     

thereof:

           

Immediately paid out (part of APA)

    0          0          0          0          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Multi-year variable compensation

    0          2,650,000          0          4,350,000          0          0     

thereof:

           

Equity Upfront Awards (part of APA)

    0          0          0          0          0          0     

Restricted Incentive Awards (APA)

    0          750,000          0          1,500,000          0          0     

Restricted Equity Awards (LTPA)

    0          1,900,000          0          2,850,000          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    0          2,650,000          0          4,350,000          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Pension service costs

    439,065          439,065          439,065          439,065          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total compensation (GCGC)

    2,368,762          5,018,762          2,368,762          6,718,762          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total compensation2

    1,900,000          4,550,000          1,900,000          6,250,000          0          0     

 

 

1   Member of the Management Board from July 1, 2015.

2   Without fringe benefits and pension service costs.

 

      

      

    Jürgen Fitschen  
Co-Chairman  
 

in

  2015 (determined)       2015 (target)       2015 (Min)       2015 (Max)       2014 (determined)       2014 (target)    

Fixed compensation (base salary)

    3,800,000          3,800,000          3,800,000          3,800,000          3,800,000          3,800,000     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Fringe benefits

    102,016          102,016          102,016          102,016          118,852          118,852     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    3,902,016          3,902,016          3,902,016          3,902,016          3,918,852          3,918,852     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

One-year variable compensation

    0          0          0          0          0          0     

thereof:

           

Immediately paid out (part of APA)

    0          0          0          0          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Multi-year variable compensation

    0          5,300,000          0          8,700,000          2,861,958          5,300,000     

thereof:

           

Equity Upfront Awards (part of APA)

    0          0          0          0          0          0     

Restricted Incentive Awards (APA)

    0          1,500,000          0          3,000,000          860,625          1,500,000     

Restricted Equity Awards (LTPA)

    0          3,800,000          0          5,700,000          2,001,333          3,800,000     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    0          5,300,000          0          8,700,000          2,861,958          5,300,000     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Pension service costs

    624,192          624,192          624,192          624,192          648,216          648,216     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total compensation (GCGC)

    4,526,208          9,826,208          4,526,208          13,226,208          7,429,026          9,867,068     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total compensation1

    3,800,000          9,100,000          3,800,000          12,500,000          6,661,958          9,100,000     

 

 
1 

Without fringe benefits and pension service costs.


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    214
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

    Anshuman Jain1
Co-Chairman  
 

in

  2015 (determined)       2015 (target)       2015 (Min)       2015 (Max)       2014 (determined)       2014 (target)    

Fixed compensation (base salary)

    1,900,000          1,900,000          1,900,000          1,900,000          3,800,000          3,800,000     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Fringe benefits

    337,718          337,718          337,718          337,718          718,914          718,914     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    2,237,718          2,237,718          2,237,718          2,237,718          4,518,914          4,518,914     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

One-year variable compensation

    0          0          0          0          0          0     

thereof:

           

Immediately paid out (part of APA)

    0          0          0          0          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Multi-year variable compensation

    0          2,650,000          0          4,350,000          2,861,958          5,300,000     

thereof:

           

Equity Upfront Awards (part of APA)

    0          0          0          0          0          0     

Restricted Incentive Awards (APA)

    0          750,000          0          1,500,000          860,625          1,500,000     

Restricted Equity Awards (LTPA)

    0          1,900,000          0          2,850,000          2,001,333          3,800,000     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    0          2,650,000          0          4,350,000          2,861,958          5,300,000     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Pension service costs

    1,553,203          1,553,203          1,553,203          1,553,203          857,192          857,192     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total compensation (GCGC)

    3,790,921          6,440,921          3,790,921          8,140,921          8,238,064          10,676,106     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total compensation2

    1,900,000          4,550,000          1,900,000          6,250,000          6,661,958          9,100,000     

 

 

1   Member of the Management Board until June 30, 2015.

2   Without fringe benefits and pension service costs.

 

      

      

    Stefan Krause    

in

  2015 (determined)       2015 (target)       2015 (Min)       2015 (Max)       2014 (determined)       2014 (target)    

Fixed compensation (base salary)

    2,400,000          2,400,000          2,400,000          2,400,000          2,400,000          2,400,000     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Fringe benefits

    105,099          105,099          105,099          105,099          124,753          124,753     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    2,505,099          2,505,099          2,505,099          2,505,099          2,524,753          2,524,753     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

One-year variable compensation

    0          0          0          0          0          0     

thereof:

           

Immediately paid out (part of APA)

    0          0          0          0          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Multi-year variable compensation

    0          3,400,000          0          5,600,000          1,952,500          3,400,000     

thereof:

           

Equity Upfront Awards (part of APA)

    0          0          0          0          0          0     

Restricted Incentive Awards (APA)

    0          1,000,000          0          2,000,000          688,500          1,000,000     

Restricted Equity Awards (LTPA)

    0          2,400,000          0          3,600,000          1,264,000          2,400,000     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    0          3,400,000          0          5,600,000          1,952,500          3,400,000     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Pension service costs

    498,908          498,908          498,908          498,908          521,887          521,887     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total compensation (GCGC)

    3,004,007          6,404,007          3,004,007          8,604,007          4,999,140          6,446,640     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total compensation1

    2,400,000          5,800,000          2,400,000          8,000,000          4,352,500          5,800,000     

 

 

1   Without fringe benefits and pension service costs.

 

      

 

  Dr. Stephan Leithner1    

in

  2015 (determined)       2015 (target)       2015 (Min)       2015 (Max)       2014 (determined)       2014 (target)    

Fixed compensation (base salary)

    2,000,000          2,000,000          2,000,000          2,000,000          2,400,000          2,400,000     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Fringe benefits

    72,570          72,570          72,570          72,570          353,552          353,552     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    2,072,570          2,072,570          2,072,570          2,072,570          2,753,552          2,753,552     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

One-year variable compensation

    0          0          0          0          0          0     

thereof:

           

Immediately paid out (part of APA)

    0          0          0          0          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Multi-year variable compensation

    0          2,833,333          0          4,666,667          2,067,250          3,400,000     

thereof:

           

Equity Upfront Awards (part of APA)

    0          0          0          0          0          0     

Restricted Incentive Awards (APA)

    0          833,333          0          1,666,667          803,250          1,000,000     

Restricted Equity Awards (LTPA)

    0          2,000,000          0          3,000,000          1,264,000          2,400,000     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    0          2,833,333          0          4,666,667          2,067,250          3,400,000     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Pension service costs

    442,033          442,033          442,033          442,033          561,694          561,694     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total compensation (GCGC)

    2,514,603          5,347,936          2,514,603          7,181,270          5,382,496          6,715,246     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total compensation2

    2,000,000          4,833,333          2,000,000          6,666,667          4,467,250          5,800,000     

 

 
1 

Member of the Management Board until October 31, 2015.

2 

Without fringe benefits and pension service costs.


Table of Contents
215   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

    Stuart Lewis    

in

  2015 (determined)       2015 (target)       2015 (Min)       2015 (Max)       2014 (determined)       2014 (target)    

Fixed compensation (base salary)

    2,400,000          2,400,000          2,400,000          2,400,000          2,400,000          2,400,000     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Fringe benefits

    97,624          97,624          97,624          97,624          84,937          84,937     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    2,497,624          2,497,624          2,497,624          2,497,624          2,484,937          2,484,937     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

One-year variable compensation

    0          0          0          0          0          0     

thereof:

           

Immediately paid out (part of APA)

    0          0          0          0          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Multi-year variable compensation

    0          3,400,000          0          5,600,000          2,029,000          3,400,000     

thereof:

           

Equity Upfront Awards (part of APA)

    0          0          0          0          0          0     

Restricted Incentive Awards (APA)

    0          1,000,000          0          2,000,000          765,000          1,000,000     

Restricted Equity Awards (LTPA)

    0          2,400,000          0          3,600,000          1,264,000          2,400,000     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    0          3,400,000          0          5,600,000          2,029,000          3,400,000     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Pension service costs

    516,969          516,969          516,969          516,969          551,095          551,095     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total compensation (GCGC)

    3,014,593          6,414,593          3,014,593          8,614,593          5,065,032          6,436,032     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total compensation1

    2,400,000          5,800,000          2,400,000          8,000,000          4,429,000          5,800,000     

 

 

1   Without fringe benefits and pension service costs.

 

      

    Sylvie Matherat1    

in

  2015 (determined)       2015 (target)       2015 (Min)       2015 (Max)       2014 (determined)       2014 (target)    

Fixed compensation (base salary)

    400,000          400,000          400,000          400,000          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Fringe benefits

    5,226          5,226          5,226          5,226          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    405,226          405,226          405,226          405,226          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

One-year variable compensation

    0          0          0          0          0          0     

thereof:

           

Immediately paid out (part of APA)

    0          0          0          0          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Multi-year variable compensation

    0          566,667          0          933,333          0          0     

thereof:

           

Equity Upfront Awards (part of APA)

    0          0          0          0          0          0     

Restricted Incentive Awards (APA)

    0          166,667          0          333,333          0          0     

Restricted Equity Awards (LTPA)

    0          400,000          0          600,000          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    0          566,667          0          933,333          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Pension service costs

    128,506          128,506          128,506          128,506          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total compensation (GCGC)

    533,732          1,100,399          533,732          1,467,065          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total compensation2

    400,000          966,667          400,000          1,333,333          0          0     

 

 

1   Member of the Management Board from November 1, 2015.

2   Without fringe benefits and pension service costs.

 

      

      

 

  Rainer Neske1    

in

  2015 (determined)       2015 (target)       2015 (Min)       2015 (Max)       2014 (determined)       2014 (target)    

Fixed compensation (base salary)

    1,200,000          1,200,000          1,200,000          1,200,000          2,400,000          2,400,000     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Fringe benefits

    61,347          61,347          61,347          61,347          96,155          96,155     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    1,261,347          1,261,347          1,261,347          1,261,347          2,496,155          2,496,155     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

One-year variable compensation

    0          0          0          0          0          0     

thereof:

           

Immediately paid out (part of APA)

    0          0          0          0          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Multi-year variable compensation

    0          1,700,000          0          2,800,000          1,952,500          3,400,000     

thereof:

           

Equity Upfront Awards (part of APA)

    0          0          0          0          0          0     

Restricted Incentive Awards (APA)

    0          500,000          0          1,000,000          688,500          1,000,000     

Restricted Equity Awards (LTPA)

    0          1,200,000          0          1,800,000          1,264,000          2,400,000     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    0          1,700,000          0          2,800,000          1,952,500          3,400,000     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Pension service costs

    550,484          550,484          550,484          550,484          539,553          539,553     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total compensation (GCGC)

    1,811,831          3,511,831          1,811,831          4,611,831          4,988,208          6,435,708     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total compensation2

    1,200,000          2,900,000          1,200,000          4,000,000          4,352,500          5,800,000     

 

 
1 

Member of the Management Board until June 30, 2015.

2 

Without fringe benefits and pension service costs.


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    216
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

     Henry Ritchotte    

in

   2015 (determined)        2015 (target)        2015 (Min)        2015 (Max)        2014 (determined)        2014 (target)    

Fixed compensation (base salary)

     2,400,000           2,400,000           2,400,000           2,400,000           2,400,000           2,400,000     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Fringe benefits

     382,390           382,390           382,390           382,390           289,842           289,842     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     2,782,390           2,782,390           2,782,390           2,782,390           2,689,842           2,689,842     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

One-year variable compensation

     0           0           0           0           0           0     

thereof:

                 

Immediately paid out (part of APA)

     0           0           0           0           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Multi-year variable compensation

     0           3,400,000           0           5,600,000           1,952,500           3,400,000     

thereof:

                 

Equity Upfront Awards (part of APA)

     0           0           0           0           0           0     

Restricted Incentive Awards (APA)

     0           1,000,000           0           2,000,000           688,500           1,000,000     

Restricted Equity Awards (LTPA)

     0           2,400,000           0           3,600,000           1,264,000           2,400,000     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     0           3,400,000           0           5,600,000           1,952,500           3,400,000     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Pension service costs

     502,274           502,274           502,274           502,274           530,086           530,086     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total compensation (GCGC)

     3,284,664           6,684,664           3,284,664           8,884,664           5,172,428           6,619,928     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total compensation1

     2,400,000           5,800,000           2,400,000           8,000,000           4,352,500           5,800,000     

 

 

1   Without fringe benefits and pension service costs.

 

      

  
     Karl von Rohr1   

in

   2015 (determined)        2015 (target)        2015 (Min)        2015 (Max)        2014 (determined)        2014 (target)    

Fixed compensation (base salary)

     400,000           400,000           400,000           400,000           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Fringe benefits

     2,348           2,348           2,348           2,348           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     402,348           402,348           402,348           402,348           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

One-year variable compensation

     0           0           0           0           0           0     

thereof:

                 

Immediately paid out (part of APA)

     0           0           0           0           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Multi-year variable compensation

     0           566,667           0           933,333           0           0     

thereof:

                 

Equity Upfront Awards (part of APA)

     0           0           0           0           0           0     

Restricted Incentive Awards (APA)

     0           166,667           0           333,333           0           0     

Restricted Equity Awards (LTPA)

     0           400,000           0           600,000           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     0           566,667           0           933,333           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Pension service costs

     131,141           131,141           131,141           131,141           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total compensation (GCGC)

     533,489           1,100,156           533,489           1,466,822           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total compensation2

     400,000           966,667           400,000           1,333,333           0           0     

 

 

1   Member of the Management Board from November 1, 2015.

2   Without fringe benefits and pension service costs.

 

      

      

  
     Dr. Marcus Schenck1   

in

   2015 (determined)        2015 (target)        2015 (Min)        2015 (Max)        2014 (determined)        2014 (target)    

Fixed compensation (base salary)

     1,460,000           1,460,000           1,460,000           1,460,000           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Fringe benefits

     38,370           38,370           38,370           38,370           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     1,498,370           1,498,370           1,498,370           1,498,370           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

One-year variable compensation

     0           0           0           0           0           0     

thereof:

                 

Immediately paid out (part of APA)

     0           0           0           0           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Multi-year variable compensation

     0           2,068,333           0           3,406,667           0           0     

thereof:

                 

Equity Upfront Awards (part of APA)

     0           0           0           0           0           0     

Restricted Incentive Awards (APA)

     0           608,333           0           1,216,667           0           0     

Restricted Equity Awards (LTPA)

     0           1,460,000           0           2,190,000           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     0           2,068,333           0           3,406,667           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Pension service costs

     478,387           478,387           478,387           478,387           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total compensation (GCGC)

     1,976,757           4,045,090           1,976,757           5,383,424           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total compensation2

     1,460,000           3,528,333           1,460,000           4,866,667           0           0     

 

 
1 

Member of the Management Board from May 22, 2015.

2 

Without fringe benefits and pension service costs.


Table of Contents
217   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

     Christian Sewing1   

in

   2015 (determined)         2015 (target)        2015 (Min)        2015 (Max)        2014 (determined)        2014 (target)    

Fixed compensation (base salary)

     2,400,000           2,400,000           2,400,000           2,400,000           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Fringe benefits

     19,471           19,471           19,471           19,471           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     2,419,471           2,419,471           2,419,471           2,419,471           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

One-year variable compensation

     0           0           0           0           0           0     

thereof:

                 

Immediately paid out (part of APA)

     0           0           0           0           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Multi-year variable compensation

     0           3,400,000           0           5,600,000           0           0     

thereof:

                 

Equity Upfront Awards (part of APA)

     0           0           0           0           0           0     

Restricted Incentive Awards (APA)

     0           1,000,000           0           2,000,000           0           0     

Restricted Equity Awards (LTPA)

     0           2,400,000           0           3,600,000           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     0           3,400,000           0           5,600,000           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Pension service costs

     559,197           559,197           559,197           559,197           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total compensation (GCGC)

     2,978,668           6,378,668           2,978,668           8,578,668           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total compensation2

     2,400,000           5,800,000           2,400,000           8,000,000           0           0     

 

 
1 

Member of the Management Board from January 1, 2015.

2 

Without fringe benefits and pension service costs.

The following table provides the disbursals in/for the 2015 financial year:

Disbursals paid out in 2015 (2014) according to GCGC

 

     John Cryan  
Co-Chairman  
     Jürgen Fitschen  
Co-Chairman  
     Anshuman Jain        Stefan Krause    

in

   2015        2014        2015        2014        2015        2014        2015        2014    

Fixed compensation

     1,900,000           0           3,800,000           3,800,000           1,900,000           3,800,000           2,400,000           2,400,000     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Fringe benefits

     29,697           0           102,016           118,852           337,718           718,914           105,099           124,753     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     1,929,697           0           3,902,016           3,918,852           2,237,718           4,518,914           2,505,099           2,524,753     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

One-year variable compensation

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

thereof immediately paid out

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Multi-year variable compensation

     0           0           285,529           420,542           0           829,761           303,115           446,444     

thereof Equity Upfront Awards:

                       

EUA for 2010 (until 2014)

     0           0           0           420,542           0           829,761           0           446,444     

thereof Restricted Equity Awards:

                       

REA for 2010 (until 2016)

     0           0           285,529           0           0           0           303,115           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     0           0           285,529           420,542           0           829,761           303,115           446,444     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Pension service costs

     439,065           0           624,192           648,216           1,553,203           857,192           498,908           521,887     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total compensation (GCGC)

     2,368,762           0           4,811,737           4,987,610           3,790,921           6,205,867           3,307,122           3,493,084     

 

 

1   Member of the Management Board from July 1, 2015.

2   Member of the Management Board until June 30, 2015.

 

      

      

     
     Dr. Stephan Leithner        Stuart Lewis        Sylvie Matherat        Rainer Neske    

in

   2015        2014        2015        2014        2015        2014        2015        2014    

Fixed compensation

     2,000,000           2,400,000           2,400,000           2,400,000           400,000           0           1,200,000           2,400,000     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Fringe benefits

     72,570           353,552           97,624           84,937           5,226           0           61,347           96,155     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     2,072,570           2,753,552           2,497,624           2,484,937           405,226           0           1,261,347           2,496,155     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

One-year variable compensation

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

thereof immediately paid out

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Multi-year variable compensation

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0           433,493     

thereof Equity Upfront Awards:

                       

EUA for 2010 (until 2014)

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0           433,493     

thereof Restricted Equity Awards:

                       

REA for 2010 (until 2016)

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0           433,493     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Pension service costs

     442,033           561,694           516,969           551,095           128,506           0           550,484           539,553     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total compensation (GCGC)

     2,514,603           3,315,246           3,014,593           3,036,032           533,732           0           1,811,831           3,469,201     

 

 
1 

Member of the Management Board until October 31, 2015.

2 

Member of the Management Board from November 1, 2015.

3 

Member of the Management Board until June 30, 2015.


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    218
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

     Henry Ritchotte        Karl von Rohr1        Dr. Marcus Schenck2        Christian Sewing3    

in

   2015        2014        2015        2014        2015        2014        2015        2014    

Fixed compensation

     2,400,000           2,400,000           400,000           0           1,460,000           0           2,400,000           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Fringe benefits

     382,390           289,842           2,348           0           38,370           0           19,471           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     2,782,390           2,689,842           402,348           0           1,498,370           0           2,419,471           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

One-year variable compensation

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

thereof immediately paid out

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Multi-year variable compensation

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

thereof Equity Upfront Awards:

                       

EUA for 2010 (until 2014)

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

thereof Restricted Equity Awards:

                       

REA for 2010 (until 2016)

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Pension service costs

     502,274           530,086           131,141           0           478,387           0           559,197           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total compensation (GCGC)

     3,284,664           3,219,928           533,489           0           1,976,757           0           2,978,668           0     

 

 
1 

Member of the Management Board from November 1, 2015.

2 

Member of the Management Board from May 22, 2015.

3 

Member of the Management Board from January 1, 2015.

In 2015, the Supervisory Board decided to suspend the tranches of deferred compensation elements which were subject to non-forfeiture and/or disbursal in 2015 for the Management Board members Fitschen, Jain, Krause, Dr Leithner, Lewis, Neske and Ritchotte, who were still active in the reporting period, as well as for four former Management Board members who already left the Management Board prior to the reporting period. Accordingly, the above table does not contain the respective compensation elements which were not disbursed (or delivered – in case of share-based elements) in February and August 2015.

Compensation in accordance with the German Accounting Standard No. 17 (GAS 17)

In accordance with the requirements of the GAS 17, the members of the Management Board collectively received in the 2015 financial year compensation totaling  23,913,876 (2014:  31,709,671) for their service on the Management Board. Of that,  22,660,000 (2014:  19,600,000) was for base salaries,  1,253,876 (2014:  1,787,005) for fringe benefits and  0 (2014:  10,322,666) for performance-related components with long-term incentives.

In accordance with German Accounting Standard No. 17, the Restricted Incentive Awards, as a deferred, non-equity-based compensation component subject to certain (forfeiture) conditions, must be recognized in the total compensation for the year of their payment (i.e., in the financial year in which the unconditional payment takes place) and not in the year they are originally granted. Based on this the Management Board members individually received the following compensation components for their service on the Management Board for or in the years 2015 and 2014, including the non-performance-related fringe benefits.


Table of Contents
219   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

Compensation according to GAS 17

 

     John Cryan1
Co-Chairman  
     Jürgen Fitschen  
Co-Chairman  
     Anshuman Jain2      Stefan Krause    

in

   2015        2014        2015        2014        2015        2014        2015        2014    

Compensation

                       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Performance-related components

                       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Without long-term incentives

                       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Immediately paid out

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

With long-term incentives

                       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash-based

                       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Restricted Incentive Award(s) paid

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Share-based

                       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Equity Upfront Award(s)

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

Restricted Equity Award(s)

     0           0           0           2,001,333           0           2,001,333           0           1,264,000     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Non-performance-related components

                       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Base salary

     1,900,000           0           3,800,000           3,800,000           1,900,000           3,800,000           2,400,000           2,400,000     

Fringe benefits

     29,697           0           102,016           118,852           337,718           718,914           105,099           124,753     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     1,929,697           0           3,902,016           5,920,185           2,237,718           6,520,247           2,505,099           3,788,753     

 

 

1   Member of the Management Board from July 1, 2015.

2   Member of the Management Board until June 30, 2015.

 

      

      

  
     Dr. Stephan Leithner1      Stuart Lewis        Sylvie Matherat2      Rainer Neske3  

in

   2015        2014        2015        2014        2015        2014        2015        2014    

Compensation

                       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Performance-related components

                       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Without long-term incentives

                       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Immediately paid out

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

With long-term incentives

                       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash-based

                       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Restricted Incentive Award(s) paid

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Share-based

                       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Equity Upfront Award(s)

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

Restricted Equity Award(s)

     0           1,264,000           0           1,264,000           0           0           0           1,264,000     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Non-performance-related components

                       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Base salary

     2,000,000           2,400,000           2,400,000           2,400,000           400,000           0           1,200,000           2,400,000     

Fringe benefits

     72,570           353,552           97,624           84,937           5,226           0           61,347           96,155     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     2,072,570           4,017,552           2,497,624           3,748,937           405,226           0           1,261,347           3,760,155     

 

 
1 

Member of the Management Board until October 31, 2015.

2 

Member of the Management Board from November 1, 2015.

3 

Member of the Management Board until June 30, 2015.


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    220
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

     Henry Ritchotte        Karl von Rohr1      Dr. Marcus Schenck2      Christian Sewing3  

in

   2015        2014        2015        2014        2015        2014        2015        2014    

Compensation

                       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Performance-related components

                       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Without long-term incentives

                       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Immediately paid out

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

With long-term incentives

                       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash-based

                       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Restricted Incentive Award(s) paid

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Share-based

                       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Equity Upfront Award(s)

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

Restricted Equity Award(s)

     0           1,264,000           0           0           0           0           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Non-performance-related components

                       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Base salary

     2,400,000           2,400,000           400,000           0           1,460,000           0           2,400,000           0     

Fringe benefits

     382,390           289,842           2,348           0           38,370           0           19,471           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     2,782,390           3,953,842           402,348           0           1,498,370           0           2,419,471           0     

 

 
1 

Member of the Management Board from November 1, 2015.

2 

Member of the Management Board from May 22, 2015.

3 

Member of the Management Board from January 1, 2015.

 

     Total    

in

   2015        2014    

Compensation

     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Performance-related components

     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Without long-term incentives

     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Immediately paid out

     0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

With long-term incentives

     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash-based

     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Restricted Incentive Award(s) paid

     0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Share-based

     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Equity Upfront Award(s)

     0           0     

Restricted Equity Award(s)

     0           10,322,666     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Non-performance-related components

     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Base salary

     22,660,000           19,600,000     

Fringe benefits

     1,253,876           1,787,005     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     23,913,876           31,709,671     

 

 

In 2015, the Supervisory Board decided to suspend the tranches of deferred compensation elements which were subject to non-forfeiture and/or disbursal in 2015 for the Management Board members Fitschen, Jain, Krause, Dr Leithner, Lewis, Neske, Ritchotte, which were still active in the reporting period, as well as for four former Management Board members which already left the Management Board prior to the reporting period. Accordingly, the table above does not contain the Restricted Incentive Awards which were not disbursed in 2015.

Share awards

The Supervisory Board decided not to grant the Management Board members any variable compensation for the 2015 financial year. The share awards granted in 2015 for the year 2014 in the form of Restricted Equity Awards were determined by dividing the respective euro amounts by the average Deutsche Bank AG XETRA share closing prices on the first ten trading days in February 2015 ( 27.108).


Table of Contents
221   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

As a result, the number of share awards granted was as follows (rounded):

 

Members of the Management Board                  

Units

  Year       Equity Upfront Award(s)  
(with retention period)  
    Restricted Equity Award(s)  
(deferred with additional  
retention period)  
 

John Cryan1

    2015          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Jürgen Fitschen

    2015          0          0     
    2014          0          73,828     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Anshuman Jain2

    2015          0          0     
    2014          0          73,828     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Stefan Krause

    2015          0          0     
    2014          0          46,628     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Dr. Stephan Leithner3

    2015          0          0     
    2014          0          46,628     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Stuart Lewis

    2015          0          0     
    2014          0          46,628     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Sylvie Matherat4

    2015          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Rainer Neske2

    2015          0          0     
    2014          0          46,628     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Henry Ritchotte

    2015          0          0     
    2014          0          46,628     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Karl von Rohr4

    2015          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Dr. Marcus Schenck5

    2015          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Christian Sewing6

    2015          0          0     

 

 
1 

Member of the Management Board from July 1, 2015.

2 

Member of the Management Board until June 30, 2015.

3 

Member of the Management Board until October 31, 2015.

4 

Member of the Management Board from November 1, 2015.

5 

Member of the Management Board from May 22, 2015.

6 

Member of the Management Board from January 1, 2015.

Management Board members do not receive any compensation for mandates on boards of Deutsche Bank subsidiaries.

Deferred compensation components granted to John Cryan by a former employer were forfeited due to the commencement of his activity as member of the Management Board. The forfeited compensation components were equally replaced by the grant of 17,440.59 Deutsche Bank share-awards based on the 2015 DB Equity Plan (Restricted Equity Awards). The Restricted Equity Awards vest on March 1, 2016 and have an additional retention period of six months. Specific forfeiture provisions apply for the Awards until their release on September 1, 2016.

Pension and Transitional Benefits

The Supervisory Board allocates an entitlement to pension plan benefits to the Management Board members. These entitlements involve a defined contribution pension plan. Under this pension plan, a personal pension account has been set up for each participating member of the Management Board after appointment to the Management Board. A contribution is made annually into this pension account.

Management Board members receive a contribution in the form of a contractually agreed fixed annual amount in Euro. The contribution accrues interest credited in advance, determined by means of an age-related factor, at an average rate of 4 % per year up to the age of 60. From the age of 61 onwards, the contribution made is credited with an annual interest payment of 4 % up to the date of retirement.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    222
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

The annual contributions, taken together, form the pension amount available to pay the future pension benefit. Under defined conditions, the pension may also become due for payment before a regular pension event (age limit, disability or death) has occurred. The pension right is vested from the start.

The following table shows the annual contributions, the interest credits, the account balances and the annual service costs for the years 2015 and 2014 as well as the corresponding defined benefit obligations for each member of the Management Board in office in 2015 as of December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014. The different balances are attributable to the different lengths of service on the Management Board, the respective age-related factors, and the different contribution rates, as well as the individual pensionable compensation amounts and the previously mentioned additional individual entitlements.

 

Members of the

Management Board

  Annual contribution,  
in the year  
    Interest credit,    
in the year  
    Account balance,  
end of year  
    Service cost (IFRS),  
in the year   
    Present value of the  
defined benefit obligation  
(IFRS), end of year  
 

in

  2015       2014       2015       2014       2015       2014       2015       2014       2015       2014    

John Cryan1

    393,250          0          0          0          393,250          0          439,065          0          450,200          0     

Jürgen Fitschen

    650,000          650,000          95,272          65,351          2,549,796          1,804,524          624,192          648,216          2,576,287          1,935,819     

Anshuman Jain2

    1,919,1258         903,500          0          0          09         2,016,125          1,553,203          857,192          0          1,884,104     

Stefan Krause3

    520,000          536,000          0          0          4,042,137          3,522,137          498,908          521,887          3,685,741          3,336,863     

Dr. Stephan Leithner3

    500,000          620,000          0          0          1,758,250          1,258,250          442,033          561,694          0          1,128,360     

Stuart Lewis

    576,000          600,000          0          0          1,786,938          1,210,938          516,969          551,095          1,551,547          1,103,545     

Sylvie Matherat4

    86,668          0          0          0          86,668          0          128,506          0          130,231          0     

Rainer Neske2

    600,667          576,000          0          0          3,973,532          3,372,865          550,484          539,553          0          3,068,819     

Henry Ritchotte

    536,000          556,000          0          0          1,648,313          1,112,313          502,274          530,086          1,496,159          1,053,970     

Karl von Rohr4

    96,001          0          0          0          96,001          0          131,141          0          132,799          0     

Dr. Marcus Schenck5

    528,001          0          0          0          528,001          0          478,387          0          490,386          0     

Christian Sewing6

    692,000          0          0          0          692,000          0          559,197          0          572,899          0     

 

 
1 

Member of the Management Board from July 1, 2015.

2 

Member of the Management Board until June 30, 2015.

3 

Member of the Management Board until October 31, 2015.

4 

Member of the Management Board from November 1, 2015.

5 

Member of the Management Board from May 22, 2015.

6 

Member of the Management Board from January 1, 2015.

7 

Including age-related factor.

8 

The stated contribution consists of a contribution for the period from January 1 to June 30, 2015 in the amount of 435,500 and a one-off insurance amount in the amount of 1,483,625 which was agreed in the termination agreement in connection with the premature termination of the service contract.

9 

The pension entitlement was not vested at the time of the termination of the Management Board membership and was paid in form of a cash compensation in the amount of 3,437,307.

Other Benefits upon Premature Termination

The Management Board members are in principle entitled to receive a severance payment upon early termination of their appointment at the Bank’s initiative, provided the Bank is not entitled to revoke the appointment or give notice under the contractual agreement for cause. The severance payment, as a rule, will not exceed the lesser of two annual compensation amounts and the claims to compensation for the remaining term of the contract. The calculation of the compensation is based on the annual compensation for the previous financial year.

If a Management Board member leaves office in connection with a change of control, he is also, under certain conditions, entitled in principle to a severance payment. The severance payment, as a rule, will not exceed the lesser of three annual compensation amounts and the claims to compensation for the remaining term of the contract. The calculation of the compensation is again based on the annual compensation for the previous financial year.

The severance payment mentioned above is determined by the Supervisory Board and within its sole discretion. In principle, the disbursement of the severance payment takes place in two installments; the second installment is subject to certain forfeiture conditions until vesting.


Table of Contents
223   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

In 2015, five Management Board Members in total left the Management Board. In connection with their exit from the Board, the Board entered into termination agreements with Anshuman Jain, Stefan Krause, Dr. Stephan Leithner, Rainer Neske and Henry Ritchotte, which contain the following terms:

Anshuman Jain left the Management Board with effect from the end of June 30, 2015. On the basis of the termination agreement, a one-off insurance amount with respect to the entitlement to pension plan benefits in the amount of  1,483,625 and a severance payment in the amount of  2,216,667 were agreed. The severance payment is paid as compensation for the termination of the service agreement and comprises the compensation payments for non-competition agreed in the employment contract. The severance payment was disbursed in June 2015. Mr. Jain will receive office use and secretarial support as well as a company car with chauffeur to use to a reasonable extent until June 30, 2017, at the latest or until he assumes another position of professional activity in a leadership function. The Bank has assumed the costs of  382,008.45 incurred for legal advice provided to Mr Jain in connection with the termination agreement in the statutory amount pursuant to RVG (Rechtsanwaltsvergütungsgesetz), and any costs incurred for tax advice provided in connection with compensation and benefits resulting from the employment relationship with the Bank will be paid until June 30, 2017.

Stefan Krause left the Management Board with effect from the end of October 31, 2015. On the basis of the termination agreement, payment of his base salary including fringe benefits until December 31, 2015, compensation payments for a post-contractual restraint on competition in the amount of  1,560,000 and a severance payment in the amount of  7,145,000 were agreed. Disbursement of the severance payment will take place in two instalments. The first instalment in the amount of  3,572,500 was disbursed in January 2016. The second instalment becomes due for disbursement in January 2017 and is subject to specific forfeiture provisions as well as a provision for the offsetting of income received from other sources. Due to the economic situation of the Bank, the Supervisory Board reduced the second instalment of the severance payment to  1,620,000. Accordingly, the total severance payment amounts to  5,192,500.

Dr. Stephan Leithner left the Management Board with effect from the end of October 31, 2015. On the basis of the termination agreement, compensation payments for a post-contractual restraint on competition in the amount of  1,560,000 were agreed. Dr. Leithner will receive office use and secretarial support to use to a reasonable extent until April 30, 2016, at the latest or until he assumes another position of professional activity in a leadership function. Dr. Leithner has assumed such a leadership function with effect from March 1, 2016. The costs for tax advice provided in connection with compensation and benefits resulting from the employment relationship with the Bank will be paid until July 31, 2016.

Rainer Neske left the Management Board with effect from the end of June 30, 2015. On the basis of the termination agreement, a severance payment in the amount of  2,960,000 was agreed. The severance payment comprises the compensation payments for non-competition agreed in the employment contract. Disbursement of the severance payment takes place in two instalments. The first instalment in the amount of  1,560,000 was disbursed in January 2016. The second instalment in the amount of  1,400,000 becomes due for disbursement in July 2016 and is subject to specific forfeiture regulations as well as a regulation for the offsetting of income received from other sources.

Henry Ritchotte left the Management Board with effect from the end of December 31, 2015. The Management Board employment contract was terminated by mutual agreement. There are no further resulting rights, since Mr. Ritchotte entered into a new employment relationship within Deutsche Bank Group immediately after leaving the Management Board.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    224
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Expense for Long-Term Incentive Components

The following table presents the compensation expense recognized in the respective years for long-term incentive components of compensation granted for service on the Management Board.

 

Members of the Management Board    Amount expensed for  
     share-based compensation  
components  
     cash-based compensation  
components  
 

in

   2015        2014        2015        2014    

John Cryan1

     0           0           0           0     

Jürgen Fitschen

     1,013,489           734,201           1,170,591           1,278,486     

Anshuman Jain2

     3,350,789           707,318           2,852,503           2,140,366     

Stefan Krause

     2,726,735           464,263           1,754,083           946,856     

Dr. Stephan Leithner3

     2,367,167           496,929           1,566,589           500,137     

Stuart Lewis

     633,658           447,126           663,466           487,735     

Sylvie Matherat4

     0           0           0           0     

Rainer Neske2

     2,474,164           487,657           1,845,774           996,551     

Henry Ritchotte

     631,719           484,343           635,927           487,735     

Karl von Rohr4

     0           0           0           0     

Dr. Marcus Schenck5

     0           0           0           0     

Christian Sewing6

     0           0           0           0     

 

 
1 

Member of the Management Board from July 1, 2015.

2 

Member of the Management Board until June 30, 2015.

3 

Member of the Management Board until October 31, 2015.

4 

Member of the Management Board from November 1, 2015.

5 

Member of the Management Board from May 22, 2015.

6 

Member of the Management Board from January 1, 2015.

Management Board Share Ownership

As of February 19, 2016 and February 21, 2015, respectively, the current members of the Management Board held Deutsche Bank shares as presented below:

 

Members of the Management Board

  

 

     Number  
of shares  
 

John Cryan1

     2016           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Jürgen Fitschen

     2016           266,739     
     2015           262,166     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Stuart Lewis

     2016           51,347     
     2015           51,347     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Sylvie Matherat2

     2016           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Quintin Price3

     2016           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Garth Ritchie3

     2016           28,778     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Karl von Rohr2

     2016           2,747     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Dr. Marcus Schenck4

     2016           26,445     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Christian Sewing5

     2016           36,249     
     2015           30,488     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Jeffrey Urwin3

     2016           120,690     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     2016           532,995     
  

 

 

    

 

 

 
     2015           344,001     

 

 
1 

Member of the Management Board from July 1, 2015.

2 

Member of the Management Board from November 1, 2015.

3 

Member of the Management Board from January 1, 2016.

4 

Member of the Management Board from May 22, 2015.

5 

Member of the Management Board from January 1, 2015.

The current members of the Management Board held an aggregate of 532,995 Deutsche Bank shares on February 19, 2016, amounting to approximately 0.04 % of Deutsche Bank shares issued on that date.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
225   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

The following table shows the number of share awards held by the Management Board members as of February 19, 2016 and February 21, 2015 as well as the number of share awards newly granted, delivered or forfeited in this period.

 

Members of the Management Board

   Balance as of  
Feb 21, 2015  
     Granted        Delivered        Forfeited        Balance as of  
Feb 19, 2016  
 

John Cryan1

     –           –           –           –           17,441     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Jürgen Fitschen

     294,514           5,953           9,439           0           291,028     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Stuart Lewis

     162,310           4,228           0           0           166,538     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Sylvie Matherat2

     –           –           –           –           3,217     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Quintin Price3

     –           –           –           –           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Garth Ritchie3

     –           –           –           –           244,227     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Karl von Rohr2

     –           –           –           –           22,846     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Marcus Schenck4

     –           –           –           –           132,517     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Christian Sewing5

     93,811           2,444           10,747           0           85,508     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Jeffrey Urwin3

                                                 379,808     

 

 
1 

Member of the Management Board from July 1, 2015.

2 

Member of the Management Board from November 1, 2015.

3 

Member of the Management Board from January 1, 2016.

4 

Member of the Management Board from May 22, 2015.

5 

Member of the Management Board from January 1, 2015.

Compensation System for Supervisory Board Members

The compensation principles for Supervisory Board members are set forth in our Articles of Association, which our shareholders amend from time to time at the Annual General Meeting. Such compensation provisions were last amended by resolution of the Annual General Meeting on May 22, 2014 which became effective on July 17, 2014. Accordingly, the following provisions apply:

The members of the Supervisory Board receive fixed annual compensation (“Supervisory Board Compensation”). The annual base compensation amounts to 100,000 for each Supervisory Board member. The Supervisory Board Chairman receives twice that amount and the Deputy Chairperson one and a half times that amount.

Members and chairs of the committees of the Supervisory Board are paid additional fixed annual compensation as follows:

 

     Dec 31, 2015    

in

Committee

   Chairperson        Member    

Audit Committee

     200,000           100,000     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Risk Committee

     200,000           100,000     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Nomination Committee

     100,000           50,000     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Mediation Committee

     0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Integrity Committee

     200,000           100,000     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Chairman’s Committee

     100,000           50,000     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Compensation Control Committee

     100,000           50,000     

 

 

75 % of the compensation determined is disbursed to each Supervisory Board member after submitting invoices in February of the following year. The other 25 % is converted by the company at the same time into company shares based on the average closing price on the Frankfurt Stock Exchange (Xetra or successor system) during the last ten trading days of the preceding January, calculated to three digits after the decimal point. The share value of this number of shares is paid to the respective Supervisory Board member in February of the year following his departure from the Supervisory Board or the expiration of his term of office, based on the average closing price on the Frankfurt Stock Exchange (Xetra or successor system) during the last ten trading days of the preceding January, provided that the member does not leave the Supervisory Board due to important cause which would have justified dismissal.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    226
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

In case of a change in Supervisory Board membership during the year, compensation for the financial year will be paid on a pro rata basis, rounded up/down to full months. For the year of departure, the entire compensation is paid in cash; a forfeiture regulation applies to 25 % of the compensation for that financial year.

The company reimburses the Supervisory Board members for the cash expenses they incur in the performance of their office, including any value added tax (VAT) on their compensation and reimbursements of expenses. Furthermore, any employer contributions to social security schemes that may be applicable under foreign law to the performance of their Supervisory Board work shall be paid for each Supervisory Board member affected. Finally, the Supervisory Board Chairman will be appropriately reimbursed for travel expenses incurred in performing representative tasks that his function requires and for the costs of security measures required on account of his function.

In the interest of the company, the members of the Supervisory Board will be included in an appropriate amount, with a deductible, in any financial liability insurance policy held by the company. The premiums for this are paid by the company.

Supervisory Board Compensation for the 2015 Financial Year

Individual members of the Supervisory Board received the following compensation for the 2015 financial year (excluding value added tax).

 

    Compensation for fiscal year 2015       Compensation for fiscal year 2014    

Members of the Supervisory Board

in

    Fixed          Paid out in February 2016          Fixed          Paid out in February 2015     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Dr. Paul Achleitner

    808,333          606,250          818,548          613,911     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Alfred Herling

    300,000          225,000          272,849          204,637     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Wolfgang Böhr1

    8,333          6,250          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Frank Bsirske

    250,000          187,500          222,849          167,137     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

John Cryan2

    200,000          200,000          400,000          300,000     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Dina Dublon

    291,667          218,750          200,000          150,000     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Katherine Garrett-Cox

    100,000          75,000          100,000          75,000     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Timo Heider

    200,000          150,000          172,849          129,637     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Sabine Irrgang

    200,000          150,000          172,849          129,637     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Prof. Dr. Henning Kagermann

    250,000          187,500          222,849          167,137     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Martina Klee

    200,000          150,000          172,849          129,637     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Suzanne Labarge3

    0          0          100,000          100,000     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Peter Löscher

    200,000          150,000          172,849          129,637     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Henriette Mark

    200,000          150,000          200,000          150,000     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Richard Meddings4

    100,000          75,000          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Louise Parent3

    200,000          150,000          91,667          68,750     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gabriele Platscher

    200,000          150,000          200,000          150,000     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Bernd Rose

    200,000          150,000          200,000          150,000     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Rudolf Stockem

    200,000          150,000          200,000          150,000     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Stephan Szukalski5

    91,667          91,667          100,000          75,000     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Dr. Johannes Teyssen

    150,000          112,500          122,849          92,137     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Georg Thoma

    300,000          225,000          245,699          184,274     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Prof. Dr. Klaus Rüdiger Trützschler

    200,000          150,000          200,000          150,000     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    4,850,000          3,710,417          4,588,710          3,466,532     

 

 
1 

Member since December 1, 2015.

2 

Member until June 30, 2015.

3 

Member until June 30, 2015.

4 

Member since October 13, 2015.

5 

Member until November 30, 2015.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
227   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

Following the submission of invoices in February 2016, 25 % of the compensation determined for each Supervisory Board member for the 2015 financial year was converted into notional shares of the company on the basis of a share price of  17.325 (average closing price on the Frankfurt Stock Exchange (Xetra) during the last ten trading days of January 2016, calculated to three digits after the decimal point). Members who left the Supervisory Board in 2015 were paid the entire amount of compensation in cash.

The following table shows the number of notional shares to three decimal places that were converted in February 2016 (2015) for members of the Supervisory Board as part of their 2015 (2014) compensation as well as the number of notional shares accumulated during the respective membership to the Supervisory Board:

 

    Number of notional shares          

Members of the Supervisory Board

   

 

 

 

 

Converted in  

February 2016  

as part of the  

compensation  

2015  

  

  

  

  

  

   

 

 

Total prior-year  

amounts from  

2013 and 2014  

  

  

  

    Total (cumulative)         

 

 

Paid out in  

February 2016  

in 1

  

  

  

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Dr. Paul Achleitner

    11,664.262          12,340.921          24,005.183          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Alfred Herling

    4,329.004          3,925.643          8,254.647          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Wolfgang Böhr

    120.250          0          120.250          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Frank Bsirske

    3,607.504          2,818.415          6,425.919          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

John Cryan2

    0          5,473.868          5,473.868          94,835     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Dina Dublon

    4,208.754          2,172.941          6,381.695          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Katherine Garrett-Cox

    1,443.001          1,650.463          3,093.464          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Timo Heider

    2,886.003          2,275.180          5,161.183          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Sabine Irrgang

    2,886.003          2,275.180          5,161.183          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Prof. Dr. Henning Kagermann

    3,607.504          3,523.406          7,130.910          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Martina Klee

    2,886.003          2,557.176          5,443.179          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Peter Löscher

    2,886.003          2,557.176          5,443.179          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Henriette Mark

    2,886.003          3,300.927          6,186.930          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Richard Meddings

    1,443.001          0          1,443.001          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Louise Parent

    2,886.003          892.533          3,778.536          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gabriele Platscher

    2,886.003          3,018.930          5,904.933          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Bernd Rose

    2,886.003          2,736.934          5,622.937          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Rudolf Stockem

    2,886.003          3,018.930          5,904.933          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Stephan Szukalski3

    0          1,368.467          1,368.467          23,709     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Dr. Johannes Teyssen

    2,164.502          1,872.942          4,037.444          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Georg Thoma

    4,329.004          3,181.891          7,510.895          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Prof. Dr. Klaus Rüdiger Trützschler

    2,886.003          3,300.927          6,186.930          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    65,776.816          64,262.850          130,039.666          118,544     

 

 
1 

At a value of  17.325 based on the average closing price on the Frankfurt Stock Exchange (Xetra or successor system) during the last ten trading days of January 2016.

2 

Member of the Supervisory Board until June 30, 2015.

3 

Member of the Supervisory Board until November 30, 2015.

As Suzanne Labarge left the Supervisory Board on June 30, 2104, the value of her virtual shares amounting to  34,755 was paid to her in February 2015.

All employee representatives on the Supervisory Board, with the exception of Frank Bsirske and Rudolf Stockem, are employed by us. In the 2015 financial year, we paid such members a total amount of  1.14 million in the form of salary, retirement and pension compensation in addition to their Supervisory Board compensation.

We do not provide members of the Supervisory Board with any benefits after they have left the Supervisory Board, though members who are or were employed by us are entitled to the benefits associated with the termination of such employment. During 2015, we set aside  0.08 million for pension, retirement or similar benefits for the members of the Supervisory Board who are or were employed by us.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    228
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

With the agreement of the Bank’s Management Board, Dr. Paul Achleitner performs representative functions in various ways on an unpaid basis for the Bank and participates in opportunities for referrals of business for the Bank. These tasks are related to the functional responsibilities of the Chairman of the Supervisory Board of Deutsche Bank AG. In this respect, the reimbursement of costs is regulated in the Articles of Association. On the basis of a separate contractual agreement, the Bank provides Dr. Paul Achleitner with infrastructure and support services free of charge for his services in the interest of the Bank. He is therefore entitled to avail himself of internal resources for preparing and carrying out his activities. The Bank’s security and car services are available for Dr. Paul Achleitner to use free of charge for these tasks. The Bank also reimburses travel expenses and participation fees and covers the taxes for any non-cash benefits provided. On September 24, 2012, the Chairman’s Committee approved the conclusion of this agreement. The provisions apply for the duration of Dr. Paul Achleitner’s tenure as Chairman of the Supervisory Board and are reviewed on an annual basis for appropriateness. Under this agreement between Deutsche Bank and Dr. Achleitner, support services equivalent to  203,000 (2014:  206,000) were provided and reimbursements for expenses amounting to  233,867 (2014:  196,271) were paid during the 2015 financial year.

[Portion of page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
229   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

 

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    230
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Employees

Group Headcount

As of December 31, 2015, we employed a total of 101,104 staff members as compared to 98,138 as of December 31, 2014. We calculate our employee figures on a full-time equivalent basis, meaning we include proportionate numbers of part-time employees.

The following table shows our numbers of full-time equivalent employees as of December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013.

 

Employees1

   Dec 31, 2015        Dec 31, 2014      Dec 31, 2013  

Germany

     45,757           45,392           46,377     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Europe (outside Germany), Middle East and Africa

     23,767           23,063           23,186     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Asia/Pacific

     20,144           19,023           18,361     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

North America2, 3

     10,842           10,054           9,752     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Latin America

     595           606           578     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total employees3

     101,104           98,138           98,254     

 

 
1 

Full-time equivalent employees; in 2014, the employees of Mauritius previously shown in Europe (outside Germany), Middle East and Africa were assigned to Asia/Pacific; numbers for 2013 (186 employees) have been reclassified to reflect this.

2 

Primarily the United States.

3 

The Cosmopolitan of Las Vegas was sold in 2014. The nominal headcount of The Cosmopolitan of Las Vegas was 4,393 as of December 31, 2013. This headcount number was composed of full time and part time employees and is not part of the Group’s full time equivalent employees figures.

The number of our employees increased in 2015 by 2,966 or 3.0 % due to the following factors:

 

 

In Corporate Banking & Securities (CB&S), the number of staff went down by 245 primarily due to adjustments related to the market development.

 

 

In Global Transaction Banking (GTB), the number of employees increased by 143 mostly driven by the development in Institutional Cash & Securities Services.

 

 

The number of staff in Deutsche Asset & Wealth Management (Deutsche AWM) increased by 157. This was particularly a result of the development in the UK and in the US.

 

 

Total staff in Private & Business Clients (PBC) decreased by 265 driven by reductions primarily in Germany and in Italy.

 

 

In the Non-Core Operations Unit (NCOU), the number of employees decreased by 58 primarily due to CB&S related Non-Core Operations.

 

 

In our Infrastructure functions, staff numbers increased by 3,234, mainly due to further build out of our captive operative platforms and due to strengthening of control functions, e.g. Compliance, Risk and Audit.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
231   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

 

LOGO

Labor Relations

In Germany, labor unions and employers’ associations generally negotiate collective bargaining agreements on salaries and benefits for employees below the management level. Many companies in Germany, including ourselves and our material German subsidiaries, are members of employers’ associations and are bound by collective bargaining agreements.

Each year, our employers’ association, the Arbeitgeberverband des privaten Bankgewerbes e.V., ordinarily renegotiates the collective bargaining agreements that cover many of our employees. The current agreement reached in June 2014 includes a pay raise of 2.4 % from July 2014 and a second pay rise of 2.1 % from July 2015 on, plus a single payment of 150 in January 2015. The existing collective bargaining agreement regarding early retirement has not been extended and ends April 2016.

Our employers’ association negotiates with the following unions:

 

 

ver.di (Vereinigte Dienstleistungsgewerkschaft), a union formed in July 2001 resulting from the merger of five unions, including the former bank unions Deutsche Angestellten Gewerkschaft and Gewerkschaft Handel, Banken und Versicherungen;

 

Deutscher Bankangestellten Verband (DBV – Gewerkschaft der Finanzdienstleister);

 

Deutscher Handels- und Industrieangestellten Verband (DHV – Die Berufsgewerkschaft);

 

Komba Gewerkschaft (public service union, only relevant for Postbank);

 

DPVKom – Die Kommunikationsgewerkschaft (only relevant for Postbank).

German law prohibits us from asking our employees whether they are members of labor unions. Therefore, we do not know how many of our employees are union members. Approximately 15 % of the employees in the German banking industry are unionized. We estimate that less than 15 % of our employees in Germany are unionized (excluding Postbank, which itself has traditionally had a significantly higher unionization rate of approximately 60 %). On a worldwide basis, we estimate that approximately 15 % of our employees are members of labor unions (including Postbank, less than 25 %).

As of December 31, 2015, 33 % of Postbank staff members in Germany are civil servants (full-time equivalent basis), compared to 34 % as of December 31, 2014.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    232
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Post-Employment Benefit Plans

We sponsor a number of post-employment benefit plans on behalf of our employees, both defined contribution plans and defined benefit plans.

In our globally coordinated accounting process covering defined benefit plans with a defined benefit obligation exceeding  2 million our global actuary reviews the valuations provided by locally appointed actuaries in each country.

By applying our global principles for determining the financial and demographic assumptions we ensure that the assumptions are best-estimate, unbiased and mutually compatible, and that they are globally consistent.

For a further discussion on our employee benefit plans see Note 35 “Employee Benefits” to our consolidated financial statements.

[Portion of page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
233   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    234
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

 

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
235   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

 

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    236
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

 

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
237   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    238
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

 

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
239   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

 

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    240
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

 

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
241   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

 

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    1 – Management Report    242
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

 

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
243   Deutsche Bank   Operating and Financial Review – 30   Employees – 230
  Annual Report 2015   Outlook – 70   Internal Control over Financial Reporting – 235
    Risk and Opportunities – 77   Information pursuant to Section – 315 (4)
    Risk Report – 79   Of the German Commercial Code and
    Compensation Report – 188   Explanatory Report – 239
    Corporate Responsibility – 228  
                              
     

 

                    

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

 

 


Table of Contents

2 – Consolidated Financial Statements

245   Consolidated Statement of Income
246   Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income
247   Consolidated Balance Sheet
248   Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity
250   Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows
251   Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements
  1 –   Significant Accounting Policies and Critical Accounting Estimates – 251
  2 –   Recently Adopted and New Accounting Pronouncements – 275
  3 –   Acquisitions and Dispositions – 277
  4 –   Business Segments and Related Information – 279
283   Notes to the Consolidated Income Statement
  5 –   Net Interest Income and Net Gains (Losses) on Financial Assets/Liabilities at Fair Value through Profit or Loss – 283
  6 –   Commissions and Fee Income – 285
  7 –   Net Gains (Losses) on Financial Assets Available for Sale – 285
  8 –   Other Income – 286
  9 –   General and Administrative Expenses – 286
  10 –   Restructuring – 286
  11 –   Earnings per Share – 287
289   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet
  12 –   Financial Assets/Liabilities at Fair Value through Profit or Loss – 289
  13 –   Amendments to IAS 39 and IFRS 7, “Reclassification of Financial Assets” – 290
  14 –   Financial Instruments carried at Fair Value – 293
  15 –   Fair Value of Financial Instruments not carried at Fair Value – 307
  16 –   Financial Assets Available for Sale – 309
  17 –   Equity Method Investments – 310
  18 –   Offsetting Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities – 310
  19 –   Loans – 315
  20 –   Allowance for Credit Losses – 316
  21 –   Transfers of Financial Assets – 316
  22 –   Assets Pledged and Received as Collateral – 319
  23 –   Property and Equipment – 320
  24 –   Leases – 321
  25 –   Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets – 322
  26 –   Non-Current Assets and Disposal Groups Held for Sale – 329
  27 –   Other Assets and Other Liabilities – 332
  28 –   Deposits – 332
  29 –   Provisions – 333
  30 –   Credit related Commitments – 348
  31 –   Other Short-Term Borrowings – 350
  32 –   Long-Term Debt and Trust Preferred Securities – 350
  33 –   Maturity Analysis of the earliest contractual undiscounted cash flows of Financial Liabilities – 351
353   Additional Notes
  34 –   Common Shares – 353
  35 –   Employee Benefits – 354
  36 –   Income Taxes – 368
  37 –   Derivatives – 370
  38 –   Related Party Transactions – 372
  39 –   Information on Subsidiaries – 374
  40 –   Structured Entities – 375
  41 –   Insurance and Investment Contracts – 380
  42 –   Current and Non-Current Assets and Liabilities – 383
  43 –   Events after the Reporting Period – 384
  44 –   Condensed Deutsche Bank AG (Parent Company only) Financial Information – 385
  45 –   SEC Registered Trust Preferred Securities – 388
417  
 


Table of Contents
245   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Consolidated Statement of Income

 

in m.

   Notes        2015        2014        2013    

Interest and similar income

     5           25,967           25,001           25,601     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Interest expense

     5           10,086           10,729           10,767     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net interest income

     5           15,881           14,272           14,834     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Provision for credit losses

     20           956           1,134           2,065     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net interest income after provision for credit losses

        14,925           13,138           12,769     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Commissions and fee income

     6           12,765           12,409           12,308     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss

     5           3,842           4,299           3,817     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net gains (losses) on financial assets available for sale

     7           203           242           394     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net income (loss) from equity method investments

     17           164           619           369     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other income (loss)

     8           669           108           193     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total noninterest income

        17,644           17,677           17,082     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Compensation and benefits

     35           13,293           12,512           12,329     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

General and administrative expenses

     9           18,632           14,654           15,126     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Policyholder benefits and claims

        256           289           460     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets

     25           5,776           111           79     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Restructuring activities

     10           710           133           399     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total noninterest expenses

        38,667           27,699           28,394     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Income (loss) before income taxes

        (6,097)          3,116           1,457     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Income tax expense

     36           675           1,425           775     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

        (6,772)          1,691           681     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net income attributable to noncontrolling interests

        21           28           15     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net income (loss) attributable to Deutsche Bank shareholders and additional equity components

        (6,794)          1,663           666     

 

 

Earnings per Share

 

in    Notes        2015        2014        2013    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Earnings per share:1

     11              

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Basic

        (5.06)2        1.34         0.64     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Diluted

        (5.06)2        1.31         0.62     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Number of shares in million:1

           

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Denominator for basic earnings per share – weighted-average shares outstanding         1,387.9           1,241.9           1,045.4     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Denominator for diluted earnings per share – adjusted weighted-average shares after assumed conversions 3         1,387.9           1,269.5           1,073.2     

 

 
1 

The number of average basic and diluted shares outstanding has been adjusted for all periods before June 2014 in order to reflect the effect of the bonus component of subscription rights issued in June 2014 in connection with the capital increase.

2 

Earnings were adjusted by 228 million net of tax for the coupons paid on Additional Tier 1 Notes in April 2015.

3 

Due to the net loss situation for 2015 potentially dilutive shares are generally not considered for the earnings per share calculation, because to do so would decrease the net loss per share. Under a net income situation however, the number of adjusted weighted average shares after assumed conversion would have been increased by 27 million shares for 2015.

The accompanying notes are an integral part of the Consolidated Financial Statements.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    246
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income

 

in m.

  2015       2014       2013    

Net income recognized in the income statement

    (6,772)         1,691          681     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income

     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss

     

Remeasurement gains (losses) related to defined benefit plans, before tax

    203          (403)         (717)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total of income tax related to items that will not be reclassified to profit or loss

    (213)         407          58     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Items that are or may be reclassified to profit or loss

     

Financial assets available for sale

     

Unrealized net gains (losses) arising during the period, before tax

    (242)         1,912          64     

Realized net (gains) losses arising during the period (reclassified to profit or loss), before tax

    (163)         (87)         (313)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Derivatives hedging variability of cash flows

     

Unrealized net gains (losses) arising during the period, before tax

    1          (6)         91     

Realized net (gains) losses arising during the period (reclassified to profit or loss), before tax

    20          339          35     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Assets classified as held for sale

     

Unrealized net gains (losses) arising during the period, before tax

    662          0          3     

Realized net (gains) losses arising during the period (reclassified to profit or loss), before tax

    0          (3)         0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Foreign currency translation

     

Unrealized net gains (losses) arising during the period, before tax

    2,156          2,955          (948)    

Realized net (gains) losses arising during the period (reclassified to profit or loss), before tax

    4          3          (1)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Equity Method Investments

     

Net gains (losses) arising during the period

    48          (35)         63     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total of income tax related to items that are or may be reclassified to profit or loss

    19          (672)         (160)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax

    2,493          4,410          (1,825)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total comprehensive income (loss), net of tax

    (4,278)         6,102          (1,144)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Attributable to:

     

Noncontrolling interests

    45          54          13     

Deutsche Bank shareholders and additional equity components

    (4,323)         6,048          (1,157)    

 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of the Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
247   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Consolidated Balance Sheet

 

in m.

  Notes       Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 2014    

Assets:

     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and central bank balances 1

      96,940          74,482     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Interbank balances (w/o central banks) 1

      12,842          9,090     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Central bank funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements

    21, 22          22,456          17,796     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Securities borrowed

    21, 22          33,557          25,834     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial assets at fair value through profit or loss

     

Trading assets

      196,035          195,681     

Positive market values from derivative financial instruments

      515,594          629,958     

Financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss

      109,253          117,285     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total financial assets at fair value through profit or loss

    12, 16, 21, 22, 37          820,883          942,924     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial assets available for sale

    16, 21, 22          73,583          64,297     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Equity method investments

    17          1,013          4,143     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loans

    19, 20, 21, 22          427,749          405,612     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Property and equipment

    23          2,846          2,909     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Goodwill and other intangible assets

    25          10,078          14,951     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other assets

    26, 27          118,137          137,980     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Assets for current tax

    36          1,285          1,819     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Deferred tax assets

    36          7,762          6,865     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

      1,629,130          1,708,703     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Liabilities and equity:

     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Deposits

    28          566,974          532,931     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Central bank funds purchased and securities sold under repurchase agreements     21, 22          9,803          10,887     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Securities loaned

    21, 22          3,270          2,339     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss

    12, 16, 37         

Trading liabilities

      52,304          41,843     

Negative market values from derivative financial instruments

      494,076          610,202     

Financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss

      44,852          37,131     

Investment contract liabilities

      8,522          8,523     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss

      599,754          697,699     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other short-term borrowings

    31          28,010          42,931     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other liabilities

    26, 27          175,005          183,823     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Provisions

    20, 29          9,207          6,677     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Liabilities for current tax

    36          1,699          1,608     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Deferred tax liabilities

    36          746          1,175     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Long-term debt

    32          160,016          144,837     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Trust preferred securities

    32          7,020          10,573     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Obligation to purchase common shares

      0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

      1,561,506          1,635,481     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Common shares, no par value, nominal value of  2.56

    34          3,531          3,531     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Additional paid-in capital

      33,572          33,626     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Retained earnings

      21,182          29,279     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Common shares in treasury, at cost

    34          (10)         (8)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Equity classified as obligation to purchase common shares

      0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax

      4,404          1,923     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total shareholders’ equity

      62,678          68,351     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Additional equity components

      4,675          4,619     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Noncontrolling interests

      270          253     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total equity

      67,624          73,223     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities and equity

      1,629,130          1,708,703     

 

   

 

 

 
1 

In 2015, comparatives have been restated. See Note 1 “Significant Accounting Policies and Critical Accounting Estimates – Significant Changes in Estimates and Changes in Presentation” for detailed information.

The accompanying notes are an integral part of the Consolidated Financial Statements.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    248
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity

 

 

 

in m.

   

 

Common shares  

(no par value)  

  

  

   

 

Additional  

paid-in capital  

  

  

   

 

Retained  

earnings  

  

  

   

 

 

 

Common  

shares in  

treasury,  

at cost  

  

  

  

  

   
 

 

 

 

Equity  
classified as  

obligation to  

purchase  

common shares  

  
  

  

  

  

 

 

 

 
 

 

 

 

Unrealized net

gains (losses)

on financial
assets available

for sale, net

of applicable

tax and other

  

  

  
  

  

  

2 

Balance as of December 31, 2012     2,380                  23,776              29,199           (60)           0                    468             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total comprehensive income, net of tax 1     0                  0              666           0           0                    (165)            

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Common shares issued     230                  2,731              0           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Cash dividends paid     0                  0              (764)           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Coupon on additional equity components, net of tax     0                  0              0           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Remeasurement gains (losses) related to defined benefit plans, net of tax     0                  0              (659)           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Net change in share awards in the reporting period     0                  (385)             0           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Treasury shares distributed under share-based compensation plans     0                  0              0           1,160           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Tax benefits related to share-based compensation plans     0                  30              0           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Additions to Equity classified as obligation to purchase common shares     0                  0              0           0           (1)                   0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Deductions from Equity classified as obligation to purchase common shares     0                  0              0           0           1                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Option premiums and other effects from options on common shares     0                  (49)             0           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Purchases of treasury shares     0                  0              0           (13,648)           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Sale of treasury shares     0                  0              0           12,535           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Net gains (losses) on treasury shares sold     0                  (49)             0           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other     0                  150              (65)           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Balance as of December 31, 2013     2,610                  26,204              28,376           (13)           0                    303             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total comprehensive income, net of tax 1     0                  0              1,663           0           0                    1,372             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Common shares issued     921                  7,587              0           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Cash dividends paid     0                  0              (765)           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Coupon on additional equity components, net of tax     0                  0              0           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Remeasurement gains (losses) related to defined benefit plans, net of tax     0                  0              5           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Net change in share awards in the reporting period     0                  (103)             0           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Treasury shares distributed under share-based compensation plans     0                  0              0           840           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Tax benefits related to share-based compensation plans     0                  (32)             0           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Additions to Equity classified as obligation to purchase common shares     0                  0              0           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Deductions from Equity classified as obligation to purchase common shares     0                  0              0           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Option premiums and other effects from options on common shares     0                  (65)             0           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Purchases of treasury shares     0                  0              0           (9,187)           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Sale of treasury shares     0                  0              0           8,352           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Net gains (losses) on treasury shares sold     0                  (6)             0           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other     0                  41              0           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Balance as of December 31, 2014     3,531                  33,626              29,279           (8)           0                    1,675             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total comprehensive income, net of tax 1     0                  0              (6,794)           0           0                    (291)            

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Common shares issued     0                  0              0           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Cash dividends paid     0                  0              (1,034)           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Coupon on additional equity components, net of tax     0                  0              (228)           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Remeasurement gains (losses) related to defined benefit plans, net of tax     0                  0              (10)           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Net change in share awards in the reporting period     0                  (80)             0           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Treasury shares distributed under share-based compensation plans     0                  0              0           880           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Tax benefits related to share-based compensation plans     0                  0              0           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Additions to Equity classified as obligation to purchase common shares     0                  0              0           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Deductions from Equity classified as obligation to purchase common shares     0                  0              0           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Option premiums and other effects from options on common shares     0                  (34)             0           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Purchases of treasury shares     0                  0              0           (9,177)           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Sale of treasury shares     0                  0              0           8,295           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Net gains (losses) on treasury shares sold     0                  (3)             0           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other     0                  63              (31)           0           0                    0             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Balance as of December 31, 2015     3,531                  33,572              21,182           (10)           0                    1,384             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
1 

Excluding remeasurement gains (losses) related to defined benefit plans, net of tax.

2 

Excluding unrealized net gains (losses) from equity method investments.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
249   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

 

 
 

 
 

 

 
 

Unrealized net
gains (losses)

on derivatives
hedging

variability

of cash flows,
net of tax 2

  
  

  
  

  

  
  

   
 

 

 
 

 
 

Unrealized net
gains (losses)

on assets

classified
as held for

sale, net of
tax 2

  
  

 

  
  

  
  

   

 
 
 

 

Foreign

currency
translation,
net of

tax 2

  

  
  
  

  

   
 
 
 
 
Unrealized net
gains (losses)
from equity
method
investments
  
  
  
  
  
   

 
 
 

 

Accumulated

other
comprehensive
income,

net of tax 1

  

  
  
 

  

   
 
 
Total
shareholders’
equity
  
  
  
   
 
 
Additional
equity
components 3
  
  
  
   
 
Noncontrolling
interests
  
  
    Total equity   
  (159)                0                  (1,593)            (10)                  (1,294)                54,001            0                239               54,240       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  57                2                  (1,121)            63                  (1,164)                (498)           0                13               (485)      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                2,961            0                0               2,961       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                (764)           0                (13)               (777)      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                0            0                0               0       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                (659)           0                0               (659)      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                (385)           0                0               (385)      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                1,160            0                0               1,160       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                30            0                0               30       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                (1)           0                0               (1)      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                1            0                0               1       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                (49)           0                0               (49)      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                (13,648)           0                0               (13,648)      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                12,535            0                0               12,535       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                (49)           0                0               (49)      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                85            0                8               93       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  (101)                2                  (2,713)            53                  (2,457)                54,719            0                247               54,966       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  181                (2)                  2,865            (35)                  4,380                6,043            0                54               6,097       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                8,508            0                0               8,508          

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                (765)           0                (4)               (769)      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                0            0                0               0       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                5            0                0               5       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                (103)           0                0               (103)      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                840            0                0               840      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                (32)           0                0               (32)      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                0            0                0               0           

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                0            0                0               0       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                (65)           0                0               (65)       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                (9,187)           0                0               (9,187)      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                8,352            0                0               8,352       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                (6)           0                0               (6)       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                41            4,6194                (44)               4,616       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  79                0                  151            18                  1,923                68,351            4,619                253               73,223       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  18                662                  2,044            48                  2,481                (4,313)           0                45               (4,269)      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                0            0                0               0       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                (1,034)           0                (10)               (1,044)      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                (228)           0                0               (228)      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                (10)           0                0               (10)      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                (80)           0                0               (80)      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                880            0                0               880       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                0            0                0               0       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                0            0                0               0       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                0            0                0               0       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                (34)           0                0               (34)      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                (9,177)           0                0               (9,177)      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                8,295            0                0               8,295       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                (3)           0                0               (3)      

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  0                0                  0            0                  0                33            565                (17)               72       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
  97                 662                  2,196            66                  4,404                62,678            4,675                270               67,624       

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
3 

Includes Additional Tier 1 Notes, which constitute unsecured and subordinated notes of Deutsche Bank and are classified as equity in accordance with IFRS.

4 

Includes net proceeds from issuance, purchase and sale of Additional Equity Components.

5 

Includes net proceeds from purchase and sale of Additional Equity Components.

The accompanying notes are an integral part of the Consolidated Financial Statements.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    250
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows

 

in m.

   2015        2014        2013    

Net Income (loss)

     (6,772)           1,691           681     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash flows from operating activities:

        

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by (used in) operating activities:

        

Provision for credit losses

     956           1,134           2,065     

Restructuring activities

     710           133           399     

Gain on sale of financial assets available for sale, equity method investments, and other

     (430)          (391)          (493)    

Deferred income taxes, net

     (987)          673           (179)   

Impairment, depreciation and other amortization, and accretion

     8,908           4,567           2,443     

Share of net income from equity method investments

     (708)          (569)          (433)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Income adjusted for noncash charges, credits and other items

     1,677           7,238           4,483     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Adjustments for net change in operating assets and liabilities:

        

Interest-earning time deposits with central banks and with banks w/o central banks 1

     30,096           8,959           55,515     

Central bank funds sold, securities purchased under resale agreements, securities borrowed

     (10,108)          5,450           11,267     

Financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss

     12,935          70,639           (27)    

Loans

     (14,015)          (26,909)          16,007     

Other assets

     26,756           (28,812)          12,048     

Deposits

     26,537           1,551           (42,281)    

Financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss and investment contract liabilities

     6,101           (54,334)          (18,558)    

Central bank funds purchased, securities sold under repurchase agreements, securities loaned

     (1,120)          (2,963)          (23,080)    

Other short-term borrowings

     (16,149)          (17,875)          (9,529)    

Other liabilities

     (14,177)          22,183           (17,625)    

Senior long-term debt

     13,536           14,315           (22,056)    

Trading assets and liabilities, positive and negative market values from derivative financial instruments, net

     13,788           4,288           38,013     

Other, net

     (8,605)          (1,678)          3,007     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities

     67,252           2,052           7,184     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash flows from investing activities:

        

Proceeds from:

        

Sale of financial assets available for sale

     18,027           11,974           18,054     

Maturities of financial assets available for sale

     3,986           8,745           11,564     

Sale of equity method investments

     165           124           76     

Sale of property and equipment

     272           133           137     

Purchase of:

        

Financial assets available for sale

     (29,665)          (34,158)          (31,588)    

Equity method investments

     (95)          (78)          (21)    

Property and equipment

     (432)          (669)          (513)    

Net cash received in (paid for) business combinations/divestitures

     555           1,931           (128)    

Other, net

     (1,055)          (826)          (596)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities

     (8,242)          (12,824)          (3,015)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash flows from financing activities:

        

Issuances of subordinated long-term debt

     2,942           101           1,217     

Repayments and extinguishments of subordinated long-term debt

     (2,043)          (3,142)          (2,776)    

Issuances of trust preferred securities

     788           49           11     

Repayments and extinguishments of trust preferred securities 2

     (5,114)          (2,709)           (49)    

Common shares issued

     0           8,508           2,961     

Purchases of treasury shares

     (9,177)          (9,187)          (13,648)    

Sale of treasury shares

     8,316           8,318           12,494     

Additional Equity Components (AT1) issued

     0           4,676           0     

Purchases of Additional Equity Components (AT1)

     (407)          (921)          0     

Sale of Additional Equity Components (AT1)

     442           888           0     

Coupon on additional equity components, pre tax

     (269)          0           0     

Dividends paid to noncontrolling interests

     (10)          (4)          (13)    

Net change in noncontrolling interests

     (17)          (17)          23     

Cash dividends paid

     (1,034)          (765)          (764)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities

     (5,583)          5,795           (544)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents

     94           897           (907)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

     53,521           (4,080)          2,718     

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period

     51,960           56,041           53,321     

Cash and cash equivalents at end of period

     105,478           51,960           56,041     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities include

        

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Income taxes paid (received), net

     902           377           742     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Interest paid

     10,608           11,423           10,687     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Interest and dividends received

     26,177           25,404           25,573     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents comprise

        

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash and central bank balances (not included Interest-earning time deposits with central banks)1

     94,923           47,169           49,146     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Interbank balances (w/o central banks) (not included: time deposits with banks of  4,304 m. as of December 31, 2015, 31,612 m. as of December 31, 2014 and 39,097 m as of December 31, 2013)1

     10,555           4,791           6,895     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     105,478           51,960           56,041     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
1 

In 2015, comparatives have been restated. See Note 1 “Significant Accounting Policies and Critical Accounting Estimates – Significant Changes in Estimates and Changes in Presentation” for detailed information.

2 

In 2014, comparative has been restated in order to reflect repayments of Trust Preferred Securities.

The accompanying notes are an integral part of the Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
251   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

01 – 

Significant Accounting Policies and Critical Accounting Estimates

Basis of Accounting

Deutsche Bank Aktiengesellschaft (“Deutsche Bank” or the “Parent”) is a stock corporation organized under the laws of the Federal Republic of Germany. Deutsche Bank together with all entities in which Deutsche Bank has a controlling financial interest (the “Group”) is a global provider of a full range of corporate and investment banking, private clients and asset management products and services.

The accompanying consolidated financial statements are stated in euros, the presentation currency of the Group. All financial information presented in million euros has been rounded to the nearest million. The consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”) as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (“IASB”) and endorsed by the European Union (“EU”). The Group’s application of IFRS results in no differences between IFRS as issued by the IASB and IFRS as endorsed by the EU.

Some IFRS disclosures incorporated in the Management Report are an integral part of the Consolidated Financial Statements. These disclosures include Segmental Results of Operations and Entity Wide disclosures on Net Revenue Components under IFRS 8, “Operating Segments” provided in the Operating and Financial Review of the Management Report. Additionally the Risk Report includes disclosures about the nature and the extent of risks arising from financial instruments as required by IFRS 7, “Financial Instruments: Disclosures”, capital disclosures as required under IAS 1, “Presentation of Financial Statements” and disclosures in relation to insurance contracts as described in IFRS 4, “Insurance Contracts”. These audited disclosures are identified by bracketing in the margins of the Management Report.

Significant Changes in Estimates and Changes in Presentation

Cash and due from banks and Interest-earning deposits with banks

In the fourth quarter 2015, the Group changed the balance sheet presentation of “Cash and due from banks,” which primarily included cash and non-interest bearing deposits and “Interest-earning deposits with banks” to be better aligned with the Group’s regulatory reporting. The balances previously reported are now presented as “Cash and central bank balances” and “Interbank balances (w/o central banks)” in the Group’s consolidated balance sheet. The change reflects the regulatory reporting of deposits with central banks and non central banks where previously the Group distinguished between interest bearing and non-interest bearing deposits. Comparative information in the Group’s consolidated balance sheet and associated notes disclosure for 2014 has been restated to reflect this change. This change in presentation did not have any other impact on the Group’s consolidated financial statements in 2014 and 2015.

Critical Accounting Estimates

The preparation of financial statements under IFRS requires management to make estimates and assumptions for certain categories of assets and liabilities. These estimates and assumptions affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the balance sheet date, and the reported amounts of revenue and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from management’s estimates. The Group’s significant accounting policies are described in “Significant Accounting Policies”.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    252
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Certain of the Group’s accounting policies require critical accounting estimates that involve complex and subjective judgments and the use of assumptions, some of which may be for matters that are inherently uncertain and susceptible to change. Such critical accounting estimates could change from period to period and may have a material impact on the Group’s financial condition, changes in financial condition or results of operations. Critical accounting estimates could also involve estimates where management could have reasonably used another estimate in the current accounting period. The Group has identified the following significant accounting policies that involve critical accounting estimates:

 

 

the impairment of associates (see “Associates” below)

 

the impairment of financial assets available for sale (see “Financial Assets and Liabilities – Financial Assets Classified as Available for Sale” below)

 

the determination of fair value (see “Financial Assets and Liabilities – Determination of Fair Value” below)

 

the recognition of trade date profit (see “Financial Assets and Liabilities – Recognition of Trade Date Profit” below)

 

the impairment of loans and provisions for off-balance sheet positions (see “Impairment of Loans and Provision for Off-balance Sheet Positions” below)

 

the impairment of goodwill and other intangibles (see “Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets” below)

 

the recognition and measurement of deferred tax assets (see “Income Taxes” below)

 

the accounting for legal and regulatory contingencies and uncertain tax positions (see “Provisions” below)

Significant Accounting Policies

The following is a description of the significant accounting policies of the Group. Other than as previously described, these policies have been consistently applied for 2013, 2014 and 2015.

Principles of Consolidation

The financial information in the Consolidated Financial Statements includes the parent company, Deutsche Bank AG, together with its consolidated subsidiaries, including certain structured entities presented as a single economic unit.

Subsidiaries

The Group’s subsidiaries are those entities which it directly or indirectly controls. Control over an entity is evidenced by the Group’s ability to exercise its power in order to affect any variable returns that the Group is exposed to through its involvement with the entity.

The Group sponsors the formation of structured entities and interacts with structured entities sponsored by third parties for a variety of reasons, including allowing clients to hold investments in separate legal entities, allowing clients to invest jointly in alternative assets, for asset securitization transactions, and for buying or selling credit protection.

When assessing whether to consolidate an entity, the Group evaluates a range of control factors, namely:

 

 

the purpose and design of the entity

 

the relevant activities and how these are determined

 

whether the Group’s rights result in the ability to direct the relevant activities

 

whether the Group has exposure or rights to variable returns

 

whether the Group has the ability to use its power to affect the amount of its returns

Where voting rights are relevant, the Group is deemed to have control where it holds, directly or indirectly, more than half of the voting rights over an entity unless there is evidence that another investor has the practical ability to unilaterally direct the relevant activities.

Potential voting rights that are deemed to be substantive are also considered when assessing control.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
253   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Likewise, the Group also assesses existence of control where it does not control the majority of the voting power but has the practical ability to unilaterally direct the relevant activities. This may arise in circumstances where the size and dispersion of holdings of the shareholders give the Group the power to direct the activities of the investee.

Subsidiaries are consolidated from the date on which control is transferred to the Group and are deconsolidated from the date that control ceases.

The Group reassesses the consolidation status at least at every quarterly reporting date. Therefore, any changes in the structure leading to a change in one or more of the control factors, require reassessment when they occur. This includes changes in decision making rights, changes in contractual arrangements, changes in the financing, ownership or capital structure as well as changes following a trigger event which was anticipated in the original documentation.

All intercompany transactions, balances and unrealized gains on transactions between Group companies are eliminated on consolidation.

Consistent accounting policies are applied throughout the Group for the purposes of consolidation. Issuances of a subsidiary’s stock to third parties are treated as noncontrolling interests. Profit or loss attributable to noncontrolling interests are reported separately in the Consolidated Statement of Income and Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income.

At the date that control of a subsidiary is lost, the Group a) derecognizes the assets (including attributable goodwill) and liabilities of the subsidiary at their carrying amounts, b) derecognizes the carrying amount of any noncontrolling interests in the former subsidiary, c) recognizes the fair value of the consideration received and any distribution of the shares of the subsidiary, d) recognizes any investment retained in the former subsidiary at its fair value and e) recognizes any resulting difference of the above items as a gain or loss in the income statement. Any amounts recognized in prior periods in other comprehensive income in relation to that subsidiary would be reclassified to the Consolidated Statement of Income or transferred directly to retained earnings if required by other IFRSs.

Associates

An associate is an entity in which the Group has significant influence, but not a controlling interest, over the operating and financial management policy decisions of the entity. Significant influence is generally presumed when the Group holds between 20 % and 50 % of the voting rights. The existence and effect of potential voting rights that are currently exercisable or convertible are considered in assessing whether the Group has significant influence. Among the other factors that are considered in determining whether the Group has significant influence are representation on the board of directors (supervisory board in the case of German stock corporations) and material intercompany transactions. The existence of these factors could require the application of the equity method of accounting for a particular investment even though the Group’s investment is less than 20 % of the voting stock.

Investments in associates are accounted for under the equity method of accounting. The Group’s share of the results of associates is adjusted to conform to the accounting policies of the Group and is reported in the Consolidated Statement of Income as Net income (loss) from equity method investments. The Group’s share in the associate’s profits and losses resulting from intercompany sales is eliminated on consolidation.

If the Group previously held an equity interest in an entity (for example, as available for sale) and subsequently gained significant influence, the previously held equity interest is remeasured to fair value and any gain or loss is recognized in the Consolidated Statement of Income. Any amounts previously recognized in other comprehensive income associated with the equity interest would be reclassified to the Consolidated Statement of Income at the date the Group gains significant influence, as if the Group had disposed of the previously held equity interest.

Under the equity method of accounting, the Group’s investments in associates and jointly controlled entities are initially recorded at cost including any directly related transaction costs incurred in acquiring the associate, and subsequently increased (or decreased) to reflect both the Group’s pro-rata share of the post-acquisition net income (or loss) of the associate or jointly controlled entity and other movements included directly in the equity of the associate or jointly controlled

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    254
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

entity. Goodwill arising on the acquisition of an associate or a jointly controlled entity is included in the carrying value of the investment (net of any accumulated impairment loss). As goodwill is not reported separately it is not specifically tested for impairment. Rather, the entire equity method investment is tested for impairment at each balance sheet date.

If there is objective evidence of impairment, an impairment test is performed by comparing the investment’s recoverable amount, which is the higher of its value in use and fair value less costs to sell, with its carrying amount. An impairment loss recognized in prior periods is only reversed if there has been a change in the estimates used to determine the investment’s recoverable amount since the last impairment loss was recognized. If this is the case the carrying amount of the investment is increased to its higher recoverable amount.

At the date that the Group ceases to have significant influence over the associate or jointly controlled entity the Group recognizes a gain or loss on the disposal of the equity method investment equal to the difference between the sum of the fair value of any retained investment and the proceeds from disposing of the associate and the carrying amount of the investment. Amounts recognized in prior periods in other comprehensive income in relation to the associate are accounted for on the same basis as would have been required if the investee had directly disposed of the related assets or liabilities.

Critical Accounting Estimates: As the assessment of whether there is objective evidence of impairment may require significant management judgement and the estimates for impairment could change from period to period based on future events that may or may not occur, the Group considers this to be a critical accounting estimate.

Foreign Currency Translation

The Consolidated Financial Statements are prepared in euro, which is the presentation currency of the Group. Various entities in the Group use a different functional currency, being the currency of the primary economic environment in which the entity operates.

An entity records foreign currency revenues, expenses, gains and losses in its functional currency using the exchange rates prevailing at the dates of recognition.

Monetary assets and liabilities denominated in currencies other than the entity’s functional currency are translated at the period end closing rate. Foreign exchange gains and losses resulting from the translation and settlement of these items are recognized in the Consolidated Statement of Income as net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss in order to align the translation amounts with those recognized from foreign currency related transactions (derivatives) which hedge these monetary assets and liabilities.

Nonmonetary items that are measured at historical cost are translated using the historical exchange rate at the date of the transaction. Translation differences on nonmonetary items which are held at fair value through profit or loss are recognized in profit or loss. Translation differences on available for sale nonmonetary items (equity securities) are included in other comprehensive income and recognised in the Consolidated Statement of Income when the non-monetary item is sold as part of the overall gain or loss on sale of the item.

For purposes of translation into the presentation currency, assets, liabilities and equity of foreign operations are translated at the period end closing rate and items of income and expense are translated into euros at the rates prevailing on the dates of the transactions, or average rates of exchange where these approximate actual rates. The exchange differences arising on the translation of a foreign operation are included in other comprehensive income. For foreign operations that are subsidiaries, the amount of exchange differences attributable to any noncontrolling interests is recognized in noncontrolling interests.

Upon disposal of a foreign subsidiary and associate (which results in loss of control or significant influence over that operation) the total cumulative exchange differences recognized in other comprehensive income are reclassified to profit or loss.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
255   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Upon partial disposal of a foreign operation that is a subsidiary and which does not result in loss of control, the proportionate share of cumulative exchange differences is reclassified from other comprehensive income to noncontrolling interests as this is deemed a transaction with equity holders. For a partial disposal of an associate which does not result in a loss of significant influence, the proportionate share of cumulative exchange differences is reclassified from other comprehensive income to profit or loss.

Interest, Commissions and Fees

Revenue is recognized when the amount of revenue and associated costs can be reliably measured, it is probable that economic benefits associated with the transaction will be realized and the stage of completion of the transaction can be reliably measured. This concept is applied to the key revenue generating activities of the Group as follows.

Net Interest Income – Interest from all interest-bearing assets and liabilities is recognized as net interest income using the effective interest method. The effective interest rate is a method of calculating the amortized cost of a financial asset or a financial liability and of allocating the interest income or expense over the relevant period using the estimated future cash flows. The estimated future cash flows used in this calculation include those determined by the contractual terms of the asset or liability, all fees that are considered to be integral to the effective interest rate, direct and incremental transaction costs and all other premiums or discounts.

Once an impairment loss has been recognized on a loan or available for sale debt instruments, although the accrual of interest in accordance with the contractual terms of the instrument is discontinued, interest income is recognized based on the rate of interest that was used to discount future cash flows for the purpose of measuring the impairment loss. For a loan this would be the original effective interest rate, but a new effective interest rate would be established each time an available for sale debt instrument is impaired as impairment is measured to fair value and would be based on a current market rate.

Commissions and Fee Income – The recognition of fee revenue (including commissions) is determined by the purpose of the fees and the basis of accounting for any associated financial instruments. If there is an associated financial instrument, fees that are an integral part of the effective interest rate of that financial instrument are included within the effective yield calculation. However, if the financial instrument is carried at fair value through profit or loss, any associated fees are recognized in profit or loss when the instrument is initially recognized, provided there are no significant unobservable inputs used in determining its fair value. Fees earned from services that are provided over a specified service period are recognized over that service period. Fees earned for the completion of a specific service or significant event are recognized when the service has been completed or the event has occurred.

Loan commitment fees related to commitments that are not accounted for at fair value through profit or loss are recognized in commissions and fee income over the life of the commitment if it is unlikely that the Group will enter into a specific lending arrangement. If it is probable that the Group will enter into a specific lending arrangement, the loan commitment fee is deferred until the origination of a loan and recognized as an adjustment to the loan’s effective interest rate.

Performance-linked fees or fee components are recognized when the performance criteria are fulfilled.

The following fee income is predominantly earned from services that are provided over a period of time: investment fund management fees, fiduciary fees, custodian fees, portfolio and other management and advisory fees, credit-related fees and commission income. Fees predominantly earned from providing transaction-type services include underwriting fees, corporate finance fees and brokerage fees.

Expenses that are directly related and incremental to the generation of fee income are presented net in Commissions and Fee Income.

Arrangements involving multiple services or products – If the Group contracts to provide multiple products, services or rights to a counterparty, an evaluation is made as to whether an overall fee should be allocated to the different components of the arrangement for revenue recognition purposes. The assessment considers the value of items or services

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    256
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

delivered to ensure that the Group’s continuing involvement in other aspects of the arrangement are not essential to the items delivered. It also assesses the value of items not yet delivered and, if there is a right of return on delivered items, the probability of future delivery of remaining items or services. If it is determined that it is appropriate to look at the arrangements as separate components, the amounts received are allocated based on the relative value of each component.

If there is no objective and reliable evidence of the value of the delivered item or an individual item is required to be recognized at fair value then the residual method is used. The residual method calculates the amount to be recognized for the delivered component as being the amount remaining after allocating an appropriate amount of revenue to all other components.

Financial Assets and Liabilities

The Group classifies its financial assets and liabilities into the following categories: financial assets and liabilities at fair value through profit or loss, loans, financial assets available for sale (“AFS”) and other financial liabilities. Appropriate classification of financial assets and liabilities is determined at the time of initial recognition or when reclassified in the Consolidated Balance Sheet.

Financial instruments classified at fair value through profit or loss and financial assets classified as AFS are recognized or derecognized on trade date, which is the date on which the Group commits to purchase or sell the asset or issue or repurchase the financial liability.

Financial Assets and Liabilities at Fair Value through Profit or Loss

The Group classifies certain financial assets and financial liabilities as either held for trading or designated at fair value through profit or loss. They are carried at fair value and presented as financial assets at fair value through profit or loss and financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss, respectively. Related realized and unrealized gains and losses are included in net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss. Interest on interest earning assets such as trading loans and debt securities and dividends on equity instruments are presented in interest and similar income for financial instruments at fair value through profit or loss.

Trading Assets and Liabilities – Financial instruments are classified as held for trading if they have been originated, acquired or incurred principally for the purpose of selling or repurchasing them in the near term, or they form part of a portfolio of identified financial instruments that are managed together and for which there is evidence of a recent actual pattern of short-term profit-taking. Trading assets include debt and equity securities, derivatives held for trading purposes, commodities and trading loans. This includes also physical commodities that are held by the Group’s commodity trading business, at fair value less costs to sell. Trading liabilities consist primarily of derivative liabilities and short positions

Financial Instruments Designated at Fair Value through Profit or Loss – Certain financial assets and liabilities that do not meet the definition of trading assets and liabilities are designated at fair value through profit or loss using the fair value option. To be designated at fair value through profit or loss, financial assets and liabilities must meet one of the following criteria: (1) the designation eliminates or significantly reduces a measurement or recognition inconsistency; (2) a group of financial assets or liabilities or both is managed and its performance is evaluated on a fair value basis in accordance with a documented risk management or investment strategy; or (3) the instrument contains one or more embedded derivatives unless: (a) the embedded derivative does not significantly modify the cash flows that otherwise would be required by the contract; or (b) it is clear with little or no analysis that separation is prohibited. In addition, the Group allows the fair value option to be designated only for those financial instruments for which a reliable estimate of fair value can be obtained. Financial assets and liabilities which are designated at fair value through profit or loss, under the fair value option, include repurchase and reverse repurchase agreements, certain loans and loan commitments, debt and equity securities and structured note liabilities.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
257   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Loan Commitments

Certain loan commitments are classified as derivatives held for trading or designated at fair value through profit or loss under the fair value option. All other loan commitments remain off-balance sheet. Therefore, the Group does not recognize and measure changes in fair value of these off-balance sheet loan commitments that result from changes in market interest rates or credit spreads. However, as specified in the discussion “Impairment of Loans and Provision for Off-Balance sheet positions”, these off-balance sheet loan commitments are assessed for impairment individually and where appropriate, collectively.

Loans

Loans include originated and purchased non-derivative financial assets with fixed or determinable payments that are not quoted in an active market and which are not classified as financial assets at fair value through profit or loss or financial assets AFS. An active market exists when quoted prices are readily and regularly available from an exchange, dealer, broker, industry group, pricing service or regulatory agency and those prices represent actual and regularly occurring market transactions on an arm’s length basis.

Loans not acquired in a business combination or in an asset purchase are initially recognized at their transaction price representing the fair value, which is the cash amount advanced to the borrower. In addition, the net of direct and incremental transaction costs and fees are included in the initial carrying amount of loans. These loans are subsequently measured at amortized cost using the effective interest method less impairment.

Loans which have been acquired as either part of a business combination or as an asset purchase are initially recognized at fair value at the acquisition date. This includes loans for which an impairment loss had been established by the acquiree before their initial recognition by the Group. The fair value at the acquisition date incorporates expected cash flows which consider the credit quality of these loans including any incurred losses and becomes the new amortized cost base. Interest income is recognized using the effective interest method. Subsequent to the acquisition date the Group assesses whether there is objective evidence of impairment in line with the policies described in the section entitled “Impairment of Loans and Provision for Off-Balance Sheet Positions”. If the loans are determined to be impaired then a loan loss allowance is recognized with a corresponding charge to the provision for credit losses line in the Consolidated Statement of Income. Releases of such loan loss allowances established after their initial recognition are included in the provision for credit losses line. Subsequent improvements in the credit quality of such loans for which no loss allowance had been recorded are recognized immediately through an adjustment to the current carrying value and a corresponding gain is recognized in interest income.

Financial Assets Classified as Available for Sale

Financial assets that are not classified as at fair value through profit or loss or as loans are classified as AFS. A financial asset classified as AFS is initially recognized at its fair value plus transaction costs that are directly attributable to the acquisition of the financial asset. The amortization of premiums and accretion of discount are recorded in net interest income. Financial assets classified as AFS are carried at fair value with the changes in fair value reported in other comprehensive income, unless the asset is subject to a fair value hedge, in which case changes in fair value resulting from the risk being hedged are recorded in other income. For monetary financial assets classified as AFS (debt instruments), changes in carrying amounts relating to changes in foreign exchange rate are recognized in the Consolidated Statement of Income and other changes in carrying amount are recognized in other comprehensive income as indicated above. For financial assets classified as AFS that are nonmonetary items (equity instruments), the gain or loss that is recognized in other comprehensive income includes any related foreign exchange component.

In the case of equity investments classified as AFS, objective evidence includes a significant or prolonged decline in the fair value of the investment below cost. In the case of debt securities classified as AFS, impairment is assessed based on the same criteria as for loans.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    258
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

If there is evidence of impairment, any amounts previously recognized in other comprehensive income are recognized in the consolidated statement of income for the period, reported in net gains (losses) on financial assets available for sale. This impairment loss for the period is determined as the difference between the acquisition cost (net of any principal repayments and amortization) and current fair value of the asset less any impairment loss on that investment previously recognized in the Consolidated Statement of Income.

When an AFS debt security is impaired, any subsequent decreases in fair value are recognized in the Consolidated Statement of Income as it is considered further impairment. Any subsequent increases are also recognized in the Consolidated Statement of Income until the asset is no longer considered impaired. When the fair value of the AFS debt security recovers to at least amortized cost it is no longer considered impaired and subsequent changes in fair value are reported in other comprehensive income.

Reversals of impairment losses on equity investments classified as AFS are not reversed through the Consolidated Statement of Income; increases in their fair value after impairment are recognized in other comprehensive income.

Realized gains and losses are reported in net gains (losses) on financial assets available for sale. Generally, the weighted-average cost method is used to determine the cost of financial assets. Unrealized gains and losses recorded in other comprehensive income are transferred to the Consolidated Statement of Income on disposal of an available for sale asset and reported in net gains (losses) on financial assets available for sale.

Critical Accounting Estimates – Because the assessment of objective evidence of impairment require significant management judgement and the estimate of impairment could change from period to period based upon future events that may or may not occur, the Group considers the impairment of Financial Assets classified as Available for Sale to be a critical accounting estimate. For additional information see Note 7 “Net Gains (Losses) on Financial Assets Available for Sale”.

Financial Liabilities

Except for financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss, financial liabilities are measured at amortized cost using the effective interest method.

Financial liabilities include long-term and short-term debt issued which are initially measured at fair value, which is the consideration received, net of transaction costs incurred. Repurchases of issued debt in the market are treated as extinguishments and any related gain or loss is recorded in the Consolidated Statement of Income. A subsequent sale of own bonds in the market is treated as a reissuance of debt.

Reclassification of Financial Assets

The Group may reclassify certain financial assets out of the financial assets at fair value through profit or loss classification (trading assets) and the AFS classification into the loans classification. For assets to be reclassi-fied there must be a clear change in management intent with respect to the assets since initial recognition and the financial asset must meet the definition of a loan at the reclassification date. Additionally, there must be an intent and ability to hold the asset for the foreseeable future at the reclassification date.

Financial assets are reclassified at their fair value at the reclassification date. Any gain or loss already recognized in the Consolidated Statement of Income is not reversed. The fair value of the instrument at reclassification date becomes the new amortized cost of the instrument. The expected cash flows on the financial instruments are estimated at the reclassification date and these estimates are used to calculate a new effective interest rate for the instruments. If there is a subsequent increase in expected future cash flows on reclassified assets as a result of increased recoverability, the effect of that increase is recognized as an adjustment to the effective interest rate from the date of the change in estimate rather than as an adjustment to the carrying amount of the asset at the date of the change in estimate. If there is a subsequent decrease in expected future cash flows the asset would be assessed for impairment as discussed in the section entitled “Impairment of Loans and Provision for Off-Balance Sheet Positions”. Any change in the timing of the

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
259   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

cash flows of reclassified assets which are not deemed impaired are recorded as an adjustment to the carrying amount of the asset.

For instruments reclassified from AFS to loans, any unrealized gain or loss recognized in other comprehensive income is subsequently amortized into interest income using the effective interest rate of the instrument. If the instrument is subsequently impaired, any unrealized loss which is held in accumulated other comprehensive income for that instrument at that date is immediately recognized in the Consolidated Statement of Income as a loan loss provision.

To the extent that assets categorized as loans are repaid, restructured or eventually sold and the amount received is less than the carrying value at that time, then a loss would be recognized in the Consolidated Statement of income as a component of the provision for credit losses, if the loan is impaired, or otherwise in other Income, if the loan is not impaired.

Offsetting of Financial Instruments

Financial assets and liabilities are offset, with the net amount presented in the Consolidated Balance Sheet, only if the Group holds a currently enforceable legal right to set off the recognized amounts and there is an intention to settle on a net basis or to realize an asset and settle the liability simultaneously. The legal right to set off the recognized amounts must be enforceable in both the normal course of business, in the event of default, insolvency or bankruptcy of both the Group and its counterparty. In all other situations they are presented gross. When financial assets and financial liabilities are offset in the Consolidated Balance Sheet, the associated income and expense items will also be offset in the Consolidated Statement of Income, unless specifically prohibited by an applicable accounting standard.

The majority of the offsetting applied by the Group relates to derivatives and repurchase and reverse repur-chase agreements. A significant portion of offsetting is applied to interest rate derivatives and related cash margin balances, which are cleared through central clearing parties such as the London Clearing House. The Group also offsets repurchase and reverse repurchase agreements for which the Group has the right to set off and has the intent to settle on a net basis or to realize an asset and settle a liability simultaneously. For further information please refer to Note 18 “Offsetting Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities”.

Determination of Fair Value

Fair value is defined as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an arm’s length transaction between market participants at the measurement date. The fair value of instruments that are quoted in active markets is determined using the quoted prices where they represent those at which regularly and recently occurring transactions take place. The Group measures certain portfolios of financial assets and financial liabilities on the basis of their net risk exposures when the following criteria are met:

 

 

The group of financial assets and liabilities is managed on the basis of its net exposure to a particular market risk (or risks) or to the credit risk of a particular counterparty, in accordance with a documented risk management strategy,

 

the fair values are provided to key management personnel, and

 

the financial assets and liabilities are measured at fair value through profit or loss.

This portfolio valuation approach is consistent with how the Group manages its net exposures to market and counterparty credit risks.

Critical Accounting Estimates – The Group uses valuation techniques to establish the fair value of instruments where prices quoted in active markets are not available. Therefore, where possible, parameter inputs to the valuation techniques are based on observable data derived from prices of relevant instruments traded in an active market. These valuation techniques involve some level of management estimation and judgment, the degree of which will depend on the price transparency for the instrument or market and the instrument’s complexity.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    260
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

In reaching estimates of fair value management judgment needs to be exercised. The areas requiring significant management judgment are identified, documented and reported to senior management as part of the valuation control process and the standard monthly reporting cycle. The specialist model validation and valuation control groups focus attention on the areas of subjectivity and judgment.

The level of management judgment required in establishing fair value of financial instruments for which there is a quoted price in an active market is usually minimal. Similarly there is little subjectivity or judgment required for instruments valued using valuation models which are standard across the industry and where all parameter inputs are quoted in active markets.

The level of subjectivity and degree of management judgment required is more significant for those instruments valued using specialized and sophisticated models and where some or all of the parameter inputs are less liquid or less observable. Management judgment is required in the selection and application of appropriate parameters, assumptions and modelling techniques. In particular, where data are obtained from infrequent market transactions then extrapolation and interpolation techniques must be applied. Where no market data are available for a particular instrument then pricing inputs are determined by assessing other relevant sources of information such as historical data, fundamental analysis of the economics of the transaction and proxy information from similar transactions, and making appropriate adjustment to reflect the actual instrument being valued and current market conditions. Where different valuation techniques indicate a range of possible fair values for an instrument then management has to decide what point within the range of estimates appropriately represents the fair value. Further, some valuation adjustments may require the exercise of management judgment to achieve fair value.

Under IFRS, the financial assets and liabilities carried at fair value are required to be disclosed according to the inputs to the valuation method that are used to determine their fair value. Specifically, segmentation is required between those valued using quoted market prices in an active market (level 1), valuation techniques based on observable parameters (level 2) and valuation techniques using significant unobservable parameters (level 3). Management judgment is required in determining the category to which certain instruments should be allocated. This specifically arises when the valuation is determined by a number of parameters, some of which are observable and others are not. Further, the classification of an instrument can change over time to reflect changes in market liquidity and therefore price transparency.

The Group provides a sensitivity analysis of the impact upon the level 3 financial instruments of using a reasonably possible alternative for the unobservable parameter. The determination of reasonably possible alternatives requires significant management judgment.

For financial instruments measured at amortized cost (which includes loans, deposits and short and long term debt issued) the Group discloses the fair value. Generally there is limited or no trading activity in these instruments and therefore the fair value determination requires significant management judgment.

For further discussion of the valuation methods and controls and quantitative disclosures with respect to the determination of fair value, please refer to Note 14 “Financial Instruments carried at Fair Value” and Note 15 “Fair Value of Financial Instruments not carried at Fair Value”.

Recognition of Trade Date Profit

If there are significant unobservable inputs used in the valuation technique, the financial instrument is recognized at the transaction price and any profit implied from the valuation technique at trade date is deferred.

Using systematic methods, the deferred amount is recognized over the period between trade date and the date when the market is expected to become observable, or over the life of the trade (whichever is shorter). Such methodology is used because it reflects the changing economic and risk profile of the instrument as the market develops or as the instrument itself progresses to maturity. Any remaining trade date deferred profit is recognized in the Consolidated Statement of Income when the transaction becomes observable or the Group enters into off-setting transactions that substantially eliminate the instrument’s risk. In the rare circumstances that a trade date loss arises, it would be

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
261   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

recognized at inception of the transaction to the extent that it is probable that a loss has been incurred and a reliable estimate of the loss amount can be made.

Critical Accounting Estimates – Management judgment is required in determining whether there exist significant unobservable inputs in the valuation technique. Once deferred, the decision to subsequently recognise the trade date profit requires a careful assessment of the then current facts and circumstances supporting observability of parameters and/or risk mitigation.

Derivatives and Hedge Accounting

Derivatives are used to manage exposures to interest rate, foreign currency, credit and other market price risks, including exposures arising from forecast transactions. All freestanding contracts that are considered derivatives for accounting purposes are carried at fair value on the Consolidated Balance Sheet regardless of whether they are held for trading or nontrading purposes.

The changes in fair value on derivatives held for trading are included in net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss.

Embedded Derivatives

Some hybrid contracts contain both a derivative and a non-derivative component. In such cases, the derivative component is termed an embedded derivative, with the non-derivative component representing the host contract. If the economic characteristics and risks of embedded derivatives are not closely related to those of the host contract and the hybrid contract itself is not carried at fair value through profit or loss, the embedded derivative is bifurcated and reported at fair value, with gains and losses recognized in net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss. The host contract will continue to be accounted for in accordance with the appropriate accounting standard. The carrying amount of an embedded derivative is reported in the same Consolidated Balance Sheet line item as the host contract. Certain hybrid instruments have been designated at fair value through profit or loss using the fair value option.

Hedge Accounting

For accounting purposes there are three possible types of hedges: (1) hedges of changes in the fair value of assets, liabilities or unrecognized firm commitments (fair value hedges); (2) hedges of the variability of future cash flows from highly probable forecast transactions and floating rate assets and liabilities (cash flow hedges); and (3) hedges of the translation adjustments resulting from translating the functional currency financial statements of foreign operations into the presentation currency of the parent (hedges of net investments in foreign operations).

When hedge accounting is applied, the Group designates and documents the relationship between the hedging instrument and the hedged item as well as its risk management objective and strategy for undertaking the hedging transactions and the nature of the risk being hedged. This documentation includes a description of how the Group will assess the hedging instrument’s effectiveness in offsetting the exposure to changes in the hedged item’s fair value or cash flows attributable to the hedged risk. Hedge effectiveness is assessed at inception and throughout the term of each hedging relationship. Hedge effectiveness is always assessed, even when the terms of the derivative and hedged item are matched.

Hedging derivatives are reported as other assets and other liabilities. In the event that a derivative is subsequently de-designated from a hedging relationship, it is transferred to financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss.

For hedges of changes in fair value, the changes in the fair value of the hedged asset, liability or unrecognized firm commitment, or a portion thereof, attributable to the risk being hedged, are recognized in the Consolidated Statement of Income along with changes in the entire fair value of the derivative. When hedging interest rate risk, any interest accrued or paid on both the derivative and the hedged item is reported in interest income or expense and the

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    262
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

unrealized gains and losses from the hedge accounting fair value adjustments are reported in other income. When hedging the foreign exchange risk of an AFS security, the fair value adjustments related to the security’s foreign exchange exposures are also recorded in other income. Hedge ineffectiveness is reported in other income and is measured as the net effect of changes in the fair value of the hedging instrument and changes in the fair value of the hedged item arising from changes in the market rate or price related to the risk(s) being hedged.

If a fair value hedge of a debt instrument is discontinued prior to the instrument’s maturity because the derivative is terminated or the relationship is de-designated, any remaining interest rate-related fair value adjustments made to the carrying amount of the debt instrument (basis adjustments) are amortized to interest income or expense over the remaining term of the original hedging relationship. For other types of fair value adjustments and whenever a fair value hedged asset or liability is sold or otherwise derecognized, any basis adjustments are included in the calculation of the gain or loss on derecognition.

For hedges of variability in future cash flows, there is no change to the accounting for the hedged item and the derivative is carried at fair value, with changes in value reported initially in other comprehensive income to the extent the hedge is effective. These amounts initially recorded in other comprehensive income are subsequently reclassified into the Consolidated Statement of Income in the same periods during which the forecast transaction affects the Consolidated Statement of Income. Thus, for hedges of interest rate risk, the amounts are amortized into interest income or expense at the same time as the interest is accrued on the hedged transaction.

Hedge ineffectiveness is recorded in other income and is measured as changes in the excess (if any) in the absolute cumulative change in fair value of the actual hedging derivative over the absolute cumulative change in the fair value of the hypothetically perfect hedge.

When hedges of variability in cash flows attributable to interest rate risk are discontinued, amounts remaining in accumulated other comprehensive income are amortized to interest income or expense over the remaining life of the original hedge relationship, unless the hedged transaction is no longer expected to occur in which case the amount will be reclassified into other income immediately. When hedges of variability in cash flows attributable to other risks are discontinued, the related amounts in accumulated other comprehensive income are reclassified into either the same Consolidated Statement of Income caption and period as profit or loss from the forecast transaction, or into other income when the forecast transaction is no longer expected to occur.

For hedges of the translation adjustments resulting from translating the functional currency financial statements of foreign operations (hedges of net investments in foreign operations) into the functional currency of the parent, the portion of the change in fair value of the derivative due to changes in the spot foreign exchange rates is recorded as a foreign currency translation adjustment in other comprehensive income to the extent the hedge is effective; the remainder is recorded as other income in the Consolidated Statement of Income.

Changes in fair value of the hedging instrument relating to the effective portion of the hedge are subsequently recognized in profit or loss on disposal of the foreign operations.

Impairment of Loans and Provision for Off-Balance Sheet Positions

The Group first assesses whether objective evidence of impairment exists individually for loans that are individually significant. It then assesses collectively for loans that are not individually significant and loans which are significant but for which there is no objective evidence of impairment under the individual assessment.

To allow management to determine whether a loss event has occurred on an individual basis, all significant counterparty relationships are reviewed periodically. This evaluation considers current information and events related to the counterparty, such as the counterparty experiencing significant financial difficulty or a breach of contract, for example, default or delinquency in interest or principal payments.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
263   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

If there is evidence of impairment leading to an impairment loss for an individual counterparty relationship, then the amount of the loss is determined as the difference between the carrying amount of the loan(s), including accrued interest, and the present value of expected future cash flows discounted at the loan’s original effective interest rate or the effective interest rate established upon reclassification to loans, including cash flows that may result from foreclosure less costs for obtaining and selling the collateral. The carrying amount of the loans is reduced by the use of an allowance account and the amount of the loss is recognized in the Consolidated Statement of Income as a component of the provision for credit losses.

The collective assessment of impairment is to establish an allowance amount relating to loans that are either individually significant but for which there is no objective evidence of impairment, or are not individually significant but for which there is, on a portfolio basis, a loss amount that is probable of having occurred and is reasonably estimable. The loss amount has three components. The first component is an amount for transfer and currency convertibility risks for loan exposures in countries where there are serious doubts about the ability of counterparties to comply with the repayment terms due to the economic or political situation prevailing in the respective country of domicile. This amount is calculated using ratings for country risk and transfer risk which are established and regularly reviewed for each country in which the Group does business. The second component is an allowance amount representing the incurred losses on the portfolio of smaller-balance homogeneous loans, which are loans to individuals and small business customers of the private and retail business. The loans are grouped according to similar credit risk characteristics and the allowance for each group is determined using statistical models based on historical experience. The third component represents an estimate of incurred losses inherent in the group of loans that have not yet been individually identified or measured as part of the smaller-balance homogeneous loans. Loans that were found not to be impaired when evaluated on an individual basis are included in the scope of this component of the allowance.

Once a loan is identified as impaired, although the accrual of interest in accordance with the contractual terms of the loan is discontinued, the accretion of the net present value of the written down amount of the loan due to the passage of time is recognized as interest income based on the original effective interest rate of the loan.

At each balance sheet date, all impaired loans are reviewed for changes to the present value of expected future cash flows discounted at the loan’s original effective interest rate. Any change to the previously recognized impairment loss is recognized as a change to the allowance account and recorded in the Consolidated Statement of Income as a component of the provision for credit losses.

When it is considered that there is no realistic prospect of recovery and all collateral has been realized or transferred to the Group, the loan and any associated allowance is charged off (the loan and the related allowance are removed from the balance sheet). Individually significant loans where specific loan loss provisions are in place are evaluated at least quarterly on a case-by-case basis. For this category of loans, the number of days past due is an indicator for a charge-off but is not a determining factor. A charge-off will only take place after considering all relevant information, such as the occurrence of a significant change in the borrower’s financial position such that the borrower can no longer pay the obligation, or the proceeds from the collateral are insufficient to completely satisfy the current carrying amount of the loan.

For collectively assessed loans, which are primarily mortgages and consumer finance loans, the timing of a charge-off depends on whether there is any underlying collateral and the Group’s estimate of the amount collectible and the legal requirements in the jurisdiction in which the loan is originated.

Subsequent recoveries, if any, are credited to the allowance account and are recorded in the Consolidated Statement of Income as a component of the provision for credit losses.

The process to determine the provision for off-balance sheet positions is similar to the methodology used for loans. Any loss amounts are recognized as an allowance in the Consolidated Balance Sheet within provisions and charged to the Consolidated Statement of Income as a component of the provision for credit losses.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    264
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

If in a subsequent period the amount of a previously recognized impairment loss decreases and the decrease is due to an event occurring after the impairment was recognized, the impairment loss is reversed by reducing the allowance account accordingly. Such reversal is recognized in profit or loss.

Critical Accounting Estimates – The accounting estimates and judgments related to the impairment of loans and provision for off-balance sheet positions is a critical accounting estimate because the underlying assumptions used for both the individually and collectively assessed impairment can change from period to period and may significantly affect the Group’s results of operations.

In assessing assets for impairments, management judgment is required, particularly in circumstances of economic and financial uncertainty, such as those of the recent financial crisis, when developments and changes to expected cash flows can occur both with greater rapidity and less predictability. The actual amount of the future cash flows and their timing may differ from the estimates used by management and consequently may cause actual losses to differ from reported allowances.

For those loans which are deemed to be individually significant, the determination of the impairment allowance often requires the use of considerable judgment concerning such matters as local economic conditions, the financial performance of the counterparty and the value of any collateral held, for which there may not be a readily accessible market.

The determination of the allowance for portfolios of loans of smaller balance homogenous loans and for those loans which are individually significant but for which no objective evidence of impairment exists is calculated using statistical models. Such statistical models incorporate numerous estimates and judgments. The Group performs a regular review of the models and underlying data and assumptions. The probability of defaults, loss recovery rates and judgments concerning ability of borrowers in foreign countries to transfer the foreign currency necessary to comply with debt repayments, amongst other things, are incorporated into this review.

The quantitative disclosures are provided in Note 19 “Loans” and Note 20 “Allowance for Credit Losses”.

Derecognition of Financial Assets and Liabilities

Financial Asset Derecognition

A financial asset is considered for derecognition when the contractual rights to the cash flows from the financial asset expire, or the Group has either transferred the contractual right to receive the cash flows from that asset, or has assumed an obligation to pay those cash flows to one or more recipients, subject to certain criteria.

The Group derecognizes a transferred financial asset if it transfers substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership.

The Group enters into transactions in which it transfers previously recognized financial assets but retains substantially all the associated risks and rewards of those assets; for example, a sale to a third party in which the Group enters into a concurrent total return swap with the same counterparty. These types of transactions are accounted for as secured financing transactions.

In transactions in which substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership of a financial asset are neither retained nor transferred, the Group derecognizes the transferred asset if control over that asset is not retained, i.e., if the transferee has the practical ability to sell the transferred asset. The rights and obligations retained in the transfer are recognized separately as assets and liabilities, as appropriate. If control over the asset is retained, the Group continues to recognize the asset to the extent of its continuing involvement, which is determined by the extent to which it remains exposed to changes in the value of the transferred asset.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
265   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

The derecognition criteria are also applied to the transfer of part of an asset, rather than the asset as a whole, or to a group of similar financial assets in their entirety, when applicable. If transferring a part of an asset, such part must be a specifically identified cash flow, a fully proportionate share of the asset, or a fully proportionate share of a specifically-identified cash flow.

If an existing financial asset is replaced by another asset from the same counterparty on substantially different terms, or if the terms of the financial asset are substantially modified (due to forbearance measures or otherwise), the existing financial asset is derecognized and a new asset is recognized. Any difference between the respective carrying amounts is recognized in the Consolidated Statement of Income.

Securitization

The Group securitizes various consumer and commercial financial assets, which is achieved via the transfer of these assets to a structured entity, which issues securities to investors to finance the acquisition of the assets. Financial assets awaiting securitization are classified and measured as appropriate under the policies in the “Financial Assets and Liabilities” section. If the structured entity is not consolidated then the transferred assets may qualify for derecognition in full or in part, under the policy on derecognition of financial assets. Synthetic securitization structures typically involve derivative financial instruments for which the policies in the “Derivatives and Hedge Accounting” section would apply. Those transfers that do not qualify for derecognition may be reported as secured financing or result in the recognition of continuing involvement liabilities. The investors and the securitization vehicles generally have no recourse to the Group’s other assets in cases where the issuers of the financial assets fail to perform under the original terms of those assets.

Interests in the securitized financial assets may be retained in the form of senior or subordinated tranches, interest only strips or other residual interests (collectively referred to as “retained interests”). Provided the Group’s retained interests do not result in consolidation of a structured entity, nor in continued recognition of the transferred assets, these interests are typically recorded in financial assets at fair value through profit or loss and carried at fair value. Consistent with the valuation of similar financial instruments, the fair value of retained tranches or the financial assets is initially and subsequently determined using market price quotations where available or internal pricing models that utilize variables such as yield curves, prepayment speeds, default rates, loss severity, interest rate volatilities and spreads. The assumptions used for pricing are based on observable transactions in similar securities and are verified by external pricing sources, where available. Where observable transactions in similar securities and other external pricing sources are not available, management judgment must be used to determine fair value. The Group may also periodically hold interests in securitized financial assets and record them at amortized cost.

In situations where the Group has a present obligation (either legal or constructive) to provide financial support to an unconsolidated securitization entity a provision will be created if the obligation can be reliably measured and it is probable that there will be an outflow of economic resources required to settle it.

When an asset is derecognized a gain or loss equal to the difference between the consideration received and the carrying amount of the transferred asset is recorded. When a part of an asset is derecognized, gains or losses on securitization depend in part on the carrying amount of the transferred financial assets, allocated between the financial assets derecognized and the retained interests based on their relative fair values at the date of the transfer.

Derecognition of Financial Liabilities

A financial liability is derecognized when the obligation under the liability is discharged or cancelled or expires. If an existing financial liability is replaced by another from the same lender on substantially different terms, or the terms of the existing liability are substantially modified, such an exchange or modification is treated as a derecognition of the original liability and the recognition of a new liability, and the difference in the respective carrying amounts is recognized in the Consolidated Statement of Income.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    266
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Repurchase and Reverse Repurchase Agreements

Securities purchased under resale agreements (“reverse repurchase agreements”) and securities sold under agreements to repurchase (“repurchase agreements”) are treated as collateralized financings and are recognized initially at fair value, being the amount of cash disbursed and received, respectively. The party disbursing the cash takes possession of the securities serving as collateral for the financing and having a market value equal to, or in excess of, the principal amount loaned. The securities received under reverse repurchase agreements and securities delivered under repurchase agreements are not recognized on, or derecognized from, the balance sheet, because the risks and rewards of ownership are not obtained nor relinquished. Securities delivered under repurchase agreements which are not derecognized from the balance sheet and where the counterparty has the right by contract or custom to sell or repledge the collateral are disclosed in Note 22 “Assets Pledged and Received as Collateral”.

The Group has chosen to apply the fair value option to certain repurchase and reverse repurchase portfolios that are managed on a fair value basis.

Interest earned on reverse repurchase agreements and interest incurred on repurchase agreements is reported as interest income and interest expense, respectively.

Securities Borrowed and Securities Loaned

Securities borrowed transactions generally require the Group to deposit cash with the securities lender. In a securities loaned transaction, the Group generally receives either cash collateral, in an amount equal to or in excess of the market value of securities loaned, or securities. The Group monitors the fair value of securities borrowed and securities loaned and additional collateral is disbursed or obtained, if necessary.

The amount of cash advanced or received is recorded as securities borrowed and securities loaned, respectively, in the Consolidated Balance Sheet.

The securities borrowed are not themselves recognized in the financial statements. If they are sold to third parties, the obligation to return the securities is recorded as a financial liability at fair value through profit or loss and any subsequent gain or loss is included in the Consolidated Statement of Income in net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss. Securities lent to counterparties are also retained on the Consolidated Balance Sheet.

Fees received or paid are reported in interest income and interest expense, respectively. Securities lent to counterparties which are not derecognized from the Consolidated Balance Sheet and where the counterparty has the right by contract or custom to sell or repledge the collateral are disclosed are disclosed in Note 22 “Assets Pledged and Received as Collateral”.

Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets

Goodwill arises on the acquisition of subsidiaries and associates and represents the excess of the aggregate of the cost of an acquisition and any noncontrolling interests in the acquiree over the fair value of the identifiable net assets acquired at the date of the acquisition.

For the purpose of calculating goodwill, fair values of acquired assets, liabilities and contingent liabilities are determined by reference to market values or by discounting expected future cash flows to present value. This discounting is either performed using market rates or by using risk-free rates and risk-adjusted expected future cash flows. Any noncontrolling interests in the acquiree is measured either at fair value or at the noncontrolling interests’ proportionate share of the acquiree’s identifiable net assets (this is determined for each business combination).

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
267   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Goodwill on the acquisition of subsidiaries is capitalized and reviewed for impairment annually or more frequently if there are indications that impairment may have occurred. For the purposes of impairment testing, goodwill acquired in a business combination is allocated to cash-generating units (“CGUs”), which are the smallest identifiable groups of assets that generate cash inflows largely independent of the cash inflows from other assets or groups of assets and that are expected to benefit from the synergies of the combination and considering the business level at which goodwill is monitored for internal management purposes. In identifying whether cash inflows from an asset (or a group of assets) are largely independent of the cash inflows from other assets (or groups of assets) various factors are considered, including how management monitors the entity’s operations or makes decisions about continuing or disposing of the entity’s assets and operations.

If goodwill has been allocated to a CGU and an operation within that unit is disposed of, the attributable goodwill is included in the carrying amount of the operation when determining the gain or loss on its disposal.

Certain non-integrated investments are not allocated to a CGU. Impairment testing is performed individually for each of these assets.

Intangible assets are recognized separately from goodwill when they are separable or arise from contractual or other legal rights and their fair value can be measured reliably. Intangible assets that have a finite useful life are stated at cost less any accumulated amortization and accumulated impairment losses. Customer-related intangible assets that have a finite useful life are amortized over periods of between 1 and 20 years on a straight-line basis based on their expected useful life. These assets are tested for impairment and their useful lives reaffirmed at least annually.

Certain intangible assets have an indefinite useful life and hence are not amortized, but are tested for impairment at least annually or more frequently if events or changes in circumstances indicate that impairment may have occurred.

Costs related to software developed or obtained for internal use are capitalized if it is probable that future economic benefits will flow to the Group and the cost can be measured reliably. Capitalized costs are amortized using the straight-line method over the asset’s useful life which is deemed to be either three, five or ten years. Eligible costs include external direct costs for materials and services, as well as payroll and payroll-related costs for employees directly associated with an internal-use software project. Overhead costs, as well as costs incurred during the research phase or after software is ready for use, are expensed as incurred. Capitalized software costs are tested for impairment either annually if still under development or when there is an indication of impairment once the software is in use.

Critical Accounting Estimates – The determination of the recoverable amount in the impairment assessment of non-financial assets requires estimates based on quoted market prices, prices of comparable businesses, present value or other valuation techniques, or a combination thereof, necessitating management to make subjective judgments and assumptions. Because these estimates and assumptions could result in significant differences to the amounts reported if underlying circumstances were to change, the Group considers these estimates to be critical.

The quantitative disclosures are provided in Note 25 “Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets”.

Provisions

Provisions are recognized if the Group has a present legal or constructive obligation as a result of past events, if it is probable that an outflow of resources will be required to settle the obligation, and a reliable estimate can be made of the amount of the obligation.

The amount recognized as a provision is the best estimate of the consideration required to settle the present obligation as of the balance sheet date, taking into account the risks and uncertainties surrounding the obligation.

If the effect of the time value of money is material, provisions are discounted and measured at the present value of the expenditure expected to be required to settle the obligation, using a pre-tax rate that reflects the current market assessments of the time value of money and the risks specific to the obligation. The increase in the provision due to the passage of time is recognized as interest expense.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    268
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

When some or all of the economic benefits required to settle a provision are expected to be recovered from a third party (for example, because the obligation is covered by an insurance policy), an asset is recognized if it is virtually certain that reimbursement will be received.

Critical Accounting Estimates – The use of estimates is important in determining provisions for potential losses that may arise from litigation, regulatory proceedings and uncertain income tax positions. The Group estimates and provides for potential losses that may arise out of litigation, regulatory proceedings and uncertain income tax positions to the extent that such losses are probable and can be estimated, in accordance with IAS 37, “Provisions, Contingent Liabilities and Contingent Assets” or IAS 12, “Income Taxes”, respectively. Significant judgment is required in making these estimates and the Group’s final liabilities may ultimately be materially different.

Contingencies in respect of legal matters are subject to many uncertainties and the outcome of individual matters is not predictable with assurance. Significant judgment is required in assessing probability and making estimates in respect of contingencies, and the Group’s final liability may ultimately be materially different. The Group’s total liability in respect of litigation, arbitration and regulatory proceedings is determined on a case-by-case basis and represents an estimate of probable losses after considering, among other factors, the progress of each case, the Group’s experience and the experience of others in similar cases, and the opinions and views of legal counsel. Predicting the outcome of the Group’s litigation matters is inherently difficult, particularly in cases in which claimants seek substantial or indeterminate damages. See Note 29 “Provisions” for information on the Group’s judicial, regulatory and arbitration proceedings.

Income Taxes

The Group recognizes the current and deferred tax consequences of transactions that have been included in the consolidated financial statements using the provisions of the respective jurisdictions’ tax laws. Current and deferred taxes are recognized in profit or loss except to the extent that the tax relates to items that are recognized directly in equity or other comprehensive income in which case the related tax is recognised either directly in equity or other comprehensive income accordingly.

Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognized for future tax consequences attributable to temporary differences between the financial statement carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases, unused tax losses and unused tax credits. Deferred tax assets are recognized only to the extent that it is probable that sufficient taxable profit will be available against which those unused tax losses, unused tax credits and deductible temporary differences can be utilized.

Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured based on the tax rates that are expected to apply in the period that the asset is realized or the liability is settled, based on tax rates and tax laws that have been enacted or substantively enacted at the balance sheet date.

Current tax assets and liabilities are offset when (1) they arise from the same tax reporting entity or tax group of reporting entities, (2) the legally enforceable right to offset exists and (3) they are intended to be settled net or realized simultaneously.

Deferred tax assets and liabilities are offset when the legally enforceable right to offset current tax assets and liabilities exists and the deferred tax assets and liabilities relate to income taxes levied by the same taxing authority on either the same tax reporting entity or tax group of reporting entities.

Deferred tax liabilities are provided on taxable temporary differences arising from investments in subsidiaries, branches and associates and interests in joint ventures except when the timing of the reversal of the temporary difference is controlled by the Group and it is probable that the difference will not reverse in the foreseeable future. Deferred income tax assets are provided on deductible temporary differences arising from such invest-ments only to the extent that it is probable that the differences will reverse in the foreseeable future and sufficient taxable income will be available against which those temporary differences can be utilized.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
269   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Deferred tax related to fair value re-measurement of AFS investments, cash flow hedges and other items, which are charged or credited directly to other comprehensive income, is also credited or charged directly to other comprehensive income and subsequently recognized in the consolidated statement of income once the underlying transaction or event to which the deferred tax relates is recognized in the consolidated statement of income.

For share-based payment transactions, the Group may receive a tax deduction related to the compensation paid in shares. The amount deductible for tax purposes may differ from the cumulative compensation expense recorded. At any reporting date, the Group must estimate the expected future tax deduction based on the current share price. The associated current and deferred tax consequences are recognized as income or expense in the consolidated statement of income for the period. If the amount deductible, or expected to be deductible, for tax purposes exceeds the cumulative compensation expense, the excess tax benefit is recognized directly in equity.

The Group’s insurance business in the United Kingdom (Abbey Life Assurance Company Limited) is subject to income tax on its policyholder’s investment returns (policyholder tax). This tax is included in the Group’s income tax expense/benefit even though it is economically the income tax expense/benefit of the policyholder, which reduces/increases the Group’s liability to the policyholder.

Critical Accounting Estimates – In determining the amount of deferred tax assets, the Group uses historical tax capacity and profitability information and, if relevant, forecasted operating results based upon approved business plans, including a review of the eligible carry-forward periods, available tax planning opportunities and other relevant considerations. Each quarter, the Group re-evaluates its estimate related to deferred tax assets, including its assumptions about future profitability.

The Group believes that the accounting estimate related to the deferred tax assets is a critical accounting estimate because the underlying assumptions can change from period to period and requires significant management judgment. For example, tax law changes or variances in future projected operating performance could result in a change of the deferred tax asset. If the Group was not able to realize all or part of its net deferred tax assets in the future, an adjustment to its deferred tax assets would be charged to income tax expense or directly to equity in the period such determination was made. If the Group was to recognize previously unrecognized deferred tax assets in the future, an adjustment to its deferred tax asset would be credited to income tax expense or directly to equity in the period such determination was made.

For further information on the Group’s deferred taxes (including quantitative disclosures on recognized deferred tax assets) see Note 36 “Income Taxes”.

Business Combinations and Noncontrolling Interests

The Group uses the acquisition method to account for business combinations. At the date the Group obtains control of the subsidiary, the cost of an acquisition is measured at the fair value of the consideration given, including any cash or non cash consideration (equity instruments) transferred, any contingent consideration, any previously held equity interest in the acquiree and liabilities incurred or assumed. The excess of the aggregate of the cost of an acquisition and any noncontrolling interests in the acquiree over the Group’s share of the fair value of the identifiable net assets acquired is recorded as goodwill. If the aggregate of the acquisition cost and any noncontrolling interests is below the fair value of the identifiable net assets (negative goodwill), a gain is reported in other income. Acquisition-related costs are recognized as expenses in the period in which they are incurred.

In business combinations achieved in stages (“step acquisitions”), a previously held equity interest in the acquiree is remeasured to its acquisition-date fair value and the resulting gain or loss, if any, is recognized in profit or loss. Amounts recognized in prior periods in other comprehensive income associated with the previously held investment would be recognized on the same basis as would be required if the Group had directly disposed of the previously held equity interest.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    270
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Noncontrolling interests are shown in the consolidated balance sheet as a separate component of equity, which is distinct from the Group’s shareholders’ equity. The net income attributable to noncontrolling interests is separately disclosed on the face of the consolidated statement of income. Changes in the ownership interest in subsidiaries which do not result in a change of control are treated as transactions between equity holders and are reported in additional paid-in capital (“APIC”).

Non-Current Assets Held for Sale

Individual non-current non-financial assets (and disposal groups) are classified as held for sale if they are available for immediate sale in their present condition subject only to the customary sales terms of such assets (and disposal groups) and their sale is considered highly probable. For a sale to be highly probable, management must be committed to a sales plan and actively looking for a buyer. Furthermore, the assets (and disposal groups) must be actively marketed at a reasonable sales price in relation to their current fair value and the sale should be expected to be completed within one year. Non-current non-financial assets (and disposal groups) which meet the criteria for held for sale classification are measured at the lower of their carrying amount and fair value less costs to sell and are presented within “Other assets” and “Other liabilities” in the balance sheet. The comparatives are not represented when non-current assets (and disposal groups) are classified as held for sale. If the disposal group contains financial instruments, no adjustment to their carrying amounts is permitted.

Property and Equipment

Property and equipment includes own-use properties, leasehold improvements, furniture and equipment and software (operating systems only). Own-use properties are carried at cost less accumulated depreciation and accumulated impairment losses. Depreciation is generally recognized using the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the assets. The range of estimated useful lives is 25 to 50 years for property and 3 to 10 years for furniture and equipment (including initial improvements to purchased buildings). Leasehold improvements are capitalized and subsequently depreciated on a straight-line basis over the shorter of the term of the lease and the estimated useful life of the improvement, which generally ranges from 3 to 18 years. Depreciation of property and equipment is included in general and administrative expenses. Maintenance and repairs are also charged to general and administrative expenses. Gains and losses on disposals are included in other income.

Property and equipment are tested for impairment at each quarterly reporting date and an impairment charge is recorded to the extent the recoverable amount, which is the higher of fair value less costs to sell and value in use, is less than its carrying amount. Value in use is the present value of the future cash flows expected to be derived from the asset. After the recognition of impairment of an asset, the depreciation charge is adjusted in future periods to reflect the asset’s revised carrying amount. If an impairment is later reversed, the depreciation charge is adjusted prospectively.

Properties leased under a finance lease are capitalized as assets in property and equipment and depreciated over the terms of the leases.

Financial Guarantees

Financial guarantee contracts are contracts that require the issuer to make specified payments to reimburse the holder for a loss it incurs because a specified debtor fails to make payments when due in accordance with the terms of a debt instrument.

The Group has chosen to apply the fair value option to certain written financial guarantees that are managed on a fair value basis. Financial guarantees that the Group has not designated at fair value are recognized initially in the financial statements at fair value on the date the guarantee is given. Subsequent to initial recognition, the Group’s liabilities under such guarantees are measured at the higher of the amount initially recognized, less cumulative amortization, and the best estimate of the expenditure required to settle any financial obligation as of the balance sheet date. These estimates are determined based on experience with similar transactions and history of past losses, and management’s determination of the best estimate.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
271   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Any increase in the liability relating to guarantees is recorded in the consolidated statement of income in provision for credit losses.

Leasing Transactions

The Group enters into lease contracts, predominantly for premises, as a lessee. The terms and conditions of these contracts are assessed and the leases are classified as operating leases or finance leases according to their economic substance at inception of the lease.

Assets held under finance leases are initially recognized on the consolidated balance sheet at an amount equal to the fair value of the leased property or, if lower, the present value of the minimum lease payments. The corresponding liability to the lessor is included in the consolidated balance sheet as a finance lease obligation. The discount rate used in calculating the present value of the minimum lease payments is either the interest rate implicit in the lease, if it is practicable to determine, or the incremental borrowing rate. Contingent rentals are recognized as an expense in the periods in which they are incurred.

Operating lease rentals payable are recognized as an expense on a straight-line basis over the lease term, which commences when the lessee controls the physical use of the property. Lease incentives are treated as a reduction of rental expense and are also recognized over the lease term on a straight-line basis. Contingent rentals arising under operating leases are recognized as an expense in the period in which they are incurred.

Employee Benefits

Pension Benefits

The Group provides a number of pension plans. In addition to defined contribution plans, there are retirement benefit plans accounted for as defined benefit plans. The assets of all the Group’s defined contribution plans are held in independently administered funds. Contributions are generally determined as a percentage of salary and are expensed based on employee services rendered, generally in the year of contribution.

All retirement benefit plans accounted for as defined benefit plans are valued using the projected unit-credit method to determine the present value of the defined benefit obligation and the related service costs. Under this method, the determination is based on actuarial calculations which include assumptions about demographics, salary increases and interest and inflation rates. Actuarial gains and losses are recognized in other comprehensive income and presented in equity in the period in which they occur. The majority of the Group’s benefit plans is funded.

Other Post-Employment Benefits

In addition, the Group maintains unfunded contributory post-employment medical plans for a number of current and retired employees who are mainly located in the United States. These plans pay stated percentages of eligible medical and dental expenses of retirees after a stated deductible has been met. The Group funds these plans on a cash basis as benefits are due. Analogous to retirement benefit plans these plans are valued using the projected unit-credit method. Actuarial gains and losses are recognized in full in the period in which they occur in other comprehensive income and presented in equity.

Refer to Note 35 “Employee Benefits” for further information on the accounting for pension benefits and other post-employment benefits.

Termination benefits

Termination benefits arise when employment is terminated by the Group before the normal retirement date or whenever an employee accepts voluntary redundancy in exchange for these benefits. The Group recognizes termination benefits as a liability and an expense if the Group is demonstrably committed to a detailed formal plan without realistic

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    272
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

possibility of withdrawal. In the case of an offer made to encourage voluntary redundancy, termination benefits are measured based on the number of employees expected to accept the offer. Benefits falling due more than twelve months after the end of the reporting period are discounted to their present value. The discount rate is determined by reference to market yields on high-quality corporate bonds.

Share-Based Compensation

Compensation expense for awards classified as equity instruments is measured at the grant date based on the fair value of the share-based award. For share awards, the fair value is the quoted market price of the share reduced by the present value of the expected dividends that will not be received by the employee and adjusted for the effect, if any, of restrictions beyond the vesting date. In case an award is modified such that its fair value immediately after modification exceeds its fair value immediately prior to modification, a remeasurement takes place and the resulting increase in fair value is recognized as additional compensation expense.

The Group records the offsetting amount to the recognized compensation expense in additional paid-in capital (“APIC”). Compensation expense is recorded on a straight-line basis over the period in which employees perform services to which the awards relate or over the period of the tranches for those awards delivered in tranches. Estimates of expected forfeitures are periodically adjusted in the event of actual forfeitures or for changes in expectations. The timing of expense recognition relating to grants which, due to early retirement provisions, include a nominal but non-substantive service period are accelerated by shortening the amortization period of the expense from the grant date to the date when the employee meets the eligibility criteria for the award, and not the vesting date. For awards that are delivered in tranches, each tranche is considered a separate award and amortized separately.

Compensation expense for share-based awards payable in cash is remeasured to fair value at each balance sheet date and recognized over the vesting period in which the related employee services are rendered. The related obligations are included in other liabilities until paid.

Obligations to Purchase Common Shares

Forward purchases of Deutsche Bank shares, and written put options where Deutsche Bank shares are the underlying, are reported as obligations to purchase common shares if the number of shares is fixed and physical settlement for a fixed amount of cash is required. At inception, the obligation is recorded at the present value of the settlement amount of the forward or option. For forward purchases and written put options of Deutsche Bank shares, a corresponding charge is made to shareholders’ equity and reported as equity classified as an obligation to purchase common shares.

The liabilities are accounted for on an accrual basis, and interest costs, which consist of time value of money and dividends, on the liability are reported as interest expense. Upon settlement of such forward purchases and written put options, the liability is extinguished and the charge to equity is reclassified to common shares in treasury.

Deutsche Bank common shares subject to such forward contracts are not considered to be outstanding for purposes of basic earnings per share calculations, but are for dilutive earnings per share calculations to the extent that they are, in fact, dilutive.

Option and forward contracts on Deutsche Bank shares are classified as equity if the number of shares is fixed and physical settlement is required. All other contracts in which Deutsche Bank shares are the underlying are recorded as financial assets or liabilities at fair value through profit or loss.

Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows

For purposes of the consolidated statement of cash flows, the Group’s cash and cash equivalents include highly liquid investments that are readily convertible into cash and which are subject to an insignificant risk of change in value. Such investments include cash and balances at central banks and demand deposits with banks.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
273   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

The Group’s assignment of cash flows to the operating, investing or financing category depends on the business model (“management approach”). For the Group the primary operating activity is to manage financial assets and financial liabilities. Therefore, the issuance and management of long-term borrowings is a core operating activity which is different than for a non-financial company, where borrowing is not a principal revenue producing activity and thus is part of the financing category.

The Group views the issuance of senior long-term debt as an operating activity. Senior long-term debt comprises structured notes and asset-backed securities, which are designed and executed by CB&S business lines and which are revenue generating activities. The other component is debt issued by Treasury, which is considered interchangeable with other funding sources; all of the funding costs are allocated to business activities to establish their profitability.

Cash flows related to subordinated long-term debt and trust preferred securities are viewed differently than those related to senior-long term debt because they are managed as an integral part of the Group’s capital, primarily to meet regulatory capital requirements. As a result they are not interchangeable with other operating liabilities, but can only be interchanged with equity and thus are considered part of the financing category.

The amounts shown in the consolidated statement of cash flows do not precisely match the movements in the consolidated balance sheet from one period to the next as they exclude non-cash items such as movements due to foreign exchange translation and movements due to changes in the group of consolidated companies.

Movements in balances carried at fair value through profit or loss represent all changes affecting the carrying value. This includes the effects of market movements and cash inflows and outflows. The movements in balances carried at fair value are usually presented in operating cash flows.

Insurance

The Group’s insurance business issues two types of contracts:

Insurance Contracts – These are annuity and universal life contracts under which the Group accepts significant insurance risk from another party (the policyholder) by agreeing to compensate the policyholder if a specific uncertain future event adversely affects the policyholder. Such contracts remain insurance contracts until all rights and obligations are extinguished or expire. As allowed by IFRS, the Group retained the accounting policies for insurance contracts which it applied prior to the adoption of IFRS (U.S. GAAP) as described further below.

Non-Participating Investment Contracts (“Investment Contracts”) – These contracts do not contain significant insurance risk or discretionary participation features. These are measured and reported consistently with other financial liabilities, which are classified as financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss.

Financial assets held to back annuity contracts have been classified as AFS. Financial assets held for other insurance and investment contracts have been designated at fair value through profit or loss under the fair value option.

Insurance Contracts

Premiums for single premium business are recognized as income when received. This is the date from which the policy is effective. For regular premium contracts, receivables are recognized at the date when payments are due. Premiums are shown before deduction of commissions. When policies lapse due to non-receipt of premiums, all related premium income accrued but not received from the date they are deemed to have lapsed, net of related expense, is offset against premiums.

Claims are recorded as an expense when incurred, and reflect the cost of all claims arising during the year, including policyholder profit participations allocated in anticipation of a participation declaration.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    274
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

The aggregate policy reserves for universal life insurance contracts are equal to the account balance, which represents premiums received and investment returns credited to the policy, less deductions for mortality costs and expense charges. For other unit-linked insurance contracts the policy reserve represents the fair value of the underlying assets.

For annuity contracts, the liability is calculated by estimating the future cash flows over the duration of the in force contracts discounted back to the valuation date allowing for the probability of occurrence. The assumptions are fixed at the date of acquisition with suitable provisions for adverse deviations (“PADs”). This calculated liability value is tested against a value calculated using best estimate assumptions and interest rates based on the yield on the amortized cost of the underlying assets. Should this test produce a higher value, the liability amount would be reset.

Aggregate policy reserves include liabilities for certain options attached to the Group’s unit-linked pension products. These liabilities are calculated based on contractual obligations using actuarial assumptions.

Liability adequacy tests are performed for the insurance portfolios on the basis of estimated future claims, costs, premiums earned and proportionate investment income. For long duration contracts, if actual experience regarding investment yields, mortality, morbidity, terminations or expenses indicates that existing contract liabilities, along with the present value of future gross premiums, will not be sufficient to cover the present value of future benefits and to recover deferred policy acquisition costs, then a premium deficiency is recognized.

The costs directly attributable to the acquisition of incremental insurance and investment business are deferred to the extent that they are expected to be recoverable out of future margins in revenues on these contracts. These costs will be amortized systematically over a period no longer than that in which they are expected to be recovered out of these future margins.

Investment Contracts

All of the Group’s investment contracts are unit-linked. These contract liabilities are determined using current unit prices multiplied by the number of units attributed to the contract holders as of the balance sheet date.

As this amount represents fair value, the liabilities have been classified as financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss. Deposits collected under investment contracts are accounted for as an adjustment to the investment contract liabilities. Investment income attributable to investment contracts is included in the consolidated statement of income. Investment contract claims reflect the excess of amounts paid over the account balance released. Investment contract policyholders are charged fees for policy administration, investment management, surrenders or other contract services.

The financial assets for investment contracts are recorded at fair value with changes in fair value, and offsetting changes in the fair value of the corresponding financial liabilities, recorded in profit or loss.

Reinsurance

Premiums ceded for reinsurance and reinsurance recoveries on policyholder benefits and claims incurred are reported in income and expense as appropriate. Assets and liabilities related to reinsurance are reported on a gross basis when material. Amounts ceded to reinsurers from reserves for insurance contracts are estimated in a manner consistent with the reinsured risk. Accordingly, revenues and expenses related to reinsurance agreements are recognized in a manner consistent with the underlying risk of the business reinsured.

All new material reinsurance arrangements are subject to local Board approval. Once transacted they are subject to regular credit risk review including an assessment of the full exposure and any lending and collateral provision. Impairment is determined in accordance with the Group’s accounting policy “Impairment of Financial Assets”.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
275   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

02 –  

Recently Adopted and New Accounting Pronouncements

Recently Adopted Accounting Pronouncements

The following are those accounting pronouncements which are relevant to the Group and which have been adopted during 2015 in the preparation of these consolidated financial statements.

Improvements to IFRS 2010-2012 and 2011-2013 Cycles

On January 1, 2015, the Group adopted amendments to multiple IFRS standards, which resulted from the IASB’s annual improvement projects for the 2010-2012 and 2011-2013 cycles. They comprise amendments that result in accounting changes for presentation, recognition or measurement purposes as well as terminology or editorial amendments related to a variety of individual IFRS standards. The amendments did not have a material impact on the Group’s consolidated financial statements.

New Accounting Pronouncements

The following accounting pronouncements were not effective as of December 31, 2015 and therefore have not been applied in preparing these financial statements.

IFRS 9 Financial Instruments

In July 2014, the IASB issued IFRS 9 “Financial Instruments”, which replaces IAS 39, “Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement”. IFRS 9 introduces new requirements for how an entity should classify and measure financial assets, requires changes to the reporting of ‘own credit’ with respect to issued debt liabilities that are designated at fair value, replaces the current rules for impairment of financial assets and amends the requirements for hedge accounting. IFRS 9 is effective for annual periods beginning on or after January 1, 2018. The Group is currently assessing the impact of IFRS 9. The standard has yet to be endorsed by the EU.

The Group has implemented a centrally managed IFRS 9 program sponsored by the Group’s chief financial officer and includes subject matter experts on methodology, data sourcing and modelling, IT processing and reporting. Overall governance is through the IFRS 9 Steering Committee which includes joint representation from Finance and Risk. Guidance and training on IFRS 9 is delivered across businesses and functions as part of the Group's internal control system in preparation for IFRS 9 becoming effective for the Group from January 1, 2018.

Classification and Measurement of financial assets and liabilities

IFRS 9 requires that an entity’s business model and a financial instrument’s contractual cash flows will determine its classification and measurement in the financial statements. Upon initial recognition each financial asset will be classified as either fair value through profit or loss (‘FVTPL’), amortized cost, or fair value through Other Comprehensive Income (‘FVOCI’). As these requirements are different than the assessments under the existing IAS 39 rules, some differences to the classification and measurement of financial assets under IAS 39 are expected.

The classification and measurement of financial liabilities remain largely unchanged under IFRS 9 from current requirements. However, where issued debt liabilities are designated at fair value, the fair value movements attributable to an entity’s own credit risk will be recognized in Other Comprehensive Income rather than in the Statement of Income. The standard also allows the election to apply the presentation of fair value movements of an entity’s credit risk in Other Comprehensive Income prior to adopting IFRS 9 in full. The Group has not early adopted these requirements of the standard as IFRS 9 has not been endorsed by the EU yet.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    276
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Impairment of financial assets

The impairment rules under IFRS 9 will apply to financial assets that are measured at amortized cost or FVOCI, and off balance sheet lending commitments such as loan commitments and financial guarantees. The determination of impairment losses and allowances will move from an incurred credit loss model whereby credit losses are recognized when a ‘trigger’ event occurs under IAS 39 to an expected credit loss model, where provisions are taken upon initial recognition of the financial asset (or the date that the Group becomes a party to the loan commitment or financial guarantee) based on expectations of potential credit losses at that time.

Under the IFRS 9 expected credit loss approach, the Group will recognise expected credit losses resulting from default events that are possible within the next 12 months for both the homogeneous and non-homogeneous performing loan pools (stage 1). IFRS 9 also requires the recognition of credit losses expected over the remaining life of the assets (‘lifetime expected losses’) which have significantly deteriorated in credit quality since origination or purchase but have yet to default (stage 2) and for assets that are credit impaired (stage 3). Under IFRS 9 expected credit losses are measured by taking into account forward-looking information, including macro-economic factors.

As a result of the changes to the impairment rules, IFRS 9 will result in an increase in subjectivity as allowances will be based on reasonable and supportable forward-looking information which probability weights future economic situations that are continuously monitored and updated over the life of the financial asset. This is in contrast to impairment recognition under IAS 39 which requires the occurrence of one or more loss events before an allowance is recorded. IFRS 9 is expected to result in an increase in the overall level of impairment allowances, due to the requirement to record an allowance equal to 12 months expected credit losses on those instruments whose credit risk has not significantly increased since initial recognition and the likelihood that there will be a larger population of financial assets to which lifetime expected losses apply as compared to the population of financial assets for which loss events have already occurred under IAS 39.

Hedge accounting

IFRS 9 also incorporates new hedge accounting rules that intend to align hedge accounting with risk management practices. Generally, some restrictions under current rules have been removed and a greater variety of hedging instruments and hedged items become available for hedge accounting.

IFRS 15 Revenue from Contracts with Customers

In May 2014, the IASB issued IFRS 15, “Revenue from Contracts with Customers”, which specifies how and when revenue is recognized, but does not impact income recognition related to financial instruments in scope of IAS 39/ IFRS 9. IFRS 15 replaces several other IFRS standards and interpretations that currently govern revenue recognition under IFRS and provides a single, principles-based five-step model to be applied to all contracts with customers. The standard also requires entities to provide users of financial statements with more informative and relevant disclosures. IFRS 15 is effective for annual periods beginning on or after January 1, 2018. The Group is currently assessing the impact of IFRS 15. The standard has yet to be endorsed by the EU.

IFRS 16 Leases

In January 2016, the IASB issued IFRS 16, “Leases”, which introduces a single lessee accounting model and requires a lessee to recognise assets and liabilities for all leases with a term of more than 12 months, unless the underlying asset is of low value. A lessee is required to recognise a right-of-use asset representing its right to use the underlying leased asset and a lease liability representing its obligation to make lease payments. There will be only minor changes to the current accounting for lessors. The standard also requires entities to provide users of financial statements with more informative and relevant disclosures. IFRS 16 is effective for annual periods beginning on or after January 1, 2019. The Group is currently assessing the impact of IFRS 16. The standard has yet to be endorsed by the EU.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
277   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Improvements to IFRS 2012-2014 Cycles

In September 2014, the IASB issued amendments to multiple IFRS standards, which resulted from the IASB’s annual improvement project for the 2012-2014 cycles. This comprises amendments that result in accounting changes for presentation, recognition or measurement purposes as well as terminology or editorial amendments related to a variety of individual IFRS standards. The amendments will be effective for annual periods beginning on or after January 1, 2016, with early adoption permitted. They will have an immaterial impact on the Group’s consolidated financial statements. The amendments have been endorsed by the EU.

IAS 1

In December 2014, the IASB issued amendments to IAS 1 “Presentation of Financial Statements” as part of an initiative to improve presentation and disclosure in financial reports. These amendments clarify that the principle of materiality is applicable to the whole of the financial statements, professional judgment should be applied in determining disclosures and that inclusion of immaterial data can reduce the effectiveness of disclosures. The amendments will be effective for annual periods beginning on or after January 1, 2016 with early adoption permitted. The amendments to IAS 1 will only have a disclosure impact on the Group. These amendments have been endorsed by the EU.

03 –  

Acquisitions and Dispositions

Business Combinations completed in 2015 and 2014

During 2015 and 2014, the Group did not undertake any acquisitions accounted for as business combinations.

Business Combinations completed in 2013

On September 2, 2013, Deutsche Bank AG announced that it completed the purchase of the remaining 51 % of the shares in its joint venture Xchanging etb GmbH (“Xetb”), which is the holding company of Xchanging Transaction Bank GmbH (“XTB”). The purchase price paid for the step-acquisition consisted of a base component of  41 million, subject to certain adjustments. Of that amount,  36 million was paid as cash consideration by the acquirer. The remaining  5 million was paid by XTB to the seller, Xchanging plc. (“Xchanging”), in the course of closing the transaction, which resulted in a reduction of the acquired net assets. The agreement between Deutsche Bank and Xchanging was signed in May 2013. As the required approvals had been obtained, including those from regulatory authorities and the shareholders of Xchanging, the change of control to Deutsche Bank became effective on September 1, 2013 (the acquisition date). On closing the transaction, Deutsche Bank gained full ownership and operating control over XTB. The transaction was intended to contribute to Deutsche Bank’s Strategy 2015+ to improve operating efficiency and to reduce process duplication, complexity and costs.

Xetb was established as a joint venture with Xchanging in 2004 and is the holding company of XTB, the Group’s former wholly-owned subsidiary european transaction bank ag (“etb”). XTB provides services in relation to the securities processing business for Deutsche Bank as well as for external clients. The acquired entities were integrated into Deutsche Bank’s infrastructure operations. Prior to obtaining control over XTB, the Group directly held 49 % of the shares in Xetb, giving it the ability to significantly influence the investee’s financial and operating policies. Accordingly and up until closing date, XetB, including its subsidiary XTB, had been accounted for using the equity method. The acquisition-date fair value of the equity interest in the acquiree amounted to  21 million. The remeasurement to fair value did not result in any gain or loss.

The acquisition accounting was finalized in the second quarter 2014, resulting in a net increase of the purchase consideration paid and a corresponding increase of goodwill recognized of  1 million each. Accordingly, the final amount of goodwill originating from the transaction amounted to  38 million, which has been allocated to PBC ( 25 million),

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    278
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

GTB ( 6 million), CB&S ( 5 million) and Deutsche AWM ( 2 million). The reconciliation of the total purchase consideration and the opening balance sheet as of the acquisition date is as follows:

Fair Value of Assets Acquired and Liabilities Assumed as of the Acquisition Date

 

in m.

  

 

 

Cash consideration transferred

     36     

 

  

 

 

 

Fair value of pre-existing stakes

     21     

 

  

 

 

 

Deduction for settlement of pre-existing relationship

     8     

 

  

 

 

 

Total purchase consideration, including fair value of the Group’s equity interest held before the business combination

     50     

 

  

 

 

 
  

 

  

 

 

 

Recognized amounts of identifiable assets acquired and liabilities assumed: 1

  

 

  

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents

     6     

 

  

 

 

 

Financial assets available for sale

     24     

 

  

 

 

 

Intangible assets

     6     

 

  

 

 

 

All other assets

     31     

 

  

 

 

 

Provisions

     22     

 

  

 

 

 

All other liabilities

     34     

 

  

 

 

 

Total identifiable net assets

     12     

 

  

 

 

 

Goodwill

     38     

 

  

 

 

 

Total identifiable net assets and goodwill acquired

     50     

 

 

1     By major class of assets acquired and liabilities assumed.

Prior to the acquisition, Deutsche Bank and XTB were parties in a joint service contract arrangement for the provision of securities processing services to Deutsche Bank. The service arrangement has been identified as a pre-existing relationship, which is accounted for separately from the aforementioned purchase transaction. The service contract, which would have expired in May 2016, was terminated in connection with the closing of the transaction. The settlement amount attributable to the service contract was determined using a discounted cash flow approach. Its recognition resulted in a loss of  8 million, which was recorded in general and administrative expenses in the Group’s income statement for 2013.

Acquisitions and Dispositions of Noncontrolling Interests while Retaining Control

During 2015 and 2014, the Group did not engage in acquisitions or dispositions of noncontrolling interests while retaining control over the related subsidiaries.

Postbank

In concluding the domination agreement with Deutsche Postbank AG (“Postbank”) in 2012, Deutsche Bank had derecognized from the Group’s total equity the remaining noncontrolling interest of 248 million in Postbank as the minority shareholders ceased to have access to the risks and rewards of ownership of the Postbank shares. Through December 31, 2014, a total of approximately 0.5 million Postbank shares (equal to about 0.22 % of total Postbank shares outstanding) were tendered by minority shareholders to Deutsche Bank under the domination agreement, thereby increasing the Group’s direct shareholding to 94.1 % at that time.

On April 22, 2015, Deutsche Bank signed an agreement to purchase an additional 5.9 million (2.7 %) of the Postbank shares, thereby increasing the Group’s ownership stake from 94.1 % to 96.8 %. Overall, the transaction resulted in a loss before income tax of approximately  92 million recorded in C&A in the second quarter 2015.

On April 27, 2015, Deutsche Bank requested Postbank to prepare a squeeze-out of the minority shareholders pursuant to Section 327a et seq. of the German Stock Corporation Act. In the specified squeeze-out request to Postbank on July 7, 2015, the amount of cash compensation was set at  35.05 per Postbank share. After approval of the squeeze-out at the Postbank annual general meeting held on August 28, 2015, a loss before income tax of  69 million was recorded in the third quarter 2015 in C&A.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
279   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statemenet of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidatet Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
    Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations –417
                              
     

 

                    

After a clearance proceeding in front of the Higher Regional Court Cologne, the squeeze-out was entered into the commercial register on December 21, 2015. At settlement on December 30, 2015, Deutsche Bank acquired the remaining 3.2 % shares in Postbank for a total consideration of  245 million and so owns directly and indirectly 100 % of the Postbank shares.

Dispositions

During 2015, 2014 and 2013, the Group finalized several dispositions of subsidiaries/businesses. These disposals mainly included businesses the Group had previously classified as held for sale. The total cash consideration received for these dispositions in 2015, 2014 and 2013 was  555 million,  1.9 billion and  57 million, respectively. The table below shows the assets and liabilities that were included in these disposals.

 

in m.

    2015      2014       2013   

Cash and cash equivalents

           0          156    

All remaining assets

    443         8,346          33    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets disposed

    443         8,346          189    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities disposed

    52         6,602          196    

 

 

04 –  

Business Segments and Related Information

The Group’s segmental information has been prepared in accordance with the “management approach”, which requires presentation of the segments on the basis of the internal management reports of the entity which are regularly reviewed by the chief operating decision maker, which is the Deutsche Bank Management Board, in order to allocate resources to a segment and to assess its financial performance.

Starting first quarter 2014, net interest income as a component of net revenue, income (loss) before income taxes and related ratios is presented on a fully taxable-equivalent basis for U.S. tax-exempt securities for Corporate Banking & Securities. This enables management to measure performance of taxable and tax-exempt securities on a comparable basis. This change in presentation resulted in an increase in CB&S net interest income of 65.4 million for full year 2014. This increase is offset in Group Consolidated figures through a reversal in C&A. Prior period comparatives have not been adjusted due to immateriality. The tax rate used in determining the fully taxable-equivalent net interest income in respect of the majority of the US tax-exempt securities is 35 %. US tax-exempt securities held by NCOU are not being presented on a fully taxable-equivalent basis due to differing approaches in the management of core and noncore activities.

Business Segments

The Group’s business segments represent the Group’s organizational structure comprising five Corporate Divisions: Corporate Banking & Securities (CB&S), Private & Business Clients (PBC), Global Transaction Banking (GTB), Deutsche Asset & Wealth Management (Deutsche AWM) and Non-Core Operations Unit (NCOU). From 2016 onwards and in accordance with the Group’s Strategy 2020 the Group’s business operations are going to be organized under a new structure with the segments Global Markets (GM), Corporate & Investment Banking (CIB), Private, Wealth and Commercial Clients (PW&CC), Postbank, Deutsche Asset Management (AM) and Non-Core Operations Unit (NCOU).

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    280
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

As part of the ongoing optimisation of the Group’s business model, in response to the changing market and regulatory environment, the Group continued to evaluate the Group’s business portfolio, adapting it to reflect current market opportunities and meet client needs. In that context, at the end of 2014, the Group announced the cessation of most trading in single name CDS and physical precious metals.

In 2013 Deutsche AWM revised their revenue disclosure categories. The new revenue disclosure segregates revenues by their character and type to allow distinction into Recurring and Non-recurring components, Net interest revenues and Revenues from other products. The new disclosure is more aligned with the market convention, adds transparency and allows for more coherent analysis of the business. Prior periods were restated to reflect these changes.

The following describes other changes in management responsibilities with a significant impact on segmental reporting:

 

 

In 2015, GTB uses a higher level of detail for its externally reported revenue categories, i.e., “Trade Finance & Cash Management Corporates”, “Institutional Cash & Securities Services” and “Other Products”, formerly part of “Transaction Services”, in order to provide more transparency on GTB’s revenue composition in line with the internal management responsibilities and management information presentation

 

In 2014, PBC revised product revenue disclosure categories. PBC introduced a new revenue category “Postal and supplementary Postbank Services”, formerly part of other revenues, to provide more transparency on PBC’s revenue composition. Prior periods were restated to reflect these changes.

 

During the fourth quarter of 2013, the decision was taken to scale down and discontinue elements of the commodities business. The portfolios containing discontinued activities were aggregated under the Special Commodities Group (SCG), which has been subsequently transferred from CB&S to NCOU in the first quarter of 2014. SCG contains assets, liabilities and contingent risks related to Energy, Agriculture, Base Metals and Dry Bulk exposures. The comparatives for CB&S and NCOU have been restated accordingly. The continued commodities business remains in CB&S.

 

In 2013, the long-term cash lending portfolio of German MidCap clients was transferred from the Corporate Division CB&S to the Corporate Division GTB.

Measurement of Segment Profit or Loss

Segment reporting requires a presentation of the segment results based on management reporting methods, including a reconciliation between the results of the business segments and the consolidated financial statements, which is presented in the “Management Report: Operating and Financial Review: Deutsche Bank Group: Corporate Divisions: Consolidation & Adjustments”. The information provided about each segment is based on internal management reporting about segment profit or loss, assets and other information which is regularly reviewed by the chief operating decision maker. Segment assets are presented in the Group’s internal management reporting based on a consolidated view, i.e., the amounts do not include intersegment balances.

Non-IFRS compliant accounting methods are rarely used in the Group’s management reporting and represent either valuation or classification differences. The largest valuation differences relate to measurement at fair value in management reporting versus measurement at amortized cost under IFRS (for example, for certain financial instruments in the Group’s treasury books in CB&S and PBC) and to the recognition of trading results from own shares in revenues in management reporting (mainly in CB&S) and in equity under IFRS. The major classification difference relates to noncontrolling interest, which represents the net share of minority shareholders in revenues, provision for credit losses, noninterest expenses and income tax expenses. Noncontrolling interest is reported as a component of pre-tax income for the businesses in management reporting (with a reversal in C&A) and a component of net income appropriation under IFRS.

Since the Group’s business activities are diverse in nature and its operations are integrated, certain estimates and judgments have been made to apportion revenue and expense items among the business segments.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
281   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

The management reporting systems follow a “matched transfer pricing concept” in which the Group’s external net interest income is allocated to the business segments based on the assumption that all positions are funded or invested via the wholesale money and capital markets. Therefore, to create comparability with those competitors who have legally independent units with their own equity funding, the Group allocates a net notional interest credit on its consolidated capital (after deduction of certain related charges such as hedging of net investments in certain foreign operations) to the business segments, in proportion to each business segment’s allocated average active equity.

Management uses certain measures for equity and related ratios as part of its internal reporting system because it believes that these measures provide it with a useful indication of the financial performance of the business segments. The Group discloses such measures to provide investors and analysts with further insight into how management operates the Group’s businesses and to enable them to better understand the Group’s results. These measures include:

Average Active Equity – The Group calculates average active equity by subtracting from average shareholders’ equity average dividends, for which a proposal is accrued on a quarterly basis and which are paid after the approval at the Annual General Meeting each year. The Group calculates active equity to make comparisons to its competitors easier and refers to active equity in several ratios. However, active equity is not a measure provided for in IFRS and the Group’s ratios based on average active equity should not be compared to other companies’ ratios without considering differences in the calculations.

The total amount of average active equity allocated is determined based on the higher of the Group’s overall economic risk exposure or regulatory capital demand. Starting 2015, the Group refined its allocation of average active equity to the business segments to reflect the communicated capital and leverage targets. Under the new methodology, the internal demand for regulatory capital is based on a Common Equity Tier 1 target ratio of 10 % (11 % from June 2015 and 12.5 % from December 2015) and on a CRD 4 leverage target ratio of 3.5 % (5 % from June 2015 and 4.5 % from December 2015) both at a Group level and assuming full implementation of CRR/CRD 4 rules. If the Group exceeds the Common Equity Tier 1 target ratio and the CRD 4 leverage target ratio, excess average equity is assigned to C&A. Average Active Equity is a blend of the aforementioned different targets.

Segmental Results of Operations

For the results of the business segments, including the reconciliation to the consolidated results of operations under IFRS please see “Management Report: Operating and Financial Review: Results of Operations: Segment Results of Operations”.

Entity-Wide Disclosures

The Group’s Entity-Wide Disclosures include net revenues from internal and external counterparties. Excluding revenues from internal counterparties would require disproportionate IT investment and is not in line with the Bank's management approach. For detail on the Group’s Net Revenue Components please see “Management Report: Operating and Financial Review: Results of Operations: Corporate Divisions”.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    282
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

The following table presents total net revenues (before provisions for credit losses) by geographic area for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The information presented for CB&S, GTB, Deutsche AWM, PBC and NCOU has been classified based primarily on the location of the Group’s office in which the revenues are recorded. The information for C&A is presented on a global level only, as management responsibility for C&A is held centrally.

 

in m.

  2015       2014       2013    

Germany:

     

CB&S

    731          860          994     

PBC

    7,241          7,662          7,654     

GTB

    1,234          1,251          1,339     

Deutsche AWM

    1,399          1,356          1,196     

NCOU

    (287)         (185)         360     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Germany

    10,318          10,945          11,542     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

UK:

     

CB&S

    5,021          3,794          3,965     

PBC

    (0)         (0)         0     

GTB

    381          317          289     

Deutsche AWM

    1,039          589          984     

NCOU

    (73)         8          (76)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total UK

    6,367          4,708          5,163     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Rest of Europe, Middle East and Africa:

     

CB&S

    645          933          868     

PBC

    1,608          1,879          1,726     

GTB

    1,026          941          952     

Deutsche AWM

    921          790          872     

NCOU

    9          2          (33)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Rest of Europe, Middle East and Africa

    4,209          4,545          4,385     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Americas (primarily United States):

     

CB&S

    4,895          5,461          4,824     

PBC

    0          (21)         (21)    

GTB

    1,146          887          830     

Deutsche AWM

    1,432          1,435          1,174     

NCOU

    754          345          670     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Americas

    8,227          8,108          7,477     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Asia/Pacific:

     

CB&S

    2,927          2,582          2,750     

PBC

    62          44          36     

GTB

    829          723          615     

Deutsche AWM

    617          533          492     

NCOU

    (1)         2          (25)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Asia/Pacific

    4,434          3,884          3,868     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Consolidation & Adjustments

    (30)         (240)         (519)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Consolidated net revenues1

    33,525          31,949          31,915     

 

 

Note: Prior periods have been restated.

1 

Consolidated net revenues comprise interest and similar income, interest expenses and total noninterest income (including net commission and fee income). Revenues are attributed to countries based on the location in which the Group’s booking office is located. The location of a transaction on the Group’s books is sometimes different from the location of the headquarters or other offices of a customer and different from the location of the Group’s personnel who entered into or facilitated the transaction. Where the Group records a transaction involving its staff and customers and other third parties in different locations frequently depends on other considerations, such as the nature of the transaction, regulatory considerations and transaction processing considerations.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
283   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

 

Notes to the Consolidated Income Statement

 

 

05 –

Net Interest Income and Net Gains (Losses) on Financial Assets/Liabilities at Fair Value through Profit or Loss

Net Interest Income

 

in m.

  2015       2014       2013    

Interest and similar income:

     

Interest-earning deposits with banks

    499          683          759     

Central bank funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements

    377          408          412     

Interest income on financial assets available for sale

    1,292          1,341          1,312     

Dividend income on financial assets available for sale

    300          97          81     

Loans

    12,219          11,820          11,941     

Other

    783          848          366     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Interest and similar income not at fair value through profit or loss

    15,470          15,196          14,872     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial assets at fair value through profit or loss

    10,496          9,805          10,729     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total interest and similar income

    25,967          25,001          25,601     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Interest expense:

     

Interest-bearing deposits

    2,764          3,210          3,360     

Central bank funds purchased and securities sold under repurchase agreements

    153          160          186     

Other short-term borrowings

    229          214          285     

Long-term debt

    1,480          1,882          1,568     

Trust preferred securities

    568          785          849     

Other

    357          214          (16)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Interest expense not at fair value through profit or loss

    5,552          6,465          6,232     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss

    4,534          4,264          4,535     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total interest expense

    10,086          10,729          10,767     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income

    15,881          14,272          14,834     

 

 

Interest income recorded on impaired financial assets was 67 million, 94 million and 76 million for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    284
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Net Gains (Losses) on Financial Assets/Liabilities at Fair Value through Profit or Loss

 

in m.

  2015       2014       2013    

Trading income:

     

Sales & Trading (equity)

    98          1,686          1,569     

Sales & Trading (debt and other products)

    3,899          2,583          2,469     

Total Sales & Trading

    3,996          4,269          4,039     

Other trading income

    (122)         137          (377)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total trading income

    3,874          4,407          3,662     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss:

     

Breakdown by financial asset/liability category:

     

Securities purchased/sold under resale/repurchase agreements

    3          (15)         31     

Securities borrowed/loaned

    0          0          0     

Loans and loan commitments

    (453)         (20)          (46)    

Deposits

    0          (1)         73     

Long-term debt 1

    761          (538)         133     

Other financial assets/liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss

    (344)         467          (35)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss

    (32)         (108)         155     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss

    3,842          4,299          3,817     

 

 

 

1 

Includes  (0.5) million,  48 million and  (86) million from securitization structures for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively. Fair value movements on related instruments of  0.8 million,  (315) million and  390 million for December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively, are reported within trading income. The total of these gains and losses represents the Group’s share of the losses in these consolidated securitization structures.

Combined Net Interest Income and Net Gains (Losses) on Financial Assets/Liabilities at Fair Value through Profit or Loss

 

in m.

  2015       2014       2013    

Net interest income

    15,881          14,272          14,834     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss

    3,842          4,299          3,817     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total net interest income and net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss     19,723          18,570          18,651     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Net interest income and net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss by Corporate Division/product:      

Sales & Trading (equity)

    2,502          2,302          2,111     

Sales & Trading (debt and other products)

    7,909          6,591          5,976     

Total Sales & Trading

    10,411          8,893          8,087     

Loan products 1

    623          688          587     

Remaining products 2

    (440)         (62)         69     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Corporate Banking & Securities

    10,594          9,519          8,743     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Private & Business Clients

    5,837          5,893          5,817     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Global Transaction Banking

    2,133          2,205          1,940     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Deutsche Asset & Wealth Management

    1,615          1,500          1,550     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-Core Operations Unit

    (631)         (612)         176     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Consolidation & Adjustments

    176          65          423     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total net interest income and net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss     19,723          18,570          18,651     

 

 
1 

Includes the net interest spread on loans as well as the fair value changes of credit default swaps and loans designated at fair value through profit or loss.

2 

Includes net interest income and net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss of origination, advisory and other products.

The Group’s trading and risk management businesses include significant activities in interest rate instruments and related derivatives. Under IFRS, interest and similar income earned from trading instruments and financial instruments designated at fair value through profit or loss (i.e., coupon and dividend income), and the costs of funding net trading positions, are part of net interest income. The Group’s trading activities can periodically drive income to either net interest income or to net gains (losses) of financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss depending on a variety of factors, including risk management strategies. The above table combines net interest income and net gains (losses) of financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss by business division and by product within CB&S.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
285   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

06 –

Commissions and Fee Income

 

in m.

  2015       2014       2013    

Commission and fee income and expense:

     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Commission and fee income

    16,412          15,746          15,252     

Commission and fee expense

    3,647          3,337          2,943     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net commissions and fee income

    12,765          12,409          12,308     

 

 

 

in m.

  2015       2014       2013    

Net commissions and fee income:

     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net commissions and fees from fiduciary activities

    4,480          3,745          3,646     
Net commissions, brokers’ fees, mark-ups on securities underwriting and other securities activities     4,134          4,033          3,920     

Net fees for other customer services

    4,151          4,632          4,742     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net commissions and fee income

    12,765          12,409          12,308     

 

 

07 –

Net Gains (Losses) on Financial Assets Available for Sale

 

in m.

  2015       2014       2013    

Net gains (losses) on financial assets available for sale:

     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net gains (losses) on debt securities:

    48          153          321     

Net gains (losses) from disposal

    58          144          319     

Impairments

    (10)         9          2     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net gains (losses) on equity securities:

    104          109          77     

Net gains (losses) from disposal/remeasurement

    156          121          92     

Impairments

    (52)         (12)         (15)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net gains (losses) on loans:

    52          (9)         6     

Net gains (losses) from disposal

    83          16          33     

Impairments

    (31)         (25)         (27)    

Reversal of impairments

    0          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net gains (losses) on other equity interests:

    1          (12)         (12)    

Net gains (losses) from disposal

    14          9          9     

Impairments

    (13)         (21)         (21)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total net gains (losses) on financial assets available for sale

    203          242          394     

 

 

Please also refer to Note 16 “Financial Assets Available for Sale” of this report.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    286
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

08 –

Other Income

 

in m.

   2015        2014        2013    

Other income:

        

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net income from investment properties

     40           57           23     

Net gains (losses) on disposal of investment properties

     (18)          5           (3)    

Net gains (losses) on disposal of consolidated subsidiaries

     (24)          18           4     

Net gains (losses) on disposal of loans

     237           (2)          288     

Insurance premiums 1

     108           141           190     

Net income (loss) from hedge relationships qualifying for hedge accounting

     (910)          (1,349)          (1,227)    

Consolidated investments

     470           949           881     

Remaining other income

     763           290           37     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total other income (loss)

     669           108           193     

 

 
1 

Net of reinsurance premiums paid. The development is primarily driven by Abbey Life Assurance Company Limited.

09 –

General and Administrative Expenses

 

in m.

   2015        2014        2013    

General and administrative expenses:

        

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

IT costs

     3,664           3,333           3,074     

Occupancy, furniture and equipment expenses

     1,944           1,978           2,073     

Professional service fees

     2,283           2,029           1,772     

Communication and data services

     807           725           706     

Travel and representation expenses

     505           521           516     

Banking and transaction charges

     598           660           743     

Marketing expenses

     294           293           294     

Consolidated investments

     406           811           797     

Other expenses 1

     8,129           4,305           5,151     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total general and administrative expenses

     18,632           14,654           15,126     

 

 
1 Includes litigation related expenses of 5.2 billion in 2015, 1.6 billion in 2014 and 3.0 billion in 2013. See Note 29 “Provisions”, for more detail on litigation.

10 –

Restructuring

Restructuring formed part of the Group’s Operational Excellence (OpEx) program which ended in December 2015. Additionally it includes parts of the new Strategy 2020 initiative which was announced in 2015. Strategy 2020 contains initiatives to reposition Investment Banking, reshape the retail business, rationalize the geographic footprint and transform the operating model – with the aim of achieving net savings of  1 to 1.5 billion by 2018.

Restructuring expense is comprised of termination benefits, additional expenses covering the acceleration of deferred compensation awards not yet amortized due to the discontinuation of employment and contract termination costs related to real estate. Restructuring expenses of  710 million were recognized during 2015 (2014:  133 million), thereof  616 million for Strategy 2020 initiative mostly driven by Private & Business Clients.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
287   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

 

in m.

  2015       2014       2013    

Corporate Banking & Securities

    (124)         (112)         (130)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Private & Business Clients

    (587)         (9)         (22)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Global Transaction Banking

    (3)         (10)         (54)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Deutsche Asset & Wealth Management

    4          3          (170)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-Core Operations Unit

    1          (4)         (25)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Infrastructure/Regional Management

    0          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Consolidation & Adjustments

    0          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Net Restructuring Charges

    (710)         (133)         (399)    

 

 

 

in m.

  2015       2014       2013    

Restructuring - Staff related

    (663)         (124)         (364)    

thereof:

     

Termination Benefits

    (602)         (94)         (287)    

Retention Acceleration

    (61)         (29)         (72)    

Social Security

    (0)         (1)         (4)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Restructuring - Non Staff related

    (46)         (9)         (35)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Net Restructuring Charges

    (710)         (133)         (399)    

 

 

Provisions for restructuring amounted to  651 million and  120 million as of December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, respectively. The majority of the current provisions for restructuring are expected to be utilized in the next three years.

During 2015, 662 full-time equivalent staff was reduced through restructuring (2014: 1,371).

 

Full-time equivalent staff

  2015       2014    

Corporate Banking & Securities

    186          319     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Private & Business Clients

    126          92     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Global Transaction Banking

    51          157     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Deutsche Asset & Wealth Management

    37          207     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-Core Operations Unit

    1          11     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Infrastructure/Regional Management

    261          585     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total full-time equivalent staff

    662          1,371     

 

 

11 –

Earnings per Share

Basic earnings per share amounts are computed by dividing net income (loss) attributable to Deutsche Bank shareholders by the average number of common shares outstanding during the year. The average number of common shares outstanding is defined as the average number of common shares issued, reduced by the average number of shares in treasury and by the average number of shares that will be acquired under physically-settled forward purchase contracts, and increased by undistributed vested shares awarded under deferred share plans.

Diluted earnings per share assumes the conversion into common shares of outstanding securities or other contracts to issue common stock, such as share options, convertible debt, unvested deferred share awards and forward contracts. The aforementioned instruments are only included in the calculation of diluted earnings per share if they are dilutive in the respective reporting period.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    288
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Computation of basic and diluted earnings per share

 

in m.

  2015       2014       2013    
Net income (loss) attributable to Deutsche Bank shareholders – numerator for basic earnings per share     (7,022) 1       1,663          666     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Effect of dilutive securities:

     

Forwards and options

    0          0          0     

Convertible debt

    0          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Net income (loss) attributable to Deutsche Bank shareholders after assumed conversions – numerator for diluted earnings per share     (7,022) 1         1,663          666     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Number of shares in million

     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Weighted-average shares outstanding – denominator for basic earnings per share     1,387.9          1,241.9          1,045.4     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Effect of dilutive securities:

     

Forwards

    0.0          0.0          0.0     

Employee stock compensation options

    0.0          0.0          0.0     

Convertible debt

    0.0          0.0          0.0     

Deferred shares

    0.0          27.6          27.8     

Other (including trading options)

    0.0          0.0          0.0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Dilutive potential common shares

    0.0          27.6          27.8     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Adjusted weighted-average shares after assumed conversions – denominator for diluted earnings per share     1,387.9          1,269.5          1,073.2     

 

 
1 

Earnings were adjusted by 228 million net of tax for the coupons paid on Additional Tier 1 Notes in April 2015.

 

Earnings per share

 

     

in

  2015       2014       2013    

Basic earnings per share

    (5.06)          1.34          0.64     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Diluted earnings per share

    (5.06)         1.31          0.62     

 

 

On June 25, 2014, Deutsche Bank AG completed a capital increase with subscription rights. As the subscription price of the new shares was lower than the market price of the existing shares, the capital increase included a bonus element. According to IAS 33, the bonus element is the result of an implicit change in the number of shares outstanding for all periods prior to the capital increase without a fully proportionate change in resources. As a consequence, the weighted average number of shares outstanding has been adjusted retrospectively.

Due to the net loss situation for 2015 potentially dilutive shares are generally not considered for the earnings per share calculation, because to do so would have been anti-dilutive and hence decreased the net loss per share.

Instruments outstanding and not included in the calculation of diluted earnings per share1

 

Number of shares in m.

    2015         2014         2013    

Forward purchase contracts

    0.0          0.0          0.0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Convertible debt

    0.0          0.0          0.0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Put options sold

    0.0          0.0          0.0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Call options sold

    0.0          0.0          0.0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Employee stock compensation options

    0.0          0.1          0.2     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Deferred shares

    52.5          0.0          0.0     

 

 

 

1 

Not included in the calculation of diluted earnings per share, because to do so would have been anti-dilutive.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
289   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet

 

12 –

Financial Assets/Liabilities at Fair Value through Profit or Loss

 

in m.

   Dec 31, 2015        Dec 31, 2014   

Financial assets classified as held for trading:

   

Trading assets:

   

Trading securities

    179,256          177,639     

Other trading assets1

    16,779          18,041     
Total trading assets     196,035          195,681     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Positive market values from derivative financial instruments

    515,594          629,958     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total financial assets classified as held for trading

    711,630          825,639     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss:

   

Securities purchased under resale agreements

    51,073          60,473     

Securities borrowed

    21,489          20,404     

Loans

    12,451          15,331     

Other financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss

    24,240          21,078     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss     109,253          117,285     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total financial assets at fair value through profit or loss

    820,883          942,924     

 

 

 

1 Includes traded loans of  15.5 billion and  16.7 billion at December 31, 2015 and 2014 respectively.

  

 

in m.

    Dec 31, 2015         Dec 31, 2014    

Financial liabilities classified as held for trading:

   

Trading liabilities:

   

Trading securities

    51,326          41,112     

Other trading liabilities

    977          731     
Total trading liabilities     52,303          41,843     

Negative market values from derivative financial instruments

    494,076          610,202     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total financial liabilities classified as held for trading:     546,380          652,045     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss:

   

Securities sold under repurchase agreements

    31,637          21,053     

Loan commitments

    79          99     

Long-term debt

    8,710          9,919     

Other financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss

    4,425          6,061     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss     44,852          37,131     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Investment contract liabilities1

    8,522          8,523     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss

    599,754          697,699     

 

 

 

1

These are investment contracts where the policy terms and conditions result in their redemption value equaling fair value. See Note 41 “Insurance and Investment Contracts”, for more detail on these contracts.

Financial Assets & Liabilities designated at Fair Value through Profit or Loss

The Group has designated various lending relationships at fair value through profit or loss. Lending facilities consist of drawn loan assets and undrawn irrevocable loan commitments. The maximum exposure to credit risk on a drawn loan is its fair value. The Group’s maximum exposure to credit risk on drawn loans, including securities purchased under resale agreements and securities borrowed, was  85 billion and  96 billion as of December 31, 2015, and 2014, respectively. Exposure to credit risk also exists for undrawn irrevocable loan commitments and is predominantly counterparty credit risk.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    290
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

The credit risk on the securities purchased under resale agreements and securities borrowed designated under the fair value option is mitigated by the holding of collateral. The valuation of these instruments takes into account the credit enhancement in the form of the collateral received. As such there is no material movement during the year or cumulatively due to movements in counterparty credit risk on these instruments.

Changes in fair value of loans1 and loan commitments attributable to movements in counterparty credit risk2

 

      Dec 31, 2015         Dec 31, 2014    

in m.

    Loans       Loan  
commitments  
      Loans       Loan  
  commitments  
 
Notional value of loans and loan commitments exposed to credit risk     4,455          8,604          5,146          15,393     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Annual change in the fair value reflected in the Statement of Income     (0)         (46)         3          43     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Cumulative change in the fair value3     9          29          14          470     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Notional of credit derivatives used to mitigate credit risk     257          4,203          417          8,152     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Annual change in the fair value reflected in the Statement of Income     (2)         1          (1)         (19)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cumulative change in the fair value3

    (4)         (154)         (3)         (257)    

 

 

 

1 

Where the loans are over-collateralized there is no material movement in valuation during the year or cumulatively due to movements in counterparty credit risk.

2 

Determined using valuation models that exclude the fair value impact associated with market risk.

3 

Changes are attributable to loans and loan commitments held at reporting date, which may differ from those held in prior periods. No adjustments are made to prior year to reflect differences in the underlying population.

Changes in fair value of financial liabilities attributable to movements in the Group’s credit risk1

 

in m.

    Dec 31, 2015         Dec 31, 20142     
Annual change in the fair value reflected in the Statement of Income     (78)         45     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 
Cumulative change in the fair value     71          202     

 

 

 

1 

The fair value of a financial liability incorporates the credit risk of that financial liability. Changes in the fair value of financial liabilities issued by consolidated structured entity have been excluded as this is not related to the Group’s credit risk but to that of the legally isolated structured entity, which is dependent on the collateral it holds.

2 

In 2015 the prior year numbers were restated (increase of 68 million in both annual and cumulative change in the fair value).

The excess of the contractual amount repayable at maturity over the carrying value of financial liabilities1

 

in m.

     Dec 31, 2015          Dec 31, 2014    

Including undrawn loan commitments2

     10,513           18,261     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Excluding undrawn loan commitments

     2,203           1,621     

 

 

 

1

Assuming the liability is extinguished at the earliest contractual maturity that the Group can be required to repay. When the amount payable is not fixed, it is determined by reference to conditions existing at the reporting date.

2 

The contractual cash flows at maturity for undrawn loan commitments assume full drawdown of the facility.

13 –

Amendments to IAS 39 and IFRS 7, “Reclassification of Financial Assets”

Under the amendments to IAS 39 and IFRS 7, issued in October 2008, certain financial assets were reclassified in the second half of 2008 and the first quarter 2009 from the financial assets at fair value through profit or loss and the available for sale classifications into the loans classification. No reclassifications have been made since the first quarter 2009.

The Group identified assets, eligible under the amendments, for which at the reclassification date it had a clear change of intent and ability to hold for the foreseeable future rather than to exit or trade in the short term. The reclassifications were made at the fair value of the assets at the reclassification date.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
291   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Reclassified Financial Assets

 

in bn.

(unless stated otherwise)

    Trading assets  
reclassified to  
loans  
    Financial assets  
available for sale  
reclassified to  
loans  
 

Carrying value at reclassification date

    26.6          11.4     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Unrealized fair value losses in accumulated other comprehensive income

    0.0          (1.1)     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Effective interest rates at reclassification date:

   

upper range

    13.1 %          9.9 %     

lower range

    2.8 %          3.9 %     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Expected recoverable cash flows at reclassification date

    39.6          17.6     

 

 

Carrying values and fair values by asset type of assets reclassified in 2008 and 2009

 

    Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 2014    

in m.

    Carrying value         Fair value         Carrying value         Fair Value    

Trading assets reclassified to loans:

       

Securitization assets

    1,382        1,346          1,983          2,124     

Debt securities

    396        405          1,067          1,160     

Loans

    916        857          1,146          888     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total trading assets reclassified to loans

    2,695        2,608          4,197          4,171     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Financial assets available for sale reclassified to loans:        

Securitization assets

    1,540        1,470          1,782          1,743     

Debt securities

    168        179          1,378          1,493     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total financial assets available for sale reclassified to loans     1,708        1,648          3,160          3,236     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total financial assets reclassified to loans

    4,403 1        4,256          7,357          7,408     

 

 

 

1 

There is an associated effect on the carrying value from effective fair value hedge accounting for interest rate risk to the carrying value of the reclassified assets shown in the table above. This effect decreases carrying value by 3 million and increases by 86 million as at December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014 respectively.

All reclassified assets are managed by the NCOU and disposal decisions across this portfolio are made by the NCOU in accordance with their remit to take the de-risking decisions. For the year ended December 31, 2015, the Group sold reclassified assets with a carrying value of  2.9 billion, resulting in a net gain of  0.3 billion on positions sold.

In addition to sales, the decrease in the carrying value of assets previously classified as trading includes redemptions and maturities of  0.3 billion. The reduction in the carrying value of assets previously classified as available for sale includes redemptions and maturities of  0.1 billion.

Unrealized fair value gains (losses) that would have been recognized in profit or loss and net gains (losses) that would have been recognized in other comprehensive income if the reclassifications had not been made

 

in m.

  2015       2014       2013    

Unrealized fair value gains (losses) on the reclassified trading assets, gross of provisions for credit losses

    141          342          245     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Impairment (losses)/Reversal on the reclassified financial assets available for sale which were impaired

    12          (6)         9     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Net gains (losses) recognized in other comprehensive income representing additional unrealized fair value gains (losses) on the reclassified financial assets available for sale which were not impaired     (32)         137          130     

 

 
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    292
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Pre-tax contribution of all reclassified assets to the income statement

 

in m.

  2015       2014       2013    

Interest income

    127          161          272     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Provision for credit losses

    28          (40)         (348)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other income1

    199          5          (141)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income before income taxes on reclassified trading assets

    353          126          (217)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Interest income

    54          97          96     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Provision for credit losses

    16          (13)         (25)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other income1

    72          0          (66)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income before income taxes on reclassified financial assets available for sale

    142          84          5     

 

 
1 

Relates to gains and losses from the sale of reclassified assets.

 

Reclassified Financial Assets: Carrying values and fair values by asset class

All IAS 39 reclassified assets were transferred into the NCOU upon creation of the new division in the fourth quarter of 2012. The NCOU has been tasked to accelerate de-risking to reduce total capital demand and IFRS assets. A number of factors are considered in determining whether and when to sell assets including the income statement, regulatory capital and leverage impacts. The movements in carrying value and fair value are illustrated in the following table:

Carrying values and fair values by asset class reclassified in 2008 and 2009

 

    Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 2014    

in m.

  Carrying  
  value (CV)  
    Fair value (FV)       Unrealized  
  gains/(losses)  
    Carrying  
  value (CV)  
      Fair value (FV)       Unrealized  
  gains/(losses)  
 
Securitization assets and debt securities reclassified:            

US municipal bonds

    405          423          19          2,302          2,503          201     

Student loans ABS

    1,456          1,478          22          1,464          1,529          65     

CDO/CLO

    534          498          (36)         717          689          (28)    

Covered bond

    298          234          (64)         893          987          95     

Commercial mortgages securities

    175          176          1          187          192          5     

Residential mortgages ABS

    92          93          1          83          92          9     

Other1

    529          498          (31)         566          528          (38)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total securitization assets and debt securities reclassified     3,487          3,400          (88)         6,211          6,520          309   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Loans reclassified:            

Commercial mortgages

    56          54          (1)         227          226          0     

Residential mortgages

    810          753          (57)         871          616          (255)    

Other

    50          49          (1)         49          46          (3)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total loans reclassified

    916          857          (59)         1,146          888          (259)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total financial assets reclassified to loans     4,403          4,256          (147)         7,357          7,408          51     

 

 

 

1 

Includes asset backed securities related to the aviation industry and a mixture of other securitization assets and debt securities.

Securitized Assets and Debt Securities

Municipal Bonds – The US Municipal bonds have a fair value above carrying value due to being predominantly fixed rate instruments with interest rates falling since reclassification. The carrying value decrease is predominantly due to sales of  2 billion.

CDO/CLO – This comprises a diverse portfolio with a variety of underlying assets and tranching levels in the capital structure. The difference between carrying value and fair value arises due to a number of factors including liquidity and the fair value model capturing market expectations of lifetime expected losses compared with the amortized cost impairment model largely based on incurred credit losses. The main movement in the carrying value is due to principal paydowns in the period of  0.2 billion.

Covered Bonds – The remaining exposure in the portfolio is to Spanish government issuers. The carrying value decrease is predominantly due to sales of  0.6 billion.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
293   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Student Loans ABS – The carrying value decrease is predominantly due to sales partly offset by FX movements.

Commercial Mortgages Securities – The reduction in carrying value is predominantly due to sales and principal repayments.

Other – The reduction in carrying value is due to principal repayments offset by FX movements.

Loans

Commercial Mortgages – The carrying value change is predominantly due to redemptions in the period of 0.1 billion.

Residential Mortgages – This category includes residential mortgages in the UK, Italy, Spain and Germany. The carrying value fair value gap has narrowed due to further price transparency on the fair value.

14 –

Financial Instruments carried at Fair Value

Valuation Methods and Control

The Group has an established valuation control framework which governs internal control standards, methodologies, and procedures over the valuation process.

Prices Quoted in Active Markets – The fair value of instruments that are quoted in active markets are determined using the quoted prices where they represent prices at which regularly and recently occurring transactions take place.

Valuation Techniques – The Group uses valuation techniques to establish the fair value of instruments where prices, quoted in active markets, are not available. Valuation techniques used for financial instruments include modeling techniques, the use of indicative quotes for proxy instruments, quotes from recent and less regular transactions and broker quotes.

For some financial instruments a rate or other parameter, rather than a price, is quoted. Where this is the case then the market rate or parameter is used as an input to a valuation model to determine fair value. For some instruments, modeling techniques follow industry standard models, for example, discounted cash flow analysis and standard option pricing models. These models are dependent upon estimated future cash flows, discount factors and volatility levels. For more complex or unique instruments, more sophisticated modeling techniques are required, and may rely upon assumptions or more complex parameters such as correlations, prepayment speeds, default rates and loss severity.

Frequently, valuation models require multiple parameter inputs. Where possible, parameter inputs are based on observable data or are derived from the prices of relevant instruments traded in active markets. Where observable data is not available for parameter inputs, then other market information is considered. For example, indicative broker quotes and consensus pricing information are used to support parameter inputs where they are available. Where no observable information is available to support parameter inputs then they are based on other relevant sources of information such as prices for similar transactions, historic data, economic fundamentals, and research information, with appropriate adjustment to reflect the terms of the actual instrument being valued and current market conditions.

Valuation Adjustments – Valuation adjustments are an integral part of the valuation process. In making appropriate valuation adjustments, the Group follows methodologies that consider factors such as bid-offer spreads, liquidity, counterparty/own credit and funding risk. Bid-offer spread valuation adjustments are required to adjust mid market valuations to the appropriate bid or offer valuation. The bid or offer valuation is the best representation of the fair value for an instrument, and therefore its fair value. The carrying value of a long position is adjusted from mid to bid, and the carrying value of a short position is adjusted from mid to offer. Bid-offer valuation adjustments are determined from bid-offer

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    294
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

prices observed in relevant trading activity and in quotes from other broker-dealers or other knowledgeable counterparties. Where the quoted price for the instrument is already a bid-offer price then no additional bid-offer valuation adjustment is necessary. Where the fair value of financial instruments is derived from a modeling technique, then the parameter inputs into that model are normally at a mid-market level. Such instruments are generally managed on a portfolio basis and, when specified criteria are met, valuation adjustments are taken to reflect the cost of closing out the net exposure the Bank has to individual market or counterparty risks. These adjustments are determined from bid-offer prices observed in relevant trading activity and quotes from other broker-dealers.

Where complex valuation models are used, or where less-liquid positions are being valued, then bid-offer levels for those positions may not be available directly from the market, and therefore for the close-out cost of these positions, models and parameters must be estimated. When these adjustments are designed, the Group closely examines the valuation risks associated with the model as well as the positions themselves, and the resulting adjustments are closely monitored on an ongoing basis.

Counterparty Credit Valuation Adjustments (CVAs) are required to cover expected credit losses to the extent that the valuation technique does not already include an expected credit loss factor relating to the non-performance risk of the counterparty. The CVA amount is applied to all relevant over-the-counter (OTC) derivatives, and is determined by assessing the potential credit exposure to a given counterparty and taking into account any collateral held, the effect of any relevant netting arrangements, expected loss given default and the probability of default, based on available market information, including Credit Default Swap (CDS) spreads. Where counterparty CDS spreads are not available, relevant proxies are used.

The fair value of the Group’s financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss (i.e., OTC derivative liabilities and structured note liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss) incorporates Debt Valuation Adjustments (DVA) to measure the change in the Group’s own credit risk of the financial liability. For derivative liabilities the Group considers its own creditworthiness by assessing all counterparties’ potential future exposure to the Group, taking into account any collateral posted by the Group, the effect of relevant netting arrangements, expected loss given default and the probability of default of the Group, based on the Group’s market CDS level. The change in the Group’s own credit risk for structured note liabilities is calculated by discounting the contractual cash flows of the instrument using the rate at which similar instruments would be issued at the measurement date as this reflects the value from the perspective of a market participant who holds the identical item as an asset.

When determining CVA and DVA, additional adjustments are made where appropriate to achieve fair value, due to the expected loss estimate of a particular arrangement, or where the credit risk being assessed differs in nature to that described by the available CDS instrument.

Funding Valuation Adjustments (FVA) are required to incorporate the market implied funding costs into the fair value of derivative positions. The FVA reflects a discounting spread applied to uncollateralized and partially collateralized derivatives and is determined by assessing the market-implied funding costs on both assets and liabilities.

Where there is uncertainty in the assumptions used within a modeling technique, an additional adjustment is taken to calibrate the model price to the expected market price of the financial instrument. Typically, such transactions have bid-offer levels which are less observable, and these adjustments aim to estimate the bid-offer by computing the liquidity-premium associated with the transaction. Where a financial instrument is of sufficient complexity that the cost of closing it out would be higher than the cost of closing out its component risks, then an additional adjustment is taken to reflect this.

Validation and Control – The Group has an independent specialised valuation control group within the Finance function which governs and develops the valuation control framework and manages the valuation control processes. The mandate of this specialist function includes the performance of the independent valuation control process for all businesses, the continued development of valuation control methodologies and techniques, as well as devising and governing the formal valuation control policy framework. Special attention of this independent valuation control group is directed to areas where management judgment forms part of the valuation process.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
295   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Results of the valuation control process are collected and analyzed as part of a standard monthly reporting cycle. Variances of differences outside of preset and approved tolerance levels are escalated both within the Finance function and with Senior Business Management for review, resolution and, if required, adjustment.

For instruments where fair value is determined from valuation models, the assumptions and techniques used within the models are independently validated by an independent specialist model validation group that is part of the Group’s Risk Management function.

Quotes for transactions and parameter inputs are obtained from a number of third party sources including exchanges, pricing service providers, firm broker quotes and consensus pricing services. Price sources are examined and assessed to determine the quality of fair value information they represent, with greater emphasis given to those possessing greater valuation certainty and relevance. The results are compared against actual transactions in the market to ensure the model valuations are calibrated to market prices.

Price and parameter inputs to models, assumptions and valuation adjustments are verified against independent sources. Where they cannot be verified to independent sources due to lack of observable information, the estimate of fair value is subject to procedures to assess its reasonableness. Such procedures include performing revaluation using independently generated models (including where existing models are independently recalibrated), assessing the valuations against appropriate proxy instruments and other benchmarks, and performing extrapolation techniques. Assessment is made as to whether the valuation techniques produce fair value estimates that are reflective of market levels by calibrating the results of the valuation models against market transactions where possible.

Fair Value Hierarchy

The financial instruments carried at fair value have been categorized under the three levels of the IFRS fair value hierarchy as follows:

Level 1 – Instruments valued using quoted prices in active markets are instruments where the fair value can be determined directly from prices which are quoted in active, liquid markets and where the instrument observed in the market is representative of that being priced in the Group’s inventory.

These include: government bonds, exchange-traded derivatives and equity securities traded on active, liquid exchanges.

Level 2 – Instruments valued with valuation techniques using observable market data are instruments where the fair value can be determined by reference to similar instruments trading in active markets, or where a technique is used to derive the valuation but where all inputs to that technique are observable.

These include: many OTC derivatives; many investment-grade listed credit bonds; some CDS; many collateralized debt obligations (CDO); and many less-liquid equities.

Level 3 – Instruments valued using valuation techniques using market data which is not directly observable are instruments where the fair value cannot be determined directly by reference to market-observable information, and some other pricing technique must be employed. Instruments classified in this category have an element which is unobservable and which has a significant impact on the fair value.

These include: more-complex OTC derivatives; distressed debt; highly-structured bonds; illiquid asset-backed securities (ABS); illiquid CDO’s (cash and synthetic); monoline exposures; some private equity placements; many commercial real estate (CRE) loans; illiquid loans; and some municipal bonds.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    296
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Carrying value of the financial instruments held at fair value1

 

    Dec 31, 2015        Dec 31, 2014     

in m.

  Quoted   
prices in   
active market   
(Level 1)   
    Valuation   
technique   
observable   
parameters   
(Level 2)   
    Valuation   
technique   
unobservable   
parameters    
(Level 3)   
    Quoted   
prices in   
active market   
(Level 1)   
    Valuation   
technique   
observable   
parameters   
(Level 2)   
    Valuation   
technique   
unobservable   
parameters    
(Level 3)   
 
Financial assets held at fair value:            

Trading assets

    90,031           93,253           12,751           82,020           100,505           13,155      

Trading securities

    89,718           82,869           6,669           81,789           86,894           8,957      

Other trading assets

    313           10,384           6,082           232           13,611           4,198      

Positive market values from derivative financial instruments

    5,629           500,520           9,445           5,439           614,960           9,559      

Financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss

    18,024           86,751           4,478           8,826           104,307           4,152      

Financial assets available for sale

    43,260           25,449           4,874           36,272           23,597           4,427      

Other financial assets at fair value

    0           3,1362           0           0           4,3352           0      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total financial assets held at fair value     156,943           709,109           31,549           132,558           847,705           31,294      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Financial liabilities held at fair value:            

Trading liabilities

    40,185           12,102           18           25,290           16,510           43      

Trading securities

    40,154           11,155           18           25,244           15,826           43      

Other trading liabilities

    30           947           0           46           685           0      

Negative market values from derivative financial instruments

    5,528           480,668           7,879           5,890           597,759           6,553      

Financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss

    2           41,797           3,053           2           34,763           2,366      

Investment contract liabilities3

    0           8,522           0           0           8,523           0      

Other financial liabilities at fair value

    0           6,4922           (1,146)4           0           5,5612          (552)4     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total financial liabilities held at fair value     45,715           549,581           9,805           31,181           663,117           8,410      

 

 

 

1 

Amounts in this table are generally presented on a gross basis, in line with the Group’s accounting policy regarding offsetting of financial instruments, as described in Note 1 “Significant Accounting Policies and Critical Accounting Estimates”.

2 

Predominantly relates to derivatives qualifying for hedge accounting.

3 

These are investment contracts where the policy terms and conditions result in their redemption value equalling fair value. See Note 41 “Insurance and Investment Contracts” for more detail on these contracts.

4 

Relates to derivatives which are embedded in contracts where the host contract is held at amortized cost but for which the embedded derivative is separated. The separated embedded derivatives may have a positive or a negative fair value but have been presented in this table to be consistent with the classification of the host contract. The separated embedded derivatives are held at fair value on a recurring basis and have been split between the fair value hierarchy classifications.

There were transfers from level 2 to level 1 on trading securities ( 8 billion of liabilities) based on liquidity testing procedures and  10 billion on financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss due to reclassification of a Treasury portfolio.

Valuation Techniques

The following is an explanation of the valuation techniques used in establishing the fair value of the different types of financial instruments that the Group trades.

Sovereign, Quasi-sovereign and Corporate Debt and Equity Securities – Where there are no recent transactions then fair value may be determined from the last market price adjusted for all changes in risks and information since that date. Where a close proxy instrument is quoted in an active market then fair value is determined by adjusting the proxy value for differences in the risk profile of the instruments. Where close proxies are not available then fair value is estimated using more complex modeling techniques. These techniques include discounted cash flow models using current market rates for credit, interest, liquidity and other risks. For equity securities modeling techniques may also include those based on earnings multiples.

Mortgage- and Other Asset-Backed Securities (MBS/ABS) include residential and commercial MBS and other ABS including CDOs. ABS have specific characteristics as they have different underlying assets and the issuing entities have different capital structures. The complexity increases further where the underlying assets are themselves ABS, as is the case with many of the CDO instruments.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
297   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Where no reliable external pricing is available, ABS are valued, where applicable, using either relative value analysis which is performed based on similar transactions observable in the market, or industry-standard valuation models incorporating available observable inputs. The industry standard external models calculate principal and interest payments for a given deal based on assumptions that can be independently price tested. The inputs include prepayment speeds, loss assumptions (timing and severity) and a discount rate (spread, yield or discount margin). These inputs/assumptions are derived from actual transactions, external market research and market indices where appropriate.

Loans For certain loans fair value may be determined from the market price on a recently occurring transaction adjusted for all changes in risks and information since that transaction date. Where there are no recent market transactions then broker quotes, consensus pricing, proxy instruments or discounted cash flow models are used to determine fair value. Discounted cash flow models incorporate parameter inputs for credit risk, interest rate risk, foreign exchange risk, loss given default estimates and amounts utilized given default, as appropriate. Credit risk, loss given default and utilization given default parameters are determined using information from the loan or CDS markets, where available and appropriate.

Leveraged loans can have transaction-specific characteristics which can limit the relevance of market-observed transactions. Where similar transactions exist for which observable quotes are available from external pricing services then this information is used with appropriate adjustments to reflect the transaction differences. When no similar transactions exist, a discounted cash flow valuation technique is used with credit spreads derived from the appropriate leveraged loan index, incorporating the industry classification, subordination of the loan, and any other relevant information on the loan and loan counterparty.

Over-The-Counter Derivative Financial Instruments Market standard transactions in liquid trading markets, such as interest rate swaps, foreign exchange forward and option contracts in G7 currencies, and equity swap and option contracts on listed securities or indices are valued using market standard models and quoted parameter inputs. Parameter inputs are obtained from pricing services, consensus pricing services and recently occurring transactions in active markets wherever possible.

More complex instruments are modeled using more sophisticated modeling techniques specific for the instrument and are calibrated to available market prices. Where the model output value does not calibrate to a relevant market reference then valuation adjustments are made to the model output value to adjust for any difference. In less active markets, data is obtained from less frequent market transactions, broker quotes and through extrapolation and interpolation techniques. Where observable prices or inputs are not available, management judgment is required to determine fair values by assessing other relevant sources of information such as historical data, fundamental analysis of the economics of the transaction and proxy information from similar transactions.

Financial Liabilities Designated at Fair Value through Profit or Loss under the Fair Value Option – The fair value of financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss under the fair value option incorporates all market risk factors including a measure of the Group’s credit risk relevant for that financial liability. The financial liabilities include structured note issuances, structured deposits, and other structured securities issued by consolidated vehicles, which may not be quoted in an active market. The fair value of these financial liabilities is determined by discounting the contractual cash flows using the relevant credit-adjusted yield curve. The market risk parameters are valued consistently to similar instruments held as assets, for example, any derivatives embedded within the structured notes are valued using the same methodology discussed in the “Over-The-Counter Derivative Financial Instruments” section above.

Where the financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss under the fair value option are collateralized, such as securities loaned and securities sold under repurchase agreements, the credit enhancement is factored into the fair valuation of the liability.

Investment Contract Liabilities – Assets which are linked to the investment contract liabilities are owned by the Group. The investment contract obliges the Group to use these assets to settle these liabilities. Therefore, the fair value of investment contract liabilities is determined by the fair value of the underlying assets (i.e., amount payable on surrender of the policies).

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    298
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Analysis of Financial Instruments with Fair Value Derived from Valuation Techniques Containing Significant Unobservable Parameters (Level 3)

Some of the instruments in level 3 of the fair value hierarchy have identical or similar offsetting exposures to the unobservable input. However, according to IFRS they are required to be presented as gross assets and liabilities.

Trading Securities – Certain illiquid emerging market corporate bonds and illiquid highly structured corporate bonds are included in this level of the hierarchy. In addition, some of the holdings of notes issued by securitization entities, commercial and residential MBS, collateralized debt obligation securities and other ABS are reported here. The decrease in the year is mainly due to a combination of sales and transfers between levels 2 and 3 due to changes in the observability of input parameters used to value these instruments.

Positive and Negative Market Values from Derivative Instruments categorized in this level of the fair value hierarchy are valued based on one or more significant unobservable parameters. The unobservable parameters may include certain correlations, certain longer-term volatilities, certain prepayment rates, credit spreads and other transaction-specific parameters.

Level 3 derivatives include customized CDO derivatives in which the underlying reference pool of corporate assets is not closely comparable to regularly market-traded indices; certain tranched index credit derivatives; certain options where the volatility is unobservable; certain basket options in which the correlations between the referenced underlying assets are unobservable; longer-term interest rate option derivatives; multi-currency foreign exchange derivatives; and certain credit default swaps for which the credit spread is not observable.

The decrease in assets was due to settlements and transfers between levels 2 and 3 due to changes in the observability of input parameters used to value these instruments. The increase in liabilities mainly refers to transfers between levels 2 and 3.

Other Trading Instruments classified in level 3 of the fair value hierarchy mainly consist of traded loans valued using valuation models based on one or more significant unobservable parameters. Level 3 loans comprise illiquid leveraged loans and illiquid residential and commercial mortgage loans. The balance increased in the year mainly due to purchases and issuances.

Financial Assets/Liabilities designated at Fair Value through Profit or Loss – Certain corporate loans and structured liabilities which were designated at fair value through profit or loss under the fair value option are categorized in this level of the fair value hierarchy. The corporate loans are valued using valuation techniques which incorporate observable credit spreads, recovery rates and unobservable utilization parameters. Revolving loan facilities are reported in the third level of the hierarchy because the utilization in the event of the default parameter is significant and unobservable.

In addition, certain hybrid debt issuances designated at fair value through profit or loss containing embedded derivatives are valued based on significant unobservable parameters. These unobservable parameters include single stock volatility correlations. Assets and Liabilities increased in the year primarily due to issuances.

Financial Assets Available for Sale include non-performing loan portfolios where there is no trading intent and unlisted equity instruments where there is no close proxy and the market is very illiquid. The increase in assets in the year is primarily due to purchases.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
299   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Reconciliation of financial instruments classified in Level 3

Reconciliation of financial instruments classified in Level 3

 

                    Dec 31, 2015   

 

 
      Changes in                    

in m.

  Balance, 
beginning 
of year 
    the group 
of consoli- 
dated com- 
panies 
    Total    
gains/    

losses1  
    Purchases     Sales      Issuances2     Settle- 
ments3
    Transfers 
into 

Level 34
    Transfers 
out of 
Level 34
    Balance, 
end of 
year 
 
Financial assets held at fair value:                    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Trading securities     8,957                512           1,844        (2,432)               (1,007)        766         (1,971)        6,669    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Positive market values from derivative financial instruments     9,559         (0)        539           0                      (1,363)        1,683         (973)        9,445    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other trading assets     4,198                413           2,527        (1,507)        1,264         (1,461)        970         (321)        6,082    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss     4,152                234           467        (36)        1,172         (1,227)        239         (523)        4,478    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Financial assets available for sale     4,427         (0)        4395          1,058        (254)               (1,183)        469         (82)        4,874    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other financial assets at fair value                   0           0                                             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total financial assets held at fair value     31,294         (0)        2,1366,7        5,896        (4,230)        2,436         (6,240)        4,126         (3,869)        31,549    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Financial liabilities held at fair value:                    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Trading securities     43                5           0                                    (39)        18    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Negative market values from derivative financial instruments     6,553                716           0                      (487)        1,904         (807)        7,879    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other trading liabilities                   0           0                                             

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss     2,366                196           0               1,249         (692)        155         (221)        3,053    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other financial liabilities at fair value     (552)               (352)          0                      (65)        (177)               (1,146)   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total financial liabilities held at fair value     8,410        0         5646,7        0        0         1,249        (1,234)        1,882        (1,067)        9,805    

 

 

 

1 

Total gains and losses predominantly relate to net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss reported in the consolidated statement of income. The balance also includes net gains (losses) on financial assets available for sale reported in the consolidated statement of income and unrealized net gains (losses) on financial assets available for sale and exchange rate changes reported in other comprehensive income, net of tax. Further, certain instruments are hedged with instruments in level 1 or level 2 but the table above does not include the gains and losses on these hedging instruments. Additionally, both observable and unobservable parameters may be used to determine the fair value of an instrument classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy; the gains and losses presented below are attributable to movements in both the observable and unobservable parameters.

2 

Issuances relate to the cash amount received on the issuance of a liability and the cash amount paid on the primary issuance of a loan to a borrower.

3 

Settlements represent cash flows to settle the asset or liability. For debt and loan instruments this includes principal on maturity, principal amortizations and principal repayments. For derivatives all cash flows are presented in settlements.

4 

Transfers in and transfers out of level 3 are related to changes in observability of input parameters. During the year they are recorded at their fair value at the beginning of year. For instruments transferred into level 3 the table shows the gains and losses and cash flows on the instruments as if they had been transferred at the beginning of the year. Similarly for instruments transferred out of level 3 the table does not show any gains or losses or cash flows on the instruments during the year since the table is presented as if they have been transferred out at the beginning of the year.

5 

Total gains and losses on available for sale include a gain of  92 million recognized in other comprehensive income, net of tax, and a loss of  13 million recognized in the income statement presented in net gains (losses) on financial assets available for sale.

6 

This amount includes the effect of exchange rate changes. For total financial assets held at fair value this effect is a gain of  524 million and for total financial liabilities held at fair value this is a loss of  161 million. The effect of exchange rate changes is reported in other comprehensive income, net of tax.

7 

For assets positive balances represent gains, negative balances represent losses. For liabilities positive balances represent losses, negative balances represent gains.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    300
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

 

 
Dec 31, 2014                    

 

 
      Changes in                   

in m.

  Balance, 
beginning 
of year 
    the
group
of
consoli-
dated

com-
panies
    Total
gains/  
losses1
    Purchases     Sales      Issuances2     Settle-  
ments3
    Transfers  
into  

Level 34
    Transfers  
out of  
Level 34
    Balance, 
end of 
year 
 
Financial assets held at fair value:                    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Trading securities     6,960                738           3,567        (2,081)               (597)        2,175         (1,804)        8,957    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Positive market values from derivative financial instruments     10,556                740           0                      (1,250)        1,167         (1,654)        9,559    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other trading assets     5,065                (43)           1,642        (2,167)        778         (845)        943         (1,173)        4,198    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss     3,123                266           265        (5)        2,175         (1,802)        192         (61)        4,152    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Financial assets available for sale     3,329         (0)        5335          1,901        (406)               (1,234)        432         (126)        4,427    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other financial assets at fair value6            (1)        0           0                      (0)                        

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total financial assets held at fair value     29,033         (1)        2,2337,8        7,373        (4,659)        2,953         (5,727)        4,908         (4,819)        31,294    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Financial liabilities held at fair value:                    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Trading securities     24                2           0                      (5)        40         (18)        43    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Negative market values from derivative financial instruments     8,321                490           0                      (1,434)        1,196         (2,019)        6,553    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other trading liabilities                   0           0                                    (0)          

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss     1,442                (53)           0               557         (221)        882         (241)        2,366    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other financial liabilities at fair value     (247)               (69)           0                      (207)        63         (93)        (552)   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total financial liabilities held at fair value     9,539         0         3717,8        0        0         557         (1,867)        2,182         (2,371)        8,410    

 

 
1 

Total gains and losses predominantly relate to net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss reported in the consolidated statement of income. The balance also includes net gains (losses) on financial assets available for sale reported in the consolidated statement of income and unrealized net gains (losses) on financial assets available for sale and exchange rate changes reported in other comprehensive income, net of tax. Further, certain instruments are hedged with instruments in level 1 or level 2 but the table above does not include the gains and losses on these hedging instruments. Additionally, both observable and unobservable parameters may be used to determine the fair value of an instrument classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy; the gains and losses presented below are attributable to movements in both the observable and unobservable parameters.

2 

Issuances relate to the cash amount received on the issuance of a liability and the cash amount paid on the primary issuance of a loan to a borrower.

3 

Settlements represent cash flows to settle the asset or liability. For debt and loan instruments this includes principal on maturity, principal amortizations and principal repayments. For derivatives all cash flows are presented in settlements.

4 

Transfers in and transfers out of level 3 are related to changes in observability of input parameters. During the year they are recorded at their fair value at the beginning of year. For instruments transferred into level 3 the table shows the gains and losses and cash flows on the instruments as if they had been transferred at the beginning of the year. Similarly for instruments transferred out of level 3 the table does not show any gains or losses or cash flows on the instruments during the year since the table is presented as if they have been transferred out at the beginning of the year.

5 

Total gains and losses on available for sale include a gain of  144 million recognized in other comprehensive income, net of tax, and a gain of  31 million recognized in the income statement presented in net gains (losses) on financial assets available for sale.

6 

Represents assets held for sale related to BHF-BANK.

7 

This amount includes the effect of exchange rate changes. For total financial assets held at fair value this effect is a gain of  585 million and for total financial liabilities held at fair value this is a gain of  128 million. The effect of exchange rate changes is reported in other comprehensive income, net of tax.

8 

For assets positive balances represent gains, negative balances represent losses. For liabilities positive balances represent losses, negative balances represent gains.

Sensitivity Analysis of Unobservable Parameters

Where the value of financial instruments is dependent on unobservable parameter inputs, the precise level for these parameters at the balance sheet date might be drawn from a range of reasonably possible alternatives. In preparing the financial statements, appropriate levels for these unobservable input parameters are chosen so that they are consistent with prevailing market evidence and in line with the Group’s approach to valuation control detailed above. Were the Group to have marked the financial instruments concerned using parameter values drawn from the extremes of the ranges of reasonably possible alternatives then as of December 31, 2015 it could have increased fair value by as much as  2.1 billion or decreased fair value by as much as  1.5 billion. As of December 31, 2014 it could have increased fair value by as much as  3.3 billion or decreased fair value by as much as  2.9 billion.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
301   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

During the third quarter of 2015 the valuation estimate for the sensitivity analysis of unobservable parameters was enhanced to better reflect the valuation uncertainty of the Level 3 financial instruments, by use of a more advanced technique, in line with emergent market practice. The changes in the sensitive amounts from December 31, 2014 to December 31, 2015 are primarily due to this change in estimate rather than significant changes in the Level 3 instruments or risk profile. Simultaneously with this enhanced estimate, and to better reflect how these risks are assessed, the sensitivity of unobservable parameters estimate in respect of Sovereign and quasi sovereign debt obligations was aggregated with the sensitivity estimates for Corporate debt securities and other debt securities. Sensitivity related to these combined line items is disclosed as Corporate, Sovereign and other debt securities.

This disclosure is intended to illustrate the potential impact of the relative uncertainty in the fair value of financial instruments for which valuation is dependent on unobservable input parameters. However, it is unlikely in practice that all unobservable parameters would be simultaneously at the extremes of their ranges of reasonably possible alternatives. Hence, the estimates disclosed above are likely to be greater than the true uncertainty in fair value at the balance sheet date. Furthermore, the disclosure is neither predictive nor indicative of future movements in fair value.

For many of the financial instruments considered here, in particular derivatives, unobservable input parameters represent only a subset of the parameters required to price the financial instrument, the remainder being observable. Hence for these instruments the overall impact of moving the unobservable input parameters to the extremes of their ranges might be relatively small compared with the total fair value of the financial instrument. For other instruments, fair value is determined based on the price of the entire instrument, for example, by adjusting the fair value of a reasonable proxy instrument. In addition, all financial instruments are already carried at fair values which are inclusive of valuation adjustments for the cost to close out that instrument and hence already factor in uncertainty as it reflects itself in market pricing. Any negative impact of uncertainty calculated within this disclosure, then, will be over and above that already included in the fair value contained in the financial statements.

Breakdown of the sensitivity analysis by type of instrument1

    Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 2014    

in m.

  Positive fair value  
movement from using  
reasonable possible   
alternatives  
    Negative fair value  
movement from using  
reasonable possible   
alternatives  
    Positive fair value  
movement from using  
reasonable possible   
alternatives  
    Negative fair value  
movement from using  
reasonable possible   
alternatives  
 

Securities:

       

Debt securities

    212          158          833          725     

Commercial mortgage-backed securities

    12          11          57          47     

Mortgage and other asset-backed securities

    38          31          235          229     

Corporate, sovereign and other debt securities

    161          116          541          449     

Equity securities

    179          105          124          224     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Derivatives:

       

Credit

    489          627          432          457     

Equity

    183          131          157          115     

Interest related

    364          147          392          184     

Foreign Exchange

    17          13          4          2     

Other

    161          100          75          74     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loans:

       

Loans

    539          261          1,175          988     

Loan commitments

    0          0          6          5     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other

    0          0          79          79     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    2,144          1,542          3,277          2,854     

 

 

 

1 

Where the exposure to an unobservable parameter is offset across different instruments then only the net impact is disclosed in the table.

Quantitative Information about the Sensitivity of Significant Unobservable Inputs

The behavior of the unobservable parameters on Level 3 fair value measurement is not necessarily independent, and dynamic relationships often exist between the other unobservable parameters and the observable parameters. Such relationships, where material to the fair value of a given instrument, are explicitly captured via correlation parameters, or are otherwise controlled via pricing models or valuation techniques. Frequently, where a valuation technique utilises more than one input, the choice of a certain input will bound the range of possible values for other inputs. In addition,

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    302
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

broader market factors (such as interest rates, equity, credit or commodity indices or foreign exchange rates) can also have effects.

The range of values shown below represents the highest and lowest inputs used to value the significant exposures within Level 3. The diversity of financial instruments that make up the disclosure is significant and therefore the ranges of certain parameters can be large. For example, the range of credit spreads on mortgage backed securities represents performing, more liquid positions with lower spreads then the less liquid, non-performing positions which will have higher credit spreads. As Level 3 contains the less liquid fair value instruments, the wide ranges of parameters seen is to be expected, as there is a high degree of pricing differentiation within each exposure type to capture the relevant market dynamics. There follows a brief description of each of the principle parameter types, along with a commentary on significant interrelationships between them.

Credit Parameters are used to assess the creditworthiness of an exposure, by enabling the probability of default and resulting losses of a default to be represented. The credit spread is the primary reflection of creditworthiness, and represents the premium or yield return above the benchmark reference instrument (typically LIBOR, or relevant Treasury Instrument, depending upon the asset being assessed), that a bond holder would require to allow for the credit quality difference between that entity and the reference benchmark. Higher credit spreads will indicate lower credit quality, and lead to a lower value for a given bond, or other loan-asset that is to be repaid to the Bank by the borrower. Recovery Rates represent an estimate of the amount a lender would receive in the case of a default of a loan, or a bond holder would receive in the case of default of the bond. Higher recovery rates will give a higher valuation for a given bond position, if other parameters are held constant. Constant Default Rate (CDR) and Constant Prepayment Rate (CPR) allow more complex loan and debt assets to be assessed, as these parameters estimate the ongoing defaults arising on scheduled repayments and coupons, or whether the borrower is making additional (usually voluntary) prepayments. These parameters are particularly relevant when forming a fair value opinion for mortgage or other types of lending, where repayments are delivered by the borrower through time, or where the borrower may pre-pay the loan (seen for example in some residential mortgages). Higher CDR will lead to lower valuation of a given loan or mortgage as the lender will ultimately receive less cash.

Interest rates, credit spreads, inflation rates, foreign exchange rates and equity prices are referenced in some option instruments, or other complex derivatives, where the payoff a holder of the derivative will receive is dependent upon the behavior of these underlying references through time. Volatility parameters describe key attributes of option behavior by enabling the variability of returns of the underlying instrument to be assessed. This volatility is a measure of probability, with higher volatilities denoting higher probabilities of a particular outcome occurring. The underlying references (interest rates, credit spreads etc.) have an effect on the valuation of options, by describing the size of the return that can be expected from the option. Therefore the value of a given option is dependent upon the value of the underlying instrument, and the volatility of that instrument, representing the size of the payoff, and the probability of that payoff occurring. Where volatilities are high, the option holder will see a higher option value as there is greater probability of positive returns. A higher option value will also occur where the payoff described by the option is significant.

Correlations are used to describe influential relationships between underlying references where a derivative or other instrument has more than one underlying reference. Behind some of these relationships, for example commodity correlation and interest rate-foreign exchange correlations, typically lie macroeconomic factors such as the impact of global demand on groups of commodities, or the pricing parity effect of interest rates on foreign exchange rates. More specific relationships can exist between credit references or equity stocks in the case of credit derivatives and equity basket derivatives, for example. Credit correlations are used to estimate the relationship between the credit performance of a range of credit names, and stock correlations are used to estimate the relationship between the returns of a range of equities. A derivative with a correlation exposure will be either long- or short-correlation. A high correlation suggests a strong relationship between the underlying references is in force, and this will lead to an increase in value of a long-correlation derivative. Negative correlations suggest that the relationship between underlying references is opposing, i.e., an increase in price of one underlying reference will lead to a reduction in the price of the other.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
303   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

An EBITDA (‘earnings before interest, tax, depreciation and amortization’) multiple approach can be used in the valuation of less liquid securities. Under this approach the enterprise value (‘EV’) of an entity can be estimated via identifying the ratio of the EV to EBITDA of a comparable observable entity and applying this ratio to the EBITDA of the entity for which a valuation is being estimated. Under this approach a liquidity adjustment is often applied due to the difference in liquidity between the generally listed comparable used and the company under valuation. A higher EV/EBITDA multiple will result in a higher fair value.

Financial instruments classified in Level 3 and quantitative information about unobservable inputs

 

     Dec 31, 2015    
     Fair value                           

in m. (unless stated otherwise)

     Assets         Liabilities      

Valuation technique(s)1  

  

Significant unobservable  
input(s) (Level 3)

   Range    
Financial instruments held at fair value – held for trading, designated at fair value and available-for-sale:                
Mortgage and other asset backed securities held for trading:                
Commercial mortgage-backed securities      224          0        Price based    Price      0%           105%     
       Discounted cash flow    Credit spread (bps)      370           1,500     

Mortgage- and other asset-backed securities

     1,891          0        Price based    Price      0%           111%     
       Discounted cash flow    Credit spread (bps)      32           2,000     
          Recovery rate      0%           100%     
          Constant default rate      0%           24%     
          Constant prepayment rate      0%           51%     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 
Total mortgage- and other asset-backed securities      2,115          0                

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Debt securities and other debt obligations

     4,721          1,654        Price based    Price      0%           230%     

Held for trading

     4,229          18        Discounted cash flow    Credit spread (bps)      9           984     

Corporate, sovereign and other debt securities

     4,229                  

Available-for-sale

     330                  

Designated at fair value

     163          1,636                

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Equity securities

     1,248          0        Market approach    Price per net asset value      70%           100%     

Held for trading

     325          0           Enterprise value/EBITDA (multiple)      1           18     

Available-for-sale

     901          Discounted cash flow    Weighted average cost capital      8%           12%     

Designated at fair value

     21                  

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Loans

     12,626          0        Price based    Price      0%           146%     

Held for trading

     6,076          0        Discounted cash flow    Credit spread (bps)      103           2,787     

Designated at fair value

     3,672             Constant default rate      0%           24%     

Available-for-sale

     2,879             Recovery rate      10%           82%     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Loan commitments

     0          84        Discounted cash flow    Credit spread (bps)      5           1,257     
          Recovery rate      20%           75%     
       Loan pricing model    Utilization      0%           100%     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other financial instruments

     1,3942         1,3333       Discounted cash flow    IRR      4%           24%     
          Repo rate (bps)      125           277     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

  

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 
Total non-derivative financial instruments held at fair value      22,104         3,071               

 

 
1

Valuation technique(s) and subsequently the significant unobservable input(s) relate to the respective total position.

2 

Other financial assets include  6 million of other trading assets,  623 million of other financial assets designated at fair value and  765 million other financial assets available for sale.

3 

Other financial liabilities include  1.2 billion of securities sold under repurchase agreements designated at fair value and  84 million of other financial liabilities designated at fair value.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    304
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

    Dec 31, 2015    
      Fair value                         

in m.

(unless stated otherwise)

  Assets       Liabilities      

Valuation technique(s)  

 

Significant unobservable
input(s) (Level 3)

  Range    
Financial instruments held at fair value:             
Market values from derivative financial instruments:             

Interest rate derivatives

    3,775        2,337      Discounted cash flow   Swap rate (bps)     (20)           915     
        Inflation swap rate     0%           8%     
        Constant default rate     0%           6%     
        Constant prepayment rate     2%           19%     
      Option pricing model   Inflation volatility     0%           8%     
        Interest rate volatility     9%           176%     
        IR - IR correlation     (25)%           100%     
        Hybrid correlation     (70)%           99%     

Credit derivatives

    2,626        1,771      Discounted cash flow   Credit spread (bps)     3           8,526     
        Recovery rate     0%           100%     
      Correlation pricing model   Credit correlation     13%           89%     

Equity derivatives

    695        1,402      Option pricing model   Stock volatility     9%           89%     
        Index volatility     12%           85%     
        Index - index correlation     45%           93%     
        Stock - stock correlation     5%           93%     

FX derivatives

    1,613        1,604      Option pricing model   Volatility     2%           24%     

Other derivatives

    736        (380) 1    Discounted cash flow   Credit spread (bps)     –           –     
      Option pricing model   Index volatility     7%           36%     
        Commodity correlation     (21)%           90%     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total market values from derivative

financial instruments

    9,445        6,733            

 

 

 

1 

Includes derivatives which are embedded in contracts where the host contract is held at amortized cost but for which the embedded derivative is separated.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
305   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

 

    Dec 31, 2014    
    Fair value                         

in m. (unless stated otherwise)

    Assets         Liabilities      

Valuation technique(s)1  

 

Significant unobservable  
input(s) (Level 3)

  Range    
Financial instruments held at fair value – held for trading, designated at fair value and available-for-sale:             
Mortgage and other asset backed securities held for trading:             

Commercial mortgage-backed securities

    342          0        Price based   Price     0%           106%     
      Discounted cash flow   Credit spread (bps)     246         1,375     

Mortgage- and other asset-backed securities

    2,342          0        Price based   Price     0%           184%     
      Discounted cash flow   Credit spread (bps)     72           1,648     
        Recovery rate     0%           97%     
        Constant default rate     0%           13%     
        Constant prepayment rate     0%           22%     
            

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

    

 

 

 
Total mortgage- and other asset-backed securities     2,684          0              

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

    

 

 

 

Debt securities and other debt obligations

    5,936          1,202        Price based   Price     0%           286%     

Held for trading

    5,477          43        Discounted cash flow   Credit spread (bps)     32           1,629     

Sovereign and quasi sovereign obligations

    835                

Corporate debt securities and other debt obligations

    4,643                

Available-for-sale

    459                

Designated at fair value

    0          1,159              

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

    

 

 

 

Equity securities

    1,719          0        Market approach   Price per net asset value     49%           100%     

Held for trading

    795          0          Enterprise value/EBITDA (multiple)     1           18     

Available-for-sale

    895          Discounted cash flow   Weighted average cost capital     6%           13%     

Designated at fair value

    29                

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

    

 

 

 

Loans

    10,648          0        Price based   Price     0%           137%     

Held for trading

    4,148          0        Discounted cash flow   Credit spread (bps)     95           3,040     

Designated at fair value

    3,719            Constant default rate     2%           21%     

Available-for-sale

    2,781            Recovery rate     0%           67%     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

    

 

 

 

Loan commitments

    0          87        Discounted cash flow   Credit spread (bps)     115           1,000     
        Recovery rate     20%           80%     
      Loan pricing model   Utilization     0%           100%     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other financial instruments

    7482          1,1213        Discounted cash flow   IRR     2%           24%     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

    

 

 

 
Total non-derivative financial instruments held at fair value     21,735         2,409             

 

 

 

1 

Valuation technique(s) and subsequently the significant unobservable input(s) relate to the respective total position.

2 

Other financial assets include  50 million of other trading assets,  405 million of other financial assets designated at fair value and  293 million other financial assets available for sale.

3 

Other financial liabilities include  1 billion of securities sold under repurchase agreements designated at fair value and  104 million of other financial liabilities designated at fair value.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    306
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

    Dec 31, 2014    
        Fair value                         

in m.

(unless stated otherwise)

  Assets       Liabilities      

Valuation technique(s)  

 

Significant unobservable
input(s) (Level 3)

  Range    
Financial instruments held at fair value:             
Market values from derivative financial instruments:             

Interest rate derivatives

    3,324        2,211      Discounted cash flow   Swap rate (bps)     42           2,418     
        Inflation swap rate     (1)%         8%     
        Constant default rate     2%           27%     
        Constant prepayment rate     2%           21%     
      Option pricing model   Inflation volatility     0%           8%     
        Interest rate volatility     1%           101%     
        IR - IR correlation     (2)%         100%     
        Hybrid correlation     (70)%         95%     

Credit derivatives

    3,586        1,921      Discounted cash flow   Credit spread (bps)     155         9,480     
        Recovery rate     0%           100%     
      Correlation pricing model   Credit correlation     13%           96%     

Equity derivatives

    1,118        1,258      Option pricing model   Stock volatility     8%           84%     
        Index volatility     8%           99%     
        Index - index correlation     48%           98%     
        Stock - stock correlation     9%           95%     

FX derivatives

    264        242      Option pricing model   Volatility     6%           26%     

Other derivatives

    1,267        368 1    Discounted cash flow   Credit spread (bps)     44           1,500     
      Option pricing model   Index volatility     7%           138%     
        Commodity correlation     (30)%           60%     

 

 
Total market values from derivative financial instruments     9,559        6,001            

 

 

 

1 

Includes derivatives which are embedded in contracts where the host contract is held at amortized cost but for which the embedded derivative is separated.

Unrealized Gains or Losses on Level 3 Instruments held or in Issue at the Reporting Date

The unrealized gains or losses on Level 3 Instruments are not due solely to unobservable parameters. Many of the parameter inputs to the valuation of instruments in this level of the hierarchy are observable and the gain or loss is partly due to movements in these observable parameters over the period. Many of the positions in this level of the hierarchy are economically hedged by instruments which are categorized in other levels of the fair value hierarchy. The offsetting gains and losses that have been recorded on all such hedges are not included in the table below, which only shows the gains and losses related to the level 3 classified instruments themselves held at the reporting date in accordance with IFRS 13.The unrealized gains and losses on level 3 instruments are included in both net interest income and net gains on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss in the consolidated income statement.

 

in m.

   Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 2014    

Financial assets held at fair value:

    

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Trading securities

     378          617    

Positive market values from derivative financial instruments

     658          951    

Other trading assets

     42          (251)    

Financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss

     156          147     

Financial assets available for sale

     47          190     

Other financial assets at fair value

     0          0     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total financial assets held at fair value

     1,282          1,652    

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial liabilities held at fair value:

    

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Trading securities

     (0)          0     

Negative market values from derivative financial instruments

     (967)         (787)    

Other trading liabilities

     0          0     

Financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss

     (134)         (48)     

Other financial liabilities at fair value

     384          46    

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total financial liabilities held at fair value

     (717)         (789)    

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     565         864    

 

 

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
307   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Recognition of Trade Date Profit

If there are significant unobservable inputs used in a valuation technique, the financial instrument is recognized at the transaction price and any trade date profit is deferred. The table below presents the year-to-year movement of the trade date profits deferred due to significant unobservable parameters for financial instruments classified at fair value through profit or loss. The balance is predominantly related to derivative instruments.

 

in m.

   2015       2014    

Balance, beginning of year

     973          796     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

New trades during the period

     493          650     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Amortization

     (365)         (251)    

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Matured trades

     (137)         (173)    

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Subsequent move to observability

     (14)         (67)    

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Exchange rate changes

     5          18     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, end of year

     955         973     

 

 

15 –

Fair Value of Financial Instruments not carried at Fair Value

The valuation techniques used to establish fair value for the Group’s financial instruments which are not carried at fair value in the balance sheet and their respective IFRS fair value hierarchy categorization are consistent with those outlined in Note 14 “Financial Instruments carried at Fair Value”.

As described in Note 13 “Amendments to IAS 39 and IFRS 7, ‘Reclassification of Financial Assets’”, the Group reclassified certain eligible assets from the trading and available for sale classifications to loans. The Group continues to apply the relevant valuation techniques set out in Note 14 “Financial Instruments carried at Fair Value”, to the reclassified assets.

Other financial instruments not carried at fair value are not managed on a fair value basis, for example, retail loans and deposits and credit facilities extended to corporate clients. For these instruments fair values are calculated for disclosure purposes only and do not impact the balance sheet or income statement. Additionally, since the instruments generally do not trade there is significant management judgment required to determine these fair values.

Short-term financial instruments – The carrying value represents a reasonable estimate of fair value for the following financial instruments which are predominantly short-term:

 

Assets

  

Liabilities

Cash and central bank balances

   Deposits

 

  

 

Interbank balances (w/o central banks)

   Central bank funds purchased and securities sold under repurchase agreements

 

  

 

Central bank funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements    Securities loaned

 

  

 

Securities borrowed

   Other short-term borrowings

 

  

 

Other assets

   Other liabilities

 

For longer-term financial instruments within these categories, fair value is determined by discounting contractual cash flows using rates which could be earned for assets with similar remaining maturities and credit risks and, in the case of liabilities, rates at which the liabilities with similar remaining maturities could be issued, at the balance sheet date.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    308
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Loans – Fair value is determined using discounted cash flow models that incorporate parameter inputs for credit risk, interest rate risk, foreign exchange risk, loss given default estimates and amounts utilized given default, as appropriate. Credit risk, loss given default and utilization given default parameters are determined using information from the loan agreement or credit default swap markets, where available and appropriate.

For retail lending portfolios with a large number of homogenous loans (i.e., German residential mortgages), the fair value is calculated on a portfolio basis by discounting the portfolio’s contractual cash flows using own new interest rates on this type of loan. For similar retail lending portfolios outside Germany, the fair value is calculated on a portfolio basis by discounting the portfolio’s contractual cash flows using risk-free interest rates. This present value calculation is then adjusted for credit risk by discounting at the margins which could be earned on similar loans if issued at the balance sheet date. For other portfolios the present value calculation is adjusted for credit risk by calculating the expected loss over the estimated life of the loan based on various parameters including probability of default and loss given default and level of collateralization. The fair value of corporate lending portfolios is estimated by discounting a projected margin over expected maturities using parameters derived from the current market values of collateralized loan obligation (“CLO”) transactions collateralized with loan portfolios that are similar to the Group’s corporate lending portfolio.

Securities purchased under resale agreements, securities borrowed, securities sold under repurchase agreements and securities loaned – Fair value is derived from valuation techniques by discounting future cash flows using the appropriate credit risk-adjusted discount rate. The credit risk-adjusted discount rate includes consideration of the collateral received or pledged in the transaction. These products are typically short-term and highly collateralized, therefore the fair value is not significantly different to the carrying value.

Long-term debt and trust preferred securities – Fair value is determined from quoted market prices, where available. Where quoted market prices are not available, fair value is estimated using a valuation technique that discounts the remaining contractual cash at a rate at which an instrument with similar characteristics could be issued at the balance sheet date.

Estimated fair value of financial instruments not carried at fair value on the balance sheet1

     Dec 31, 2015    

in m.

   Carrying value        Fair value        Quoted  
prices in  
active market  
(Level 1)  
     Valuation  
technique  
observable  
parameters  
(Level 2)   
     Valuation  
technique  
unobservable  
parameters  
(Level  3)  
 

Financial assets:

              

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash and central bank balances

     96,940           96,940           96,940           0           0     

Interbank balances (w/o central banks)

     12,842           12,842           1,540           11,302           0     
Central bank funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements      22,456           22,456           0           22,456           0     
Securities borrowed      33,557           33,557           0           33,557           0     
Loans      427,749           426,365           0           30,040           396,325     
Other financial assets      101,901           101,868           0           101,868           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Financial liabilities:

              

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deposits

     566,974           566,652           3,638           563,014           0     
Central bank funds purchased and securities sold under repurchase agreements      9,803           9,803           0           9,803           0     
Securities loaned      3,270           3,270           0           3,270           0     
Other short-term borrowings      28,010           28,003           0           28,000           3     
Other financial liabilities      149,994           149,994           1,106           148,888           0     
Long-term debt      160,016           160,065           0           152,297           7,768     
Trust preferred securities      7,020           7,516           0           7,087           430     

 

 

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
309   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

 

     Dec 31, 2014     

in m.

   Carrying value        Fair value        Quoted  
prices in  
active market  
(Level 1)  
     Valuation  
technique  
observable  
parameters  
(Level 2)   
     Valuation  
technique  
unobservable  
parameters  
(Level  3)  
 

Financial assets:

              

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash and central bank balances

     74,482           74,482           74,482           0           0     

Interbank balances (w/o central banks)

     9,090           9,090           0           9,090           0     
Central bank funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements      17,796           17,796           0           17,796           0     

Securities borrowed

     25,834           25,834           0           25,834           0     

Loans

     405,612           410,769           0           29,786           380,983     

Other financial assets

     120,838           120,827           0           120,820           7     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Financial liabilities:

              

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deposits

     532,931           532,581           2,754           529,826           0     
Central bank funds purchased and securities sold under repurchase agreements      10,887           10,887           0           10,887           0     

Securities loaned

     2,339           2,339           0           2,339           0     

Other short-term borrowings

     42,931           42,929           0           42,825           105     

Other financial liabilities

     159,930           159,930           2,575           157,300           55     

Long-term debt

     144,837           146,215           0           135,016           11,199     

Trust preferred securities

     10,573           12,251           0           11,075           1,176     

 

 
1

Amounts generally presented on a gross basis, in line with the Group’s accounting policy regarding offsetting of financial instruments as described in Note 1 “Significant Accounting Policies and Critical Accounting Estimates”.

Loans – The difference between fair value and carrying value arose predominantly due to an increase in expected default rates and reduction in liquidity as implied from market pricing since initial recognition. These reductions in fair value are offset by an increase in fair value due to interest rate movements on fixed rate instruments.

Long-term debt and trust preferred securities – The difference between fair value and carrying value is due to the effect of changes in the rates at which the Group could issue debt with similar maturity and subordination at the balance sheet date compared to when the instrument was issued.

 

16

Financial Assets Available for Sale

 

in m.

   Dec 31, 2015        Dec 31, 2014    

Debt securities:

     

German government

     18,042         14,370   

U.S. Treasury and U.S. government agencies

     2,890         235   

U.S. local (municipal) governments

     3,103         2,777   

Other foreign governments

     34,123         31,805   

Corporates

     8,922         8,512   

Other asset-backed securities

     588         646   

Mortgage-backed securities, including obligations of U.S. federal agencies

     28         236   

Other debt securities

     570         551   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total debt securities

     68,266         59,132   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Equity securities:

     

Equity shares

     1,166         1,184   

Investment certificates and mutual funds

     75         99   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total equity securities

     1,241         1,283   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other equity interests

     974         976   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Loans

     3,102         2,906   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total financial assets available for sale

     73,583         64,297   

 

 

Please also refer to Note 7 “Net Gains (Losses) on Financial Assets Available for Sale” of this report.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    310
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

17 –

Equity Method Investments

Investments in associates and jointly controlled entities are accounted for using the equity method of accounting.

The Group holds interests in 91 (2014: 116) associates and 15 (2014: 15) jointly controlled entities. Following the reclassification of the investment Hua Xia Bank Company Limited to Held for Sale as per December 28, 2015, no other investments are material to the Group. Further information on the reclassification of Hua Xia Bank Company Limited can be found in Note 26 “Non-current Assets and Disposal Groups Held for Sale” of this report.

Aggregated financial information on the Group’s share in associates and joint ventures that are individually immaterial

 

in m.

      Dec 31, 2015            Dec 31, 2014     

Carrying amount of all associates that are individually immaterial to the Group

     1,013            999      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Aggregated amount of the Group's share of profit (loss) from continuing operations

     177            130      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Aggregated amount of the Group's share of post-tax profit (loss) from discontinued operations

     0            0      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Aggregated amount of the Group's share of other comprehensive income

     4            3      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Aggregated amount of the Group's share of total comprehensive income

     181            133      

 

 

18 –

Offsetting Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities

The Group is eligible to present certain financial assets and financial liabilities on a net basis on the balance sheet pursuant to criteria described in Note 1 “Significant Accounting Policies and Critical Accounting Estimates: Offsetting Financial Instruments”.

The following tables provide information on the impact of offsetting on the consolidated balance sheet, as well as the financial impact of netting for instruments subject to an enforceable master netting arrangement or similar agreement as well as available cash and financial instrument collateral.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
311   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Assets

 

                                        Dec 31, 2015    
 

 

 

 
                          Amounts not set off on the balance sheet            
       

 

 

   

in m.

  Gross  
amounts  
of financial  
assets  
    Gross  
amounts  
set off on the  
balance  
sheet   
    Net amounts  
of financial  
assets  
presented  
on the  
balance  
sheet  
    Impact of  
Master  

Netting  
Agreements  
    Cash  
collateral  
    Financial  
instrument  
collateral 1  
    Net amount    
Central bank funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements (enforceable)     21,309          (5,174)         16,135          0          0          (16,127)         8     
Central bank funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements (non-enforceable)     6,321          0          6,321          0          0          (5,910)         411     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Securities borrowed (enforceable)     13,956          0          13,956          0          0          (13,448)         508     
Securities borrowed (non-enforceable)     19,601          0          19,601          0          0          (18,583)         1,018     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Financial assets at fair value through profit or loss              

Trading assets

    196,478          (442)         196,035          0          (12)         (592)         195,431     

Positive market values from derivative financial instruments (enforceable)

    612,412          (113,977)         498,435          (407,171)         (55,896)         (13,218)         22,150     

Positive market values from derivative financial instruments (non-enforceable)

    17,159          0          17,159          0          0          0          17,159     

Financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss (enforceable)

    86,596          (30,801)         55,796          (2,146)         (1,167)         (44,437)         8,045     

Financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss (non-enforceable)

    53,457          0          53,457          0          0          (28,793)         24,664     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total financial assets at fair value through profit or loss     966,102          (145,219)         820,883          (409,317)         (57,075)         (87,041)         267,449     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loans

    427,768          (19)         427,749          0          (14,296)         (49,117)         364,335     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other assets

    134,742          (16,605)         118,137          (58,478)         (7)         0          59,652     

thereof: Positive market values from derivatives qualifying for hedge accounting (enforceable)

    8,272          (5,137)         3,136          (2,461)         0          0          674     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Remaining assets not subject to netting     206,348          0          206,348          0          (555)         (549)         205,245     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

    1,796,146         (167,016)         1,629,130          (467,795)          (71,933)         (190,775)         898,627     

 

 

 

1 

Excludes real estate and other non-financial instrument collateral.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    312
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Liabilities

 

                                        Dec 31, 2015    
 

 

 

 
                          Amounts not set off on the balance sheet            
       

 

 

   

in m.

  Gross  
amounts  
of financial  
liabilities  
    Gross  
amounts  

set off  
on the  
balance  
sheet  
    Net  
amounts  
of financial  
liabilities  
presented  

on the  
balance  

sheet  
    Impact of  
Master  

Netting  
Agreements  
    Cash  
collateral  
    Financial  
instrument  
collateral  
    Net amount    

Deposits

    566,993          (19)         566,974          0          0          0          566,974     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Central bank funds purchased and securities sold under repurchase agreements (enforceable)     9,089          (5,135)         3,954          0          0          (3,954)         0     
Central bank funds purchased and securities sold under repurchase agreements (non-enforceable)     5,849          0          5,849          0          0          (5,130)         719     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Securities loaned (enforceable)     1,795          0          1,795          0          0          (1,795)         0     
Securities loaned (non-enforceable)     1,475          0          1,475          0          0          (951)         524     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss              

Trading liabilities

    53,215          (910)         52,304          0          0          0          52,304     

Negative market values from derivative financial instruments (enforceable)

    588,281          (117,306)         470,975          (403,267)         (53,149)         (14,559)         0     

Negative market values from derivative financial instruments (non-enforceable)

    23,101          0          23,101          0          0          (2,867)         20,234     

Financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss (enforceable)

    50,690          (29,929)         20,761          (2,105)         0          (18,657)         0     

Financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss (non-enforceable)

    32,612          0          32,612          0          0          (11,077)         21,535     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss     747,899          (148,145)         599,754          (405,372)         (53,149)         (47,160)         94,073     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other liabilities     188,723          (13,718)         175,005          (68,626)         0          0          106,379     

thereof: Negative market values from derivatives qualifying for hedge accounting (enforceable)

    8,615          (2,250)         6,365          (6,365)         0          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Remaining liabilities not subject to netting     206,699          0          206,699          0          0          0          206,699     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

    1,728,522          (167,016)         1,561,506          (473,998)         (53,149)        (58,990)         975,368     

 

 

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
313   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Assets

 

                                        Dec 31, 2014  
 

 

 

 
                          Amounts not set off on the balance sheet            
       

 

 

   

in m.

  Gross  
amounts  
of financial  
assets  
    Gross  
amounts  
set off on the  
balance  
sheet   
    Net amounts  
of financial  
assets  
presented on the  
balance  

sheet  
    Impact of  
Master  
Netting  
Agreements  
    Cash  
collateral  
    Financial  
instrument  
collateral 1  
    Net amount    
Central bank funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements (enforceable)     17,051          (2,419)         14,632          0          0          (14,602)         29     
Central bank funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements (non-enforceable)     3,164          0          3,164          0          0          (2,386)         779     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Securities borrowed (enforceable)     11,891          0          11,891          0          0          (11,406)         485     
Securities borrowed (non-enforceable)     13,943          0          13,943          0          0          (13,294)         649     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Financial assets at fair value through profit or loss              

Trading assets

    196,157          (476)         195,681          0          (11)         (1,049)         194,621     

Positive market values from derivative financial instruments (enforceable)

    823,578          (217,158)         606,421          (519,590)         (61,518)         (15,330)         9,982     

Positive market values from derivative financial instruments (non-enforceable)

    23,537          0          23,537          0          0          0          23,537     

Financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss (enforceable)

    101,845          (37,075)         64,770          (2,782)         (1,924)         (50,245)         9,819     

Financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss (non-enforceable)

    52,516          0          52,516          0          0          (31,358)         21,158     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total financial assets at fair value through profit or loss     1,197,633          (254,708)         942,924          (522,373)         (63,453)         (97,982)         259,117     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loans

    405,673          (61)         405,612          0          (16,259)         (46,112)         343,242     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other assets

    157,771          (19,792)         137,980          (67,009)         (239)         (13)         70,720     

thereof: Positive market values from derivatives qualifying for hedge accounting (enforceable)

    10,723          (6,320)         4,403          (3,837)         0          0          566     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Remaining assets not subject to netting     178,557          0          178,557          0          (874)         (451)         177,231   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

    1,985,683          (276,980)         1,708,703          (589,381)         (80,825)         (186,246)         852,252     

 

 

 

1 

Excludes real estate and other non-financial instrument collateral.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    314
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Liabilities

 

                                        Dec 31, 2014  
 

 

 

 
                          Amounts not set off on the balance sheet            
       

 

 

   

in m.

  Gross  
amounts
of financial  
liabilities  
    Gross  
amounts  
set off on the  
balance  
sheet   
    Net amounts of  
financial  
liabilities  
presented on the  
balance  

sheet  
    Impact of  
Master  
Netting  
Agreements  
    Cash  
collateral  
    Financial  
instrument  
collateral  
    Net amount    

Deposits

    532,992          (61)         532,931          0          0          0          532,931     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Central bank funds purchased and securities sold under repurchase agreements (enforceable)     5,673          (2,419)         3,254          0          0          (2,966)         288     
Central bank funds purchased and securities sold under repurchase agreements (non-enforceable)     7,633          0          7,633          0          0          (2,278)         5,356     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Securities loaned (enforceable)     1,791          0          1,791          0          0          (1,614)         177     
Securities loaned (non-enforceable)     549          0          549          0          0          (209)         339     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss              

Trading liabilities

    42,960          (1,117)         41,843          0          0          0          41,843     

Negative market values from derivative financial instruments (enforceable)

    803,073          (217,597)         585,475          (518,364)         (63,172)         (3,939)         0     

Negative market values from derivative financial instruments (non-enforceable)

    24,726          0          24,726          0          0          (11,996)         12,731     

Financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss (enforceable)

    52,517          (35,994)         16,523          (2,782)         0          (13,741)         0     

Financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss (non-enforceable)

    29,132 1        0          29,132 1        0          (3,130)         (5,718)         20,283 1   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss     952,407 1        (254,708)         697,699 1        (521,146)         (66,302)         (35,394)         74,856 1   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other liabilities

    203,615 1          (19,792)         183,823 1        (71,645)         0          0          112,178 1   

thereof: Negative market values from derivatives qualifying for hedge accounting (enforceable)

    11,383          (6,320)         5,063          (5,063)         0          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Remaining liabilities not subject to netting     207,801          0          207,801          0          0          0          207,801     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

    1,912,461          (276,980)         1,635,481          (592,791)         (66,302)         (42,460)         933,927     

 

 

 

1 

Numbers were restated by moving  67 billion from Financial liabilities at fair value through profit and loss (non-enforceable) to Other liabilities.

The column ‘Gross amounts set off on the balance sheet’ discloses the amounts offset in accordance with all the criteria described in Note 1 “Significant Accounting Policies and Critical Accounting Estimates: Offsetting Financial Instruments”.

The column ‘Impact of Master Netting Agreements’ discloses the amounts that are subject to master netting agreements but were not offset because they did not meet the net settlement/simultaneous settlement criteria; or because the rights of set off are conditional upon the default of the counterparty only. The amounts presented for other assets and other liabilities include cash margin receivables and payables respectively.

The columns ‘Cash collateral’ and ‘Financial instrument collateral’ disclose the cash and financial instrument collateral amounts received or pledged in relation to the total amounts of assets and liabilities, including those that were not offset.

Non-enforceable master netting agreements refer to contracts executed in jurisdictions where the rights of set off may not be upheld under the local bankruptcy laws.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
315   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

The cash collateral received against the positive market values of derivatives and the cash collateral pledged towards the negative mark-to-market values of derivatives are booked within the ‘Other liabilities’ and ‘Other assets’ balances respectively.

The Cash and Financial instrument collateral amounts disclosed reflect their fair values. The rights of set off relating to the cash and financial instrument collateral are conditional upon the default of the counterparty.

19 –

Loans

Loans by industry classification

in m.

   Dec 31, 2015        Dec 31, 2014 1    

Financial intermediation

     57,047           59,586     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Manufacturing

     26,994           25,619     

thereof:

     

Basic metals and fabricated metal products

     4,082           4,348     

Electrical and optical equipment

     3,183           3,684     

Transport equipment

     3,832           3,212     

Chemicals and chemical products

     4,008           3,008     

Machinery and equipment

     2,801           2,787     

Food products

     2,374           2,514     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Households (excluding mortgages)

     45,317           44,839     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Households – mortgages

     154,689           153,140     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Public sector

     17,181           18,082     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Wholesale and retail trade

     16,837           15,714     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Commercial real estate activities

     43,093           35,764     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Lease financing

     561           1,104     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Fund management activities

     25,007           12,138     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other

     46,824           44,896     

thereof:

     

Residential real estate, leasing and related business activities

     15,013           12,506     

Transport, storage and communication

     12,014           11,317     

Mining and quarrying of energy-producing materials

     4,701           4,504     

Electricity, gas and water supply

     4,305           4,197     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Gross loans

     433,549           410,883     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

(Deferred expense)/unearned income

     772           58     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Loans less (deferred expense)/unearned income

     432,777           410,825     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Less: Allowance for loan losses

     5,028           5,212     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total loans

     427,749           405,612     

 

 

 

1 

Comparatives have been restated to reflect changes in industry sectors.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    316
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

20 –

Allowance for Credit Losses

The allowance for credit losses consists of an allowance for loan losses and an allowance for off-balance sheet positions.

Breakdown of the movements in the Group’s allowance for loan losses

    2015       2014       2013    

in m.

  Individually  
assessed  
    Collectively  
assessed  
    Total       Individually  
assessed  
    Collectively  
assessed  
    Total       Individually  
assessed  
    Collectively  
assessed  
    Total    
Allowance, beginning of year     2,364          2,849          5,212          2,857          2,732          5,589          2,266          2,426          4,692     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Provision for loan losses     334          548          882          499          631          1,129          1,377          683          2,060     
Net charge-offs:     (482)         (612)         (1,094)         (997)         (512)         (1,509)         (701)         (352)         (1,053)    

Charge-offs

    (538)         (717)         (1,255)         (1,037)         (613)         (1,650)         (730)         (485)         (1,215)    

Recoveries

    56          105          161          40          101          141          30          132          162     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other Changes     36          (8)         28          5          (2)         3          (85)         (25)         (110)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Allowance, end of year     2,252          2,776          5,028          2,364          2,849          5,212          2,857          2,732          5,589     

 

 

Activity in the Group’s allowance for off-balance sheet positions (contingent liabilities and lending commitments)

 

    2015       2014       2013    

in m.

  Individually  
assessed  
    Collectively  
assessed  
    Total       Individually  
assessed  
    Collectively  
assessed  
    Total       Individually  
assessed  
    Collectively  
assessed  
    Total    
Allowance, beginning of year     85          141          226          102          114          216          118          97          215     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Provision for off-balance sheet positions     58          16          74          (13)         18          4          (15)         21          5     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Usage     0          0          0          0          0          0          0          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other changes     1          10          11          (4)         10          6          (0)         (3)         (4)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Allowance, end of year     144          168          312          85          141          226          102          114          216     

 

 

21 –

Transfers of Financial Assets

The Group enters into transactions in which it transfers financial assets held on the balance sheet and as a result may either be eligible to derecognize the transferred asset in its entirety or must continue to recognize the transferred asset to the extent of any continuing involvement, depending on certain criteria. These criteria are discussed in Note 1 “Significant Accounting Policies and Critical Accounting Estimates”.

Where financial assets are not eligible to be derecognized, the transfers are viewed as secured financing transactions, with any consideration received resulting in a corresponding liability. The Group is not entitled to use these financial assets for any other purposes. The most common transactions of this nature entered into by the Group are repurchase agreements, securities lending agreements and total return swaps, in which the Group retains substantially all of the associated credit, equity price, interest rate and foreign exchange risks and rewards associated with the assets as well as the associated income streams.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
317   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Information on asset types and associated transactions that did not qualify for derecognition

in m.

  Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 2014  

Carrying amount of transferred assets

   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Trading securities not derecognized due to the following transactions:

   

Repurchase agreements

    26,752          23,873     

Securities lending agreements

    51,300          52,531     

Total return swaps

    2,648          3,463     

Other

    642          782     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total trading securities

    81,342          80,649     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other trading assets

    12          433     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss

    0          537     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial assets available for sale

    2,192          1,731     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loans

    536          2,225     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    84,082          85,576     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Carrying amount of associated liabilities

    52,717          57,800     

 

 

Information on assets transferred that did not qualify for derecognition where associated liability is recourse only to the transferred assets1

 

    Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 2014    

in m.

   
 
Carrying  
value  
  
  
   
 
Fair  
value  
  
  
   
 
Carrying  
value  
  
  
   
 
Fair  
value  
  
  

Trading securities

    300          300          507          507     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other trading assets

    0          0          370          370     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial assets available for sale

    1,372          1,372          1,660          1,660     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loans

    18          19          2,074          2,087     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    1,690          1,691          4,611          4,624     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Associated liability

    1,460          1,460          4,282          4,282     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net position

    230          231          329          342     

 

 

 

1 

Associated liabilities are notes issued by Consolidated Group Sponsored Securitizations.

Carrying value of assets transferred in which the Group still accounts for the asset to the extent of its continuing involvement

 

in m.

  Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 2014    

Carrying amount of the original assets transferred:

   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Trading securities

    21          254     

Loans

    96          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Carrying amount of the assets continued to be recognized:

   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Trading securities

    21          26     

Loans

    33          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Carrying amount of associated liabilities

    37          25     

 

 

The Group could retain some exposure to the future performance of a transferred asset either through new or existing contractual rights and obligations and still be eligible to derecognize the asset. This on-going involvement will be recognized as a new instrument which may be different from the original financial asset that was transferred. Typical transactions include retaining senior notes of non-consolidated securitizations to which originated loans have been transferred; financing arrangements with structured entities to which the Group has sold a portfolio of assets; or sales of assets with credit-contingent swaps. The Group’s exposure to such transactions is not considered to be significant as any substantial retention of risks associated with the transferred asset will commonly result in an initial failure to derecognize. Transactions not considered to result in an on-going involvement include normal warranties on fraudulent activities that could invalidate a transfer in the event of legal action, qualifying pass-through arrangements and standard trustee or administrative fees that are not linked to performance.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    318
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

The impact on the Group’s Balance Sheet of on-going involvement associated with transferred assets derecognized in full:

 

    Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 2014    

in m.

  Carrying  
value  
    Fair  
value  
    Maximum  
Exposure  
to Loss1  
    Carrying  
value  
    Fair  
value  
    Maximum  
Exposure  
to Loss1  
 
Loans:            

Securitization notes

    56          56          132          93          89          153     

Other

    12          12          12          12          12          12     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total Loans     68          68          144          105          101          165     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial assets held at Fair Value through the P&L:

           

Securitization notes

    134          134          134          511          511          511     

Non-standard Interest Rate, cross-currency or inflation-linked swap

    11          11          11          33          33          33     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Financial assets held at Fair Value through the P&L

    145          145          145          544          544          544     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial assets available for sale:

           

Securitization notes

    0          0          0          13          13          13     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Financial assets available for sale

    0          0          0          13          13          13     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total financial assets representing on-going involvement

    214          214          289          662          658          722     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial liabilities held at Fair Value through the P&L:

           

Non-standard Interest Rate, cross-currency or inflation-linked swap

    57          57          0          32          32          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total financial liabilities representing on-going involvement

    57          57          0          32          32          0     

 

 

 

1 

The maximum exposure to loss is defined as the carrying value plus the notional value of any undrawn loan commitments not recognized as liabilities.

The impact on the Group’s Statement of Income of on-going involvement associated with transferred assets derecognized in full:

 

     Dec 31, 2015        Dec 31, 2014    

in m.

   Year-to-  
date P&L  
     Cumulative  
P&L  
     Gain/(loss)  
on disposal  
     Year-to-  
date P&L  
     Cumulative  
P&L  
     Gain/(loss)  
on disposal  
 

Securitization notes

     86           97           0           55           171           01     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Non-standard Interest Rate, cross-currency or inflation-linked swap      119           716           0           30           671           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Net gains/(losses) recognized from on-going involvement in derecognized assets      205           813           0           85           842           0     

 

 

 

1 

Typically, sales of assets into securitization vehicles were of assets that were classified as Fair Value through P&L, therefore any gain or loss on disposal is immaterial.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
319   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

22 –

Assets Pledged and Received as Collateral

The Group pledges assets primarily for repurchase agreements, securities borrowing agreements as well as other borrowing arrangements and for margining purposes on OTC derivative liabilities. Pledges are generally conducted under terms that are usual and customary for standard securitized borrowing contracts and other transactions described.

Carrying value of the Group’s assets pledged as collateral for liabilities or contingent liabilities1

in m.

  Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 2014    

Financial assets at fair value through profit or loss

    51,904        53,699   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial assets available for sale

    3,554        3,517   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loans

    45,776        45,919   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other

    302        302   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    101,535        103,438   

 

 

 

1 

Excludes assets pledged as collateral from transactions that do not result in liabilities or contingent liabilities.

Total assets pledged to creditors available for sale or repledge1

 

in m.

  Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 2014    

Financial assets at fair value through profit or loss

    80,480          73,557     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial assets available for sale

    819          67     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loans

    347          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    81,646          73,624     

 

 
1 

Includes assets pledged as collateral from transactions that do not result in liabilities or contingent liabilities.

The Group receives collateral primarily in reverse repurchase agreements, securities lending agreements, derivatives transactions, customer margin loans and other transactions. These transactions are generally conducted under terms that are usual and customary for standard secured lending activities and the other transactions described. The Group, as the secured party, has the right to sell or repledge such collateral, subject to the Group returning equivalent securities upon completion of the transaction. This right is used primarily to cover short sales, securities loaned and securities sold under repurchase agreements.

Fair Value of collateral received

 

in m.

   Dec 31, 2015        Dec 31, 2014    

Securities and other financial assets accepted as collateral

     286,032           253,722     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

thereof:

     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

collateral sold or repledged

     238,236           203,321     

 

 
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    320
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

23 –

Property and Equipment

 

in m.

  Owner  
occupied  
properties  
    Furniture and  
equipment  
    Leasehold  
improvements  
    Construction-  
in-progress  
    Total    

Cost of acquisition:

         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as of January 1, 2014

    3,749        3,926        2,240        170        10,084   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Changes in the group of consolidated companies

    (8)        11        (1)        0        3   

Additions

    42        332        122        173        669   

Transfers

    10        26        122        (153)        5   

Reclassifications (to)/from “held for sale”

    (2,507)        (1,364)        (133)        (55)        (4,058)   

Disposals

    0        201        39        0        241   

Exchange rate changes

    275        217        68        6        566   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as of December 31, 2014

    1,560        2,947        2,379        141        7,027   

Changes in the group of consolidated companies

    8        (37)        (72)        0        (101)   

Additions

    4        153        162        114        432   

Transfers

    (2)        76        181        (129)        126   

Reclassifications (to)/from “held for sale”

    (5)        82        1        (2)        77   

Disposals

    132        267        61        0        461   

Exchange rate changes

    (1)        107        72        6        184   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as of December 31, 2015

    1,432        3,060        2,662        130        7,284   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Accumulated depreciation and impairment:

         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as of January 1, 2014

    1,525        2,762        1,378        0        5,664   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Changes in the group of consolidated companies

    0        8        (1)        0        6   

Depreciation

    39        271        179        0        490   

Impairment losses

    58        105        10        0        172   

Reversals of impairment losses

    0        0        0        0        0   

Transfers

    28        10        22        0        59   

Reclassifications (to)/from “held for sale”

    (1,289)        (1,127)        (95)        0        (2,511)   

Disposals

    2        83        34        0        119   

Exchange rate changes

    140        175        41        0        356   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as of December 31, 2014

    498        2,121        1,500        0        4,118   

Changes in the group of consolidated companies

    (1)        (31)        (64)        0        (96)   

Depreciation

    35        234        170        0        439   

Impairment losses

    6        16        3        1        27   

Reversals of impairment losses

    0        9        0        0        9   

Transfers

    (3)        21        93        (1)        109   

Reclassifications (to)/from “held for sale”

    (0)        58        7        0        65   

Disposals

    73        239        38        0        349   

Exchange rate changes

    2        86        46        (0)        134   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as of December 31, 2015

    464        2,257        1,716        0        4,438   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Carrying amount:

         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as of December 31, 2014

    1,062        826        880        141        2,909   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as of December 31, 2015

    967        802        946        130        2,846   

 

 

Impairment losses on property and equipment are recorded within general and administrative expenses for the income statement.

The carrying value of items of property and equipment on which there is a restriction on sale was  56 million as of December 31, 2015.

Commitments for the acquisition of property and equipment were  70 million at year-end 2015.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
321   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

24 –

Leases

The Group is lessee under lease arrangements covering property and equipment.

Finance Lease Commitments

Most of the Group’s finance lease arrangements are made under usual terms and conditions.

Net Carrying Value of Leasing Assets Held under finance leases

in m.

   Dec 31, 2015        Dec 31, 2014    

Land and buildings

     14           13     

Furniture and equipment

     2           1     

Other

     0           5     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net carrying value

     15           19     

 

 

Future Minimum Lease Payments Required under the Group’s Finance Leases

in m.

  Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 2014    

Future minimum lease payments:

   

Not later than one year

    6          6     

Later than one year and not later than five years

    20          24     

Later than five years

    70          84     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total future minimum lease payments

    97          114     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Less: Future interest charges

    66          71     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Present value of finance lease commitments

    30          43     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Future minimum lease payments to be received

    4          9     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Contingent rent recognized in the income statement 1

    0          0     

 

 

 

1 

The contingent rent is based on market interest rates, such as three months EURIBOR; below a certain rate the Group receives a rebate.

Operating Lease Commitments

The Group leases the majority of its offices and branches under long-term agreements. Most of the lease contracts are made under usual terms and conditions, which means they include options to extend the lease by a defined amount of time, price adjustment clauses and escalation clauses in line with general office rental market conditions. However, the lease agreements do not include any clauses that impose any restriction on the Group’s ability to pay dividends, engage in debt financing transactions or enter into further lease agreements. The Group has one significant lease contract which contains five options to extend the lease each for a period of five years and there is no purchase option in this specific lease.

Future Minimum Lease Payments Required under the Group’s Operating Leases

in m.

  Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 2014    

Future minimum rental payments:

   

Not later than one year

    773          778     

Later than one year and not later than five years

    2,398          2,370     

Later than five years

    1,999          1,955     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total future minimum rental payments

    5,170          5,103     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Less: Future minimum rentals to be received

    91          171     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net future minimum rental payments

    5,079          4,932     

 

 

As of December 31, 2015, the total future minimum rental payments included  355 million for the Group headquarters in Frankfurt am Main that was sold and leased back on December 1, 2011. The Group entered into a 181 months leaseback arrangement for the entire facility in connection with the transaction.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    322
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

In 2015, the rental payments for lease and sublease agreements amounted to  848 million. This included charges of  864 million for minimum lease payments and  9 million for contingent rents as well as  25 million related to sublease rentals received.

25 –

Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets

Goodwill

Changes in Goodwill

The changes in the carrying amount of goodwill, as well as gross amounts and accumulated impairment losses of goodwill, for the years ended December 31, 2015, and 2014, are shown below by cash-generating units (“CGU”).

Goodwill allocated to cash-generating units

 

in m.

  Corporate  
Banking &  
Securities  
    Private &  
Business  
Clients  
    Global  
Transaction  
Banking  
    Deutsche  
Asset &  
Wealth  
Management  
    Non-Core  
Operations  
Unit 1  
    Others       Total    

Balance as of January 1, 2014

    1,863          2,758          431          3,843          0          179          9,074     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Goodwill acquired during the year

    0          0          0          0          0          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Purchase accounting adjustments

    0          1          0          0          0          0          1     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Transfers

    0          0          0          0          0          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Reclassification from (to) “held for sale”     (13)         (1)         0          (3)         0          0          (17)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Goodwill related to dispositions without being classified as “held for sale”     0          0          (1)         (2)         0          0          (3)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Impairment losses 2

    0          0          0          0          0          (49)         (49)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Exchange rate changes/other

    166          5          44          293          0          4          512     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as of December 31, 2014

    2,016          2,763          474          4,131          0          134          9,518     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross amount of goodwill

    3,249          2,763          474          4,131          651          676          11,944     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Accumulated impairment losses

    (1,233)         0          0          0          (651)         (542)         (2,426)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as of January 1, 2015

    2,016          2,763          474          4,131          0          134          9,518     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Goodwill acquired during the year

    0          0          0          0          0          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Purchase accounting adjustments

    0          0          0          0          0          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Transfers

    0          0          0          0          0          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Reclassification from (to) “held for sale”     0          (1)         0          (47)         0          (138)         (186)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Goodwill related to dispositions without being classified as “held for sale”     0          0          0          (1)         0          0          (1)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Impairment losses 2

    (2,168)         (2,765)         0          0          0          0          (4,933)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Exchange rate changes/other

    152          3          45          287          0          5          492     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as of December 31, 2015

    0          0          519          4,370          0          1          4,890     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross amount of goodwill

    3,509          2,762          519          4,370          652          607          12,419     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Accumulated impairment losses

    (3,509)         (2,762)         0          0          (652)         (606)         (7,529)    

 

 

 

1 

Includes primary CGUs NCOU Wholesale Assets and NCOU Operating Assets.

2 

Impairment losses of goodwill are recorded as impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets in the income statement.

In addition to the primary CGUs, the segments CB&S and NCOU carry goodwill resulting from the acquisition of nonintegrated investments which are not allocated to the respective segments’ primary CGUs. Such goodwill is summarized as “Others” in the table above. The nonintegrated investments in the NCOU consisted of Maher Terminals LLC and Maher Terminals of Canada Corp., with the latter disposed of in the third quarter 2015.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
323   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

In 2015, changes in goodwill (other than those related to exchange rate changes) mainly included the impairments of  2,168 million in CB&S and of  2,765 million in PBC. These charges were the result of the goodwill impairment test conducted in the third quarter 2015. The test was triggered by the further substantiation of Strategy 2020 in the third quarter, largely driven by the impact of expected higher regulatory capital requirements for both segments as well as the current disposal expectations in PBC. In connection with the sale of the Canadian port operations of Maher Terminals, goodwill of  138 million was allocated to the disposal group classified as held for sale in the first quarter 2015.

In 2014, changes in goodwill (other than those related to exchange rate changes) mainly included the impairment of  49 million recorded in the NCOU upon write-off of goodwill related to the nonintegrated investment in Maher Terminals LLC (included in column ‘Others’ of the above table), which was based on the continuing market uncertainty on the demand for U.S consumables impacting business volumes. The fair value less costs of disposal of the investment was determined based on a discounted free cash flow model. Accordingly, the fair value measurement was categorized as level 3 in the fair value hierarchy. The carrying amount of Maher Terminals LLC exceeded its recoverable amount, resulting in an impairment loss of  194 million, which was recorded as impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets. Of that impairment amount,  49 million was allocated to fully write-off related goodwill and another  145 million was allocated to other intangible assets included in the CGU (see ‘Other Amortizing Intangible Assets’ in this Note). Key assumptions used in the fair value estimation included a discount rate (weighted average cost of capital, post-tax) of 9.3 % (prior year 9.1 %), a terminal value growth rate of 5.3 % and an average EBITDA growth rate of 13.2 %.

Goodwill Impairment Test

For the purposes of impairment testing, goodwill acquired in a business combination is allocated to CGUs. On the basis as described in Note 1 “Significant Accounting Policies and Critical Accounting Estimates”, the Group’s primary CGUs are as outlined above. “Other” goodwill is tested individually for impairment on the level of each of the nonintegrated investments. Goodwill is tested for impairment annually in the fourth quarter by comparing the recoverable amount of each goodwill-carrying CGU with its carrying amount. In addition, in accordance with IAS 36, the Group tests goodwill whenever a triggering event is identified. The recoverable amount is the higher of a CGU’s fair value less costs of disposal and its value in use.

The Group’s further updating of its new Strategy 2020 constituted a trigger event leading to an impairment test. The goodwill impairment test in the third quarter 2015 resulted in goodwill impairments totaling  4,933 million, consisting of  2,168 million and  2,765 million in the CGUs CB&S and PBC, respectively. The impairment in CB&S was mainly driven by changes to the business mix in light of expected higher regulatory capital requirements, leading to a recoverable amount of approximately  26.1 billion. The impairment in PBC was, in addition to the changed capital requirements, mainly driven by current disposal expectations regarding Hua Xia Bank Co. Ltd. and Postbank, which resulted in a recoverable amount of approximately  12.3 billion for the CGU.

The recoverable amounts of all remaining primary CGUs, except for those in the NCOU, were substantially in excess of their respective carrying amounts. A triggering event review as of December 31, 2015 confirmed that there was no indication that the remaining goodwill in the primary CGUs was impaired. However, the new segmental structure and the reallocation of goodwill to the new CGU structure could result in further impairments in the future.

A review of the Group’s strategy or certain political or global risks for the banking industry such as a return of the European sovereign debt crisis, uncertainties regarding the implementation of already adopted regulation and the introduction of legislation that is already under discussion as well as a slowdown of GDP growth may negatively impact the performance forecasts of certain of the Group’s CGUs and, thus, could result in an impairment of goodwill in the future.

The annual goodwill impairment test in 2014 did not result in an impairment loss on the goodwill of the Group’s primary CGUs as the recoverable amounts for these CGUs were higher than their respective carrying amounts.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    324
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Carrying Amount

The carrying amount of a primary CGU is derived using a capital allocation model. The allocation uses the Group’s total equity at the date of valuation, including Additional Tier 1 Notes (“AT1 Notes”), which constitute unsecured and subordinated notes of Deutsche Bank and which are classified as Additional equity components in accordance with IFRS. Total equity is adjusted for specific effects related to nonintegrated investments, which are tested separately for impairment as outlined above, and for an add-on adjustment for goodwill attributable to noncontrolling interests.

The carrying amount (excluding the AT1 Notes) is allocated to the primary CGUs in a two-step process, which is aligned with both the determination of the recoverable amount and the current equity allocation framework of Deutsche Bank. The two step approach works as follows: Allocation of shareholders’ equity using a solvency-based key first, until the current target of 11 % CET 1 ratio (CRR/CRD 4 calculated on a fully loaded basis) is met, and then, if applicable, incremental capital allocation to consider the leverage ratio requirements. The solvency-based allocation contains the assignment of goodwill (plus the add-on adjustment for noncontrolling interests) and unamortizing other intangible assets. Further, it comprises equity allocations based on the CGU’s relative share of risk-weighted assets, on capital deduction items as well as on regulatory reconciliation items. In the second step, if applicable, the CGUs receive equity allocations based on their pro-rata leverage ratio exposure measure relative to the Group. Additionally, noncontrolling interests are considered in the carrying amounts of the respective primary CGUs.The AT1 Notes are allocated to the primary CGUs in proportion to their specific leverage ratio shortfall, with leverage ratio shortfall being a function of the Group’s target leverage ratio, the CGU’s leverage ratio exposure measure and the allocated CET 1 capital.

The carrying amount for nonintegrated investments is determined on the basis of their respective equity.

Recoverable Amount

The Group determines the recoverable amounts of its primary CGUs on the basis of fair value less costs of disposal (level 3 of the fair value hierarchy) and employs a discounted cash flow (DCF) model, which reflects the specifics of the banking business and its regulatory environment. The model calculates the present value of the estimated future earnings that are distributable to shareholders after fulfilling the respective regulatory capital requirements. The recoverable amounts also include the fair value of the AT1 Notes, allocated to the primary CGUs consistent to their treatment in the carrying amount. The recoverable amounts of the CGUs derived from the DCF models have been compared to external analyst valuations and are deemed to be within a plausible range.

The DCF model uses earnings projections and respective capitalization assumptions (with capital ratios increasing from current levels to a Common Equity Tier 1 capital ratio of 12.5 % and a leverage ratio (using a fully loaded definition of Tier 1 capital) of 5.0 % in the medium term) based on five-year financial plans agreed by management, which are discounted to their present value. Estimating future earnings and capital requirements involves judgment and the consideration of past and current performances as well as expected developments in the respective markets, and in the overall macroeconomic and regulatory environments. Earnings projections beyond the initial five-year period are, where applicable, adjusted to derive a sustainable level. In case of a going concern, the cash flow to equity is assumed to increase by or converge towards a constant long-term growth rate of up to 3.2 % (2014: 3.2 %). This is based on projected revenue forecasts of the CGUs as well as expectations for the development of gross domestic product and inflation, and is captured in the terminal value.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
325   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Key Assumptions

The DCF value of a CGU is sensitive to the earnings projections, to the discount rate (cost of equity) applied and, to a much lesser extent, to the long-term growth rate. The discount rates applied have been determined based on the capital asset pricing model and comprise a risk-free interest rate, a market risk premium and a factor covering the systematic market risk (beta factor). The values for the risk-free interest rate, the market risk premium and the beta factors are determined using external sources of information. CGU-specific beta factors are determined based on a respective group of peer companies. Variations in all of these components might impact the calculation of the discount rates.

Primary cash-generating units

 

    Discount rate (post-tax)    

 

  2015       2014    

Corporate Banking & Securities

    9.7%          10.3%     

Private & Business Clients

    9.2%          10.0%     

Global Transaction Banking

    8.1%          8.5%     

Deutsche Asset & Wealth Management

                     9.1%                          9.5%     

 

 

Management determined the values for the key assumptions in the following table based on a combination of internal and external analysis. Estimates for efficiency and the cost reduction program are based on progress made to date and scheduled future projects and initiatives.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    326
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Primary goodwill-carrying

cash-generating unit

 

Description of key assumptions

 

Uncertainty associated with key assumptions
and potential events/circumstances that could
have a negative effect

Corporate Banking & Securities  

-    Client-driven franchise offering a wide suite of investment banking products in debt and equity, as well as corporate finance advisory and origination businesses

-    Focus on clients with higher potential to deliver true relationship value

-    Modest economic recovery in Europe while Americas returns to solid recovery path accompanied by a gradual tightening of monetary policy

-    Debt Sales & Trading revenue pools are expected to increase slightly as monetary policy normalises and volatility increases while Equities and Corporate Finance revenue pools are expected to remain broadly flat going forward

-    Mitigate regulatory driven RWA increases through business exits and portfolio management

-    Reduce overall capital consumption while re-investing to enhance returns

-    Cost efficiencies driven by portfolio measures, revised platform size and regional footprint review

 

-    Market environment remains challenged

-    Structure and content of a range of regulatory changes being drafted in various jurisdictions could have a more severe impact than anticipated

-    Strategic portfolio optimisation may not generate expected revenue growth and resource optimisation may have more than expected impact on revenues

-    Potential margin compression and increased competition in products with lower capital requirements beyond expected levels

-    Outcome of major litigation cases

-    Decline in costs expected from strategic portfolio optimization, country exits and efficiency saves does not materialize in the plan time frame

-    Increase cost pressures from regulatory driven spend

-    Structural risks associated with unforeseen regulatory hurdles, additional costs for CCAR compliance and setting up IHC in the U.S. as well as more stringent than expected banking separation rules in some jurisdictions

 

 

 

 

 

Private & Business Clients  

-    Leading position in home market Germany with strongholds in five other attractive European markets

-    Deconsolidation of Postbank

-    Improvement of digital capabilities as key initiative in PBC as well as reorganization and optimization of branch network

-    Reduced complexity and competitive cost efficiency

-    Expanding in investment and insurance business in advisory banking partially mitigating impacts from low interest rate environment and leverage constraints and rebalancing of Credit Products

 

-    Severe economic decline potentially resulting in higher unemployment rates, increasing credit loss provisions and lower business growth

-    Development of investment product markets and respective revenues additionally depend on customer confidence for investments

-    Continued low interest rates potentially leading to further margin compression

-    Efficiency programs are not executed as planned

-    An environment of tightening regulation leading to further not yet anticipated impact on revenues and costs

 

 

 

 

 

Global Transaction Banking  

-    Cost savings in light of product, country and client perimeter review

-    Capitalize on synergies resulting from closer co-operation with other areas of the bank

-    Macroeconomic recovery leading to gradual interest rate improvements and positive development of international trade volumes, cross-border payments and corporate actions

-    Deepening relationships with Complex Corporates and Institutional Clients in existing regions while pushing further growth in Emerging Markets

 

-    Slower recovery of the world economy and its impact on trade volumes, interest rates and foreign exchange rates

-    Unfavorable margin development and adverse competition levels in key markets and products beyond expected levels

-    Uncertainty around regulation and its potential implications not yet anticipated

-    Cost savings in light of product, country and client perimeter review do not materialize as anticipated

-    Outcome of potential legal matters

 

 

 

 

 

Deutsche Asset & Wealth Management  

-    Strategy continuously informed by market trends and developments, including global wealth creation, a growing retirement market and the rapid expansion of alternatives and passive investment offerings

-    Expanding business with ultra high net worth clients with strong coverage in developed and emerging markets

-    Building out the alternatives, passive/ETF & lending businesses

-    Home market leadership in Germany through Wealth Management and DWS

-    Organic growth strategy in Asia/Pacific and Americas

-    Maintained or increased market share in the fragmented competitive environment

-    Cost savings in light of Deutsche AWM platform optimization

-    Targeted investment in platform enhancements and digital capabilities

 

-    Major industry threats, i.e., market volatility, sovereign debt burden, increasing costs from regulatory changes

-    Investors continue to hold assets out of the markets, retreat to cash or simpler, lower fee products

-    Business/execution risks, i.e., under achievement of net new money targets from market uncertainty, loss of high quality relationship managers

-    Difficulties in executing organic growth strategies through certain restrictions, e.g. unable to hire relationship managers

-    Cost savings following efficiency gains and expected IT/process improvements are not achieved to the extent planned

-    Uncertainty around regulation and its potential implications not yet anticipated

 

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
327   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Other Intangible Assets

The changes of other intangible assets by asset classes for the years ended December 31, 2015, and 2014, are as follows.

 

    Purchased intangible assets      Internally 
generated 
intangible 
assets 
    Total 
other 
intangible 
assets 
 
    Unamortized      Amortized      Amortized     

 

 

in m.

  Retail 
investment 
management 
agreements 
    Other      Total 
unamortized 
purchased 
intangible 
assets 
    Customer- 
related 
intangible 
assets 
    Value of 
business 
acquired 
    Contract-
based 
intangible 
assets 
    Software 
and 
other 
    Total 
amortized 
purchased 
intangible 
assets 
    Software     

 

 
Cost of acquisition/
manufacture:
                   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Balance as of January 1, 2014     840         441         1,281         1,449         830         661         935         3,875         2,776         7,932    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Additions                          40                       52         92         962         1,054    
Changes in the group of consolidated companies                                        (14)        (2)        (16)        (0)        (16)   
Disposals                                               12         21         99         121    
Reclassifications from (to) “held for sale”                                                      (0)               (0)   
Transfers                          (3)               (1)        17         13         (26)        (13)   
Exchange rate changes     111                112         53         58         74         34         219         101         432    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Balance as of December 31, 2014     951         441         1,392         1,529         888         720         1,025         4,162         3,715         9,269    
Additions                          26                       21         47         1,217         1,265    
Changes in the group of consolidated companies            (3)        (3)                             (1)        (1)        (3)        (7)   
Disposals                                                             193         193    
Reclassifications from (to) “held for sale”                          (42)                      (13)         (55)               (55)   
Transfers                                               42         42         (11)        31    
Exchange rate changes     110                112         45         53         75         39         212         121         446    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Balance as of December 31, 2015     1,061         440         1,501         1,559         941         795         1,112         4,407         4,846         10,755    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Accumulated amortization and impairment:                    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Balance as of January 1, 2014     287                289         836         194         180         667         1,877         909         3,075    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Amortization for the year                          99         35         35         78         247         335         582 1    
Changes in the group of consolidated companies                                        (6)        (2)        (8)        (1)        (9)   
Disposals                                               12         20         97         117    
Reclassifications from (to) “held for sale”                                                      (0)               (0)   
Impairment losses                                        117         29         146         48         195 2    
Reversals of impairment losses     84                84                                                   84 3    
Transfers                                 (1)        (0)                      (7)        (4)   
Exchange rate changes     37                38         49         15         17         18         99         63         200    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Balance as of December 31, 2014     240                243         976         243         343         781         2,343         1,248         3,835    
Amortization for the year                          87         44         36         45         212         499         710 4    
Changes in the group of consolidated companies            (3)        (3)                             (1)        (1)        (3)        (7)   
Disposals                                               (1)        (1)        190         189    
Reclassifications from (to) “held for sale”                          (25)                      (4)        (29)               (29)   
Impairment losses            416         416         397                14         16         427         191         1,034 5    
Reversals of impairment losses                                                                      
Transfers                          (0)        (1)               28         27         (24)          
Exchange rate changes     28                30         41         14         35         29         119         61         209    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Balance as of December 31, 2015     268         418         686         1,476         300         429         893         3,098         1,782         5,566    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Carrying amount:                    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
As of December 31, 2014     711         438         1,149         553         645         377         243         1,818         2,466         5,433    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
As of December 31, 2015     793         22         815         83         641         367         218         1,309         3,064         5,188    

 

 

 

1 

The  582 million were included in general and administrative expenses.

2 

Of which  146 million were included in impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets, consisting of impairments of contract-based intangible assets ( 117 million) and trade names ( 29 million). Furthermore,  48 million of impairments related to self-developed software, which were recorded in general and administrative expenses.

3 

 84 million were recorded as reversal of a prior year’s impairment and are included under impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets.

4 

The  710 million were included in general and administrative expenses.

5 

Of which  843 million were included in impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets, consisting of impairments of unamortized trademark intangible assets ( 416 million) as well as amortized customer-related ( 397 million), contract-based ( 14 million) and trademark ( 16 million) intangible assets. Furthermore,  191 million of impairments related to self-developed software, which were recorded in general and administrative expenses.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    328
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Amortizing Intangible Assets

During 2015, the main changes in amortizing other intangible assets included additions to internally generated intangible assets of 1.2 billion, which represent the capitalization of expenses incurred in conjunction with the Group’s activities related to the development of own-used software. On the other hand and as a result of the reassessment of current platform software as well as software under construction, the Group recorded impairments of self-developed software of 191 million. On April 27, 2015, Deutsche Bank announced its new strategic roadmap, in which the sale of Postbank is an integral part. The Group’s further updating of its new Strategy 2020 constituted a triggering event upon which goodwill and all other non-financial assets included in the CGU PBC had to be tested for impairment. The valuation performed in the third quarter 2015 on the new strategic plan resulted in an impairment of the CGU PBC. After allocation of the impairment to fully write-off the PBC goodwill ( 2.8 billion), an impairment loss of  837 million related to other intangible assets within the CGU PBC was recognized, reflecting the change in strategic intent and the expected deconsolidation of Postbank. The impairment is based on a fair value less costs of disposal model (Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy). Of that impairment amount,  427 million are related to amortizing intangible assets, mainly comprising write-offs of customer-related intangible assets ( 397 million), BHW trademark intangibles ( 16 million) and contract-based intangible assets ( 14 million). The remainder was allocated to write-off the unamortizing Postbank trademark intangible asset ( 410 million; see below).

In 2014, additions to internally generated intangible assets were  962 million, which represent the capitalization of expenses incurred in conjunction with the Group’s activities related to the development of own-used software. Impairments of  146 million recorded on purchased other intangible assets were largely attributable to Maher Terminals LLC (NCOU; thereof  116 million on lease rights (‘contract-based’) and  29 million on trade mark (‘software and others’)), following the continued negative outlook for container and business volumes (please refer to ‘Changes in Goodwill’ in this Note for additional information on the valuation result of Maher Terminals LLC). The impairment of self-developed software of  48 million was largely a result of the reassessment of current platform software under the OpEx Program.

Changes in amortizing other intangible assets recognized during 2013 mainly included additions of  663 million to internally generated intangible assets. Impairments of  83 million recorded on purchased other intangible assets were largely attributable to the commercial banking activities in the Netherlands (GTB), which had seen similar charges already in 2012. The impairment on self-developed software of  43 million was largely a result of the reassessment of current platform software under the OpEx Program.

Other intangible assets with finite useful lives are generally amortized over their useful lives based on the straight-line method (except for the VOBA, as explained in Note 41 “Insurance and Investment Contracts”).

Useful lives of other amortized intangible assets by asset class

 

   Useful lives in
years  
 

Internally generated intangible assets:

  

Software

     up to 10     

 

  

 

 

 

Purchased intangible assets:

  

Customer-related intangible assets

     up to 20     

Contract-based intangible assets

     up to 23     

Value of business acquired

     up to 30     

Other

     up to 80     

 

 

Unamortized Intangible Assets

Within this asset class, the Group recognizes certain contract-based and marketing-related intangible assets, which are deemed to have an indefinite useful life.

In particular, the asset class comprises the below detailed investment management agreements related to retail mutual funds and certain trademarks. Due to the specific nature of these intangible assets, market prices are ordinarily not observable and, therefore, the Group values such assets based on the income approach, using a post-tax DCF-methodology.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
329   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Retail investment management agreements: These assets, amounting to  793 million, relate to the Group’s U.S. retail mutual fund business and are allocated to the Deutsche AWM CGU. Retail investment management agreements are contracts that give DWS Investments the exclusive right to manage a variety of mutual funds for a specified period. Since these contracts are easily renewable, the cost of renewal is minimal, and they have a long history of renewal, these agreements are not expected to have a foreseeable limit on the contract period. Therefore, the rights to manage the associated assets under management are expected to generate cash flows for an indefinite period of time. This intangible asset was recorded at fair value based upon a valuation provided by a third party at the date of the Group’s acquisition of Zurich Scudder Investments, Inc. in 2002.

The recoverable amount of the asset of  793 million was calculated as fair value less costs of disposal using the multi-period excess earnings method and the fair value measurement was categorized as level 3 in the fair value hierarchy. The key assumptions in determining the fair value less costs of disposal include the asset mix, the flows forecast and the effective fee rate. The discount rates (cost of equity) applied in the calculation were 11.0 % in 2015 and 10.7 % in 2014. For 2015, the review of the valuation neither resulted in any impairment nor a reversal of prior impairments. In 2014, a reversal of impairment of  84 million was recognized and recorded in impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets in the income statement, mainly due to a positive flows forecast on the back of a strengthening franchise, a favorable asset mix and a decrease in the discount rate. In 2013, neither an impairment nor write-up was recorded, as the valuation remained steady to prior year.

Trademarks: The other unamortized intangible assets include the Postbank (allocated to CGU PBC) and the Sal. Oppenheim (allocated to CGU Deutsche AWM) trademarks, which were acquired in 2010. The Postbank trademark was initially recognized in 2010 at  382 million. In finalizing the purchase price allocation in 2011, the fair value of the Postbank trademark increased to  410 million. The Sal. Oppenheim trademark was recognized at  27 million. Since both trademarks were expected to generate cash flows for an indefinite period of time, they were classified as unamortized intangible assets. Both trademarks were recorded at fair value at the acquisition date, based on third party valuations. The recoverable amounts were calculated as the fair value less costs of disposal of the trademarks based on the income approach using the relief-from-royalty method. Reflecting the change in strategic intent and the expected deconsolidation of Postbank, the Postbank trademark ( 410 million) was fully written off in the third quarter 2015. Following a review of the valuation model for the Sal. Oppenheim trademark, a write-down of  6 million was recorded in the fourth quarter 2015.

26 –

Non-Current Assets and Disposal Groups Held for Sale

Within the balance sheet, non-current assets and disposal groups held for sale are included in other assets and other liabilities.

 

in m.

  Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 2014    
Cash, due and deposits from banks, Central bank funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements     0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Trading assets, Derivatives, Financial assets designated at fair value through P&L

    0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial assets available for sale

    0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loans

    28          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Property and equipment

    43          142     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other assets

    3,420          38     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets classified as held for sale

    3,491          180     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 
   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Deposits, Central bank funds purchased and securities sold under resale agreements

    0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Trading liabilities, Derivatives, Financial liabilities designated at fair value through P&L

    0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Long-term debt

    0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other liabilities

    37          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities classified as held for sale

    37          0     

 

 
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    330
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

As of December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, unrealized net gains of 662 million and 0 million, respectively, relating to non-current assets classified as held for sale were recognized directly in accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) (net of tax).

Non-Current Assets and Disposal Groups Held for Sale as of December 31, 2015

In line with the Bank’s strategic intent and by further progressing on the execution of Strategy 2020, Deutsche Bank announced on December 28, 2015 that it has agreed to sell its entire 19.99 % stake in Hua Xia Bank Company Limited (“Hua Xia”) to PICC Property and Casualty Company Limited for a consideration of RMB 23.0 billion to RMB 25.7 billion. The sale is subject to final price adjustments at closing (approximately  3.2 billion to  3.7 billion, based on December 2015 exchange rates). Accordingly, the investment of  3.3 billion, which is held in the PBC corporate division, was reclassified to the held-for-sale category at year-end 2015. Prior to its reclassification, Hua Xia had been accounted for as an associate under the equity method of accounting. The revaluation of the equity method investment to its fair value (quoted market price less costs of disposal in an active market (level 1)) resulted in a partial reversal of  162 million from the initial impairment amount of  649 million recorded during the third quarter 2015. Accordingly, the net impairment of  487 million was recorded in PBC and reported under net income (loss) from equity method investments. The agreement to sell the stake in Hua Xia combined with the share price development resulted in an overall net loss of  697 million in total.

The reclassification of the investment to the held-for-sale category did not result in an impairment of the non-current asset. Along with the held-for-sale classification, accumulated other comprehensive income of  662 million related to the investment has been reclassified within equity to unrealized net gains (losses) on assets classified as held for sale. The completion of the transaction, which is anticipated in the mid-year 2016, is subject to customary closing conditions and regulatory approvals, including that of the China Banking Regulatory Commission.

Also in the fourth quarter 2015 and in line with the Bank’s agenda to focus on strategic priorities, the Group announced that it has entered into a definitive asset purchase agreement to sell its U.S. Private Client Services unit (“PCS”) of Deutsche AWM to Raymond James Financial, Inc. The reclassification of the PCS business to the held-for-sale category did not result in an impairment loss of the disposal group. The transaction is expected to close in the third quarter 2016.

In the first quarter 2015, the Group had classified its investment in the Fairview Container Terminal in Port of Prince Rupert, Canada, which is a segment of Maher Terminals, a multi-user container terminal operator, as a disposal group held for sale within the Corporate Division Non-Core Operations Unit. Under the disposal transaction, DP World, a Dubai-based marine terminal operator, agreed to acquire 100 % of the Fairview Container Terminal for a consideration of  391 million (CAD 580 million). Its classification as a disposal group held for sale did not result in an impairment loss. The sale was completed in the third quarter 2015.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
331   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Disposals in 2015

 

Division

  

Disposal

  

Financial impact1

  

Date of the disposal

Infrastructure

   Piecemeal sale of parts of the Group’s wholesale banking information technology (IT) infrastructure to Hewlett Packard.    None in 2015.    Second quarter 2015

 

1 

Impairment losses and reversals of impairment losses are included in Other income.

Non-Current Assets and Disposal Groups Held for Sale as of December 31, 2014

 

Division

  

Non-current assets and disposal
groups held for sale

  

Financial impact1

  

Additional information

Infrastructure

   Designated sale of parts of the Group’s wholesale banking information technology (IT) infrastructure to Hewlett Packard.    An impairment loss of  11 million recorded in the fourth quarter 2014.    Second quarter 2015

 

1 

Impairment losses and reversals of impairment losses are included in Other income.

Disposals in 2014

 

Division

  

Disposal

  

Financial impact1

  

Date of the disposal

Non-Core Operations Unit

   Sale of Nevada Property 1 LLC, a wholly owned subsidiary and owner of The Cosmopolitan of Las Vegas (“The Cosmopolitan”), a leading resort and casino, to Blackstone. Under the transaction, Blackstone acquired 100 % of The Cosmopolitan for a cash consideration of approximately 1.4 billion (U.S.$ 1.73 billion).    An impairment loss of  9 million recorded in the fourth quarter 2014.    Fourth quarter 2014

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

Deutsche Asset & Wealth Management    Sale of part of the Group’s Wealth Management business in the UK.    An impairment loss of 9 million recorded in the first quarter 2014.    Third quarter 2014

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

Private & Business Clients    Office building previously held as property and equipment.    None.    Second quarter 2014

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

Non-Core Operations Unit

   Sale of the Group’s subsidiary BHF-BANK AG to Kleinwort Benson Group and RHJ International (“RHJI”), following receipt of outstanding regulatory approvals. The Group received total consideration subject to closing purchase price adjustments of 340 million, comprised of 309 million in cash and 31 million in RHJI shares issued at par value.    None.    First quarter 2014

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

Non-Core Operations Unit    Sale of office buildings previously held as investment property within other assets.    None.    First quarter 2014

 

1 

Impairment losses and reversals of impairment losses are included in Other income.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    332
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

27 –

Other Assets and Other Liabilities

 

in m.

  Dec 31, 2015     Dec 31, 2014  

Other assets:

   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Brokerage and securities related receivables

   

Cash/margin receivables

    60,421        65,096   

Receivables from prime brokerage

    10,575        10,785   

Pending securities transactions past settlement date

    4,221        4,741   

Receivables from unsettled regular way trades

    19,722        34,432   

Total brokerage and securities related receivables

    94,939        115,054   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Accrued interest receivable

    2,649        2,791   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Assets held for sale

    3,491        180   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other

    17,058        19,955   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other assets

    118,137        137,980   

 

 

 

in m.

  Dec 31, 2015     Dec 31, 2014  

Other liabilities:

   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Brokerage and securities related payables

   

Cash/margin payables

    71,161        70,558   

Payables from prime brokerage

    40,854        33,985   

Pending securities transactions past settlement date

    3,847        3,473   

Payables from unsettled regular way trades

    18,776        35,195   

Total brokerage and securities related payables

    134,637        143,210   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Accrued interest payable

    2,607        2,953   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Liabilities held for sale

    37        0   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other

    37,725        37,659   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other liabilities

    175,005        183,823   

 

 

For further details on the assets and liabilities held for sale please refer to Note 26 “Non-Current Assets and Disposal Groups Held for Sale”.

28 –

Deposits

 

in m.

   Dec 31, 2015      Dec 31, 2014  

Noninterest-bearing demand deposits

     192,010         160,733   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Interest-bearing deposits

     

Demand deposits

     153,559         144,172 1 

Time deposits

     124,196         124,347   

Savings deposits

     97,210         103,679 1 

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total interest-bearing deposits

     374,964         372,198   

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total deposits

     566,974         532,931   

 

 
1 

Prior year numbers have been restated. Certain types of deposits were shifted from saving deposits to demand deposits, as they did not meet the characteristics of saving deposits.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
333   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

29 –

Provisions

Movements by Class of Provisions

 

in m.

  Home Savings
Business
    Operational
Risk
    Civil
Litigations
    Regulatory
Enforcement
    Restructuring     Mortgage
Repurchase
Demands
    Other1     Total  

Balance as of January 1, 2014

    1,011          256          723          1,126          207          345          639          4,307     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Changes in the group of consolidated companies

    0          0          0          0          0          0          (0)          0     

New provisions

    211          303          337          1,409          154          411          609          3,434     

Amounts used

    104          50          257          0          195          45          194          845     

Unused amounts reversed

    3          110          59          150          52          88          189          651     

Effects from exchange rate fluctuations/ Unwind of discount

    35          23          17          63          6          46          14          204     

Transfers

    0          0          0          0          0          0          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as of December 31, 2014

    1,150          422          761          2,448          120          669          880          6,450     

Changes in the group of consolidated companies

    0          0          0          0          0          0          2          2     

New provisions

    316          170          1,296          4,067          688          16          915          7,468     

Amounts used

    301          17          562          2,504          118          123          554          4,179     

Unused amounts reversed

    1          289          112          69          40          231          380          1,121     

Effects from exchange rate fluctuations/ Unwind of discount

    (32)          18          38          119          1          78          39          261     

Transfers

    0          12          (4)          (13)          4          0          21          20     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance as of December 31, 2015

    1,132          315          1,418          4,048          656          409          922          8,900     

 

 
1 

For the remaining portion of provisions as disclosed on the consolidated balance sheet, please see Note 20 “Allowance for Credit Losses”, in which allowances for credit related off-balance sheet positions are disclosed.

Classes of Provisions

Home Savings provisions arise out of the home savings business of Deutsche Postbank Group and Deutsche Bank Bauspar-Aktiengesellschaft. In home savings, a customer enters into a building loan agreement, whereby the customer becomes entitled to borrow on a building loan once the customer has on deposit with the lending bank a targeted amount of money. In connection with the building loan agreement, arrangement fees are charged and interest is paid on deposited amounts at a rate that is typically lower than that paid on other bank deposits. In the event the customer determines not to make the borrowing, the customer becomes entitled to a retroactive interest bonus, reflecting the difference between the low contract savings interest rate and a fixed interest rate, currently substantially above market rate. The home savings provision relates to the potential interest bonus and arrangement fee reimbursement liability. The model for the calculation of the potential interest bonus liability includes parameters for the percentage of customer base impacted, applicable bonus rate, customer status and timing of payment. Other factors impacting the provision are available statistical data relating to customer behavior and the general environment likely to affect the business in the future.

Operational provisions arise out of operational risk and exclude civil litigation and regulatory enforcement provisions, which are presented as separate classes of provisions. In the 2014 Financial Report, operational, civil litigation and regulatory enforcement provisions were presented in a single class of provisions entitled “Operational/Litigation”.

Operational risk is the risk of loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes, people and systems, or from external events. The definition used for the purposes of determining operational provisions differs from the risk management definition, as it excludes risk of loss resulting from civil litigations or regulatory enforcement matters. For risk management purposes, operational risk includes legal risk, as payments to customers, counterparties and regulatory bodies in civil litigations or regulatory enforcement matters constitute loss events for operational shortcomings, but excludes business and reputational risk.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    334
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Civil Litigation provisions arise out of current or potential claims or proceedings alleging non-compliance with contractual or other legal or regulatory responsibilities, which have resulted or may result in demands from customers, counterparties or other parties in civil litigations.

Regulatory Enforcement provisions arise out of current or potential claims or proceedings alleging non-compliance with legal or regulatory responsibilities, which have resulted or may result in an assessment of fines or penalties by governmental regulatory agencies, self regulatory organizations or other enforcement authorities.

Restructuring provisions arise out of restructuring activities. The Group aims to enhance its long-term competitiveness through major reductions in costs, duplication and complexity in the years ahead. For details see Note 10 “Restructuring”.

Mortgage Repurchase Demands provisions arise out of Deutsche Bank’s U.S. residential mortgage loan business. From 2005 through 2008, as part of Deutsche Bank’s U.S. residential mortgage loan business, Deutsche Bank sold approximately U.S.$ 84 billion of private label securities and U.S.$ 71 billion of loans through whole loan sales. Deutsche Bank has been presented with demands to repurchase loans from or to indemnify purchasers, investors or financial insurers with respect to losses allegedly caused by material breaches of representations and warranties. Deutsche Bank’s general practice is to process valid repurchase demands that are presented in compliance with contractual rights.

As of December 31, 2015, Deutsche Bank has approximately U.S.$ 2.4 billion of mortgage repurchase demands outstanding and not subject to agreements to rescind (based on original principal balance of the loans). These demands consist primarily of demands made in respect of private label securitizations by the trustees or servicers thereof. Against these outstanding demands, Deutsche Bank recorded provisions of U.S.$ 445 million ( 409 million) as of December 31, 2015. Deutsche Bank is the beneficiary of indemnity agreements from the originators or sellers of certain of the mortgage loans subject to these demands, with respect to which Deutsche Bank has recognized receivables of U.S.$ 109 million ( 100 million) as of December 31, 2015. The net provisions against these demands following deduction of such receivables were U.S.$ 336 million ( 308 million) as of December 31, 2015.

As of December 31, 2015, Deutsche Bank has completed repurchases, obtained agreements to rescind, settled or rejected as untimely claims on loans with an original principal balance of approximately U.S.$ 7.2 billion. In connection with those repurchases, agreements and settlements, Deutsche Bank has obtained releases for potential claims on approximately U.S.$ 93.0 billion of loans sold by Deutsche Bank as described above.

Deutsche Bank has entered into agreements with certain entities that have threatened to assert mortgage loan repurchase demands against Deutsche Bank to toll the relevant statutes of limitations. It is possible that these potential demands may have a material impact on Deutsche Bank.

Deutsche Bank anticipates that additional mortgage repurchase demands may be made in respect of mortgage loans that it has sold, but cannot reliably estimate their timing or amount. On June 11, 2015, the New York Court of Appeals issued a ruling affirming dismissal of mortgage repurchase claims asserted in litigation relating to a residential mortgage-backed security issued by Deutsche Bank on the grounds that the action was not timely commenced. This decision could impact the extent to which future repurchase demands are made to Deutsche Bank and the likelihood of success of any such claims. Deutsche Bank did not act as servicer for the loans sold to third parties as whole loans (which constitute almost half of all U.S. residential mortgage loans sold from 2005 through 2008) and, once sold, Deutsche Bank ceased to have access to information about their performance. While loan performance is publicly available on the mortgage loans that Deutsche Bank securitized, no direct correlation has been observed between their performance and repurchase demands received. Demands have been received on loans that have defaulted, as well as loans that are current and loans that have been repaid in full.

Other provisions include several specific items arising from a variety of different circumstances, including the provision for the reimbursement of loan processing fees, deferred sales commissions, provisions for bank levies and a provision under the credit card business cooperation of Deutsche Bank and Hua Xia Bank Co. Ltd.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
335   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Provisions and Contingent Liabilities

The Group recognizes a provision for potential loss only when there is a present obligation arising from a past event that is probable to result in an economic outflow that can be reliably estimated. Where a reliable estimate cannot be made for such an obligation, no provision is recognized and the obligation is deemed a contingent liability. Contingent liabilities also include possible obligations for which the possibility of future economic outflow is more than remote but less than probable. Where a provision has been taken for a particular claim, no contingent liability is recorded; for matters or sets of matters consisting of more than one claim, however, provisions may be recorded for some claims, and contingent liabilities (or neither a provision nor a contingent liability) may be recorded for others.

The Group operates in a legal and regulatory environment that exposes it to significant litigation risks. As a result, the Group is involved in litigation, arbitration and regulatory proceedings and investigations in Germany and in a number of jurisdictions outside Germany, including the United States. In recent years, regulation and supervision in a number of areas have increased, and regulators, governmental bodies and others have sought to subject financial services providers to increasing oversight and scrutiny, which in turn has led to additional regulatory investigations and enforcement actions which are often followed by civil litigation. This trend has accelerated markedly as a result of the global financial crisis and the European sovereign debt crisis.

In determining for which of the claims the possibility of a loss is probable, or less than probable but more than remote, and then estimating the possible loss for those claims, the Group takes into consideration a number of factors, including but not limited to the nature of the claim and its underlying facts, the procedural posture and litigation history of each case, rulings by the courts or tribunals, the Group’s experience and the experience of others in similar cases (to the extent this is known to the Group), prior settlement discussions, settlements by others in similar cases (to the extent this is known to the Group), available indemnities and the opinions and views of legal counsel and other experts.

The provisions the Group has recognized for civil litigation and regulatory enforcement matters as of December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014 are set forth in the table above. For some matters for which the Group believes an outflow of funds is probable, no provisions were recognized as the Group could not reliably estimate the amount of the potential outflow.

For the matters for which a reliable estimate can be made, the Group currently estimates that, as of December 31, 2015, the aggregate future loss of which the possibility is more than remote but less than probable is approximately  1.4 billion for civil litigation matters (December 31, 2014:  1.2 billion) and 1.0 billion for regulatory enforcement matters (December 31, 2014: 0.8 billion). These figures include matters where the Group’s potential liability is joint and several and where the Group expects any such liability to be paid by a third party. For other significant civil litigation and regulatory enforcement matters, the Group believes the possibility of an outflow of funds is more than remote but less than probable but the amount is not reliably estimable, and accordingly such matters are not included in the contingent liability estimates. For still other significant civil litigation and regulatory enforcement matters, the Group believes the possibility of an outflow of funds is remote and therefore has neither recognized a provision nor included them in the contingent liability estimates.

This estimated possible loss, as well as any provisions taken, is based upon currently available information and is subject to significant judgment and a variety of assumptions, variables and known and unknown uncertainties. These uncertainties may include inaccuracies in or incompleteness of the information available to the Group, particularly at the preliminary stages of matters, and assumptions by the Group as to future rulings of courts or other tribunals or the likely actions or positions taken by regulators or adversaries may prove incorrect. Moreover, estimates of possible loss for these matters are often not amenable to the use of statistical or other quantitative analytical tools frequently used in making judgments and estimates, and are subject to even greater degrees of uncertainty than in many other areas where the Group must exercise judgment and make estimates. The estimated possible loss, as well as any provisions taken, can be and often are substantially less than the amount initially requested by regulators or adversaries or the maximum potential loss that could be incurred were the matters to result in a final adjudication adverse to the Group. Moreover, in several regions in which the Group operates, an adversary often is not required to set forth the amount it

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    336
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

is seeking, and where it is, the amount may not be subject to the same requirements that generally apply to pleading factual allegations or legal claims.

The matters for which the Group determines that the possibility of a future loss is more than remote will change from time to time, as will the matters as to which a reliable estimate can be made and the estimated possible loss for such matters. Actual results may prove to be significantly higher or lower than the estimate of possible loss in those matters where such an estimate was made. In addition, loss may be incurred in matters with respect to which the Group believed the likelihood of loss was remote. In particular, the estimated aggregate possible loss does not represent the Group’s potential maximum loss exposure for those matters.

The Group may settle litigation or regulatory proceedings or investigations prior to a final judgment or determination of liability. It may do so to avoid the cost, management efforts or negative business, regulatory or reputational consequences of continuing to contest liability, even when the Group believes it has valid defenses to liability. It may also do so when the potential consequences of failing to prevail would be disproportionate to the costs of settlement. Furthermore, the Group may, for similar reasons, reimburse counterparties for their losses even in situations where it does not believe that it is legally compelled to do so.

Current Individual Proceedings

Set forth below are descriptions of civil litigation and regulatory enforcement matters or groups of matters for which the Group has taken material provisions, or for which there are material contingent liabilities that are more than remote, or for which there is the possibility of material business or reputational risk; similar matters are grouped together and some matters consist of a number of proceedings or claims. The disclosed matters include matters for which the possibility of a loss is more than remote but for which the Group cannot reliably estimate the possible loss.

Esch Funds Litigation. Sal. Oppenheim jr. & Cie. AG & Co. KGaA (“Sal. Oppenheim”) was prior to its acquisition by Deutsche Bank in 2010 involved in the marketing and financing of participations in closed end real estate funds. These funds were structured as Civil Law Partnerships under German law. Usually, Josef Esch Fonds-Projekt GmbH performed the planning and project development. Sal. Oppenheim held an indirect interest in this company via a joint-venture. In relation to this business a number of civil claims have been filed against Sal. Oppenheim. Some but not all of these claims are also directed against former managing partners of Sal. Oppenheim and other individuals. The claims brought against Sal. Oppenheim relate to investments of originally approximately  1.1 billion. After certain claims have either been dismissed in court or were settled to the effect that no further action will be taken, claims relating to investments of originally approximately 500 million are still pending. Currently, the aggregate amounts claimed in the pending proceedings are approximately  640 million. The investors are seeking to unwind their fund participation and to be indemnified against potential losses and debt related to the investment. The claims are based in part on an alleged failure of Sal. Oppenheim to provide adequate information on related risks and other material aspects important for the investors’ decision. Based on the facts of the individual cases, some courts have decided in favor and some against Sal. Oppenheim. Appeals are pending. The Group has recorded provisions and contingent liabilities with respect to these cases but has not disclosed the amounts thereof because it has concluded that such disclosure can be expected to prejudice seriously their outcome.

FX Investigations and Litigations. Deutsche Bank has received requests for information from certain regulatory and law enforcement agencies globally who are investigating trading in, and various other aspects of, the foreign exchange market. Deutsche Bank is cooperating with these investigations. Relatedly, Deutsche Bank is conducting its own internal global review of foreign exchange trading and other aspects of its foreign exchange business.

Deutsche Bank also has been named as a defendant in multiple putative class actions brought in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York alleging antitrust and U.S. Commodity Exchange Act claims relating to the alleged manipulation of foreign exchange rates. The complaints in the class actions do not specify the damages sought. On January 28, 2015, the federal court overseeing the class actions granted the motion to dismiss with prejudice in two actions involving non-U.S. plaintiffs while denying the motion to dismiss in one action involving U.S. plaintiffs then

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
337   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

pending. Additional actions have been filed since the court’s January 28, 2015 order. There are now three actions pending. The pending consolidated action is brought on behalf of a putative class of over-the-counter traders and a putative class of central-exchange traders, who are domiciled in or traded in the United States or its territories, and alleges illegal agreements to restrain competition with respect to and to manipulate both benchmark rates and spot rates, particularly the spreads quoted on those spot rates; the complaint further alleges that those supposed conspiracies, in turn, resulted in artificial prices on centralized exchanges for foreign exchange futures and options. A second action tracks the allegations in the consolidated action and asserts that such purported conduct gave rise to, and resulted in a breach of, defendants’ fiduciary duties under the U.S. Employment Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 (ERISA). The third putative class action was filed in the same court on December 21, 2015, by Axiom Investment Advisors, LLC alleging that Deutsche Bank rejected FX orders placed over electronic trading platforms through the application of a function referred to as “Last Look” and that these orders were later filled at prices less favorable to putative class members. Plaintiff has asserted claims for breach of contract, quasi-contractual claims, and claims under New York statutory law. Deutsche Bank has moved to dismiss the consolidated action and intends to move to dismiss the ERISA and Last Look actions in their entirety. The motion to dismiss in the Last Look case is due March 7, 2016, while there is no schedule yet for the ERISA action. Discovery has commenced in the consolidated and ERISA actions. Discovery has not yet commenced in the Last Look action.

Deutsche Bank also has been named as a defendant in two Canadian class proceedings brought in the provinces of Ontario and Quebec. Filed on September 10, 2015, these class actions assert factual allegations similar to those made in the consolidated action in the United States and seek damages pursuant to the Canadian Competition Act as well as other causes of action.

The Group has not disclosed whether it has established a provision or contingent liability with respect to these matters because it has concluded that such disclosure can be expected to prejudice seriously their outcome.

High Frequency Trading/Dark Pool Trading. Deutsche Bank has received requests for information from certain regulatory authorities related to high frequency trading and the operation of Deutsche Bank's alternative trading system (“ATS” or “Dark Pool”), SuperX. The Bank is cooperating with these requests. The Group has recorded a provision with respect to this matter. The Group has not disclosed the amount of this provision because it has concluded that such disclosure can be expected to prejudice seriously the outcome of this matter.

Deutsche Bank was initially named as a defendant in putative class action complaints alleging violations of U.S. securities laws related to high frequency trading, but in their consolidated amended complaint filed September 2, 2014, the plaintiffs did not include Deutsche Bank as a defendant.

Interbank Offered Rates Matters. Regulatory Enforcement Matters. Deutsche Bank has received subpoenas and requests for information from various regulatory and law enforcement agencies in Europe, North America and Asia/Pacific, including various U.S. state attorneys general, in connection with industry-wide investigations concerning the setting of London Interbank Offered Rate (LIBOR), Euro Interbank Offered Rate (EURIBOR), Tokyo Interbank Offered Rate (TIBOR) and other interbank offered rates. Deutsche Bank is cooperating with these investigations.

As previously reported, Deutsche Bank reached a settlement with the European Commission on December 4, 2013 as part of a collective settlement to resolve the European Commission’s investigations in relation to anticompetitive conduct in the trading of Euro interest rate derivatives and Yen interest rate derivatives. Under the terms of the settlement agreement, Deutsche Bank agreed to pay  725 million in total. This fine has been paid in full and does not form part of the Bank’s provisions.

Also as previously reported, on April 23, 2015, Deutsche Bank entered into separate settlements with the U.S. Department of Justice (DOJ), the U.S. Commodity Futures Trading Commission (CFTC), the U.K. Financial Conduct Authority (FCA), and the New York State Department of Financial Services (NYSDFS) to resolve investigations into misconduct concerning the setting of LIBOR, EURIBOR, and TIBOR. Under the terms of these agreements, Deutsche Bank agreed to pay penalties of U.S.$ 2.175 billion to the DOJ, CFTC and NYSDFS and GBP 226.8 million to the FCA. These fines have been paid in full and do not form part of the Bank’s provisions, save for U.S.$150 million that is payable to the DOJ following the sentencing of DB Group Services (UK) Ltd. as described below. The agreements also

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    338
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

contained provisions requiring various undertakings with respect to Deutsche Bank’s benchmark rate submissions in the future, as well as provisions requiring the appointment of an independent corporate monitor. Deutsche Bank was also required to take further disciplinary action against certain employees who were working at the Bank at the time of the agreements.

As part of the resolution with the DOJ, Deutsche Bank entered into a Deferred Prosecution Agreement with a three-year term pursuant to which it agreed (among other things) to the filing of a two-count criminal Information in the U.S. District Court for the District of Connecticut charging Deutsche Bank with one count of wire fraud and one count of price-fixing, in violation of the Sherman Act. As part of the agreement, DB Group Services (UK) Ltd. (an indirectly held, wholly-owned subsidiary of Deutsche Bank) entered into a Plea Agreement with the DOJ, pursuant to which the company pled guilty to a one-count criminal Information filed in the same court and charging the company with wire fraud. Deutsche Bank has made provision for a U.S.$ 150 million fine, which (subject to court approval) is expected to be paid by Deutsche Bank pursuant to the Plea Agreement within ten business days of when DB Group Services (UK) Ltd. is sentenced. (The U.S.$ 150 million fine is included in the U.S.$ 2.175 billion in total penalties referenced in the immediately preceding paragraph.) DB Group Services (UK) Ltd. currently has a sentencing date of October 7, 2016.

Other regulatory investigations of Deutsche Bank concerning the setting of various interbank offered rates remain ongoing, and Deutsche Bank remains exposed to further regulatory action. The Group has recorded a provision with respect to certain of the regulatory investigations. The Group has not disclosed the amount of this provision because it has concluded that such disclosure can be expected to prejudice seriously the outcome of these regulatory investigations.

Overview of Civil Litigations. Deutsche Bank is party to 47 civil actions concerning manipulation relating to the setting of various Interbank Offered Rates which are described in the following paragraphs. Most of the civil actions, including putative class actions, are pending in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York (SDNY), against Deutsche Bank and numerous other banks. All but six of the civil actions were filed on behalf of parties who allege losses as a result of manipulation relating to the setting of U.S. dollar LIBOR. The six civil actions pending against Deutsche Bank that do not relate to U.S. dollar LIBOR are also pending in the SDNY, and include two actions concerning Yen LIBOR and Euroyen TIBOR, one action concerning EURIBOR, two actions concerning Pound Sterling (GBP) LIBOR and one action concerning Swiss franc (CHF) LIBOR.

With one exception, all of the civil actions pending in the SDNY concerning U.S. dollar LIBOR are being coordinated as part of a multidistrict litigation (the “U.S. dollar LIBOR MDL”). This U.S. dollar LIBOR MDL includes 33 actions against Deutsche Bank and others: ten class actions and 23 individual actions. One of these individual actions includes ten actions for which the plaintiffs submitted one consolidated complaint, and is therefore discussed here as one action. Six actions originally part of the U.S. dollar LIBOR MDL were dismissed and a consolidated appeal is pending in the U.S. Court of Appeals for the Second Circuit. Several other actions that are part of the U.S. dollar LIBOR MDL were dismissed in part and also are part of the consolidated appeal. There is one non-MDL class action concerning U.S. dollar LIBOR that was dismissed and for which an appeal is pending in the U.S. Court of Appeals for the Ninth Circuit.

Claims for damages for all 47 of the civil actions discussed have been asserted under various legal theories, including violations of the U.S. Commodity Exchange Act (CEA), federal and state antitrust laws, the U.S. Racketeer Influenced and Corrupt Organizations Act (RICO), and other federal and state laws. In all but five cases, the amount of damages has not been formally articulated by the counterparty. The five cases that allege a specific amount of damages are individual actions consolidated in the U.S. dollar LIBOR MDL and seek a minimum of more than U.S.$ 1.25 billion in damages in the aggregate from all defendants including Deutsche Bank. The Group has not disclosed whether it has established a provision or contingent liability with respect to these matters because it has concluded that such disclosure can be expected to prejudice seriously their outcome.

U.S. dollar LIBOR. In three rulings between March 2013 and June 2014, the court in the U.S. dollar LIBOR MDL granted in part and denied in part motions to dismiss addressed to the six first-filed complaints (three class actions and three individual actions). The court issued decisions permitting certain CEA claims and state law contract and unjust enrichment claims to proceed, while dismissing certain CEA claims as time-barred and dismissing all of plaintiffs’ federal and state law antitrust claims and claims asserted under RICO. This resulted in the dismissal of four cases in their

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
339   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

entirety (one class action and three individual actions) and the partial dismissal of two cases (both class actions). One of the four cases dismissed in its entirety is being appealed as part of the consolidated appeal discussed below. In the other three cases dismissed in their entirety, the U.S. Court of Appeals for the Second Circuit denied plaintiffs’ efforts to appeal as untimely, and in October 2015, the U.S. Supreme Court denied plaintiffs’ petition to have it review the Second Circuit’s denial. Separately, and prior to the Supreme Court’s October 2015 denial, on February 10, 2015, the plaintiffs in those three cases filed a second notice of appeal, which defendants have moved to dismiss.

Various additional plaintiffs proceeding in their individual capacities have brought actions against Deutsche Bank. On August 4, 2015, the court issued an opinion concerning some of the 23 individual actions consolidated in the U.S. dollar LIBOR MDL. Deutsche Bank is a defendant in 17 of those cases. Several claims have been dismissed against certain parties, including a subsidiary of Deutsche Bank, based on lack of jurisdiction. Other claims were dismissed against all parties, including claims for antitrust, RICO, conspiracy, consumer protection, unfair business practices, and state law claims for injunctive and equitable relief. Contract, fraud and other tort claims from certain counterparties with whom Deutsche Bank had direct dealings remain pending against Deutsche Bank. For some claims, the court described legal principles and directed the parties in the first instance to attempt to reach agreement on which claims survive. On January 21, 2016, the parties filed a response to the court’s request.

Some of the plaintiffs in these individual actions were permitted by the lower court to pursue appeals on their federal antitrust claims. These plaintiffs, along with plaintiffs in one of the first-filed class actions discussed above, are pursuing appeals to the U.S. Court of Appeals for the Second Circuit. Also part of the consolidated appeal are two class actions involving only federal antitrust claims, which were dismissed upon the plaintiffs’ request so that they could become part of the appeal. The Second Circuit granted a motion by defendants to consolidate these appeals, and briefing was completed on August 17, 2015. Oral argument was held on November 13, 2015. Certain other class actions with federal antitrust claims are stayed pending resolution of this appeal.

Plaintiffs representing putative classes of homeowners and lenders also have brought actions against Deutsche Bank, which have been consolidated in the U.S. dollar LIBOR MDL. On November 3, 2015, the court issued an opinion dismissing all lender plaintiffs’ claims except those by one plaintiff. The court ordered the parties to confer in the first instance to discuss which claims in the action are within the court’s jurisdiction. The court also dismissed all claims by homeowner plaintiffs for lack of jurisdiction. On November 17, 2015, the lender plaintiffs filed an amended complaint and an accompanying letter regarding additional amendments. Defendants opposed the filings.

Plaintiffs representing a putative class of plaintiffs who allegedly transacted in exchange-traded financial instruments referencing U.S. dollar LIBOR (the “exchange-based plaintiffs”) also have brought an action against Deutsche Bank, which has been consolidated in the U.S. dollar LIBOR MDL. On June 29, 2015, the exchange-based plaintiffs requested leave to move to amend their complaint to include new allegations relating to Deutsche Bank’s April 23, 2015 IBOR settlements with the DOJ, CFTC, NYSDFS, and FCA. The proposed amended complaint also would add two Deutsche Bank subsidiaries, DB Group Services (UK) Ltd. and Deutsche Bank Securities Inc., as named defendants. In December 2015, several defendants, including Deutsche Bank, opposed the proposed amendments. On October 29, 2015, the court denied a request by the exchange-based plaintiffs for leave to file a motion to reconsider aspects of its earlier opinions, and denied their request for certification of an interlocutory appeal. On November 3, 2015, the court issued an opinion regarding defendants’ motion to dismiss exchange-based plaintiffs’ claims for lack of jurisdiction, but ordered the parties to confer in the first instance to discuss which claims survive on jurisdiction grounds. This ruling does not bear directly on exchange-based plaintiffs’ proposed amended complaint. Discovery is ongoing.

Plaintiffs representing a putative class of plaintiffs who allegedly transacted in U.S. dollar LIBOR-referencing over-the-counter financial instruments (the “OTC plaintiffs”) filed a proposed third amended complaint on November 23, 2015. Defendants opposed plaintiffs’ proposed amendments on December 18, 2015.

The court in an additional action concerning U.S. dollar LIBOR that was independently pending in the SDNY, outside of the U.S. dollar LIBOR MDL, has granted defendants’ motions to dismiss. The plaintiff has filed a motion to amend its complaint, which is pending.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    340
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Deutsche Bank also was named as a defendant in a civil action in the Central District of California concerning U.S. dollar LIBOR. The court granted Deutsche Bank’s motion to dismiss. The plaintiff is currently pursuing an appeal to the U.S. Court of Appeals for the Ninth Circuit, and briefing was completed on January 8, 2016.

Yen LIBOR and Euroyen TIBOR. A putative class action was filed in the SDNY against Deutsche Bank and other banks concerning the alleged manipulation of Yen LIBOR and Euroyen TIBOR. On March 31, 2015, the court denied in part and granted in part a motion by the plaintiff to amend his complaint. The court denied plaintiff’s requests to assert RICO claims against Deutsche Bank and to add two new named plaintiffs. On December 18, 2015, plaintiff served a third amended complaint. On January 8, 2016, the court struck the third amended complaint as going beyond the amendments the court authorized in its March 31, 2015 decision. On January 28, 2016, plaintiffs requested permission to file a new proposed third amended complaint. Defendants opposed this request on February 18, 2016.

A second putative class action alleging manipulation of Yen LIBOR and Euroyen TIBOR and naming Deutsche Bank and a subsidiary, DB Group Services (UK) Ltd., as defendants, along with other banks and inter-dealer brokers, was filed in the SDNY on July 24, 2015. On December 18, 2015, plaintiffs served an amended complaint. Motions to dismiss the complaint were filed on February 1, 2016.

EURIBOR. Deutsche Bank and a subsidiary, DB Group Services (UK) Ltd., are also named as defendants in a putative class action concerning the alleged manipulation of EURIBOR, pending in the SDNY. A motion to dismiss plaintiffs’ further amended complaint was filed in October 2015 and is pending.

Pound Sterling (GBP) LIBOR. On May 6, 2015, Deutsche Bank was named as a defendant in a putative class action in the SDNY concerning the alleged manipulation of Pound Sterling (GBP) LIBOR. Defendants’ motions to dismiss were filed on November 13, 2015.

On January 21, 2016, Deutsche Bank was named as a defendant in an additional putative class action in the SDNY concerning the alleged manipulation of Pound Sterling (GBP) LIBOR. On February 11, 2016, the court consolidated these two actions.

Swiss Franc (CHF) LIBOR. On June 19, 2015, Deutsche Bank and a subsidiary, DB Group Services (UK) Ltd., were named as defendants in a putative class action in the SDNY concerning the alleged manipulation of Swiss Franc (CHF) LIBOR. Motions to dismiss were filed in August 2015 and are pending.

Kaupthing CLN Claims. In June 2012, Kaupthing hf, an Icelandic stock corporation, acting through its winding-up committee, issued Icelandic law clawback claims for approximately  509 million (plus interest calculated on a damages rate basis and penalty rate basis) against Deutsche Bank in both Iceland and England. The claims relate to leveraged credit linked notes (“CLNs”), referencing Kaupthing, issued by Deutsche Bank to two British Virgin Island special purpose vehicles (“SPVs”) in 2008. The SPVs were ultimately owned by high net worth individuals. Kaupthing claims to have funded the SPVs and alleges that Deutsche Bank was or should have been aware that Kaupthing itself was economically exposed in the transactions. Kaupthing claims that the transactions are voidable by Kaupthing on a number of alternative grounds, including the ground that the transactions were improper because one of the alleged purposes of the transactions was to allow Kaupthing to influence the market in its own CDS (credit default swap) spreads and thereby its listed bonds. Additionally, in November 2012, an English law claim (with allegations similar to those featured in the Icelandic law claims) was commenced by Kaupthing against Deutsche Bank in London. Deutsche Bank filed a defense in the Icelandic proceedings in late February 2013 and continues to defend the claims. In February 2014, proceedings in England were stayed pending final determination of the Icelandic proceedings. Additionally, in December 2014, the SPVs and their joint liquidators served Deutsche Bank with substantively similar claims arising out of the CLN transactions against Deutsche Bank and other defendants in England. The SPVs are also claiming approximately  509 million (plus interest), although the amount of that interest claim is less than in Iceland. Deutsche Bank has filed a defense in these proceedings and continues to defend them. The SPVs’ claims are not expected to increase Deutsche Bank’s overall potential liability in respect of the CLN transactions beyond the amount already claimed by Kaupthing. The Group has not disclosed whether it has established a provision or contingent liability with respect to these matters because it has concluded that such disclosure can be expected to prejudice seriously their outcome.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
341   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Kirch. The public prosecutor’s office in Munich (Staatsanwaltschaft München I) has conducted and is currently conducting criminal investigations in connection with the Kirch case with regard to former Management Board members as well as the current Management Board member Jürgen Fitschen. The Kirch case involved several civil proceedings between Deutsche Bank AG and Dr. Leo Kirch as well as media companies controlled by him. The key issue was whether an interview given by Dr. Rolf Breuer, then Spokesman of Deutsche Bank’s Management Board, in 2002 with Bloomberg television, during which Dr. Breuer commented on Dr. Kirch’s (and his companies’) inability to obtain financing, caused the insolvency of the Kirch companies. In February 2014, Deutsche Bank and the Kirch heirs reached a comprehensive settlement, which has ended all legal disputes between them.

The main investigation involving Mr. Fitschen and several former Management Board members has been concluded and an indictment against all accused was filed on August 6, 2014. Trial started on April 28, 2015 and court dates are currently scheduled until April 2016, generally one day per week. The court ordered the secondary participation of Deutsche Bank AG, which could result in the imposition of a monetary fine on the Bank.

The investigation involving former Management Board member Dr. Stephan Leithner is ongoing.

The allegations of the public prosecutors are that Mr. Fitschen and former Management Board member Dr. Stephan Leithner failed to correct in a timely manner factual statements made by Deutsche Bank’s litigation counsel in submissions filed in one of the civil cases between Kirch and Deutsche Bank AG before the Munich Higher Regional Court and the Federal Court of Justice, after allegedly having become aware that such statements were not correct. Under German law, a party in a civil litigation is under a statutory duty to make sure all factual statements made by it in court are accurate. The indictment of Mr. Fitschen and the ongoing investigation of Dr. Leithner are based on the allegation that (unlike the other Management Board members) they had special knowledge or responsibility in relation to the Kirch case. The indictment regarding other former Management Board members is based on the allegation that they gave incorrect testimony to the Munich Higher Regional Court.

The Supervisory Board and the Management Board of Deutsche Bank have obtained opinions from an international law firm and a retired president of one of the leading courts of appeal in Germany to the effect that there is no basis for the accusation of criminal wrongdoing made by the public prosecutors against Mr. Fitschen and Dr. Leithner. Deutsche Bank is fully cooperating with the Munich public prosecutor’s office.

The Group does not expect these proceedings to have significant economic consequences for it and has not recorded a provision or contingent liability with respect thereto.

KOSPI Index Unwind Matters. Following the decline of the Korea Composite Stock Price Index 200 (the “KOSPI 200”) in the closing auction on November 11, 2010 by approximately 2.7 %, the Korean Financial Supervisory Service (“FSS”) commenced an investigation and expressed concerns that the fall in the KOSPI 200 was attributable to a sale by Deutsche Bank of a basket of stocks, worth approximately  1.6 billion, that was held as part of an index arbitrage position on the KOSPI 200. On February 23, 2011, the Korean Financial Services Commission, which oversees the work of the FSS, reviewed the FSS’ findings and recommendations and resolved to take the following actions: (i) to file a criminal complaint to the Korean Prosecutor’s Office for alleged market manipulation against five employees of the Deutsche Bank group and Deutsche Bank’s subsidiary Deutsche Securities Korea Co. (DSK) for vicarious corporate criminal liability; and (ii) to impose a suspension of six months, commencing April 1, 2011 and ending September 30, 2011, of DSK’s business for proprietary trading of cash equities and listed derivatives and DMA (direct market access) cash equities trading, and the requirement that DSK suspend the employment of one named employee for six months. There was an exemption to the business suspension which permitted DSK to continue acting as liquidity provider for existing derivatives linked securities. On August 19, 2011, the Korean Prosecutor’s Office announced its decision to indict DSK and four employees of the Deutsche Bank group on charges of spot/futures linked market manipulation. The criminal trial commenced in January 2012. On January 25, 2016, the Seoul Central District Court rendered a guilty verdict against a DSK trader and a guilty verdict against DSK. A criminal fine of KRW 1.5 billion (less than 2.0 million) was imposed on DSK. The Court also ordered forfeiture of the profits generated on the underlying trading activity. The Group disgorged the profits on the underlying trading activity in 2011. The criminal trial verdict is subject to appeal by both the prosecutor and the defendants.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    342
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

In addition, a number of civil actions have been filed in Korean courts against Deutsche Bank and DSK by certain parties who allege they incurred losses as a consequence of the fall in the KOSPI 200 on November 11, 2010. First instance court decisions were rendered against the Bank and DSK in some of these cases starting in the fourth quarter of 2015. The outstanding known claims have an aggregate claim amount of less than  80 million (at present exchange rates). The Group has recorded a provision with respect to these outstanding civil matters. The Group has not disclosed the amount of this provision because it has concluded that such disclosure can be expected to prejudice seriously the outcome of these matters.

Mortgage-Related and Asset-Backed Securities Matters and Investigation. Regulatory and Governmental Matters. Deutsche Bank, along with certain affiliates (collectively referred in these paragraphs to as “Deutsche Bank”), have received subpoenas and requests for information from certain regulators and government entities, including members of the Residential Mortgage-Backed Securities Working Group of the U.S. Financial Fraud Enforcement Task Force, concerning its activities regarding the origination, purchase, securitization, sale and/or trading of mortgage loans, residential mortgage-backed securities (RMBS), commercial mortgage-backed securities (CMBS), collateralized debt obligations, other asset-backed securities and credit derivatives. Deutsche Bank is cooperating fully in response to those subpoenas and requests for information. The Group has recorded provisions with respect to some of the regulatory investigations but not others. The Group has not disclosed the amount of these provisions because it has concluded that such disclosure can be expected to prejudice seriously the outcome of these regulatory investigations.

Deutsche Bank was named as a defendant in a civil action brought by the Commonwealth of Virginia asserting claims for fraud and breach of the Virginia Fraud Against Taxpayers Act as a result of purchases by the Virginia Retirement System (VRS) of RMBS issued or underwritten by Deutsche Bank. This matter was settled in the fourth quarter of 2015 for an amount that was not material to Deutsche Bank.

Issuer and Underwriter Civil Litigation. Deutsche Bank has been named as defendant in numerous civil litigations brought by private parties in connection with its various roles, including issuer or underwriter, in offerings of RMBS and other asset-backed securities. These cases, described below, include putative class action suits, actions by individual purchasers of securities and actions by trustees on behalf of RMBS trusts. Although the allegations vary by lawsuit, these cases generally allege that the RMBS offering documents contained material misrepresentations and omissions, including with regard to the underwriting standards pursuant to which the underlying mortgage loans were issued, or assert that various representations or warranties relating to the loans were breached at the time of origination. The Group has recorded provisions with respect to several of these civil cases, but has not recorded provisions with respect to all of these matters. The Group has not disclosed the amount of these provisions because it has concluded that such disclosure can be expected to prejudice seriously the outcome of these matters.

Deutsche Bank was a defendant in putative class action relating to its role, along with other financial institutions, as underwriter of RMBS issued by IndyMac MBS, Inc. On September 8, 2014, Deutsche Bank, certain other financial institution defendants and lead plaintiffs executed a stipulation to settle the action. On September 30, 2014, the court issued an order certifying the class for settlement and approving notice to the class. On February 23, 2015, the court issued an order approving the settlement and dismissing the action. Under the settlement, all settling defendants paid a total of U.S.$ 340 million. Deutsche Bank’s portion of the settlement is not material to it. On March 25, 2015, Pacific Investment Management Company, LLC (PIMCO) filed a notice of appeal of the court’s February 23, 2015 order, but withdrew the appeal on June 11, 2015.

Deutsche Bank is a defendant in a putative class action relating to its role, along with other financial institutions, as underwriter of RMBS issued by Novastar Mortgage Corporation. No specific damages are alleged in the complaint. On February 5, 2015, the court issued an order vacating its prior decision that had dismissed five of six RMBS offerings from the case. The court ordered the plaintiffs to amend the operative complaint to include the previously dismissed offerings. On March 9, 2015, the lead plaintiff filed its third amended complaint pursuant to the court’s February 5, 2015 order. Discovery in the action is ongoing.

Deutsche Bank currently is a defendant in various non-class action lawsuits by alleged purchasers of, and counterparties involved in transactions relating to, RMBS, and their affiliates, including: (1) Aozora Bank, Ltd. (alleging U.S.$ 61 million in damages attributable to Deutsche Bank); (2) the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (FDIC) as

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
343   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

receiver for: (a) Colonial Bank (in one of two separate actions, alleging no less than U.S.$ 189 million in damages in the aggregate against all defendants), (b) Franklin Bank S.S.B. and Guaranty Bank (alleging no less than U.S.$ 901 million in damages in the aggregate against all defendants), and (c) Citizens National Bank and Strategic Capital Bank (in one of two separate actions, alleging no less than U.S.$ 66 million in damages in the aggregate against all defendants); (3) the Federal Home Loan Bank of San Francisco; (4) Phoenix Light SF Limited (as purported assignee of claims of special purpose vehicles created and/or managed by former WestLB AG); and (5) Royal Park Investments (as purported assignee of claims of a special-purpose vehicle created to acquire certain assets of Fortis Bank). Unless otherwise indicated, the complaints in these matters did not specify the damages sought.

On January 14, 2015, the court granted Deutsche Bank’s motion to dismiss the action brought against it by Aozora Bank, Ltd., relating to a collateralized debt obligation identified as Blue Edge ABS CDO, Ltd. On March 31, 2015, the court denied Aozora Bank, Ltd.’s motion to reargue, or, in the alternative, to file an amended complaint. On April 29, 2015, Aozora Bank, Ltd. filed a notice of appeal and the appeal commenced on October 5, 2015. The appeal is pending. Deutsche Bank also is a defendant, along with UBS AG and affiliates, in an action brought by Aozora Bank, Ltd. On October 14, 2015, the court granted in part and denied in part defendants’ motions to dismiss the complaint. On October 30, 2015, defendants filed notices of appeal. Discovery has not yet commenced.

In 2012, the FDIC, as receiver for Colonial Bank, Franklin Bank S.S.B., Guaranty Bank, Citizens National Bank and Strategic Capital Bank, commenced several actions in different federal courts asserting claims under Sections 11 and 12(a)(2) of the Securities Act of 1933, as well as Article 581-33 of the Texas Securities Act, against several underwriters, including Deutsche Bank. Each of these actions has been dismissed as time-barred. The FDIC has appealed these rulings to the Second, Fifth and Ninth Circuits Courts of Appeal. The appeals in the Second and Ninth Circuits Courts of Appeal are pending. On August 10, 2015, the Court of Appeals for the Fifth Circuit reversed the district court’s dismissal of the FDIC’s claims as time-barred. On August 24, 2015, Deutsche Bank and the other defendants filed a petition for rehearing en banc in that action. On September 11, 2015, the Court of Appeals for the Fifth Circuit denied that petition. On December 10, 2015, Deutsche Bank and other defendants filed a petition for a writ of certiorari to the United States Supreme Court challenging the Court of Appeals for the Fifth Circuit’s reversal of the district court’s dismissal of the case.

On January 22, 2015, pursuant to a confidential settlement agreement with Deutsche Bank, the Federal Home Loan Bank of San Francisco dismissed with prejudice claims that it had filed against Deutsche Bank relating to seven RMBS offerings. On January 26, 2015, pursuant to a confidential agreement between the Federal Home Loan Bank of San Francisco and Countrywide, the Federal Home Loan Bank of San Francisco entered an order dismissing with prejudice claims brought against Deutsche Bank by the Federal Home Loan Bank of San Francisco relating to 15 offerings issued by entities affiliated with Countrywide. Deutsche Bank’s understanding is that the dismissal with respect to these 15 offerings was pursuant to a confidential settlement agreement to which Deutsche Bank was not a party. Deutsche Bank remains a defendant in the case with respect to one RMBS offering and two offerings described as resecuritizations of RMBS certificates. No specific damages are alleged in the complaint. The case is in discovery.

Residential Funding Company has brought a repurchase action against Deutsche Bank for breaches of representations and warranties on loans sold to Residential Funding Company and for indemnification for losses incurred as a result of RMBS-related claims and actions asserted against Residential Funding Company. The complaint did not specify the amount of damages sought. On June 8, 2015, the court denied Deutsche Bank’s motion to dismiss certain of the claims. Also on June 8, 2015, Deutsche Bank moved to dismiss other claims. On September 29, 2015, the court denied Deutsche Bank’s second motion to dismiss. Discovery is ongoing.

On December 19, 2014, a stipulation was filed dismissing with prejudice claims brought against Deutsche Bank by Mass Mutual Life Insurance Company relating to offerings issued by entities affiliated with Countrywide. Deutsche Bank’s understanding is that the dismissal with respect to these offerings was pursuant to a confidential settlement agreement to which Deutsche Bank was not a party. Deutsche Bank was a defendant in separate litigation brought by Mass Mutual Life Insurance Company relating to certificates not issued by entities affiliated with Countrywide. On July 22, 2015, Deutsche Bank and Mass Mutual Life Insurance Company entered into a settlement agreement to resolve all pending claims against Deutsche Bank. On August 11, 2015, Deutsche Bank paid the settlement amount and

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    344
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

on August 15, 2015, the court dismissed the actions. The economic impact of the settlement was not material to Deutsche Bank.

On April 20, 2011, the Federal Home Loan Bank of Boston filed a complaint against dozens of entities, including Deutsche Bank, alleging a variety of claims under the Massachusetts Uniform Securities Act and various other Massachusetts statutory and common laws. The complaint did not specify the amount of damages sought. On October 16, 2015, the parties signed a settlement agreement to resolve the matter. On October 27, 2015, the Federal Home Loan Bank of Boston filed a stipulation of voluntary dismissal with prejudice. The financial terms of the settlement are not material to Deutsche Bank.

On September 22, 2015, Deutsche Bank and the Federal Home Loan Bank of Des Moines, as successor to the Federal Home Loan Bank of Seattle, executed a settlement agreement resolving all claims related to the single bond at issue. On October 12, 2015, the court entered the parties’ stipulation dismissing the matter. The financial terms of the settlement are not material to Deutsche Bank.

Deutsche Bank and Monarch Alternative Capital LP and certain of its advisory clients and managed investments vehicles (Monarch) reached an agreement on December 18, 2014 to propose a settlement agreement to HSBC Bank USA, National Association (HSBC) to resolve litigation relating to three RMBS trusts. After receiving approval from a majority of certificate holders, on July 13, 2015, HSBC executed the settlement agreements, and on July 27, 2015, the actions were dismissed. A substantial portion of the settlement funds were paid by a non-party to the litigation. The net economic impact of the settlements was not material to Deutsche Bank. On June 17, 2015, the court granted defendants’ motion to dismiss the RMBS-related claims brought by Commerzbank AG against Deutsche Bank and several other financial institutions. Commerzbank AG filed a notice to appeal on July 24, 2015, but withdrew that appeal on August 17, 2015.

In March 2012, RMBS Recovery Holdings 4, LLC and VP Structured Products, LLC brought an action in New York state court against Deutsche Bank alleging breaches of representations and warranties made by Deutsche Bank concerning the mortgage loans in the ACE Securities Corp. 2006-SL2 RMBS offering. The complaint did not specify the amount of damages sought. On May 13, 2013, the court denied Deutsche Bank’s motion to dismiss the action as time-barred. On December 19, 2013, the appellate court reversed the lower court’s decision and dismissed the case. On June 11, 2015, the New York Court of Appeals affirmed the appellate court’s dismissal of the case. The court found that plaintiff’s cause of action accrued more than six years before the filing of the complaint and was therefore barred by the statute of limitations.

Deutsche Bank was named as a defendant in a lawsuit filed by Sealink Funding Ltd., an entity established as part of the bailout of Sachsen Landesbank to function as purported assignee of claims of special purpose vehicles created and/or managed by Sachsen Landesbank and its subsidiaries. In the third and fourth quarters of 2015, Sealink Funding Ltd. unsuccessfully appealed an order dismissing its claims against Morgan Stanley in another similar action for lack of standing. In denying Sealink Funding Ltd.’s appeal, the appellate court found that the sales and purchase agreements through which Sealink Funding Ltd. acquired the at-issue securities did not validly transfer tort claims. The appellate court’s decision was dispositive of Sealink Funding Ltd.’s claims against Deutsche Bank, as Sealink Funding Ltd. acquired the at-issue securities in the Deutsche Bank action through the same sales and purchase agreements involved in the Morgan Stanley case. On December 21, 2015, Sealink Funding Ltd. voluntarily dismissed its claims with prejudice.

Deutsche Bank was a defendant in a civil action brought by Texas County & District Retirement System alleging fraud and other common law claims in connection with Texas County & District Retirement System’s purchase of four RMBS bonds underwritten by Deutsche Bank. On November 18, 2015, Deutsche Bank and Texas County & District Retirement System reached an agreement to settle the latter’s claims against Deutsche Bank. On December 3, 2015, the district court entered an order dismissing the action with prejudice. The financial terms of the settlement are not material to Deutsche Bank.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
345   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Deutsche Bank was named as a defendant in a civil action brought by the Charles Schwab Corporation seeking rescission of its purchase of a single Countrywide-issued RMBS certificate. In the fourth quarter of 2015, Bank of America, which indemnified Deutsche Bank in the case, reached an agreement to settle the action with respect to the single certificate at issue for Deutsche Bank. On January 25, 2016, the Charles Schwab Corporation filed a request for dismissal with prejudice as to Deutsche Bank Securities Inc.

Deutsche Bank was named as a defendant in a FINRA arbitration brought by the Knights of Columbus (“Knights”) alleging fraud, negligence, violation of state securities law, and violations of industry rules and practice in connection with six third-party offerings underwritten by Deutsche Bank. On February 22, 2016, Deutsche Bank and Knights executed an agreement to settle the matter. The financial terms of the settlement are not material to Deutsche Bank.

Deutsche Bank and Amherst Advisory & Management LLC (Amherst) reached an agreement on February 12, 2016 to propose settlement agreements to HSBC Bank USA, National Association (HSBC) to resolve breach of contract actions relating to five RMBS trusts. Pursuant to the agreements with Amherst, on February 17, 2016 Amherst requested that HSBC conduct a vote of certificateholders for each of the trusts concerning the approval or rejection of the proposed settlements. A substantial portion of the settlement funds that would be paid by Deutsche Bank with respect to one of the five trusts, if the proposed settlement is consummated as to that trust, would be reimbursed by a non-party to that litigation. The net economic impact of the settlements was already reflected in prior periods.

On February 3, 2016, Lehman Brothers Holding, Inc. instituted an adversary proceeding in United States Bankruptcy Court for the Southern District of New York against, among others, MortgageIT, Inc. (MIT) and Deutsche Bank AG, as alleged successor to MIT, asserting breaches of representations and warranties set forth in certain 2003 and 2004 loan purchase agreements concerning 63 mortgage loans that MIT sold to Lehman, which Lehman in turn sold to the Federal National Mortgage Association (Fannie Mae) and the Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation (Freddie Mac). The complaint seeks indemnification for losses incurred by Lehman in connection with settlements entered into with Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac as part of the Lehman bankruptcy proceedings to resolve claims concerning those loans. No specific damages are alleged in the complaint. The time to respond to the complaint has not yet expired.

In the actions against Deutsche Bank solely as an underwriter of other issuers’ RMBS offerings, Deutsche Bank has contractual rights to indemnification from the issuers, but those indemnity rights may in whole or in part prove effectively unenforceable where the issuers are now or may in the future be in bankruptcy or otherwise defunct.

Deutsche Bank has entered into agreements with certain entities that have threatened to assert claims against Deutsche Bank in connection with various RMBS offerings and other related products to toll the relevant statutes of limitations. It is possible that these potential claims may have a material impact on Deutsche Bank. In addition, Deutsche Bank has entered into settlement agreements with some of these entities, the financial terms of which are not material to Deutsche Bank.

Trustee Civil Litigation. Deutsche Bank National Trust Company (“DBNTC”) and Deutsche Bank Trust Company Americas (“DBTCA”) have been sued by investors in civil litigation concerning their role as trustees of certain RMBS trusts.

On June 18, 2014, a group of investors, including funds managed by Blackrock Advisors, LLC, PIMCO-Advisors, L.P., and others, filed a derivative action against DBNTC and DBTCA in New York State Supreme Court purportedly on behalf of and for the benefit of 544 private-label RMBS trusts asserting claims for alleged violations of the U.S. Trust Indenture Act of 1939 (TIA), breach of contract, breach of fiduciary duty and negligence based on DBNTC and DBTCA’s alleged failure to perform their duties as trustees for the trusts. Plaintiffs subsequently dismissed their state court complaint and filed a derivative and class action complaint in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York on behalf of and for the benefit of 564 private-label RMBS trusts, which substantially overlapped with the trusts at issue in the state court action. The complaint alleges that the trusts at issue have suffered total realized collateral losses of U.S.$ 89.4 billion, but the complaint does not include a demand for money damages in a sum certain. DBNTC and DBTCA filed a motion to dismiss, and on January 19, 2016, the court partially granted the motion on procedural grounds: as to the 500 trusts that are governed by Pooling and Servicing Agreements, the court declined to exercise jurisdiction. The court did not rule on substantive defenses asserted in the motion to dismiss. The court further

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    346
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

ordered plaintiffs to file an amended complaint consistent with its ruling as to the remaining 64 trusts governed by indentures. DBNTC and DBTCA will have an opportunity to file new defensive motions with respect to the amended complaint after it is filed.

On June 18, 2014, Royal Park Investments SA/NV filed a class and derivative action complaint on behalf of investors in ten RMBS trusts against DBNTC in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York asserting claims for alleged violations of the TIA, breach of contract and breach of trust based on DBNTC’s alleged failure to perform its duties as trustee for the trusts. Royal Park’s complaint alleges that the total realized losses of the ten trusts amount to over U.S.$ 3.1 billion, but does not allege damages in a sum certain. On February 3, 2016, the court granted in part and dismissed in part plaintiffs’ claims: the court dismissed plaintiff’s TIA claim and its derivative theory and denied DBNTC’s motion to dismiss the breach of contract and breach of trust claims. Discovery is ongoing.

On November 7, 2014, the National Credit Union Administration Board (“NCUA”), as an investor in 121 RMBS trusts, filed a complaint in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York against DBNTC as trustee of those trusts, alleging violations of the TIA and the New York Streit Act for DBNTC’s alleged failure to perform certain purported statutory and contractual duties. On March 5, 2015, NCUA amended its complaint to assert claims as an investor in 97 of the 121 RMBS trusts that were the subject of its first complaint. The amended complaint alleges violations of the TIA and Streit Act, as well as breach of contract, breach of fiduciary duty, negligence, gross negligence, negligent misrepresentation, and breach of the covenant of good faith. NCUA’s complaint alleges that the trusts at issue have suffered total realized collateral losses of U.S.$ 17.2 billion, but the complaint does not include a demand for money damages in a sum certain. DBNTC filed a motion to dismiss that is fully briefed but not yet decided. Discovery is stayed.

On December 23, 2014, certain CDOs (collectively, “Phoenix Light SF Limited”) that hold RMBS certificates issued by 21 RMBS trusts filed a complaint in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York against DBNTC as trustee of the trusts, asserting claims for violation of the TIA and the Streit Act, breach of contract, breach of fiduciary duty, negligence, gross negligence, and negligent misrepresentation, based on DBNTC’s alleged failure to perform its duties as trustee for the trusts. On April 10, 2015, the CDOs filed an amended complaint relating to an additional 34 trusts (for a total of 55 trusts) and amended their complaint for a second time on July 15, 2015 to include additional allegations. The CDOs allege that DBNTC is liable for over U.S.$ 527 million of damages. DBNTC filed a motion to dismiss that is fully briefed but not yet decided. Discovery is stayed. On February 2, 2016, the court entered a stipulation signed by the parties to dismiss with prejudice claims relating to four of the 55 trusts.

On March 24, 2015, the Western and Southern Life Insurance Company and five related entities (collectively “Western & Southern”), as investors in 18 RMBS trusts, filed a complaint in the Court of Common Pleas, Hamilton County, Ohio, against DBNTC as trustee for 12 of those trusts, asserting claims for violation of the TIA and the Streit Act, breach of contract, breach of fiduciary duty, negligence, gross negligence, negligent misrepresentation, and breach of the covenant of good faith and fair dealing, based on DBNTC’s alleged failure to perform its duties as trustee for the trusts. Western & Southern alleges that it purchased certificates of the trusts with a face value of more than U.S.$ 220 million and that the trusts at issue have suffered total realized collateral losses of U.S.$ 1 billion, but the complaint does not include a demand for money damages in a sum certain. DBNTC filed a motion to dismiss based upon lack of personal jurisdiction and forum non conveniens; a motion to stay the case pending the resolution of similar actions in New York against DBNTC; and a motion to sever the claims against DBNTC from those against its co-defendant. On November 5, 2015, the Court denied DBNTC’s motion to dismiss and motion to stay the case but granted DBNTC’s motion to sever. After DBNTC’s first motion to dismiss was decided, DBNTC filed another motion to dismiss, this time for failure to state a claim. Discovery is ongoing.

On December 23, 2015, Commerzbank AG (“Commerzbank”), as an investor in 50 RMBS trusts, filed a complaint in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York against DBNTC as trustee of the trusts, asserting claims for violations of the TIA and New York’s Streit Act, breach of contract, breach of fiduciary duty, negligence, and breach of the covenant of good faith, based on DBNTC’s alleged failure to perform its duties as trustee for the trusts. Commerzbank alleges that DBNTC caused it to suffer “hundreds of millions of dollars in losses,” but the complaint does not include a demand for money damages in a sum certain. This case and the Phoenix Light case were assigned to the same judge. The judge stayed this case until after he adjudicates DBNTC’s motion to dismiss in the

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
347   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Phoenix Light action, at which time Commerzbank will be given an opportunity to amend its complaint. Discovery has not yet commenced.

On December 30, 2015, IKB International, S.A. in Liquidation and IKB Deutsche Industriebank A.G. (collectively, “IKB”), as an investor in 37 RMBS trusts, filed a summons with notice in the Supreme Court of the State of New York, New York County, against DBNTC and DBTCA as trustees of the trusts. It appears that IKB may assert claims for violation of the TIA, violation of New York’s Streit Act, breach of contract, fraud, fraudulent and negligent misrepresentation, breach of fiduciary duty, negligence, and unjust enrichment. IKB appears to allege that DBNTC and DBTCA are liable for over U.S.$ 274 million of damages. Discovery has not yet commenced.

The Group believes a contingent liability exists with respect to these seven cases, but at present the amount of the contingent liability is not reliably estimable.

Precious Metals Investigations and Litigations. Deutsche Bank has received inquiries from certain regulatory and law enforcement authorities, including requests for information and documents, pertaining to investigations of precious metals trading and related conduct. Deutsche Bank is cooperating with these investigations and engaging with relevant authorities, as appropriate. Relatedly, Deutsche Bank has been conducting its own internal review of Deutsche Bank’s historic participation in the precious metals benchmarks and other aspects of its precious metals trading and precious metals business.

Deutsche Bank is also named as a defendant in several putative class action complaints, which have been consolidated in two lawsuits pending in the U. S. District Court for the Southern District of New York. The U.S. suits allege violations of U.S. antitrust law, the U.S. Commodity Exchange Act, and related state law arising out of the alleged manipulation of gold and silver prices through participation in the Gold and Silver Fixes, but do not specify the damages sought. The U.S. class action complaints are in the early stages. Deutsche Bank has filed motions to dismiss the U.S. complaints, which are still pending. In addition, Deutsche Bank has been named as a defendant in a Canadian class action proceeding in the Ontario Superior Court of Justice concerning gold. The Ontario statement of claim was issued on January 15, 2016, and plaintiffs seek damages for alleged violations of the Canadian Competition Act as well as other causes of action.

The Group has recorded provisions with respect to certain of these matters. The Group has not disclosed the amount of these provisions, nor has it disclosed whether it has established provisions with respect to others of these matters or any contingent liability with respect to any of these matters, because it has concluded that such disclosure can be expected to prejudice seriously their outcome.

Referral Hiring Practices Investigations. Certain regulators are investigating, among other things, Deutsche Bank’s compliance with the U.S. Foreign Corrupt Practices Act and other laws with respect to the Bank’s hiring practices related to candidates referred by clients, potential clients and government officials, and its engagement of consultants in the Asia/Pacific region. Deutsche Bank is responding to and continuing to cooperate with these investigations. The Group has recorded a provision with respect to certain of these regulatory investigations. The Group has not disclosed the amount of this provision because it has concluded that such disclosure can be expected to prejudice seriously the outcome of these regulatory investigations.

Russia/UK Equities Trading Investigation. Deutsche Bank is investigating the circumstances around equity trades entered into by certain clients with Deutsche Bank in Moscow and London that offset one another. The total volume of the transactions under review is significant. Deutsche Bank's internal investigation of potential violations of law, regulation and policy and into the related internal control environment remains ongoing; to date it has identified certain violations of Deutsche Bank’s policies and deficiencies in Deutsche Bank's control environment. Deutsche Bank has advised regulators and law enforcement authorities in several jurisdictions (including Germany, Russia, the U.K. and U.S.) of this investigation. Deutsche Bank has taken disciplinary measures with regards to certain individuals in this matter and will continue to do so with respect to others as warranted. The Group has recorded a provision with respect to this matter. The Group has not disclosed the amount of this provision because it has concluded that such disclosure can be expected to prejudice seriously the outcome of this matter.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    348
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

U.S. Embargoes-Related Matters. Deutsche Bank has received requests for information from certain U.S. regulatory and law enforcement agencies concerning its historical processing of U.S. dollar payment orders through U.S. financial institutions for parties from countries subject to U.S. embargo laws. These agencies are investigating whether such processing complied with U.S. federal and state laws. In 2006, Deutsche Bank voluntarily decided that it would not engage in new U.S. dollar business with counterparties in Iran, Sudan, North Korea and Cuba and with certain Syrian banks, and to exit existing U.S. dollar business with such counterparties to the extent legally possible. In 2007, Deutsche Bank decided that it would not engage in any new business, in any currency, with counterparties in Iran, Syria, Sudan and North Korea and to exit existing business, in any currency, with such counterparties to the extent legally possible; it also decided to limit its non-U.S. dollar business with counterparties in Cuba. On November 3, 2015, Deutsche Bank entered into agreements with the New York State Department of Financial Services and the Federal Reserve Bank of New York to resolve their investigations of Deutsche Bank. Deutsche Bank paid the two agencies U.S.$ 200 million and U.S.$ 58 million, respectively, and agreed to terminate certain employees, not rehire certain former employees and install an independent monitor for one year. In addition, the Federal Reserve Bank of New York ordered certain remedial measures, specifically, the requirement to ensure an effective OFAC compliance program and an annual review of such program by an independent party until the Federal Reserve Bank of New York is satisfied as to its effectiveness. The investigations of the U.S. law enforcement agencies remain ongoing.

The Group has not disclosed whether it has established a provision or contingent liability with respect to this matter because it has concluded that such disclosure can be expected to prejudice seriously its outcome.

U.S. Treasury Securities Investigations and Litigations. Deutsche Bank has received inquiries from certain regulatory and law enforcement authorities, including requests for information and documents, pertaining to U.S. Treasuries auctions, trading, and related market activity. Deutsche Bank is cooperating with these investigations.

Deutsche Bank Securities Inc. has been named as a defendant in several putative class action complaints filed in the U.S. District Courts for the Southern District of New York, the Northern District of Illinois, the Southern District of Alabama, and the District of the Virgin Islands alleging violations of U.S. antitrust law, the U.S. Commodity Exchange Act and common law related to the alleged manipulation of the U.S. Treasury securities market. These cases are in their early stages. The Judicial Panel on Multidistrict Litigation has centralized these cases in the Southern District of New York.

The Group has not disclosed whether it has established a provision or contingent liability with respect to these matters because it has concluded that such disclosure can be expected to prejudice seriously their outcome.

30 –

Credit related Commitments and Contingent Liabilities

Irrevocable lending commitments and lending related contingent liabilities

In the normal course of business the Group regularly enters into irrevocable lending commitments, including fronting commitments as well as contingent liabilities consisting of financial and performance guarantees, standby letters of credit and indemnity agreements on behalf of its customers. Under these contracts the Group is required to perform under an obligation agreement or to make payments to the beneficiary based on third party’s failure to meet its obligations. For these instruments it is not known to the Group in detail if, when and to what extent claims will be made. In the event that the Group has to pay out cash in respect of its fronting commitments, the Group would immediately seek reimbursement from the other syndicate lenders. The Group considers all the above instruments in monitoring the credit exposure and may require collateral to mitigate inherent credit risk. If the credit risk monitoring provides sufficient perception about a loss from an expected claim, a provision is established and recorded on the balance sheet.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
349   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

The following table shows the Group’s irrevocable lending commitments and lending related contingent liabilities without considering collateral or provisions. It shows the maximum potential utilization of the Group in case all these liabilities entered into must be fulfilled. The table therefore does not show the expected future cash flows from these liabilities as many of them will expire without being drawn and arising claims will be honored by the customers or can be recovered from proceeds of arranged collateral.

Irrevocable lending commitments and lending related contingent liabilities

in m.

  Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 2014    

Irrevocable lending commitments

    174,549          154,446     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Contingent liabilities

    57,325          62,087     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    231,874          216,533     

 

 

Government Assistance

In the course of its business, the Group regularly applies for and receives government support by means of Export Credit Agency (“ECA”) guarantees covering transfer and default risks for the financing of exports and investments into Emerging Markets and to a lesser extent, developed markets for Structured Trade & Export Finance and short-/medium-term Trade Finance business. Almost all export-oriented states have established such ECAs to support their domestic exporters. The ECAs act in the name and on behalf of the government of their respective country and are either constituted directly as governmental departments or organized as private companies vested with the official mandate of the government to act on its behalf. Terms and conditions of such ECA guarantees granted for short-term, mid-term and long-term financings are quite comparable due to the fact that most of the ECAs act within the scope of the Organisation for Economic Cooperation and Development (“OECD”) consensus rules. The OECD consensus rules, an intergovernmental agreement of the OECD member states, define benchmarks intended to ensure that a fair competition between different exporting nations will take place.

In some countries dedicated funding programs with governmental support are offered for ECA-covered financings. On a selective basis, the Group makes use of such programs. In certain financings, the Group also receives government guarantees from national and international governmental institutions as collateral to support financings in the interest of the respective governments. The majority of such ECA guarantees received by the Group were issued either by the Euler-Hermes Kreditversicherungs AG acting on behalf of the Federal Republic of Germany or by the Korean Export Credit Agencies (Korea Trade Insurance Corporation and The Export-Import Bank of Korea) acting on behalf of the Republic of Korea.

Irrevocable payment commitments with regard to levies

Irrevocable payment commitments related to bank levy according to Bank Recovery and Resolution Directive (BRRD) amounted to 160.2 million as of December 2015.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    350
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

31 –

Other Short-Term Borrowings

 

in m.

  Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 2014    

Other short-term borrowings:

   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Commercial paper

    9,327          14,787     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other

    18,683          28,144     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other short-term borrowings

    28,010          42,931     

 

 

32 –

Long-Term Debt and Trust Preferred Securities

Long-Term Debt by Earliest Contractual Maturity

in m.

  Due in  
2016  
    Due in  
2017  
    Due in  
2018  
    Due in  
2019  
    Due in  
2020  
    Due after  
2020  
    Total  
Dec 31,  
2015  
    Total  
Dec 31,  
2014  
 

Senior debt:

               

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Bonds and notes:

               

Fixed rate

    16,545          18,293          9,090          8,031          8,781          25,515          86,255          84,795     

Floating rate

    7,310          6,408          3,847          6,410          3,903          11,085          38,963          34,651     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Subordinated debt:

               

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Bonds and notes:

               

Fixed rate

    500          0          70          28          1,146          2,858          4,602          2,689     

Floating rate

    368          0          50          20          0          1,373          1,811          2,358     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other

    1,404          15,100          2,129          1,042          889          7,821          28,385          20,344     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total long-term debt

    26,129          39,801          15,186          15,530          14,719          48,652          160,016          144,837     

 

 

The Group did not have any defaults of principal, interest or other breaches with respect to its liabilities in 2015 and 2014.

Trust Preferred Securities1

in m.

  Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 2014    

Fixed rate

    6,067          8,662     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Floating rate

    953          1,912     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total trust preferred securities

    7,020          10,573     

 

 
1 

Perpetual instruments, redeemable at specific future dates at the Group’s option.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
351   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

33 –

Maturity Analysis of the earliest contractual undiscounted cash flows of Financial Liabilities

 

        Dec 31, 2015    

in m.

              On demand               Due within  
3 months  
         Due between  
3 and 12  
months  
    Due between  
    1 and 5 years  
                Due after  
5 years  
 
Noninterest bearing deposits       192,010          0          0          0          0     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Interest bearing deposits       153,788          156,710          42,680          15,382          12,004     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Trading liabilities 1       52,303          0          0          0          0     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Negative market values from derivative financial instruments 1       494,076          0          0          0          0     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss       18,450          25,067          3,964          4,357          5,985     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Investment contract liabilities 2       0          104          873          1,701          5,843     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Negative market values from derivative financial instruments qualifying for hedge accounting 3       0          556          918          1,908          2,983     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Central bank funds purchased       574          0          0          0          0     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Securities sold under repurchase agreements       7,498          1,919          519          0          0     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Securities loaned       2,818          16          0          1          414     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other short-term borrowings       17,782          2,771          6,865          0          0     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Long-term debt       62          16,834          12,414          92,914          52,169     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Trust preferred securities       0          831          628          5,772          1,285     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other financial liabilities       146,684          3,791          456          361          36     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Off-balance sheet loan commitments       166,236          0          0          0          0     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Financial guarantees       19,828          0          0          0          0     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total 4       1,272,109          208,600          69,317          122,396          80,719     

 

 
1 

Trading liabilities and derivatives not qualifying for hedge accounting balances are recorded at fair value. The Group believes that this best represents the cash flow that would have to be paid if these positions had to be closed out. Trading liabilities and derivatives not qualifying for hedge accounting balances are shown within “on demand” which Group’s management believes most accurately reflects the short-term nature of trading activities. The contractual maturity of the instruments may however extend over significantly longer periods.

2 

These are investment contracts where the policy terms and conditions result in their redemption value equaling fair value. See Note 41 “Insurance and Investment Contracts” for more detail on these contracts.

3 

Derivatives designated for hedge accounting are recorded at fair value and are shown in the time bucket at which the hedged relationship is expected to terminate.

4 

The balances in the table do not agree to the numbers in the Group’s balance sheet as the cash flows included in the table are undiscounted. This analysis represents the worst case scenario for the Group if the Group was required to repay all liabilities earlier than expected. The Group believes that the likelihood of such an event occurring is remote.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    352
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

        Dec 31, 2014    

in m.

              On demand               Due within  
3 months  
         Due between  
3 and 12  

months  
    Due between  
    1 and 5 years  
                Due after 
5 years 
 
Noninterest bearing deposits       160,733          0          0          0          0     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Interest bearing deposits       138,030          160,290          51,183          13,855          12,503     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Trading liabilities 1       41,843          0          0          0          0     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Negative market values from derivative financial instruments 1       610,202          0          0          0          0     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Financial liabilities designated at fair value through profit or loss       29,752          12,543          4,292          3,947          6,696     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Investment contract liabilities 2       0          91          847          1,586          5,999     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Negative market values from derivative financial instruments qualifying for hedge accounting 3       0          282          636          1,543          2,602     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Central bank funds purchased       986          0          0          0          0     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Securities sold under repurchase agreements       3,696          4,964          2,007          0          0     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Securities loaned       1,961          26          0          0          363     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other short-term borrowings       26,633          8,035          8,832          0          0     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Long-term debt       543          6,597          21,983          83,529          51,855     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Trust preferred securities       0          4,183          1,396          6,440          251     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other financial liabilities       155,066          4,011          477          372          23     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Off-balance sheet loan commitments       139,342          0          0          0          0     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Financial guarantees       22,344          0          0          0          0     

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total 4       1,331,132          201,023          91,653          111,271          80,292     

 

 
1 

Trading liabilities and derivatives not qualifying for hedge accounting balances are recorded at fair value. The Group believes that this best represents the cash flow that would have to be paid if these positions had to be closed out. Trading liabilities and derivatives not qualifying for hedge accounting balances are shown within “on demand” which Group’s management believes most accurately reflects the short-term nature of trading activities. The contractual maturity of the instruments may however extend over significantly longer periods.

2 

These are investment contracts where the policy terms and conditions result in their redemption value equalling fair value. See Note 41 “Insurance and Investment Contracts” for more detail on these contracts.

3 

Derivatives designated for hedge accounting are recorded at fair value and are shown in the time bucket at which the hedged relationship is expected to terminate.

4 

The balances in the table do not agree to the numbers in the Group’s balance sheet as the cash flows included in the table are undiscounted. This analysis represents the worst case scenario for the Group if the Group was required to repay all liabilities earlier than expected. The Group believes that the likelihood of such an event occurring is remote.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
353   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Additional Notes

34 –

Common Shares

Common Shares

Deutsche Bank’s share capital consists of common shares issued in registered form without par value. Under German law, each share represents an equal stake in the subscribed capital. Therefore, each share has a nominal value of  2.56, derived by dividing the total amount of share capital by the number of shares.

 

Number of shares

  Issued and  
fully paid  
    Treasury shares       Outstanding    

Common shares, January 1, 2014

    1,019,499,640          (171,904)         1,019,327,736     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Shares issued under share-based compensation plans

    0          0          0     

Capital increase

    359,773,491          0          359,773,491     

Shares purchased for treasury

    0          (310,846,161)         (310,846,161)    

Shares sold or distributed from treasury

    0          310,757,883          310,757,883     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Common shares, December 31, 2014

    1,379,273,131          (260,182)         1,379,012,949     

Shares issued under share-based compensation plans

    0          0          0     

Capital increase

    0          0          0     

Shares purchased for treasury

    0          (326,647,008)         (326,647,008)    

Shares sold or distributed from treasury

    0          326,532,326          326,532,326     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Common shares, December 31, 2015

    1,379,273,131          (374,864)         1,378,898,267     

 

 

There are no issued ordinary shares that have not been fully paid.

Shares purchased for treasury consist of shares held by the Group for a period of time, as well as any shares purchased with the intention of being resold in the short-term. In addition, the Group has bought back shares for equity compensation purposes. All such transactions were recorded in shareholders’ equity and no revenues and expenses were recorded in connection with these activities. Treasury stock held as of year-end will mainly be used for future share-based compensation.

Authorized Capital

The Management Board is authorized to increase the share capital by issuing new shares for cash and in some circumstances noncash consideration. As of December 31, 2015, Deutsche Bank AG had authorized but unissued capital of  1,760,000,000 which may be issued in whole or in part until April 30, 2020. Further details are governed by Section 4 of the Articles of Association.

 

Authorized capital       Consideration       Pre-emptive rights       Expiration date

 

   

 

   

 

   

 

352,000,000     Cash or noncash     May be excluded if the capital increase is for noncash consideration with the intent of acquiring a company or holdings in a company and may be excluded pursuant to Section 186 (3) sentence 4 of the Stock Corporation Act     April 30, 2020

 

   

 

   

 

   

 

 1,408,000,000     Cash     May be excluded insofar as is necessary to grant to the holders of option rights, convertible bonds and convertible participatory rights issued by the company (see Articles of Association Section 4)     April 30, 2020

 

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    354
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Conditional Capital

The Management Board is authorized to issue once or more than once, participatory notes that are linked with conversion rights or option rights and/or convertible bonds and/or bonds with warrants. The participatory notes, convertible bonds or bonds with warrants may also be issued by affiliated companies of Deutsche Bank AG. For this purpose share capital was increased conditionally upon exercise of these conversion and/or exchange rights or upon mandatory conversion.

 

Contingent capital

   Expiration date for the
issuance of conversion
and/or option rights

 230,400,000

   April 30, 2017

 

  

 

 256,000,000

   April 30, 2019

 

Dividends

The following table presents the amount of dividends proposed or declared for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively.

 

 

  2015  
(proposed)  
    2014        2013    

Cash dividends declared (in m.) 1

    0          1,034           765     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash dividends declared per common share (in )

    0.00          0.75           0.75     

 

 
1 

Cash dividend for 2015 is based on the number of shares issued as of December 31, 2015.

No dividends have been declared since the balance sheet date.

35 –

Employee Benefits

Share-Based Compensation Plans

The Group made grants of share-based compensation under the DB Equity Plan. This plan represents a contingent right to receive Deutsche Bank common shares after a specified period of time. The award recipient is not entitled to receive dividends during the vesting period of the award.

The share awards granted under the terms and conditions of the DB Equity Plan may be forfeited fully or partly if the recipient voluntarily terminates employment before the end of the relevant vesting period. Vesting usually continues after termination of employment in cases such as redundancy or retirement.

In countries where legal or other restrictions hinder the delivery of shares, a cash plan variant of the DB Equity Plan was used for granting awards.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
355   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

The following table sets forth the basic terms of these share plans.

 

Grant year(s)

  

Deutsch Bank Equity Plan

  

Vesting schedule

  

Early retirement provisions

  

Eligibility

2015/

2014/

2013

   Annual Award   

1/3: 12 months1

1/3: 24 months1

1/3: 36 months1

   Yes    Select employees as annual retention
     

 

  

 

  

 

      Or cliff vesting after 54 months1    Yes2    Members of Management Board or of Senior Management Group
  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

   Retention/New Hire    Individual specification    Yes    Select employees to attract and retain the best talent
  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

   Annual Award – Upfront    Vesting immediately at grant3    No    Regulated employees

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

2012/

2011

   Annual Award   

1/3: 12 months4

1/3: 24 months4

1/3: 36 months4

   Yes    Select employees as annual retention
  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

   Retention/New Hire    Individual specification    Yes    Select employees to attract and retain the best talent
  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

   Annual Award – Upfront    Vesting immediately at grant3    No    Regulated employees

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

2010

   Annual Award    Graded vesting in nine equal tranches between 12 months and 45 months    Yes    Select employees as annual retention
  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

      Or cliff vesting after 54 months    Yes    Select employees as annual retention
  

 

  

 

  

 

  

 

   Retention/New Hire    Individual specification    No    Select employees to attract and retain the best talent

 

1 

For members of the Management Board or of the Senior Management Group and all other regulated employees a further retention period of six months applies.

2 

Early retirement provisions do not apply to members of the Management Board.

3 

For members of the Management Board share delivery after a retention period of three years. For all other regulated employees share delivery after a retention period of six months.

4 

For members of the Management Board a different schedule applies. For all other regulated employees share delivery after a further retention period of six months.

Furthermore, the Group offers a broad-based employee share ownership plan entitled Global Share Purchase Plan (“GSPP”). The GSPP offers employees in specific countries the opportunity to purchase Deutsche Bank shares in monthly installments over one year. At the end of the purchase cycle, the bank matches the acquired stock in a ratio of one to one up to a maximum of ten free shares, provided that the employee remains at Deutsche Bank Group for another year. In total, about 19,000 staff from 28 countries enrolled in the seventh cycle that began in November 2015.

The Group has other local share-based compensation plans, none of which, individually or in the aggregate, are material to the consolidated financial statements.

The following table shows the outstanding share award units as of the respective dates, which represent a contingent right to receive Deutsche Bank common shares after a specified period of time. It also includes the grants under the cash plan variant of the DB Equity Plan.

 

 

   Share units  
(in thousands)  
     Weighted-average  
grant date fair  
value per unit  
 

Balance as of December 31, 2013

     51,291           € 33.61     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Balance as of December 31, 2014

     52,449           € 31.60     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Balance as of December 31, 2015

     53,651           € 28.18     

 

 
     

Share-based payment transactions resulting in a cash payment give rise to a liability, which amounted to approximately  19 million,  21 million and  32 million for the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    356
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

As of December 31, 2015, the grant volume of outstanding share awards was approximately  1.5 billion. Thereof,  1.0 billion had been recognized as compensation expense in the reporting year or prior to that. Hence, compensation expense for deferred share-based compensation not yet recognized amounted to  0.5 billion as of December 31, 2015.

In addition to the amounts shown in the table above, approximately 5.4 million shares were issued to plan participants in February 2016, resulting from the vesting of DB Equity Plan awards granted in prior years (thereof 0.2 million units under the cash plan variant of this DB Equity Plan).

Post-employment Benefit Plans

Nature of Plans

The Group sponsors a number of post-employment benefit plans on behalf of its employees, both defined contribution plans and defined benefit plans. The Group’s plans are accounted for based on the nature and substance of the plan. Generally, for defined benefit plans the value of a participant’s accrued benefit is based on each employee’s remuneration and length of service; contributions to defined contribution plans are typically based on a percentage of each employee’s remuneration. The rest of this note focuses predominantly on the Group’s defined benefit plans.

The Group’s defined benefit plans are primarily described on a geographical basis, reflecting differences in the nature and risks of benefits, as well as in the respective regulatory environments. In particular, the requirements set by local regulators can vary significantly and determine the design and financing of the benefit plans to a certain extent. Key information is also shown based on participant status, which provides a broad indication of the maturity of the Group’s obligations.

 

     Dec 31, 2015  
  

 

 

 

in m.

   Germany        UK        U.S.        Other        Total    

Defined benefit obligation related to

              

Active plan participants

     4,352           796           436           845           6,429     

Participants in deferred status

     1,883           2,350           538           196           4,967     

Participants in payment status

     4,548           1,177           533           300           6,558     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total defined benefit obligation

     10,783           4,323           1,507           1,341           17,954     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Fair value of plan assets

     10,371           5,322           1,182           1,210           18,085     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Funding ratio (in %)

     96           123           78           90           101     

 

 
            Dec 31, 2014  
  

 

 

 

in m.

   Germany        UK        U.S.        Other        Total    

Defined benefit obligation related to

              

Active plan participants

     4,611           813           405           780           6,609     

Participants in deferred status

     1,983           2,266           478           195           4,922     

Participants in payment status

     4,669           1,216           492           285           6,662     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total defined benefit obligation

     11,263           4,295           1,375           1,260           18,193     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Fair value of plan assets

     10,634           5,095           1,072           1,109           17,910     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Funding ratio (in %)

     94           119           78           88           98     

 

 

The majority of the Group’s defined benefit plan obligations relate to Germany, the United Kingdom and the United States. Within the other countries, the largest obligations relate to Switzerland and the Netherlands. In Germany and some continental European countries, post-employment benefits are usually agreed on a collective basis with respective employee works councils or their equivalent. The Group’s main pension plans are governed by boards of trustees, fiduciaries or their equivalent.

Post-employment benefits can form an important part of an employee’s total remuneration. The Group’s approach is that their design shall be attractive to employees in the respective market, but sustainable for the Group to provide over the longer term. At the same time, the Group tries to limit its risks related to provision of such benefits. Consequently the Group has moved to offer defined contribution plans in many locations over recent years.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
357   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

In the past the Group typically offered pension plans based on final pay prior to retirement. These types of benefits still form a significant part of the pension obligations for participants in deferred and payment status. Currently, in Germany and the United States, the main defined benefit pension plans for active staff are cash account type plans where the Group credits an annual amount to individuals’ accounts based on an employee’s current salary. Dependent on the plan rules, the accounts increase either at a fixed interest rate or participate in market movements of certain underlying investments to limit the investment risk for the Group. Sometimes, in particular in Germany, there is a guaranteed benefit amount within the plan rules, e.g. payment of at least the amounts contributed. Upon retirement, beneficiaries may usually opt for a lump sum or for conversion of the accumulated account balance into an annuity. This conversion is often based on market conditions and mortality assumptions at retirement. In the United Kingdom, the main defined benefit pension plan was redesigned in 2011 for active employees still eligible to the plan to reduce the overall long-term risk exposure to the Group.

The Group also sponsors retirement and termination indemnity plans in several countries, as well as some post-employment medical plans for a number of current and retired employees, mainly in the United States. The post-employment medical plans typically pay fixed percentages of medical expenses of eligible retirees after a set deductible has been met. In the United States, once a retiree is eligible for Medicare, the Group contributes to a Health Reimbursement Account and the retiree is no longer eligible for the Group’s medical program. The Group’s total defined benefit obligation for post-employment medical plans was  196 million and  197 million at December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, respectively. In combination with the benefit structure, these plans represent limited risk for the Group.

The following amounts of expected benefit payments from the Group’s defined benefit plans include benefits attributable to employees’ past and estimated future service, and include both amounts paid from the Group’s external pension trusts and paid directly by the Group in respect of unfunded plans.

 

in m.

   Germany        UK        U.S.        Other        Total    

Actual benefit payments 2015

     383           123           85           69           660     

Benefits expected to be paid 2016

     386           86           81           68           621     

Benefits expected to be paid 2017

     398           96           83           66           643     

Benefits expected to be paid 2018

     417           102           82           66           667     

Benefits expected to be paid 2019

     433           111           88           67           699     

Benefits expected to be paid 2020

     448           123           83           65           719     

Benefits expected to be paid 2021 – 2025

     2,516           776           449           350           4,091     

Weighted average duration of defined benefit obligation (in years)

     14           20           12           16           16     

 

 

Multi-employer Plans

In Germany, the Group is a member of the BVV together with other financial institutions. The BVV offers retirement benefits to eligible employees in Germany as a complement to post-employment benefit promises of the Group. Both employers and employees contribute on a regular basis to the BVV. The BVV provides annuities of a fixed amount to individuals on retirement and increases these fixed amounts if surplus assets arise within the plan. According to legislation in Germany, the employer is ultimately liable for providing the benefits to its employees. An increase in benefits may also arise due to additional obligations to retirees for the effects of inflation. BVV is a multi-employer defined benefit plan. However the Group accounts for it as a defined contribution plan since insufficient information is available to identify assets and liabilities relating to the Group’s current and former employees, primarily because the BVV does not fully allocate plan assets to beneficiaries nor to member companies. According to the BVV’s most recent disclosures, there is no current deficit in the plan that may affect the amount of future Group contributions. Furthermore, any plan surplus emerging in the future will be distributed to the plan members, hence it cannot reduce future Group contributions.

The Group’s expenses for defined contribution plans also include annual contributions by Deutsche Post-bank AG to the pension fund for postal civil servants in Germany. Responsibility for the liability for these benefits lies with the German government.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    358
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Governance and Risk

The Group maintains a Pensions Risk Committee to oversee its pension and related risks on a global basis. This Committee meets quarterly, reports directly to the Senior Executive Compensation Committee and is supported by the Pensions Operating Committee.

Within this context, the Group develops and maintains guidelines for governance and risk management, including funding, asset allocation and actuarial assumption setting. In this regard, risk management means the management and control of risks for the Group related to market developments (e.g., interest rate, credit spread, price inflation), asset investment, regulatory or legislative requirements, as well as monitoring demographic changes (e.g., longevity). In addition, the Group estimates and provides for uncertain income tax positions which may have an impact on the Group’s plan assets. Significant judgment is required in making these estimates and the Group’s final liabilities may ultimately be materially different. Especially during and after acquisitions or changes in the external environment (e.g., legislation, taxation), topics such as the general plan design or potential plan amendments are considered. Any plan changes follow a process requiring approval by Group Human Resources. To the extent that pension plans are funded, the assets held mitigate some of the liability risks, but introduce investment risk.

In the Group’s key pension countries, the Group’s largest post-employment benefit plan risk exposures relate to potential changes in credit spreads, price inflation and longevity, although these have been partially mitigated through the investment strategy adopted.

Overall, the Group seeks to minimize the impact of pensions on the Group’s financial position from market movements, subject to balancing the trade-offs involved in financing post-employment benefits, regulatory capital and constraints from local funding or accounting requirements. The Group measures its pension risk exposures on a regular basis using specific metrics developed by the Group for this purpose.

Funding

The Group maintains various external pension trusts to fund the majority of its defined benefit plan obligations. The Group’s funding policy is to maintain coverage of the defined benefit obligation by plan assets within a range of 90 % to 100 % of the obligation, subject to meeting any local statutory requirements. The Group has also determined that certain plans should remain unfunded, although their funding approach is subject to periodic review, e.g. when local regulations or practices change. Obligations for the Group’s unfunded plans are accrued on the balance sheet.

For most of the externally funded defined benefit plans there are minimum funding requirements. The Group can decide on any additional plan contributions, with reference to the Group’s funding policy. There are some locations, e.g. the United Kingdom, where the trustees and the Bank jointly agree contribution levels. In most countries the Group expects to receive an economic benefit from any plan surpluses of plan assets compared to defined benefit obligations, typically by way of reduced future contributions. Given the broadly fully funded position and the investment strategy adopted in the Group’s key funded defined benefit plans, any minimum funding requirements that may apply are not expected to place the Group under any material adverse cash strain in the short term. For example, in the United Kingdom and the United States, the main plan funding contributions in these countries are expected to be immaterial to the Group overall in 2016. In Germany, no minimum funding requirements typically apply, however the Group will consider reimbursements for benefits paid from the Group’s assets as cash contributions into the external pension trusts during the year, with reference to the Group’s funding policy.

For post-retirement medical plans, the Group accrues for obligations over the period of employment and pays the benefits from Group assets when the benefits become due.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
359   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Actuarial Methodology and Assumptions

December 31 is the measurement date for all plans. All plans are valued by independent qualified actuaries using the projected unit credit method. A Group policy provides guidance to local actuaries on setting actuarial assumptions to ensure consistency globally.

The key actuarial assumptions applied in determining the defined benefit obligations at December 31 are presented below in the form of weighted averages.

 

    Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 2014    

 

  Germany       UK       U.S.1       Other       Germany       UK       U.S.1       Other    
Discount rate (in %)     2.4          3.9          4.2           2.6          2.0          3.7          3.9           2.3     
Rate of price inflation (in %)     1.6          3.4          2.3           2.2          1.5          3.4          2.2           2.0     
Rate of nominal increase in future compensation levels (in %)     2.1          4.4          2.3           2.5          2.0          4.4          2.2           2.6     
Rate of nominal increase for pensions in payment (in %)     1.5          3.3          2.3           1.1          1.4          3.2          2.2           1.2     
Assumed life expectancy at age 65                

For a male aged 65 at measurement date

    19.0          23.5          21.8           21.6          18.9          23.7          21.7           21.5     

For a female aged 65 at measurement date

    23.1          25.0          24.0           24.1          22.9          25.3          23.9           24.1     

For a male aged 45 at measurement date

    21.6          25.1          23.5           23.4          21.5          25.4          23.4           23.2     

For a female aged 45 at measurement date

    25.6          26.9          25.6           25.8          25.5          27.1          25.6           25.7     
Mortality tables applied    
 
 
Richttafeln  
Heubeck  
2005G  
  
  
  
   
 
 
 
SAPS Light  
with CMI  
2015  
projections  
  
  
  
  
   
 
RP2014   
Aggregate   
  
  
   
 
 
Country  
specific  
tables  
  
  
  
   
 
 
Richttafeln  
Heubeck  
2005G  
  
  
  
   
 
 
 
SAPS  
Light with  
CMI 2013  
projections  
  
  
  
  
   
 
RP2014   
Aggregate   
  
  
   
 
 
Country  
specific  
tables  
  
  
  

 

 
1 

Cash balance interest crediting rate in line with the 30-year US government bond yield.

For the Group’s most significant plans in the key countries, the discount rate used at each measurement date is set based on a high quality corporate bond yield curve – derived based on bond universe information sourced from reputable third-party index providers and rating agencies – reflecting the timing, amount and currency of the future expected benefit payments for the respective plan. For longer durations where limited bond information is available, reasonable yield curve extrapolation methods are applied using respective actual swap rates and credit spread assumptions. Consistent discount rates are used across all plans in each currency zone, based on the assumption applicable for the Group’s largest plan(s) in that zone. For plans in the other countries, the discount rate is based on high quality corporate or government bond yields applicable in the respective currency, as appropriate at each measurement date with a duration broadly consistent with the respective plan’s obligations.

The price inflation assumptions in the eurozone and the United Kingdom are set with reference to market measures of inflation based on inflation swap rates in those markets at each measurement date. For other countries, the price inflation assumptions are typically based on long term forecasts by Consensus Economics Inc.

The assumptions for the increases in future compensation levels and for increases to pensions in payment are developed separately for each plan, where relevant. Each is set based on the price inflation assumption and reflecting the Group’s reward structure or policies in each market, as well as relevant local statutory and plan-specific requirements.

Among other assumptions, mortality assumptions can be significant in measuring the Group’s obligations under its defined benefit plans. These assumptions have been set in accordance with current best practice in the respective countries. Future potential improvements in longevity have been considered and included where appropriate.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    360
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Reconciliation in Movement of Liabilities and Assets – Impact on Financial Statements

 

     2015     

in m.

   Germany         UK         U.S.         Other         Total     

Change in the present value of the defined benefit obligation:

              

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Balance, beginning of year

     11,263            4,295            1,375            1,260            18,193      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Defined benefit cost recognized in Profit & Loss

              

Current service cost

     202            30            24            61            317      

Interest cost

     224            170            58            29            481      

Past service cost and gain or loss arising from settlements

     4            4            0            1            9      

Defined benefit cost recognized in Other Comprehensive Income

              

Actuarial gain or loss arising from changes in financial assumptions

     (551)           (143)           (39)           (50)           (783)     

Actuarial gain or loss arising from changes in demographic assumptions

     0            (66)           0            0            (66)     

Actuarial gain or loss arising from experience

     22            (103)           15            (9)           (75)     

Cash flow and other changes

              

Contributions by plan participants

     3            0            0            13            16      

Benefits paid

     (383)           (123)           (85)           (69)           (660)     

Payments in respect to settlements

     0            0            0            0            0      

Acquisitions/Divestitures

     0            0            0            0            0      

Exchange rate changes

     0            259            159            54            472      

Other 1

     (1)           0            0            51            50      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Balance, end of year

     10,783            4,323            1,507            1,341            17,954      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

thereof:

              

Unfunded

     2            14            203            114            333      

Funded

     10,781            4,309            1,304            1,227            17,621      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Change in fair value of plan assets:

              

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Balance, beginning of year

     10,634            5,095            1,072            1,109            17,910      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Defined benefit cost recognized in Profit & Loss

              

Interest income

     213            201            45            26            485      

Defined benefit cost recognized in Other Comprehensive Income

              

Return from plan assets less interest income

     (463)           (152)           (49)           (41)           (705)     

Cash flow and other changes

              

Contributions by plan participants

     3            0            0            13            16      

Contributions by the employer

     367            2            64            51            484      

Benefits paid 2

     (383)           (122)           (72)           (47)           (624)     

Payments in respect to settlements

     0            0            0            0            0      

Acquisitions/Divestitures

     0            0            0            0            0      

Exchange rate changes

     0            304            124            49            477      

Other 1

     0            0            0            51            51      

Plan administration costs

     0            (6)           (2)           (1)           (9)      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Balance, end of year

     10,371            5,322            1,182            1,210            18,085      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Funded status, end of year

     (412)           999            (325)           (131)           131      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Change in irrecoverable surplus (asset ceiling)

              

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Balance, beginning of year

     0            0            0            0            0      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Interest cost

     0            0            0            0            0      

Changes in irrecoverable surplus

     0            0            0            0            0      

Exchange rate changes

     0            0            0            0            0      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Balance, end of year

     0            0            0            0            0      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
              

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net asset (liability) recognized

     (412)           999            (325)           (131)           131 3      

 

 
1 

Includes the opening balance of a plan in India for which defined contribution plan accounting was applied before

2 

For funded plans only.

3 

Thereof recognized  1,161 million in Other assets and  1,030 million in Other liabilities.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
361   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

 

     2014     

in m.

   Germany         UK         U.S.         Other         Total     

Change in the present value of the defined benefit obligation:

              

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Balance, beginning of year

     9,487            3,588            1,136            1,022            15,233      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Defined benefit cost recognized in Profit & Loss

              

Current service cost

     163            28            21            53            265      

Interest cost

     330            166            55            35            586      

Past service cost and gain or loss arising from settlements

     13            1            0            17            31      

Defined benefit cost recognized in Other Comprehensive Income

              

Actuarial gain or loss arising from changes in financial assumptions

     1,883            405            35            184            2,507      

Actuarial gain or loss arising from changes in demographic assumptions

     0            0            50            (1)            49      

Actuarial gain or loss arising from experience

     26            (22)            (5)            6            5      

Cash flow and other changes

              

Contributions by plan participants

     4            0            0            13            17      

Benefits paid

     (379)            (79)            (75)            (72)            (605)      

Payments in respect to settlements

     0            0            0            (10)            (10)      

Acquisitions/Divestitures1

     (265)            (57)            0            (15)            (337)      

Exchange rate changes

     0            265            158            25            448      

Other2

     1            0            0            3            4      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Balance, end of year

     11,263            4,295            1,375            1,260            18,193      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

thereof:

              

Unfunded

     0            15            197            122            334      

Funded

     11,263            4,280            1,178            1,138            17,859      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Change in fair value of plan assets:

              

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Balance, beginning of year

     9,142            4,099            856            921            15,018      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Defined benefit cost recognized in Profit & Loss

              

Interest income

     322            189            41            32            584      

Defined benefit cost recognized in Other Comprehensive Income

              

Return from plan assets less interest income

     1,334            621            44            126            2,125      

Cash flow and other changes

              

Contributions by plan participants

     4            0            0            13            17      

Contributions by the employer

     449            3            76            46            574      

Benefits paid3

     (378)            (78)            (65)            (39)            (560)      

Payments in respect to settlements

     0            0            0            0            0      

Acquisitions/Divestitures1

     (238)            (43)            0            (14)            (295)      

Exchange rate changes

     0            307            122            24            453      

Other

     0            0            0            0            0      

Plan administration costs

     (1)            (3)            (2)            0            (6)      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Balance, end of year

     10,634            5,095            1,072            1,109            17,910      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Funded status, end of year

     (629)            800            (303)            (151)            (283)      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Change in irrecoverable surplus (asset ceiling)

              

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Balance, beginning of year

     0            0            0            (29)            (29)      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Interest cost

     0            0            0            (1)           (1)      

Changes in irrecoverable surplus

     0            0            0            30            30      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Balance, end of year

     0            0            0            0            0      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
              

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net asset (liability) recognized

     (629)            800            (303)            (151)           (283) 4     

 

 
1 

BHF-Bank, Tilney.

2 

Includes opening balances of first time application of smaller plans.

3 

For funded plans only.

4 

Thereof recognized  952 million in Other assets and  1,235 million in Other liabilities.

There are no reimbursement rights for the Group.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    362
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Investment Strategy

The Group’s investment objective is to protect the Group from adverse impacts of changes in the funding position of its defined benefit pension plans on key financial metrics, with a primary focus on immunizing the plans’ IFRS funded status, while taking into account the plans’ impact on other metrics, such as regulatory capital and local profit & loss accounts. Investment mandates allow for risk-taking through duration mismatches and asset class diversification with respect to the relevant investment benchmark.

To achieve the primary objective of immunizing the IFRS funded status of key defined benefit plans, the Group applies a liability driven investment (LDI) approach. Risks from mismatches between fluctuations in the present value of the defined benefit obligations and plan assets due to capital market movements are minimized, subject to balancing relevant trade-offs. This is achieved by allocating plan assets closely to the market risk factor exposures of the pension liability to interest rates, credit spreads and inflation. Thereby, plan assets broadly reflect the underlying risk profile and currency of the pension obligations. For pension plans where a full LDI approach may impact adversely other key financial metrics important to the Group’s overall financial position, the Group may deviate from this primary investment strategy. In 2015, the Group decided to adjust temporarily the investment strategy for the German main pension plan assets by reducing the interest rate and credit spread hedges. The Group closely monitors this divergence from the primary investment strategy and has put in place governance mechanisms to ensure a regular review of the deviation from the LDI approach.

Where the desired hedging level for these risks cannot be achieved with physical instruments (i.e., corporate and government bonds), derivatives are employed. Derivative overlays mainly include interest rate and inflation swaps. Other instruments are also used, such as credit default swaps and interest rate futures. In practice, a completely hedged approach is impractical, for instance because of insufficient market depth for ultra-long-term corporate bonds, as well as liquidity and cost considerations. Therefore, plan assets contain further asset categories to create long-term return enhancement and diversification benefits such as equity, real estate, high yield bonds or emerging markets bonds.

Plan asset allocation to key asset classes

The following table shows the asset allocation of the Group’s funded defined benefit plans to key asset classes, i.e., exposures include physical securities in discretely managed portfolios and underlying asset allocations of any commingled funds used to invest plan assets.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
363   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Asset amounts in the following table include both “quoted” (i.e., Level 1 assets in accordance with IFRS 13 –amounts invested in markets where the fair value can be determined directly from prices which are quoted in active, liquid markets) and “other” (i.e., Level 2 and 3 assets in accordance with IFRS 13) assets.

 

     Dec 31, 2015        Dec 31, 2014    

in m.

   Germany        UK        U.S.        Other        Total        Germany        UK        U.S.        Other        Total    

Cash and cash equivalents

     1,230           138           27           86           1,481           1,056           102           25           68           1,251     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Equity instruments1

     961           648           113           272           1,994           134           560           108           208           1,010     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Investment-grade bonds2

                             

Government

     3,659           1,918           524           287           6,388           3,517           1,502           400           255           5,674     

Non-government bonds

     4,271           2,456           400           346           7,473           5,731           2,035           447           358           8,571     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Non-investment-grade bonds

                             

Government

     125           0           0           11           136           54           0           0           14           68     

Non-government bonds

     277           79           8           19           383           215           109           12           30           366     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Structured products

     35           259           45           12           351           14           389           42           29           474     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Insurance

     1           0           0           14           15           0           0           0           17           17     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Alternatives

                             

Real estate

     189           137           0           39           365           114           117           0           35           266     

Commodities

     0           7           0           8           15           25           0           0           2           27     

Private equity

     51           0           0           0           51           51           0           0           0           51     

Other

     347           38           0           100           485           56           0           0           33           89     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Derivatives (Market Value)

                             

Interest rate

     (811)          (60)          65           21           (785)          482           409           38           73           1,002     

Credit

     (11)          0           0           0           (11)          (27)          (1)          0           (1)          (29)    

Inflation

     0           (245)          0           (8)          (253)          (763)          (214)          0           (12)          (989)    

Foreign exchange

     42           (6)          0           2           38           (51)          40           0           (1)          (12)    

Other

     5           (47)          0           1           (41)          26           47           0           1           74     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Total fair value of plan assets      10,371           5,322           1,182           1,210           18,085           10,634           5,095           1,072           1,109           17,910     

 

 
1 

Allocation of equity exposure is broadly in line with the typical index in the respective market, e.g. the equity portfolio’s benchmark of the UK retirement benefit plans is the MSCI All Countries World Index.

2 

Investment-grade means BBB and above. Average credit rating exposure for the Group’s main plans is around A.

The following table sets out the Group’s funded defined benefit plan assets only invested in “quoted” assets, i.e., Level 1 assets in accordance with IFRS 13.

 

     Dec 31, 2015        Dec 31, 2014    

in m.

   Germany        UK        U.S.        Other        Total        Germany        UK        U.S.        Other        Total    

Cash and cash equivalents

     1,209           138           29           68           1,444           1,056           100           14           50           1,220     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Equity instruments

     961           648           113           272           1,994           131           560           108           206           1,005     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Investment-grade bonds

                             

Government

     1,883           1,917           522           183           4,505           2,255           1,502           0           182           3,939     

Non-government bonds

     0           0           0           0           0           26           1,887           0           84           1,997     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Non-investment-grade bonds

                             

Government

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0           14           14     

Non-government bonds

     0           0           0           0           0           78           97           0           3           178     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Structured products

     0           259           0           11           270           0           368           0           29           397     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Insurance

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Alternatives

                             

Real estate

     0           0           0           0           0           9           68           0           0           77     

Commodities

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

Private equity

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0     

Other

     108           0           0           6           114           0           0           0           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Derivatives (Market Value)

                             

Interest rate

     0           0           17           (1)          16           0           0           0           13           13     

Credit

     0           0           0           0           0           (27)          (1)          0           0           (28)    

Inflation

     0           0           0           0           0           0           0           0           (3)          (3)    

Foreign exchange

     42           (6)          0           2           38           0           40           0           0           40     

Other

     5           0           0           1           6           0           0           0           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Total fair value of quoted plan assets      4,208           2,956         681           542           8,387           3,528           4,621           122           578           8,849     

 

 
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    364
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

All the remaining assets are invested in “other” assets, the majority of which are invested in Level 2 assets in accordance with IFRS 13, being primarily investment-grade corporate bonds. A relatively small element overall is in Level 3 assets in accordance with IFRS 13, being primarily real estate, insurance policies and derivative contracts.

The following tables show the asset allocation of the “quoted” and other defined benefit plan assets by key geography in which they are invested.

 

     Dec 31, 2015    

in m.

   Germany        United  
Kingdom  
     United  
States  
     Other  
Eurozone  
    Other  
developed  
countries  
     Emerging  
markets  
     Total    

Cash and cash equivalents

     35           147           66           1,183          26           24           1,481     

Equity instruments

     256           137           859           236          375           131           1,994     
Government bonds (investment-grade and above)      1,842           1,895           535           1,446          209           461           6,388     
Government bonds (non-investment-grade)      0           0           0           4          4           128           136     
Non-government bonds (investment-grade and above)      427           1,838           2,184           2,081 1      864           79           7,473     
Non-government bonds (non-investment-grade)      19           48           168           107          29           12           383     

Structured products

     34           219           42           39          16           1           351     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Subtotal

     2,613           4,284           3,854           5,096          1,523           836           18,206     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Share (in %)

     14           24           21           28          8           5           100     

Other asset categories

                      (121)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Fair value of plan assets

                      18,085     

 

 
1 

Majority of this amount relates to bonds of French, Italian and Dutch corporate bonds.

 

     Dec 31, 2014    

in m.

   Germany        United  
Kingdom  
     United  
States  
     Other  
Eurozone  
    Other  
developed  
countries  
     Emerging  
markets  
     Total    

Cash and cash equivalents

     1,052           106           57           7          9           20           1,251     

Equity instruments

     75           84           415           174          168           94           1,010     
Government bonds (investment-grade and above)      2,089           1,457           628           933          82           485           5,674     
Government bonds (non-investment-grade)      0           0           0           0          0           68           68     
Non-government bonds (investment-grade and above)      473           1,644           2,302           3,106 1      688           358           8,571     
Non-government bonds (non-investment-grade)      18           76           91           132          17           32           366     

Structured products

     14           409           36           13          2           0           474     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
                   

Subtotal

     3,721           3,776           3,529           4,365          966           1,057           17,414     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Share (in %)

     21           22           20           25          6           6           100     

Other asset categories

                      496     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Fair value of plan assets

                      17,910     

 

 
1 

Majority of this amount relates to bonds of French, Italian and Dutch corporate bonds.

Plan assets at December 31, 2015 include derivative transactions with Group entities with a negative market value of around  793 million. There is neither a material amount of securities issued by the Group nor other claims on Group assets included in the fair value of plan assets. The plan assets do not include any real estate which is used by the Group.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
365   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Key Risk Sensitivities

The Group’s defined benefit obligations are sensitive to changes in capital market conditions and actuarial assumptions. Sensitivities to capital market movements and key assumption changes are presented in the following table. Each market risk factor or assumption is changed in isolation. Sensitivities of the defined benefit obligations are approximated using geometric extrapolation methods based on plan durations for the respective assumption. Duration is a risk measure that indicates the broad sensitivity of the obligations to a change in an underlying assumption and provides a reasonable approximation for small to moderate changes in those assumptions.

For example, the discount rate duration is derived from the change in the defined benefit obligation to a change in the discount rate based on information provided by the local actuaries of the respective plans. The resulting duration is used to estimate the remeasurement liability loss or gain from changes in the discount rate. For other assumptions, a similar approach is used to derive the respective sensitivity results.

For defined benefit pension plans where the Group applies a LDI approach, changes in capital market conditions will impact the plan obligations via actuarial assumptions – mainly discount rate and price inflation rate – as well as the plan assets. Consequently, to aid understanding of the Group’s risk exposures related to key capital market movements, the net impact of the change in the defined benefit obligations and plan assets due to a change of the related market risk factor or underlying actuarial assumption is shown; for sensitivities to changes in actuarial assumptions that do not impact the plan assets, only the impact on the defined benefit obligations is shown.

Asset-related sensitivities are derived for the Group’s major plans by using risk sensitivity factors determined by the Group’s Market Risk Management function. These sensitivities are calculated based on information provided by the plans’ investment managers and extrapolated linearly to reflect the approximate change of the plan assets’ market value in case of a change in the underlying risk factor.

The sensitivities illustrate plausible variations over time in capital market movements and key actuarial assumptions. The Group is not in a position to provide a view on the likelihood of these capital market or assumption changes. While these sensitivities illustrate the overall impact on the funded status of the changes shown, the significance of the impact and the range of reasonable possible alternative assumptions may differ between the different plans that comprise the aggregated results. Even though plan assets and plan obligations are sensitive to similar risk factors, actual changes in plan assets and obligations may not fully offset each other due to imperfect correlations between market risk factors and actuarial assumptions. Caution should be used when extrapolating these sensitivities due to non-linear effects that changes in capital market conditions and key actuarial assumptions may have on the overall funded status. Any management actions that may be taken to mitigate the inherent risks in the post-employment defined benefit plans are not reflected in these sensitivities.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    366
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

     Dec 31, 2015        Dec 31, 2014    

in m.

   Germany        UK        U.S.        Other        Germany        UK        U.S.        Other    

Discount rate (–100 bp):

                       

(Increase) in DBO

     (1,610)          (920)          (90)          (215)          (1,740)          (950)          (90)          (220)    

Expected increase in plan assets1

     660           1,025           80           125           1,525           925           75           115     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Expected net impact on funded status (de-) increase

     (950)          105           (10)          (90)          (215)          (25)          (15)          (105)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Discount rate (+100 bp):

                       

Decrease in DBO

     1,395           760           85           180           1,505           775           85           180     

Expected (decrease) in plan assets1

     (660)          (1,025)          (80)          (125)          (1,525)          (925)          (75)          (115)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Expected net impact on funded status (de-) increase

     735           (265)          5           55           (20)          (150)          10           65     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Credit spread (–100 bp):

                       

(Increase) in DBO

     (1,610)          (920)          (190)          (230)          (1,740)          (950)          (180)          (230)    

Expected increase in plan assets1

     465           250           50           40           880           225           45           40     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Expected net impact on funded status (de-) increase

     (1,145)          (670)          (140)          (190)          (860)          (725)          (135)          (190)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Credit spread (+100 bp):

                       

Decrease in DBO

     1,395           760           170           190           1,505           775           160           190     

Expected (decrease) in plan assets1

     (465)          (250)          (50)          (40)          (880)          (225)          (45)          (40)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Expected net impact on funded status (de-) increase

     930           510           120           150           625           550           115           150     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Rate of price inflation (–50 bp):2

                       

Decrease in DBO

     305           340           0           50           350           330           0           75     

Expected (decrease) in plan assets1

     (215)          (355)          0           (10)          (245)          (290)          0           (10)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Expected net impact on funded status (de-) increase

     90           (15)          0           40           105           40           0           65     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Rate of price inflation (+50 bp):2

                       

(Increase) in DBO

     (315)          (370)          0           (55)          (365)          (355)          0           (80)    

Expected increase in plan assets1

     215           355           0           10           245           290           0           10     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Expected net impact on funded status (de-) increase

     (100)          15           0           (45)          (120)          (65)          0           (70)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Rate of real increase in future compensation levels (–50 bp):                        

Decrease in DBO, net impact on funded status

     70           15           0           15           80           15           0           15     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Rate of real increase in future compensation levels (+50 bp):                        

(Increase) in DBO, net impact on funded status

     (70)          (15)          0           (15)          (80)          (15)          0           (15)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Longevity improvements by 10 %:3

                       

(Increase) in DBO, net impact on funded status

     (260)          (110)          (25)          (25)          (275)          (85)          (25)          (20)    

 

 
1 

Expected changes in the fair value of plan assets contain the simulated impact from the biggest plans in Germany, the UK, the U.S., Channel Islands, Switzerland, the Netherlands and Belgium which cover over 99 % of the total fair value of plan assets. The fair value of plan assets for other plans is assumed to be unchanged for this presentation.

2 

Incorporates sensitivity to changes in nominal increase for pensions in payment to the extent linked to the price inflation assumption.

3 

Estimated to be equivalent to an increase of around 1 year in overall life expectancy.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
367   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Expected cash flows

The following table shows expected cash flows for post-employment benefits in 2016, including contributions to the Group’s external pension trusts in respect of funded plans, direct payment to beneficiaries in respect of unfunded plans, as well as contributions to defined contribution plans.

 

                 2016    

in m.

   Total    

Expected contributions to

  

Defined benefit plan assets

     275     

BVV

     55     

Pension fund for Postbank's postal civil servants

     95     

Other defined contribution plans

     265     

Expected benefit payments for unfunded defined benefit plans

     30     

 

  

 

 

 

Expected total cash flow related to post-employment benefits

     720     

 

 

Expense of employee benefits

The following table presents a breakdown of specific expenses according to the requirements of IAS 19 and IFRS 2 respectively.

 

in m.

               2015                    2014                    2013    

Expenses for defined benefit plans:

        

Service cost

     326           296           261     

Net interest cost (income)

     (4)           3           10     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total expenses defined benefit plans

     322           299           271     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Expenses for defined contribution plans:

        

BVV

     53           51           51     

Pension fund for Postbank’s postal civil servants

     95           97           97     

Other defined contribution plans

     264           228           221     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total expenses for defined contribution plans

     412           376           369     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total expenses for post-employment benefit plans

     734           675           640     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Employer contributions to mandatory German social security pension plan

     231           229           230     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Expenses for share-based payments, equity settled1

     816           860           918     

Expenses for share-based payments, cash settled1

     15           11           29     

Expenses for cash retention plans1

     738           815           811     

Expenses for severance payments2

     184           205           274     

 

 
1 

Including expenses for new hire awards and the acceleration of expenses not yet amortized due to the discontinuation of employment including those amounts which are recognized as part of the Group’s restructuring expenses.

2 

Excluding the acceleration of expenses for deferred compensation awards not yet amortized.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    368
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

36 –

Income Taxes

 

in m.

               2015                    2014                    2013    

Current tax expense (benefit):

        

Tax expense (benefit) for current year

     1,385           764           913     

Adjustments for prior years

     277           (12)           41     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total current tax expense (benefit)

     1,662           752           954     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deferred tax expense (benefit):

        

Origination and reversal of temporary difference, unused tax losses and tax credits

     (378)           644           7     

Effect of changes in tax law and/or tax rate

     140           44           35     

Adjustments for prior years

     (749)           (15)           (221)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total deferred tax expense (benefit)

     (987)           673           (179)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total income tax expense (benefit)

     675           1,425           775     

 

 

Income tax expense includes policyholder tax attributable to policyholder earnings, amounting to an income tax benefit of 0.4 million in 2015, an income tax expense of  2 million in 2014 and an income tax expense of  23 million in 2013.

Total current tax expense includes benefits from previously unrecognized tax losses, tax credits and deductible temporary differences, which reduced the current tax expense by  3 million in 2015. These effects reduced the current tax expense by  5 million and by 3 million in 2014 and 2013, respectively.

Total deferred tax benefit includes benefits from previously unrecognized tax losses (tax credits/deductible temporary differences) and the reversal of previous write-downs of deferred tax assets and expenses arising from write-downs of deferred tax assets, which decreased the deferred tax benefit by  187 million in 2015. In 2014 these effects reduced the deferred tax expense by  303 million and increased the deferred tax benefit by  237 million in 2013.

Difference between applying German statutory (domestic) income tax rate and actual income tax expense

 

in m.

               2015                    2014                    2013    
Expected tax expense at domestic income tax rate of 31 %      (1,890)           966           451     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Foreign rate differential      (157)           88           154     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Tax-exempt gains on securities and other income      (345)           (371)           (337)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Loss (income) on equity method investments      (21)           (93)           (84)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Nondeductible expenses      1,288           649           571     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Impairments of goodwill      1,407           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Changes in recognition and measurement of deferred tax assets1      184           (308)           (240)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Effect of changes in tax law and/or tax rate      140           44           35     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Effect related to share-based payments      (5)           78           (5)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Effect of policyholder tax      0           (2)           23     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Other1      74           374           207     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Actual income tax expense (benefit)      675           1,425           775     

 

 
1 

Current and deferred tax expense/(benefit) relating to prior years are mainly reflected in the line items “Changes in recognition and measurement of deferred tax assets” and “Other”.

The Group is under continuous examinations by tax authorities in various jurisdictions. In 2015, 2014 and 2013 “Other” in the preceding table mainly includes the effects of these examinations by the tax authorities.

The domestic income tax rate, including corporate tax, solidarity surcharge, and trade tax, used for calculating deferred tax assets and liabilities was 31 % for the years 2015, 2014 and 2013.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
369   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Income taxes charged or credited to equity (other comprehensive income/additional paid in capital)

in m.

               2015                    2014                    2013    
Actuarial gains/losses related to defined benefit plans      (213)           407           58     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Financial assets available for sale:         

Unrealized net gains/losses arising during the period

     104           (457)           (21)     

Net gains/losses reclassified to profit or loss

     10           5           103     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Derivatives hedging variability of cash flows:         

Unrealized net gains/losses arising during the period

     3           (7)           (58)     

Net gains/losses reclassified to profit or loss

     (6)           (146)           (10)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Other equity movement:         

Unrealized net gains/losses arising during the period

     (90)           (68)           (175)     

Net gains/losses reclassified to profit or loss

     (2)           1           1     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Income taxes (charged) credited to other comprehensive income      (194)           (265)           (102)     

 

 
Other income taxes (charged) credited to equity      72           (21)           65     

 

 

Major components of the Group’s gross deferred tax assets and liabilities

in m.

    Dec 31, 2015          Dec 31, 2014     

Deferred tax assets:

   

Unused tax losses

    3,477          2,785     

Unused tax credits

    215          192     

Deductible temporary differences:

   

Trading activities

    7,748          8,454     

Property and equipment

    468          459     

Other assets

    1,640          2,382     

Securities valuation

    92          93     

Allowance for loan losses

    982          1,020     

Other provisions

    1,310          811     

Other liabilities

    1,028          838     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total deferred tax assets pre offsetting

    16,960          17,034     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Deferred tax liabilities:

   

Taxable temporary differences:

   

Trading activities

    7,446          7,746     

Property and equipment

    64          52     

Other assets

    954          832     

Securities valuation

    523          1,628     

Allowance for loan losses

    50          71     

Other provisions

    351          233     

Other liabilities

    556          782     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total deferred tax liabilities pre offsetting

    9,944          11,344     

 

 

Deferred tax assets and liabilities, after offsetting

in m.

  Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 2014    

Presented as deferred tax assets

    7,762          6,865     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Presented as deferred tax liabilities

    746          1,175     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net deferred tax assets

    7,016          5,690     

 

 

The change in the balance of deferred tax assets and deferred tax liabilities does not equal the deferred tax expense/(benefit). This is due to (1) deferred taxes that are booked directly to equity, (2) the effects of exchange rate changes on tax assets and liabilities denominated in currencies other than euro, (3) the acquisition and disposal of entities as part of ordinary activities and (4) the reclassification of deferred tax assets and liabilities which are presented on the face of the balance sheet as components of other assets and liabilities.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    370
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Items for which no deferred tax assets were recognized

in m.

     Dec 31, 2015 1          Dec 31, 2014 1    

Deductible temporary differences

     (277)          (314)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Not expiring

     (4,372)          (3,745)    

Expiring in subsequent period

     (2)          (4)    

Expiring after subsequent period

     (1,067)          (1,334)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Unused tax losses

     (5,441)          (5,083)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Expiring after subsequent period

     (95)          (88)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Unused tax credits

     (97)          (88)    

 

 
1 

Amounts in the table refer to deductible temporary differences, unused tax losses and tax credits for federal income tax purposes.

Deferred tax assets were not recognized on these items because it is not probable that future taxable profit will be available against which the unused tax losses, unused tax credits and deductible temporary differences can be utilized.

As of December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, the Group recognized deferred tax assets of  5.0 billion and  5.5 billion, respectively, that exceed deferred tax liabilities in entities which have suffered a loss in either the current or preceding period. This is based on management’s assessment that it is probable that the respective entities will have taxable profits against which the unused tax losses, unused tax credits and deductible temporary differences can be utilized. Generally, in determining the amounts of deferred tax assets to be recognized, management uses historical profitability information and, if relevant, forecasted operating results, based upon approved business plans, including a review of the eligible carry-forward periods, tax planning opportunities and other relevant considerations.

As of December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, the Group had temporary differences associated with the Group’s parent company’s investments in subsidiaries, branches and associates and interests in joint ventures of  93 million and  134 million respectively, in respect of which no deferred tax liabilities were recognized.

37 –

Derivatives

Derivative Financial Instruments and Hedging Activities

Derivative contracts used by the Group include swaps, futures, forwards, options and other similar types of contracts. In the normal course of business, the Group enters into a variety of derivative transactions for both trading and risk management purposes. The Group’s objectives in using derivative instruments are to meet customers’ risk management needs and to manage the Group’s exposure to risks.

In accordance with the Group’s accounting policy relating to derivatives and hedge accounting as described in Note 1 “Significant Accounting Policies and Critical Accounting Estimates”, all derivatives are carried at fair value in the balance sheet regardless of whether they are held for trading or nontrading purposes.

Derivatives held for Trading Purposes

Sales and Trading

The majority of the Group’s derivatives transactions relate to sales and trading activities. Sales activities include the structuring and marketing of derivative products to customers to enable them to take, transfer, modify or reduce current or expected risks. Trading includes market-making, positioning and arbitrage activities. Market-making involves quoting bid and offer prices to other market participants, enabling revenue to be generated based on spreads and volume. Positioning means managing risk positions in the expectation of benefiting from favorable movements in prices, rates or indices. Arbitrage involves identifying and profiting from price differentials between markets and products.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
371   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Risk Management

The Group uses derivatives in order to reduce its exposure to market risks as part of its asset and liability management. This is achieved by entering into derivatives that hedge specific portfolios of fixed rate financial instruments and forecast transactions as well as strategic hedging against overall balance sheet exposures. The Group actively manages interest rate risk through, among other things, the use of derivative contracts. Utilization of derivative financial instruments is modified from time to time within prescribed limits in response to changing market conditions, as well as to changes in the characteristics and mix of the related assets and liabilities.

Derivatives qualifying for Hedge Accounting

The Group applies hedge accounting if derivatives meet the specific criteria described in Note 1 “Significant Accounting Policies and Critical Accounting Estimates”.

Fair Value Hedge Accounting

The Group enters into fair value hedges, using primarily interest rate swaps and options, in order to protect itself against movements in the fair value of fixed-rate financial instruments due to movements in market interest rates.

 

     Dec 31, 2015        Dec 31, 2014    
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

in m.

   Assets       Liabilities        Assets        Liabilities    

Derivatives held as fair value hedges

     2,671         986           3,679           2,136     

 

 

For the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, a loss of 1.1 billion, a gain of  1.0 billion and a loss of  2.4 billion, respectively, were recognized on the hedging instruments. For the same periods, the results on the hedged items, which were attributable to the hedged risk, were a gain of 1.0 billion, a loss of  1.3 billion and a gain of  1.7 billion.

Cash Flow Hedge Accounting

The Group enters into cash flow hedges, using interest rate swaps and equity index swaps, in order to protect itself against exposure to variability in interest rates and equities.

 

     Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 2014    

in m.

   Assets       Liabilities        Assets        Liabilities    

Derivatives held as cash flow hedges

     239         0           234           0     

 

 

Periods when hedged cash flows are expected to occur and when they are expected to affect the income statement

in m.

   Within 1 year      1–3 years      3–5 years      Over 5 years   

As of December 31, 2015

        

Cash inflows from assets

     32        49        0        0   

Cash outflows from liabilities

     (20 )       (33 )       (26 )       (15 )  

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash flows 2015

     12        16        (26     (15

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2014

        

Cash inflows from assets

     23        35        5        0   

Cash outflows from liabilities

     (21 )       (35 )       (28 )       (25 )  

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash flows 2014

     2        0        (23     (25

 

 
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    372
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Cash Flow Hedge Balances

in m.

   Dec 31, 2015      Dec 31, 2014      Dec 31, 2013   

Reported in Equity 1

     138        118        (215

thereof relates to terminated programs

     (14     (15     (16

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gains (losses) posted to equity for the year ended

     1        (6     91   

Gains (losses) removed from equity for the year ended

     (20     (339     (35

Ineffectiveness recorded within P&L

     (1     (3     1   

 

 
1 

Reported in equity refers to accumulated other comprehensive income as presented in the Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income.

As of December 31, 2015 the longest term cash flow hedge matures in 2022.

Net Investment Hedge Accounting

Using foreign exchange forwards and swaps, the Group enters into hedges of translation adjustments resulting from translating the financial statements of net investments in foreign operations into the reporting currency of the parent at period end spot rates.

 

     Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 2014   

in m.

   Assets       Liabilities       Assets       Liabilities   

Derivatives held as net investment hedges

     226         5,379         490         2,927   

 

 

For the years ended December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, losses of 425 million,  357 million and  320 million, respectively, were recognized due to hedge ineffectiveness which includes the forward points element of the hedging instruments.

38 –

Related Party Transactions

Parties are considered to be related if one party has the ability to directly or indirectly control the other party or exercise significant influence over the other party in making financial or operational decisions. The Group’s related parties include:

 

 

key management personnel, close family members of key management personnel and entities which are controlled, significantly influenced by, or for which significant voting power is held by key management personnel or their close family members,

 

subsidiaries, joint ventures and associates and their respective subsidiaries, and

 

post-employment benefit plans for the benefit of Deutsche Bank employees.

Transactions with Key Management Personnel

Key management personnel are those persons having authority and responsibility for planning, directing and controlling the activities of Deutsche Bank, directly or indirectly. The Group considers the members of the Management Board and of the Supervisory Board of the parent company to constitute key management personnel for purposes of IAS 24.

Compensation expense of key management personnel

in m.

   2015        2014        2013    

Short-term employee benefits

     31           26           18     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Post-employment benefits

     6           4           3     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other long-term benefits

     11           7           6     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Termination benefits

     20           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Share-based payment

     15           5           8     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     83           42           35     

 

 

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
373   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

The above mentioned table does not contain compensation that employee representatives and former board members on the Supervisory Board have received. The aggregated compensation paid to such members for their services as employees of Deutsche Bank or status as former employees (retirement, pension and deferred compensation) amounted to 1.1 million as of December 31, 2015,  1.1 million as of December 31, 2014 and  1 million as of December 31, 2013.

Among the Group’s transactions with key management personnel as of December 31, 2015 were loans and commitments of  11 million and deposits of  8 million. As of December 31, 2014, the Group’s transactions with key management personnel were loans and commitments of  3 million and deposits of  16 million.

In addition, the Group provides banking services, such as payment and account services as well as investment advice, to key management personnel and their close family members.

Transactions with Subsidiaries, Joint Ventures and Associates

Transactions between Deutsche Bank AG and its subsidiaries meet the definition of related party transactions. If these transactions are eliminated on consolidation, they are not disclosed as related party transactions. Transactions between the Group and its associated companies and joint ventures and their respective subsidiaries also qualify as related party transactions.

Loans

in m.

     2015           2014     

Loans outstanding, beginning of year

     321           357     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Loans issued during the year

     464           596     

Loan repayment during the year

     376           657     

Changes in the group of consolidated companies

     (31)           (1)     

Exchange rate changes/other

     18           27     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Loans outstanding, end of year1

     396           321     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other credit risk related transactions:

     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Allowance for loan losses

     1           5     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Provision for loan losses

     0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Guarantees and commitments

     263           45     

 

 
1 

Loans past due were 4 million as of December 31, 2015 and 3 million as of December 31, 2014. For the above loans the Group held collateral of  69 million and  70 million as of December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, respectively.

Deposits

in m.

     2015           2014     

Deposits outstanding, beginning of year

     128           167     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deposits received during the year

     326           245     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deposits repaid during the year

     295           244     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Changes in the group of consolidated companies

     (0)           (43)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Exchange rate changes/other

     2           4     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deposits outstanding, end of year1

     162           128     

 

 
1 

The deposits are unsecured.

Other Transactions

Trading assets and positive market values from derivative financial transactions with associated companies amounted to  32 million as of December 31, 2015 and  87 million as of December 31, 2014. Trading liabilities and negative market values from derivative financial transactions with associated companies amounted to  0 million as of December 31, 2015 and  0 million as of December 31, 2014.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    374
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Other transactions with related parties also reflected the following:

Hua Xia Bank: The Group holds a stake of 19.99 % in Hua Xia Bank Company Limited and has accounted for this associate under the equity method since February 11, 2011. The investment has been reclassified from equity method to held for sale as per December 31, 2015. In 2006, Deutsche Bank and Hua Xia Bank jointly established a credit card business cooperation combining the international know-how of Deutsche Bank AG in the credit card business and local expertise of Hua Xia Bank. A provision has been recognized for the cooperation with an amount of 54 million as per December 31, 2015. This provision captures the Group’s estimated obligation from the cooperation. Further details are included in Note 26 “Non-Current Assets and Disposal Groups Held for Sale”.

Transactions with Pension Plans

Under IFRS, certain post-employment benefit plans are considered related parties. The Group has business relationships with a number of its pension plans pursuant to which it provides financial services to these plans, including investment management services. The Group’s pension funds may hold or trade Deutsche Bank shares or securities.

Transactions with related party pension plans

in m.

   2015        2014    

Equity shares issued by the Group held in plan assets

     0           6     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other assets

     0           73     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Fees paid from plan assets to asset managers of the Group

     41           31     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Market value of derivatives with a counterparty of the Group

     (793)          (255)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Notional amount of derivatives with a counterparty of the Group

     10,516           11,806     

 

 

39 –

Information on Subsidiaries

Composition of the Group

Deutsche Bank AG is the direct or indirect holding company for the Group’s subsidiaries.

The Group consists of 1,217 (2014: 1,485) consolidated entities, thereof 545 (2014: 756) consolidated structured entities. 796 (2014: 869) of the entities controlled by the Group are directly or indirectly held by the Group at 100 % of the ownership interests (share of capital). Third parties also hold ownership interests in 421 (2014: 616) of the consolidated entities (noncontrolling interests). As of December 31, 2014 and 2015, the noncontrolling interests are neither individually nor cumulatively material to the Group.

Significant restrictions to access or use the Group’s assets

Statutory, contractual or regulatory requirements as well as protective rights of noncontrolling interests might restrict the ability of the Group to access and transfer assets freely to or from other entities within the Group and to settle liabilities of the Group.

Since the Group did not have any material noncontrolling interests at the balance sheet date, any protective rights associated with these did not give rise to significant restrictions.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
375   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

The following restrictions impact the Group’s ability to use assets:

 

 

The Group has pledged assets to collateralize its obligations under repurchase agreements, securities financing transactions, collateralized loan obligations and for margining purposes for OTC derivative liabilities.

 

The assets of consolidated structured entities are held for the benefit of the parties that have bought the notes issued by these entities.

 

Assets held by insurance subsidiaries are primarily held to satisfy the obligations to the companies’ policy holders.

 

Regulatory and central bank requirements or local corporate laws may restrict the Group’s ability to transfer assets to or from other entities within the Group in certain jurisdictions.

Restricted assets

     Dec 31, 2015        Dec 31, 2014    

in m.

   Total  
assets  
     Restricted  
assets  
     Total  
assets  
    Restricted  
assets  
 

Interest-earning deposits with banks

     78,263           2,190           63,518          1,254     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial assets at fair value through profit or loss

     820,883           79,222           942,924          82,612     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial assets available for sale

     73,583           11,046           64,297          10,638     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loans

     427,749           46,352           405,612          51,450     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other

     239,441           9,294           232,352          9,506     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     1,629,130           148,105           1,708,703         155,460     

 

 

The table above excludes assets that are not encumbered at an individual entity level but which may be subject to restrictions in terms of their transferability within the Group. Such restrictions may be based on local connected lending requirements or similar regulatory restrictions. In this situation, it is not feasible to identify individual balance sheet items that cannot be transferred. This is also the case for regulatory minimum liquidity requirements. The Group identifies the volume of liquidity reserves in excess of local stress liquidity outflows. The aggregate amount of such liquidity reserves that are considered restricted for this purpose is 19.7 billion as of December 31, 2015 (as of December 31, 2014:  32.4  billion).

40 –

Structured Entities

Nature, purpose and extent of the Group’s interests in structured entities

The Group engages in various business activities with structured entities which are designed to achieve a specific business purpose. A structured entity is one that has been set up so that any voting rights or similar rights are not the dominant factor in deciding who controls the entity. An example is when voting rights relate only to administrative tasks and the relevant activities are directed by contractual arrangements.

A structured entity often has some or all of the following features or attributes:

 

 

Restricted activities;

 

A narrow and well defined objective;

 

Insufficient equity to permit the structured entity to finance its activities without subordinated financial support;

 

Financing in the form of multiple contractually linked instruments to investors that create concentrations of credit or other risks (tranches).

The principal uses of structured entities are to provide clients with access to specific portfolios of assets and to provide market liquidity for clients through securitizing financial assets. Structured entities may be established as corporations, trusts or partnerships. Structured entities generally finance the purchase of assets by issuing debt and equity securities that are collateralized by and/or indexed to the assets held by the structured entities. The debt and equity securities issued by structured entities may include tranches with varying levels of subordination.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    376
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Structured entities are consolidated when the substance of the relationship between the Group and the structured entities indicate that the structured entities are controlled by the Group, as discussed in Note 1 “Significant Accounting Policies and Critical Accounting Estimates”.

Consolidated structured entities

The Group has contractual arrangements which may require it to provide financial support to the following types of consolidated structured entities.

Securitization vehicles

The Group uses securitization vehicles for funding purchase of diversified pool of assets. The Group provides financial support to these entities in the form of liquidity facility. As of December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014, there were outstanding loan commitments to these entities for 251 million and 2 billion respectively.

Funds

The Group may provide funding and liquidity facility or guarantees to funds consolidated by the group. As of December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014 notional value of the liquidity facilities and guarantees provided by the group to such funds was 13.4 billion and 28 billion.

Unconsolidated structured entities

These are entities which are not consolidated because the Group does not control them through voting rights, contract, funding agreements, or other means. The extent of the Group’s interests to unconsolidated structured entities will vary depending on the type of structured entities.

Below is a description of the Group’s involvements in unconsolidated structured entities by type.

Repackaging and investment entities

Repackaging and investment entities are established to meet clients’ investment needs through the combination of securities and derivatives. These entities are not consolidated by the Group because the Group does not have power to influence the returns obtained from the entities. These entities are usually set up to provide a certain investment return pre-agreed with the investor, and the Group is not able to change the investment strategy or return during the life of the transaction.

Third party funding entities

The Group provides funding to structured entities that hold a variety of assets. These entities may take the form of funding entities, trusts and private investment companies. The funding is collateralized by the asset in the structured entities. The group’s involvement involves predominantly both lending and loan commitments.

The vehicles used in these transactions are controlled by the borrowers where the borrowers have the ability to decide whether to post additional margin or collateral in respect of the financing. In such cases, where borrowers can decide to continue or terminate the financing, the borrowers will consolidate the vehicle.

Securitization Vehicles

The Group establishes securitization vehicles which purchase diversified pools of assets, including fixed income securities, corporate loans, and asset-backed securities (predominantly commercial and residential mortgage-backed securities and credit card receivables). The vehicles fund these purchases by issuing multiple tranches of debt and equity securities, the repayment of which is linked to the performance of the assets in the vehicles.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
377   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

The Group often transfers assets to these securitization vehicles and provide financial support to these entities in the form of liquidity facilities.

The Group also invests and provides liquidity facilities to third party sponsored securitization vehicles.

The securitization vehicles that are not consolidated into the Group are those where the Group does not hold the power or ability to unilaterally remove the servicer or special servicer who has been delegated power over the activities of the entity.

Funds

The Group establishes structured entities to accommodate client requirements to hold investments in specific assets. The Group also invests in funds that are sponsored by third parties. A group entity may act as fund manager, custodian or some other capacity and provide funding and liquidity facilities to both group sponsored and third party funds. The funding provided is collateralized by the underlying assets held by the fund.

The Group does not consolidate funds when Deutsche Bank is deemed agent or when another third party investor has the ability to direct the activities of the fund.

Other

These are Deutsche Bank sponsored or third party structured entities that do not fall into any criteria above. These entities are not consolidated by the Group when the Group does not hold power over the decision making of these entities.

Income derived from involvement with structured entities

The Group earns management fees and, occasionally, performance-based fees for its investment management service in relation to funds. Interest income is recognized on the funding provided to structured entities. Any trading revenue as a result of derivatives with structured entities and from the movements in the value of notes held in these entities is recognized in ‘Net gains/losses on financial assets/liabilities held at fair value through profit and loss’.

Interests in unconsolidated structured entities

The Group’s interests in unconsolidated structured entities refer to contractual and non-contractual involvement that exposes the Group to variability of returns from the performance of the structured entities. Examples of interests in unconsolidated structured entities include debt or equity investments, liquidity facilities, guarantees and certain derivative instruments in which the Group is absorbing variability of returns from the structured entities.

Interests in unconsolidated structured entities exclude instruments which introduce variability of returns into the structured entities. For example, when the Group purchases credit protection from an unconsolidated structured entity whose purpose and design is to pass through credit risk to investors, the Group is providing the variability of returns to the entity rather than absorbing variability. The purchased credit protection is therefore not considered as an interest for the purpose of the table below.

Maximum Exposure to unconsolidated structured entities

The maximum exposure to loss is determined by considering the nature of the interest in the unconsolidated structured entity. The maximum exposure for loans and trading instruments is reflected by their carrying amounts in the consolidated balance sheet. The maximum exposure for derivatives and off balance sheet commitments such as guarantees, liquidity facilities and loan commitments under IFRS 12, as interpreted by the Group, is reflected by the notional amounts. Such amounts do not reflect the economic risks faced by the Group because they do not take into account the effects of collateral or hedges nor the probability of such losses being incurred. At December 31, 2015, the notional related to the positive and negative replacement values of derivatives and off balance sheet commitments were 255 billion, 606 billion and 31 billion respectively. At December 31, 2014, the notional related to the positive and negative replacement values of derivatives and off balance sheet commitments were 301 billion, 615 billion and 32 billion respectively.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    378
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Size of structured entities

The Group provides a different measure for size of structured entities depending on their type. The following measures have been considered as appropriate indicators for evaluating the size of structured entities:

 

 

Funds – Net asset value or asset under management where the Group holds fund units and notional of derivatives when the Group’s interest comprises of derivatives.

 

Securitizations – notional of notes in issue when the Group derives its interests through notes its holds and notional of derivatives when the Group’s interests is in the form of derivatives.

 

Third party funding entities –Total assets in entities

 

Repackaging and investment entities – Fair value of notes in issue

For Third party funding entities, size information is not publicly available, therefore the Group has disclosed the greater of the collateral the Group has received/pledged or the notional of the exposure the Group has to the entity.

The following table shows, by type of structured entity, the carrying amounts of the Group’s interests recognized in the consolidated statement of financial position as well as the maximum exposure to loss resulting from these interests. It also provides an indication of the size of the structured entities. The carrying amounts presented below do not reflect the true variability of returns faced by the Group because they do not take into account the effects of collateral or hedges.

Carrying amounts and size relating to Deutsche Bank’s interests

 

     Dec 31, 2015    

in m.

   Repacka-  
ging and  
Investment  
Entities  
     Third Party  
Funding  
Entities  
     Securiti-  
zations  
     Funds        Total    

Assets

              

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Cash and central bank balances 1      0           0           0           0           0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Interbank balances (w/o central banks) 1      18           0           110           422           550     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Central bank funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements      0           0           20           1,445           1,465     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Securities Borrowed

     0           0           66           23,045           23,111     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total financial assets at fair value through profit or loss

     1,924           3,106           14,203           66,109           85,455     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Trading assets

     1,256           1,339           13,886           18,709           35,3032     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Positive market values (derivative financial instruments)

     619           114           94           6,525           7,352     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss

     48           1,653           223           40,876           42,800     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Financial assets available for sale

     0           421           568           1,722           2,711     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Loans

     135           34,340           25,026           20,958           80,459     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other assets

     103           2,150           565           18,365           21,182     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total assets

     2,179           40,017           40,558           132,065           214,9322     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Liabilities

              

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss

     319           150           669           9,961           11,099     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Negative market values (derivative financial instruments)

     319           150           669           9,961           11,099     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     319           150           669           9,961           11,099     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Off-balance sheet exposure

     2           7,724           9,408           13,459           30,7102     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     1,863           47,591           49,297           135,563           234,544     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
              

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Size of structured entity

     10,607           63,187           1,417,316           2,694,148        

 

 
1 

From December 31, 2015 onwards Cash and due from banks changed to Cash and central bank balances and Interest-earning deposits with banks changed to Interbank balances (w/o central banks).

2 

Includes 113 million for total assets and 116 million for off-balance sheet exposure for entity type Others.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
379   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

 

     Dec 31, 2014    

in m.

   Repacka-  
ging and  
Investment  
Entities  
     Third Party  
Funding  
Entities  
    Securiti-  
zations  
     Funds        Total    

Assets

             

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Interest-earning deposits with banks      0           13 1        0           405           419     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Central bank funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements      0           0          0           1,599           1,599     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Securities Borrowed

     0           0          0           17,367           17,367     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total financial assets at fair value through profit or loss

     1,292           6,875          21,282           65,934           95,384     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Trading assets

     963           4,315          21,108           13,419           39,805     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Positive market values (derivative financial instruments)

     329           703          143           8,789           9,963     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss

     0           1,858          31           43,726           45,616     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Financial assets available for sale

     0           410          875           1,418           2,703     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Loans

     77           32,553          16,250           15,671           64,551     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other assets

     11           87          2,280           21,447           23,824     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total assets

     1,380           39,938          40,687           123,842           205,846     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
             

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Liabilities

             

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss

     225           626          579           16,968           18,398     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Negative market values (derivative financial instruments)

     225           626          579           16,968           18,398     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     225           626          579           16,968           18,398     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Off-balance sheet exposure

     3           3,064          1,268           27,699           32,035     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     1,158           42,376          41,375           134,572           219,483     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
             

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Size of structured entity

     10,938           98,197          3,044,623           3,695,476        

 

 
1 

Includes 13 million of Cash and due from banks.

Trading assets – Total trading assets as of December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014 of 35.3 billion and  39.8 billion are comprised primarily of 13.8 billion and 21.1 billion in Securitizations and  18.7 billion and  13.4 billion in Funds structured entities respectively. The Group’s interests in securitizations are collateralized by the assets contained in these entities. Where the Group holds fund units these are typically in regards to market making in funds or otherwise serve as hedges for notes issued to clients. Moreover the credit risk arising from loans made to Third party funding structured entities is mitigated by the collateral received.

Financial assets designated at fair value through profit or loss – Reverse repurchase agreements to Funds comprise the majority of the interests in this category and are collateralized by the underlying securities.

Loans – Loans as of December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014 consists of 80.4 billion and 64.6 billion investment in securitization tranches and financing to Third party funding entities. The Group’s financing to Third party funding entities is collateralized by the assets in those structured entities.

Other assets – Other assets as of December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014 of 21.2 billion and  23.8 billion, respectively, consists primarily of prime brokerage receivables and cash margin balances.

Pending Receivables – Pending Receivable balances are not included in this disclosure note due to the fact that these balances arise from typical customer supplier relationships out of e.g. brokerage type activities and their inherent volatility would not provide users of the financial statements with effective information about Deutsche Bank’s exposures to structured entities.

Financial Support

Deutsche Bank did not provide non-contractual support during the year to unconsolidated structured entities.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    380
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Sponsored Unconsolidated Structured Entities where the Group has no interest as of December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014.

As a sponsor, the Group is involved in the legal set up and marketing of the entity and supports the entity in different ways, namely:

 

 

transferring assets to the entities

 

providing seed capital to the entities

 

providing operational support to ensure the entity’s continued operation

 

providing guarantees of performance to the structured entities.

The Group is also deemed a sponsor for a structured entity if market participants would reasonably associate the entity with the Group. Additionally, the use of the Deutsche Bank name for the structured entity indicates that the Group has acted as a sponsor.

The gross revenues from sponsored entities where the Group did not hold an interest as of December 31, 2015 and December 31, 2014 were 20.2 million and 166 million respectively. Instances where the Group does not hold an interest in an unconsolidated sponsored structured entity include cases where any seed capital or funding to the structured entity has already been repaid in full to the Group during the year. This amount does not take into account the impacts of hedges and is recognized in Net gains/losses on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit and loss. The aggregated carrying amounts of assets transferred to sponsored unconsolidated structured entities in 2015 were 981 million for securitization and 281 million for repackaging and investment entities. In 2014, they were 469 million for securitization and 1.9 billion for repackaging and investment entities.

41 –

Insurance and Investment Contracts

Liabilities arising from Insurance and Investment Contracts

 

      Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 2014    

in m.

   Gross        Reinsurance        Net       Gross        Reinsurance        Net    

Insurance contracts

     4,921           (78)          4,843          4,750           (67)          4,683     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Investment contracts

     8,522           0           8,522          8,523           0           8,523     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     13,443           (78)          13,365         13,273           (67)          13,206     

 

 

Generally, amounts relating to reinsurance contracts are reported gross unless they have an immaterial impact on their respective balance sheet line items.

Carrying Amount

The following table presents an analysis of the change in insurance and investment contracts liabilities.

 

      2015        2014    

in m.

   Insurance  
contracts  
     Investment  
contracts  
     Insurance  
contracts  
     Investment  
contracts  
 

Balance, beginning of year

     4,750           8,523           4,581           8,067     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

New business

     120           48           158           52     

Claims/withdrawals paid

     (426)          (708)          (427)          (544)    

Other changes in existing business

     195           191           118           429     

Exchange rate changes

     282           468           320           519     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Balance, end of year

     4,921           8,522           4,750           8,523     

 

 

Other changes in existing business for the investment contracts of  191 million and  429 million are principally attributable to changes in the fair value of underlying assets for the years ended December 31, 2015 and 2014, respectively.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
381   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

As of December 31, 2015 the Group had insurance contract liabilities of  4.9 billion. Of this, 2.8 billion represents traditional annuities in payment, 1.7 billion universal life contracts and 431 million unit linked pension contracts with guaranteed annuity rates. Guaranteed annuity rates give the policyholder the option, on retirement, to take up a traditional annuity at a rate that was fixed at the inception of the policy. The liability of  431 million for unit linked pension contracts with guaranteed annuity rates is made up of the unit linked liability of  283 million and a best estimate reserve of 148 million for the guaranteed annuity rates. The latter is calculated using the differential between the fixed and best estimate rate, the size of the unit linked liability and an assumption on take up rate.

As of December 31, 2014 the Group had insurance contract liabilities of 4.8 billion. Of this,  2.5 billion represents traditional annuities in payment, 1.8 billion universal life contracts and 444 million unit linked pension contracts with guaranteed annuity rates (made up of a unit linked liability of 288 million and a best estimate reserve of 156 million for the guaranteed annuity rates).

Key Assumptions in relation to Insurance Business

The liabilities will vary with movements in interest rates, which are applicable, in particular, to the cost of guaranteed benefits payable in the future, investment returns and the cost of life assurance and annuity benefits where future mortality is uncertain.

Assumptions are made related to all material factors affecting future cash flows, including future interest rates, mortality and costs. The assumptions to which the long term business amount is most sensitive are the interest rates used to discount the cash flows and the mortality assumptions, particularly those for annuities.

The assumptions are set out below:

Interest Rates

Interest rates are used that reflect a best estimate of future investment returns taking into account the nature and term of the assets used to support the liabilities. Suitable margins for default risk are allowed for in the assumed interest rate.

Mortality

Mortality rates are based on published tables, adjusted appropriately to take into account changes in the underlying population mortality since the table was published, company experience and forecast changes in future mortality. If appropriate, a margin is added to assurance mortality rates to allow for adverse future deviations. Annuitant mortality rates are adjusted to make allowance for future improvements in pensioner longevity. Improvements in annuitant mortality are based on 100 % of the Continuous Mortality Investigation 2014 mortality improvement tables with an ultimate rate of improvement of 1 % per annum.

Costs

For non-linked contracts, allowance is made explicitly for future expected per policy costs.

Other Assumptions

The take-up rate of guaranteed annuity rate options on pension business is assumed to be 63 % for the year ended December 31, 2015 and 67 % for the year ended December 31, 2014.

Key Assumptions impacting Value of Business Acquired (VOBA)

On acquisition of insurance businesses, the excess of the purchase price over the acquirer’s interest in the net fair value of the identifiable assets, liabilities and contingent liabilities is accounted for as an intangible

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    382
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

asset. This intangible asset represents the present value of future cash flows over the reported liability at the date of acquisition. This is known as value of business acquired (“VOBA”).

The VOBA is amortized at a rate determined by considering the profile of the business acquired and the expected depletion in its value. The VOBA acquired is reviewed regularly for any impairment in value and any reductions are charged as an expense to the consolidated statement of income.

The opening VOBA arising on the purchase of Abbey Life Assurance Company Limited was determined by capitalizing the present value of the future cash flows of the business over the reported liability at the date of acquisition. If assumptions were required about future mortality, morbidity, persistency and expenses, they were determined on a best estimate basis taking into account the business’s own experience. General economic assumptions were set considering the economic indicators at the date of acquisition.

The rate of VOBA amortization is determined by considering the profile of the business acquired and the expected depletion in future value. At the end of each accounting period, the remaining VOBA is tested against the future net profit expected related to the business that was in force at the date of acquisition.

If there is insufficient net profit, the VOBA will be written down to its supportable value.

Key Changes in Assumptions

Upon acquisition of Abbey Life Assurance Company Limited in October 2007, liabilities for insurance contracts were recalculated from a regulatory basis to a best estimate basis in line with the provisions of IFRS 4. The non-economic assumptions set at that time have not been changed but the economic assumptions have been reviewed in line with changes in key economic indicators. For annuity contracts, the liability was valued using the locked-in basis determined at the date of acquisition.

Sensitivity Analysis (in respect of Insurance Contracts only)

The following table presents the sensitivity of the Group’s profit before tax and equity to changes in some of the key assumptions used for insurance contract liability calculations. For each sensitivity test, the impact of a reasonably possible change in a single factor is shown with other assumptions left unchanged.

 

     Impact on profit before tax            Impact on equity    

in m.

   2015        2014                2015                2014    

Variable:

           

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Mortality (worsening by ten percent)1

     (10)          (10)          (8)          (8)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Renewal expense (ten percent increase)

     (1)          (1)          (1)          (1)    

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Interest rate (one percent increase)

     7           8           (194)          (185)    

 

 
1 

The impact of mortality assumes a ten percent decrease in annuitant mortality and a ten percent increase in mortality for other business.

For certain insurance contracts, the underlying valuation basis contains a Provision for Adverse Deviations (“PADs”). For these contracts any worsening of expected future experience would not change the level of reserves held until all the PADs have been eroded while any improvement in experience would not result in an increase to these reserves. Therefore, in the sensitivity analysis, if the variable change represents a worsening of experience, the impact shown represents the excess of the best estimate liability over the PADs held at the balance sheet date. As a result, the figures disclosed in this table should not be used to imply the impact of a different level of change and it should not be assumed that the impact would be the same if the change occurred at a different point in time.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
383   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

42–

Current and Non-Current Assets and Liabilities

Asset and liability line items by amounts recovered or settled within or after one year

Asset items as of December 31, 2015

 

     Amounts recovered or settled        Total    

in m.

     within one year           after one year          Dec 31, 2015    

Cash and central bank balances

     96,940           0           96,940     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Interbank balances (w/o central banks)

     12,620           223           12,842     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Central bank funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements      21,240           1,216           22,456     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Securities borrowed

     33,556           1           33,557     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Financial assets at fair value through profit or loss

     783,383           37,499           820,883     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Financial assets available for sale

     7,359           66,225           73,583     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Equity method investments

     0           1,013           1,013     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Loans

     130,483           297,266           427,749     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Property and equipment

     0           2,846           2,846     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Goodwill and other intangible assets

     0           10,078           10,078     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other assets

     111,653           6,484           118,137     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Assets for current tax

     997           288           1,285     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total assets before deferred tax assets

     1,198,231           423,139           1,621,368     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deferred tax assets

           7,762     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total assets

           1,629,130     

 

 

Liability items as of December 31, 2015

 

     Amounts recovered or settled        Total    

in m.

     within one year          after one year          Dec 31, 2015    

Deposits

     541,557           25,417           566,974     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Central bank funds purchased and securities sold under repurchase agreements      9,803           0           9,803     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Securities loaned

     2,857           414           3,270     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss

     584,474           15,280           599,754     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other short-term borrowings

     28,010           0           28,010     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other liabilities

     168,205           6,800           175,005     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Provisions

     9,207           0           9,207     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Liabilities for current tax

     1,086           613           1,699     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Long-term debt

     26,129           133,887           160,016     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Trust preferred securities

     995           6,025           7,020     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total liabilities before deferred tax liabilities

     1,372,324           188,436           1,560,760     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deferred tax liabilities

           746     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total liabilities

           1,561,506     

 

 

 

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    384
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Asset items as of December 31, 2014

 

     Amounts recovered or settled        Total    

in m.

     within one year           after one year        Dec 31, 2014    

Cash and central bank balances1

     74,379           103           74,482     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Interbank balances (w/o central banks)1      8,822           268           9,090     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Central bank funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements      17,494           303           17,796     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Securities borrowed

     25,800           34           25,834     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Financial assets at fair value through profit or loss

     906,129           36,796           942,924     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Financial assets available for sale

     7,740           56,557           64,297     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Equity method investments

     0           4,143           4,143     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Loans

     135,376           270,236           405,612     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Property and equipment

     0           2,909           2,909     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Goodwill and other intangible assets

     0           14,951           14,951     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other assets

     130,891           7,089           137,980     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Assets for current tax

     1,589           230           1,819     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total assets before deferred tax assets

     1,308,224           393,614           1,701,838     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deferred tax assets

           6,865     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total assets

           1,708,703     

 

 
1 

In 2015, comparatives have been restated. See Note 1 “Significant Accounting Policies and Critical Estimates – Significant Changes in Estimates and Changes in Presentation” for detailed information.

Liability items as of December 31, 2014

 

     Amounts recovered or settled        Total    

in m.

     within one year           after one year        Dec 31, 2014    

Deposits

     508,481           24,451           532,931     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Central bank funds purchased and securities sold under repurchase agreements      10,887           0           10,887     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Securities loaned

     1,976           363           2,339     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss

     680,496           17,203           697,699     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other short-term borrowings

     42,931           0           42,931     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other liabilities

     177,798           6,024           183,823     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Provisions

     6,677           0           6,677     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Liabilities for current tax

     780           828           1,608     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Long-term debt

     25,739           119,098           144,837     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Trust preferred securities

     4,906           5,667           10,573     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total liabilities before deferred tax liabilities

     1,460,672           173,634           1,634,306     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deferred tax liabilities

           1,175     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total liabilities

           1,635,481     

 

 

43 –

Events after the Reporting Period

On February 23, 2016 the Group announced the successful completion of the tender offer to repurchase up to  3 billion of five Euro-denominated issues of senior unsecured debt securities. The resulting accepted total volume amounted to  1.27 billion. In addition, on February 29, 2016 the Group announced the initial results of the tender offer to repurchase up to U.S.$ 2 billion of eight U.S. dollar-denominated issues of senior unsecured debt securities. The resulting accepted total volume amounted to U.S.$ 740 million. The Group expects to record a positive income in the first quarter of 2016 related to these transactions of approximately 55 million.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
385   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

44 –

Condensed Deutsche Bank AG (Parent Company only) Financial Information

Condensed Statement of Income

in m.

   2015        2014       2013    

Interest income, excluding dividends from subsidiaries

     13,760           12,262          11,222     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Dividends received from subsidiaries:

       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Bank subsidiaries

     296           405          735     

Nonbank subsidiaries

     5,010           2,775          3,152     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Interest expense

     7,559           7,833          6,956     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest and dividend income

     11,506           7,609          8,153     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Provision for credit losses

     359           764          801     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest and dividend income after provision for credit losses

     11,147           6,845          7,352     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Noninterest income:

       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Commissions and fee income

     4,265           4,349          4,148     

Net gains (losses) on financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss

     4,918           3,559          3,791     

Other income (loss)1

     (1,371)           (1,597)          (1,591)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total noninterest income

     7,812           6,311          6,348     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Noninterest expenses:

       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Compensation and benefits

     5,763           5,187          5,063     

General and administrative expenses

     10,997           6,755          7,104     

Services provided by (to) affiliates, net

     1,621           77          (7)     

Impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets

     519           0          0     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total noninterest expenses

     18,899           12,019          12,160     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) before income taxes

     60           1,137          1,540     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income tax expense (benefit)

     1,003           602          316     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 
Net income (loss) attributable to Deutsche Bank shareholders and additional equity components      (943)           535         1,224     

 

 
1 

Includes net gains (losses) on financial assets available for sale and impairments/write-ups on investments in subsidiaries.

Condensed Statement of Comprehensive Income

in m.

           2015                2014                2013    
Net income (loss) attributable to Deutsche Bank shareholders and additional equity components      (943)           535           1,224     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax

     1,183           2,174           (1,211)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total comprehensive income (loss), net of tax

     240           2,709           13     

 

 

 

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    386
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Condensed Balance Sheet

in m.

   Dec 31, 2015     Dec 31, 2014  

Assets:

    

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and central bank balances:1

     65,379          45,932     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Interbank balances (w/o central banks):1

    

Bank subsidiaries

     66,498          84,336     

Other

     9,785          6,809     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Central bank funds sold, securities purchased under resale agreements, securities borrowed:

    

Bank subsidiaries

     5,336          6,691     

Nonbank subsidiaries

     61,380          66,323     

Other

     17,281          8,036     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial assets at fair value through profit or loss:

    

Bank subsidiaries

     13,955          9,691     

Nonbank subsidiaries

     17,739          22,710     

Other

     690,362          810,600     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial assets available for sale

     46,884          34,347     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Investments in associates

     340          829     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Investment in subsidiaries:

    

Bank subsidiaries

     12,032          12,257     

Nonbank subsidiaries

     36,759          41,075     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loans:

    

 

    

Bank subsidiaries

     37,295          22,272     

Nonbank subsidiaries

     59,728          64,084     

Other

     159,566          138,653     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other assets:

    

Bank subsidiaries

     1,514          1,964     

Nonbank subsidiaries

     15,972          16,055     

Other

     100,880          113,150     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

     1,418,684          1,505,815     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Liabilities and equity:

    

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Deposits:

    

Bank subsidiaries

     100,159          119,081     

Nonbank subsidiaries

     28,214          34,805     

Other

     284,948          255,976     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Central bank funds purchased, securities sold under repurchase agreements and securities loaned:

    

Bank subsidiaries

     2,773          1,325     

Nonbank subsidiaries

     31,189          20,843     

Other

     4,271          2,521     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss:

    

Bank subsidiaries

     11,383          6,242     

Nonbank subsidiaries

     7,198          13,980     

Other

     558,469          664,741     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other short-term borrowings:

    

Bank subsidiaries

     230          330     

Nonbank subsidiaries

     1,206          1,526     

Other

     25,239          29,352     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other liabilities:

    

Bank subsidiaries

     1,808          1,802     

Nonbank subsidiaries

     25,496          29,940     

Other

     133,333          130,788     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Long-term debt

     147,713          136,487     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     1,363,629          1,449,741     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total shareholders’ equity

     50,379          51,418     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Additional equity components

     4,676          4,656     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total equity

     55,055          56,074     

 

  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities and equity

     1,418,684         1,505,815     

 

 
1 

In 2015, comparatives have been restated. See Note 1 “Significant Accounting Policies and Critical Accounting Estimates – Significant Changes in Estimates and Changes in Presentation” for detailed information.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
387   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Condensed Statement of Cash Flows

in m.

   2015        2014        2013    

Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities

     49,259           (19,616)           22,925     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash flows from investing activities:

        

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Proceeds from:

        

Sale of financial assets available for sale

     14,948           8,546           7,444     

Maturities of financial assets available for sale

     4,034           5,566           5,552     

Sale of investments in associates

     13           17           13     

Sale of property and equipment

     19           4           16     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Purchase of:

        

Financial assets available for sale

     (26,426)           (24,377)           (22,676)     

Investments in associates

     (93)           (60)           (1)     

Property and equipment

     (164)           (227)           (200)     

Net change in investments in subsidiaries

     3,664           2,935           (5,921)     

Other, net

     (1,047)           (760)           (384)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) investing activities

     (5,052)           (8,356)           (16,157)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash flows from financing activities:

        

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Issuances of subordinated long-term debt

     3,303           91           1,176     

Repayments and extinguishments of subordinated long-term debt

     (1,126)           (2,384)           (2,188)     

Capital increase

     0           8,508           2,961     

Purchases of treasury shares

     (9,003)           (9,026)           (13,255)     

Sale of treasury shares

     8,142           8,161           12,106     

Additional Equity Components (AT1) issued

     0           4,676           0     

Purchases of Additional Equity Components (AT1)

     177           589           0     

Sale of Additional Equity Components (AT1)

     (176)           (588)           0     

Coupon on additional equity components, pre tax

     (269)           0           0     

Cash dividends paid

     (1,034)           (765)           (764)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities

     14           9,262           36     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents

     (1,503)           217           (656)     

Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

     42,718           (18,493)           6,148     

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period

     67,633           86,126           78,699     

Cash and cash equivalents at end of period

     110,351           67,633           84,847     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities include

        

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Income taxes paid (received), net

     418           (29)           235     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Interest paid

     8,244           8,209           6,579     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Interest and dividends received

     19,233           15,746           14,665     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents comprise

        

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cash and central bank balances (not included Interest-earning time deposits with central banks)1

     64,472           20,943           28,178     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Interbank balances (w/o central banks)1

     45,880           46,960           56,669     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

     110,352           67,633           84,847     

 

 
1 

In 2015, comparatives have been restated. See Note 1 “Significant Accounting Policies and Critical Accounting Estimates – Significant Changes in Estimates and Changes in Presentation” for detailed information.

Parent Company’s Long-Term Debt by Remaining Maturities

By remaining maturities

  Due in  
2016  
    Due in  
2017  
    Due in  
2018  
    Due in  
2019  
    Due in  
2020  
    Due after  
2020  
    Total  
Dec 31,  
2015  
    Total  
Dec 31,  
2014  
 
in m.                                                

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Senior debt:

               

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Bonds and notes:

               

Fixed rate

    15,792          15,687          7,246          6,337          5,716          17,229          68,006          67,010     

Floating rate

    7,129          6,447          3,838          6,478          3,903          11,118          38,913          35,597     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Subordinated debt

               

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Bonds and notes:

               

Fixed rate

    1,012          735          4,085          292          1,146          2,619          9,888          11,077     

Floating rate

    0          0          50          0          0          2,076          2,126          2,502     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other

    1,838          15,480          1,958          1,466          645          7,391          28,779          20,301     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total long-term debt

    25,771          38,349          17,177          14,573          11,409          40,433          147,713          136,487     

 

 
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    388
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

45 –

SEC Registered Trust Preferred Securities

Deutsche Bank AG has, via several subsidiaries, issued “trust preferred” securities that are listed on the New York Stock Exchange. In each such transaction, a Delaware statutory business trust (the “Trust”) issues trust preferred securities (the “Trust Preferred Securities”) in a public offering in the United States. All the proceeds from the sale of the Trust Preferred Securities are invested by the Trust in the Class B Preferred Securities (the “Class B Preferred Securities”) of a wholly-owned subsidiary of Deutsche Bank AG organized in the form of a limited liability company (the “LLC”). The LLC uses all the proceeds from the sale of the Class B Preferred Securities to the Trust to purchase a debt obligation from Deutsche Bank AG (the “Debt Obligation”). The distributions on the Class B Preferred Securities match those of the Trust Preferred Securities. The Trust Preferred Securities and the Class B Preferred Securities pay distributions quarterly in arrears and are redeemable only upon the occurrence of certain events specified in the documents governing the terms of those securities. Subject to limited exceptions, the Class B Preferred Securities generally cannot be redeemed until at least five or ten years after their issuance. The Trust Preferred Securities and the Class B Preferred Securities are each subject to a full and unconditional subordinated guarantee of Deutsche Bank AG. These subordinated guarantees are general and unsecured obligations of Deutsche Bank AG and rank, both as to payment and in liquidation of Deutsche Bank AG, junior in priority of payment to all current and future indebtedness of Deutsche Bank AG and on parity in priority of payment with the most senior preference shares, if any, of Deutsche Bank AG. In the above 2015 condensed consolidating balance sheet, a total of 3.8 billion of the long-term debt of the Parent and Deutsche Bank AG Consolidated represents the Debt Obligations issued by Deutsche Bank AG to the LLC in these transactions.

Issuances of SEC Registered Trust Preferred Securities

Trust

 

LLC

 

Issuance Date

 

Earliest

Redemption Date

 

Parent Long-term Debt1

Deutsche Bank Contingent Capital Trust II

  Deutsche Bank
Contingent Capital
LLC II
  May 23, 2007   May 23, 2017   735 million

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Deutsche Bank Contingent Capital Trust III

  Deutsche Bank
Contingent Capital
LLC III
  February 20, 2008   February 20, 2018   1,813 million

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Deutsche Bank Contingent Capital Trust V

  Deutsche Bank
Contingent Capital
LLC V
  May 9, 2008 2   June 30, 2018   1,272 million

 

1 

Amount of long-term debt of the Parent and Deutsche Bank AG Consolidated represented by the Debt Obligations issued by Deutsche Bank AG to the applicable LLC, as of December 31, 2015.

2 

On March 30, 2010 Deutsche Bank AG additionally issued an amount of U.S.$ 120 million

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
389   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

To the Supervisory Board of

Deutsche Bank Aktiengesellschaft:

We have audited the consolidated balance sheets of Deutsche Bank Aktiengesellschaft and subsidiaries (the “Company”) as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, and the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, changes in equity, and cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2015, and the related notes, and the specific disclosures described in Note 1 to the consolidated financial statements as being part of the financial statements. These consolidated financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Deutsche Bank Aktiengesellschaft and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2015 and 2014, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2015, in conformity with International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2015, based on criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO), and our report dated March 2, 2016 expressed an unqualified opinion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.

Frankfurt am Main, Germany

March 2, 2016

KPMG AG

Wirtschaftsprüfungsgesellschaft

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    390
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
391   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    392
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
393   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    394
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
395   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    396
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
397   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    398
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
399   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    400
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
401   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    402
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
403   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    404
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
405   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    406
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
407   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statements    408
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
409   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statement    410
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
411   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statement    412
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
413   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statement    414
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
415   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    2 – Consolidated Financial Statement    416
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
417   Deutsche Bank   Consolidated Statement of Income – 245   Notes to the
  Annual Report 2015   Consolidated Statement of   Consolidated Financial Statements – 251
    Comprehensive Income – 246   Notes to the
    Consolidated Balance Sheet – 247   Consolidated Income Statement – 283
    Consolidated Statement of   Notes to the Consolidated Balance Sheet – 289
    Changes in Equity – 248   Additional Notes – 353
                             Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows – 250   Confirmations – 417
     

 

                    

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents

3 –

Corporate Governance Statement/

Corporate Governance Report

419   Management Board and Supervisory Board
431   Reporting and Transparency
432   Related Party Transactions
432   Auditing and Controlling
435   Compliance with the German Corporate Governance Code


Table of Contents
419   Deutsche Bank   Management Board and   Auditing and Controlling – 432
  Annual Report 2015   Supervisory Board – 419   Compliance with the German Corporate
    Reporting and Transparency – 431   Governance Code – 435
    Related Party Transactions – 432  
                              
     

 

                    

All information presented in this Corporate Governance Statement/Corporate Governance Report is shown as of February 19, 2016.

Management Board and Supervisory Board

Management Board

The Management Board is responsible for managing the company. Its members are jointly accountable for the management of the company. The duties, responsibilities and procedures of our Management Board are specified in its Terms of Reference, the current version of which is available on our website (www.db.com/ir/en/documents.htm).

With effect from July 1, 2015, John Cryan was appointed member of the Management Board for a five-year period and became Co-Chairman of the Management Board together with Jürgen Fitschen. With effect from November 1, 2015, Sylvie Matherat and Karl von Rohr were appointed members of the Management Board for a three-year period. With effect from January 1, 2016, Quintin Price, Garth Ritchie and Jeffrey Herbert Urwin were each appointed members of the Management Board for a three-year period.

Anshuman Jain and Rainer Neske stepped down from the Management Board at the end of June 30, 2015. Stefan Krause and Dr. Stephan Leithner stepped down from the Management Board at the end of October 31, 2015. Henry Ritchotte stepped down from the Management Board at the end of December 31, 2015.

The following paragraphs show information on the current members of the Management Board. The infor-mation includes the year in which they were born, the year in which they were appointed and the year in which their term expires and their current positions and area of responsibility according to the current Business Allocation Plan for the Management Board. Furthermore their other board mandates or directorships outside of Deutsche Bank Group are specified. The members of our Management Board have generally undertaken not to assume chairmanships of supervisory boards of companies outside Deutsche Bank Group.

John Cryan

Year of birth: 1960

First appointed: 2015

Term expires: 2020

John Cryan became a member of our Management Board on July 1, 2015 and Co-Chairman of our Management Board together with Jürgen Fitschen. According to the Business Allocation Plan he is responsible for, among other things, the areas of Communications, Corporate Strategy, Non-Core Operations (NCOU) and Group Incident & Investigation Management.

Mr. Cryan became a member of Deutsche Bank’s Supervisory Board in 2013, where he served as Chairman of the Audit Committee and member of the Risk Committee. Upon becoming Co-Chairman of the Management Board, he stepped down from the Supervisory Board. At the meeting of the Supervisory Board of June 7, 2015, it was resolved that Mr. Cryan will become sole Chairman of the Management Board when Jürgen Fitschen steps down in May 2016.

Mr. Cryan was President Europe, Head Africa, Head Portfolio Strategy and Head Credit Portfolio at Temasek Holdings Pte. Ltd., the Singaporean investment company, from 2012 to 2014. Previously, he was Group Chief Financial Officer of UBS AG from 2008 to 2011, having worked in corporate finance and client advisory roles at UBS and SG Warburg in London, Munich and Zurich from 1987.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    3 – Corporate Governance Statement/ Corporate Governance Report    420
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

He began his career as a trainee chartered accountant at Arthur Andersen in London. He is a graduate of the University of Cambridge.

Mr. Cryan is a non-executive Director of MAN Group Plc.

Jürgen Fitschen

Year of birth: 1948

Appointed: 2009

Term expires: 2017

Jürgen Fitschen became a member of our Management Board on April 1, 2009. Since the end of the Annual General Meeting on May 31, 2012, he has been Co-Chairman of the Management Board. Mr. Fitschen decided to resign from his position as Co-Chairman of the Management Board before the end of his term and will step down as member of Deutsche Bank’s Management Board and as its Co-Chairman at the end of the General Meeting on May 19, 2016.

Mr. Fitschen has been with Deutsche Bank since 1987, and was previously a member of the Management Board from 2001 to the beginning of 2002. He first took on functional responsibility for global Regional Management in 2005 and from June 2012 until end of 2015 has held functional responsibility for the bank’s Regional Management worldwide, with the exception of the bank’s European region but including Germany and the UK. Since January 2016 he is responsible for the global Regional Management with the exception of Germany and the UK.

From 1975 to 1987, he worked at Citibank in Hamburg and Frankfurt am Main in various positions. In 1983 he was appointed member of the Executive Committee Germany of Citibank.

Mr. Fitschen studied Economics and Business Administration at the University of Hamburg and graduated in 1975 with a Master’s degree in Business Administration.

Mr. Fitschen is a non-executive member of the Board of Directors of Kühne + Nagel International AG and a member of the Supervisory Board of METRO AG.

Stuart Wilson Lewis

Year of birth: 1965

First appointed: 2012

Term expires: 2020

Stuart Wilson Lewis became a member of our Management Board.on June 1, 2012. He is our Chief Risk Officer and is responsible for, among other things, the functions managing Credit Risk, Market Risk, Liquidity Risk, Strategic Risk as well as for further Risk-Infrastructure entities.

He joined Deutsche Bank in 1996. Prior to assuming his current role, Mr. Lewis was Deputy Chief Risk Officer and subsequently Chief Risk Officer of Corporate & Investment Banking from 2010 to 2012. Between 2006 and 2010 he was Chief Credit Officer.

Before joining Deutsche Bank in 1996, he worked at Credit Suisse and Continental Illinois National Bank in London. He studied at the University of Dundee, where he obtained an LLB (Hons), and he holds an LLM from the London School of Economics. He also attended the College of Law, Guildford.

Mr. Lewis is non-executive member of the Board of Directors of the London Stock Exchange.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
421   Deutsche Bank   Management Board and   Auditing and Controlling – 432
  Annual Report 2015   Supervisory Board – 419   Compliance with the German Corporate
    Reporting and Transparency – 431   Governance Code – 435
    Related Party Transactions – 432  
                              
     

 

                    

Sylvie Matherat

Year of birth: 1962

First appointed: 2015

Term expires: 2018

Sylvie Matherat became a member of our Management Board on November 1, 2015. She is our Chief Regulatory Officer and is responsible for, among other things, the functions Compliance, Anti-Financial Crime (AFC), and Group Regulatory Affairs (GRA).

Ms. Matherat joined Deutsche Bank from Banque de France where she was Deputy Director General and responsible for regulation and financial stability issues, payment and settlement infrastructures, banking services, and the Target 2 Securities project. Ms. Matherat previously held various positions at the Banking Supervisory Authority and in the private sector.

She studied public law and finance at the Institut d’Études Politiques de Paris, France, and holds a Master’s degree in law and political sciences. In 2014 she was awarded the Légion d'Honneur.

Ms. Matherat does not have any external directorships subject to disclosure.

Quintin Price

Year of birth: 1961

First appointed: 2016

Term expires: 2018

Quintin Price became a member of our Management Board on January 1, 2016. He is Head of our Deutsche Asset Management business division.

Prior to joining Deutsche Bank, Mr. Price was Global Head of Alpha Strategies at BlackRock and a member of the Global Executive Committee. He joined BlackRock in 2005 from Gartmore Investment Management.

He holds a Bachelor of Science in Economic and Social History from the University of Bristol (UK).

Mr. Price does not have any external directorships subject to disclosure.

Garth Ritchie

Year of birth: 1968

First appointed: 2016

Term expires: 2018

Garth Ritchie became a member of our Management Board on January 1, 2016. He is Head of our Global Markets business division and is responsible for Regional Management for UK.

Mr. Ritchie joined Deutsche Bank in 1996 and became Head of Equities in the Corporate Banking & Securities Business Division in 2010. He held positions in trading and derivatives for over two decades.

Prior to joining Deutsche Bank, Mr. Ritchie held positions at Fergusson Brothers and First National Bank of South Africa.

He holds a Bachelor of Commerce in Finance and Economics from the University of Port Elizabeth (South Africa).

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    3 – Corporate Governance Statement/ Corporate Governance Report    422
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Mr. Ritchie does not have any external directorships subject to disclosure.

Karl von Rohr

Year of birth: 1965

First appointed: 2015

Term expires: 2018

Karl von Rohr became a member of our Management Board on November 1, 2015. He is our Chief Administrative Officer and is responsible for the functions Legal, Global Corporate Governance and Human Resources.

Mr. von Rohr joined Deutsche Bank in 1998. From 2013 to 2015 he was Global Chief Operating Officer, Regional Management. Prior to this, he was Head of Human Resources for Deutsche Bank in Germany and member of the Management Board of Deutsche Bank PGK AG. During his time at Deutsche Bank he held various senior management positions in other divisions in Germany and Belgium.

He studied law at the universities of Bonn (Germany), Kiel (Germany), Lausanne (Switzerland) and at Cornell University (U.S.A.).

Mr. von Rohr does not have any external directorships subject to disclosure.

Dr. Marcus Schenck

Year of birth: 1965

First appointed: 2015

Term expires: 2018

Dr. Marcus Schenck became a member of our Management Board on May 21, 2015. He is our Chief Financial Officer and is responsible for, among other things, the functions Finance, Group Tax and Group Treasury as well as Corporate M&A.

In January 2015, Dr. Schenck joined Deutsche Bank from Goldman Sachs International, where he was Partner and Head of Investment Banking Services for Europe, Middle East & Africa. Additionally, he was a member of the Operating Committee of the Investment Banking Division of Goldman Sachs. From 2006 to 2013, Dr. Schenck was Chief Financial Officer and a member of the Management Board of German energy supplier E.ON SE. From 1997 to 2006, he held a number of senior positions at Goldman Sachs in Frankfurt. Prior to that, he was a consultant at McKinsey & Company.

He holds a “Diplom-Volkswirt” degree from the University of Bonn and a PhD in Economics from the University of Cologne.

Dr. Schenck does not have any external directorships subject to disclosure.

Christian Sewing

Year of birth: 1970

First appointed: 2015

Term expires: 2017

Christian Sewing became a member of our Management Board on January 1, 2015. Since January 2016 he is our Head of Private, Wealth & Commercial Clients as well CEO Germany. From January until June 2015, he was responsible on the Management Board for Legal, Incident Management Group and Group Audit, and thereafter he assumed responsibility for Private & Business Clients.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
423   Deutsche Bank   Management Board and   Auditing and Controlling – 432
  Annual Report 2015   Supervisory Board – 419   Compliance with the German Corporate
    Reporting and Transparency – 431   Governance Code – 435
    Related Party Transactions – 432  
                              
     

 

                    

Prior to assuming his role on our Management Board, Mr. Sewing was Global Head of Group Audit and before that held a number of positions in Risk, including Deputy Chief Risk Officer (from 2012 to 2013) and Chief Credit Officer of Deutsche Bank (from 2010 to 2012).

From 2005 until 2007, Mr. Sewing was a member of the Management Board of Deutsche Genossenschafts-Hypothekenbank.

Before graduating with a diploma from the Bankakademie Bielefeld and Hamburg, Mr. Sewing completed a bank apprenticeship at Deutsche Bank in 1989.

Mr. Sewing does not have any external directorships subject to disclosure.

Jeffrey Herbert Urwin

Year of birth: 1956

First appointed: 2016

Term expires: 2018

Jeffrey Herbert Urwin became a member of our Management Board on January 1, 2016. He is our Head of Corporate & Investment Banking. Mr. Urwin joined Deutsche Bank in 2015 as Co-Head of Corporate Banking & Securities and Head of Corporate Finance.

He joined from JP Morgan, most recently as Global Co-Head of Treasury Services, Corporate Banking and Investment Banking. During his career at JP Morgan, he was Chairman and CEO of JP Morgan Asia, Head of Global Investment Banking, Co-Head of North American Investment Banking, and Head of Americas Investment Banking Coverage. He joined JP Morgan following its acquisition of Bear Stearns Inc.

He holds an LLB from the University of Birmingham (UK) and is a Barrister at Law.

Mr. Urwin does not have any external directorships subject to disclosure.

Group Executive Committee

The Group Executive Committee was established in 2002. In accordance with the Strategy 2020 objective to reduce organizational complexity, it was dissolved in October 2015. The Group Executive Committee comprised the members of the Management Board and senior representatives from the regions, corporate divisions and certain infrastructure functions appointed by the Management Board. The Group Executive Committee was a body that is not required by the Stock Corporation Act. It served as a tool to coordinate our business and regions, discussed Group strategy and prepared recommendations for Management Board decisions. It had no decision-making authority.

Supervisory Board

The Supervisory Board appoints, supervises and advises the Management Board and is directly involved in decisions of fundamental importance to the bank. The Management Board regularly informs the Supervisory Board of the intended business policies and other fundamental matters relating to the assets, liabilities, financial and profit situation of the bank as well as its risk situation, risk management and risk controlling. A report is made to the Supervisory Board on corporate planning at least once a year. The Supervisory Board decides on the appointment and dismissal of members of the Management Board including long-term succession planning for the Management Board based on the recommendations of the Chairman’s Committee taking into account the recommendations of the Nomination Committee. Based on the recommendation of the Compensation Control Committee, the Supervisory Board determines the total compensation of the individual members of the Management Board, resolves on the compensation system for the Management Board and reviews it regularly. The Chairman of the Supervisory Board coordinates work within the

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    3 – Corporate Governance Statement/ Corporate Governance Report    424
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Supervisory Board. He maintains regular contact with the Management Board, especially with the Co-Chairmen of the Management Board, and consults with them on strategy, the development of business and risk management. The Supervisory Board Chairman is informed by the Co-Chairmen of the Management Board without delay of important events of substantial significance for the situation and development as well as for the management of Deutsche Bank Group. The types of business that require the approval of the Supervisory Board to be transacted are specified in Section 13 of our Articles of Association. The Supervisory Board meets, if required, without the Management Board. For the performance of its duties, the Supervisory Board may, at its professional discretion, use the services of auditors, legal advisors and other internal and external consultants.

In 2015, a total of 73 meetings of the Supervisory Board and its committees took place. The number of sessions in which committees jointly met was expanded from the previous year.

The duties, procedures and committees of the Supervisory Board are specified in its Terms of Reference. The current version is available on the Deutsche Bank website (www.db.com/ir/en/documents.htm).

The members representing our shareholders were elected at the Annual General Meeting on May 23, 2013, except for Katherine Garrett-Cox, who was elected at the Annual General Meeting on May 26, 2011, and Dr. Paul Achleitner, Peter Löscher and Professor Dr. Klaus Rüdiger Trützschler, who were elected at the Annual General Meeting on May 31, 2012. Louise M. Parent was appointed to the Supervisory Board by the court with effect from July 1, 2014 and was elected at the Annual General Meeting on May 21, 2015. The election of employee representatives took place on April 16, 2013.

John Cryan stepped down from the Supervisory Board at the end of June 30, 2015 and was appointed a member and Co-Chairman of the Management Board by the Supervisory Board with effect from July 1, 2015. He was succeeded on the Supervisory Board by Richard Meddings, who was appointed to the Supervisory Board by the court with effect from October 13, 2015. Stephan Szukalski was a member of the Supervisory Board until the end of November 30, 2015. After he left the Supervisory Board, the substitute member elected to replace him for the remainder of his term of office was Wolfgang Böhr, who was first elected to the Supervisory Board in 2008 and whose first mandate ended in 2013.The following table shows information on the current members of our Supervisory Board. The information includes the years in which the members were born, the years in which they were first elected or appointed, the years when their terms expire, their principal occupation and their membership on other companies’ supervisory boards, other nonexecutive directorships and other positions.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
425   Deutsche Bank   Management Board and   Auditing and Controlling – 432
  Annual Report 2015   Supervisory Board – 419   Compliance with the German Corporate
    Reporting and Transparency – 431   Governance Code – 435
    Related Party Transactions – 432  
                              
     

 

                    

 

Member

 

Principal occupation

 

Supervisory board memberships and other directorships

Dr. Paul Achleitner

Year of birth: 1956

First elected: 2012

Term expires: 2017

  Chairman of the Supervisory Board of Deutsche Bank AG, Frankfurt   Bayer AG; Daimler AG; Henkel AG & Co. KGaA (member of the Shareholders’ Committee)

 

 

 

 

 

Wolfgang Böhr*

Year of birth: 1963

Promoted to the post as

Alternate Member: 2015

Term expires: 2018

 

Chairman of the Staff Council of Deutsche Bank, Düsseldorf

Member of the Group Staff Council of Deutsche Bank,

Member of the General Staff Council of Deutsche Bank

  Betriebskrankenkasse Deutsche Bank AG (member of the Advisory Board)

 

 

 

 

 

Frank Bsirske*

Year of birth: 1952

First elected: 2013

Term expires: 2018

  Chairman of the trade union ver.di (Vereinte Dienstleistungsgewerkschaft), Berlin   RWE AG (Deputy Chairman); Deutsche Postbank AG (Deputy Chairman); IBM Central Holding GmbH; Kreditanstalt für Wiederaufbau (KfW) (member of the Advisory Board)

 

 

 

 

 

Dina Dublon

Year of birth: 1953

First elected: 2013

Term expires: 2018

    Accenture Plc; PepsiCo Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

Katherine Garrett-Cox

Year of birth: 1967

First elected: 2011

Term expires: 2016

  Chief Executive Officer of Alliance Trust Plc (until February 2016), Dundee   Alliance Trust Savings Ltd. (Executive Chairperson) (until January 2016); Alliance Trust Investments Ltd. (Chief Executive) (until March 2016)

 

 

 

 

 

Timo Heider*

Year of birth: 1975

First elected: 2013

Term expires: 2018

  Chairman of the Group Staff Council of Deutsche Postbank AG; Chairman of the General Staff Council of BHW Kreditservice GmbH; Chairman of the Staff Council of BHW Bausparkasse AG, BHW Kreditservice GmbH, Postbank Finanzberatung AG and BHW Holding AG; Member of the Group Staff Council of Deutsche Bank; Member of the European Staff Council of Deutsche Bank   Deutsche Postbank AG; BHW Bausparkasse AG (Deputy Chairman); Pensionskasse der BHW Bausparkasse AG VVa.G. (Deputy Chairman); PBC Banking Services GmbH (member of the Advisory Board) (until end 2015)

 

 

 

 

 

Alfred Herling*

Year of birth: 1952

First elected: 2008

Term expires: 2018

  Deputy Chairman of the Supervisory Board of Deutsche Bank AG; Chairman of the Combined Staff Council Wuppertal/Sauerland of Deutsche Bank; Chairman of the General Staff Council of Deutsche Bank; Member of the European Staff Council of Deutsche Bank; Chairman of the Group Staff Council of Deutsche Bank   No memberships or directorships subject to disclosure

 

 

 

 

 

Sabine Irrgang*

Year of birth: 1962

First elected: 2013

Term expires: 2018

  Head of Human Resources Management (Württemberg), Deutsche Bank AG   No memberships or directorships subject to disclosure

 

 

 

 

 

Professor Dr. Henning Kagermann

Year of birth: 1947

First elected: 2000

Term expires: 2018

  President of acatech – German Academy of Science and Engineering, Munich   Münchener Rückversicherungs-Gesellschaft Aktiengesellschaft; Deutsche Post AG; BMW Bayerische Motoren Werke AG; Franz Haniel & Cie. GmbH (until April 2015)

 

 

 

 

 

Martina Klee*

Year of birth: 1962

First elected: 2008

Term expires: 2018

  Chairperson of the Staff Council Group COO Eschborn/Frankfurt of Deutsche Bank   Sterbekasse für die Angestellten der Deutsche Bank VVa.G.

 

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    3 – Corporate Governance Statement/ Corporate Governance Report    426
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Member

 

Principal occupation

 

Supervisory board memberships and other directorships

Peter Löscher

Year of birth: 1957

First elected: 2012

Term expires: 2017

  Chief Executive Officer of Renova Management AG, Zurich   TBG AG; Sulzer AG (Chairman of the Board of Directors); Conscientia Investment Limited (until February 2015)

 

 

 

 

 

Henriette Mark*

Year of birth: 1957

First elected: 2003

Term expires: 2018

  Chairperson of the Combined Staff Council Munich and Southern Bavaria of Deutsche Bank; Member of the Group Staff Council of Deutsche Bank; Member of the General Staff Council of Deutsche Bank   No memberships or directorships subject to disclosure

 

 

 

 

 

Richard Meddings

Year of birth: 1958

Appointment by court: 2015

    HM Treasury Board; Legal & General Group Plc

 

 

 

 

 

Louise M. Parent

Year of birth: 1950

Appointment by court: 2014

Term expires: 2018

  Of Counsel, Cleary Gottlieb Steen & Hamilton LLP, New York   Zoetis Inc.

 

 

 

 

 

Gabriele Platscher*

Year of birth: 1957

First elected: 2003

Term expires: 2018

  Chairperson of the Combined Staff Council Braunschweig/Hildesheim of Deutsche Bank   BVV Versicherungsverein des Bankgewerbes a.G. (Deputy Chairperson); BVV Versorgungskasse des Bankgewerbes e.V. (Deputy Chairperson); BVV Pensionsfonds des Bankgewerbes AG (Deputy Chairperson)

 

 

 

 

 

Bernd Rose*

Year of birth: 1967

First elected: 2013

Term expires: 2018

  Chairman of the Joint General Staff Council of Postbank Filialvertrieb AG and Postbank Filial GmbH; Member of the General Staff Council of Deutsche Postbank, Member of the General Staff Council of Deutsche Bank; Member of the European Staff Council of Deutsche Bank   Deutsche Postbank AG; Postbank Filialvertrieb AG; ver.di Vermögensverwaltungsgesellschaft (Deputy Chairman)

 

 

 

 

 

Rudolf Stockem*

Year of birth: 1956

Promoted to the post as

Alternate Member: 2012

Term expires: 2018

  Secretary to the trade union ver.di (Vereinte Dienstleistungsgewerkschaft), Berlin   Deutsche Bank Privat- und Geschäftskunden AG (until December 2015); PBC Banking Services GmbH (member of the Advisory Board) (until end 2015)

 

 

 

 

 

Dr. Johannes Teyssen

Year of birth: 1959

First elected: 2008

Term expires: 2018

  Chairman of the Management Board of E.ON SE, Dusseldorf   Salzgitter AG (until September 2015)

 

 

 

 

 

Georg F. Thoma

Year of birth: 1944

First elected: 2013

Term expires: 2018

  Of Counsel, Shearman & Sterling LLP, Frankfurt   Sapinda Holding B.V. (until December 2015)

 

 

 

 

 

Professor Dr. Klaus

Rüdiger Trützschler

Year of birth: 1948

First elected: 2012

Term expires: 2017

    Sartorius AG; Wuppermann AG (Chairman); Zwiesel Kristallglas AG (Chairman); Wilh. Werhahn KG

 

* Elected by the employees in Germany.

Objectives for the composition of the Supervisory Board and status of implementation

In accordance with the German Banking Act, members of the Supervisory Board must be reliable, must have the expertise required to perform their supervisory function and to assess and monitor the businesses the company operates, and must commit sufficient time to the performance of their tasks. While taking these requirements into account in accordance with Section 5.4.1 of the German Corporate Governance Code, the Supervisory Board established the following objectives for its composition in October 2010, which were last amended in October 2015 and confirmed in January 2016.

The Supervisory Board of Deutsche Bank AG must be composed in such a way that its members as a whole possess the knowledge, ability and expert experience to properly complete its tasks. In particular, the Supervisory Board

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
427   Deutsche Bank   Management Board and   Auditing and Controlling – 432
  Annual Report 2015   Supervisory Board – 419   Compliance with the German Corporate
    Reporting and Transparency – 431   Governance Code – 435
    Related Party Transactions – 432  
                              
     

 

                    

members should have sufficient time to perform their mandates. The composition of the Supervisory Board should ensure the Supervisory Board’s qualified oversight of and advice for the Management Board of an internationally operating, broadly positioned bank and should preserve the reputation of Deutsche Bank Group among the public. In this regard, in particular, attention should be placed on the integrity, personality, willingness to perform, professionalism and independence of the individuals proposed for election. The objective is for the Supervisory Board as a whole to have all of the knowledge and experience considered to be essential while taking into account the activities of Deutsche Bank Group.

Furthermore, the Supervisory Board shall have an adequate number of independent members and shall not have more than two former members of the Management Board of Deutsche Bank AG. Under the premise that the performance of the Supervisory Board mandate in itself by the representatives of the employees cannot be reason to doubt fulfillment of the independence criteria according to Section 5.4.2 of the German Corporate Governance Code, the Supervisory Board shall have a total of at least sixteen members that are independent within the meaning of the Code. In any event, the Supervisory Board shall be composed such that the number of independent members, within the meaning of Section 5.4.2, among the shareholder representatives will be at least six. The members of the Supervisory Board may not exercise functions on a management body of, or perform advisory duties, at major competitors. Important and not just temporary conflicts of interest with respect to a member of the Supervisory Board should lead to a termination of the mandate. With effect from July 1, 2014 members of the Supervisory Board may not hold more than the allowed number of supervisory board mandates according to Section 25d of the German Banking Act (KWG) or mandates in supervisory bodies of companies which have similar requirements. There is a regular maximum age limit of 70. In well-founded, individual cases, a Supervisory Board member may be elected or appointed for a period that extends at the latest until the end of the fourth Annual General Meeting that takes place after he or she has reached the age of 70. This age limit was taken into account in the election proposals to the recent General Meetings and shall also be taken into account for the next Supervisory Board elections or subsequent appointments for Supervisory Board positions that become vacant. In October 2015, the Supervisory Board resolved that for members of the Supevisory Board to be elected or appointed in future, the length of each individual Supervisory Board membership shall not, as a rule, exceed 15 years.

The Supervisory Board respects diversity when proposing members for appointment to the Supervisory Board. In light of the international operations of Deutsche Bank, care should be taken that the Supervisory Board has an appropriate number of members with long-term international experience. Currently, the professional careers and private lives of four members of the Supervisory Board are centered outside Germany. Furthermore, all of the shareholder representatives on the Supervisory Board have several years of international experience from their current or former activities as management board members or CEOs or a comparable executive function of corporations with international operations. In these two ways, the Supervisory Board believes the international activities of the company are sufficiently taken into account. The objective is to retain the currently existing international profile.

For the election proposals to the General Meeting, the Supervisory Board takes into account the recommendations of the Nomination Committee and the legal requirements according to which the Supervisory Board shall be composed of at least 30 % women and at least 30 % men. Special importance was already attached to an appropriate consideration of women in the selection process for the Supervisory Board elections in 2008 and also for those held in 2013. In reviewing potential candidates for a new election or subsequent appointments to Supervisory Board positions that have become vacant, qualified women shall be included in the selection process and shall be appropriately considered in the election proposals. In accordance with the specified objectives, Ms. Garrett-Cox was elected by the 2011 General Meeting and Ms. Dublon by the 2013 General Meeting, in each case based on the proposals of the Supervisory Board. Ms. Parent was appointed by the court on July 1, 2014 and elected to the Supervisory Board by the General Meeting on May 21, 2015. Since the Supervisory Board elections in 2003, between 25 % and 40 % of the Supervisory Board members have been women. The Supervisory Board currently counts seven women among its members, which corresponds to 35 % and three of them are shareholder representatives. The Supervisory Board strives to maintain this number. It should be taken into account that the Supervisory Board can only influence the composition of the Supervisory Board through its election proposals to the General Meeting. The Supervisory Board believes that it complies with the specified concrete objectives regarding its composition.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    3 – Corporate Governance Statement/ Corporate Governance Report    428
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

In accordance with Section 5.4.2 of the German Corporate Governance Code, the Supervisory Board determined that it has what it considers to be an adequate number of independent members.

Some members of the Supervisory Board are, or were last year, in high-ranking positions at other companies that Deutsche Bank has business relations with. Business transactions with these companies are conducted under the same conditions as those between unrelated third parties. These transactions, in our opinion, do not affect the independence of the Supervisory Board members involved.

Standing Committees

The Supervisory Board has established the following seven standing committees. The Report of the Supervisory Board in the Annual Report 2015 provides information on the concrete work of the committees over the preceding year.

Chairman’s Committee: The Chairman’s Committee is responsible for all Management Board and Supervisory Board matters. It prepares the decisions for the Supervisory Board on the appointment and dismissal of members of the Management Board, including long-term succession planning, while taking into account the recommendations of the Nomination Committee. It is responsible for entering into, amending and terminating the service contracts and other agreements in consideration of the Supervisory Board’s sole authority to decide on the compensation of the members of the Management Board and provides its approval for ancillary activities, honorary offices or special tasks outside of Deutsche Bank Group performed by Management Board members pursuant to Section 112 of the German Stock Corporation Act (AktG) and for certain contracts with Supervisory Board members pursuant to Section 114 of the German Stock Corporation Act (AktG). Furthermore, it prepares the decisions of the Supervisory Board in the field of corporate governance. The Chairman’s Committee held twelve meetings in 2015, thereof two jointly with the Nomination Committee.

The current members of the Chairman’s Committee are Dr. Paul Achleitner (Chairman), Frank Bsirske, Alfred Herling and Professor Dr. Henning Kagermann.

Nomination Committee: The shareholder representatives on the Nomination Committee prepare the Supervisory Board’s proposals for the election or appointment of new shareholder representatives to the Supervisory Board. In this context, they orient their recommendations on the criteria specified by the Supervisory Board for its composition. In accordance with Section 25d (11) of the German Banking Act (KWG), which became effective on January 1, 2014, the Nomination Committee supports the Supervisory Board in identifying candidates to fill positions on the bank's Management Board, drawing up an objective to promote the representation of the underrepresented gender on the Supervisory Board as well as a strategy for achieving this. It supports the Supervisory Board with the regular assessment, to be performed at least once a year, of the structure, size, composition and performance of the Management Board and of the Supervisory Board and makes recommendations regarding this to the Supervisory Board. It continues to support the Supervisory Board with the regular assessment, to be performed at least once a year, of the knowledge, skills and experience of the individual members of the Management Board and of the Supervisory Board as well as of the respective body collectively. The Nomination Committee reviews the management's principles for selecting and appointing persons to the upper management levels and the recommendations made to the Management Board in this respect. The Nomination Committee held seven meetings in 2015, thereof two jointly with the Chairman’s Committee.

The current members of the Nomination Committee are Dr. Paul Achleitner (Chairman), Frank Bsirske, Alfred Herling, Professor Dr. Henning Kagermann and Dr. Johannes Teyssen.

Audit Committee: The Audit Committee supports the Supervisory Board in the following matters in particular: in monitoring the financial accounting process; the effectiveness of the risk management system, particularly of the internal control system and the internal audit system; the auditing of the financial statements, especially with regard to the auditor’s independence and the additional services provided by the auditor; and the Management Board’s prompt remediation – through suitable measures – of the deficiencies identified by the auditor. The Audit Committee pre-reviews the documentation relating to the annual and consolidated financial statements and discusses the audit reports with the auditor. It prepares the decisions of the Supervisory Board on establishing the annual financial statements and

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
429   Deutsche Bank   Management Board and   Auditing and Controlling – 432
  Annual Report 2015   Supervisory Board – 419   Compliance with the German Corporate
    Reporting and Transparency – 431   Governance Code – 435
    Related Party Transactions – 432  
                              
     

 

                    

the approval of the consolidated financial statements and discusses important changes to the audit and accounting methods. The Audit Committee also discusses the quarterly financial statements and the report on the limited review of the quarterly financial statements with the Management Board and the auditor prior to their publication. Furthermore, the Audit Committee submits proposals to the Supervisory Board for the appointment of the auditor and prepares the proposal of the Supervisory Board to the General Meeting for the election of the auditor. The Audit Committee advises the Supervisory Board on issuing the audit mandate to the auditor elected by the General Meeting, submits proposals to the Supervisory Board for the auditor’s remuneration and supports the Supervisory Board in monitoring the independence, qualifications and efficiency of the auditor as well as the rotation of the members of the audit team. The Audit Committee is responsible for acknowledging communications about significant reductions in the compliance budget and for taking receipt of and handling the report by the Head of Compliance on the appropriateness and effectiveness of the principles, methods and procedures in accordance with Section 33 (1) sentence 2 No. 5 of the German Securities Trading Act (WpHG) (Compliance Report). The Compliance Report is issued at least once a year. The Head of Group Audit regularly reports to the Audit Committee on its ongoing work. The Audit Committee is informed about special audits, substantial complaints and other exceptional measures on the part of bank regulatory authorities. It has functional responsibility for receiving and handling complaints concerning accounting, internal audit process and issues relating to the audit. The Audit Committee supports the Supervisory Board in connection with its approval for mandates engaging the auditor for non-audit-related services (in this context, see also the Principal Accountant Fees and Services section starting on page 386 of the Corporate Governance Statement/Corporate Governance Report). The Audit Committee held seventeen meetings in 2015, thereof three jointly with the Risk Committee and four jointly with the Integrity Committee.

The current members of the Audit Committee are Richard Meddings (Chairman since October 13, 2015), Dr. Paul Achleitner, Henriette Mark, Gabriele Platscher, Bernd Rose and Professor Dr. Klaus Rüdiger Trützschler.

Risk Committee: The Risk Committee advises the Supervisory Board, in particular on the current and future overall risk appetite and overall risk strategy and supports the Supervisory Board in monitoring the implementation of this strategy by the upper management level. The Risk Committee monitors all the major aspects of the bank’s rating and valuation procedures. The Risk Committee monitors the terms and conditions in the client business to ensure they are in line with the bank’s business model and risk structure. If this is not the case, the Risk Committee requests proposals from the Management Board on how the terms and conditions in the client business could be structured to bring them into line with the bank’s business model and risk structure, and monitors their implementation. The Risk Committee examines whether the incentives set by the compensation system take into consideration the company's risk, capital and liquidity structure as well as the likelihood and timing of earnings. The Risk Committee also performs all of the tasks assigned to it by law or regulatory authorities. It handles loans which require a resolution by the Supervisory Board pursuant to law or our Articles of Association. Subject to its review, it grants its approval for the acquisition of shareholdings in other companies insofar as the value of the shareholding is more than 2 %, but does not exceed 3 % of our regulatory banking capital and if it is likely that the shareholding will not remain in our full or partial possession for more than twelve months. At the meetings of the Risk Committee, the Management Board reports on credit, market, liquidity, operational, litigation and reputational risks. The Management Board also reports on risk strategy, credit portfolios, loans requiring Supervisory Board approval pursuant to law or our Articles of Association, questions of capital resources and matters of special importance due to the risks they entail (for additional information on the disclosure of the risk management objectives and policies for individual risk categories, please see the Risk Report starting on page 79 of the Financial Report). The Risk Committee held eleven meetings in 2015, thereof two jointly with the Compensation Control Committee and three jointly with the Audit Committee.

The current members of the Risk Committee are Dr. Paul Achleitner (Chairman until January 28, 2015), Dina Dublon (Chairperson since January 28, 2015), Richard Meddings (since October 13, 2015), Louise M. Parent and Rudolf Stockem.

Integrity Committee: The Integrity Committee continually advises and monitors the Management Board with regard to whether management is committed to the economically sound, sustainable development of the company while observing the principles of sound, responsible management, fulfilling the company's social responsibilities and protecting the natural resources of the environment (environmental, social and governance (ESG) issues); and with regard to whether

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    3 – Corporate Governance Statement/ Corporate Governance Report    430
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

the business management is aligned to these with the objective of a holistic corporate culture. The Integrity Committee deals, in particular, with the following matters: It monitors the Management Board’s measures to ensure the company’s compliance with legal requirements, authorities’ regulations and the company’s own in-house policies. It regularly reviews the bank's Code of Business Conduct and Ethics to foster exemplary conduct on the part of company employees, both within and outside the company, and that such conduct is not just aligned to formal compliance with statutory requirements. It observes and analyzes the legal and reputational risks that are material to the bank and advocates their avoidance. For this purpose, it advises the Management Board on how to generate awareness of the importance of such risks. The Integrity Committee also prepares the Supervisory Board decisions on pursuing recourse claims or taking other measures against current or former members of the Management Board. The Integrity Committee held fifteen meetings in 2015, thereof four jointly with the Audit Committee.

The current members of the Integrity Committee are Georg Thoma (Chairman), Dr. Paul Achleitner, Sabine Irrgang, Timo Heider, Martina Klee and Peter Löscher.

Compensation Control Committee: The Compensation Control Committee supports the Supervisory Board in the appropriate structuring of the compensation systems for the Management Board. It monitors the appropriate structure of the compensation systems for the Manaagement Baord and employees and, in particular, the appropriate structure of the compensation for the heads of the risk control function and compliance function and for the employees who have a material influence on the bank's overall risk profile. It supports the Supervisory Board in monitoring the appropriate structure of the compensation systems for the company's employees and assesses the effects of the compensation systems on risk, capital and liquidity management, while ensuring that the compensation systems are aligned to the business strategy focused on the bank's sustainable development, to the risk strategies derived from this and to the compensation strategies at the company and Group levels. The Compensation Control Committee prepares the Supervisory Board's resolutions on the compensation of the Management Board, considering, in particular, the effects of the resolutions on the company's risks and risk management. The long-term interests of shareholders, investors and other stakeholders as well as the public interest are also taken into account. It prepares the Supervisory Board's resolutions on setting the total amount of variable compensation for the members of the Management Board in accordance with Section 45 (2) sentence 1 No. 5a of the German Banking Act (KWG) in consideration of Section 7 of the Regulation on Remuneration in Financial Institutions (InstitutsVV) and on setting the appropriate compensation parameters, targets for contributions to performance, payment and deferral periods as well as the conditions for a full forfeiture or partial reduction of variable compensation. It also checks regularly, at least annually, whether the adopted specifications are still appropriate. Furthermore, it checks, as part of its support to the Supervisory Board in monitoring the appropriate structure of the compensation systems for employees, regularly, but at least annually, in particular, whether the total amount of variable compensation has been set in accordance with Section 45 (2) sentence 1 No. 5a of the German Banking Act (KWG) in consideration of Section 7 of the Regulation on Remuneration in Financial Institutions (InstitutsVV) and whether the specified principles to assess the compensation parameters, contributions to performance as well as the payment and deferral periods, including the conditions for a full forfeiture or partial reduction of the variable compensation, are appropriate. In addition, it supports the Supervisory Board in monitoring whether the internal controls and other relevant areas are properly involved in the structuring of the compensation systems. The Compensation Control Committee held twelve meetings in 2015, thereof two jointly with the Risk Committee.

The current members of the Compensation Control Committee are Dr. Paul Achleitner (Chairman), Frank Bsirske, Alfred Herling and Professor Dr. Henning Kagermann.

Mediation Committee: In addition to these six standing committees, the Mediation Committee, which is required by German law, makes proposals to the Supervisory Board on the appointment or dismissal of members of the Management Board in cases where the Supervisory Board is unable to reach a two-thirds majority decision with respect to the appointment or dismissal. The Mediation Committee only meets if necessary and did not hold any meetings in 2015.

The current members of the Mediation Committee are Dr. Paul Achleitner (Chairman), Wolfgang Böhr (since December 1, 2015), Alfred Herling and Professor Dr. Henning Kagermann.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
431   Deutsche Bank   Management Board and   Auditing and Controlling – 432
  Annual Report 2015   Supervisory Board – 419   Compliance with the German Corporate
    Reporting and Transparency – 431   Governance Code – 435
    Related Party Transactions – 432  
     
     
                              
     

 

                    

Further details regarding the Chairman’s Committee, the Nomination Committee, the Audit Committee, the Risk Committee, the Integrity Committee and the Compensation Control Committee are regulated in separate Terms of Reference. The current versions are available on our website, along with the Terms of Reference for the Supervisory Board (see: www.db.com/ir/en/documents.htm).

Share Plans

For information on our employee share programs, please refer to Note 35 “Employee Benefits” to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

Reporting and Transparency

Directors’ Share Ownership

Management Board. For information on the share ownership of the Management Board, please refer to our detailed Compensation Report in the Management Report.

Supervisory Board. The members of our Supervisory Board held the following numbers of our shares and share awards under our employee share plans.

 

Members of the Supervisory Board

  

Number of shares  

    

Number of share
awards

Dr. Paul Achleitner

   0        0  

 

  

 

    

 

Wolfgang Böhr

   0        0  

 

  

 

    

 

Frank Bsirske

   0        0  

 

  

 

    

 

Dina Dublon

   0        0  

 

  

 

    

 

Katherine Garrett-Cox

   0        0  

 

  

 

    

 

Timo Heider

   0        0  

 

  

 

    

 

Alfred Herling

   1,561        10  

 

  

 

    

 

Sabine Irrgang

   735        10  

 

  

 

    

 

Professor Dr. Henning Kagermann

   0        0  

 

  

 

    

 

Martina Klee

   1,367        10  

 

  

 

    

 

Peter Löscher

   0        0  

 

  

 

    

 

Henriette Mark

   1,006        10  

 

  

 

    

 

Richard Meddings

   0        0  

 

  

 

    

 

Louise Parent

   0        0  

 

  

 

    

 

Gabriele Platscher

   1,060        10  

 

  

 

    

 

Bernd Rose

   0        0  

 

  

 

    

 

Rudolf Stockem

   0        0  

 

  

 

    

 

Dr. Johannes Teyssen

   0        0  

 

  

 

    

 

Georg Thoma

   2,250        0  

 

  

 

    

 

Professor Dr. Klaus Rüdiger Trützschler

   2,950        0  

 

  

 

    

 

Total

   10,929        50  

 

The members of the Supervisory Board held 10,929 shares, amounting to less than 0.01 % of our shares as of February 19, 2016.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    3 – Corporate Governance Statement/ Corporate Governance Report    432
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

As listed in the “Number of share awards” column in the table, the members who are employees of Deutsche Bank hold matching awards granted under the Global Share Purchase Plan, which are scheduled to be delivered to them on November 1, 2016.

As described in the “Management Report: Compensation Report: Compensation System for Supervisory Board Members”, 25 % of each member’s compensation for services as a member of the Supervisory Board for a given prior year is, rather than being paid in cash, converted into notional shares of Deutsche Bank in February of the following year. The cash value of the notional shares is paid to the member in February of the year following his departure from the Supervisory Board or the expiration of his term of office, based on the market price of the Deutsche Bank share near the payment date. The table in the section specified above shows the number of notional shares that were credited in February 2016 to members of the Supervisory Board as part of their 2015 compensation.

Related Party Transactions

For information on related party transactions please refer to Note 38 “Related Party Transactions“.

Auditing and Controlling

Audit Committee Financial Expert

The Supervisory Board determined that Dr. Paul Achleitner, Richard Meddings and Professor Dr. Klaus Rüdiger Trützschler, who are members of its Audit Committee, are “audit committee financial experts”, as such term is defined by the implementation rules of the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission issued pursuant to Section 407 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. These audit committee financial experts are “independent” of the bank, as defined in Rule 10A-3 under the U.S. Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and Section 100 (5) of the German Stock Corporation Act (AktG). In accordance with the provisions of Sections 107 (4) and 100 (5) of the German Stock Corporation Act (AktG) as well as Section 25d (9) of the German Banking Act (KWG), they have the required expert knowledge in financial accounting and auditing.

Compensation Control Committee Compensation Expert

Since January 1, 2014, pursuant to Section 25d (12) of the German Banking Act (KWG), at least one member of the Compensation Control Committee must have sufficient expertise and professional experience in the field of risk management and risk controlling, in particular, with regard to the mechanisms to align compensation systems to the company’s overall risk appetite and strategy and the bank’s capital base. The Supervisory Board determined that Dr. Paul Achleitner and Professor Dr. Henning Kagermann, members of the Compensation Control Committee, fulfill the requirements of Section 25d (12) of the German Banking Act (KWG) and therefore have the required expertise and professional experience in risk management and risk controlling.

For a description of the experience of the Supervisory Board members mentioned above, please see “Management Report: Corporate Governance Statement/Corporate Governance Report: Management Board and Supervisory Board: Supervisory Board” on pages 423 to 428 of the Financial Report.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
433   Deutsche Bank   Management Board and   Auditing and Controlling – 432
  Annual Report 2015   Supervisory Board – 419   Compliance with the German Corporate
    Reporting and Transparency – 431   Governance Code – 435
    Related Party Transactions – 432  
                              
     

 

                    

Values and leadership principles

Code of Business Conduct and Ethics

Deutsche Bank’s Code of Business Conduct and Ethics describes the values and minimum standards for ethical business conduct that we expect all of our employees to follow. These values and standards govern em-ployee interactions with our clients, competitors, business partners, government and regulatory authorities, and shareholders, as well as with other employees. The Code contains a voluntary commitment from the Management Board. It reflects our values and believes. In addition, it forms the cornerstone of our policies, which provide guidance on compliance with applicable laws and regulations.

In accordance with Section 406 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, we adopted a code of ethics with special obligations that apply to our “Senior Financial Officers”, which currently consist of Deutsche Bank’s Co-Chairmen of the Management Board, Chief Financial Officer, Group Controller and certain other Senior Financial Officers. There were no amendments or waivers to this code of ethics in 2015. Information regarding any future amendments or waivers will be published on Deutsche Bank’s code of ethics website, referred to below.

The current versions of the codes of ethics are available from Deutsche Bank’s website: www.db.com/ir/en/documents.htm.

House of Governance Initiative

Deutsche Bank AG’s House of Governance Initiative was successfully completed at the end of June 2015. The objective of this initiative was to improve the corporate governance structures of Deutsche Bank AG. For this initiative, a target model for assigning responsibilities was created and well-defined, transparent accountabilities with consistent delegation and escalation lines, as well as committee functions and information flows, were established. As part of this initiative, the “Governance Owner App“ (GO App) was developed to enable the documentation and control of governance processes.

Corporate Governance Fundamentals

The Policy “Corporate Governance Fundamentals – Deutsche Bank Group” was introduced in September 2015. The Policy defines the fundamental Corporate Governance principles that regulate the interaction between Deutsche Bank's internal corporate bodies and decision-makers. The Corporate Governance Fundamentals provide the internal structure through which Deutsche Bank's objectives are implemented. Furthermore, they institutionalize the roles, competencies and ownership within the legal framework governing Deutsche Bank, and support clear mandates and responsibilities. The Management Board and senior management support the Fundamentals and have made a commitment to work toward their full implementation.

Principal Accountant Fees and Services

In accordance with German law, our principal accountant is appointed at our Annual General Meeting based on a recommendation of our Supervisory Board. The Audit Committee of our Supervisory Board prepares such a recommendation. Subsequent to the principal accountant’s appointment, the Audit Committee awards the contract and in its sole authority approves the terms and scope of the audit and all audit engagement fees as well as monitors the principal accountant’s independence. KPMG AG Wirtschaftsprüfungsgesellschaft was our principal accountant for the 2014 and 2015 fiscal years, respectively.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    3 – Corporate Governance Statement/ Corporate Governance Report    434
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

The table set forth below contains the aggregate fees billed for each of the last two fiscal years by KPMG AG Wirtschaftsprüfungsgesellschaft and the worldwide member firms of KPMG International in each of the following categories: (1) Audit fees, which are fees for professional services for the audit of our annual financial statements or services that are normally provided by the accountant in connection with statutory and regulatory filings or engagements for those fiscal years, (2) Audit-related fees, which are fees for assurance and related services that are reasonably related to the performance of the audit or review of our financial statements and are not reported as Audit fees, (3) Tax-related fees, which are fees for professional services rendered for tax compliance, tax consulting and tax planning, and (4) All other fees, which are fees for products and services other than Audit fees, Audit-related fees and Tax-related fees. These amounts include expenses and exclude Value Added Tax (VAT).

 

Fee category in m.

  2015       2014    

Audit fees

    53          54     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Audit-related fees

    17          14     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Tax-related fees

    5          8     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

All other fees

    1          2     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total fees1

    76          78     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

The Audit fees figure excludes the audit fees for Postbank and its subsidiaries, as they are not audited by KPMG. The Audit-related fees include fees for accounting advisory, due diligence relating to actual or contemplated acquisitions and dispositions, attestation engagements and other agreed-upon procedure engagements. Our Tax-related fees include fees for services relating to the preparation and review of tax returns and related compliance assistance and advice, tax consultation and advice relating to Group tax planning strategies and initiatives and assistance with assessing compliance with tax regulations. All other fees were incurred for project-related advisory services.

United States law and regulations, and our own policies, generally require that all engagements of our principal accountant be pre-approved by our Audit Committee or pursuant to policies and procedures adopted by it. Our Audit Committee has adopted the following policies and procedures for consideration and approval of requests to engage our principal accountant to perform non-audit services. Engagement requests must in the first instance be submitted to the Accounting Engagement Team. If the request relates to services that would impair the independence of our principal accountant, the request must be rejected. Our Audit Committee has given its pre-approval for specified assurance, financial advisory and tax services, provided the expected fees for any such service do not exceed 1 million. If the engagement request relates to such specified pre-approved services, it may be approved by the Accounting Engagement Team and must thereafter be reported to the Audit Committee. If the engagement request relates neither to prohibited non-audit services nor to pre-approved non-audit services, it must be forwarded to the Audit Committee for consideration. In addition, to facilitate the consideration of engagement requests between its meetings, the Audit Committee has delegated approval authority to several of its members who are “independent” as defined by the Securities and Exchange Commission and the New York Stock Exchange. Such members are required to report any approvals made by them to the Audit Committee at its next meeting.

Additionally, United States law and regulations permit the pre-approval requirement to be waived with respect to engagements for non-audit services aggregating to no more than five percent of the total amount of revenues we paid to our principal accountant, if such engagements were not recognized by us at the time of engagement and were promptly brought to the attention of our Audit Committee or a designated member thereof and approved prior to the completion of the audit. In 2014 and 2015, the percentage of the total amount of revenues we paid to our principal accountant for non-audit services that was subject to such a waiver was less than 5 % for each year.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
435   Deutsche Bank   Management Board and   Auditing and Controlling – 432
  Annual Report 2015   Supervisory Board – 419   Compliance with the German Corporate
    Reporting and Transparency – 431   Governance Code – 435
    Related Party Transactions – 432  
                              
     

 

                    

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    3 – Corporate Governance Statement/ Corporate Governance Report    436
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

 

 

                    

 


Table of Contents

4 –

Supplementary Information

438     Non-GAAP Financial Measures

443    Declaration of Backing

445    Imprint / Publications


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    4 – Supplementary Information    438
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Non-GAAP Financial Measures

This document and other documents the Group has published or may publish contain non-GAAP financial measures. Non-GAAP financial measures are measures of the Group’s historical or future performance, financial position or cash flows that contain adjustments that exclude or include amounts that are included or excluded, as the case may be, from the most directly comparable measure calculated and presented in accordance with IFRS in the Group’s financial statements.

Fully loaded CRR/CRD 4 Measures

As part of its measurements, the Group uses fully loaded CRR/CRD 4 metrics, including with respect to regulatory assets, exposures, risk-weighted assets, capital and ratios thereof. Such fully loaded metrics are are described in the “Management Report: Risk Report: Risk and Capital Performance: Capital and Leverage Ratio”, which also provides reconciliation to the respective CRR/CRD 4 transitional or IFRS values.

Return on Equity Ratios

The Group reports a number of return on equity ratios. These ratios comprise the pre-tax and post tax return on average shareholders’ equity, the pre-tax and post-tax return on average active equity and the post-tax return on average tangible shareholders’ equity, each of which is a non-GAAP financial measure.

Pre-tax returns on average shareholders’ equity and pre-tax return on average active equity, are defined as IBIT attributable to Deutsche Bank shareholders, as a percentage of average shareholders’ equity or average active equity, respectively. Income before income taxes attributable to Deutsche Bank shareholders is a non-GAAP financial measure and is defined as income (loss) before income taxes excluding pre-tax income (loss) attributable to noncontrolling interests.

The post-tax returns on average shareholders’ equity, average tangible shareholders' equity and average active equity are calculated as net income (loss) attributable to Deutsche Bank shareholders as a percentage of average shareholders’ equity, average tangible shareholders' equity and average active equity, respectively. Net income (loss) attributable to Deutsche Bank shareholders is a non-GAAP financial measure and is defined as net income (loss) excluding post-tax income (loss) attributable to noncontrolling interests.

At the Group level, the post-tax return reflects the reported effective tax rate for the Group, which was (11) % for the full year 2015, 46 % for 2014 and 53 % for 2013. To calculate post-tax return for the segments, the applied tax rate was 35 % for the respective periods.

At the Group level, tangible shareholders' equity is the shareholders’ equity as reported in the Consolidated Balance Sheet excluding goodwill and other intangible assets. Tangible shareholders´ equity for the segments is calculated by deducting goodwill and other intangible assets from active equity as allocated to the segments. Active equity represents the shareholders’ equity adjusted for dividends, for which a proposal is accrued on a quarterly basis and which are paid after the approval at the Annual General Meeting each year. C&A contains the dividend accrual. Shareholders’ equity, tangible shareholders’ equity and active equity are presented on an average basis. The Group believes that a presentation of the measures average tangible shareholders’ equity and average active equity makes comparisons to its competitors easier, and refers to these measures in a number of the return on equity ratios presented by the Group. However, average tangible shareholders’ equity and average active equity are not measures provided for in IFRS, and the Group’s ratios based on these measures should not be compared to other companies’ ratios without considering differences in the calculations.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
439   Deutsche Bank   Non-GAAP Financial Measures – 438  
  Annual Report 2015   Declaration of Backing – 435   Impressum/Publications – 445
                              
     

 

                    

For the allocation of average active equity across the segments, please see Note 4 “Business Segments and Related Information” to the consolidated financial statements.

The reconciliation of the aforementioned ratios is set forth in the table below:

 

    2015     

in m. (unless stated otherwise)

  Corporate  
Banking &  
Securities  
    Private &  
Business  
Clients  
    Global  
Transaction  
Banking  
    Deutsche  
Asset &  
Wealth  
Management  
    Non-Core  
Operations  
Unit  
    Consoli-  
dation &  
Adjustments  
    Total  
Consolidated  
 
Income (loss) before income taxes (IBIT)     (2,035)          (3,291)          1,439           1,250           (2,732)          (729)          (6,097)     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Less income (loss) before income taxes attributable to noncontrolling interests     0           0           0           0           0           27           27      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
IBIT attributable to Deutsche Bank Shareholders     (2,035)          (3,291)          1,439           1,250           (2,732)          (756)          (6,124)     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Income (loss) before income taxes (IBIT)     (2,035)          (3,291)          1,439           1,250           (2,732)          (729)          (6,097)     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Income tax expense     (720)          (1,165)          509           443           (967)          2,575           675      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Net Income (loss)     (1,315)          (2,126)          929           808           (1,765)          (3,304)          (6,772)     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Net income (loss) attributable to noncontrolling interests     0           0           0           0           0           (21)          (21)     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Net Income attributable to DB shareholders and additional equity components     (1,315)          (2,126)          929           808           (1,765)          (3,326)          (6,794)     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Average shareholders’ equity                 69,055      

 

             

 

 

 
Add (deduct): Average dividend accruals                 (696)     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Average active equity     30,948           15,099           7,607           8,023           6,674           7           68,359      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Add (deduct)              

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Average dividend accruals     0           0           0           0           0           696           696      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Average goodwill and other intangible assets     (3,897)          (3,407)          (1,053)          (5,362)          (573)          383           (13,909)     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Average tangible shareholders’ equity     27,051           11,693           6,554           2,662           6,100           1,087           55,146      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Post-tax return on average tangible share- holders’ equity (in %) 1     (4.9)          (18.2)          14.2           30.3           N/M           N/M           (12.3)     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Pre-tax return on average active equity (in %)     (6.6)          (21.8)          18.9           15.6           N/M           N/M           (9.0)     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Post-tax return on average active equity (in %)1     (4.2)          (14.1)          12.2           10.1           N/M           N/M           (9.9)     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

1 

The post-tax return on average shareholders’ equity, average active equity and average tangible shareholders’ equity, at the Group level reflects the reported effective tax rate for the Group.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    4 – Supplementary Information    440
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

    2014     

in m. (unless stated otherwise)

  Corporate  
Banking &  
Securities  
    Private &  
Business  
Clients  
    Global  
Transaction  
Banking  
    Deutsche  
Asset &  
Wealth  
Management  
    Non-Core  
Operations  
Unit  
    Consoli-  
dation &  
Adjustments  
    Total  
Consolidated  
 
Income (loss) before income taxes (IBIT)     2,909          1,189          1,152          1,016          (2,899)         (251)         3,116     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Less income (loss) before income taxes attributable to noncontrolling interests     0          0          0          0          0          28          28     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
IBIT attributable to Deutsche Bank Shareholders     2,909          1,189          1,152          1,016          (2,899)         (279)         3,088     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Income (loss) before income taxes (IBIT)     2,909          1,189          1,152          1,016          (2,899)         (251)         3,116     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Income tax expense     1,018          416          403          356          (1,015)         247          1,425     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Net Income (loss)     1,891          773          749          661          (1,884)         (498)         1,691     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Net income (loss) attributable to noncontrolling interests     0          0          0          0          0          (28)         (28)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Net Income attributable to DB shareholders and additional equity components     1,891          773          749          661          (1,884)         (526)         1,663     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Average shareholders’ equity                 61,410     

 

             

 

 

 
Add (deduct): Average dividend accruals                 (785)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Average active equity     25,445          14,853          6,033          6,532          7,762          0          60,624     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Add (deduct)              

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Average dividend accruals     0          0          0          0          0          785          785     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Average goodwill and other intangible assets     (3,759)         (4,107)         (883)         (4,678)         (809)         (63)         (14,299)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Average tangible shareholders’ equity     21,686          10,746          5,151          1,854          6,953          722          47,111     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Post-tax return on average tangible share- holders’ equity (in %)1     8.7          7.2          14.5          35.6          N/M          N/M          3.5     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Pre-tax return on average active equity (in %)     11.4          8.0          19.1          15.6          N/M          N/M          5.1     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Post-tax return on average active equity (in %)1     7.4          5.2          12.4          10.1          N/M          N/M          2.7     

 

 

 

1 

The post-tax return on average shareholders’ equity, average active equity and average tangible shareholders’ equity, at the Group level reflects the reported effective tax rate for the Group.

 

    2013     

in m. (unless stated otherwise)

  Corporate  
Banking &  
Securities  
    Private &  
Business  
Clients  
    Global  
Transaction  
Banking  
    Deutsche  
Asset &  
Wealth  
Management  
    Non-Core  
Operations  
Unit  
    Consoli-  
dation &  
Adjustments  
    Total  
Consolidated  
 
Income (loss) before income taxes (IBIT)     2,891          1,363          1,053          762          (3,478)         (1,136)         1,456     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Less income (loss) before income taxes attributable to noncontrolling interests     0          0          0          0          0          15          15     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
IBIT attributable to Deutsche Bank Shareholders     2,891          1,363          1,053          762          (3,478)         (1,151)         1,442     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Income (loss) before income taxes (IBIT)     2,891          1,363          1,053          762          (3,478)         (1,136)         1,456     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Income tax expense     917          432          334          242          (1,103)         (46)         775     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Net Income (loss)     1,975          931          719          520          (2,376)         (1,089)         681     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Net income (loss) attributable to noncontrolling interests     0          0          0          0          0          (15)         (15)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Net Income attributable to DB share- holders and additional equity components     1,975          931          719          520          (2,376)         (1,104)         666     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Average shareholders’ equity                 56,080     

 

             

 

 

 
Add (deduct): Average dividend accruals                 (646)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Average active equity     20,161          13,976          5,136          5,864          10,296          0          55,434     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Add (deduct)              

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Average dividend accruals     0          0          0          0          0          646          646     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Average goodwill and other intangible assets     (4,423)         (3,704)         (788)         (4,657)         (1,775)         1,199          (14,149)    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Average tangible shareholders’ equity     15,738          10,273         4,348          1,207         8,521          1,845          41,931    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Post-tax return on average tangible share- holders’ equity (in %)1     12.5          9.1          16.5          43.1          N/M          N/M          1.6     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Pre-tax return on average active equity (in %)     14.3          9.8          20.5          13.0          N/M          N/M          2.6     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Post-tax return on average active equity (in %)1     9.8          6.7          14.0          8.9          N/M          N/M          1.2     

 

 

 

1 

The post-tax return on average shareholders’ equity, average active equity and average tangible shareholders’ equity, at the Group level reflects the reported effective tax rate for the Group.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
441   Deutsche Bank   Non-GAAP Financial Measures – 438  
  Annual Report 2015   Declaration of Backing – 435   Impressum/Publications – 445
                              
     

 

                    

Adjusted Costs

Adjusted costs is one of the key performance indicator outlined in strategy 2020. Adjusted costs is a non-GAAP financial measure most directly comparable to the IFRS financial measure noninterest expenses. Adjusted costs is calculated by adjusting noninterest expenses under IFRS for (i) impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets, (ii) litigation, (iii) policyholder benefits and claims and (iv) restructuring and severances. The Group believes that a presentation of noninterest expenses excluding the impact of these items provides a more meaningful depiction of the costs associated with our operating businesses.

 

in

      Dec 31, 2015        Dec 31, 2014     

Noninterest expenses

    (38,667 )        (27,699 )   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Impairment of Goodwill and other intangible Assets

    (5,776 )        (111 )   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Litigation1

    (5,218 )        (1,971 )   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Policyholder benefits and claims

    (256 )        (289 )   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Restructuring and Severance

    (965 )        (375 )   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Adjusted cost

    (26,452 )        (24,953 )   

 

 
1 

2014 include 400 million charges from loan processing fees.

Book Value and Tangible Book Value per Basic Share Outstanding

Book value per basic share outstanding and tangible book value per basic share outstanding are non-GAAP financial measures that are used and relied upon by investors and industry analysts as capital adequacy metrics. Book value per basic share outstanding represents the Bank’s total shareholders’ equity divided by the number of basic shares outstanding at period-end. Tangible book value represents the Bank’s total shareholders’ equity less goodwill and other intangible assets. Tangible book value per basic share outstanding is computed by dividing tangible book value by period-end basic shares outstanding.

Tangible Book Value

 

in m.                     2015 increase (decrease)   
from 2014   
    2014 increase (decrease)   
from 2013   
 

(unless stated otherwise)

  2015        2014        2013        in   m.        in %        in m.         in %     
Total shareholders’ equity (Book value)         62,678               68,351               54,719           (5,673)          (8)          13,633            25      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 
Goodwill and other intangible assets     (10,078)          (14,951)          (13,932)          4,873           (33)          (1,019)           7      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 
Tangible shareholders’ equity (Tangible book value)     52,600           53,400           40,786           (800)          (1)          12,614             31      

 

 

Basic Shares Outstanding

 

                      2015 increase (decrease)   
from 2014
    2014 increase (decrease)   
from 2013
 

in m.

(unless stated otherwise)

  2015        2014        2013        in m.        in %        in m.        in %     
Number of shares             1,379.3                   1,379.3                   1,068.5           0           0           310.7           29.1      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Shares outstanding:              

Treasury shares

    (0.4)          (0.3)          (0.2)          (0.1)          44.1           (0.1)          44.4      

Vested share awards

    8.9           6.8           8.8           2.1           31.6           (2.0)          (22.9)     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Basic shares outstanding     1,387.8           1,385.8           1,077.1 1          2.0           0.1           308.7           28.7      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Book value per basic share outstanding in €     45.16           49.32           50.80           (4.16)          (8.4)          (1.48)          (2.9)     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Tangible book value per basic share outstanding in €     37.90           38.53           37.87           (0.63)          (1.6)         0.66           1.7      

 

 

 

1

The basic shares outstanding have been adjusted in order to reflect the effect of the bonus component of subscription rights issued in June 2014 in connection with the capital increase.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    4 – Supplementary Information    442
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

Valuation Adjustments

In the “Management Report: Operating and Financial Review”, the Group refers to impacts on profit and loss from Debt Valuation Adjustments (DVA) and Funding Valuation Adjustments (FVA), as well as from regulatory capital hedges in respect of Credit Valuation Adjustments (CVA).

DVA incorporates the impact of the Group’s own credit risk in the fair valuing of financial liabilities, including derivative contracts.

FVA is applied to derivative positions that are not wholly collateralized. It reflects the market implied funding costs on both assets and liabilities and has the effect of incorporating the present value of funding costs into the fair value of derivative positions that are not wholly collateralized.

As described in Note 14 “Financial Instruments Carried at Fair Value”, counterparty CVA is applied to derivative positions and is determined by assessing the potential credit exposure to a given counterparty. The calculation of CVA takes into account any collateral held, the effect of netting agreements, expected loss given default and the credit risk, based on available market information, including credit default swap spreads.

CVAs result in charges to the Group’s Risk Weighted Asset (RWAs) under the CRR/CRD 4 capital rules. The Group has sought to mitigate these RWA charges through hedging with credit default swaps. These regulatory capital hedges are additional to those entered into to hedge CVA exposures under IFRS hedge accounting rules, and accordingly, result in mark-to-market movements in profit and loss that are reported as a revenue item.

The Group believes that the presentation of these measures excluding the impact of these items provides a more meaningful depiction of the underlying fundamentals of its businesses impacted by such items.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
443   Deutsche Bank   Non-GAAP Financial Measures – 438   Impressum/Publications – 445
  Annual Report 2015   Declaration of Backing – 443  
     
     
     
     
                              
     

 

                    

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    4 – Supplementary Information    444
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
445   Deutsche Bank   Non-GAAP Financial Measures – 438   Impressum/Publications – 445
  Annual Report 2015   Declaration of Backing – 443  
     
     
     
     
                              
     

 

                    

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

 

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank    4 – Supplementary Information    446
Annual Report 2015      
     
     

 

[Page intentionally left blank for SEC filing purposes]

 

 


Table of Contents

 

 

[Page intentionally left blank]

 

 

 

 


Table of Contents
S-1   Deutsche Bank   PART I – 8   Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F   PART II – 103   Annual Report – 116
    PART III – 114   Supplemental Financial Information
      (Unaudited) – 1
                              
     

 

                    

Supplemental Financial Information (Unaudited)

Industry Guide 3 Information

Amounts for 2015, 2014, 2013, 2012 and 2011 are prepared in accordance with IFRS, which is consistent with the Group’s Financial Statements.

Financial Condition

Average balance sheet based upon month-end balances

 

Average balance sheet and interest and similar income   2015      2014      2013   

in m.

(unless stated otherwise)

  Average  
balance  
    Interest       Average 
yield/rate 
    Average  
balance  
    Interest       Average 
yield/rate 
    Average  
balance  
    Interest       Average 
yield/rate 
 
Assets:1                  

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Interest-earning deposits with banks:                  

In German offices

    12,007          (17)          (0.14) %         9,360          34          0.36 %         30,508          65          0.21 %    

In Non-German offices

    57,377          516          0.90 %         79,336          649          0.82 %         82,664          694          0.84 %    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total interest-earning deposits with banks     69,384          499          0.72 %         88,696          683          0.77 %         113,172          759          0.67 %    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Central bank funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements:                  

In German offices

    8,713          (9)          (0.10) %         14,502          39          0.27 %         21,528          40          0.18 %    

In Non-German offices

    16,125          386          2.39 %         13,243          369          2.79 %         14,045          372          2.65 %    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total central bank funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements     24,838          377          1.52 %         27,745          408          1.47 %         35,573          412          1.16 %    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Securities borrowed:                  

In German offices

    116          0          (0.19) %         154          0          0.00 %         120          0          0.08 %    

In Non-German offices2

    31,494          (368)          (1.17) %         24,563          (313)          (1.27) %         25,024          (375)          (1.50) %    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total securities borrowed     31,610          (368)          (1.17) %         24,717          (313)          (1.27) %         25,144          (375)          (1.49) %    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Interest-earning financial assets at fair value through profit or loss:                  

In German offices

    23,907          630          2.64 %         29,780          633          2.13 %         41,471          936          2.26 %    

In Non-German offices

    302,528          9,866          3.26 %         365,298          9,172          2.51 %         420,367          9,793          2.33 %    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total interest-earning financial assets at fair value through profit or loss     326,435          10,496          3.22 %         395,078          9,805          2.48 %         461,838          10,729          2.32 %    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Financial assets available for sale:                  

In German offices

    21,820          367          1.68 %         21,043          551          2.62 %         26,737          728          2.72 %    

In Non-German offices

    49,708          1,225          2.46 %         34,448          886          2.57 %         24,807          666          2.68 %    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total financial assets available for sale     71,528          1,592          2.23 %         55,491          1,437          2.59 %         51,544          1,394          2.70 %    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Loans:3                  

In German offices

    216,398          6,448          2.98 %         216,371          6,546          3.03 %         221,758          6,912          3.12 %    

In Non-German offices

    212,904          5,771          2.71 %         176,676          5,274          2.98 %         167,738          5,029          3.00 %    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total loans     429,302          12,219          2.85 %         393,047          11,820          3.01 %         389,496          11,941          3.07 %    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total other interest-earning assets     78,730          1,152          1.46 %         56,134          1,161          2.07 %         59,895          741          1.24 %    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total interest-earning assets     1,031,827          25,967          2.52 %         1,040,908          25,001          2.40 %         1,136,662          25,601          2.25 %    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Cash and due from banks     22,513              18,111              20,551         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Noninterest-earning financial assets at fair value through profit or loss:                  

In German offices

    298,011              258,290              302,888         

In Non-German offices

    328,502              278,504              351,880         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
All other assets     114,036              133,972              135,451         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Allowance for credit losses     (5,115)              (5,288)              (5,044)         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total assets     1,789,774              1,724,497              1,942,388         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
% of assets attributable to Non-German offices     67 %                66 %                65 %        

 

 

 

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       S-2
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

Average balance sheet and interest expense   2015      2014      2013   

in m.

(unless stated otherwise)

  Average 
balance 
    Interest      Average 
yield/rate 
    Average 
balance 
    Interest      Average 
yield/rate 
    Average 
balance 
    Interest      Average 
yield/rate 
 
Liabilities and equity:1                  

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Interest-bearing deposits:                  

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

In German offices:

                 

Time deposits

    68,412         370         0.54 %         52,004        411         0.79 %         50,737         484         0.95 %    

Savings deposits

    98,372         866         0.88 %         100,555        928         0.92 %         104,983         1,131         1.08 %    

Demand deposits

    42,156         34         0.08 %         38,963        74         0.19 %         51,253         134         0.26 %    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total in German offices

    208,940         1,270         0.60 %         191,522        1,413         0.74 %         206,973         1,749         0.84 %    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

In Non-German offices:

                 

Time deposits

    60,913         1,102         1.81 %         77,660        998         1.29 %         107,684         992         0.92 %    

Savings deposits

    4,565         22         0.47 %         2,723        23         0.85 %         5,418         40         0.75 %    

Demand deposits

    114,640         370         0.32 %         101,883        776         0.76 %         89,870         579         0.64 %    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total in Non-German offices

    180,118         1,494         0.83 %         182,266        1,797         0.99 %         202,972         1,611         0.79 %    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total interest-bearing deposits     389,058         2,764         0.71 %         373,788        3,210         0.86 %         409,945         3,360         0.82 %    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Central bank funds purchased and securities sold under repurchase agreements:                  

In German offices

    59         (11)         (18.37) %        185               4.02 %         3,226                0.23 %    

In Non-German offices

    10,482         164         1.56 %         24,381        152         0.62 %         39,480         179         0.45 %    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total central bank funds purchased and securities sold under repurchase agreements     10,541         153         1.45 %         24,566        160         0.65 %         42,706         186         0.44 %    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Securities loaned:                  

In German offices2

                  (0.17) %        21               (1.52) %        14                (2.09) %   

In Non-German offices2

    3,006         (45)         (1.50) %        3,813        (157)         (4.10) %        4,699         (215)         (4.58) %   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total securities loaned     3,015         (45)         (1.50) %        3,834        (157)         (4.09) %        4,713         (216)         (4.57) %   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Interest-bearing financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss:                  

In German offices

    8,197         134         1.63 %         13,714        259         1.89 %         19,623         459         2.34 %    

In Non-German offices

    96,594         4,400         4.56 %         150,011        4,005         2.67 %         182,394         4,076         2.23 %    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total interest-bearing financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss     104,791         4,534         4.33 %         163,725        4,264         2.60 %         202,017         4,535         2.24 %    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other short-term borrowings:                  

In German offices

    547                1.66 %         1,077        15         1.41 %         1,318         16         1.24 %    

In Non-German offices

    33,778         220         0.65 %         53,003        199         0.38 %         69,142         269         0.39 %    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total other short-term borrowings     34,325         229         0.67 %         54,080        214         0.40 %         70,460         285         0.40 %    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Long-term debt and trust preferred securities:                  

In German offices

    89,180         771         0.87 %         74,490        1,190         1.60 %         77,107         1,078         1.40 %    

In Non-German offices

    76,469         1,277         1.67 %         75,680        1,477         1.95 %         79,002         1,339         1.69 %    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total long-term debt and trust preferred securities     165,649         2,048         1.24 %         150,170        2,667         1.78 %         156,109         2,417         1.55 %    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total other interest-bearing liabilities     109,414         403         0.37 %         84,942        371         0.44 %         93,295         200         0.21 %    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total interest-bearing liabilities     816,793        10,086        1.24 %         855,105        10,729        1.25 %         979,245        10,768        1.10 %    

 

 
1 

The allocation of the assets and liabilities between German and Non-German offices are based on the location of the entity which carries the respective asset or liability.

2 

Interest-earning deposits with banks include interest earning deposit with central bank and interest earning deposit with bank w/o central bank.

3 

Interest income and expense figures adjusted for 2013 to reflect the fees paid/received on securities borrowed/securities loaned transactions.

4 

Categories of loans include impaired loans.

5 

Interest-bearing deposits figures for Non German offices adjusted for 2014 and 2013 to reflect the time deposits, saving deposits and demand deposits.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents

S-3

  Deutsche Bank   PART I – 8   Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F   PART II – 103   Annual Report – 116
    PART III – 114   Supplemental Financial Information
      (Unaudited) – 1
                              
     

 

                    

 

Average balance sheet and interest expense   2015     2014     2013  

in m.

(unless stated otherwise)

  Average  
balance  
    Interest     Average  
yield/rate  
  Average  
balance  
    Interest     Average  
yield/rate  
  Average  
balance  
    Interest     Average  
yield/rate  
Noninterest-bearing deposits:                  

In German offices

    144,976              129,720              115,984         

In Non-German offices

    34,960              31,246              28,288         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Noninterest-bearing financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss:                  

In German offices

    265,922              233,796              279,090         

In Non-German offices

    338,378              282,043              349,330         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

All other noninterest-bearing liabilities     114,742              128,605              134,080         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total shareholders’ equity

    69,055              61,410              56,080         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Additional equity components     4,667              2,308              0         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Noncontrolling interests

    281              264              291         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total equity

    74,003              63,982              56,371         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities and equity

    1,789,774              1,724,497              1,942,388         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

% of liabilities attributable to Non-German offices1     57 %              60 %              61 %         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Rate spread

    1.28 %              1.14 %              1.15 %         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest margin (Net interest income to total interest-earning assets):                  

In German offices

    1.85 %              1.64 %              1.59 %         

In Non-German offices

    1.42 %              1.26 %              1.18 %         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    1.54 %             1.37 %             1.31 %         

 

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       S-4
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

Analysis of changes in interest and similar income and interest expense

 

    2015 over 2014 due to changes in1     2014 over 2013 due to changes in1  

in m.

  Net change       Volume       Rate       Net change       Volume       Rate    

Interest and similar income:

           

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Interest-earning deposits with banks:

           

German offices

    (50)          7           (58)          (31)          (60)          29      

Non-German offices

    (132)          (193)          61           (45)          (28)          (17)     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total interest-earning deposits with banks     (182)          (186)          3           (76)          (88)          12      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Central bank funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements:            

German offices

    (48)          (11)          (37)          0           (15)          15      

Non-German offices

    16           74           (57)          (4)          (22)          18      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total central bank funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements     (32)          63           (94)          (4)          (37)          33      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Securities borrowed:

           

German offices

    0           0           0           0           0           0      

Non-German offices

    (55)          (83)          27           62           7           55      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total securities borrowed     (55)          (83)          27           62           7           55     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial assets at fair value through profit or loss:

           

German offices

    (3)          (138)          136           (303)          (251)          (52)     

Non-German offices

    695           (1,748)          2,442           (622)          (1,346)          724      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total financial assets at fair value through profit or loss     692           (1,886)          2,578           (925)          (1,597)          672      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial assets available for sale

           

German offices

    (183)          20           (203)          (177)          (150)          (27)     

Non-German offices

    338           377           (39)          221           249           (28)     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total financial assets available for sale     155           397           (242)          44           99           (55)     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loans:

           

German offices

    (98)          1           (99)          (366)          (166)          (200)     

Non-German offices

    497           1,013           (515)          244           267           (23)     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total loans     399           1,014           (614)          (122)          101           (223)     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other interest-earning assets     (10)          388           (398)          420           (49)          469      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total interest and similar income     967           (293)          1,260           (601)          (1,564)          963      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Interest expense:

           

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Interest-bearing deposits:

           

German offices

    (143)          121           (263)          (335)          (125)          (211)     

Non-German offices

    (303)          (21)          (283)          186           (176)          362      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total interest-bearing deposits     (446)          100           (546)          (149)          (301)          151      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Central bank funds purchased and securities sold under repurchase agreements:            

German offices

    (18)           (2)          (16)          0           (13)          13      

Non-German offices

    12           (123)          134           (27)          (81)          55      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total central bank funds purchased and securities sold under repurchase agreements     (6)          (125)          118           (27)          (94)          68      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Securities loaned:

           

German offices

    0           0           0           0           0           0      

Non-German offices

    111           28           83           60           38           22      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total securities loaned     111           28           83           60           38           22      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss:

           

German offices

    (126)          (94)          (32)          (200)          (122)          (78)     

Non-German offices

    396           (1,764)          2,159           (71)          (791)          720      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss     270           (1,858)          2,127           (271)          (913)          642      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other short-term borrowings:

           

German offices

    (6)          (8)          2           (1)          (2)          1      

Non-German offices

    21           (86)          106           (70)          (59)          (11)     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total other short-term borrowings     15           (94)          108           (71)          (61)          (10)     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Long-term debt and trust preferred securities:

           

German offices

    (418)          203           (620)          111           (38)          149      

Non-German offices

    (201)          15           (216)          138           (58)          196      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total long-term debt and trust preferred securities     (619)          218           (836)          249           (96)          345      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other interest-bearing liabilities     32           97           (63)          171           (19)          190      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total interest expense     (643)          (1,634)          991           (38)          (1,446)          1,408      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Net change in net interest income     1,610           1,341           269           (563)          (118)          (445)     

 

 
1 

Changes due to combination of volume and rate are allocated proportionally.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents

S-5

  Deutsche Bank   PART I – 8   Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F   PART II – 103   Annual Report – 116
    PART III – 114   Supplemental Financial Information
      (Unaudited) – 1
                              
     

 

                    

Investment Portfolio (Securities Available for Sale)

Fair values of the Group’s investment portfolio

 

in m.

  Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 2014       Dec 31, 2013    

Debt securities:

     

German government

    18,042          14,370          9,076     

U.S. Treasury and U.S. government agencies

    2,890          235          1,571     

U.S. local (municipal) governments

    3,103          2,777          126     

Other foreign governments

    34,123          31,805          22,570     

Corporates

    8,922          8,512          9,248     

Other asset-backed securities

    588          646          943     

Mortgage-backed securities, including obligations of U.S. federal agencies

    28          236          53     

Other debt securities

    570          551          656     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total debt securities

    68,266          59,132          44,242     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Equity securities:

     

Equity shares

    1,166          1,184          979     

Investment certificates and mutual funds

    75          99          98     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total equity securities

    1,241          1,283          1,076     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    69,507          60,415          45,319     

 

 

Fair value, amortized cost and gross unrealized holding gains and losses for the Group’s securities available for sale

 

Dec 31, 2015         Gross unrealized holding        

in m.

  Fair value       Gains       Losses       Amortized cost    

Debt securities:

       

German government

    18,042          241          66          17,867     

U.S. Treasury and U.S. government agencies

    2,890          0          53          2,943     

U.S. local (municipal) governments

    3,103          56          0          3,046     

Other foreign governments

    34,123          741          67          33,450     

Corporates

    8,922          339          59          8,641     

Other asset-backed securities

    588          46          4          546     

Mortgage-backed securities, including obligations of U.S. federal agencies

    28          1          0          27     

Other debt securities

    570          1          3          572     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total debt securities

    68,266          1,425          252          67,093     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Equity securities:

       

Equity shares

    1,166          396          3          782     

Investment certificates and mutual funds

    75          2          2          75     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total equity securities

    1,241          398          5          857     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    69,507          1,824          257          67,950     

 

 

The following table presents the fair value, remaining maturities, approximate weighted-average yields (based on amortized cost) and total amortized cost by maturity distribution of the debt security components of the Group’s investment portfolio as of December 31, 2015:

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       S-6
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

    Up to one year       More than one year and up  
to five years  
    More than five years and up  
to ten years  
    More than ten years       Total    

in m.

  Amount       Yield       Amount       Yield       Amount       Yield       Amount       Yield       Amount       Yield    
German government     1,213          1.5 %          9,002          1.4 %          6,200          1.8 %          1,627          5.6 %          18,042          1.9 %     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
U.S. Treasury and U.S. government agencies     204          0.5 %          2,686          0.2 %          0          0.0 %          0          0.0 %          2,890          0.2 %     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
U.S. local (municipal) governments     1          0.7 %          (1)          0.0 %          0          0.0 %          3,102          3.7 %          3,103          3.7 %     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other foreign governments     2,503          1.9 %          18,474          1.4 %          11,002          1.9 %          2,145          1.3 %          34,123          1.6 %     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Corporates     784          3.8 %          3,903          2.5 %          2,790          3.1 %          1,445          5.1 %          8,922          3.2 %     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other asset-backed securities     (12)          (0.0) %          101          1.4 %          213          4.6 %          286          4.9 %          588          4.3 %     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Mortgage-backed securities, including obligations of U.S. federal agencies     20          1.2 %          5          0.7 %          3          0.2 %          0        0.0 %          28          1.0 %     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other debt securities     384          2.4 %          39          2.2 %          40          3.4 %          107          0.1 %          570          2.1 %     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total fair value     5,097          2.1 %          34,209          1.4 %          20,248          2.0 %          8,712          3.6 %        68,266          1.9 %     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total amortized cost     5,110            33,719            19,965            8,299            67,093       

 

 

Loans Outstanding

Analysis of the Group’s loan portfolio by industry sector and by the borrower’s country of domicile (in- or outside Germany)

 

in m.

  Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 20141       Dec 31, 2013       Dec 31, 2012       Dec 31, 2011    

German:

         

Financial intermediation

    5,609          6,920          6,197          7,949          10,177     

Fund management activities

    344          296          0          0          0     

Manufacturing

    8,508          8,583          7,428          8,463          9,154     

Wholesale and retail trade

    4,563          4,294          4,062          4,212          3,948     

Households

    137,332          137,162          135,123          131,047          126,462     

Commercial real estate activities

    21,372          19,275          20,418          20,762          21,093     

Public sector

    12,785          12,725          11,417          9,729          10,747     

Lease financing

    482          723          712          244          820     

Other

    11,515          12,909          15,599          16,675          17,746     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total German

    202,510          202,888          200,956          199,081          200,147     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-German:

         

Financial intermediation

    51,438          52,666          18,903          19,900          25,131     

Fund management activities

    24,663          11,842          0          0          0     

Manufacturing

    18,486          17,036          13,978          14,740          13,600     

Wholesale and retail trade

    12,274          11,420          9,903          12,814          11,097     

Households

    62,674          60,817          58,393          49,927          47,726     

Commercial real estate activities

    21,721          16,490          13,841          24,544          25,050     

Public sector

    4,396          5,357          4,811          5,649          5,665     

Lease financing

    79          381          718          636          859     

Other

    35,309          31,988          60,584          74,915          87,782     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Non-German

    231,039          207,995          181,130          203,125          216,910     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross loans

    433,549          410,883          382,086          402,206          417,057     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

(Deferred expense)/unearned income

    772          58          (85)         137          381     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loan less (deferred expense)/unearned income

    432,777          410,825          382,171          402,069          416,676     

 

 
1 

Comparatives have been restated to reflect changes in industry sectors.

Included in the category Other is Fund Management activities exposure of  10.0 billion,  16.8 billion and  25.0 billion for December 31, 2013, 2012 and 2011, respectively.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
S-7   Deutsche Bank   PART I – 8   Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F   PART II – 103   Annual Report – 116
    PART III – 114   Supplemental Financial Information
      (Unaudited) – 1
                              
     

 

                    

Loan Maturities and Sensitivity to Changes in Interest Rates

Analysis of maturities of the Group’s loan portfolio (excluding lease financing)

 

Dec 31, 2015

in m.

  Within 1 year       After one but  
within 5 years  
    After 5 years       Total    

German:

       

Financial intermediation

    3,397          1,850          362          5,609     

Fund management activities

    239          75          31          344     

Manufacturing

    5,580          2,421          507          8,508     

Wholesale and retail trade

    3,505          790          268          4,563     

Households (excluding mortgages)

    5,843          5,767          6,778          18,388     

Households – mortgages

    6,901          17,005          95,038          118,944     

Commercial real estate activities

    3,208          6,552          11,612          21,372     

Public sector

    6,157          3,010          3,618          12,785     

Other

    4,648          4,490          2,377          11,515     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total German

    39,478          41,960          120,591          202,028     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-German:

       

Financial intermediation

    30,182          15,424          5,832          51,438     

Fund management activities

    12,228          5,863          6,572          24,663     

Manufacturing

    11,867          5,338          1,281          18,486     

Wholesale and retail trade

    9,307          2,214          753          12,274     

Households (excluding mortgages)

    13,765          9,856          3,308          26,929     

Households – mortgages

    4,227          2,717          28,801          35,745     

Commercial real estate activities

    6,933          10,596          4,191          21,721     

Public sector

    1,143          1,102          2,151          4,396     

Other

    13,564          16,033          5,712          35,309     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Non-German

    103,216          69,144          58,601          230,961     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gross loans

    142,693          111,104          179,191          432,989     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

(Deferred expense)/unearned income

    (23)         29          766          772     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loans less (deferred expense)/unearned income

    142,717          111,075          178,425          432,217     

 

 

Volumes of loans in loan portfolio (excluding lease financing) with residual maturities of more than one year from that date

 

Dec 31,2015

in m.

  After one but  
within 5 years  
    After 5 years       Total    

Fixed rate loans

    90,951        149,756        240,708   

Floating or adjustable rate loans

    20,153        29,435        49,588   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    111,104        179,191        290,295   

 

 

Risk Elements

The following section provides information about certain risk elements included in the loan portfolio intended to address the requirements of SEC Industry Guide 3 while at the same time reflect the classifications most relevant to how Deutsche Bank Group evaluates the credit quality of its loan portfolio. All potential problem loans, which are defined as loans where known information about possible credit problems of borrowers causes the Group’s management to have serious doubts as to the ability of such borrowers to comply with the present loan repayment terms, are included in this disclosure of risk elements.

Loans 90 days or more Past Due and still accruing

Exposure of loans carried at amortized cost which were 90 days or more past due and still accruing for the last five years

 

in m.

  Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 2014       Dec 31, 2013       Dec 31, 2012       Dec 31, 2011    

German

    278          499          745          336          403     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-German

    135          148          238          118          147     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total loans 90 days or more past due and still accruing     413          647          983          454          550     

 

 
 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       S-8
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

Impaired Loans

Breakdown of the Group’s IFRS impaired loans by region based on the borrower’s country of domicile

 

in m.

  Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 2014       Dec 31, 2013       Dec 31, 2012       Dec 31, 2011    

Germany

    3,004          3,499          3,261          3,615          3,721     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Western Europe (excluding Germany)

    4,337          4,986          5,832          5,476          4,665     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Eastern Europe

    255          259          252          344          241     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

North America

    342          425          590          626          1,133     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Central and South America

    6          3          32          41          40     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Asia/Pacific

    178          174          175          233          270     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Africa

    26          1          1          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other

    2          1          0          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total impaired loans

    8,151          9,348          10,143          10,335          10,070     

 

 

Breakdown of the Group’s IFRS impaired loans by industry sector of the borrower

 

in m.

  Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 20141       Dec 31, 2013       Dec 31, 2012       Dec 31, 2011    

Financial intermediation

    155          270          45          53          118     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Fund management activities

    8          64          93          128          917     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Manufacturing

    712          757          811          926          831     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Wholesale and retail trade

    497          591          661          554          468     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Households

    3,263          3,750          3,671          3,707          3,402     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Commercial real estate activities

    1,646          2,048          2,683          3,358          2,945     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Public sector

    16          54          39          0          0     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other2

    1,854          1,815          2,139          1,609          1,389     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total impaired loans

    8,151          9,348          10,143          10,335          10,070     

 

 
1 

Comparatives have been restated to reflect changes in industry sectors.

2 

Thereof ‘Transportation, storage and communication’: Total Impaired Loans 858 million (44 %) in 2015 and 804 million (39 %) in 2014. The rest is split across varrious industries (of which no single one contributes 25 % or more o the total of the category ‘Other’).

Interest Revenue of Impaired Loans

The following table shows the approximate effect on interest revenue of IFRS impaired loans. It shows the gross interest income that would have been recorded during the reporting period, if those loans had been current in accordance with their original terms and had been outstanding throughout the reporting period or since their origination, if Deutsche Bank Group only held them for part of the reporting period. It also shows the amount of interest income on those loans that was included in net income for the reporting period.

 

in m.

  2015    

German loans:

 

Gross amount of interest that would have been recorded at original rate

    126     

Less interest, net of reversals, recognized in interest revenue

    34     

 

 

 

 

 

Reduction of interest revenue

    91     

 

 

 

 

 

Non-German loans:

 

Gross amount of interest that would have been recorded at original rate

    70     

Less interest, net of reversals, recognized in interest revenue

    32     

 

 

 

 

 

Reduction of interest revenue

    38     

 

 

 

 

 

Total reduction of interest revenue

    129     

 

 

 

 

                    

 


Table of Contents
S-9   Deutsche Bank   PART I – 8   Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F   PART II – 103   Annual Report – 116
    PART III – 114   Supplemental Financial Information
      (Unaudited) – 1
                              
     

 

                    

Renegotiated Loans

Breakdown of the Group’s renegotiated loans representing our troubled debt restructurings

 

in m.

  Dec 31, 2015       Dec 31, 20141       Dec 31, 2013       Dec 31, 2012       Dec 31, 2011    
Renegotiated loans considered nonimpaired          

German

    520          502          383          210          114     

Non-German

    356          448          399          678          950     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total renegotiated loans considered nonimpaired     876          950          783          888          1,064     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Renegotiated loans considered impaired          

German

    942          1,145          709          309          252     

Non-German

    876          1,125          1,140          1,317          1,102     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total renegotiated loans considered impaired     1,819          2,270          1,849          1,626          1,354     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Renegotiated loans

         

German

    1,463          1,647          1,092          519          366     

Non-German

    1,233          1,573          1,539          1,995          2,052     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total renegotiated loans

    2,695          3,220          2,632          2,514          2,418     

 

 
1 

Comparatives for forborne assets as per Financial Report 2014 have been restated. As a result, Total renegotiated loans increased by 457 million omitted in prior disclosure.

The Group’s renegotiated loans declined by 525 million or 16 % in 2015 driven by disposals and charge offs of impaired assets in NCOU and Postbank.

Restated 2014 renegotiated loans increased by 588 million compared to 2013. The increase in impaired renegotiated loans of 421 million was driven by Postbank along with individually assessed items within Germany in NCOU and CB&S, which was nearly off-set outside Germany due to reductions mainly within NCOU. The increase in non-impaired renegotiated loans in 2014 was again driven by Postbank along with other individually assessed items in Germany.

In 2013, the level of the Group’s renegotiated loans increased by  118 million or 4.7 % to  2.6 billion compared to prior year-end. Reductions recorded for non-impaired loans were primarily due to one commercial real estate loan to a counterparty in Western Europe (excluding Germany) which was consolidated due to the Group obtaining control over the structured entity borrowers during the second quarter of 2013. The renegotiated loans considered impaired increased due to individually assessed items Germany in the Group’s core business for which a small number of new provisions were required.

In 2012, renegotiated loans increased by  96 million or 4 %. The key driver for the decrease in 2012 in Non-German renegotiated loans considered non-impaired was a single loan amounting to  435 million within the Group’s leveraged finance activities in Western Europe (excluding Germany) which became impaired and was partially written off. Excluding this single item, non-German renegotiated loans considered nonimpaired have increased in line with the Group’s total renegotiated loans position.

In 2011, increases included several large transactions in the Group’s commercial real estate activities through the Group’s entities in the UK and the Americas as well as in subsidiaries the Group acquired in 2010 in Germany. Renegotiated loans also increased to a lesser extent in Spain due to the deteriorating home finance market.

It should be noted that these renegotiations are not part of a special modification or restructuring program such as the Fannie Mae “Home Affordable Modification Program”. Rather, new terms (for example modification of interest rates, principal amounts, interest due, maturities, etc.) were arranged depending on the requirements of the individual renegotiation.

Foreign Outstandings

The following tables list only those countries for which the cross-border outstandings exceeded 0.75 % of the Group’s total assets as of December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013. Offsetting of local country claims is done for third party liabilities of the respective foreign offices that represent legal obligations of the foreign offices and for which no payment is guaranteed at locations outside of the country of the office. As of December 31, 2015, there were no outstandings that

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       S-10
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

exceeded 0.75 % of total assets in any country currently facing debt restructuring or liquidity problems that the Group expects would materially impact the country’s ability to service its obligations.

 

Dec 31, 2015

 

in m.

(unless stated otherwise)

  Banks and  
other financial  
institutions  
    Governments  
and Official  
institutions   
    Other1        Commit-
ments   
    Net local  
country claim  
    Total        in %    

United States

    8,803          16,364          145,268          15,209          323,952          509,596          31.28     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Great Britain

    5,960          10,919          17,175          4,492          60,516          99,062          6.08     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Luxembourg

    9,458          13,531          36,149          3,877          10,297          73,312          4.50     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

France

    7,371          11,865          34,225          5,980          –          59,441          3.65     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Italy

    10,030          13,988          12,159          764          9,351          46,292          2.84     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Netherlands

    3,107          8,714          18,440          4,148          171          34,580          2.12     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Spain

    5,431          3,222          9,471          1,113          3,900          23,137          1.42     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Switzerland

    2,761          3,980          11,011          3,998          1,147          22,897          1.41     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ireland

    692          1,873          17,251          1,336          804          21,956          1.35     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

China

    5,114          1,977          9,600          600          51          17,342          1.06     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Japan

    963          1,117          10,741          568          2,639          16,028          0.98     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cayman Islands

    197          873          6,774          571          6,669          15,084          0.93     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

India

    3,921          1,008          6,436          235          3,066          14,666          0.90     

 

 
1 

Other includes commercial and industrial, insurance and other loans.

 

Dec 31, 2014

 

in m.

(unless stated otherwise)

  Banks and  
other financial  
institutions  
    Governments  
and Official  
institutions  
    Other1       Commit-
ments  
    Net local  
country claim  
    Total       in %    

United States

    7,662          30,096          125,879          10,645          29,982          204,264          11.95     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Great Britain

    6,816          6,777          52,563          3,579          43,348          113,083          6.62     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

France

    5,157          13,802          19,174          6,221          —          44,354          2.60     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Luxembourg

    7,712          8,706          23,328          3,395          879          44,020          2.58     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Netherlands

    4,210          9,562          22,930          3,848          112          40,662          2.38     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Italy

    9,662          18,914          7,840          446          3,228          40,090          2.35     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Spain

    6,865          3,579          8,134          738          4,737          24,053          1.41     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

China

    7,205          1,354          9,067          605          42          18,273          1.07     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ireland

    985          1,115          14,238          1,079          839          18,256          1.07     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Switzerland

    2,138          421          9,909          3,813          1,098          17,379          1.02     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

India

    3,884          551          5,940          235          2,846          13,456          0.79     

 

 
1 

Other includes commercial and industrial, insurance and other loans.

 

Dec 31, 2013

 

in m.

(unless stated otherwise)

  Banks and  
other financial  
institutions  
    Governments  
and Official  
institutions  
    Other 1       Commit-
ments  
    Net local  
country  claim  
    Total       in %    

United States

    9,301          35,837          101,532          7,751          107,383          261,804          16.25     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Great Britain

    8,073          9,506          44,878          2,524          47,587          112,568          6.99     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Luxembourg

    8,226          6,597          46,089          1,559          398          62,869          3.90     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

France

    4,754          16,799          14,889          7,430          —          43,872          2.72     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Netherlands

    3,228          11,917          18,246          4,256          219          37,866          2.35     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Italy

    6,156          21,707          7,583          621          4,877          40,944          2.54     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Japan

    2,002          2,253          16,195          238          7,112          27,800          1.73     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Spain

    6,726          4,492          5,998          975          5,266          23,457          1.46     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cayman Islands

    76          —          10,562          426          9,277          20,341          1.26     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Switzerland

    1,945          555          9,309          3,928          1,487          17,224          1.07     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

China

    6,867          622          6,403          259          45          14,196          0.88     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Australia

    1,549          1,327          5,515          205          5,623          14,219          0.88     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ireland

    1,122          507          9,152          705          887          12,373          0.77     

 

 
1 

Other includes commercial and industrial, insurance and other loans.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents

S-11

  Deutsche Bank   PART I – 8   Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F   PART II – 103   Annual Report – 116
    PART III – 114   Supplemental Financial Information
      (Unaudited) – 1
                              
     

 

                    

Allowance for Loan Losses

Breakdown of the movements in the Group’s allowance for loan losses

 

in m.

(unless stated otherwise)

  2015         2014         2013         20121         20111      

Balance, beginning of year

    5,212            5,589            4,692            4,158            3,296       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Charge-offs:

         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

German:

         

Financial intermediation

    (3)            (1)            (0)            (1)            (2)       

Manufacturing

    (32)            (52)            (79)            (42)            (93)       

Wholesale and retail trade

    (24)            (60)            (17)            (42)            (26)       

Households (excluding mortgages)

    (276)            (167)            (192)            (265)            (273)       

Households – mortgages

    (107)            (142)            (64)            (60)            (26)       

Commercial real estate activities

    (30)            (92)            (26)            (11)            (13)       

Public sector

    0             0             (0)            (0)            (0)       

Other

    (75)            (59)            (95)            (71)            (112)       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

German total

    (547)            (574)            (474)            (491)            (546)       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-German total

    (708)            (1,076)            (741)            (789)            (519)       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total charge-offs

    (1,255)            (1,650)            (1,215)            (1,281)            (1,065)       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Recoveries:

         

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

German:

         

Financial intermediation

    0            1            0            0            1       

Manufacturing

    14            9            10            10            18       

Wholesale and retail trade

    3            3            3            6            8       

Households (excluding mortgages)

    33            26            64            106            93       

Households – mortgages

    39            40            38            15            1       

Commercial real estate activities

    7            3            2            2            3       

Public sector

    0            0            0            0            0       

Other

    14            13            18            19            17       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

German total

    110            95            136            158            142       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-German total

    51            46            26            37            26       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total recoveries

    161            141            162            195            168       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net charge-offs

    (1,094)           (1,509)           (1,053)           (1,086)           (897)      

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Provision for loan losses

    882            1,129            2,060            1,728            1,832       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Other changes (i.e., exchange rate changes, changes in the group of consolidated companies)     28            3            (109)            (108)            (69)       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, end of year

    5,028            5,212            5,589            4,692            4,162       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Percentage of total net charge-offs to average loans for the year

    0.25 %            0.37 %            0.28 %            0.27 %            0.22 %       

 

 
1 

Allowance, beginning of year 2012 differs from Allowance, end of year 2011 due to changes in consolidation rules according to IFRS 10.

2 

Comparatives have been restated to reflect changes in industry sectors.

The Group’s allowance for loan losses as of December 31, 2015 was  5.0 billion, 55 % of which is related to collectively assessed and 45 % to individually assessed loan losses. The reduction in the allowance for loan losses of  184 million compared to prior year end mainly relates to  1.1 billion net charge-offs largely offset by  0.9 billion of additional loan loss provisions.

The reduction in 2015 in provisions for loan losses in our individually assessed loan portfolio amounted to  164 million driven by IAS 39 reclassified assets and other real estate exposures recorded in NCOU, partly offset by higher provisioning in our Shipping and Leveraged Finance Portfolios in CB&S. The reduction in our collectively assessed loan portfolio of 83 million mainly results from higher releases related to NPL sales along with an ongoing positive credit environment in Germany and a stabilization of Southern European markets.

The reduction in charge offs of 415 million compared to 2014 is mainly driven by Postbank and results from high prior year levels caused by a one-off effect due to the alignment of processes.

Our allowance for loan losses for IAS 39 reclassified assets, which are reported in NCOU, amounted to  389 million at the end of 2015, representing 8 % of our total allowance for loan losses, down 25 % from the level at the end of the prior year which amounted to  518 million (10 % of total allowance for loan losses). This reduction was driven by net

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       S-12
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

charge offs of 113 million along with net releases of 44 million and partly offset by increases related to foreign exchange as most IAS 39 reclassified assets are denominated in non-Euro currencies.

Compared to 2014, provision for loan losses for IAS 39 reclassified assets dropped by  129 million and net charge-offs increased by  98 million in 2015. Both changes were partly related to disposals.

The Group’s allowance for loan losses as of December 31, 2014 was  5.2 billion, 55 % of which is related to collectively assessed and 45 % to individually assessed loan losses. The reduction in the allowance for loan losses of  376 million compared to prior year end mainly relates to  1.5 billion net charge-offs largely offset by  1.1 billion of additional loan loss provisions.

The Group’s provision for loan losses decreased by  930 million or 45 % in 2014 compared with 2013. The reduction in our individually assessed loan portfolio of  878 million reflects material reductions across all businesses. The reduction in NCOU was driven by decreased provision for credit losses in IAS 39 reclassified and commercial real estate assets, while the performance in our Core Bank benefited from increased releases and a non-recurrence of large single name bookings. Provisions for our collectively assessed portfolio decreased compared to prior year reflecting among other factors the ongoing good environment in the German credit market.

The main driver of the increase in charge-offs in 2014 against our individually assessed loan portfolio was an alignment of processes in Postbank. This alignment resulted in an adjustment of the level of loan loss allowance for loans recorded at Postbank by  233 million reflecting accelerated write-offs as well as the elimination of previous misclassification of recoveries in the credit quality of Postbank loans, which had been impaired after change of control, as interest income. Additionally, higher charge-offs in GTB relating to a single client credit event in the prior year contributed to the overall increase which was partly offset by reductions in charge-offs for IAS 39 reclassified assets. The increase in charge-offs against our collectively assessed loan portfolio mainly related to the disposal of impaired loan portfolios in Italy.

The Group’s allowance for loan losses as of December 31, 2013 was attributable 51 % to individually assessed and 49 % to collectively assessed loan losses. The net increase in the allowance for loan losses of  897 million compared with prior year end results from additions of 2.1 billion partly offset by  1.1 billion of net charge-offs and  110 million other changes, such as accretion of interest on impaired loans and foreign exchange effects.

The Group’s provision for loan losses increased by  332 million or 19 % in 2013 compared with 2012. This increase was driven by the individually assessed loan portfolio, where provisioning increased by  262 million along with an increase of  70 million in the collectively assessed portfolio. The increase of provisions in the individually assessed loan portfolio is a result of a single client credit event recorded in GTB, increased provisioning for shipping exposure recorded in CB&S and higher charges in NCOU driven by single client items amongst others related to the European Commercial Real Estate sector. The increase in the collectively assessed loan portfolio was driven by NCOU and was mainly the result of higher provisioning related to the Group’s de-risking activities. This increase was partly offset by reductions in the Group’s Core business mainly reflecting an improved credit environment in the German retail market compared to prior year.

Net charge-offs slightly decreased by  33 million or 3 % in 2013 driven by a reduction of  61 million in the individually assessed loan portfolio and partly offset by an increase of  28 million in the Group’s collectively assessed loan portfolio.

The Group’s allowance for loan losses as of December 31, 2012 was  4.7 billion, 52 % of which is related to collectively assessed and 48 % to individually assessed loan losses. The increase in the allowance for loan losses of  531 million mainly relates to  1.7 billion of additional loan loss provisions partly offset by  1.1 billion of charge-offs.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents

S-13

  Deutsche Bank           PART I – 8   Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F           PART II – 103   Annual Report – 116
            PART III – 114   Supplemental Financial Information
      (Unaudited) – 1
                              
     

 

                    

The Group’s provision for loan losses decreased by  104 million or 6 % in 2012 compared with 2011. This decrease was driven by the collectively assessed loan portfolio, which saw a reduction of  312 million or 34 % driven by lower levels of provisioning for non-impaired loans within the NCOU mainly as a result of the Group’s de-risking measures along with lower provisioning in the homogenous Postbank portfolio basically driven by improvements in the portfolio quality. Further credit was recorded in other interest income representing increases in the credit quality of Postbank loans recorded at fair value on initial consolidation in the Group accounts. The increase in provisions for individually assessed loans of  208 million or 23 % is related to assets which had been reclassified in accordance with IAS 39 in North America and United Kingdom now held in the NCOU.

Net charge-offs increased by  189 million or 21 % in 2012. Net charge-offs for individually assessed loans were up  249 million mainly related to assets which had been reclassified in accordance with IAS 39.

The Group’s allowance for loan losses as of December 31, 2011 was  4.2 billion, a 26 % increase from prior year end. The increase in the Group’s allowance was principally due to increased new provisions following the first full year consolidation of Postbank and lower net charge-offs compared to the prior year.

The Group’s provision for loan losses showed an increase of  520 million or 40 % in 2011, thereof  345 million or 61 % related to individually assessed loans, and  175 million or 23 % related to the Group’s collectively assessed loan portfolios. The rise in individually assessed provision for loan losses was driven by the first time consolidation of Postbank and furthermore reflected impairment charges taken on a number of exposures in the Americas and in Europe in an overall challenging global economic credit environment. Reduced provisioning levels for IAS 39 reclassified assets partly compensated these increases. Loan loss provisions for the Group’s collectively assessed loan portfolios, which increased by 23 % compared to 2010, were also affected by the first time consolidation of Postbank. Excluding Postbank, the loan loss provision for the Group’s collectively assessed exposure was reduced due to the Group’s retail business in Germany which contributed lower provisions, despite the challenging economic environment.

The Group’s net charge-offs decreased by  403 million or 31 % in 2011, almost fully related to the Group’s individually assessed loans, where the Group saw a reduction of  384 million fully driven by IAS 39 reclassified assets.

The following table presents an analysis of the changes in the non-German component of the allowance for loan losses. As of December 31, 2015, 67 % of the Group’s total allowance was attributable to non-German clients compared to 64 % as of December 31, 2014.

 

in m.

   2015         2014         2013         2012         2011     

Balance, beginning of year

     3,339            3,612            2,968            2,509            2,284      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Provision for loan losses

     612            724            1,438            1,152            751      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net charge-offs

     (657)           (1,030)           (715)           (752)           (493)     

Charge-offs

     (708)           (1,076)           (741)           (789)           (519)     

Recoveries

     51            46            26            37            26      

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 
Other changes (i.e., exchange rate changes, changes in the group of consolidated companies)      51            34            (80)           59            (33)     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Balance, end of year

     3,345            3,339            3,612            2,968            2,509      

 

 

The following table presents the components of the Group’s allowance for loan losses by industry of the borrower, and the percentage of its total loan portfolio accounted for by those industry classifications, on the dates specified. The breakdown between German and non-German borrowers is based on the location of the borrowers.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       S-14
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

in m.

(unless stated otherwise)

  Dec 31, 2015     Dec 31, 20141     Dec 31, 2013     Dec 31, 2012     Dec 31, 2011  

German:

                   

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Individually assessed loan loss allowance:

                   

Financial intermediation

    0          1 %          2          1 %          2          2 %          1          2 %          13          2 %     

Manufacturing

    196          2 %          213          2 %          236          2 %          277          2 %          252          2 %     

Households (excluding mortgages)

    98          4 %          152          4 %          139          5 %          94          5 %          78          4 %     

Households – mortgages

    6          27 %          6          29 %          11          30 %          14          28 %          12          26 %     

Public sector

    0          3 %          0          3 %          0          3 %          0          2 %          0          3 %     

Wholesale and retail trade

    84          1 %          82          1 %          129          1 %          111          1 %          112          1 %     

Commercial real estate activities

    48          5 %          78          5 %          149          5 %          157          5 %          241          5 %     

Other2

    216          3 %          207          4 %          197          4 %          128          4 %          124          4 %     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Individually assessed loan loss allowance German total     647            740            864            782            832       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Collectively assessed loan loss allowance     1,035            1,133            1,113            942            821       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
German total     1,683          47 %          1,873          50 %          1,977          53 %          1,724          49 %          1,653          48 %     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Non-German:                    

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Individually assessed loan loss allowance

    1,604            1,624            1,993            1,484            1,179       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Collectively assessed loan loss allowance

    1,741            1,715            1,619            1,484            1,327       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Non-German total     3,345          53 %          3,339          50 %          3,612          47 %          2,968          51 %          2,507          52 %     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total allowance for loan losses     5,028          100 %          5,212          100 %          5,589          100 %          4,692          100 %          4,162          100 %     

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total individually assessed loan loss allowance     2,252            2,364            2,857            2,266            2,011       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total collectively assessed loan loss allowance     2,776            2,849            2,732            2,426            2,150       

 

 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total allowance for loan losses

    5,028            5,212            5,589            4,692            4,162       

 

 
1 

Comparatives have been restated to reflect changes in industry sectors.

2 

Includes mainly Transportation and Services.

Deposits

The amount of other time deposits in the amount of U.S.$ 100,000 or more in offices in Germany was  39.4 billion as of December 31, 2015, thereof with maturities within three months  16.3 billion, after three months but within six months  9.3 billion, after six months but within one year  7.1 billion and after one year  6.8 billion. The amount of certificates of deposits in the amount of U.S.$ 100,000 or more in offices in Germany was  2.0 billion as of December 31, 2015, thereof with maturities within three months  212 million and after six months but within one year  1.8 billion.

The amount of certificates of deposits and other time deposits in the amount of U.S.$ 100,000 or more issued by non-German offices was  37.3 billion as of December 31, 2015.

Total deposits by foreign depositors in German offices were 40.5 billion, 38.4 billion and  24.8 billion as of December 31, 2015, 2014 and 2013, respectively.

Return on Equity and Assets

 

     2015        2014        2013    

Return on average shareholders’ equity (post-tax)1

     (9.84) %           2.71 %           1.19 %     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Return on average total assets (post-tax)2

     (0.38) %           0.10 %           0.03 %     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Equity to assets ratio3

     3.86 %           3.56 %           2.89 %     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Dividend payout ratio:4

        

Basic earnings per share

     0 %           56 %           112 %     

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Diluted earnings per share

     0 %           57 %           115 %     

 

 

N/M – Not meaningful

1 

Net income (loss) attributable to Deutsche Bank shareholders as a percentage of average shareholders’ equity.

2 

Net income (loss) attributable to Deutsche Bank shareholders as a percentage of average total assets.

3 

Average shareholders’ equity as a percentage of average total assets for each year.

4 

Dividends paid per share in respect of each year as a percentage of the Group’s basic and diluted earnings per share for that year.

 

                    

 


Table of Contents

S-15

  Deutsche Bank   PART I – 8   Signatures – 115
  Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F   PART II – 103   Annual Report – 116
    PART III – 114   Supplemental Financial Information
      (Unaudited) – 1
                              
     

 

                    

Short-Term Borrowings with an original maturity of one year or less

The difference between the period-end and average balances for central bank funds purchased and securities sold under repurchase agreements mainly arises from fluctuating activity with respect to fixed income securities positions within CB&S. Intra-quarter trading volume, which increases the monthly averages relative to quarter- and year-end, predominantly comprises financing of short-term positions in highly liquid U.S. Treasuries and Agencies, which is a result of the Bank providing liquidity to the market via market-making activity and is largely driven by client demand. These U.S. Treasury and Agency positions are very low risk and have negligible impact on the firm’s liquidity and capital position.

 

in m.

(unless stated otherwise)

   Dec 31, 2015          Dec 31, 2014          Dec 31, 2013      
Central bank funds purchased and securities sold under repurchase agreements:         

Balance, end of year

     9,803             10,887             13,381       

Average balance1

     10,541             24,566             42,706       

Maximum balance at any month-end

     17,520             42,492             75,762       

Weighted-average interest rate during the year

     1.45 %             0.65 %             0.44 %       

Weighted-average interest rate on year-end balance

     0.89 %             1.25 %             0.32 %       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Securities loaned:

        

Balance, end of year

     3,270             2,339             2,106       

Average balance1

     3,015             3,834             4,562       

Maximum balance at any month-end

     3,449             4,443             6,837       

Weighted-average interest rate during the year

     (1.50) %             (4.08) %             (4.57) %       

Weighted-average interest rate on year-end balance

     0.32 %             1.01 %             0.25 %       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Commercial paper:

        

Balance, end of year

     9,327             14,787             20,852       

Average balance1

     13,130             21,472             24,936       

Maximum balance at any month-end

     15,883             25,738             28,496       

Weighted-average interest rate during the year

     0.47 %             0.43 %             0.37 %       

Weighted-average interest rate on year-end balance

     0.65 %             0.49 %             0.29 %       

 

  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other:

        

Balance, end of year

     18,683             28,144             38,915       

Average balance1

     21,195             32,608             45,524       

Maximum balance at any month-end

     24,451             39,034             49,770       

Weighted-average interest rate during the year

     0.79 %             0.38 %             0.43 %       

Weighted-average interest rate on year-end balance

     0.55 %             0.34 %             0.32 %       

 

 

 

1 

Based upon month-end balances.

 


Table of Contents
Deutsche Bank       S-16
Annual Report 2015 on Form 20-F      
     
     

 

 

[Page intentionally left blank]